Search results
Pages
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Summer Catalog, 1976
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
ALL COURSES a t Augsburg College c a r r y a v a l u e of one Course C r e d i t ,
t h e e q u i v a l e n t of s i x q u a r t e r c r e d i t s o r f o u r s e m e s t e r c r e d i t s .
PROJECTED SUMMER OFFERINGS a r e l i s t e d i n t h i s brochure.,
LOWER-DIVISION COURSES, i n t e n...
Show more
ALL COURSES a t Augsburg College c a r r y a v a l u e of one Course C r e d i t ,
t h e e q u i v a l e n t of s i x q u a r t e r c r e d i t s o r f o u r s e m e s t e r c r e d i t s .
PROJECTED SUMMER OFFERINGS a r e l i s t e d i n t h i s brochure.,
LOWER-DIVISION COURSES, i n t e n d e d p r i m a r i l y f o r freshman and sophomore s t u d e n t s , a r e t h o s e w i t h a 1 o r 2 a s t h e t h i r d d i g i t of t h e
f i v e - d i g i t Course Number. A 3 o r 4 i n t h a t p o s i t i o n i n d i c a t e s a n
upper-division course, intended primarily f o r juniors o r seniors.
COURSES REGULARLY TAUGHT d u r i n g t h e academic y e a r a r e more f u l l y
I f you need
d e s c r i b e d i n t h e c a t a l o g i s s u e of AUGSaURG COLLEGE NW.
more i n f o r m a t i o n about a s p e c i a l summer o f f e r i n g , p l e a s e c o n t a c t
t h e Summer School O f f i c e .
INDEPENDENT STUW, while not f i t e d among M e couhbe o66&n@, may
be pwlnued d d n g M e nummm i n a nwnbm 06 d e p a h t m e d . Fok &dotm d o n , cons& M e Summm School O66ice.
CHANGES I N REGISTRATION must b e made a t t h e Summer School O f f i c e .
No c o u r s e may b e added a f t e r i t h a s met more t h a n s i x h o u r s e l a p s e d
c l a s s time, e x c e p t w i t h t h e s p e c i a l permission of t h e i n s t r u c t o r .
THE COLLEGE RESERVES THE RIWT TO CANCEL LISTED COUSES.
SUMMER SCHOOLCHARGES i n c l u d e a G e n e r a l Fee of $15. T u i t i o n i s $190
p e r c o u r s e . Laboratory o r s p e c i a l f e e s may b e charged f o r some
courses.
A DEPOSIT of $30 must accompany t h e A p p l i c a t i o n Form. T h i s d e p o s i t
i s r e f u n d a b l e o n l y i f t h e c o u r s e s l i s t e d by t h e s t u d e n t , i n c l u d i n g
a l t e r n a t e s , should b e c a n c e l l e d .
The d e p o s i t a p p l i e s toward t h e
General Fee and T u i t i o n .
CHARGE FOR AUDITING a c o u r s e ( t a k i n g i t w i t h o u t c o l l e g e c r e d i t ) i s
I n courses with limited enrollment, ere$90 p l u s $15 g e n e r a l f e e .
ference w i l l be given t o f u l l - t u i t i o n students.
REGISTRATTON .in t o be compL&ed not Latea Man t h e
6 h t
day
06
each
tm at M e Summm School Oddice. A L L CHARGES doh .the tm mwt be
paid bedote tegh-thation -in compLete. A L d e Reghthation Fee 06
$10 w i l l 2 be added doh ntudemh who compleXe keg.in,hztion a 6 t m t h e
6 i h 6 t day 0 6 M e t e r n .
TUITION REFUND f o r c a n c e l l e d c o u r s e s
COURSE CANCELLATION DATE
w i l l b e allowed a s i n d i c a t e d by t h e
REFUND
TERM I
TERM I1
t a b l e on t h e r i g h t .
( S U ~~ I C ~ U .in
J I ~--ToO%June 1-2 J u n e 28-30
fieimited by M e ion-he,jmdabLedepirn-LZ.) 80X
June 3-4
~ u l y1-6
No r e f u n d - w i l l be made a f t e r t h e l i s t e d
60%
June 7-8
J u l y 7-9
40%
June 9-10 J u l y 12-14
dates.
-
I I T ~ T ~
[I
4
I
ART
ART 10 132
PHOTOGRAPHY
F h i ~ ~ e n~ h n
The camera used a s a t o o l f o r v i s u a l c r e a t i v i t y and express i o n w i t h a t t e n t i o n g i v e n t o b l a c k and w h i t e , c o l o r and photographic processes.
Time a r r . ( 1 s t meeting 6/28 7:00 p.m. A r t S)
TERM 11
ART 10242
FILM MAKING I
RLUt e n
D i s c u s s i o n and o b s e r v a t i o n of t h e e x p r e s s i v e and s t r u c t u r a l
elements of f i l m w i t h p r a c t i c a l l a b o r a t o r y e x p e r i e n c e . Add. $70
fee.
TERM 1
Time a r r . ( 1 s t meeting 611 7:00 p.m. EH)
**
ART 10342
FILM MAKING I1
RusXen
Advanced c o u r s e f o r t h o s e w i t h p r e v i o u s e x p e r i e n c e i n f i l m
making. Add. $70 f e e .
TERM 1
Time a r r . ( 1 s t meeting 611 7:00 p.m. EH)
BIOLOGY
HUMAN ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
Uichelbmg
BIO 20103
A p r o f e s s i o n a l c o u r s e i n t h e s t r u c t u r e and f u n c t i o n of t h e
human body.
Course r u n s 10 weeks.
TERM I E I 1
6:OO-9:00 p.m. T,TH
S-205
BUSINESS
K a h
BUS 21101
PRINCIPLES OF FINANCIALACCOUNTING
I n t r o d u c t i o n t o b u s i n e s s a c t i v i t i e s , b a s i c c o n c e p t s and
fundamentals of a c c o u n t i n g , t h e a c c o u n t i n g c y c l e and p r e p a r a t i o n
of f i n a n c i a l s t a t e m e n t s .
TERM 1
1:50-5:00 p.m. M-Th
MH- 1
BUS 21 102
PRINCIPLES OF .WAGJRIAL ACCOUNTING
Kadm
I n t r o d u c t i o n t o b u s i n e s s a c t i v i t i e s , b a s i c concepts and
fundamentals o f m a n a g e r i a l a c c o u n t i n g .
TERM I
11:lO-1:40 p.m. M-F
S-22
BUSINESS EDUCATION
BED 33108
CALCULATING MACHINES
Lund
Operation of ten-key a d d i n g machine; r o t a r y , p r i n t i n g and
electronic calculators.
8:30-11:OO a.m. M-F
M-10
TERM 1
CHEMISTRY
CHM 34105
PRINCIPLES OF CHEMISTRY
k&on
Concepts and laws u n d e r l y i n g c h e m i s t r y i l l u s t r a t e d by a
v a r i e t y of examples i n c l u d i n g o r g a n i c and e n v i r o n m e n t a l systems.
TERM 11
12:OO-1:25 p.m. M-F, Lab 1:25-4:00 p.m. T-Th
S-205, S-323
CHM 3435 3
.QU@TITATIVE ANALYTICAL CHEMISTRY
Gybehg
Covers g r a v i m e t r i c and v o l u m e t r i c a n d y s i s and s o l u t i o n
e q u i l i b r i u m i n d e t a i l ; g i v e s an i n t r o d u c t i o n t o s p e c t r o p h o t o m e t r i c t e c h n i q u e s of a n a l y s i s .
10:25-11:50 a.m. M-F, Lab 12:OO-4:00 p.m. N-Th
TERM 11
S-205, S-327
ECONOMICS
ECO 22120
ECONOMICS OF URBAN ISSUES
Sabe&
Study of economic i m p l i c a t i o n s of many problems f a c i n g a
metro-urban environment.
TERM 1
6:50-10:OO p.m. M-Th
S-34
ECO 22122
PRINCIPLES OF ECONOMICS (MACRO)
Sub&
An i n t r o d u c t i o n t o macro-economics; n a t i o n a l income a n a l y s i s , monetary and f i s c a l p o l i c y , i n t e r n a t i o n a l t r a d e , economic
growth.
TERM 11
6:OO-9:30 p.m. M,W
L- 1
ECO 22123
PRINCIPLES OF ECONOMICS (MICRO)
SabtUa
An i n t r o d u c t i o n t o micro-economics, t h e t h e o r y of t h e housen o l d , f i r m , market s t r u c t u r e s and income d i s t r i b u t i o n .
6:oO-9:30 p.m.
T,Th
S-34
TERM 11
EDUCATION
ORIENTATION TO EDUCATION I N AN URBAN SETTISG
Pt&0n
(ELEMENTARY)
I n v e s t i g a t i o n of v a r i o u s a s p e c t s of t n e t e a c h i n g p r o f e s s i o n and o p p o r t u n i t y f o r in-school work.
TERM 1
8:30-11:OO a.m. M-F
L-4
EDE 44255
EDE 44425
NURSERY SCHOOL CURRICULUM: METHODS AND
MATERIALS
Redm
Learning about and d e m o n s t r a t i n g knowledge and s k i l l s of
t e a c h i n g t h e young c h i l d .
6:OO-9:30 p.m. T,Th
L-4
TERM 1
EDE 44481
STUDENT TEAMING (ELEMENTARY)
sXa66
Observing and d i r e c t i n g l e a r n i n g e x p e r i e n c e s i n elementary
s c h o o l s under s u p e r v i s i o n of c o l l e g e and elementary s c h o o l pers o n n e l . $15 f e e
TERU 1 0 . t 11
Time a r r a n g e d
EDS 44265
ORIENTATION TO EDUCATION ( S E C O N D A R Y ) F U ~ & ~
I n v e s t i g a t i o n of v a r i o u s a s p e c t s of t h e t e a c h i n g p r o f e s s i o n
and o p p o r t u n i t y f o r i n - s c i ~ o o l work.
TERM 1
9:50-12:20 p.m. M-F
L-4
C~-como'~)
8
EDS 45482
-9%
O p p o r t u n i t i * arm p r , d d e d zb?c;q e r s - q e s i n o b s e r v i n g
and d i r e c t i n g l e a r n i n g e x p e r i e n c e s on t h e s e c o n d a r y s c h o o l
l e v e l u n d e r t h e s u p e r v i s i o n of c o l l e g e and h i g h s c h o o l personnel.
$15.00 f e e .
TERM I oh I I
Time a r r a n g e d .
ENGLISH
**
ENG54282
TOPIC: T H R E E m $ m k W R I T E R S
Pdohaat~c
A u t h o r s s t u d i e d a r e Rolvaag, Lewis, and F i t z g e r a l d . F i e l d
t r i p s included.
TERM 11
12:OO-1:25 p.m. M-F
S-34
**
Thohntvn
ENG 54338
MODERN BRITISH LITERATURE
An e x a m i n a t i o n of t h e m a j o r t r e n d s i n modern B r i t i s h l i t e r a t u r e , f o c u s i n g on James J o y c e , D.H. Lawrence, V i r g i n i a Woolf,
T.S. E l i o t a n d o t h e r s .
TERM I
1:50-5:00 p.m. M-Th
S-205
**
ENG 54340
LITERATURE AND FILM
P d 0 h ~
T h i s c o u r s e w i l l i n v e s t i g a t e t h e d i f f e r e n c e s between w r i t t e n n a r r a t i v e and f i l m e d n a r r a t i v e . P r e r e q u i s i t e : c o l l e g e literature or film class.
TERM 11
6:OO-9:30 p.m. M,W
S-205
FRENCH
COACHING OF SPORTS
I~ n i g e h
HPE 55482
Theory and t e c h n i q u e s of c o a c h i n g and p r e v e n t i o n and c a r e
of a t h l e t i c i n j u r i e s .
G-24
7:lO-9:40 a . m . M-F
TERM I
C. ~ V e k o n
HPE 55485
APPLIED ADAPTED ACTIVITIES
Course i n c l u d e s c o n s i d e r a t i o n o f a m b u l a t i o n , s e l f c a r e ,
a d a p t e d s p o r t s and games, a n d swimming f o r t h e handicapped.
TERM I
F r i d a y e v e . , S a t u r d a y mom. G-12
HPE 55491
THERAPEUTIC EXERCISE
C. Nchon
A s t u d y of t h e t r e a t m e n t o f d i s e a s e and i n j u r y .
Includes
g e n e r a l p r i n c i p l e s and a d m i n i s t r a t i o n of n e u r o m u s c u l a r re-education.
TERM 11
F r i d a y e v e . , S a t u r d a y mom. G-12
Saugutad
HPE 55495
PROFESSIONAL AFFILIATION
Actual h o s p i t a l experience i n c o r r e c t i v e therapy; psychia t r y , orthopedics, neurology, and r e h a b i l i t a t i o n .
TERM 11
Time a r r a n g e d .
G- 12
HISTORY
Jem en
HIS 56103
MODERN WORLD
A s t u d y of t h e main c u r r e n t s i n w e s t e r n c i v i l i z a t i o n
from t h e t i m e of Napoleon t o t h e p r e s e n t .
6:50-10:OO p.m. M-Th
L-1
TERM I
**
FRE 70212
INTERMEDIATE FRENCH I1
Aan ko w
T w e n t i e t h - c e n t u r y l i t e r a r y works a r e e x p l o r e d w i t h t h e
g o a l s of communicating i d e a s a n d b u i l d i n g s u f f i c i e n t r e a d i n g
s k i l l t o p u r s u e g e n e r a l r e a d i n g and l i t e r a r y s t u d y i n F r e n c h .
TERM I
9:50-12:20 p.m. M-F
S-20 1
HIS 56234156334 QUELVS, COURTESANS AND CONSORTS N&on
A b a s i c c o u r s e i n t h e development of a n c i e n t c i v i l i z a t i o n ,
f o c u s i n g on t h e c e n t r a l theme of t h e p l a c e of women, b o t h publ i c and p r i v a t e , w i t h i n t h a t c u l t u r e .
TERM I1
10:25-11:50 a.m. M-F
S-34
GERMAN
IWTERDISCIPLINARY
GER 72111
BEGINNING GERMAN I
-sx~nm&z
Classroom p r a c t i c e i n s p e a k i n g , u n d e r s t a n d i n g and r e a d i n g
b a s i c German f o r s t u d e n t s w i t h no p r e v i o u s background i n G e r man.
TERM I
7: 10-9:40 a.m. M-F
S-201
Steinm&z
GER 72112
BEGINNING GERMAN T I
For s t u d e n t s who h a v e h a d 72111 o r e q u i v a l e n t o r l e s s
t h a n two y e a r s of h i g h s c h o o l German.
TERM I1
7: 15-8:40 a.m. ?I-F
S-20 1
HEALTH AND PHYSICAL EDUCATION
HPE 55111
SAFETY AND DRUG EDUCATION E.NeRnon, SaugenRad
An a n a l y s i s o f d r u g a b u s e and what c a n b e done f o r t h e
a b u s e s . A l s o i n c l u d e s American Red C r o s s F i r s t Aid c o u r s e .
TERM I
7:lO-9:40 a.m. M-F
G-12
**
INS 60110/60310
SICEKTFNNIAL SPECIAL:
POlJER I N AHERICA
P + Z L Lm~ d Py.'iud
The s o c i a l s c i e n c e , h i s t o r i c a l and l i t e r a l v i a r p o i n c s of
power; i t s h o l d e r s , t h e a d a p t i o n of t h o s e l e s s p o w e r f u l a n d t h e
d i f f u s i o n of power t o o t h e r p o p u l a t i o n s w i l l b e i n c l u d e d .
6:OO-9:30 p.m. T , Th
TERM 11
L- 1
PHILOSOPHY
PHI 83130
LOGIC
Reichenbach
Examination of t h e r u l e s which g o v e r n v a l i d a r g u m e n t s ;
d e v e l o p a b i l i t y t o r e c o g n i z e and c o n s t r u c t sound arguments.
TERM I
8:30-9:40 a.m. & 11:lO-12:20 p.m. M-F
L-4, L-1
**
PHI 83450
PHILOSOPHIES OF FEYINISM
P h i l o s o p h i c a l a n a l y s i s of key concepts of feminism i n myth,
l i t e r a t u r e , r e l i g i o n and a r t ; t h e o r i e s and i m p l i c a t i o n s of matr i a r c h i a l l p a t r i a r c h i a l , pro-feministlanti-feminist c u l t u r e s ,
c o u r t l y and romantic l o v e , and t h e c u l t of t h e v i r g i n . No prerequisites
TERN 11
10:25-11:50 a.m. Y-F
L- 1
.
PHYSICS
PHY 84101
Pa& on
ASTRONOMY
A d e s c r i p t i v e c o u r s e of o u r s o l a r system, s t a r s , and gal-
a x i e s . Requires elementary a l g e b r a .
TERM 11
6:OO-9:30 p.m. ?I,W
PSY 86375
SOCIAL PSYCHOLOGY
MLLJL~u
An examination o f t h e i d e a o f "group", i t s r e l a t i o n s h i p t o
i n d i v i d u a l b e h a v i o r and s o c i e t y .
TERM 11
12:OO-1:25 p.m. M-F
L- 1
PSY 86493
SEMINAR: CONTEMPORARY ISSUES
Andexegg
P o i n t s of view w i t h i n b e h a v i o r a l s c i e n c e on contemporary
p r o f e s s i o n a l and s o c i e t a l i s s u e s . P r e r e q u i s i t e :
3 courses i n
Psychology.
TERM 1
11:lO-1:40 p.m. M-F
MH- 1
MH- 1
RELIGION
POLITICAL SCIENCE
POL 85170
LAW I N THE UNITED STATES
Sten5 hoed
A s u r v e y of American law and l e g a l p r o c e s s . T h e o r i e s of
law; law and s o c i e t y ; r o l e s of c o u r t s , p o l i c e , l a w y e r s , and
j u r i e s ; t h e U.S. C o n s t i t u t i o n a s "supreme" law; law as p o l i t i c s ;
h i s t o r i c and contemporary l e g a l i s s u e s .
TERN 11
10:25-11:50 a.m. N-F
MH-1
POL 85295
SEMINAR: GANES OF POLITICS
Hedbdom
An approach t o t h e u n d e r s t a n d i n g of p o l i t i c a l i s s u e s and
p r o c e s s e s through s i m u l a t i o n .
TERU 1
8:30-11:OO a.m. N-F
Place a r r .
Hedbdom
POL 85342
YASS COMMUNICATIONS I N SOCIETY
E f f e c t s of mass communications on i n d i v i d u a l b e h a v i o r ;
t h e u s e s and c o n t r o l of mass media f o r p o l i t i c a l and s o c i a l
purposes i n c l u d i n g p u b l i c o p i n i o n r e s e a r c h and p o l i t i c a l publ i c relations.
ERA4 1
12:30-3:20 p.m. M-Th
L- 1
*
REL 87111
INTRODUCTION TO THEOLOGY
Quad ecir
An i n t r o d u c t i o n t o t h e academic d i s c i p l i n e of theology and
t o t h e d i a l o g u e between t h e church and t h e world view which concerns Christian doctrine.
8:50-10:15 a.m. M-F
L- 1
TERM 11
**
REL 87372
RELIGIONS OF INDIA:
HINDUISM AND BUDDHISM.
8en.6on
H i s t o r i c a l , l i t e r a r y and s o c i o l o g i c a l p e r s p e c t i v e s from
a n t i q u i t y t o t h e p r e s e n t . Uses primary t e x t s , f i l m s of Hindu
ritual.
TERM 11
8:50-10: 15 a.m. M-F
L-1
**
REL 87369
RELIGIOUS IMAGINATION I N MODERN LITERATURE
Skibbe
P a r t i c u l a r i t i e s of r e l i g i o u s discernment, symbolism and
world view w i l l b e d i s c u s s e d i n c o n v e r s a t i o n format.
9:50-12:20 p.m. M-F
S-205
TERM 1
SOCIOLOGY
PSYCHOLOGY
PSY 86 105
GENERAL PSYCHOLOGY
Fehcju OM-1,Mahhen-11
Methods and approaches used i n psychology f o r t h e purpose
of u n d e r s t a n d i n g b e h a v i o r .
TEa.1 1
8:30-11:OO a.m. Y-F
L-1
(Fe~cjuon)
TERM 11
8:50-10:15 a.m. M-F
S-34 (hiahken]
** PSY
SOC 94231
SOCIOLOGY OF THE FAMILY
Maeheb
An examination of t h e p a i r e d r e l a t i o n s h i p i n mass s o c i e t y ;
t h e p r o c e s s of d a t i n g and mate s e l e c t i o n ; m a r r i a g e and i t s a l t e r n a t i v e s ; and t h e dynamics and s t r u c t u r e of t h e f a m i l y u n i t .
TERM 1
8:30-11:OO a.m. M-F
S-34
SOC 94241
86130
COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT
Dyhud
A s t u d y w i l l b e made of t h e development of t h e c h i l d ' s
r e p r e s e n t a t i o n of e v e n t s , t h e s t a g e s , and example i n language,
reasoning and judgement.
Field t r i p .
$5 m a t e r i a l s f e e .
TERhi 11
8:50-10:15 a.m. Y-F
?lH- 1
PSY 8635 1
DEVELOPMENTAL PSYCHOLOGY: CHILD
Jchmon
A c t i v e i n q u i r y i n t o p r a c t i c a l i m p l i c a t i o n s and a p p l i c a t i o n s
of d a t a and t'neory i n r e s p e c t t o t h e development of c h i l d r e n .
TERM I
7: 10-9:40 a.m. TI-F
S-205
*(I( t.ie PbyCjloLogq C O ~ &Zed,
~ A
E d u c d o n heqLLihement.
u,rCI, - PSY
b6105 meea .the Genehd
- .--
INTRODUCTION TO CULTURAL ANTHROPOLOGY
G e ~ ~ a h o
THE CHILD'S WORLD:
An examination of t h e i d e a of c u l t u r e ; t h e p e r s o n ' s r e l a t i o n t o c u l t u r e ; language a s a major o r g a n i z i n g element i n t h e
way we s e e t h e world.
TERM I
8:30-11:OO a.m. M-F
MH- 1
**
SOC 94255
YOUTH WORK I N A WILDERNESS MEDIUM
Wagnu
Wilderness camping a s focus f o r b u i l d i n g groups and i n d i vidual relationships.
Add. $60 f e e .
Time a r r .
TERM 11
PERSONS I N GOOD STANDING a t r e g i o n a l l y a c c r e d i t e d c o l l e g e s and
u n i v e r s i t i e s , a s w e l l a s g r a d u a t e s of s u c h i n s t i t u t i o n s , a r e e l i g i b l e t o a t t e n d Augsburg Summer S c h o o l . Good s t a n d i n g i m p l i e s t h a t
t h e s t u d e n t h a s b e e n a d m i t t e d t o a c o l l e g e and h a s n o t s u b s e q u e n t l y
b e e n dropped by t h a t i n s t i t u t i o n .
STUDENTS ADMITTED to Augnbutg CoLCsge dcri -tire F& Tern 0 6 Lize cuhyyem m e e&g.ibBe t o attend .%InIm~h Sdlool, a5 ahe p C h 5 O r z h admiLted by otheh coLLeg~5 6oh t h e ha?? 0 6 t k i a yeah.
I F REGULARLY ATTENDING OR ADMITTED t o a n o t h e r e d u c a t i o n a l i n s t i t u t i o n , t h e a p p l i c a n t must p r o v i d e Augsburg Summer S c h o o l w i t h a s t a t e ment from a n a p p r o p r i a t e o f f i c i a l of h i s c o l l e g e t h a t h e i s i n good
s t a n d i n g and e l i g i b l e t o e a r n c r e d i t s d u r i n g t h e summer s e s s i o n s .
Credits
(A form f o r t h i s p u r p o s e i s a t t h e b o t t o m of t h i s p a g e . )
c a n n o t b e t r a n s f e r r e d u n t i l t h i s r e q u i r e m e n t h a s been f u l f i l l e d .
OTHER PERSONS whlzing t o .take bwnmeh school tuohk nizodd contact Rhe
D i h e c t o ~0 6 Sunnnek School t o ancehtain &ig-ibiLLty u n d u opecide
cihcmtancch .
fst,fzn.
TF.&
<
3 : 3Ct-,i 1 :-OQ a:.rri .
,,cS.nlq.;es
-
.* ,\
.L
I
ACCEPTANCE a s a summer s t u d e n t d o e s n o t imply a d m i s s i o n a s a r e g u l a r
s t u d e n t of Augsburg C o l l e g e .
Persons wishing t o begin a degree
program a t t h e c o l l e g e s h o u l d a p p l y f o r a d m i s s i o n t h r o u g h t h e O f f i c e
of Admissions.
c&:
L6
? â¬
T
n
,.
bi.-g
5-34
;
C:G.tTviE r ' S , w x g S
3SS%2iiatkn ar.4 ;ri-.tics i n s ?uryterLing and
( T h i s form i s t o b e u s e d by s t u d e n t s r e g u l a r l y a t t e n d i n g i n s t i t u t i o n s
o t h e r t n a n Augsburg C o l l e g e . Augsburg Summer S c h o o l c r e d i t s may b e
t r a n s f e r r e d t o t h e s t u d e n t ' s home i n s t i t u t i o n i f a p p r o v a l i s g r a n t e d
by t n a t c o l l e g e o r u n i v e r s i t y . )
-
.%LLP,r,,bIS:T?)W~ ~ O ~ ~ I C TI $f O V
%:A!&&$~l%'
&e.ilirig t:r'i-t%,
t h r advarc?? 8 t e ~ s sO F tell?vislo%
v r o b u z i n g and 3irecCLnq.
a m
6:5G-JO:33.p.b.'f?-T77
MB-2
S2Z- $824:
.-
$- ,,urse
S t u d e n t ' s Name:
z
College o r University:
The p e r s o n named above i s a s t u d e n t i n good s t a n d i n g and i s p e r m i t t e d
t o e a r n summer s c n o o l c r e d i t s a t Augsburg C o l l e g e .
332 983x5
~,~;sc;(ss,op
o m - 2 : ~ r i ; s g ~ . ? . . ~ ,--
~~~-~~~~~~.~~~dj,,
Sf
gT3&
6~7~;1&!icsi
z
s&,,t 6.
R e s t r i c t i o n s o r q u a l i f i c a t i o n s , i f any:
C of t h e :roll?
-
-Sagn -uhe aiiz
I
bfle
--
~
m
-
~
=
~
e
i
= -
( R e t w completed damn t o Summeh
ScCzool, Augbbwrg CoUege, Minneapa&,
Mn. 5 5 4 5 4 )
t
A U G S B U R G
S U M M E R
S C H O O L
A P P L I C A T I O N
FULL NAME:
last
first
middle o r maiden
AUGSBURG STUDENT NUMBER ( i f any)
PRESENT
ADDRESS:
PERMANENT
ADDRESS:
street
city
state
county
i~
telephone
street
City
state
county
zip
telephone
PLEASE CHECR AND COMPLETE ALL APPLICABLE ITEMS:
I am now a s t u d e n t a t Augsburg College and have been s i n c e
-I p r e v i o u s l y a t t e n d e d Augsburg College (When?)
.
n o t a n Augsburg s t u d e n t b u t a t t e n d
-II am
am t r a n s f e r r i n g t o Augsburg; I (have)
-I have
earned a b a c h e l o r ' s degree from
(have n o t ) been admitted.
College.
have been admitted t o Augsburg a s a Freshman f o r n e x t f a l l .
I p l a n t o a t t e n d Augsburg College only f o r t h e Summer School.
-I
-
-So. -Jr. -Sr. -Other
My PRESENT classification:-Fr.
THE MAXIMUM LOAD FOR TERM I I S ONE COURSE.
I1 IS TWO COURSES.
THE MAXIMUM FOR TERM
I plan t o t a k e t h e f o l l o w i n g courses:
TERM
DFPT.
,COUKSENO.
SECT.
, ABBREVIATED
COURSE TITLE
I
I f my above courses a r e c a n c e l l e d , I would s u b s t i t u t e t h e following:
A non-m6wrdabt.e t&tion d e p o ~ do d $30.00 muax a ~ n p a n y.tkid 60m.
U chrvrgeb do* TERM 1 wt
Ckeckd nne payable ;to Axgbuhg College. A
be paid &I 6uR.t n o t eatm d?a
Tueddaq, Jule T , 1976. TERM I I chnngea
mwt be paidno2 & ~ r . t h a n Jwe 2 8 , r976. R e h m
60mand
d e p o b i L to S U W R SCHOOL, AUGSBURG COLLEGE, MIMMEAPOLIS, W 5 5 4 5 4
--
DATE:
=.-
:
---19 76
STGNATURE:
I
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Summer Catalog, 1980
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
AUGS8URG COLLEGE
731 2 1 s t AVENUE SOUTH
MINNEAPOLIS, MN 55454
gr
- 8
Official Publication o f
I
Augsburg College, ~ i n n e a p o l i sM
, N
I-
m
A
I
S U M M E R 1980
!I
.
J
1
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Summer Catalog, 1974
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
about summer courses
COURSES a t Augsburg College carry a value of one Course Credit,
the equivalent of six quarter credits o r four semester credits.
W
TERM I
May 28
TERM I 1
June 24
AUGUST
%
-
June 20
- August
.-
4
11
5
12
6
13
7
14
8
15
9
16
10
17
P ~ ~ F ESUM
DMER OFFERI...
Show more
about summer courses
COURSES a t Augsburg College carry a value of one Course Credit,
the equivalent of six quarter credits o r four semester credits.
W
TERM I
May 28
TERM I 1
June 24
AUGUST
%
-
June 20
- August
.-
4
11
5
12
6
13
7
14
8
15
9
16
10
17
P ~ ~ F ESUM
DMER OFFERINGSare l i s t e d i n the center of t h i s brochure.
LOWER-DIVISION courses, intended primarily for freshman and sophomore
students, are those with a '1 or 2 as the third digitof the five-digit
Course Number. A 3 o r 4 i n t h a t position indicates an upper-division
course, intended primarily for juniors or seniors.
2
COURSES REGULARLY taught during the academic year are described i n
I f you need more informathe catalog issue of Augsburg C o l l e g e Now.
tion about special summer offerings, please consult the Summer School
Office.
-
TERM I1 WORKSHOP
August 5
23
-
INmPENDENT STUDY, while not l i s t e d among the course offerings, may
be pursued during the summer in a number of depaments. For information consult the Summer School Office.
CHANGES I N REGISTRATION must be made a t the Sunmrer School Office.
No course may be added a f t e r it has met more than s i x hours elapsed
class time, except with the special permission of the instructor.
THE
COIL!ZGE
RESERVES
the r i g h t t o cancel l i s t e d courses.
costs
SUMMER SCHOOL CHARGES i n c l u d e a General Fee o f $15, p l u s T u i t i o n o f
$170 per course.
Laboratory o r s p e c i a l f e e s may be charged f o r same
courses.
A DEPOSIT cf $30 must accompany t h e A p p l i c a t i o n Form. T h i s d e p s i t
i s r e f u n d a b l e only i f the courses l i s t e d b y the s t u d e n t , i n c l u d i n g
a l t e r n a t e s , should be c a n c e l l e d . The d e p o s i t a p p l i e s toward t h e
General Fee and T u i t i a n .
CHARGE FOR AUDITING a course ( t a k i n g it w i t h o u t c o l l e g e c r e d i t ) i s
$80. In courses w i t h l i m i t e d e n r o l l m e n t , p r e f e r e n c e w i l l be g i v e n t o
full-tuition students.
SUMMER STUDENTS may take one course during Term I and two courses
during Term 11, f o r a t o t a l of three courses i n the two regular
terms. The Japanese Print Making Workshop, beginning August 5, may
be taken i n addition t o courses completed i n the regular terms.
PERSONS PLANNING t o attend Summer School are advised t o apply as soon
as possible, since courses without substantial demand may be dropped.
STUDENTS NEEDING HWSING may o b t a i n i n f o r m a t i o n from t h e D i r e c t o r of
Limited food s e r v i c e i s a v a i l a b l e , supplemented b y s e v e r a l
Housing.
r e s t a u r a n t s and snack shops i n t h e Augsburg v i c i n i t y .
C O V E R :
D A V I D
S T E N S H O E L
a
REGISTRATION i s t o be completed not l a t e r than the f i r s t day o f each
term a t the Summer School O f f i c e , Memorial H a l l 111. ALL CHARGES f o r
t h e term must be paid before r e g i s t r a t i o n i s complete. A Late Regist r a t i o n Fee o f $10 w i l l be added f o r students who complete registrat i o n a f t e r t h e f i r s t day o f the term.
TUITION REFUND f o r c a n c e l l e d courses
w i l l b e allowed a s i n d i c a t e d b y the
t a b l e on t h e r i g h t .
Such r e f u n d i s
l i m i t e d b y the non-refundable dep o s i t . No r e f u n d w i l l be m d e a f t e r
t h e l i s t e d dates.
COURSE CANCELLATION DATE
REFUND! TERM I
1 TERM I i
:z 1
1
100%f Mav 28-29 1 June 25-27
May 30-31
June 28-30
J i e 3-4
July 1-3
40% June 5-6
July 5-10
1974 SUMMER SPECIALS
bgskrrgColkge
JAZZ
STYLES.
E a r l y jazz h e r i t a g e s and t h e b l u e s ; New Orleans and
Chicago Dixieland,
ragtime, boogie-woogie,
swing, bop, cool and
funky s t y l e s ; our e c l e c t i c e r a and p o s s i b l e f u t u r e s .
Performance
a b i l i t y n o t required; includes a paper o r p r o j e c t a p p r o p r i a t e t o
D r . James Carlson. Term I I . See MUS 82240.
s t u d e n t ' s jazz capacity.
FILMMAKING.
Students design and produce a 16m sound film.
The
language of f i l m , f i l m design, s c r i p t i n g , production planning; cinemato9raphy, l i g h t i n g , sound recording; c a s t i n g , d i r e c t i n g , s t a g i n g ;
Lab f e e of $50 provides a l l s t u d e n t needs,
l a b o r a t o r y techniques.
Instructor i s Paul Rusten.
See ART 10242,
s u p p l i e s , equipment use.
1 Summer School -Memori a1
2 Sverdrup L i b r a r . ~
3 ~ ce ni c e l ~ d mni i s t r a t i on
4 OldMain
5 Augsburg College Center
6 Mortensen Tower
7 Urness Tower
8 Murphy Square (Park)
9 A r t Studio
10 S i Melby H a l l
11 Music B u i l d i n g
12 Drama-Speech B u i l d i n g
S t . Paul
ENG 54244, SPC 98242.
PHOTOGRAPHY.
The a r t of s t i l l camera photography.
Development of
s k i l l s of photographic composition; using p i c t u r e s t o communicate;
camera techniques and l i m i t a t i o n s ; photographic processing possiART 101 32.
b i l i t i e s , darkroom. work. Robert Friederichsen, Term I .
MOVING IMAGE MEDIA, The s h o r t f i l m and t e l e v i s i o n ;
p r e t a t i o n , production techniques.
Work i n 8mm f i l m
For e n t h u s i a s t s a s w e l l a s t e a c h e r s who want t o use
Taught by John Mitchell, Term I I .
See ENG
sion.
.
CONTEMPORARY AFRICAN LITERATURE.
analysis, interand video media.
f i l m and t e l e v i -
AUGSBURG COLLEGE i s i n the Cedar-Riverside area o f Minneapolis, where
i t s r ' n s t i t u t i ona'l neighbors include the U n i v e r s i t y o f Minnesota (West
Bank) and Fairview and S t . Mary's h o s p i t a l s . The College i s e a s i l y
accessible from Interstate Highway 94. Approaching from t h e west,
use t h e 25th Avenue-Riverside e x i t ; from t h e e a s t , e x i t t o Riverside.
54242,
I
A readings course i n works of contemporary African n o v e l i s t s , p o e t s , d r a m a t i s t s , s h o r t s t o r y w r i t e r s ,
and e s s a y i s t s t o f a m i l i a r i z e s t u d e n t s with t h e growing wealth of
African l i t e r a t u r e , themes and t r a d i t i o n s , and t o s t i m u l a t e a crossTerm I I .
See ENG 54364.
c u l t u r a l human experience. John Mitchell.
A study of c r e a t i v i t y with emphasis upon
CREATIVE PROBLEM-SOLVING.
ways of c u l t i v a t i n g c r e a t i v e behavior and applying it t o v a r i o u s
a s p e c t s of problem solving; p h i l o s o p h i c a l and psychological dimenD r . Raymond Anderson.
Term I I .
See SPC 98356.
s i o n s of t h e task.
LOVE I N LITERATURE AND MEDIA.
Passionate l o v e i n lite r a t u r e from a n t i a u i t -v t o today; i d e a s about sex and
love i n contemporary popular music, t e l e v i s i o n & film.
D r . Ronald Palosaari.
Term I .
See ENG 54269.
-
CHRISTIAN DEVOTIONAL CLASSICS.
s i g n i f i c a n t w r i t i n g s from t h e second
century t o t h e present.
Among works considered a r e those of August i n e , Bernard of Clairvaux, Catherine of Siena and D i e t r i c h Bonhoeff e r ; understandings of t h e s p i r i t u a l l i f e a s d i s c l o s e d i n t h e s e
D r . Philip Quanbeck. Term I .
See REL 87370.
Christian classics.
RELIGIONS OF INDIA:
Hinduism & Buddhism.
H i s t o r i c a l , l i t e r a r y and
s o c i o l o g i c a l p e r s p e c t i v e s from a n t i q u i t y t o t h e present. Also t r e a t s
Jainism, Sikkhism and Islam.
Uses primary t e x t s , films of Hindu
Instructor: D r . John Benson.
Term I I .
See REL 87372.
ritual.
WOMAN: Image and Reality
WOMEN WRITERS AND NOMAN'S IDENTITY.
s e l e c t e d female w r i t e r s of t h e
twentieth century, including V i r g i n i a Woolf and S y l v i a P l a t h , who
have explored i n t h e i r works what it means t o be a woman; reading i n
depth t h e work of a woman w r i t e r of each s t u d e n t ' s choice.
Taught by D r . Catherine Nicholl. ' Term I .
See EN6 54239.
PSYCHOLOGY AND WOMEN. c u l t u r a l assumptions and psychological premise s of presumed s e x - r e l a t e d c h a r a c t e r i s t i c s ;
research on sex d i f f e r Taught by Lila Anderegg.
Term
ences, including s t a t u s and r o l e s .
11, evenings.
See PSY 86395 308.
PHILOSOPHIES OF FEMINISM.
Philosophical a n a l y s i s of key concepts
of feminism i n myth, l i t e r a t u r e , r e l i g i o n and a r t ; t h e o r i e s and imp l i c a t i o n s ofmatriarchical/patriarchical, pro-feminist/anti-feminist
c u l t u r e s , c o u r t l y and romantic love, and t h e c u l t of t h e v i r g i n .
Taught by D r . Mark Fuehrer.
Term I I .
See PHI 83450.
(Descriptions continued after listings)
COURSES
DEPT NUMBER SECT COURSE TITLE
ART
ART
ART
ART
ART
ART
ART
BED
BED
€310
BUS
CHM
CHM
ECO
EDE
EDS
ENG
ENG
ENG
ENG
ENG
ENG
GER
GER
HIS
HPE
HPE
HPE
MUS
PHI
PHI
PHY
POL
POL
POL
PSY
PSY
PSY
PSY
PSY
PSY
REL
REL
SOC
SOC
SOC
SOC
SOC
SOC
SPA
SPA
SPC
SPC
SPC
SPC
10102
10118
10132
10223
10242
10355
10368
33101
33350
20103
21121
34105
34353
22120
4448454854239
54269
54242
54244
54338
54364
72111
72112
56260
551 11
55484
55491
82240
83130
83450
84101
85295
85367
85365
86105
86351
86364
86375
86395
86395
87370
87372
94255
94255
94367
94372
94375
94480
76111
76112
98111
98116
98242
98356
309
305
306
303
303
303
306
304
307
305
306
304
300
307
-----
306
303
300
306
306
302
305
303
300
306
307
302
300
302
304
302
301
308
302
301
301
304
300
308
31 7
300
306
312
304
302
307
300
308
301
309
305
304
308
306
INSTRUCTOR
TERM TIME
Environmental E s t h e t i c s
Friederichsen I 1
Thompson
I1
Painting I
Photography
Friederichsen I
Yoshi da
IIW
Printmaking I (Japanese Wood-Block)
Filmmaking
Rusten
I
Painting I 1
Thompson
I1
Yoshida
IIW
Printmaking I 1 (Japanese Wood-Block)
Elementary T y p e w r i t i n g (no c r e d i t )
Wammer
I1
I1
Advanced T y p e w r i t i n g
Wammer
Human Anatomy and Physiology
Mickelberg
It11
I
I n t r o d u c t i o n t o Management
O'Malley
P r i n c i p l e s o f Chemistry
Gyberg
I1
Q u a n t i t a t i v e Analysis
Gyberg
I1
Economics o f Urban Issues
Sabel 1a
I
Student Teaching, Elementary
Staff
I1
Student Teaching, Secondary
E. Johnson
I1
C. N i c h o l l
I
Women W r i t e r s and Woman's I d e n t i t y
I
Love i n L i t . and Media
Pal o s a a r i
Mitchell
11
Moving Image Media
I
Filmmaking
Rusten
Twentieth Century B r i t i s h L i t e r a t u r e
Sargent
I
M itchel 1
I1
Contemporary A f r i c a n L i t e r a t u r e
Oyler
I
Beginning German I
Oyl e r
I1
Beginning German I 1
Minnesota Discovery
Chrislock/R. Nelson
I
S a f e t y and Drug Education
Lindgren
I1
C. Nelson
I
A p p l i e d Adapted A c t i v i t i e s
C. Nelson
I1
Therapeutic Exercise
I n t r o d u c t i o n t o Jazz S t y l e s
Carl son
I1
Logic
Fuehrer
I1
Philosophies o f Feminism
Fuehrer
I1
Astronomy
Paulson
I1
I1
Games o f P o l i t i c s
Hedbl om
O r r i L p i U n f o r S o c i a l Change
Schei be1
I1
I
International Politicians
Noonan
I
General Psychology
Thoni
I
Developmental Psycho1 ogy: C h i l d
D. Johnson
Experimental Psychology
Dyrud/Anderegg
I1
S o c i a l Psycho1 ogy
Dyrud
I1
Psychology and Women
Anderegg
I1
Themes i n Human I d e n t i t y
Knefel kamp/Widick
I1
I
C h r i s t i a n Devotional Classics
(luanbeck
Religions o f I n d i a
Benson
I1
I
Youth Work i n Wilderness Medium
Wagner
Youth Work i n Wilderness Medium
Wagner
11
O r g a n i z a t i o n f o r S o c i a l Change
Schei be1
I1
I
Aging i n Urbanized America
Steen
S o c i a l Psychology
Dyrud
I1
Urban New Towns
Torstenson
I
Kingsley
I
Beginning Spanish I
Kingsley
I1
Beginning Spanish I 1
Beginning Speech
Cole
I
C r e a t i v e Dramatics
Cole
I
Filmmaking
Rusten
I
C r e a t i v e Problem-Solving
ReAnderson I 1
8
9
H+J
9
S
9
9
9
9
S
C+D
4+5
3+5
J+K
9
9
B+C
H+J
6
S
C+D
7
B+D
2
F+G+S
6
Arr.
Arr.
5
2
4
7
3
3
C+D
B+D
B+C
3
5
7
7
AtB
1
F+G+S
8+9
3
H+J
5
C+D
B+E
2
C+D
S
S
2
ADD
ROOM FEE SPECIAL COMMENTS
A-110
Arts
Arts
Arts
A-110 $50
Arts
Arts
OM-10
OM-10
S-205
L-1
S-205
S-205
L-1
A r r . $15
Arr. $15
Arr.
MH-1
S-205 $10
A-110 $50
S-205
S-205
MH-1
MH-1
S-205 Yes
6-12
Arr.
Arr.
S-34
S-34
S-34
S-34
S-34
MH-1
MH-1
A-110
S-34
L-1
L-1
L-1
MH-1
L-1
S-205
S-34 Yes
5-34 Yes
MH-1
S-34
L-1
A-110
S-205
S-205
Theater
Arr.
A-110$50
L-1
Times arranged
August 5-23, 8:30 am t o noon
1:OO-5:00 pm, MTWT
Times arranged
August 5-23, 8:30 am t o noon
T u i t i o n = $80; 6:45-9pm MTTh
6:45-9:00 pm, MTTh
10 weeks, 6-9 pm, T & Th
L e c t u r e = 4; l a b = 5
L e c t u r e = 3; l a b = 5
June 17 through J u l y 26;
Dept. o f Education
( consult
1:OO-5:00
pm, MTWT
About $75 t r a v e l costs
--
(People, E l i t e s & For. Pol.)
P e r i o d D meets i n S-34
A v a i l a b l e e i t h e r term. ca,
f o r wilderness t r i p .
( $60
6:OO-10:OO pm, Tues.,
1:OO-5:00pm,MTWT
Wed.
UNLESS OTHERWISE noted under "SPECIAL COMMENTS," Term I classes extend from Tuesday, May 28, through Thursday, June 20,
and Term I 1 courses a r e t a u g h t from Monday, June 24, through Friday, August 2. The schedules below i n d i c a t e t h e hours
and days o f t h e week when classes meet, keyed t o t h e l e t t e r o r number l i s t e d above under "TIME".
NOTE t h a t most Term I
courses meet e i g h t t o t e n times p e r week; thus "A+BM means t h a t a c l a s s meets
7:10 t o 8:20 and 8:30 t o 9:40.
both
A =
7:lO-8:20
am
MTWT F
MTWTF
MTWTF
MTWTF
MTWTF
MTWT
MTWT
5:lO-6:40 ~ r n
MTWT
6:50-8:20 bm
MTWT
MTWT
=8 : 3 o - i o : o o ~ m
See "SPECIA~ COMMENTS"
TERM B = 8:30-9:40am
C = 9:50-11 :00 am
D = 11:lO am-12:20 pm
I
E = 12:30-1:40 pm
F
1:50-3:20 pm
May28 G = 3:30-5:00 pm
=
H
J
J u n e 2 0
S
=
=
~
=
TERM
11
JUW 24
Aug. 2
1 = 7:15-8:40am
2 = 8:50-10:15am
3=10:25-11:50am
4 = 12:OO-1:25 pm
5 = 1:35-3:20pm
6 = 3:30-5:15pm
7 = 6:00-9:30 pm
9 =
See
1
1
MTWTF
MTWTF
MTWTF
MTWTF
MTWT
MTWT
Room Locations
M. w
COMMENTS"
~
~
A-110
ArtS
1-1
5-34
5-205
0m-10 ~
MH-1
A r t Bui 1d i n g
A r t Bui 1d i n g
L i b r a r y (basement)
Science B u i l d i n g
Science Bui l d i ng
~
Old~ Main ~
Memorial H a l l (SE,
basement)
~
This Summer in the SOCIAL SCIENCES
MINNESOTA DISCOVERY. H i s t o r i c a l s i t e s and museums a s an approach t o
understanding s t a t e and a r e a h i s t o r y . Students supply camping equipment and provisions f o r extended f i e l d t r i p s .
Cooperation with t h e
Minnesota H i s t o r i c a l Society, readings and p r o j e c t s , t o introduce
career opportunities.
T r i p s w i l l r e q u i r e some a d d i t i o n a l expense.
Term I. See HIS 56260.
Professors Carl Chrislock & Richard Nelson.
INTERNATIONAL POLITICIANS.
The powers behind f o r e i g n p o l i c y decisions i n t h e United S t a t e s , focusing upon t h e Cuban m i s s i l e c r i s i s
and i t s r e s o l u t i o n ; t h e r o l e of e l i t e s and determinants of a l t e r n a Term I. See POL 85365.
tives.
Taught by D r . Norma Noonan.
GAMES OF POLITICS.
An approach t o t h e understanding of p o l i t i c a l
i s s u e s and processes through simulation.
Consideration of s t r e n g t h s
and l i m i t a t i o n s of games a s media of teaching and learning.
No preTerm II. See POL 85295.
requisites.
Taught by Dr. Milda Hedblom.
INTRODUCTION TO MANAGEMENT.
Fundamental concepts and p r i n c i p l e s of
management, r e l a t i n g o r g a n i z a t i o n a l g o a l s , o b j e c t i v e s and p o l i c i e s
t o t h e planning and c o n t r o l processes.
Behavioral, s t r u c t u r a l , t a s k
M . O'ffalley.
Term I. See BUS 21121,
and resource considerations.
~ u m m b rWorkshops
JAPANESE PRINTMAKING
TOSHI YOSHIDA, c e l e b r a t e d Japanese printmaker, r e t u r n s t o Augsburg
College f o r a three-week workshop August 5 t o 23. L i m i t e d t o t h i r t y
students, t h e workshop provides an e x t r a o r d i n a r y o p p o r t u n i t y t o study
t r a d i t i o n a l and contemporary approaches t o t h e unique a r t o f t h e
Japanese wood-block p r i n t .
The Augsburg workshop i s one o f f o u r throughout t h e U n i t e d States
Member o f t h e t h i r d generawhich Mr. Yoshida i s teaching i n 1974.
t i o n o f a r t i s t s i n t h e y o s h i d a f a m i l y , he has had more than 100 oneman shows i n t h e United States. H i s works a r e i n t h e permanent c o l l e c t i o n s o f many major museums, among them t h e Museum o f Modern A r t
i n New York, t h e Museum o f Modern A r t i n Tokyo, t h e Museum o f Fine
A r t s i n Boston, t h e A r t I n s t i t u t e o f Chicago, and t h e Sydney Museum
i n Australia.
Students may r e g i s t e r f o r t h e Yoshida Workshop under Printmaking I
(ART 10223) o r Printmaking I 1 (ART 10368), depending upon previous
experience.
H U M A N RELATIONS
URBAN NEW TOWNS.
Comprehensive community planning i n t h e modern
metropolis;
t h e European experience;
s t r u c t u r e s , processes and
i s s u e s of community planning i n American c i t i e s ; Cedar-Riverside and
D r . J o e l Torstenson.
Term I. See SOC 94480.
Jonathan.
YOUTH WORK IN A WILDERNESS MEDIUM.
Wilderness camping a s focus f o r
building group, i n d i v i d u a l r e l a t i o n s h i p s .
The youth subculture;
p r i n c i p l e s , techniques of youth work; wilderness camping s k i l l s ;
leadership.
(Canoe-trip l a b o r a t o r y i n Boundary Waters a r e a involves
added costs.)
Anthony Wagner.
Term I o r Term II. See SOC 94256.
HUMAN RELATIONS WORKSHOP.
Understanding r a c i a l , c u l t u r a l and economic groups; developing s k i l l s ir. hpadling d i s c r i m i n a t i o n and b i a s
and i n c r e a t i n g p o s i t i v e i n t e r p e r s o n a l r e l a t i o n s h i p s .
Minimum of 60
hours c l a s s and f i e l d work.
F u l f i l l s t h e EDU 521 S t a t e Department
Taught by
of Education requirement of human r e l a t i o n s f o r t e a c h e r s .
D r . Sheldon Fardig.
See EDE 44488, EDS 45488.
Note s p e c i a l dates.
JAZZ
AGING I N URBANIZED AMERICA.
Demographic r e a l i t i e s of aging; sociol o g i c a l , p o l i t i c a l , economic and psychological a s p e c t s of aging. New
o r g a n i z a t i o n a l and programmatic approaches i n t h e seventies.
Taught
by D r . Paul Steen.
Term I. See SOC 94372,
ORGANIZATION FOR SOCIAL CHANGE. For persons d e s i r i n g t o p a r t i c i p a t e
i n giving d i r e c t i o n t o s o c i a l change; l e d by James Scheibel of t h e
Center f o r Urban Encounter.
The n a t u r e of change, t h e understanding
of power, t h e d e f i n i t i o n of i s s u e s , t h e implementation of change.
Term II. See POL 85367 o r SOC 94367.
THEMES
IN HUMAN
AUGSBURG JAZZ WORKSHOP.
New t h i s y e a r , t h e Jazz Workshop w i l l be a
one-week experience f o r jazz musicians and music d i r e c t o r s .
Dates
a r e June 16-21.
With work i n performance, arranging and composing,
t h e workshop w i l l be under t h e l e a d e r s h i p of Steve Wright, A r t i s t i n
Residence a t Augsburg.
College c r e d i t is a v a i l a b l e . For information
write:
Michael Walgren, Augsburg College, Minneapolis, MN 55404,
CHOIR
IDENTITY.
I n t e r d i s c i p l i n a r y course i n psychology
and l i t e r a t u r e emphasizing themes i n human i d e n t i t y a s found i n modern l i t e r a t u r e and i n p e r s o n a l i t y theory.
Limited t o freshmen,
sophomores and f i r s t - t e r m juniors.
Taught by Lee Knefelkamp and
See PSY 86395 315.
Carole Widick.
Term 11, evenings.
SATEREN CHORAL WORKSHOP. This y e a r ' s workshop w i l l be h e l d June 16
through June 21.
I n a d d i t i o n t o D r , Lee Sateren and D r . Dale
Warland, guest composer w i l l be D r . Daniel Pinkham of t h e f a c u l t y of
t h e New England Conservatory of Music, who i s a l s o music d i r e c t o r of
h i s t o r i c King's Chapel i n Boston.
College c r e d i t a v a i l a b l e .
InforIMtion:
Michael Walgren, Augsburg College, Minneapolis, MN 55404.
1
augsburg summer school application form
eligibility
FULL NAME : ---,--last----------first-----------rniddle
PmQNS IN GOOD SR4AQlNG a t r e g i o n a l l y a c c r e d i t e d c o l l e g e s and universities, as we22 a s graduates of such i n s t i t u t i o n s , are e l i g i b l e t o
a t t e n d Augsburg S-r
Sehoal. Good s t a n d i n g i m p l i e s t h a t the s t u d e n t
has been admitted t o a collage and h a s n o t s u b s e q u e n t l y b e e n dropped
by t h a t i n s t i t d o n .
SEX:
MARITAL STATUS:
Divorced
- Single
Married
Widowed
-
- MF
-
STUDENTS AOEIITTED t o Augsburg C o l l e g e f o r the F a l l Term o f the ~ u r ~ n t.,
year a r e e l i g i b l e t o a t t e n d Summer School, a s a r e persons a d m i t t e d b y
o t h e r c o l l e g e s f o r the f a l l o f this year.
PERMANENT
ADDRESS :
PRESENT
ADDRESS:
IP R B F U W ATTEw2?3NG or admitted to ataOthsr educaUonkX i n s t i t u t i o n ,
the applf cant must provide Rugsburg. S m m ~ f School w i t h a statement
f m an appropriate o f f i c i a l of his college that k is in gmd standi n g and eligfble tn earn credits d u r i n g the summer ~ e s s i o n s .
(A form
for this purpose i s at the Bottom of this page.)
C r e d i t s cannot be
transferred u n t i l this mqwirementr has been f u l f i l l e d .
o r maiden------
...........................
AUGSBURG STUDENT NUMBER ( i f any)
----street----------/------~ity----------/----state------
----county---------/----zip---/------telephone------------street ----------/-------city----------/----state---------county----------/----zip----/------telephone---------
PLEASE CHECK AND COMPLETE ALL APPLICABLE ITEMS:
I am now a student a t Augsburg College and have been since
- I previously attended Augsburg Col 1ege [When?]
Col l ege.
Iam n o t an Augshurg student b u t attend
I am t r a n s f e r r i n g t o Augsburg; L (have) (have n o t ) b e ~ nadmitted.
- I have been admitted t o Augsburg as a Freshman for next Fa1Coll
1. ege.
I have earned a bachelor's degree from
- I plan t o attend Augsburg College o n l y Tor t h e Sumner School.
So. - Jr.
Sr. - Other.
My PRESENT c l a s s i f i c a t i o n : - Fr.
Fr. --So.
- Jr.
Sr.
Other.
C l a s s i f i c a t i o n SUMMER '74:
.
-
OTHER PERSONS wishing to take summer school work should contact the
Director of Summer School to ascertain eligibility under special
circumstances.
ACCEPTANCE a s a sunxner s t u d e n t does n o t i m p l y admission a s a r e g u l a r
s t u d e n t of Augsburg College.
Persons w i s h i n g t o b e g i n a degree
program a t the c o l l e g e should apply f o r admission through the O f f i c e
o f Admissions.
-
-
-
THE MAXIMUM LOAD f o r TERM I i s one course.
I s two courses.
The maximum f o r
-
TERM I 1
IPLAN TO TAKE THE FOLLOWING COURSES:
approval form
TERM
fTkis form i s to be used by stuUeats regularly attending institutions
other than kugsbuq College. Augsburg Summer School credits may be
transferred to the student's home institution if approval is granted
by that college or universitg.)
ABBREVIATED COURSE TITLE
SECT.
COURSE NO.
DEPT.
I
Student's Name
I f my above choices are cancelled, Iwould s u b s t i t u t e the following:
College o r University
The person named above i s a student i n good standing and i s permitted
t o earn sumner school c r e d i t s a t Augsburg College.
Restrictions o r q u a l i f i c a t i o n s , i f any:
Signature and T i t l e
(Dean, R e g i s t r a r , o r o t h e r Responsible O f f i c e r )
(Return completed form to Summer School,
Augsburg C o l l e g e , Minneapolis, MN 55404
I
I
1
1
.
A non-refundable t u i t i o n deposit o f $30.00 must accompany t h i s form.
A l l charges f o r TERM Imust
Checks are payable t o Augsburg College.
be p a i d i n f u l l n o t l a t e r than Tuesday, May 28, 1974. TERM 11 charges
must be p a i d n o t l a t e r than June 24, 1974. Return t h i s form and
deposit, t o S u n e r School , Augsburg College, Minneapolis, MN 55404.
DATE:
1974
SIGNATURE:
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Summer Catalog, 1987
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
-
-
J u g s burg College
- -
7 3 1 2 1 S T A V E N U ES O U T H
An Official Publication of
Augsburg College
Non-Profit Org.
U.S. POSTAGE
Minneapolis,
Permit No. 2031
Augsburg College is a four-year, fully accredited liberal arts
college of The American Lutheran Church. Located in the
...
Show more
-
-
J u g s burg College
- -
7 3 1 2 1 S T A V E N U ES O U T H
An Official Publication of
Augsburg College
Non-Profit Org.
U.S. POSTAGE
Minneapolis,
Permit No. 2031
Augsburg College is a four-year, fully accredited liberal arts
college of The American Lutheran Church. Located in the
heart of the Twin Cities, the small college environment, about
1800 students during the academic year, is enriched by the
many cultural, sporting and recreational activities found in
this vibrant metropolitan area. An active summer combining
classes and participation in metropolitan events is a
delightful and broadening experience.
Augsburg College provides a diverse summer curriculum
including regular courses, internships, independent studies
and student teaching over two terms. Term I runs from
June 1-June 26, Term I1 runs from June 29-August 7.
This brochure presents the Summer School Program and
was correct at the time of publication.
Summer Students may take one course during Term I
and two courses during Term 11. Unless otherwise
indicated, all courses carry a value of one course credit,
the equivalent of four semester credits or six quarter
credits. Courses fulfilling Augsburg distribution
requirements are so noted in the course descriptions.
Term1
Term11
(- \
Preregistration
with Tuition Discount
April 22
April 22
Confirmation of Registration
Classes Begin
Balance of Tuition Due
June 1
June 29
Last Day to:
Change Grading Option
Drop Class Without Notation
Register with a Late Fee of $10
(noregistrations will be
accepted after this date)
June 3
July 1
Holiday
None
July 4
Last Day to Withdraw from
Class (W)
June 15
July 20
Classes End
June 26
August 7
Grades Due in Registrar's Office
July 1
August 12
Course Levels are indicated by the first digit of the three
digit course number: 1or 2, lower division, primarily for
freshmen and sophomores; 3 or 4, upper division,
/--7rimarily for juniors and seniors; and 5, graduate level.
4.,burses
Regularly Taught during the academic year are
more fully described in the Augsburg College Catalog. If
you need more information about a special summer
offering, please contact the Summer School Office.
Independent Study and Internships, in addition to those
listed, may be pursued during the summer in a number
of departments. Internships involve work experience
related to the academic program in an agency,
government, or industry. Consult the Summer School
Office for information.
Students Needing Housing may obtain information from
the Director of Housing.
Persons Planning to Attend Summer School are
advised to preregister as soon as possible, since courses
without substantial demand may be dropped.
The College Reserves t h e Right t o Cancel Listed
Courses.
Additional information and registration forms may be
obtained from the Summer School office. Write or call:
I
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
SUMMER SCHOOL OFFICE
Memorial Hall - 230
731 21st Avenue South
Minneapolis, MN 55454
(612) 330-1026
Pat Parker, Director
Kay Thomsen, Secretary
P e r s o n s in Good Standing at regionally accredited colleges
and universities, graduates of such institutions, and students
admitted for the next Fall Term are eligible to attend
Augsburg Summer School. Good standing implies that the
student has been admitted and not subsequently dropped by
that institution.
Other P e m o n s wishing to take summer school work should
contact the Director of Summer School to ascertain eligibili~ \
under special circumstatlcea.
k .<)
Acceptance as a summer student does not imply admission
as a re$ular student of Augsburg College. Those wishing to
begin a degree program at the College should apply for
Lhe Office of Admission.
admission throi~gl~
Augsburg College admitn studenls of any race, color, national
and ethnic origin to ail rights, privileges, programs, and
activities generally accorded or made available to students at
[heschool, It does not discriminate on the basis of race, color,
creed, national and ethnic origin in employment practices or
ndministl-ation of its educational policies, admissions
policies, acholarslrip and loan programs and athletic and
other school-administe~~ed
programs.
Financial Aid is limited to the Guaranteed Student Loan. Any
student taking 1 course is regarded as a half-time student for
the summer and is eligible to apply for a Guaranteed Student
Loan. Contact the Financial Aid Office to make loan
arrangements (33Ck1046).
Term I Summer School students are required to confirm
their registrations on June 1. Term I1 registrations must be
confirmed on June 29. This procedure includes confirmation
of all preregistered courses and applies to internships and
independent studies as well as to regularly scheduled
courses.
Confirmation of registration will take place at the Registrar's
Office, 114 Science Hall, between the hours of 8:30 a.m. and
6:30 p.m. on June 1 and June 29.
)xilance owing for tuition must be paid before
i'~*istrationis confirmed. Augsburg students please note:
Balance due on Augsburg account from previous term/s
must be paid in full before confirmation of registration.
'
A late fee of $10.00 will be assessed for Term I registrations
completed on June 2 and 3. A late fee of $10.00 will be
assessed for Term I1 registrations completed on June 30 and
July 1. Registrations will not b e accepted ajter these dates.
To cancel your registration, add a course, or drop a course
and enroll in another course, fill out a Cancel/Add form at the
Registrar's Office. There is a charge of $5.00 for changing a
registration after the first day of each term. This must be
done by 3:30 p.m. on June 3 for Term I courses and by 3:30
p.m. on July 1 for Term I1 courses. This procedure applies to
internships and independent studies as well as scheduled
courses. Any refund or adjustment of fees is determined
according to the "Tuition Refund Policy."
The tuition charge for Summer School is $375.00 for each
course taken for credit, unless otherwise indicated. The audit
charge (non-credit)is $188.00 for each course. Laboratory/
special fees are noted with course descriptions.
Preregistration on April 22 will result in a savings of $30.00
for each course taken. This reduced tuition of $345.00 per
course applies only to those courses for which the student
preregisters on April 22. A nonrefundable deposit of $50.00
per course is required at this time and is applied to
designated course tuition. If a course is cancelled due to low
enrollment, a substitution may be made without loss of
discount. Students may preregister for both Term I and Term
I1 courses on April 22, tuition discount applies to both terms.
After April 22, students may preregister at the Registrar's
Office on an ongoing basis during regular office hours. The
required $50.00 per course nonrefundable deposit is applied
to designated course tuition. Substitutions allowed if course
is cancelled.
The $50.00 deposit is not refundable. Refund of all or part of
the remaining fee is calculated from the first day of the term
to the date of the student's official course cancellation at the
Registrar's Office.
3SW from the NorthTake Washington Avenue exit and turn left on Washington
(turns right onto Cedar Avenue),turn left at Riverside, right at
21st Avenue S.
Schedule of Refunds (No refund after the dates listed below.)
1-94 East from MinneapolisTake 25th Avenue exit, turn left at 25th Avenue, turn left at
Riverside, turn left at 21st Avenue S.
Refund
Term I
Term I1
100%
90%
80%
70%
60%
June 1
June 2
June 3
June 4
June 5
June 29
June 30
July 1
July 2
July 3
1-94 West from St. PaulTake Riverside exit, turn right at Riverside, turn left at 21st
Avenue S.
36W from the SouthFollow 1-94 St. Paul signs (moveright lane after each of two
mergers). Take 25th Avenue exit and turn left on 25th Avenue,
turn left at Riverside, turn left at 21st Avenue S.
,
'I
STUDENT TEACHING: SECONDARY
Observing and directing learning experiences on secondary school level
under supervision of college and high school personnel.
Additional $35.00 fee. Dist.: No.
Prerequisite: Acceptance, Education Department.
Arranged
EDS 4 8 1 , - 8 0 8 1 / 4 8 2 - 8 0 8 2
483-8083/484-8084
-
-
-
Secondary
Osnes/Staff
-
1
-
F~
REI
LA
C
NN
GYB~ES
--SPA 111-8044
BEGINNING SPANISH I
Kingsley
Aims to develop four basic skills: understanding,
", sneaking.
n
". readini.
". and
writing of elementary Spanish. lntroduction to culture of Spanish-speaking world. Dist.: Yes.
8:30-10:50 a.m.
M,T,W,Th,F
M24
.
-
-.
----
-
-
-
HEALTH EDUCATION AND PHYSICAL EDUCATION
-
--
v
-
-
-
-B o l l m a n
A R T 107-8001DRAWING
Drawing in pencil, charcoal, ink, pastels. Subfects include still-life, figures,
building interiors, exteriors, experimental work. Dist.: Yes.
1:oo-4:oop.m.
M,T,W , T ~
on-
,
-
.
HPE 3 2 0 - 8 0 4 1
SCHOOL HEALTH C U R R ~ C U L U ~
~orsGd
Techniques for developing a course of study based upon growth and development for grades K-12. Special work units in nutrition and diseases.
Dist.: No.
Prerequisite: Consent of instructor. (May continue through Term 11)
Arranged
I
A R T 223-8002
PRINT MAKING I & 11
Bollm,..
368-8003
Principles and methods of print making in a variety of media including
etching, silkscreen and woodcut. Dist.: Yes.
1:OO-4:00p.m.
M,T,W,Th
OM17
A R T 242-8008
FILM-MAKING WORKSHOP
Rueten
Students will produce 16mm black & white sound motion pictures using
professional equipment and techniques. Script, photography, sound, editing and synchronizing. Dist.: Yes. Lab. fee of $95.00 for film stock, processing, supplies and equipment.
T,W,Th
OM4
6:OO-9:00p.m.
9:OO-12:00 noon
Sat.
--
-
-
BIO 1 0 3 - 8 0 0 9 HUMAN ANATOMY A N D PHYSIOLOGY
Mickelberg
Professional course in the structure and function of the human body. Dist.:
Yes.
S205
12:OO-3:00p.m. Lect.
M,W,Th,F
T
12:OO-3:00p.m. Lab.
PE 4 1 0 - 8 0 4 0 ADMINISTRATION A N D SUPERVISION
Borstad
O F SCHOOL HEALTH PROGRAM
Historical background, legal bases, school health services, and relationships to community health program and resources. Dist.: No.
Prerequisite: HPE 3 2 0
5:30-8:30 p.m.
M,T,W,Th
L4
HISTORY
-
-
HIS 239-8042
EASTERN EUROPE IN
S. A n d e r s o n
339-8043
T H E 20th CENTURY
Examines the nationality problem in Austria, Russia and Germany, and
the creation of new "national states" after the war. World War I1 Nazi occupation to postwar Soviet domination, the start of the Cold War over
East Europe, and more recent crises. Dist.: Yes.
Additional work required for upper division credit.
M,T,W,Th
M24
5:OO-8:00 p.m.
DIRECTED STUDY/
INDEPENDENT STUDY
(Diverse Topics: See Instructor)
-.
INTERDISCIPLINHRY
-
BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION
-
--
Gustafson
HIS 299-/499-
INS 3 9 9 - 8 0 4 6
- -
Arranged
--
,
-
-
INTERNSHIPS
Hesser
Arranged
-
BUS 1 7 6 - 8 0 1 6
COMPUTERS FOR
Schield
ECONOMICS AND BUSINESS
Introduction to computerized data processing: BASIC, LOTUS, DBASE,
word processing, computerized business graphics. Dist.: No.
Prerequisite: High school algebra.
6:OO-9:00 p.m.
M,T,W,Th
S112
BUS 2 2 1 - 8 0 1 4
PRINCIPLES O F ACCOUNTING 1
K~:J
Introduction to business activities, basic concepts and fundamentals of
counting, the accounting cycle and preparation of financial statements.
Dist.: No.
6:OO-9:00 p.m.
M,T,W,Th
M5
BUS 2 4 2 - 8 0 1 3
PRINCIPLES O F MANAGEMENT
Cerrito
Development of the theory of management, organization, staffing, planning
and control. The nature of authority, accountability and responsibility,
analysis of the role of the professional manager. Dist . Nn
6:OO-9:00p.m.
M,T,W
M23
MUS 1 5 5 - 8 0 4 6
-- PIANO CLASS METHODS -
-
Nortwen
(GROUP PIANO)
Basic keyboard familiarity, simple accompaniment and music skills.
'st.: No. (1/4 course).
J
Arranged
-1
-
~OLITTAL
SCIENCE
-
--
-
-.
a
0
6
0
WORLD POLITICS
Goldman
Introduction to the processes and issues of international politics, including the dynamics of the international system, theories of international
relations, with focus on recent problems. Dist.: Yes.
8:
0.50 a.m.
M,T,W,Th,F
M5
I
QUANTITATIVE METHODS FOR
Morgan
ECONOMICS AND BUSINESS
Introduction to quantitative reasoning, descriptive measures, p.robability,
sampling distributions, inference, and estimation with e m p h a s ~ son their
use in applied problems in business and economics. Dist.: No.
Prerequisite: Math placement 111o r a grade of at least 2.0 in MAT 104.
12:OO-3:00p.m.
MtT,W,TYI
M23
399-8066
BUS 279-8016
BUS 399-8019
INTERNSHIPS
Ka
Arranged with individual faculty in the Department of Business Admi-,
tration & Econimics.
44
Arranged
---
--
PSYCHOLOGY_
-
-
-
INTRODUCTION TO THE
Hirdman
WORLD OF PSYCHOLOGY
Exploration of the discipline of psychology; concepts, data, and methdology. Students may not receive credit for this course and also for PSY
;&5
(General Psychology). Dist.: Yes.
.do-10:50a.m.
M,T,W,Th,F
M22
-
r
ECONOMICS
ECO 110-8028
ECONOMICS OF URBAN ISSUES
Sabella
Study of economic implications of problems facing a metrmurban environment. By independent study. Dist.: Yes.
Arranged
ECO 112-8029 PRINCIPLES OF MACROECONOMICS
Gupta
Introduction to macreeconomics; national income analvsis,
"
. monetarv and
fiscal policy, international trade, economic growth. Dist.: Yes.
6:00-9:00p.m.
M,T,W,Th
M4
EDUCATION
-
EDE 255-8037
ORIENTATION TO EDUCATION
Osnes
EDS 265-8038
IN AN URBAN SEITING
Investigation of various aspects of the teaching profession and opportunity
for in-school work. Open to all students. Dist.: Yes.
Prerequisite: sophomore standing o r above.
Arranged
EDE 375-8036
DISCOVERY IN THE WORLD
Endorf
OF KINDERGARTEN
Kindergarten curriculum, materials, teaching approaches. Lab. arr. Prerequisite to student teaching at kindergarten level and to obtaining a license for teaching at that level. Consent of instructor. Dist.: No.
Arranged
EDE 363-8039
CLINICAL EXPERIENCE
McNeff
Includes 160 hours in Kindergarten/Elementary classroom experienr
video tapings, seminars. Dist.: No. (1/2 course)
I
)
Prerequisite: Consent of instructor.
Arranged
-
-
-
S.-T U D E N T TEACHING
-The Department of Education offers student teaching for both elementary
and secondary education during the general period from the middle of
June to the end of July where suitable arrangements can be made.
STUDENT TEACHING: ELEMENTARY AND KINDERGARTEN
Observing and directing learning experiences in elementary schools under
supervision of college and public school personnel.
Additional $35:00 fee. Dist.: No.
Prerequisite: Acceptance, Education Department.
Arranged
EDE 481-8071/482-8072
483-8073/484-8074
-
PSY 121-8060
Kindergarten a n d Elementary Osnes/Staff
EDE 481-8061/482-8062
483-8063/484-8064
Elementary (Gr. 1-6)
Osnes/Staff
BDE 481-8066/482-8067
483-8068/484-8069
Kindergarten
Osnes/Staff
RBL 369-8070
RELIGIOUS IMAGINATION IN
Skibbe
MODERN LITERATURE
Particularities of religious discernment, symbolism and world view.
Reading and discussion of selected novels, poems, etc. Class meets approximately every other day. Dist.: Yes.
Prerequisite: REL 111o r 221 o r permission of instructor.
9:30-11:50a.m.
M,T,W,Th,F
M23
~
A W O RLK
- SWK 410-8085
FAMILY VIOLENCE
M. Brown
Overview of the phenomena of domestic violence including contributing
factors, consequences for the family and the broader society, and policies and programs which address the issue. Dist.: No.
Prerequisite: One course in psychology, sociology of family o r instructor's permission.
2:OO-590p.m.
M,T,W,Th
OM4
SWK 399-8082
INTERNSHIPS
(May continue through Term 11)
M. Brown
Arranged
- -
SOCIOLOGY
--.
- SOC 121-8075
PRINCIPLES OF SOCIOLOGY
B.
Sociolo$y a s a mode of analysis o r way of knowing. Its applications to a n
understanding of basic aspects of society; socialization, family life, social
inequalities, large-scale institutions, etc. Dist.: Yes.
8:30-10:50a.m.
M,T,W,Th,F
M4
JX
3C 2 3 1-8076
SOCIOLOGY OF THE FAMILY
B. J o h n s o n
examination of the family as,a social institution. The process of dating, mate selection, marital adjustment and divorce. The relationship of
the family to its institutional and cultural context. Dist.: No.
6:OO-9:00p.m.
M,T,W,Th
M22
r
SOC 265-8077
RACIAL AND MINORITY
Gerasimo
GROUP RELATIONS
The dimension of racial and minority group relations emphasizing prejudice, racism and the role of self-understanding. Dist.: Yes. (P/N grading
only).
6:OO-9:00p.m.
M,T,W,Th
L1
SOC 199-8078/399-8080
INTERNSHIPS
Hesser
Arranged
SPEECH, COMMUNICA'I'ION ANU T H E A ~ RARTS
SPC 111-8079
BEGINNING SPEECH
Lapakko
Basic approach to effective speaking and critical listening. Dist.: No.
1:OO-4:00p.m.
M,T,W,Th
M5
HEALTH EDUCATION AND PHYSICAL EDUCATION
HPE 115-9047
HEALTLNE
H CHEMICAL
ors st ad
DEPENDENCY EDUCATION
An analysis of chemical abuse and what can be done for the abuser. Includes information about school health programs and prevalent health
needs and problems of school age children. Dist.: No. (This course meets
M N teacher licensure requirement). (1/2 course)
5:30-9:00p.m.
M, w
M5
(June 29-July 15)
HISTORY
HIS 250/9051
INTRODUCTION TO
Brueee
MODERN RUSSIAN HISTORY
Introduction to the main themes; political, social, cultural and economic, which have characterized the evolution of modern Russia, Tsarist and Soviet. Dist.: Yes. Additional work required for upper division
credit.
G:00-9:30p.m.
T,Th
M23
350/9053
- ART
ART 107-9001
DRAWING
8. Olson
A s a way of seeing and a means of personal expression working with a variety of media: pencil, pen, charcoal, pastel. Dist.: Yes.
9:00-12:00 N.
M,W,Th
- -
-
ART 118-9004/355-9005 PAINTING I & 11
B.OI-dn
Watercolor - Acrylic; translating the visual world of nature, landscapes,
still-life, using design concepts, developing personal expression and exploring variety of techniques. Weekly critiques. Dist.: Yes.
9:00-12:00 N.
M, W,Th
OM17
ART 132-9006
PHOTOGRAPHY (SECTION I)
Friederichsen
ART 132-9007
PHOTOGRAPHY (SECTION 11)
Friederichsen
The camera used as a tool for visual creativity and expression; black and
white, color and photographic processes. Need access to a 35mm camera.
Dist.: Yes. Estimated cost of film, etc.: $75.00.
1:30-5:00p.m.
M, W Seclion I
OM4
M,W Section I1
330-9:00 p.m.
HIS 299-499
DIRECTED STUDY/
INDEPENDENT STUDY
(Diverse Topics: See Instructor)
Gustafson
Arranged
-
- Y
~ ~ s C ~ P L I N A- R
INS 399-9054
INTERNSHIPS
PHILOSOPHY
-
PHI 380-9055
-
Hesser
Arranged
-
ETHICS OF MEDICINE
C. J o h n s o n
AND HEALTH CARE
Application of ethical principles to problems which arise in the areas of
health care and delivery, human experimentation, human engineering,
abortion, care for the dying and euthanasia. Dist.: Yes.
330-9.90 p.m.
M, W
M24
--
;
1310 203-9010
PRINCIPLES OF NUTRITION
Mickelberg
Study of basic human nutrition and the changes that occur in nutritional
needs due to physiological stresses and periods of the life cycle; weight
control, dietary myths, and personal dietary analysis. Dist.: Yes.
Prerequisite: Consent of instructor.
1l:40-1:25p.m.
M,T,W,Th
S205
--
B U S I m 3 AUMINIY'I'H
-
--
-
--
+
BUS 175-9015
COMPUTERS FOR
Herzog
ECONOMICS AND BUSINESS
Introduction to computerized data processing: BASIC, LOTUS, DBASE,
word processing, computerized business graphics. Dist.: No.
Prerequisite: High school algebra.
1:30-3.35p.m.
M,T,W,Th
S112
PHY 101-9060
- ASTRONOMY
Hollabaugh
Study solar system, stars, galaxies. Explain optical instruments; use 12inch reflecting telescope, 8-inch Celestron, 3-inch Questar. Dist.: Yes.
Prerequisite: Elementary algebra.
G:00-9:30p.m.
M, W
MZ2
POLITICAL S C ~ E N C E
POL 365-9065
TOPICS: NUCLEAR WAR.
NUCLEAR WEAPONS
Il~r!
History, politics, economics, strateglna and ecolagiea ~tir~utldlog
technologies propelling the a r m s ractt, an the one hand, and affecting
a r m s control, on the other. Explorotfon of thapolltba mderratc,qy of nuclear security issues. Dist.: (Consent of depwtmsnr ~ ~ ~ ~ P ~ F M J I I
G:00-9:30p.m.
T,Th
M24
POL 199-9066
INTERNSHIPS
,'
BUS 222-9016
PRINCIPLES OF ACCOUNTING I1
So;
.
Introduction to business activities, accounting for corporations. Basic co"cepts and fundamentals of managerial accounting, planning and controlling processes, decision-making and behavioral considerations. Dist.: No.
Prerequisite: BUS 221.
10:05-11:30a.m.
M,T, W,Th,F
M4
BUS 252-90 17
PRINCIPLES OF MARKETING
Cerrito
Basic policy and strategy issues in marketing. Legal, ethical, competitive,
behavioral, economic and technological factors as they affect product, p r o
m n t i n n m - r l r ~ t i n dn h n n n o l 3 n A nrir4n.r A a n i r i n n r nint . hln
Hedblom
399-9067
Arranged
)LOGY
PSY 2--/SO70 I
-
PSYCHOLOGY AND
HMman
CHEMICAL DEPENDENCY
Chemical dependency; its psychological effects on the individual, t h e
family, and the community. Attention given to development of chemical
dependency and available treatment and rehabilitation. Students will explore their own values and attitudes related to the topic. Dist.: No. lThis
ourse does not meet MN teacher licensure requirement).
-
-
i
-BUS 322-9018 ACCOUNTING THEORY AND PRACTICE I
Kader
Analysis of accounting theory pertaining to financial statements, income
concepts, current and non-current assets. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: BUS 221, ECO 113.
6:OO-9:30p.m.
T,Th
M4
BUS 399-9019
INTERNSHIPS
Kader
Arranged with individual faculty in the Department of Business Adtration and Economics.
-
e
- -- -
ECO 110-9030
ECONOMICS OF URBAN ISSUES
S~G
Study of economic implications of problems facing a metreurban environment. By independent study only. Dist.: Yes.
Arranged
ECO 113-9031 PRINCIPLES OF MICROECONOMICS
Sabella
lntroduction to micro-economics, the theorv of the household, firm, market structures and income distribution. ~ i ~ l i c a t i oofn e ~ e m k n t a reco~
nomic theory to market policy. Dist.: Yes.
6:OO-9:30p.m.
M, w
M5
ECO 315-9032
MONEY & BANKING
Gupta
Monetary and banking systems, particularly commercial banks, and the
Federal Reserve System; monetary theory and policy. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: ECO 112,113.
6:OO-9:30p.m.
M, W
-
EDE 363-9035
CLINICAL EXPERIENCE
McNeff
Includes 160 hours in Kindergarten/Elementary classroom experiences:
video tapings, seminars. Dist.: No. (1/2 course)
Prerequisite: Consent of instructor.
ENG 282-9040
TOPICS: AMERICAN PARABLES:
Garrison
CHRISTIANITY IN MODERN AMERICAN FICTION
Reading of selected works of fiction; examination of their relationship to
Christianity - its myths, themes, metaphors, use a s a tool for understanding history, and its own instructive, "parabolic" stories. Dist.: Yes.
M,T, W,Th
M5
FOREIGN LANGUAGES
SPA 112-9046
BEGINNING SPANISH 11
"
Aims to develop the four basic skills: understanding, speaking, reading,
and writing of elementary
lntroduction to culture of Spanish. Spanish.
.
speaking world. Dist.: Yes.
-
8:30-9:55a.m.
M,T, W,Th,F
M22
SPA 21 1-9046
INTERMEDIATE SPANISH I
Kingsley
Conversation; grammar review. Reading of selected Latin American and
Spanish texts.
6:OO-9:30p.m.
M, W
--
-
M23
AEL 486-9078
I I I~
I
PSYCHOLOGY OF RELIGION
Beneon
AND THEOLOGY
Study of current psychological views of religion in the context of the traditional Christian view of human nature. Special attention to the classics
in the field by Freud, Jung, and William James, and to those Christian
theologians who have been influenced by them. Dist.: Yes.
5:30-9:00 p.m.
T,Th
M5
SOC 366-9080
ISSUES IN CONTEMPORARY
CORRECTIONS
Bloom
Analysis of adult correctional programs and processes. Lectures, discussion, and site visits to correctional institutions and government offices.
Dist.: No.
- -
--
1:30-5:00p.m.
SOC 199-9081/399-9082
INTERNSHIPS
H m r
Arranged
M4
McNeff
OF TEACHING READING
EDS 351-9034
Study and utilization of a variety of techniques and resources in the reading
and the diagnosis and correction of reading difficulties. Dist.: No.
6:OO-9:00p.m.
M,T, W,Th
L1
(July 20-August 6)
11:40-125 p.m.
M,T, W,Th,F
n 3 0 - 9 : 5 5 a.m.
-
EDUCATION
-
RELIGION
-REL 3--/SO76
RELIGIONS OF CHINA AND JAPAN
Beneon
A study of the chief traditions of China and Japan that are usually associated with "religion," including the "popular" religious traditions of
China; Confucianism, Taoism, Buddhism and Japanese Shintoism. Interrelation of religion and culture. Dist.: Yes.
M23
-
SPEECH, COMMUNICATION AND THEATER ARTS
SMALL GROUP COMMUNICATION
Abrame
SPC 355A study of group dynamics and leadership with emphasis on factors involved in effective functioning within small groups and organizations.
Dist.: No.
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
M, w
OM1 1
SPC 367-9086
THEATER IN THE TWIN CITIES
Cole
Studying, viewing, and critiquing the acting and production of five plays.
Dist.: No.
T,Th
2815 41st Avenue South,
6:OO-9:30p.m.
Mpls., MN 55406 pel.: 721-2565)
-r
1
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Summer Catalog, 2007
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
augsburg in the summer
summer session info
Augsburg College offers a varied summer curriculum that includes courses in 13
academic disciplines as well as internships and independent studies. A detailed listing
of courses begins o n page 8.
Course loads in Summer Session:
summer session ...
Show more
augsburg in the summer
summer session info
Augsburg College offers a varied summer curriculum that includes courses in 13
academic disciplines as well as internships and independent studies. A detailed listing
of courses begins o n page 8.
Course loads in Summer Session:
summer session I
May 29 to June 29
w
summer session S
I
July 9 to August 9
\
summer online
June 25 to August 31
about augsburg
I
Augsburg College is a four-year, liberal arts college located in the heart of
Minneapolis, and affiliated with the Evangelical Lutheran Church in America.
Augsburg is accredited by The Higher Learning Commission.* The small college
environment (about 3,700 students during the academic year) is enriched by the
many opportunities found in this vibrant metropolitan area. Augsburg's setting allows
students to participate in a host of cultural and recreational activities.
* Tile Higller Letlmii~gCotnrl~rsslonof tlie N~~rth
Cer~rrulAssociutioi~of Colleges nr~dScla~ols,C(miir~issioii
on
Students may take up to 2.0 credits in
each summer session (3.0 credits if the
Cum GPA is 3.00 or better). However, the
total credit load for
Day/WEC/Rochestel? L Inited students
behveen Spring WEC and Summer
Session I cannot exceed 2.0 credits (3.0
credits if the Cum GPA is 3.00 or better).
Additionally, total credit load between
Summer Sessions I and 11 and Summer
Online cannot exceed 2.0 credits at any
one time (3.0 credits if the Cum GPA
is 3.00 or better). Students desiring to
exceed these limits must petition the
Student Standing Committee prior to
registration. Unless otherwise indicated, all
courses carry a value of 1.0 course credit.
One Augsburg course credit is the
equivalent of four semester credits or six
quarter credits.
Employer reimbursement:
Students who qualify for reimbursement
from their employers may use their
reimbursement to pay for Summer Session
courses.
Housing:
Students who need housing may contact
the Residence Life Office at 612-330-1488.
information:
Additional informationmay be ob-
Courses fulfilling Augsburg's Liberal Arts
Perspectives, Core Curriculum, and
Graduation Skills requirements are so
noted along with the description of the
course.
www.augsburg.edu/sum mer
Augsburg College
Campus Box 143
2211 Riverside Avenue
Minneapolis, MN 55454
For registration or financial questions:
612-330-1046 (Enrollment Center)
For questions related to courses:
612-330-1025 (Academic At.l\,ising)
Augsburg general education:
ab
Course levels:
Eligibility:
The first digit of the threedigit course
number indicates the course level. Course
numbers beginning with a "1" or "2" are
lower division courses and are intended
primarily for freshmen and sophomores;
course numbers beginning with a "3" or
"4" are upper division and are primarily
for juniors and seniors.
Persons in good standing at regionally
accredited colleges and universities,
graduates of such institutions, and
students admitted for the next fall term,
are eligible to attend Augsburg's Summer
Session. Good standing implies that the
student has been admitted and not
subsequently dismissed by that instihltion.
Independent study:
Students accepted for Summer Sess@n are
not automatically granted admission as
regular sn~dentsof Augsburg College.
Those wishing to begin a degree program
at Augsburg should apply to the Office of
Undergraduate Admissions, 612-330-1001,
or the Weekend College Admissions
Office 612-330-1743.
Independent studies may be arranged in
consultation with individual faculty
members.
liurirutiolu of Higher Educurion, 30 Nor111LuSulle Street, Sre 2400, Chicogo, Illii~ois,60602-2504, 3 12.2630456. Websire <www.~~cucihe.or~>
internships are carefully planned workbased learning experiences, supervised and
evaluated by a faculty member. Consult
the Center for Service, Work, and
Learning at 612-330-1148 for more
information.
Internships:
In addition to those listed, internship
opportunities may be arranged
individually during the summer. Academic
'L
to register
All s t ~ ~ J c nmay
t s hexin to register for
S u ~ ~ i mSession
er
courses on April 16.
Web registration wiU remain open until
May 3 (Session
n d Jime 8 (Session
II). Wch re:
~ r will
s be 8:30
a.m.-1 1:59p.n~.dally. ~ u g s h n r gst~ndents
arc encouraged to use Well rcfiistration.
Non-Augshurg stuclents must rcxister in
person a t the Enrollment Ccntcr I>ctwccn
8:30 a.m.- 4:30 p.m. M-W (H:3O ;a.m.-7
is located in Svercl~-~~p
Hall. Wc
recommcncl th:lt ~ O L I SCIICC~IIIC yo111
courses
:IS
c:lrly as possible.
I t ;a discrep:~ncyis foinnd I>ctween this
catalog :lnd course inhrmation fi)uncl
through AuxNet, AugNet shol~lclhe
co~isidereclthe no st curl.cnt ;uicl, thus,
correct.
Students registering for Sumtner
Session I must conlplete their
registration by May 29. Signature of the
instructor is needed to add a class after
the first day of class.
.Icnts will he hillcci r l ~ r o ~ ~ f i l ~
lilnts. Non-Augsh~~rfi
:I[ die time of rcgi'str,lcion.u students
must be paid in full by May 4 for
Sunlnler Session I and June 15 for
S u n ~ ~ nScssion
cr
11. Augsburg students
who have unpaid balances from
previous tern
lust r--.* h u e balances
before tb
Sess'
the first day of class.
Web registration closes
May 3
June 8
June 8
Balance of tuition due
May 29
July 9
June 25
Classes begin
May 29
July 9
June 25
May 29
July 9
June 25
Last day to:
Register (without late fee)
June 1
July 12
June 29
(signature of instructor needed; no registratiuns will be accepted after this date!
*Drop class without notation
June 1
July 12
June 29
'Change grading option
June 15
July 26
August 3
Withdraw from class
June 15
July 26
August 3
Classes end
June 29
August 9
August 31
nt the Enl-ollmcnt Ccnrer (this must he
Grades due in Registrar's Office
July 9
August 17
September 10
clone in I>crso~l).
Thel-c is ,I ch;irgc of
$100 for each course cancelled.
Schedule of Refunds: The following refund schedule is based on the percentage
FOIrcf~nnclinform:~tio~~
plc;lse see
This applies to all students who drop one or more courses during each term.
lo\\! enrollments will lie cnncellctl one
\vcck I>ch~-e
the first ciay of the session.
Students \\lho clcciclc to c.~ncelrhcir
rcgistr:ltion prior to the tirst cl;iy of rhc
session nunst complete a clrol>/nclcl tor~n
of class time remaining o n the date of the student's official withdrawal from class.
Schedule of Refunds o n the next [page.
Percentage of class time remaining after official drop or withdrawl and amount of refund:
s t ~ ~ ~ l cwho
n r s I-existel-:liter the finst day of
the term. No Session 1 registrations will
he :acccl>tecl:liter June I . N o Scssion I1
rcgistr:~tionswill he :~ccc~)tecl
:~frcrJuly 12.
No Summer Online rcfiistr;ltions will he
Students registering for Summer
Online must complete their
registration by June 25.
online
*Register (added late fee of $75)
ngc in Registration:
A lntc tcc of $75 will he nssessecl tor
Students registering for Summer
Session I1 must complete their
registration by July 9. Signature of the
instructor is needed to add a class after
calendar
I summer 2007
;icccl~tcclnttcr June 29
100% to 90% remaining-Full refund (minus $100 administrative fee)
8 9 % to 50% remaining-Refund equals the percentage of term remaining
49% or less remaining-No refund
This refund schedule is effective whether or not a student has attended classes.
Pl'ease allow two weeks for tuition and possible financial aid adjustments to be
finalized. If a credit balance remains on the student's account, a credit refund
check will be issued at that time.
map of augsburg
costs
T u i t i o n rates f o r
I[ ~ L I I ~ Sc
LC
COlIrSeS:
5
3
%
Su_mmer
for
-_
o n c ~ ~ r r e n tw
l yi t h t h e
trimester.
WEC s t u c l e n t s
I1 or
Session
Summer O n l i n e may be(e1EibFfor
hnl
financial aid
l e tuition r a t e s
, are
if t h e i r
"l e a s t 1.0 c r e
c o u r s e l o a c l IS a t
listed abov
To apply
financial aid
Eligibility for Summer S e s s i o n a t t e n d e e s
T h e on
of fi
for
sion a t t e n d e e s a r e t h e
d
by the program
state
and
federal f i n a n c i a l aid.
ments), a n d s t u d e n t loans. V i s i t
for-
t h e E n r o l l ~ n e nC
t e n t e r website t o
form:
download a n application
t
www.augsb~~rg.edu/enroll.
The financial
aid priority deadline for Summer S e s s i o n
Day program
S t u d e n t s e n r o l l e d in e i t h e r S c s s i o n
11, or
ant (for s t u c l e n r s who m e e t e l i g i b i l i t y
in w l i i c
a r e e n r o l l e d ) a r e e l i g i b l e to a p p l y
lid a v a i l a b l e
F e d e r a l P e l l ~ ~ , t nt ht e, M i n n e s o t a S t a t e
Stuclents w h o m a i n t a i n h a l f - t i m e status
5 def
Summer
Ior
is
May 15, 2007.
b o t h Sessions c o m b i n e d , [ n a y b e
e l i g i b l e t o apply f o r f i n a n c i a l
c o u r s e l o a d is a t least
aid if t h e i r
1.5 c r e d i t s
over the
Augsburg
College
who
rnaxiniuni
For WEC
are eligible
tuition
for
benefit
the
will
receive a
60 p e r c e n t c l i s c o u n t on S u m m e r
WEC program
students enrolled
in s p r i n g
for
Sumnier
t r i m e s t e r , no a i d i s g i v e n
Employee Tuition B e n e f i t
Faculty, staff, a n d d e p e n d e n t s o f t h e
tllltlOl1.
Session
COLLE(;E MAP INI:OKMATION
I Crnrr~t t l r Ctltllrbrl~nc. t ~ r c ltlcitltl,
I'rt~~n~~rtc~n
! Wcchcnil nn~l(;r.~,luntc A~lnllw<,nr
1 AII Srrucrr~rcEnrr.~ncc
(Nolc~nl~cr
t l ~ r t ~ ohI,ml,)
gl~
.I E~lu~.Nrlxtn
Arhlcrs
Flcl~l,ln~lScarcmnl Air Structurc
5 (:hr~rrcn'c.nCenrcr 2nd
I>ny A ~ l ~ n ~ s w n \
6 MBA Pn>gl.~ln
7 h > > h , Lchccl, M~lcs,Ccntcr ior
I ) ~ , ~ n l., ~
l n~l
W~>I\III~~.
Communlc.~t~crn
8 S\CIJ~,II>
tl:~ll
9 Hual,).Stru~n~r,l.nTcnlrl* Cc,,,rt*
117 I c r Arrnn
I I I',II~I,<l<~l,lt,,?,,\.b,><l
I3 M,llnrcn.~nrc,rnJ C;~<>t~nclr
Slrllll
14 MLITICI.CI H.bll
15 Murlrl>yl'lncc
16 M ~ ( r p l Iq
7.,r!.
17 M u w H.rll
I8 Nc\r licr~ilcnrcH.111
1') 01<1
M.,nn
20 Anilcrv,n IH.tII
21 Qu.,cl
2 2 Sclcncr H.111
2 3 P ~ I I ~ S?ICI>
II~ c : ~ ~ I ~ ~ I ~ ~ ~
Ccnrcr
24 S l r ~ l q >,m
~ncl
~ ~Krcc~v~ng
g
2 5 SI Mc,lhg H;dI
26 S \ c ~ - ~ l ~ ~ ~ ~Mc~t,<>r~.nl
~ C > t r r ~Ii.1II
l.~l
27 Lirnc\\ H.111
28 Kcnncilg (:cnlcr
~ ~ ~ ~ ~ , ~ I I c ~ I ~ ~
Conrrnt~n~c.ut~wn
I2 Ltndcll Llhr.\r\
campus location
35W from thc NorthTnkc W.t\l,~n~ton
Avcnr~eexit :,nJ ttlrn lcir <,n
W ; ~ \ l t i n ~ t i(turtrs
ln
1 1 ~ 1Cmto
i r Crcl,~rA\vnr~c),turn lcit
;at R~ver\~clc
Avc~rr~c,
r ~ ~ nr
l i r2lbt Awnuc South.
1-94 Enst from Minocapolist
Avcn~~c,
rum
Tlhc 25th A\vnl~ccur, turn Icit . ~ 25th
left :at Rl\r~siclcAvcnuc, rurn Iclr . ~ Zt l h t A\*cnuc
S~~r~rli
,.1-94 Wcst fro111 St. PaulTrtc Rrvcr.rrcleculr, rur I> r~yhr:It R~\.cr\~ilc
Avcnuc,
turn Iclr . ~2Ist
t Atenuc Sot~rh.
35W from thc South-
I
l~c~llow
tlw 1.94 St. P:tt~lb ~ ~ r i(~tiove
,
rct r ~ c l Italic
~ r ;ii~cr
c.~rho f nix, mcrficr*), L h c 25th Awnr~ecult ia~i<I
turn
Ich , ~Rt ~ \ c ~ , rAvenl~c,
~ ~ l c rurn leir ;bt 2lsr Avcnl~cSouth
session I
'A
may 29 - june 29.2007
Rooms listeo LUL ~ a c h
course below are auu~ectto change aulct: rne printing of this
catalog. Please refer to AugNet Records and Registration for the latest information
on room assignment for a particd~r
BUS
AR'
1
Swccncy
This c o ~ l l s ew ~ l
AIS 105-S
h
Lifc Drawing
~ c t i o nt o A m e r i c
d i a n Studies
tl1c bt '
'
IIES
I? C c r r i t o
Dm,elopment o t tlie theory o f Iiianngement.
$
n:rn h r m
Weston
2423
Principles o f Management
Iiis course is intended t o introrlucc sturlents to
A m c i~c . ~ n1nrli;in Studies. Concepts ancl topics to
urg:~nimtlon,staffing, planning, and a ~ n m u l T
. lie
COM 11 1-S
P u b l i c Speaking
nature ot authority, nccountah~lity,n ~ i crcaln,nsibil~ry,
l
T h e courrc tocuscs o n speech prcparation,
nn;ilysls o f the rule o f the pmtcssionnl m;lnager.
organization, n u ~ l i c n c canalysis, style, I~stcning,nntl
6-9:30 11m
be co\,erecl include, among others, Iiistory,
M,
w
RVI : L I N 16
Inclians w i l l be emphaslzerl ndiere npproplinte
l n t e r c ~ ~ l r ~Au,(~rcn~.rs
m~l
1
annto~ny,slinrlIng%cntlcrinl:
cu1i11>o~itio11,
P C ~ I ~ C ~ I I ~ ~ ~ I I V
f&
I A ~ I I I ~ ~FIW
~ OA m
1.4:-
Perspe~.~~t,e.
I A F in Humanities
6-9:30 1
M, W
.:
OM 17
J. C e r r i t o
H u m a n Resource M a n a g e m e n t
k n o n n c l f i ~ n c t i o ni n business, acquirition nntl
ut~lizationof human resources; cles~nblew l r k ~ n y
relationships; effective integration o t tlic wurker with
I
>
,-S
T h i s course nclc
the a w l s
(with H I S 24913493)
igned Environment
Andcrson
s t h c rlcs~gncilen\zir~>nment,
ART 100-S
the i n t c n t i o n n l ,
Topics: P l c i n Air S k e t c h i n g
W e w i l l ~n\.estigatca1
T h i s introcluctnry, f~)unclntional
: ~ r c h i t e c t u urban
~ ~ , cleslgn, :~nclurh;in Ihisn>ry; cl:lss
ienccl places i n \\,li~cli a'c I ~ v e .
-a
I Ithe
~
M. W
Financial Managcmcnt
Kapoor
risk nntl return, recurity \faluation, capital
i n sulnmer. By making site visits 2nd working on
Prcrccl.: n o n e for 249; tor 349: E N L II I (,r ENL
mnliagement.
l o c a t ~ o nstudents
,
w i l l engage w i t h the subject
112 o r H O N 111 ;rnrl :In :art, liist<~ry,or u r h : ~ n
matter they are sketch~ng<Inn ~iiulti-sensory
s t t ~ ~ l i ec so ~ ~ r s e
T l i e course i n c l u ~ l e st i n a n c ~ nstatement
l
;~n:ilysis,
P~n~cr~ctlrv/Sk~ll/LAF.
Acstherlo m (CIQ I'~np~.ct~tc;
Wr~tlng
Skill (ART 349 u~rly).L A F 111 F11ieArts (ART 249 only)
tbr them. Stu~lentsarc rcspnnsihle b,r Ipurchasc o f
n , = . SCI
M, W
ACC 2213
Kadcr
P~n~ctilc/SkilVLAF.AatL,llo I'Lnpl.c~~w;L A F 131FLIW
Arb
6.9:30 0.m
T. T h
Rm.: O M 4
E C O 112 a n J 113 may he rnken i n either orrler.
1-4:30 0 ~n
M, W
Rm : O M 13
Gybcrg
T h i s course introcluces hnsic chemistry cuncepts 111
ECO 1 1 3 3
tlie context of numerous science,b;~seJ Issues I n o u r
Principles o f Microeconomics
everyclay I~vcs,with the ge11;1
A n introduction to micr<~econ(>mics:
tlie theory o f
o f s t u ~ l c n t shaving ;I
Gilsdorf
Introrluctiun to h u r ~ n c r s:~cti\,itiea, b:isic concept.*,
basic unclersrnn~linl:o f tlie science b e h i n d irsucs
tlie lhouschol~l,f i r m , m:~rketstructures, anel income
nncl t u n ~ l n m e n m l so f accounting, the nccounting
present and i n tlie tuture.
~ l i s t r i h u t i o n .A l q ~ l i c a t i o nof clcmcntnry economic
cycle, :lncl preparation o t t~n:rnci;~l
st;ltcments.
Prc~erl.: M P G 2
8.30 (r m - n o u ~ ~
M, W
I t ~ :n SVE 202
c ~ ~ c a t i vancl
~ t y cxprcssion uaing black ancl white
film, etc: $200-225. (capacity liniits enr<,ll~ncntt o 14)
M n y he taken ~ n c l c p c n ~ l e n tof
l y E C O 113 o r 110.
L A F ill Soc~r~l
mid Bchraz~orulSc~ences
Chemistry f o r Changing T i m c s
locations. (capnc~t)'l11111ts
c n r o l l ~ n c n to
t 15)
35mm,s~nale.lens rctlcx cnmcr:l. Est~m;iteilcost o f
RI~I: SCI 2 0 5
Per>pec~ioe/Skill/LAF: Wcsrern Hcr~rogePcrspec~iue;
CHM 100-S
plhotogrnl~liicprocesses. Sturlcnts need ncccsr to a
Gilsdorf
A n l n t r o ~ l u c t i o nt o macroeconomics: national
international trade Application o f elementary
123
has~csketcli~ngk i t from WetP;iint A r t Supplier ($40)
Principles o f A c c o u n t i n g 1
Principles o f Macrocconomics
Prererl.: M P G 2
a ~ i c for
l tr;1nsl>nrtnrion to clesignntrd off-carnl3us
Boechcr
Rm : SVE I
i n c ~ m i ennnlysis, llionctary anrl fisc;rl policy,
Piercq : E C O 112 or 113, A C C 221, nncl MI'G 3
6-9:30 p m
pcrson;ll scale. I n this w.~ythey w i l l n t t e ~ n p t o
Photography
M, W
e c o n o ~ n i ctheory to current economic problems
unclcrstancl where they arc, a n d why it has mcnnina
T h e camera w i l l he usecl ns n tool tLr \,~sunl
III
FIN 3 3 1 3
excellence ancl l h i s t ~ ) r ~ SI~I~I~~C:II~CC.
c~I
ART 1 3 2 3
6.9:30 p
Hm : SVE 206
places, habits, nncl architecture o f the T w ~ nCities
Iltn : O M 17
tlirourli vrrb;il ;and nun-verhal mess;lges; emphasis
Instructor
6.930 I,m
Lapakko
A stucly of the d y n a m ~ c sof h u m a n i n t c ~ a c t i < > n
overcome communication b:irricrs
Prereq.: B U S 200 o r B U S 242 o r consent o f
uhsel-\,ation ; ~ n r ~l l ~ r eon-site
ct
s k e z i n u the ~wo~,le,
. .
M. W
COM 3 5 4 3
Interpersonal C o m m u n i c a t i o n
o n factors that huilcl relntionsli~psn n i l hell> t o
f i r n ~ancl society.
and slre \'is~tat u prominent examples ofclesign
8:30 a.ni -11our1
R m : M U R I11
ccrure, I;~nclrcapc
perceptual plein :lir sketching u ~ i l l ~ i i rn l ei r o ~ ~ ~ h scsslons cc~nsist: ~ l m o s tcxclus~oclyo t w c l l k i n g tours
PL'~S~CCLI~,~./S~III/LAF:
L A F 111 Fine Artr
T. Th
BUS 3403
contelnporary issues, a n d the arts Minnesota
Pcrspcctirc/Skill/LAF:
(>vcrcomingspeech fright
6.9:30 p m
language, culture, literature, policy, Images,
Lapakko
ACC 2 2 2 - 5
Principles o f A c c o u n t i n g I1
Kadcr
anrl it~nrlamcnt:ils 11t; ~ c c o i ~ n t i n gtlie
, nccol~nring
cycle, nnrl prcp;ir,itlon o f financial stnte~nents.
8:30 (1.m
loan
T. TI1
I'erspcct~t~c/Sk~ll/LAF: Natlrrul WorLl 2 Pcrspe~.[l~e,
L A F in N'lrlrrnl Scienccs rind Mnthemr~tics
8.30 o 111-1ioun
I n t r o ~ l u c t i o nto business a c r ~ r i t ~ c bs n
, r ~ cconcepts
RIII.:
SVE I
tliec~ryt o m:irket policy May be taken
T. TI1
RI~I. SCI 123
~ n ~ l c p c n ~ l c no tfl E
y C O 110 o r I I 2 E C O 112 .inJ
I I 3 may be taken I n cithcr order.
,
;
.
I
Prerecl.: M P C 2
Perspect~t~e/Sk~ll/LAI::
Socir~lWorlrl I or 2 Pcrs0cc~i1,e;
L A F in Soc~oland Belurt~~or~rl
Science,
1.4:30 p ~n
T. Tll
Rm : O M 13
HIS 3323
History o f U n i t c d
States Foreign Relations
EED 2 0 3 3
Physical Scicncc
d
Elcmcntary Tcacl
a
This ccrursc tocc~ss 11
Lorcnz-Mcycr
A survey oFUn~tcclSratcs torc~gnrcl:1ric>nsi r o m rhc
8
r
A n i c r i c a ~ li l c \ ~ o l i ~ tthrough
i ~ ~ n the Colrl War,
Grcgoirc
crnl~h:~rlzing
cli:ing~ngJci~nitic,na ot \tJ;lr 31111 PC:ICC.
IMSEP ~physicnlscience
tcnaluns hcnvccn intcrn:rtio~ialian~
:inJ
H P E 001-S
Foundations o f Fitness (0.0 crcdit)
Navarrc
This courrc ia ~ c q u i r c Jc~f:ill Augshurg t u r l c n t s
Prerccl : One EF
It
sccka to Ilnl>ro\'c the sti~clcnt'skno\r.lcclgc ancl
SVE 206
i x t l ; ~ t i o n i r m the
, cmcrgcncc u i rlie U n i t c ~Sratc*
l
ns
.In cconrllnlc ; r ~ i ~~il~ i l i t ; power
~ry
6 9:30 1) rn
M. W/
RI~I : SVE 206
i~nJcratancl~<
~>
i gthe
t componcnrh o f ~ihysical: ~ n r l
IO\,
they c o n t ~ i h u t cto pcrx~n:ilI ~ i c l o lhc:1ltl1
n~
;ancl
to nor only
\vcll hcing T l l ~ scourac is clcs~gnc~l
lpr<>v~Je
k ~ i ~ ~ ~l ~~ ;ilsc>
~ ~l e
tot ~c lli >~ cct ~
~ ~~ ~~;in:~l\,zc
i c l
s c l r r c I;rh rcqwrenients iLr gracluation
4
Prercil.: Muat he Elcmcnr,iry Ecluc;~tic~n
m ; ~ j o.~.
liccnaurc r c c k ~ n g
T
6.9:30 11m.
TI1
IGS009-S
T
Co-op
.
Olson
k Experience 1s ;i0-creclit
The C;ST 00'
11.
SCI 19
t
i tor I
??$
Espuiuicc
Thih (llxi011
\\,dys nn inclivicl~~nl
c;in n.*scas, monltur, motl\,atc
INS 3 9 9 3
I n t e r n sh i p
:~nclcl~aciplineI i ~ ~ n / l i e r a et<,
l t ~n:iinr:iina l i t e t y l c o i
A \vork o~ ser\,~cc-hnscrlcxpcrlcncc I n \r,liicli rlic
iitness 2 n d \rcllnt.s
~ r u c l c n tt, ~ c u l ysl,r,naor,
6-7:45 11111
M, W
MEL 206
RIII.
&sign
3
Olson
ancl \\,c)rk site supervisor
Ie:~rning:igreenicnt p1a11 tlliit 11nka cclllrsr
tlicuries nncl conccl>ts aclors rl~scil>l~ncs,
general
ati1izc.r .rtuclcnrs' c ~ n p l ~ r y m c rclntccl
nt
r<>t h c ~ rnl;ijur
HPE 1 1 5 3
;inrl through ~ c t l e c t ~ r Ihnka
> n on-co~iipur,learning ro
rhc constituency gc131s. ~ i i i s s i ~ ~~ inc,c cor
l icleaa c d
Health and Clienucal
D q m d c n c y Education (.5 crcdit)
Psyclic,lug~cnla n ~ ~pliilo\opliicnl
l
clinicnsion?,u i
<!ti-caml'us ~pco~dc,
org.~nizations,nnrl/o~'
hc
A n :in:ilyhis o i c h e m ~ c ; i nhu.*c
l
:incl w l i : ~ can
t
porttolio hnaccl o n the intcrn.*liip Sruclcnts must
c o m ~ n u n i c ; ~ t i othruugh
~i
the use n t inarruction.il
c o m m ~ ~ n i t ~Telsi c. rcqu~rcclC<H>I' r e t l e c t ~ c ~ n
clone for the nbuscr. Inclu~lcs~nfi)rrnnr~crn
:ahout
consult \r,itli the k u l t y spona<>ra n ~ Lois
l
Olacbn i n
SCIIUOI
l i e i ~ l t l eclumtion
i
ancl resources
the Ccntcr tor Service, W u r k , nncl L c ; ~ r l i ~ n g
E D C 220-S
Educational Tcchnology (.5 c r c q t ~
Erickson
technolo~~
Selection,
.
p ~ c l ~ n r n t i o~~pi ,~ < ~ c l u c ;and
t~on,
assignnicnts k,cus
cvaluatio~io t etfecri\v a u c l i ~ ~ - \ ~ im:~tcri:ils
~ual
for
knowlctlcc, u n ~ l c r s t ; r n ~ l io~ i gthe
tenc1iindle;irning sitt~:ltions. Computer training \\,ill
t>rgan~zat~on/\\.o~-k~>Iiicc
nncl :In nwarencs* o f
he inclu~lccli n t h ~ scour.rc.
o c ~ c t niasucs
l
that may ; ~ i i tlic
~ ~\vorkpl:icc.
t
9 a.m .nmn
M , \V
F htne 1829
Km : SVE 205
<In nl)l'licntion
o i c~>u~sc
6-9:30 1, 111.
c'lucat~<,n, ankl g~ncli~:~tic>n
skill5 \r,ith the 1c:irning
M unly
register.
rcqh~~rc~ncnt
H I S 249134923 ( w i t h ART 2 4 9 1 3 4 9 3 )
Dcsigned Environment
Th15 course huilcls on rlie Iprnctlce ; ~ n d~nctlioclr~ > t
Quantitativc R c a s o n i ~ i g
Schicld
C ~ ~ t i ctal ili n k ~ n g; a h , ~ ~st.~ristics
t
n\ cviclencc. F<>cu\
Eilccrlvc W ~ i t i ~ i g
Irs. \\,i~rkslic~l>
t c ~ ~ n i strcsscb
at
htylc
1111 :issocii~tio~i,
cai~s:itio~i.
ohser\~:iri~~niil
btuilica,
nncl o r q n i z : ~ t i o n ,the proccr> ( revi.\~(>n,
~ i hcli i ~ n r l
cxllcrimcnt\, riak, c<)nfc>uncling,hiaa, ;rnJ ch;incc.
IICCI.
c \ , n l u i ~ t i ~ ni ~, n cthe
l r c l : ~ t ~ ~ > nI)cnvccn
~liil~
rcncl~ng;inJ wr~ting.Kcrli~ircclfor sccc~~icla~
y
Anderson
T h ~ scuurse :~~lclrerses
the ~lesigneclenvironment,
GST 2003
Swanson
Rcv~e\\,cwnlnun tcclin~cluca~ n \ c l l \ i n gstntiaticol
~ ~ l ~ l w ~ r r u ~Stucly
i i s n iconcliti~,n:~l
.
r c . ~ x > n i nig~ s i n g
I~censurenncl Element:i~yEclucation concentration
English to clcscrihc and compc>scrates .ind
i n C o m ~ n u n ~ c : ~ r i , > ~ i / L : ~ ~Arts
ig~~;igc
pcrccnt;igc\ prc\c11tcrl i n t ; ~ h l c;inJ graplih. Use
tlic intcntionnlly clca~gnc<l~pl;lco111which we live
We w ~ l In\,catlaatc
l
nrchitcctl~rc,I:inclscal~c
;rrcliitccturc, urh:In clcsign nncl urh,~nhistory; cln.\s
rcssic~nsconsist :ilmoat cxclu\i\.cly o f \\,;ilking t0111s
nncl site visits to Ipronllncnt cx;i~nl?lcso f clesian
cxccllence ;and lhist<,r~cals ~ g ~ i ~ i i c : ~ n c e
Prcrcq : none tor 249; h,r H I S 349: E N L 1I I (>r
E N L 112 c1r H O N I l l
Prcrc~l.:E N L I II L>r 112. (>r HON 1 1 I
cmnclar~l~zntio~i
to tnkc inn, accoilnt the ~ntluence
Pcrs\~ccti~~e/Sk~ll/LAF:
\V~IIS
I ~k ~~l l
r,ict,ntol~n~lcr.;Analysis ~ , i ~ t ~ t i ~ t i c ~ l l y - h ~ ~ ~ ~ l
\ V r l r ~ nSkill
~ (HIS 349 only); L A F 111 HIL~I~(I~IIICS
(HIS
argtlmcnt\. E ~ i i l ~ h : ~osni ai n t c r p r c t ; ~ t ~ o cvnlu;it~nn,
n,
249 mly)
.~nclc c ~ m m u n i c . ~ t i o ~ i ,
1.4:30 p tn
M, \V
RIII : 5(:1 212
ML 5 8 9 3
Topics: Comprchensivc E x a m i n a t i o n
The
t<,r
IIUI
;ix
Pikc
11usc <)i
t l ~ i as c ~ i i i n n1s~ to Iprcparc stu~lcnts
t c l i c<,~nprclie~isi\~e
exi~min:itions3s tlic
coml>lction ca~.\t<lnc
o i tlic Master o f Art.* i n
1-e;iclcrshili. Stuclenta WIII cxl>erlelicc n ~ intense,
i
coll;rI~~~rat~
nncl
v c ,clircctccl ~ntegrntiono f their
unclcrst:~n~ling
o i lenclcrshil, c x p ~ c s ~tch~r ol t d l i
.*ucceaaiul completion o i the cx;in~~n;lticlnsThe
I'ersl~ecu~~e/Sk~ll/LAF.
Aerrhet~oor
4:308 1, nt
rrgnrcling rccluircmcnts :~nclget ~pcrmissi(>n
ti)
register. P/N gr.~ilinl: (>nly S.~tisf:ictory coml>lcr~<>n
Stuclcnts mu.*t consult w i t h Lois Olson i n the
r e q u ~ r e ~ i i e nnt rn ~get
l l~erlnisai<,n
I n t c n l l c d i a t c Expository W r i t i n g
R n l : KEN 307
s t u ~ l c n r~ i i u rcon1plctc
t
:In ;ic;iclc~ii~c
1c;irninl:
\vill i u l i i l l the Augshura Exper~cnccgracluntinn
Ccntcr tor Scr\,~cc.W o r k , ancl L c : i ~ n i ~ rcwircling
ig
ENL ~ L U - J
oppurtuniticb inherent i n the Intclnahip. The
Umvk
(:II~I'ersl~ccut,e;
c x a ~ n ~ n n r i o[ins
n tlircc parts: a mkc-lic~mc\\,rltrcn
scctlon (hasccl prini;~rily Ihur not exclusi\.ely on tlic
cust<rmi:cd rcnclinga), a #rc,ul> ordl e x : i ~ i i i n ; i t i ~ ~ i ,
T Th
RIII : SCI I 2 3
~ n ciil i ~ l ~ r - \cntccl
l i ~ ~ c~s :~~ r~ n i ~ i : ~ tP/N
i ( ~ ngr;lrl~ng
session
L 111-S
--,inning
Spanish 1
only Tliis course me
S:lturclay morning. Scneuu~ew u ~
oe
A i m s to clevelo
A p r i l aitcr negotint~onw i t h membc
'
: A
r
I,, I.IS~
'
-- .-:.nester
COI
m
MAT 1 0 5 4
Haincs
Concepts o f lineal
id, Iogaritli~nic,oncl
other ni<)~lcIsw i t h a s
iis on :~pplications t o
the social,a.%.nntw
;eryJa
C
srudent
KI
SPA 111
Stcinmctz
business, anrl
;racle o f 2.0
-
NIIG 3. S t t ~ d c ~ preparing
~ts
tor
M P G 3 o r higher may not register b r crecl~t.Sturlents'
6-9:30 p.~n
M, W
algebra
II:
thcoricz ~,i
internatiun:rl relat~clnsT h e course \\.ill
Relipiour heliets, apiritu:rl c u s t o ~ ~ iancl
s , philosophy ot
SCI 108
6-8.30 p11
Underhill
cxpl<,rc issues c>fpeace, suhtninablc ccononllc
N o r t h American I n ~ l i a n sare studied. Tribal
clc\'elopmcnt, g l t ~ b a cit~zcnshil>,
l
nncl efforts t o
silnil:iritirs ;~nclcliiierences ;are explore~las are trih:il
cumbnt ~ n l u s t i c ca n ~ il n e q u ; r l ~arouncl
~
the glohc.
rcl:itionships w i t h nature, rcliglous o\~ersigIito i life
T l i i s class alms t o hcain p r c u , i ~ l i natuclents
~
\ \ , ~ t l itlic
c~,clcs,s;rcrccl r ~ t u acerrnlc,nies,
l
a n ~beliefs
l
i n an
Lnourlerlgc ncceasnry i o ~tilking intormccl :lction i n
;ittcrlite
Irspc,nse t u the c11~11c11~es
II~
the currelit glohnl
Prcrccl.: E N L III o r 112 o r H O N 11 1, j u n i o r
xrcna. Questions cxpl<~rrclinclurlc: Wh;rt should
stancling, :rnJ R E L I 0 0 c>r 3 0 0
i n 1r;rrl Ilc? W l i i ~ are
t ohsracles t o
Att'c~rene,r I Persl~ccttt,~;
Writing Skill
1rnp;lct LIOintcrn:itionnl ~ l c v c l o p m c n t slhavc nn o u r
6.9.30 p rn
MUS 1603
Fundamentals o f M u s i c Theory
1
Mikkelson
S W K 4951699 PA 5 9 5 3
Topics: I n t e r d i s c i p l i n a r y
Perspectives o n A g i n g
Holroyd
POL 2 4 1 3
Environmental a n d
T h i s course is for i n c o m i n g Firstyear stil~lentso r
R i v c r Politics
stucle~itsw l i o are c o n s i ~ l e r i n g;I music major w h o
T h i s course cx,i~ninesthe ~ p o l ~ t ~~cl ;y~nli r ~ n i c s
syntax o f ASL. S t u ~ l e n t sobaer\,r the lemons strati on
woulcl like n b;lsic music thcc~ryfuunclatiun prior to
r c l ~ l t i n gt o o u r I ~ ~ c au~
l ,ban, a w l c:rmpus
Underhill
o f signs, practlce their own signing, ;lnC learn the
beginning their nus sic major. Tliis course is also i ~ ~ r
en\,llonlncnr nncl rel;rr~~>n.\hil,
t k ~the c<~rn~rhunitics
h c i n l expressions nncl hotly language neeclcrl t o
stuclcnts w h o have h a d p r i m expcrlencc in music
ancl ecosystems o f tlie U p p e r M i s s ~ * s i p pW;rtersIiecl
~
communicate clearly w i t h tle;iianil Iharcl-of-hearing
who
WOIIICIlike t o b u ~ l c ul p u n their bas~cn ~ u r i c
people.
theory skills S t ~ l d e n t sw i l l attend one uutsiclc
Pcrspcct~re/Sk~ll/LAF: I n ~ e r c u l ~Au,orcness
~~n~l 2
concert as a grollp.
6.8:30 p m
T, W, TI1
R m : O M 10
I'ersl,ccuvc/SkilI/LAF:
6-9:30
pm
ancl larger, glc~halcnvironlncnt Topics cxpl,,rccl
implicotiona o f o u r claily choices; I<rc;~l\v;lter, i ~ i r ,
a n d soil pollution; the lock a n d clam system on thc
L A F in Fine Arts
7; Th
Km: M U S 5
U p ~ xM
r i s s ~ s s ~ p p~n\.asi\.e
i;
slwcics :~nclhi<l~li\.ersity;
c l i m ; ~ t cclinngc. u~arertrontccc)nomic clc\.elopmcnt;
A S L 101-T
B c g i n n i n g S i g n Languagc I
M U S 241-S
urban aprawl; :lnJ encrhy procluctlun. T h e class \\,ill
A n i n t r < , ~ l u c t i ~ )to
n cle;if culture n n ~the
l signs nnrl
Jazz H i s t o r y
look ; ~ the
t
ch:rllcngc (>fh;rl;~nclng e c o n o ~ n i c
syntax o f ASL. Stuclents observe the Jemonstration
T h i s courae is a stucly o f the musical elements,
Traincr
Milcnkovic
o f signs, practice their o w n signing, and learn the
anrl the lhistor~cal
c t ~ l t u r i lperspectIvcs,
l
facial expressions a n d horly langu:ige neeclerl t o
cle\,elopment u f jazz. M a n y sryles o f jazz arc
communicate clearly w i t h <leaf ancl liarcl-of-hearing
exnminecl i n c l u ~ l i n gearly N e w Orleans D~xielancl,
swing, cool, j a z z / r ~ c k / f ( ~ s i o ~ragti~nc,
i,
bop, a n ~ l
cunten1lJor:lry jazz.
I'erspectit~e/Sk~lI/LAF: Intercult~rrulAuarcnes, 1
<I~n-nnon
T TI1
Alexander/Erickson
atuclents ancl upper Ic\fcl un<lcrgrnclunte stuclcnts i n
Ihcalth a n d stlc~alservices cliscildincs t o explore
Issues rclntecl to aging ;lnd care o f the clrlcrly.
Stuclcnts gain rc;rl \rorlrl cxpcrience by working
coll;~h~,rati\~ely
i n an intercliscil>linary context
Stuclents \\,ill be askecl to :rpply
~I~~~w
and
IcLI~c
skills clirectly w i t h c l ~ l c r su t i l ~ z ~ nan
g experlentin1
Icarning mc,tlcl St~lclcntsw i l l h u i l l l n beginning
expert le\,el k n < ~ a r l e ~ lbase
g e r e ~ r ~ l i issues
ng
that
:affect u l ~ l e rn ~ l u l t si n ctmtemporary health nncl
rocial wcl61rc cuntcxts.
Prcrcrl : Social W u r k , Physiciirn Assistant Stutlies,
or Nursing s t i ~ ~ l e n t z
T 71.
p... . O M IP
~ I e \ ~ l u p ~ ~site> c~~i ;tj ~, l~ s t i c :11icI
e , e11\,iro1111ie11r,rI
s t e u ~ n r ~ l n h111
i l ~the region. There \\,ill he excurslnns
t o site5 ;along tlie river, ~n-cl;lssclch:ites, ancl
oplxwtunity to meet w i t h st:rkehol~lers\\r>rking on
r~ver.rclatc~Iibst~es
SOC I l l - S
Perrpect~t~~'/Sk~lI/UF:
Soc~c~l
World Pcrsl~cculr,C n ~ i n r l
Community and the
M o d e r n Metropolis
T h i n k u ~Sklll, ~rrl<l
L A F I" Soci'11 and Bchut,rorrrl Sclcnce
T h ~ cuursc
s
ex;~minesthe clitierent w;~ysth;rt
Fischcr
sc~ciologist\:~nclurban planners ha\,c \,lewccl citics,
Pcrspec~it,e;L A F 111 Fine Art)
8:30
Rni : SCI 212
T h i s course prcn,iclcs a n opportuniry t&r grarluntr
A n introduction t o c l m t c u l t u r e a n J the signs 2 n d
Perspcct~t'e;mud en^ Lnngrruge I
7; Th
ORK
MODERN LANGUAGES
ASL 1013
B e g i n n i n g S i g n Language
I'erspec~ive/Sk~ll/LAF: Chri>tiuu Ftri~h3 or In~cr~.~tlt;rrr~l
achie\.~ngn nx,re just ancl eqt~itahle\vorlcl! W h a t
Rnb: O M 29
,
Jacobson
lives i n the Turin Cities!
:e 1
wurk will be e\~alu:itell L
y quizzes and exams.
s%
e
A m e r i c a n I n d i a n Spirituality
a n d Philosophical T h o u g h t
US
I
114 sha~ulrlconsult the clepartment. Studen
Prereq.: M P G 2 11nrl a y c ~ ~i
~ rh i g h
I n t m ~ l u c t i o nt o the ilyn;r~n~ca,
history, ancl m ; ~ j o r
W o r l d Politics
'nA7.
Applicd A l g
REL 3 7 0 - S
POL 1603
;es must he completed; may
R m : M US 5
session ll july 9 - august 9,2007
Rooms listed for each course below are subject to change since the printing of this
catalog. Please refer to AugNet Records and Registration for the latest information
on room assignment for a particular class.
t11e1r ~perb
ART 118-S
be anJ i n f v r n i uur
. w e w i l l explore Iici\v
the city can
II~IIII:III
' n : ~ t ~ ~ rhahitat"
;rl
,,i
I>uili
Creativc Drama:
Acting and I m p r o
herween <lift
~prc)tits,nnil
Painting
THR 1 1 6 3
flucncc, \\.it11 a i ~ > c u<>n
s hn\v
c i t ~ c rcan hecorn
1
Fundarncntals o f Staincd Glass
Q
Bollniat~
i l n p r t : l n t conccpts (dpainting. Most cl;lss time is
apcnt painting. Sliclc Iccturcs, ilem(,nstrat~ons,nncl
imagin;lri\.c, and tcchn~c;ilploccsa associnreJ w ~ t h
~ ~ n l m > v i r . l t i onc~ i ,
t i c ~ t i
Tom
CI:irs is t<irmul:itcrl to engake the cre;rtl\,c.
A study (,i
rhc.itric;i
I
I n thls first Ievel p;linrilig course, st~lclcntslenrli
ART 100-S
cr~tiilucscompletc the Ic:lrning experience.
the crc;lrion o t st;~inecl glms prujccrs. T l ~ cunique
P~nixct~~t./Sk~l(/lAF:
Aetlrtio Pmkcli~.lin.;
l A F in FIW Arls
intcr~,lay between conccl,t, clesign, :rnJ liKlit within
6.9:30 I, ln
M, W
11n1 : OM 17
sr.linccl glass Iiirs the ability to inspire our liearta
.I cxl~cricnccsthl~lcntswill gain :In
I ' e r ~ l ~ c c ~ ~ t e / S k ~ l I / lC
WIFI:~Pcnpecr~re,L A F 111 Sol.lcll
(r~~
Rd
e h ~ ~ t ' i oSilencer
n~l
6-9:30 1, m
T, Th
Photography
appliecl to glnrs, li:!ncl torils, anrl orher
The c;lnier;r \+,III be used as I: t<>olfor \,isu:rl
1l11sccll:lneouacnnsulnnhle sul>plics. M ~ n l m t l r nu i
crcati\ziry a n ~cxpresslon
l
using black nncl \vIiite
eight l i ~ ~ u per
r a week outslile
photographic proccrses. Stuclcnrs ~ i c c r;Icceaa
l
tu
3
35mm, s ~ n ~ l c - l e nreflex
s
c:lmer:r. Estimated cust
~i
M, W
6-9:30 11.111.
Rnl.
OM I
I n t r o d u c t i o n t o H u m a n SOCICL~
iilm, ctc.: $200-225.
c<~ntrolthat shalw the clirccrion
Jl~ristiansen
our Il\,cs! H ~ n .Ire
v
the rules ;rncl cxl,ect,ltions o i 3 c ~ l l t ~ or
~ rSeO C I C ~ ~
~lc\~clopecl,
ancl \\,lmr c<,nil~clsus t(> confilm or break
tlie~n! W h a t Iinlcls sociel)' ttigethcr nnrl s,Ii;rt causes
liist<>ricala~iclsucinl
Finr ATO
ART 102-S
Dcsign
Arc thcrc soci:rl inilucnccs hcyoncl our i ~ n ~ n c c l ~ ; i t c
Peril~~'clitc/Sk~Il/'LAF:l1~Ij111)En~fil n:l
M l ~ b r. q ~ ~ ~ r e , n r ~ n r ,
Ae,theuc I'i7.rl~~~l~re,
L A F m FIII~ Art,
1.4.30 p.111.
7; TI1
Ilnl:
Fou Tlicctv~
A sturly oiilcsi.n
Tom
Hln.: O M 4
the visual nrts- Two- ;~nclthree-climension31 projects
ART 2 2 5 3
Graphic Design 1
and principles. Supply fec o i $65.
This course is n n i n r m ~ i t ~ c t ~too the
n principles nncl
Penpccur,JSkill/LAF:
~pcrson;lli ~ l e n t i y ! Wli;lt is U.S. culture like toclay.
14:30 p 111
Aothcrlcr Per.\pecr~re;
Sl,eaklnK
Bowdcn
tccliniclues oigrnphic clesign usina page I;lyout
sr)ttware. E m p l i ; ~ r ~wsi l l be placecl 111- clesirning
M. W
l1m. O M 4
with text and image.
Pc.rspcc~it,e/Sk~II,'LAF: Ae,lhct~rr Pers~c.c~zre;
Spcok~n~
alicl \\*lint arc ~ t sliiatoric;~lr<,ot.r! Tlicsc arc the k ~ n ~ l a
Skill; L A F 111 FIIIC Art,
oiquestions that u.c w ~ l;~cl~lrcss.
l
Put siniply, t l i ~ s
ART 107-S
ct,llrsc Intcrmg.ltcs the nicaning ( > i l i ~ ~ ncxpcrience
~;~n
Drawing
u ~ i r l i i n; ~ n r through
l
aoci:~lgroups and s<,cicty.
Stu~lentsuse tr;lrlition;il meclia t u clevelop technical
Rn.: O M 16
T, Th
clem~instr,~ting
the use ot the h;rsic cleaign elements
Sk~ll;L A F 111 Fme ATIS
M. W
6-9:30 11.1n.
:I> the uniiying f<lunLlnti<,n for
circ~~~nsr:~n
impact
c r s our scnsc oiseli:lncl even our
1-4.30 ~,III
McCartncy
Per~pect~r'e/Sk~ll/LAF:
Aerthelic, I'~.n\,ectirc; L A F 111
soc 121.S
soci:ll c o n t l ~ c t ?How
cl;las time wquirecl.
P e r s p e c u r e / S k ~ l l ~ FL: A F 111 Flne Arls
: SCI 205
ART 1 3 2 4
i111i1 1i111icIs
ill the c ~ ~ \ , i r ~ ~ i ~i li li \V
eIC~
I i t s \rre live,
~pl;~y,
nncl ) m y . S t u ~ l c nI;ib
t k c o i $ l l O will hc
Bolln~an
skills nncl exl,l(>rc clcscr~pt~ve
;and experimental
6-9:30 p m
M, W
Knl.: I'os, ZZH
ART 3 3 0 3
iclcns ior perceptual a~iclc<,nccptual clrawilig.
Graphic Design I1
Emp1i;isis is place~l,117 fc>un~l;~tio~ial
rlrnw~ng
A n ;~<lv;~ncecl
stucly o t Inyour, typography. :~n<l\,isuol
Bowden
COIiCCl>tS.
Illlalery tilr print p r o ~ l u c t i r ~using
n
the co~iiputcr.
Per~l,ec~t~e/SkiIl/LAF: A e \ r l t c ~ eI'erspect~~~e;
~
L A F 111
IncluJes iclentiiication ()i
design ~ i r o h l e ~ n;rnJ
s
Fine Arls
6-9.30 p,nl
~ p r e s e n t a t i to
~ ~tlic
i clic~it.
T, TI
I1m : O M 17
Prcrcq.: A R T 225
6-9:30 1, n~
M, W
C'.
BUS 4 4 0 3
CHFMISTRY
r10ral Imaging
J.
pain:hrurll,
I'rcreq.: Any A
8:30
pencil, pen, .~ncl
prczsion.
COII~III~II~~C:I~
, MIS. or C S C course
11 111 -IIO.,.*
K111: Fur, 22U
Gybcrg
Chemistry f o r Changing T i n i c s
:rnJ \cctorb.
the context o f ntlmcrous acicncc-h;~rccl ~a.rtlc.*
I n <,ur
rel:itions. I t tuliills the Ecluc.~rionL l c l ~ , ~ r t ~ ~ l c n t
Prcrcq.: BUS
c\vrycl:ry I~vcs\r'ith the gn;~l~ >atuclcntt.
f
II:I\.~II~ :I
human rcl;lrion\ :inil M l n n c o r a A111cric:ln 1nili:ln
Insrluctol
h,lsic ~ ~ ~ i ~ l e r a t i( ~~~tllc
ti ~ sl ~c inel~: i ~helii~icl
e
i~sue\
r e q ~ ~ i r c m e nancl
t s i.*:II opticrn \\,ith~nthe liccnaurc
Iprcscnr 2nd i n the filturc.
progr,l m
Prereq.: M P C 2
6 9:30 1, m
Painti1
-Solving f o r Busincss
Isaacson
c ~ n p l i a r i z ~ n~nrli\,lJu;ll
g
cxprcsslon.
This cuursc ap
~rl\,;rncccl.*ofn\f;~rcc;rll;~hilitic.*
Prerrq : A R T 1 18
like m;lcr<,s. SI
ancl Scenario Manager i n
I'~~rspecu~~e/Sklll/LAF~
Ac\rlletir Perspectin
Fdne Arls
Microsoit Exec
6-9:30 11 III
h~~siiiess
t h r o ~ ~rlrc
~ l uze
i
o i rcnl~srichus~ncarc;lscs
OM 17
Prcrcq
L
L A F m N~IIIITCII SCICISCS
8:30
(ILIII.~IOOII
E D C 4901580-S
(111~1MLII~ICIII(IIICI
T, TI1
K111: SC1 212
BUS 2 4 2 3
:
Scrcenwriting
M PC? 3
. SVE 205
Lazaridi
This is n Ihyhricl coursc w ~ t h~n-clnss.*c\alont, : ~ the
t
P.
Cerrito
I~~J*.CI~LV/S~III,~AF.
S*i<ll W(n11 Ih\\*.cl~<v,
W ~ l l l lSkill
l~
Principles o f M a r k e t i n g
8:30
Mcziou
marketing
Legal, ethical, c<,mpetiri\~e,ecc,n<,llllc.
.rncl tcchnol~~gic;rl
t;~ctora as they :~ttectpmcluct,
rc~le,~i
the
price, Iprolnotlun. ;rnJ clistrihut~unclcc~aion.\.
6-9:30 1)
III
M , \Y/
I<>n: O M 13
11111: O M 16
Advertising
1. C e r r i t o
Personnel i u n c t i o ~ In
i business, acquisition 2nd
A n intrc>cluctic,n
stu~lentstrum &tory outline to tlie
creation
Mcziou
scrccnldny cl~;lft.I n aclLlition to \vriting thcir own
,I.*
import:~nt
K- 12 Reading Assessment
The .\tuily c,t stuclcnt rencli11gclevclopmcnt, the
knou.lc~lgenncl usc ofgntllerinl:
cliscus*ic~no i nesthetic.*, cr;lit, ;and ft>rm.
of stu~lenrs'~ e : ~ c l ~ n
:lnJ
g , clesigning : ~ ~ ~ p r o p r i : ~ t e
July 7, 8, 28, 11nc129 10 < I , ~-6
I pm
llm : O M 18
intercultural C o n l m u n i c a t i o n
with the gn;rlz o f the i ~ r mnnrl soclcty.
:lnJ h:incls<,n I r : ~ r n i n gtc>ols.
Prcrcq
6-9.30
6-9:30 1,
111
T. Tb
Rrn : SVE I
Lpakko
~ m p l i c a t ~ u nfor
s communlcatl<ln, ~ n c l u c l ~ n g
Kt11: O M I 3
cuursc is rcqu~rccltbr stuclcnts oht:linlnu thcir K-I2
C<~rcq.:E D C 510
This course explores c u l t l ~ r : ~
~liiierenccs
l
;lnJ their
TI1
Cllnicnl rxpcllcncc 11~1urh\v11I he ~ n c l u ~ l c iTl h c
Rc.lcling Tc.~chcr ILiccnzurc E n ~ l o r s c n ~ c n t .
COM 3293
clcmcnra I n moclc~n m ; ~ r k c t ~ n:lnd
g
T
; ~ n r .l ~ n n l y i ~ nclot.r
g
re,~cl~ng
curriculum hnrecl o n this inforrn:rtion.
com~nunicat~rlnsThis ccnlr>c conlhines classroom
p III
Jacobson
~ i \ , ~ n~letailecl
g
critical analysis :~nclc11u:iging I n
relat~onshil>s;cifecti\,e integr;rtiun o i thc worker
BUS 242 rrr consent o f instructor
EDC 508-S
analyze work jr.1 Ittcn hy each mcmhcr o f thc cl;r\s.
~ ~ r i l i z a t i oof
n l i u m : ~ nresources; clesirahlc working
:
RI~I . SVE 2
scriptr, stu<lcnts will re\,ic\v feature f ~ l l n s.lnJ
print, brt,;l~lcazr,;anJ Wcb-
hnsecl a~l\.ert~aing
.~nclprorn(,tion
M, W
<I.III- t ~ c , w ,
of 3
Prcrcrl.: E N L 220 or 221
MKT 3 5 7 3
BUS 3 4 0 3
[)cl1:11tlnent
coursc i n writing l i ~ film,
r
this courac will t:lkc
( > ~ g a n i ~ ; l r ~srafilng,
on,
plnnning, ;incl control. T h e
professional Iilnnnjier
I'rerecl.: PPST :lnJ nclm~hsionto the Eclucnri~>n
online acti\,~t~esi n henrjeen. Air intrucluctory
Prunc~plcso f h;~aic~pollcynncl >tr;ltehy iasucs i n
nature ot authority, accountnhilily, nncl
;I.;
f ~ n a lthet,rctic:~l ~p~el>:rr;~rion
k , ~htudcnt tc:rchina
MKT 2 5 2 3
De\,elupment o i the tlieory o f manncement,
H u m a n Resourcc Management
Erickson
o n ~ p ~ not\,ic\v
ts
.~h<,utthe rc,lc n i
E~nl>li;is~&
Ic:lclc~ahil, .lncl prc>fcba~<~n.~l
clcvclr~p~iicnt,
Scr\,c\
COMENL3283
h e c i n n ~ n g:rnrl c<,nclu.*~c~n
<>f
r h ~ acourse, ancl
M, W
School a n d Society
&chor\li n m o r l c r ~ocicry,
i
rclat~,,llrIiil~s\ v ~ t h
other simul:~tionanil
KIII
6-9:30 11 rn
1<111: SVE I
~ p : ~ r u i t s a nct>mmunity,
il
cc>ll.~b~>r;~ri\c
~noclcla,
:
I ~ the
M , \V
l'cr~\~cc~~~~c/Sk~ll/LAF.
NOIIL~C~I
W,,TICI 2 l'en\~ec~~rc;
AJVZ ucly i n ncryl~co r o i l p ; ~ i n t~necli:~
responsihiliry; ;~nalysisC
Grcsczyk
This cour>c cs;rmines 1i11nr:lncli\,errir) :lnJ 1111rn:ln
:
Principles o f Managelnentz
DivcrsityA4inncsota American lndians
This courac i n t r < ~ ~ l u chnslc
c s clicm~stryconcepts i n
SVE 206
ART
EDC 2061566-S
CHM 1 0 0 - B
st \fis~1;11
i111,1ges u5i11g
Explor;rt~unot rhe creal
the colnpute
~crrito
cliffcrences I n \,nlues, norlns, soci:ll illter:~ction,:lncl
coJc systelns.
l14ly 5-10
8 ,I111.-3p 111
1111s11-17
8 <I
I:IOOI
KIIL : SVE 1
Hnnunhce
Elemcnu~r~
Schr,ul
PL'~S~CCL~I~C/S~II~/LAF:
I ~ ~ t c r c ~ ~Auclrcnerr
l~unll I
Penllucli~e
6.9.30 11.m.
P~erctl.: ELIC 505, EEI) 520, ESE 500 or conacnt
01 ilist~ ~ c t o r
M, W
lt111: L I N 16
,y,
sess Iot1
SPE 4241524-S
Jacobson
SPE 4 3 4 1 5 3 4 3
Etiology a n d O r i g i n
o f Learning D i s a b i l i
Tcaching C o n t c n t Arcas to
Studcnts W i t h L c a r n i n g Disabilitics
Staff
T h ~ scourse w i l l rcncli stuclenrs to iclcnt~ty,:1~1:1pt;rncl
I l i a i ~ i c l ~ ~;II~
~ l i~~.cleptl>
es
ENL 2 2 6 3
I n t r o d u c t i o n t o Creative W r i t i n g
Reiniringcr
implement clcvcl<~l>~ncnt;rIlg
apl)rt,prlate inatruct~cjn
i g ~ l ~ s a h ~ l ~ t as
i c .\veil
; , nr
th;rt suplwrt tlic 1e;rrnlng oistuclents ~rlcntiheclSI;
h a v ~ n gIcnrning r l i s ; ~ h i l ~ t ~ cT\h. e cuursc \vlII
spccificnlly toeus 011the arms o f rencl~ng,w r i t ~ n gn ~ i c l
$00, or
lulv 18-31
8
(4 rn
ALIPLI~~
14
8
(1
.lu,un
Prcreq.: ENI. I l l or 112 or t l O N I 1 I
~>rc~hlem-sol\,i~ig
sk~lls. Tlierc \vlII he n str(>ng il>cur
Perspcct,~r%\'k~ll/LAF:Ae,uhcr~csPcn\>eclwc;Wn~irrgSk~ll
on the mr>clif~c;~t~<,na
~nvol\.ccli n tlicsc areas :rncl the
1-4:30 p.m.
R~I.:'
~n-3p.111
~
Rm.: SVE 2
~
8:30
~
'1.111
-11oon
~
~
,
~ I<III:
SVE
b
206 ~
Elementary Education E a r t h Sc/
Stangl
1
This a ~ u r s cis clca~gncclfor clcmcnr,~rycclucnti~>n
~ n i i ~ jia~i~l
~ r s inclu~lesart11 science " I i i ~ n ~ l s - ~ n "
~nrluiry-h~aerl
:~cti\'iticsthnt m r ~ d e the
l
te;lcIi~nganrl
learning process o i s c ~ e l i t i i i cInrlulry. Meets bnsic
eiirtIi SCICIICC
s ~ ~ b j rmatter
ct
.*tnnrlar~lsk,r ~ n ~ t i n l
I~cc~ist~re.
6-9:30 11.n1.
M, W
Rln.: SCI 19
Etiology and O r i g i n s
o f Learning Disabilitics
Kclley
This course will focus un the li~srory;and context ~i
I c n r n ~ n gcl~sahilirics(LD). This incluclcs :In ~n<lcl>tli
look :it the origin o t Ienrnlng dis;ihilities. S
I: \\,ell
V:I
SI;
ious thcorerical moclcls (sc,ci<,loylcnl, hioloaie:il,
psych~~logic;rl,
cognitive, nil beliaviornl) :ippliecl to
u n ~ l e r s t : ~ n c l ~Ic;~rning
ng
rl~s;~bilities.T l i e course \\,ill
also provicle a critique o f current p h ~ l ~ , s ~ ~ p l i ~ c : i l
pc'sirlons I n the h c l ~ l . St~ltlentswill also ncquirc
ESE 4 9 5 3
~
H
~
kno\\,leclge rclateil t ~ Erccesslng
,
~ n i < ~ r m n t i rele\,:rnt
nn
~~~~~~~~h~
~ ~ i ,
~
~p e t~
c~
r s o n ~:c p p to tlie i i e l ~~
l I m)
r ni
i n g clisab~ltties.
Tliis cuursc is clcs~ancrlS
I: an ~ntrn<lucriolito the
6.9'30 Illn
T. TI1
principal concepts, aplironches, ancl pcrsl,cctivcs ~ > i
SPE 4241524-R
the sturly nige~ljir:lpliyt h r o i ~ g l irhc exn~l~in;rtlon
of
Etiology and O r i g i n s
world gc(,grnl>liic pzlttcrns ; ~ n r lprocesses. M:~jor
o f Learning Disabilities
JcnscnISmith
topics i ~ ~ c l u~~pl o
c p ~ ~ l a Jt i~~s) tl ri i h u t ~ ( cc~ltural
l~i,
Tliis course will f<>cuso n the history ;~nclcontext 11i
cIi~~r,~cteristics
ancl ce~ltc~r:rl
I:~~i~Isc;i~
po
~ le~st ,i c a l
Ienrn~ngrllsah~l~tiea
( L I I ) . This inclucler :In i n l l e p t l i
~ n t c g ~ a t i oand
n clisintegrntion, ecc~no~nic
InnJ use,
look at the w i g i n o t learning disabilities, ;is well as
settlements nncl urhnni2;rrlon. This cuursc w i l l meet
various tlieureticnl 1110~1e1s
(sociol~g~cnl,
hiologicnl.
the M N St:~n~larcls
o f Eifecti\,c Practlce ~n
~psycliologic:~l,
c(>gniti\,c, nncl helin\,ior;~l) npplicJ to
Gcogrnphy for micl~llcrcliool nn'l high scli<,crl social
~ ~ n c l c r s t a n r l ~learning
ng
~l~s;rhil~ties.
The course will
\ t u ~ l i c sI~censt~re.
also provicle a critique ot currcnt p h i l o s ~ ~ p l i i c ~ ~ l
6-9:30 11,m
T. TI1
Rln. L I N 16
pobitions i n the i i e l ~ l . St~lclcntsw ~ l ;~lso
l
;~ccluirc
ENL 2 2 7 3
Jorgcnscn
cn~pli:lais(>nw r i t ~ n gt<>rhro:lrlcaar nncl onlhnc mecl~;r.
Staff
S t ~ t r l c ~ i use
t s nn ~ n t e n s i \ v~pr;rcticemc~clelto learn
Tliia course \\*ill tcncli stuilcnrs to iclcntih, adapt,
tlic h:isicb o f ~~e\\,sgntlieri~ig.
~ r i t i n g 2nd
,
prorluct~on
. i ~ i c Iiml~lcrncnr~ l c \ ~ c l o l ~ m e n t na1>1m?~ri:1tc
lly
ic>r telcviaion, r n ~ l i o nnil
,
tlic Internet.
instructi(>n that support the learning ( > i s t ~ ~ c l e n t \
Prcrerl.: E N L I1I or 112, o r HON I I 1
iclcliti ficcl ;I> I i ; r v ~ ~licg; r r ~ i ~ ~ li g
i s ; i l ~ i l i tT~hce~course
~
Pcr.,l,ccuti./Skill/LAF:
CII? I'crrpecure; W~IIIIIR S k ~ l l
w ~ l sl>cciticnlly
l
tc,cus <In the nrens o i rcncling, writing
Rln.: SVE 205
: i n J libtening comprcliena~on.m;lth, re;rsnninK, 311'1
Ipr(,hlcn~-sol\,~na
sk~lls. There will he n strong iclcus
<In tlic mc~cliiic:itionsin\rolveJ i n these :lrens ;inJ the
6.9:30 p.m
ENLICOM 3283
Screcnwriting
Lazaridi
This is n hyhricl courae w i t h in-cl:~sssesrlulis nr the
process invol\,ecl.
M, W
Rtu :
SVE 2
h c g i n n ~ n; ~ nconclus~on
~l
o f this course, nncl online
acti\.~tiesi n hct\rzeen. An intr~>clucrory
course i n
writing for film, this coursc will take .;tu~lcnts i r u n
SPE 4341534-R
I<tn : O M 16
1<1n: SVE 206
An introcluctr,ry nc\r,s\\,rit~ngcoursc w i t h :In
Tcaching C o n t e n t Arcas t o
Studcnts W i t h L c a r n i n g Disabilities
SPE 4241524-T
I
M, W
Journalism
~
SPE 4341534-T
--- - - - -
:lncl creat1t.c pr<>ac.
Ilstcning coniprelicnsio~i,1n.lt11, rcasoliing. :and
Tcaching C o n t e n t Areas t o
Students W i t h L c a r n i n g Disabilitics
stol.y o e ~ t l ~ ntoe the creation o f n scrcenl>lay <lr;rit. I n
Olson
a d r l i t ~ o nto w r ~ t i n xtheir mrrn scripts, stu~lcntswill
Thls course will teach st~~clents
to i ~ l e n t i 6 :ic1:1pt
,
:~ncl
i r n l ~ l u ~ i u~lcvclopment;rlly
it
npproprintc instructi(>n
tli:it support the learning elf atuilents ~ c l e n t ~ l i e3s
<l
having learn~ng~lis;rh~l~ries.
T l i e coursc rvill
c ~ a t t nncl
,
hr~n.
sl>cc~t~cnlly
tocus on the arcns o i rc.ltling, writing : ~ n t l
Prercq.: E N L 220 or 221
listening comprclicnsion, m;rtIi, reasoning, nncl
]MI? 7.
~pn,blc~n-sol\~~lig
akills. There w ~ l Ihc
l n strong h c u s
c>n the mocliticatiolis involvccl i n tlicsc :rrc:ls and the
planning Iproceas i n w l v c ~ l .
5:30-9 p.ln
M , TI1
I<ochc~~cr
CLII~I
8.28, alul 29 10 ( 1 m 6 D m
1<111,: O M I 8
ML 580-S
Ulson
c(>mmun~cntecle:rrly with <leaf nncl hard-oi-liear~ng
~wol>le
C o l l o q u i u m o f Contemporary
T h c o r i c s i n Leadership
Link
T l i ~ sdccclcrntcJ cmlrac 1s an ~mmersionclass that
oilers
;iaclccti~>n
o
i Ie:~clerahipthe<>riesi n class plus
cx;~ml>lcs<>i.rl,l?lic.rt~onthrough rite viaits Sturlents
chc,osc n Icaclcr tor ~n-clcpthst~lcly;lncl ~p~eacntation
prclecl : ASL 101
Pcr,\>cc~i~,c/Skill/LAF:In~crcultlm~l
Auorcness 3
Prrspectir,~;Modern Lulgllt~ge2
T, W, TI1
Knl : SCI 212
B e g i n n i n g Sign Language 11
Trainer
6 8:30 1) m
This course has :In <>n-linecolnponcnr Successil~l
> n , nceila, or 1 ~ 1 o~f ~ s
the ct)nrtitl~cncy
aol>lc, erg,
OF~.C.IIPI
Spulibor an<[ 1 - 0 1 O l r o n i n the Centel- for
e.
;~aaign~ncnts
klcilb On . ~ l ) l ? l i ~ , ~ 01
t i oc(111rse
~i
Cwk, ,lncl Learning rcgnrcl~nl:rcqulrementa
P-
tlic orc;~nir;~tlc,j,,
kno\\,lc~l:.c. ~ ~ n J c r s t a n c lhi
in~
\rr~rkpl.rcc,nncl ;an .~\v.~rcncs\
o i a ~ ) c ~ c t lasues
nl
that
r
I&S
c o ~ n l ~ l c t ~oof nthe course t l ~ l t ~ lwnc
l s c > i the pnl,cr
n crnsliip. Students must cc>nsult n r l t ~ i
c o l i i l i i u n ~ & ~ ~ r c rcqulrc~,m t e c t i o n
m;ly .ltfcct the u.r>rkpl;rcc, Stuclenrs
,tl~IIent
'W
hns.ani~/<,r
-
-
I
-
I ~ ~ r ~ ~. -i i s aregister.
~
P/N graclinc only.
Sntist;lerc~ry co117
" h ~ l i l l the
l Augshure
,IIILI
#LC
Exl>cricncegr;icl
~irel~le~lt.
~ p e r l n ~ s s ito
o l ~rc;i\tcr.
ML 520-S
Sclf-Identity, Values, a n d
Personal G r o w t h
L i f c t i m c Activity:
Fitness W a l k i n g (0.0 credit)
clapp
Prcrcq : 6 M A L c<,urscr
Jul) 9. 11, 17, 6-10 p tn ,July 14, 8
synt;m of ASL Stuclenn obsenv the clcmonstrntion o f
(I 111 -n,xn),
RI,I,
11,1> 18, 6-9 p 111
<,;(
nll,v 11111,CC
T ~ I cc,urrc
*
l o r ~ k s,it rlic cc>nccpt o f uni\,c~-s;ll
Lashbrook
r
ii N I I I
t
Knufman
S t k l ~ l c n \t v ~ l ~
l a r t ~ c ~ l >i inl t;Ichcrlc\ o f a c ~ i i ~ ~ i n r
i s
n ~ > l ? l y a~ ~hisi gto^ ic;ll Ipcr\l)ectl\8e
al'enking, reading, ;and writing o f elemental y
I I ~ ~ ~ ~ I ~
~ It n~icl
,~ K L\r,h;rr
~
~t can rencli you ; ~ h n ~YOIII.
lt
1 I
soc~oec<,nomic
forming Intcll,crst~n:~lr c l ; ~ t i ( ~ n s l ~with
il>s
explc~reyour \,lsl(>nsh r the future ;IIC~ I10\\, to 111:lke
~~c~s<,ns,'c)r~an~:atio
in1111
~ i a a n o t h e ~culture; nncl
~IICIIIr c . ~ l i ~ M
) ' .i j c j r n a a ~ g ~ i ~ ~\YIII
~ e be
~ i t.IsIlk btory,
I o o k ~ n g:lt
l ~ i crnol', .~nclonline journaliny. Cclursc in\,<,l\,c\ ;I
(>f\,ocatic~n,
helicirysrcln, ancl uni\,crsal
three-hour nricnr;rt~<~n,
nr,c~-~l;~y
retreat, online
Ic;lrninl:, .~nclfi~ll-cl:lgclos~ngsca.rli,n, Scp;lr,lte n,om
"'"hO'll\l
Moo , JILI?9. 69:30 p.111, ~111<l\;I[.. AII~~UI11, 9 <l.m4 ~ ~ r n
CIIII~IIB*IZC
s c l e c t i ~that
~ i ~ 11~111\~II(ICI~IS
to th111k
(ICLYHLI?
WA>IIJII
""
~/II(IIIIIIIU
TILS)
RI~I: CLII~II~Rln, CC
critlc:rlly, u ~ r c l c ~ ~ rt~lnclcas
n n ~ l icle;ls, libten c a r c i ~ ~ l l y ,
.~litl~p~otession;iI
gc>als~n terms
I~CYSOII~~
T
111
TI1
.
A
OD
A
A S L 102-S
ML 5 3 0 3
cclucation, .;oci;~laclcncc, ;lnd I:lng~l:~gc
;art5 m:ljors.
Ethics ill C o m n l u n i c a t i o n
T h ~ ccollrrc may XIS,>
he r:rkcn &)r gr.~clu:ltc crcrl~t.
Tlir<rugIi the in\,cstig;~t~on
o f a variety ~,fetliic~~l
syntax c l i ASI..
For rcgl*tr;rtlon c<>nt;lctA n n c K:ruinl:ln (612-330-
~pcr\lwcti\ca.this cc,llrse i c ~ c u s con the use ;lnJ
o t 51:ns. ~practicctlicll oir.11.;ign~ng.and Ic;rrn the
B c g i n n i l i g Sign Language I1
I I 8 8 or ~ ; I ~ I ~ I ~ : I ~ @ ~ ~ ' ; I ~ I ~ S I ~ I I ~ ~ . ~ Lnhr~se
I I I ) ~c>ic<>1nrnun1c:lrio11
i n 1)11I1ties,ail\,crtib~~ig,
.4 11.n1.
(I !II
11111: OM 29
~ ~ i t c ~ ~ ~ ercl;~ti~,n.*liil,s,
~ s < i n a l nncl s,,ci:~l an'l
o r g , ~ n ~ z , r t ~ rctt~ngs.
r~~i;~l
6-9:30
11.111.
T, TI1
RIII,.
OM 10
Steinnletz
~
Sl>nnlsIi. I n t ~ o ~ l u c t l oton the c u l t u ~ eo f tlie Spanisli-
Pers~ccti~,l./Sk~ll/LAF:Inr~.rcultun~l
Au,ure~~e>s
3
I'enbec~i~,e;
Modern Languns 2
8:30-11
'
In
7; W, TI1
Rm : O M 26
SPA 1 1 2 7
r e \ l x ~ n s ~ l > ~; l~i t ynclohal
~l
cnnncctcclncs.
6 9.30 1,
ancl qucstir~nt h ~ r u g l i t i i ~ l lTliia
y
cr,tlrac ia iclcal k,r
Lapakko
i
s p m k i n ~mirlcl
i l c \ c l c > l ~ ~a ~
n i ign t c r ~ l i a c i p l i ~ i : r r y / ~ ~ i t c r ~ ~ ~ r c ~ i c s s ~ i ~ ~ i ; i l
Prcrcq.: SPA 111
;~l,~r<lncli
to ~p~cthleln
\ol\.ing :uncl \,aluc n\rralcness;
c:illhng .rnd living o n ;~uthcnticlitc. YOI \\,ill alsu
cliscus\~onli~llc,\\wng the P a ~ c l c selnin.lr
~:~
torm:it 3s
3
Tlu, ~.o~tr,rr t ~ lhr
l held /rrm J~rly30-A1lg11\[
I1n1: O M 25
Ai111s to clevelop four hasic skills: i ~ n d e r s r n n ~ l i n c ,
arc ~..lllc~lto Jw ;lnrl h ~ \ \Y,W c;ln
~levclolieclhy M w t ~ ~ n Acller.
er
Sc~n~nn
tol,~cs
r
8:30
M , T, W
uccks i n N~cnr;i:u:~ C o u ~ s c<>hjccti\.csincluclc:
YLILI
exl>h?reyoilr ow11 I~tc-the i;ict<,ra th:~th:lvc
Paidcia S e n ~ i n a r s
I'erspectir~c; Modern Lon~t~ogc
2
6.8:30 1) m
tliat clccpcns your u n c l c r a t a ~ i c l i ~
I iI~\\,lie
~
you ;arc,
\\hat
I I
rllscil>line I n Nic.ir;lgu;~.rnrl thc U n l t e ~Sr.rtcs;
l
INS 2553
ASI. 101
SPA 1 1 2 . ~
~
~
span& 11~
iI
\oil1 he ahlc t ~i~nclcr.mncl
>
ancl ~ l c m o n s t ~ - . h;~aic
~tc
11111,: MUL 206
:
Perspect~c~e/Skill/LAF: Intercultun~lAwnrcncss 3
history [,iU S relntio~is This cotllse includes two
ancl prt~t;.ss~(>n;~lly.
To iillilll tIi:lt Ipurposc you will
T, TIl
Prcrcq
The ~ p u r l x ~ or ci this courrc ib to txcilir;irc r c i l c c t l o l ~
~ i r o l > l c ~ nco~iiparing
s;
the stt~clenr'spnrticula~
6-7.45 11.n1.
exprcsions nncl Lrnly language necrlctl to communicate
r c ~ ~ x ~ n s;ind
~ hc ~
l o lh ~; ~tc(>~incctcrlncss
l~
rlir(luali the
a u t l ~ c ~ ~ t i ccontrihute
~lly
:lncl grow hotli l>crson.llly
;and rules ,,i the :ncri\wty.
sl:ns, plnctlcc their o\r8nsigning, n n ~Ile a ~ nthe hcinl
clc:~rlywith cleoi:lnrl Iharrk>f-hearing people.
it^^,^^^ ~~~i~~~
cour.rc,\
~~~~~~~~l
[(,Iml,ro\,e
prL,iicicncy
in a sclcctcil
pl,yaic:llnctl,,ir): Stuclcl,ts
s k ~ l l rsrr.ltc:T
,
A S L 102-T
A n introcluctlon to ~ l e a t c u l n ~ nncl
r e tlie signs and
Topics: T h c U n i t c d Statcs, G l o b a l
Connections, a n d U n i v e r s a l Responsibility:
A Nicaraguan Perspcctivc
Bidinger
ncl get
HPE 1 0 2 3
B
ML 599-S
\ritIi I.i,is OI,~II 111 rIic Center, ; ti,r
:>;&s
2nd lLc;~rn~ng
regarcling rcqwrcmc
~ c ~ l ~ ~ ~ ~ ctor
~iM
i c An Lt .Plan
\
Mikkelsoll
A n Introrlucti,,n
tc, <lea(
cultllrc;lncl
nnil
Scr~clenthohserve the ~ l c ~ n o n b r r n t i o n
h c i a l cxl>rciai~>ns
;inJ lhocly Inngu;~:.e necclecl to
B e g i n n i n g Spanish I1
Steinmetz
Aims to ~ l c \ ' c l t ~four
p bns~cskills: unrlcrstnniling,
apcnking, rencling, and writing ()i
elementary
Sp;rnlsIi I n t r ~ ~ ~ l u cto
t ~ the
c ~ nc u l t i ~ r co f the Spanishspeaking a n ~ l c l .
Prcrcq.: SPA II I
-> ,
w
Pcnpec~i~~c/Skill/LAF.Il~[crculrr~rr~l
A~wrrcncss3
I'cr~llcc~n'e;
Morlerrl L l n ~ l u ~ g2e
68:30 1, tn
T W,TI1
l1m : O M 26
~
i
sesslor
I'cnl~ecrit~e/Sk~ll/LAI:: Soc1<11
World I'cr\l~ccur,c,
.nus
F
NUR 5 6 2 1 W S T 362-Sr
1600s
Holroyd
,111~1 Sel~or~~onzl
SCICICC
L A F 111 Sucl<~l
.
I-4:30 11 >II
7;Th
l<n~.OM16
W a l k i n g t l i e Truth: r
Culture, Gcndcr. a n ~ ; H I \ / / A I U b
i n Sub-Sahara1
HailongaLeuning
W a l k i n g thc Truth: Culture,
Gcnder, and H I V I A I D S
in Sub-Saliann A f r i c a
Hailonga/L.cu~iing
ica
l i e
1,
Suh-S;ili;~r
tlmc
HI*
T l ~ cnatural
t l u c ~ i c co i
+~ncle~iitc
in
%,ioloky,
REL 2 0 0 3
T l i ~ sh n ~ a ~ l - h : l scourse
c~l
cxpl<,rc\ the ~ n f l u e n c c
C h r i s t i a n V o c a t i o ~ and
i
the
Search f o r M e a n i n g 11
o i c u l t u r e and g c n ~ l eo~n tlie t l l V / A I I I S
Q u a ~ i b c c kI1
Thib course i(>cuscson .irticulntlng stu~lents'
cn\,n tlieolc>gicnl ~ ~ u c x ~alicl
~ i pcts~tions
~ i s
;)nil
once?
~ ' e r s ~ ~ c u i ~ e , ~ . ~ kL~Al lF/ ~
111~F~ne
F . Arrr
T. Th
6-9:30 11.n~
M U S 220-S
Worlds o f M u s i c
ilenkovic
A sur\,ey o i lion-Western ~ i i u s ~ c . i l
Europe, A t r ~ c ; ~
:inJ
, Asin \\,ill he covereil (luring this
c,>11r1Ic.
Perspec~~vc/Sk~ll/LAF:Aorhcucs or lnrcri.~tlutn~l
L A F 111 FII~CArt5
Auoreiles5 I Pcr~pcst~t,~.;
T Th
MUS4963
Topics: JazzIContcmporary
Music Thcory
\.olvccl i n curbing the crlbis.
un~lerlyingcultur.ll belieis, \,.llues, ancl trn~litions
flint hot11 p r o ~ l i ~ i.rnd
t c Ih~nclcrthe prcacl
~ n u s i ccultc~rcro i N o r r l 1 nnil ~ c , u t ~ r A n i c r i c n .
8:30 ':.t,b.-nuon
i n tlic ;i~e.isc ~ h~hllc:ll
t
intcrprctat~onnncl rlic
11111.: M U S
HIV
u , i t h ~ nAiric:ln l ~ o p ~ ~ l , ~ t iTul i~ci scc>Llrse
.
is 1 : 1 ~ 1 ~I n
llt
Milc~ikovic
Ii~stc,r~cnl.
cultur:il. : ~ n dglc>h,il contest5 o t
tlieoluglcal, n n J ~polit~cnl
response* to the
clise;lre :ire c s : l m i ~ i c dt l i r c ~ ~ ~rc;~rl~ngs.
gli
atructurcil tli;ilog, and >crr.~cc-lc:irl~~ng
C1iristi:lnir). ;~nclother uorlcl ~ e l i g i < ~ ~ i s .
eupcrlence \\,it11 ~pcrsolisacti\fcly invol\zecl i n
E\;llu;lt~on hy qu~zzcso n , and rcalx>nt.csto
curbing the crisib. Critical reflection on tlic
r c n c l ~ n ~;ind
s , kwr tlicol~rgicnl position Iyapers,
u ~ i c q t ~~; n~ilc c t i o nrates hewccn \rromcn ;~ncl
P ~ c ~ c i lR
. :E L 100
8:30
'I 11) .noon
liicli In Airled illll~lii~i:ltcs
11lidcrIy111g
~11Itllr.1I
T Ti
KIII : SVE 2
h r l i c h . r:iluc\, .ind traJitiona th:rt I>c~tli
N;~mihl;ii n coll.lhorntic~n\\'it11 iqiculr).ancl 5t:ltt trc>m
promorc ;inrl liinclcr the sprc.i~lot H I V \r4tliin
Aushurg's Ccntcr tor C;lr>h;rl E c l r ~ r . ~ t ~nonn~the
l
Atrican 1po1>t11ati<)1it..
T l i c ccnIrsc
Univcra~tyot Namih~n.I n this crlntmt. \r,<>~ncn'a
\r,itli klculr). 2nd srait
N:lliiibin ill c~>ll:~hc)~nt~<,n
15 tiluglit
111
Iic.iltli o i t l i c ~ rk i ~ i i ~ l i ;inJ
r a comrnunlrlc, are
SWK 6993
Asscssmcnt a n d Diagnosis
in M e n t a l H c a l t h Practice
SI:
Ihopetul ;and po*iti\.e re\pr>n\es tc, the
lhiglil~glite~l
Tliis
H I V / A I D S crisis i n Sub-Snli:~r;inAiric;i. (Fuliills the
~ p s y c h ~ r l ~ a t l i ancl
o l r , ~tlic r<>lc~ ) i s o c i n \\.urkcrs
l
prcselvc rlic health o i t l i c ~ ri.~milies.lnil
i
licoltli
I n assessment ;and cliqnosis (lment;ll
c o ~ i i ~ n t ~ n ~are
t i eliiglil~glitecl
a
ns I h o l ~ c i t and
~l
ctlllcctivc ancl i n ~ l l v i ~ l u ciiorts
;ll
to Ipmscr\,c tlie
l1m.: M U S 3
p;~nilem~
i nc SubS:lhnr;in Airica. T h e natural
liist<,ry, hioloky. :~nclc l > ~ c l c ~ n i o l tof
> ~AyI D S I n
A i r ~ c n S.I: \vcll ;is roc~<>cultur,ll,ct1iic:ll.
<,n rccogn~:ing : i n J e\.:llu;~ting~cligiousclaims
m
~NNII).
WST 362NUR 5623
gl<>hnlcxl>cricncc r c r l t ~ i r e ~ i i e~nLtI I
.i~ i i : i j o01~
min(>r
ib
i r o m Augrhurg's Ccntcr tor Glohal Ecluc.ltinn
BoisenISyers
n~iclthe Cln~vcrs~ry
<,tNa~lilh~ii.
111r l i ~ sco~itext,
women'* collecti\~cnlicl i n ~ l i v i ~ l u c: i il i o ~
ts to
an clcct~\,ccuursc wlrich cxl,lorcs
~wuti\zercspc>nacst u t l ~ eHIV/AILIS criais i n
This course \\,III ~ n c l u d cthe stllrly oih.~,~cj;izz
i n Women's Stuclle\ i n Augshurg'h (:<ire
In
lhnr~iiony.We \\.ill cliscuss n clioril-acnlc theory,
Curriculum). For cleraila contnct Sh,lron W;iclc i n
cx:llnl lies ~ ~ s y c l i ~ ~ p . i t l :II~LI
i ~ i l o~nent:rl
~y
Suh-S;~Ii:~r.ln
A i r ~ c : ~(Fuli~llt.
.
the gl~1'1l
covcrinl: major acalc hnl-mony/cli~~rcl
rcnlcs, tonic
the N u ~ s ~ nDcl>;ilVtmcnt:
g
612-330-1214 o r
clisorclert. trim n systc~iis,ccolo~ic:ll.;~ncl
cspcrlencc rcclulrcmcnt tor n 111njorclr ~ l i i n o r
\r~3de'i@3i111l:sh~rg.e~lu.
s t ~ c n g t l i \~peral>ccti\,c. Empli.lsi~it. 1p1:lcecl on
I n Women's S t ~ ~ c l ~
i l lc AugshurKSs
s
Cole
D<lter:l ~ r l y5-22. 2007
unclcratan~lingh i ~ ~ l ~ ~ ~ c l i 1 1i 1~ 1i 0
t l~~1ca ~I 011
ice~
C u r r i c u l u ~ n ) For
.
clct:lils contact Shnrc>n W:i<lc
wl1<,le-tonc x n l c li:r~mc)ny. \saric)l~se h ~ ~ r ~ I - ~ ciliri ~ l e s
tlie lirimnry clc>min:lnt 7th cliorcl, h;xbic ~nocl:ll
cycle
hubs :rncl,
i t tiliie p r r ~ i i i t s ,tonic .wstc~iis.
\ v ~ t l Iv(>l>cr
i
use (11c l i ~ ~ raymhc~l
cl
nor,ltlon a11d
;ivariety
~ ~ i s c r \ ' l csettin:..
c
T h e cclursc
the mc>st
rhc inciclcncc ;and cc>ursc ,>i
I n the Nursing L)cl>;~rt~iicnt:
612-130-1214 o r
c ~ ) r n ~ i i < ~~prc\cntccl
nly
~ i i c n t ; cl~sorclerr
~l
;inJ the
\\,dclca@nugt.hurgcclu.
clilicrcntial cttcct 111 thcsc 1;lctors on kI~\,crx
D(:tcs. 1111y5-22. 2007
s~te
1 ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ 1,l ~: ribk
ti t 1 ~Thih
1 1 i is
~ :I ~ p r c r c q ~ ~ i lor
r~,
Fee,: SI.220 m ~I~~IIIUII 10 11(111011( ~ i i d( ~ i r k ~Fee)
SWK 627 F;lmily Pr.lcticc Elccrlvc: Mental
l,l~lt,~Ic!I O ~ I ~ , ,,110>r
, ~ , 1l,Cl:l.,,
.I>
tlcaltli Pr.lcticc, :~ncl15 strongly cncul~r;~gcrl
rnlnrllvrrdrlun t1'1t1ut1
thc solmrq
al>plic.itiii~i< > tclio~~l.scnlc
thc,,ry ancl g u ~ r l ct<,~ics.
POL 1 2 1 3
lprcl>;rr;1tio11tor tlic ht.11~l i c c ~ i ~ ies:r~ii.
~ig
Ear t r a l n l n ~cxcrci\cs u.111be c<n,crccl.
I n t r o d u c t i o n to
6-9:30 11 111
Prcrcil.: MClS 101 cir cqui\vlent
American Govcrnrnc~it
Aoki
E x ; ~ ~ i i i n c~\n ; ~ j o
~parrs
r
o f A ~ i i e r ~ c an.~tional
n
L A 1 111 FIIIC Art5
A ~ ~ ~ I T c III ~Perrl~ec~~r~e;
,~
8:30 n.111 -nonu
M. \V
I<,,:
MUS 3
g0\~~111iie11r
11iclu~1111::
Cwrgrca\, tlic ~prcs~clcncy,
;rnJ
the courts, ns well S
I: cnmp:iigns alicl elections,
T, TI1
I,(II
. OM
18
<l,,<l
,,IO$l
--
-
,-
-
-
-
- - =-
-
-- ---
---
- - -
--
--
--
- -
dl
-\,
summer
o.nIi.ne.!j"~~5towgust31,m7
Summer Online courses ai-e:deliwered ow& the Inter
low students maximum
flexibility to organize'their work. Students will need
>ersonalcomputer
with a browser and'Intcmet connection. While students are
ired to log in to the
Id in work, they will
se several t i m . h week to participate in discussions and
teed to d?-this at specific times. Some classes may require occasional clasnoom
meetings and t@~:will be held during weekday evenings or weekends to
accommodate work schedules. Augsburg students using AugNet Records and
Registration to m i s t e r for Summer Online will find these courses listed under
Summer Session I
I
1
.
-_
I
POL 121-L
A m e r i c a n G o v c r n n l c n t and Politics
Hcdblorn
Suri'eys ~n.ijorp:lrts c r i Anieric:ln n:ltio~l;ll
; i ~ \ ~ r r n m e n t - i ~ i c I ~(:<,~lgrcss,
~ ~ l i ~ i g the p r c r i ~ l c n c ~ .
.~nclthe cotlrts-;rs well :la c a l l l l ~ ~ i g nancl
s clccti~~n,
fcclcr:ilism, interest grcrups, :inJ p < > l ~ t i cparrlcr
.~l
I'cr~pe~~ttre/Sk~Il/LAF:
Soc~t~l
World I or 2 I'CI~\IC~IIV~;
1-
FN
I 240-r.
L A F in Socl~ll(111d ljehi1t10rt11
SCC
IC
I CI
ECO II~-L
F
I
Pcrso'nal Financc
Principles o f Microcconornics
Intr<)Juction to ~pcrs<)naltin;~nci;llplanning ;1
I>uclgeting, crcclit manngellicnt, inccblue t;~scs,
tlic II~IIFCIIIIILI,
real cstntc, i ~ l \ ~ c s t ~ l i e n~etirement,
ts,
awl
~I~SLII.IIICC,
cst.ltc lplann~n;.
MKT 4 6 6 - L
International M a r k e t i n g
r
r:
rlrrn,
':cr structi~rcs,;rnrl ~nc(>mc
>felementaly econonlic
c l i s t r i h u t i ~ ~Anp p l ~ c a
theory to m:lrlet pol
Stcin
rnccon~)mica:the tlieoly o f
A n intro~luctic>~
,
lay he taken inclcpc~l~lently
C I ~ E C O I I @ ( > r112. E C O 112 ;rnrl 113 may he r.~ken
i t i citlicr o n l e ~ .
Mcziou
P~crcq.:M P G 2
Thih co~lrsecx:lmines t h ~ ~ s~ssuca
c
;and ;icti\,~tic.\
I'er~bect~i,c/Skill/LAF: Sucinl Wurlil I or 2 I'crs~ccr~~,c;
uniqtle to marketing I n nn internntion:ll setting.
mid I j e l u ~ ~ , ~ oSc~enies
r'~l
L A F 111 Soc~r~l
Emphasis
ib
lilnceil o n :~clnl>tntio~l
o i 3 marketin::
lniix OCCO~~IIIIC
to the ~ ~ i t c ~ n n t ~~onnnnr kl c t ~ n g
e~i\~~ro~i~lic~it.
P H I 110-L
Prcrctl.: M K T 252
I n t r o d u c t i o n to Philosophy
Ward
Thih c o u ~ s ci ~ l t r c ~ ~ l u stc~clcnts
ces
tt, typ~cnl
pliilosc~pliic;ilquestion.* (like how we kn11\\,, if u8eran
CHM 102-L
Ilnve certnln kn<~u,lcrlgc,i f there arc 11111\,cranl
~iit~r;~l
C h c m i s t v for Changing Timcs w i t h Lab
Fcdic
This is a Iccturc anil Inhorntory course tll:1t tle\.cl~~l)s
h;lsic c~lclli,trg
prinsll)lca
\\.itll tllc :15,,lml,ti,,n
tilac
~pri~lciples
\r,licrlier G o d exlsts, the nntilrc t,f the
~cdl
nncl t c ~
m i n d ctc ), to p l i i l ~ ~ s o l ~ hvocahulnry,
critical thinking rind w l i ; ~ ti t means t<>\,iew tlic
I)~~~~SOI~~IIC~~~Y.
ill the 1711y~i~;~l !vo~ILI
sturlents h3vc llttlc Or 110 I1;1ek~ro111lcI
scicnccs This liyhriil coilrse mccts for thrcc S:itunlny
I'erspcct~t~e/Sk~ll/LAF: HI(III(I~ Idetlt~lyP~TSIICCLI(,~;L A F
Inh seasion.\: 7:30 n m -3:30 p.m o n June 30. July
it1
14, nncl August
4.
Cc>u~sc
~>cri<i~m;incc
ia c\.aluntcil
\<'it1111111t
I~~SCIISSI~II
C X C I C I S ~ Salirl
cl~lizics,a11
<>ngoingj c ~ u ~ n lprojcct
al
cserctsc, 2nd the l a h o r ~ t o r y
SebLIOllS
Prcrcq
:
MPC; 3
I'ers~zc~i~z/Sk~lI/LAF:
Nidturizl World I or 2 Pen\,ecut'c,
L A F 111 Naruatl Sctencc\ 011d M~~I~ICIII~LLIO
I<m: SCI 322
I
24
H~~rntllulles
--
- P
. -
notes
d u m m r r Sess
~pplicntionsare a\~:lilnl~le
online at:
w,nr~~sh~~r~.edu/enrolI/rc~istmr
then clicl
'fDd
Registrar Forms"
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Interim Catalog, 1973
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
NOTES AND QUlRlES
The academic y e a r 1972-1973 marks t h e b e g i n n i n g o f t h e
4-1-4 c a l e n d a r a t Augsburg C o l l e g e .
J a n u a r y , 1973, w i l l be t h e
f i r s t l n t e r i m a t t h e Co l l ege. The I n t e r i m w i l l b e g i n on Wednesday, J a n u a r y 3...
Show more
NOTES AND QUlRlES
The academic y e a r 1972-1973 marks t h e b e g i n n i n g o f t h e
4-1-4 c a l e n d a r a t Augsburg C o l l e g e .
J a n u a r y , 1973, w i l l be t h e
f i r s t l n t e r i m a t t h e Co l l ege. The I n t e r i m w i l l b e g i n on Wednesday, J a n u a r y 3, 1973, and w i t 1 end o n Tuesday, J a n u a r y 30, 1973.
R e q u i r e m e n t s and Course Load
The l n t e r i m i s an o r g a n i c p a r t o f t h e c o l l e g e y e a r .
Each
s t u d e n t i s t o c o m p l e t e o n e l n t e r i m f o r each f u l l y e a r he i s e n r o l l e d
a t Augsburg.
A s t u d e n t may t a k e an I n t e r i m i n h i s m a j o r o r o u t s i d e
h i s major.
Each d i s c i p l i n e may r e q u i r e one l n t e r i m o f i t s m a j o r s ,
and each s t u d e n t may e l e c t one a d d i t i o n a l l n t e r i m i n h i s m a j o r . Beyond t h e t w o l n t e r i m s i n h i s m a j o r each s t u d e n t w i l l e l e c g l n t e r i m s
outside h i s major.
One l n t e r i m c o u r s e i s t h e l i m i t o f t h e s t u d e n t ' s academic
l o a d d u r i n g t h e one-month t e r m .
Each d e p a r t m e n t a t Augsburg o f f e r s a t l e a s t one l n t e r i m c o u r s e
t h a t w i l l , f u l f i l l t h e d i s t r i b u t i o n requirements f o r graudation.
Each
i n s t r u c t o r d e t e r m i n e s t h e manner i n w h i c h he w i I l g r a d e t h e I n t e r i m .
The g r a d i n g i s l i s t e d w i t h each l n t e r i m d e s c r i p t i o n . T r a d i t i o n a l
(A,B,C,D,F);
P/NC; O p t i o n a l ( t h e s t u d e n t e l e c t s a t t h e t i m e o f r e g i s t r a t i o n e i t h e r t h e t r a d i t i o n a l o r P/NC.)
Class Meetings
An l n t e r i m c o u r s e s h o u l d make t h e same t i m e demands upon t h e
s t u d e n t a s a s t a n d a r d semester c o u r s e . The number and l e n g t h o f c l a s s
meetings i s n o t r i g i d l y fixed.
S t u d e n t s , however, s h o u l d p l a n f o r
i n - c l a s s p a r t i c i p a t i o n o f a b o u t t e n h o u r s p e r week.
In addition, there
w i l l be labs, f i e l d s t u d y , t r a v e l , r e a d i n g s , r e p o r t s , and p a p e r s .
A l l l n t e r i m c l a s s e s w i l l meet t h e f i r s t and t h e l a s t c l a s s days
o f t h e Interim.
On-Campus Classes,
Off-Campus C l a s s e s ,
Independent Study
The f o l l o w i n g c a t a l o g u e l i s t s t h e l n t e r i m c o u r s e s a v a i l a b l e a t
Augsburg.
I n a d d i t i o n t o t h e s e c o u r s e s , Augsburg s t u d e n t s may e n r o l l
f o r t h e i r l n t e r i m a t Hamline, M a c a l e s t e r , o r S t . C a t h e r i n e s i n S t . P a u l .
S h o u l d s t u d e n t s have q u e s t i o n s a b o u t other-campus l n t e r i m s and , m a j o r
requirements, t h e y should c o n s u l t w i t h t h e department chairman o f t h e i r
major.
Should t h e y have q u e s t i o n s a b o u t other-campus l n t e r i m s and
d i s t r i b u t i o n requirements, t h e y should c o n s u l t w i t h t h e R e g i s t r a r .
S t u d e n t s may e l e c t an independent s t u d y program f o r t h e I n t e r i m .
I f t h e y p l a n such, t h e y m u s t meet t h e d e p a r t m e n t ' s r e q u i r e m e n t s f o r
independent s t u d y . They must a l s o p r e s e n t a t t h e t l m e o f r e g i s t r a t i o n
f o r t h e I n t e r i m a w r i t t e n agreement f r o m t h e i n d i v i d u a l i n s t r u c t o r who
w i l l d i r e c - b t h e i r independent s t u d y program. A t o p i c and t e n t a t f v e
o u t l i n e , i n c l u d i n g b i b l i o g r a p h y , f o r t h e independent s t u d y must be
s u b m i t t e d t o t h e i n s t r u c t o r no l a t e r t h a n J a n u a r y 3, 1973.
C l a s s Day
The l n t e r i m day i s d i v i d e d i n t o f o u r b l o c k s o f t i m e . These
t i m e p e r i o d s a r e f l e x i b l e , b u t f o r t h e sake o f o p e n i n g s e s s i o n s t h e
day i s b l o c k e d as f o l l o w s :
C a n c e l l i n q and Adding
F r i d a y , J a n u a r y 5,
adding a course.
1973,
i s t h e l a s t day f o r cancelling and
Additional Questions
S t u d e n t s w i t h p a r t i c u I at- q u e s t i o n s a b o u t t h e I.ntarlm: s:tigu.lzd
c o n s u l t Dr. Mark D a v i s , I n t e r i m D i r e c t o r , O l d Main 26, Ex,tension
577.
Daaartment o f A r t
10250
L i f e Drawing qnd S c u l p t u r e
A two-dimensional and t h r e e - d i m e n s i o n a l s t u d y o f t h e nude f i g u r e f o r none x p e r i e n c e d s t u d e n t s as w e l l as a r t s t u d e n t s .
With a c h o i c e o f media i n
drawing ( p e n c i l , c o n t e crayon, ink, c h a r c o a l , e t c . ) and a c h o i c e o f media
i n s c u l p t u r e ( c l a y , p l a s t e r , p o l y e s t e r r e s i n , lead, wood).
I n s t r u c t o r : Ho l e n
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l l m e n t : 20
Grad i ng : Opt iona l
Time:
Room:
No
II
Upper l e v e l , A r t B u i l d i n g
Film-making t h r o u g h p r a c t i c a l l a b e x p e r i e n c e .
D i s c u s s i o n and o b s e r v a t i o n
o f t h e e x p r e s s i v e and s t r u c t u r a l elements o f f i l m .
I n s t r u c t o r : Rusten
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l l m e n t : 20
Grading: O p t i o n a l
10231
Mexican C i v i l i z a t i o n :
No
Fee: $50
Time:
III
Room: Lower l e v e l , A r t B u i l d i n g
A n c i e n t and Modern
(see F o r e i g n Language)
Department o f B i o l o g y
20 1 10
Man and t h e Envi ronment
The concept o f t h e ECOSYSTEM, l o o k i n g a t some o f i t s h o m e o s t a t i c
mechanisms. The Impact man has made upon t h e ecosystem w i t h h i s
u r b a n i z a t i o n , p o l l u t i o n , and p o p u l a t i o n e x p l o s i o n .
L a b o r a t o r y demons t r a t i o n o f l e c t u r e concepts. The p r e s e n t s i t u a t i o n i n t h e n a t u r a l
w o r l d i n l i g h t o f t h e C h r i s t i a n e t h i c . Does n o t a p p l y toward t h e
b i o l o g y major.
I n s t r u c t o r : M i c k e l berg
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
Enro l I ment : 35
20353
Yes,
urban
Grading: T r a d i t i o n a l
Time:
I
Room: 21 3
Comparative V e r t e b r a t e Zoology
A c o m p a r a t i v e s t u d y d e a l i n g w i t h t h e c l a s s i f i c a t i o n , morphology,
evolution,distribution,
b e h a v i o r , and p o p u l a t i o n dynamics o f t h e
vertebrates.
I n s t r u c t o r : R. H e r f o r t h
Di s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t : No
E n r o l l m e n t : 20
Prerequisite:
112 General B i o l o g y
Grading: T r a d i t i o n a l
Time:
I I and Lab 2:OO-4:30,
Room: 205
M-Th
20471
C e l l u l a r Biology
A study c o r r e l a t i n g c e l l f u n c t i o n w i t h u l t r a - s t r u c t u r e .
Laboratory
work ' i n c l u d e s m i c r o - t e c h n i q u e , c y t o l o g - i c a l s t u d i e s , s t u d i e s i n ce l l
p h y s i o l o g y and b i o c h e m i s t r y , and an i n t r o d u c t i o n t o t i s s u e c u - l t u r e .
I n s t r u c t o r : Thorpe
Di s t r i b u t i o n requ i rement: No
Enrol lment: 20
Prerequisite:
112, Chemistry 223 o r 351
Recommended - 367
20499
Grading: T r a d i t i o n a l
Time:
I and Lab 1:OO-5:00
M,WJ F
Room: 205
Independent Study
I n d i v i d u a l work on a r e s e a r c h p r o j e c t under t h e d i r e c t i o n o f an
instructor.
Intended f o r b i o l o g y m a j o r s . P r i m a r i l y l a b o r a t o r y work.
I n s t r u c t o r : Su l e r u d
Grading: T r a d i t i o n a l
D i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t : No
Enrollment:
15
P r e r e q u i s i t e : 112, and p r e v i o u s arrangement w i t h i n s t r u c t o r .
Department o f Business A d m i n i s t r a t i o n ,
Economics
Business Education, and
-Business A d m i n i s t r a t i o n
21 131
Business Law
Legal r u l e s r e l a t i n g t o c o n t r a c t s , agency, n e g o t i a b l e i n s t r u m e n t s ,
p r o p e r t y and business o r g a n i z a t i o n s under t h e Uniform Commercial Code.
I n s t r u c t o r : Hei d e n r e i c h
Di s t r i b u t i o n requ i rement :
Enrol l ment : 25
No
Grad i ng : Opt i ona l
11.1
Time:
Room: 23
-Business Education
33110
O f f i c e Technology
O p e r a t i o n o f t r a n s c r r i p t i o n machines, f i l i n g and r e c o r d s management,
i n t r o d u c t i o n t o d a t a p r o c e s s i n g , and e f f i c i e n t h a n d l i n g o f o f f i c e d u t i e s .
Instructor:
Lund
Di s t r i b u t i o n requ i rement :
E n r o l lment: 25
22120
No
Grading: O p t i o n a l
Time:
I and I I , M,W,F
Room: 10
Economics o f Urban Issues
Study o f t h e economic i m p l i c a t i o n s o f t h e many problems f a c i n g a metro;
urban environment. Some o f t h e t o p i c s t o be d i s c u s s e d a r e : P o p u l a t i o n
" C r i s i st'; D r a f t vs. an Al I-Vol u n t e e r Army; Ecology and Income D i s t r i b u t i o n : D i s t r i b u t i n g Free Bread; Mass T r a n s i t Systems. Note: ECONOMICS
1 2 0 I S A BASIC COURSE DESIGNED FOR THOSE STUDENTS WHO DO NOT PLAN TO
MAJOR I N E l THER ECONOM I CS, BUS l NESS ADM l N l STRAT l ON OR BUS~NESS
EDUCATION.
STUDENTS WHO PLAN TO MAJOR IN THE ABOVE THREE AREAS SHOULD ENROLL IN
122 AND 123 RATHER THAN 120.
I n s t r u c t o r : D. H e r f o r t h
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l lment : 35
Yes, urban
Grading: O p t i o n a l
II
Time:
Room: 23
Department o f Chemistry
34246
T o p i c s i n Environmental Chemistry
T h i s c o u r s e i s i n t e n d e d t o s e r v e p e o p l e i n a number o f f i e l d s who
f e e l t h a t something s h o u l d be done about environmental decay and i s
aimed n o t a t f u e l i n g t h e r h e t o r i c o f s l o g a n e e r s b u t r a t h e r a t enr i c h i ng t h e i n f o r m a t i o n a l b a s i s o f a c t i o n s t h a t have t o - be t a k e n .
We s h a l l assume t h a t i n t h i s area i t i s b e t t e r t o know something
and a c t on t h a t r a t h e r t h a n t o know n o t h i n g and a c t s o l e l y o n
emotion. We s h a l l aim t o l e a r n something o f t h e m a t e r i a l s t h a t a r e
rui.ning us, where t h e y come from, and how emeshed we a l l a r e i n
t h e i r origins.
To t h i s end we shal l c o n s i d e r o u r m a j o r sources
o f energy--both f o r mechanical energy and h e a t (e.g., o i l and c o a l )
and f o r o u r i n t e r n a l needs (food)--and see how v i r t u a l l y a l l o f t h e
p r i n c i p a l p o l l u t a n t s o r i g i n a t e d i r e c t l y o r i n d i r e c t l y from t h i s
As we move t h r o u g h t h e s e t o p i c s t h e i r
p r i m a r y need f o r . e n e r g y .
r e l a t i o n t o economics, p o l i t i c s , urban a f f a i r s , p o p u l a t i o n problems
and o t h e r s w i l l b e g i n t o emerge. We hope t o use f i l m s , o u t s i d e
speakers, f i e l d t r i p s , and i n d i v i d u a l p r o j e c t s t o supplement
r e a d i n g s , l e c t u r e s , and c l a s s room d i s c u s s i o n s .
Students e l e c t i n g
t h i s c o u r s e a r e expected t o have a t l e a s t a h i g h school back-
g
language o f c h e m i s t r y i s assumed.
I n s t r u c t o r : Holum
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l l m e n t : 30
34353
Yes,
urban
g
Grading: Optional
Time:
II
Room: 320
Q u a n t i t a t i v e A n a l y t i c a l Chemistry
T h i s c o u r s e w i l l c o v e r v o l u m e t r i c a n a l y s i s and s o l u t i o n e q u i l i b r i a
i n d e t a i l and w i l l g i v e an i n t r o d u c t i o n t o s p e c t r o p h o t o m e t r i c
t e c h n i q u e s o f a n a l y s i s . The c o u r s e i s t o be t a k e n by c h e m i s t r y
majors, n o r m a l l y i n t h e I n t e r i m o f t h e i r sophomore y e a r . M e d i c a l
t e c h n o l o g i s t s s h o u l d t a k e C h e m i s t r y 353. There w i l l be d a i l y
c l a s s e s and l a b o r a t o r y s e s s i o n s .
I n s t r u c t o r : Gyberg
D i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t : No
E n r o l l m e n t : 25
P r e r e q u i s i t e : C h e m i s t r y 106 o r 116
Grading: T r a d i t i o n a l
Time:
II
Room: 315
34499
Independent Study
I n o r d e r t o g i v e j u n i o r and s e n i o r c h e m i s t r y m a j o r s an o p p o r t u n i l - y
t o pursue a t o p i c o r problem i n d e t a i l , a t l e a s t one member o f t h e
c h e m i s t r y f a c u l t y w i l l work w i t h s t u d e n t s i n a r e a s o f t h e i r own
i n t e r e s t such a s c o n t i n u a t i o n o f r e s e a r c h problems a l r e d d y s t a r t e d ,
o r p a r t i c u l a r problems o f s y n t h e s i s o r ana l y s i s, o r t o p i c s l i ke
polymers o r c o l l o i d s n o t covered i n d e p t h i n r e g u l a r courses. O f f campus a c t i v i t i e s such as r e s e a r c h a t Argonne o r i n i n d u s t r y may
be p o s s i b l e . The s t u d e n t i s r e q u i r e d t o s u b m i t h i s p r o p o s a l f o r
work.
Grad i ng : Trad i t i ona l
I n s t r u c t o r : A1 t o n
Time:
I
Di s t r i b u t ion requ i rement : No
Enrollment:
12
Room: 318
P r e r e q u i s i t e : J u n i o r o r s e n i o r Chemistry m a j o r
Department o f E d u c a t i o n
44345
E a r l y Childhood Activit?:es
Experience i n p l a n n i n g , implementing and e v a l u a t i n g a c t i v i t i e s f o r
Day Care C e n t e r f o r use i n n u r s e r y school and e a r l y c h i l d h o o d
education.
I n s t r u c t o r : Reuter
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l lment: 20
44485
No
G r a d i n g : P/NC
Time:
I
Room: t l
S t u d e n t Teaching
O p p o r t u n i t y f o r e l e m e n t a r y classroom o b s e r v a t i o n s and e x p e r i e n c e s
i n d i r e c t i n g l e a r n i n g a c t i v i t i e s under t h e s u p e r v i s i o n o f c o l l e g e
and e l e m e n t a r y school p e r s o n n e l .
Instructor: Pelton
Grad i ng : P/DIF
D i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t : No
Time: TBA
Enro l lment : 20
P r e r e q u i s i t e : Admission t o s t u d e n t t e a c h i n g
Secondary E d u c a t i o n
45375
Audio-Visual
Internship
The s t u d e n t w i l l be a s s i g n e d f u l l t i m e t o work c l o s e l y w i t h t h e
Audio-Visual D i r e c t o r o f a p u b l i c sehool h a v i n g an o u t s t a n d i n g a u d i o v i s u a l department; t h e s t u d e n t w i l l have e x p e r i e n c e s i n a l l o f t h e
f a c e t s r e l a t i v e t o t h e s u c c e s s f u l o p e r a t i o n o f an a u d i o - v i s u a l
department.
I n s t r u c t o r : Holmen
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l lment:
15
No
Grad i ng : P/NC
III
Time:
Room: L I
45420
lnnovations i n Education
l n n o v a t i o n s i n E d u c a t i o n i s designed as a s t u d y o f new, i n t e r e s t i n g
and p r o m i s i n g e d u c a t i o n a l programs and e s p e c i a l l y t h o s e t h a t a r e
b e i n g c a r r i e d o u t i n t h e Upper Midwest.
Students w i l l be i n v o l v e d
b o t h on and o f f campus i n v e s t i g a t i n g i n n o v a t i v e ideas and o b s e r v i n g
school programs, elementary and secondary, where t h e s e ideas a r e
A smal l amount of t r a v e l expense and p o s s i b l y
being c a r r i e d out.
Some i n d i v i an o v e r n i g h t accommodation expense w i l l be necessary.
d u a l i z a t i o n o f a s t u d e n t F s a c t i v i t i e s w i l l be p o s s i b l e .
I n s t r u c t o r : Fard i g
Grad i ng : P/NC
I
D i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t : No
Time:
E n r o l l m e n t : 20
Room: S34
P r e r e q u i s i t e : Upperclass s t a n d i n g o r consent o f i n s t r u c t o r
45482
S t u d e n t Teaching
E x p e r i e n c e i n o b s e r v i n g and i d r e c t i n g l e a r n i n g e x p e r i e n c e s on t h e
secondary l e v e l under t h e d i r e c t i o n o f c o l l e g e and h i g h school
p e r s o n n e l . T h i s c o u r s e i s o f f e r e d as an o p p o r t u n i t y f o r secondary
c a n d i d a t e s t o s t u d e n t t e a c h a t a n o t h e r l e v e l and/or a d i f f e r e n t
school s i t u a t i o n .
I n s t r u c t o r : E. Johnson
D i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t : No
E n r o l lment:
15
P r e r e q u i s i t e : Consent o f i n s t r u c t o r
Grad i ng : P/D/F
Time:
II
Room: L I
Department o f Eng l i sh
54241
Science F i c t i o n
A c o u r s e d e a l i n g w i t h s c i e n c e f i c t i o n n o v e l s and s h o r t s t o r i e s . W h i l e
r e a d i n g s w i l l i n c l u d e n i n e t e e n t h and e a r l y t w e n t i e t h c e n t u r y works,
t h e m a j o r emphasis o f t h e c o u r s e w i l l be a c o n s i d e r a t i o n o f l e a d i n g
s c i e n c e f i c t i o n w r i t e r s and works o f t o d a y . C o n s i d e r a t i o n w i l l be
g i v e n t o t h e r e l a t i o n s h i p between s c i e n c e f i c t i o n and t h e modern
technological society.
I n s t r u c t o r : Palosaari
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l l m e n t : 30
54251
Yes
Grading: Optional
Time:
II
Room: 25
The l nd i an i n American L i t e r a t u r e
Examination o f t h e a t t i t u d e s t o w a r d and images o f t h e l n d i a n and h i s
e x p e r i e n c e from w h i t e and l n d i a n p o i n t s o f view.
Primary m a t e r i a l
w i l l be b o t h w h i t e and n a t i v e American w r i t i n g s .
American I n d i a n
r e s o u r c e p e o p l e w i l l be i n v o l v e d ,
Instructor: Nicholl
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l l m e n t : 30
54281
Yes
Grad i ng : O b t i o n a 1
Time:
II
Room: 21
The S h o r t S t o r y I n t e r n a t i o n a l
Readings and d i s c u s s i o n s o f s h o r t s t o r i e s , p r i m a r i l y o u t s i d e t h e
B r i t i s h and American t r a d i t i o n .
I n s t r u c t o r : Dahlen
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
Enro l l ment : 30
5436 1
Yes
Grad i ng : O p t i o n a l
Time:
I
Room: 25
Advanced W r i t i n g Workshop
A c o u r s e designed t o enhance s k i l l s i n t h e w r i t i n g o f b o t h p r o s e
and p o e t r y .
I n s t r u c t o r : L i v i ngston
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
Enrollment:
15
Grad i ng : OPti ona l
54371
No
Time:
III
Room: 22
Prerequisite;
I l l and 219
o r consent o f
instructor
Contemporary M u l t i - M e d i a S a t i r e
A f t e r a b r i e f i n t r o d u c t i o n t o t h e s a t i r i c traditions o f Horace,
Juvenal, and S w i f t , t h e c o u r s e w i l l proceed t o an i n v e s t i g a t i o n o f
present-day s a t i r i s t s w o r k i n g i n t h e v a r i o u s media:
books, magaz i n e s , records, cinema, and t e l e v i s i o n .
Some o f t h e s a t i r i s t s t o
be s t u d i e d i n c l u d e : P h i l i p Wylie, Tom Wolfe, T e r r y Southern, Lenny
Bruce, D i c k Gregory, Tom Lehrer, N a t h a n i e l Benchley, and whatever
TV and movie s c e n a r i s t s happen t o be c u r r e n t and/or a v a i l a b l e .
T o p i c s f o r d i s c u s s i o n w i l l i n c l u d e modern s a t i r e ' s d e b t t o t h e p a s t ,
i t s p o s s i b l e c o n t r i b u t i o n s t o t h e f u t u r e , and i t s advantages and
d i s a d v a n t a g e s as a t o o l t o mend mankind.
I n s t r u c t o r : Wood
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l l m e n t : 30
54445
Yes
Grading: Optional
Tlme:
I
Room: 2 1
P o t p o u r r i : Read i n g f o r Fun and C r e d i t
The purpose o f t h e c o u r s e i s t o g i v e t h e s t u d e n t an o p p o r t u n i t y t o
r e a d some o f t h o s e b o o k s w a t he has been i n t r o d u c e d t o b u t which he
has n o t been a b l e t o read. The s t u d e n t w i l l d e t e r m i n e h i s r e a d i n g
l i s t i n consultation with the instructor.
I n s t r u c t o r : Andersen
D i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t : No
E n r o l l ment : 15
Prerequi s i t e : j u n i o r o r s e n i o r standing
Time:
I
Room: L201
Grad i ng : O p t i ona l
Department of Fore igm Lang uags
French
70244
French L i t e r a t u r e i n T r a n s l a t i o n
The passions (good and bad) i n human n a t u r e as r e f l e c t e d I n
r e p r e s e n t a t i v e works o f French 1 i t e r a t u r e t o be read i n
translation.
I n s t r u c t o r : Johnson
Di s t r i b u t i o n requ i rement:
Enrol lment: 25
Grad i ng : o p t i o n a l
Time:
Ill
Room: 8
70453
Yes
French Short S t o r y
The Frenchman r e v e a l s h i m s e l f and h i s c u l t u r e through t h e s h o r t
f i c t i o n a l masterpieces c a l led I1le contet1 o r !'la nouvel let!. Reading
o f r e p r e s e n t a t i v e works w i l l a l so show how t h e French w r i t e r has become
a master o f h i s a r t .
I n s t r u c t o r : Aaskov
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
Enrollment: 25
Grad i ng : o p t i ona l
Time:
II
Room: 4
Yes
Prerequ i s i t e :
l ntermed i a t e French
o r perm i ss i on o f
instructor
German
72333
Contemporary Germany
Survey o f l i f e i n present-day Germany: s o c i a l , economic, and p o l i t i c a l
problems, l i v i n g standards, medical oare, education, s t a t u s symbols,
t h e g e n e r a t i o n gap, t h e s t u d e n t scene, urban problems, p o l l u t i o n ,
d r a f t r e s i s t a n c e , etc., w l t h emphasis on changes i n l i f e - s t y l e s i n c e
M a t e r i a l s f rom t h e c u r r e n t p r e s s and o t h e r med i a .
World War I I
.
I n s t r u c t o r : Dyl e r
D i s t r i b u t i o n requlrement; Yes
Enrollment: 25
Prerequisite:
I n t e r m e d i a t e German o r permission o f i n s t r u c t o r
Grad i ng : o p t i o n a l
Time:
III
Room: 4
Foreign Language(continued)
Linguistics
54299
I n t r o d u c t o r y L i ngu i s t i c s
An i n t r o d u c t i o n t o l i n g u i s t i c a n a l y s i s and general l i n g u i s t i c
p r i n c i p l e s , w i t h focus on l i n g u s i ~ s t i cuniversa1.s ( o r g a n i z a t i o n a l
p r i n c i p l e s and f e a t u r e s common t o a l l languages) and p s y c h o l i n g u i s t i c s
( i n q u i r y i n t o t h e mechanisms o f language l e a r n i n g and t h e s t r u c t u r e o f
t h e mind as revealed i n language). T h e o r e t i c a l q u e s t i o n s w i I l be
approached by studying samples o f v a r i o u s languages.
I n s t r u c t o r : S t e i nmetz
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
Enrol lment: 25
Grading: o p t i o n a l
Time:
II
Room: 8
Yes
Span i sh
76231
Mexican C i v i l i z a t i o n :
Ancient and Modern
Travel t o t h e major c e n t e r s o f Mexico w i t h r e l e v a n t c u l t u r a l and
h i s t o r i c a l s t u d i e s . Emphasis upon t h e study o f language and t h e
v i s u a l a r t s . Cross l i s t e d w l t h t h e A r t Department and team-taught
by members o f t h e spanlsh Department and t h e A r t Department.
I n s t r u c t o r s : Ki ngs I ey, Rozenta l s, Thompson
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement: Yes ( f o r e i g n language o r f i n e a r t s )
Enrollment: 40
Grading: o p t i o n a l
General Studies
58299
I t ' s How You Play t h e Game
1 n . l e c t u r e and l a b an experimental e x p l o r a t i o n i n t o t h e s t r u c t q r e , t h e o r y ,
and .playing o f games. Emphasis w i l l be on board and s i m u l a t l i o n games-I n a d d i t i o n t h e r e w i l l be study o f t h e s e l e c t i o n and
both o l d and new.
p r o d u c t i o n o f games s o l d commercially. The course w i l l conclude w i t h
p a r t l c i p a n t s p r e p a r l n g a game o f t h e i r own.
I n s t r u c t o r : Gustaf son
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
Enrollment: 30
Grad i ng: Opt i ona l
Time:
II
Room: 27
No
Department o f H e a l t h and P h y s i c a l E d u c a t i o n
55482
Coaching o f S p o r t s
Theory and t e c h n i q u e s o f coaching.
injuries.
P r e v e n t i o n and c a r e o f a t h l e t i c
I n s t r u c t o r s : Car i s, Nel son, Peterson, Raymond
Di s t r i b u t i o n requ i rement : No
E n r o l l m e n t : 40 ( l i m i t e d t o j u n i o r s and s e n i o r s ; o t h e r s w i t h p e r m i s s i o n
o f in s t r u c t o r
Grad i ng : Trad it iona l
Time:
II
Room: GI2
55483
Contemporary Hea l t h Prob l ems
A n a l y s i s i n depth o f b a s i c human h e a l t h problems.
I n c l u d e s v i s i t s by
h e a l t h r e s o u r c e e x p e r t s and s t u d e n t v i s i t s o f a number o f community h e a l t h
programs.
I n s t r u c t o r s : P f a f f , Saugestad
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement: No
Enrol lment: 35
Grading: O p t i o n a l
I
Time:
Room: GI2
Department o f Hi s t o r y
56250
French Hi s t o r y f o r Students and Trave l l e r s
A study o f French h i s t o r y from t h e t w e l f t h - c e n t u r y Renaissance t h r o u g h
t h e Napoleonic Era. The c u l t u r a l emphasis w i l l come from readings,
a u d i o - v i s u a l a i d s , and o u t s i d e resource people. There w i l l be an emphasis
on a r c h i t e c t u r e as an e x p r e s s i o n o f a c i v i l i z a t i o n .
Instructor: Gisselquist
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l l m e n t : 30
Grading: T r a d i t i o n a l
II
Time:
Room: 7
56350
Yes
How t h e H i s t o r i a n Works
An i n v e s t i g a t i o n i n t o t h e w r i t i n g o f h i s t o r y . Students w i l l e v a l u a t e
t h e use o f evidence, t y p e s o f sources, and t h e v a r i o u s forms o f
c r i t i c i s m which h i s t o r i a n s use i n t h e i r d i s c i p l i n e . P a r t i c u l a r emphasis
w i l l be g i v e n t o t e n d e n t i o u s h i s t o r i e s and i n v e s t i g a t i o n o f well-known
personal i t i e s whose l i fe and work a r e known o n l y t h r o u g h secondary
sources
.
I n s t r u c t o r : Nelson
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l lment: 30
Grading: T r a d i t i o n a l
III
Time:
Room: 7
No
Department o f Mathematics
61141
Mathematics:
A Human Endeavor
A modern approach o t t h e s t u d y o f . f u n d a m e n t a l i d e a s o f mathematics w i t h
an emphasis on i t s beauty and i t s power. Deisgned f o r . s t u d e n t s w i t h a
m i m i ma 1 background i n mat hemati cs.
I n s t r u c t o r : Durkee
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l l ment: 35
Grading: O p t i o n a l
Time:
I
Room: 212
61361
Yes
A p p l i c a t i o n s o f M a t r i x Algebra
An i n t r o d u c t i o n t o m a t r i x a l g e b r a and p r o b a b i l i t y w i t h a p p l i c a t i o n t o
game t h e o r y , graphs, and networks.
I n s t r u c t o r : Persons
D i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t : No
Enrol lment: 20
Grading: O p t i o n a l
Time:
II
Room: 212
P r e r e q u i s i t e s : Mathematics 121 o r 124
Department o f Mus 1 c
A,survey o f music o u t s l d e t h e European a r t tradition, e..g.,
music, A f r i c a n muslc, Afro-American music.
I n s t r u c t o r : Metzker
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
En r o l l ment : 30
Grad i ng : Trad i t lona l
Time:
Ill
Room: M20
82270
Oriental
Yes
Folk Music of t h e Southeastern U.S.
An e x p l o r a t i o n of t h e o r i g i n s and t r a d l t i o n s o f American f o l k music i n
t h e southeastern q u a r t e r o f t h e U.S.
Study w i l l a l s o focus on t h e i n fluence of t h a t f o l k music on contemporary f o l k music. Travel t o t h e
c e n t e r s o f American f o l k music t r a d i t i o n i s a p a r t o f t h e study.
I n s t r u c t o r : Sateren
D i s t r i b u t i o n requi rement: Yes
Enrollment: L i m i t e d t o members of t h e Augsburg Cholr
Grad i ng : P/NC
82390
Chamber Music Workshop
The study and performance of chamber music o f t h e c l a s s i c , romantic,
and comtemporary eras.
Included i s any combination f o r s t r i n g s , woodwinds, and piano.
Instructor: Vuicich
Di s t r i b u t i o n requ i rement : No
Enrollment: L i m i t e d t o competent musical performers.
Grad i ng : P/NC
Time:
IV
Room: M I I
82395
See i n s t r u c t o r .
Opera Workshop
The p r e p a r a t i o n and performance o f an opera.
I n s t r u c t o r s : Gabrielsen, Johnson, V u i c i c h
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement: No
Enrol lment: L i m i t e d t o competent musical performers.
Grad i ng :
Time:
II
Room: MI I
See i n s t r u c t o r .
Department o f Music
82410
Electronic Techniques i n Musical C m p o s l t l o n
Contemporary approach t o musical composltion using sounds c r e a t e d
by t r a d i t i o n a l instruments, unconventional sources, and e l e c t r o n i c
devices, I n c l u d i n g a synthesizer. Sounds created, manipulated, and
organized I n t o I n d i v i d u a l forms o f a u r a l a r t . Theories and techniques
o f e l e c t r o n i c composltion a r e s t u d i e d I n a c t u a l practice.
I n s t r u c t o r : Karlen
Distribution requirement:
Enrol lment: 30
Grad i ng : P/NC
Time:
III
Room: MI I
No
Department o f Philosophy
83 1 10 Great Phi losophers o f Athens
I n t r o d u c t i o n t o p h l losophy through t h e study o f t h e t e a c h i n g s o f
Socrates, Plato, and A r i s t o t l e . Concern w l l l be shown f o r t h e r o l e t h a t
these men played i n developing Ideas b a s l c t o Western c l v i l l z a t i o n , and
t h e i r l a s t i n g c o n t r l b u t i o n s on t o p l c s such as t h e n a t u r e o f t h e r e a l ,
t h e good l i f e , search f o r knowledge.
I n s t r u c t o r : Bai l e y
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
Enrollment: 40
Grad i ng : Opt iona l
Time:
III
Room: 213
83390
Yes
The Nature o f t h e M y s t l c V i s i o n
A study o f t h e w r i t i n g s o f several o f t h e g r e a t mystical, p h i l o s o p h e r s
o f t h e Western T r a d i t i o n , w i t h a view t o e i t h e r ( a ) uncovering t h e i r
b a s i c p r e s u p p o s i t i o n s and/or ( b ) comparing them w i t h t h e m y s t i c a l
t r a d i t i o n i n t h e Orient.
I n s t r u c t o r : Fuehrer
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
Enrollment: 25
Grading: t r a d i t i o n a l
Tlme:
II
Room: 2
No
Department o f P h y s i c s
84 16 1
Understand i ng t h e Weather
An i n t r o d u c t i o n t o t h e e a r t h ' s weather, i t s causes and c h a r a c t e r . Designed f o r t h o s e i n t e r e s t e d i n weather and weather p r e d i c t i o n , t h i s
course assumes no p r i o r s c i e n c e o r mathematics background. T o p i c s t o
be discussed i n c l u d e : t h e r e l a t i o n s h i p o f sun, e a r t h and atmosphere;
i m p o r t a n t p h y s i c a l q u a n t i t i e s such as t e m p e r a t u r e and p r e s s u r e ; c l o u d s
and p r e c i p i t a t i o n ; unusual c o n d i t i o n s I i ke t o r n a d o s and h u r r i c a n e s ;
t e c h n i q u e s and i n s t r u m e n t a t i o n f o r weather m o n i t o r i n g and c o n t r o l ; and
t h e i n f l u e n c e o f weather on p o l l u t i o n . P o s s i b l e course a c t i v i t i e s i n c l u d e e x p e r i m e n t a t i o n and f o r e c a s t i n g , f i e l d t r i p s and g u e s t speakers.
I n s t r u c t o r : E r i ckson
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l l m e n t : 35
Grading: T r a d i t i o n a l
Time:
II
Room: 22
84322
Yes
R a d i a t i o n D e t e c t i o n and Measurements
A s t u d y o f r a d i o a c t i v i t y f r o m b o t h an e x p e r i m e n t a l and t h e o r e t i c a l
basis.
L a b o r a t o r y e x p e r i e n c e u s i n g v a r i o u s d e t e c t i o n and measurement
systems f o r b o t h charged p a r t i c l e and gamma r a d i a t i o n t o g e t h e r w i t h
i s o t o p i c n e u t r o n sources f o r t h e p r o d u c t i o n o f r a d i o i s o t o p e s . P r o d u c t i o n
o f r a d i o a c t i v e isotopes, energy and h a l f - l i f e measurement, c o u n t i n g
s t a t i s t i c s , a b s o r p t i o n and m o d e r a t i o n o f r a d i a t i o n , s t a n d a r d i z a t i o n ,
n e u t r o n a c t i v a t i o n a n a l y s e s and h e a l t h p h y s i c s c o n s i d e r a t i o n .
The
c o u r s e i s planned t o be a c o o p e r a t i v e v e n t u r e w i t h t h e S p e c i a l T r a i n i n g
D i v i s i o n o f Oak Ridge A s s o c i a t e d U n i v e r s i t i e s . S u b j e c t t o a p p r o v a l o f
t h e P h y s i c s Department and t h e O.R.A.U.
The c o u r s e w i l l be t a u g h t i n
Special T r a i n i n g
f u l l o r i n p a r t a t t h e l a b o r a t o r i e s o f t h e O.R.A.U.
D i v i s i o n , Oak Ridge, Tennessee.
--
I n s t r u c t o r : Paulson
Di s t r i b u t i o n requ i rement: No
Enrollment:
15
P r e r e q u i s i t e : Consent o f I n s t r u c t o r
Grading: O p t i o n a l
Time:
III
Room: 22
Fees: T r a v e l expense t o Oak Ridge, Tennessee
Department o f Psycho l o g y
86215
Mechanisms o f Animal Behavior
The course w i l l examine animal b e h a v i o r from lower a n i m a l s ( i n v e r t e b r a t e s ) t h r o u g h humans. M a j o r t o p i c s w i l l i n c l u d e b e h a v i o r a l e v o l u t i o n , b e h a v i o r a l development, and s o c i a l b e h a v i o r i n b o t h animal s and
humans. ( P r i o r s t u d y o f psychology and/or b i o l o g y w i l l be h e l p f u l t o
t h e s t u d e n t b u t i s n o t a s t r i c t requirement.)
I n s t r u c t o r : Ferguson
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
Enrol lment: 25
Grading: O p t i o n a l
Time:
III
Room: 205
86370
Yes
Creativity
C o o p e r a t i v e group i n q u i r y i n t o f a c t o r s and c o n d i t i o n s t h a t c o n t r i b u t e
toward c r e a t i v e b e h a v i o r and t h a t make such b e h a v i o r more p o s s i b l e and
l i k e l y . C o n s i d e r a t i o n o f a p p r o p r i a t e d e s c r i p t i o n and d e f i n i t i o n o f
c r e a t i v e b e h a v i o r . A c t i v e o b s e r v a t i o n o f persons, a c t i v i t i e s , and p r o d u c t s t h a t may a i d u n d e r s t a n d i n g o f t h e c r e a t i v e process.
I n s t r u c t o r : D. Johnson
D i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t : No
Enrol lment: 25
Grad i ng : P/NC
Time:
II
Room: 2 13
A d d i t i o n a l Costs: $25-$50 f o r t r a n s p o r t a t i o n , m a t e r i a l s and admission
t o Twin C i t y i n s t i t u t e s and performances
Department o f P o l i t i c a l Science
85250
Arner i can Pos i ti ve S t a t e
The p o l i t i c s o f p u b l i c a d m i n i s t r a t i o n and b u r e a u c r a t i c p o l i c y - m a k i n g
i n t h e American w e l f a r e - w a r f a r e s t a t e : governmental r e g u l a t i o n ,
p r o m o t i o n and management, emphasizing p o l i t i c a l and e x o n m i c i n t e r a c t i o n .
I n s t r u c t o r : Stenshoe l
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement: Yes
E n r o l l ment : 30
Grad i ng : Opt iona I
Time:
I I and I l l , Mon., Thurs.
Room: S34
85358
The Urban Powerful
Study o f t h e l i n k s between t h e urban p o w e r f u l and t h e e l e c t e d s t a t e
policy-makers, t a k i n g t h e Twin C i t i e s - M i n n e s o t a l e g i s l a t u r e as a case
s t u d y . E x p l o r a t i o n o f who speaks f o r t h e urban area, t h r o u g h what
communication channels, w i t h what messages by means o f s i m u l a t i o n , f i e l d
work i n t h e c i t y and a t t h e s t a t e l e g i s l a t u r e , and seminar sessions.
I n s t r u c t o r : Hedblom
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l l ment : 30
Grad i ng : P/NC
II
Time:
Room:
19
85385
Yes (Urban)
L i f e S t y l e s i n Soviet Society:
Focus o n Youth
Study c o u r s e conducted i n t h e U.S.S.R.,
emphasizing t h e theme o f t h e
r o l e s , a t t i t u d e s , mores, i n t e r e s t s , o c c u p a t i o n s , and a c t i v i t i e s o f S o v i e t
youth.
I n s t r u c t o r : Noonan
D i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t : Yes
E n r o l l m e n t : 20
Grading: O p t i o n a l
P r e r e q u i s i t e s : P.S. 351 ( f o r m e r l y 51)
and p e r m i s s i o n o f i n s t r u c t o r .
Russ i an l ang uage recommended b u t
not required.
.
Department o f Re l i q i o n
8736 1
Church F a t h e r s
The development o f some fundamental d o c t r i n e s from t h e t i m e o f t h e
Aposto l i c F a t h e r s t h r o u g h Aug.ust,i ne.
Instructor: O l l i l a
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirementt
E n r o l l m e n t : 35 .
P r e r e q u i s i t e : 1 1 1 o r 22'1
Gradi ng : Opt ionail
Time:
I
Room: S22
Yes
,
87370
Myth:
I t s F u n c t i o n and Meaning
A s t u d y o f s e v e r q ) myths o f e y i l from t h e v i e w p o i n t o f t h e i r s o c i a l
and p s y c h o l o g i ~ a l function, t o g e t h g r w i t h a phenomenological a n a l y s i s
o f t h e i r meaning. Myths t o be c o n s i d e r e d a r e : The B a b y l o n i a n Creat i o n Myth (Enuma E l i s h ) , fhe Adqmic Myth o f t h e B i b l e , Sophoclesl
Oedipus Rex ( t r a g i c myth), and t h e O r p h i c ~ ~ to fh t'h e Greeks. Viewp o i n t s t a k e n w i l l be t h o s e a f s e l e c t e d a n t h r o p o l o g i s t s , p s y c h o a n a l y s t s
( e s p e c i a l l y Freud), and t h e p h a n ~ r n g n o l p 9 i s t s , M i r c e a E l i a d e and Paul
Ri coeur.
I n s t r u c t o r : Benson
D i s t r i but ion 'requirement:
E n r o l l m e n t : 25
P r e r e q u i s i t e - : 111 o r .I21
Grading: O p t i o n a l
Time:
II
Room: 18
87486
Yes
The R e l i g i o u s l m a g i n a t l o n i n Modern ' L i t e r a t u r e
S e l e c t e d n o v e l s and p l a y s used a s t h e b a s i s f o r d i s c u s s i n g t h e a r t i s t ' s
development o f images f o r God and t h e r e l i g i o u s l i f e .
I n s t r u c t o r : Skl bbe
Di s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t :
E n r o l lment: 35
P r e r e q u i s i t e : 1 1 1 o r 221
Grading: O p t i o n a l
Time:
III
Room: 212
Yes
Department o f S o c i o l o g y
941 1 1
Human Community and t h e Modern Mefropo l i s
'
An i n n o v a t i v e l o o k a t t h e dynamics and p o t e n t i a l s f o r community i n
t h e modern m e t r o p o l i s by f o c u s i n g upon an i s s u e o f c u r r e n t community
concern i n t h e Twin C i t y M e t r o p o l i t a n Area. S t u d e n t s w i l l become a
p a r t o f t h e M e t r o p o l i t a n decision-making p r o c e s s by i n v o l v i n g thems e l v e s i n g r o u p s o r w i t h persons a t t e m p t i n g t o i n f l u e n c e t h e process.
For example, had t h e i n t e r i m been o f f e r e d i n January 1972, t h e course
c o u l d have focused upon t h e c o n s t r u c t i o n o f an I n d i a n C e n t e r on p a r k
land o r m i n o r i t y h i r i n g i n a m u n i c i p a l f i r e department. Background
r e a d i n g w i I I be assigned t o p r o v i d e a conceptual framework b u t p r i m a r y
emphasis w i l l be on p a r t i c i p a n t o b s e r v a t i o n .
I n s t r u c t o r : Nelson
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l l m e n t : 35
Grading: O p t i o n a l
Time:
I
Room: 28
94257
Yes (Urban)
V o l u n t e e r S e r v i c e and Independent Study
With f a c u l t y approval, s t u d e n t s e l e c t s a placement as a f u l l - t i m e
v o l u n t e e r i n a s o c i a l agency o r i n s t i t u t i o n . O p p o r t u n i t y t o know
s o c i a l work p r o f e s s i o n a l s , s o c i a l s e r v i c e d e l i v e r y systems, and c a r e e r
aspects i n t h e h e l p i n g vocations.
lndependent s t u d y w i t h a t e r m paper
r e p o r t and r e v i e w conferences.
E s p e c i a l l y recommended f o r freshmen
and sophomores
.
I n s t r u c t o r : Steen
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
Enrol lment: 12
Grading: O p t i o n a l
Time:
I
Room: 23
94357
No
B a s i c S k i l l s i n Casework o r Groupwork
A f u l l - t i m e f i e l d placement i n a s o c i a l agency f o r l e a r n i n g by p r a c t i c e
casework o r groupwork.
I n s t r u c t o r : Steen
D i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i rement:
E n r o l lment: 12
Grading: T r a d i t i o n a l
Time:
I
Room: 23
No
Department o f Speech, Communication,
98354
and T h e a t e r A r t s
I n t e r p e r s o n a l Communication
An i n t r o d u c t i o n t o t h e dynamics o f i n t e r p e r s o n a l comnunication.
I n s t r u c t o r : Anderson
Distribution requirement:
E n r o l lment: 25
Grading: O p t i o n a l
Time:
III
Room: 43
98255
Yes
Black Theater
A h i s t o r i c a l s u r v e y o f American B l a c k T h e a t e r w i t h emphasis on r e c e n t
works.
I n s t r u ' c t o r : 0 l son '
O i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i rement:
E n r o l lment: 25
Grad i n g : Opt iona l
Time:
II
Room: 40
98285
No
T h e a t e r P r a c t icum
Students accepted f o r t h i s course w l l l work f u l l - t i m e on t h e p r o d u c t i o n
o f a play.
I n s t r u c t o r : Cole
D i s t r i b u t i o n requirement:
E n r o l l m e n t : 20
Grading: O p t i o n a l
Time: TBA
No
94379
L l f e and C u l t u r e o f American l n d l a n s
An a t t e m p t t o understand t h e l i f e and c u l t u r e o f t h e American I n d i a n
t h r o u g h f i e l d t r i p s and v i s i t s , speakers, and r e a d i n g s . A l t h o u g h t h e
form o f t h e i n t e r i m may v a r y from y e a r t o year, t h e i n t e n t i s t o l i m i t
t h e scope o f t h e course t o u n d e r s t a n d i n g a few a s p e c t s o f I n d i a n l i f e
i n depth.
I n s t r u c t o r : Gerasimo
D i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t : No
E n r o l lment: 15
Grading: O p t i o n a l
Time:
II
Room: L201
Fee: Trave 1 expense t o r e s e r v a t i o n s i n n o r t h e r n Minnesota
94480
The New-Town Movement and the.Modern M e t r o p o l i s
A s t u d y o f such new-towns as Columbia, Maryland, Jonathan, and CedarR i v e r s i d e , Minnesota. An e x a m i n a t i o n o f t h e i r r o l e L i n t h e p l a n n i n g and
development o f comprehensive communities i n modern m e t r o p o l i t a n r e g i o n s .
A v i s i t t o COI umbia Maryland, w i 1 l supp lement more i n t e n s i v e s t u d y o f
t h e Jonathan and Cedar-Riverside developments. Background r e a d i n g
on t h e New Town movement i n Europe w i 1 l p r o v i d e conceptual framework
f o r t h e study.
I n s t r u c t o r : Torstenson
D i s t r i b u t i o n r e q u i r e m e n t : No
Enrol 1 ment : 20
II
Time:
Room: 28
P r e r e q u i s i t e : Upperclass s t a n d i n g o r p e r m i s s i o n on i n s t r u c t o r
Grading: O p t i o n a l
-
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
ST. OLAF COLLEGE INTERIM ABROAD
3 t o 31 JANUARY 1973
ART:
The A r t s o f Norway.
ASIAN STUDIES:
$625
Drama i n Japan.
Tokyo, Osaka, and Kyoto.
BIOLOGY: Human Ecology i n I s r a e l . P r e r e q u i s i t e s :
one semester o f b e h a v i o r a l s c i e n c e . $800
CLASSICS:
Mediterranean C u l t u r e .
ECONOMICS-POLITICAL SCIENCE:
S w i t z e r l and and I t a l y.
$625
ENGLISH-SPEECH:
$895
one semester o f b i o l o g y and
Greece w i t h C r e t e .
$675
Systems and I n s t i t u t i o n s i n England,
T h e a t e r i n London.
France,
$625
FRENCH: T h e a t e r , C i v i l i z a t i o n , Language. P a r i s . Planned p a r t i c u l a r l y f o r
s t u d e n t s c o n t i n u i n g i n t o t h e Term i n Avignon b u t open t o o t h e r s a d e q u a t e l y
p r e p a r e d i n t h e language.
$600
GERMAN: T h e a t e r , C i v i l i z a t i o n , Language. Vienna. Planned f o r s t u d e n t s
c o n t i n u i n g i n t o t h e Term i n Germany b u t open t o o t h e r s adequate1 y p r e p a r e d
i n t h e language.
$600
INTERDISCIPLINARY:
London.
$625
MUSIC:
E n g l i s h and I r i s h F o l k s o n g and Folkdance.
C o n c e r t s , Operas, Music H i s t o r y .
NURSING:
RELIGION:
Munich, S a l z b u r g , Vienna.
H e a l t h Care D e l i v e r y Systems i n Norway and Denmark.
POLITICAL SCIENCE:
Youth i n S o c i a l i s t S o c i e t y .
C h r i s t i a n Rome.
Principal location
$625
$800
$625
SPANISH:
I n t e n s i v e Language Program ( i n t e r m e d i a t e ) i n Cuernavaca.
including transportation.
SPANISH:
l n t e n s i ve Language Program (advanced) i n Cuernavaca.
cluding transportation.
SPANISH-ART:
$625
Mexican C i v i l i z a t i o n .
$325, n o t
$335, n o t i n -
$450
The c o s t s a r e based on r o u n d - t r i p c h a r t e r t r a n s p o r t a t i o n between M i n n e a p o l i s and
Europe, i n t e r - E u r o p e a n t r a n s p o r t a t i o n , accommodation and t w o m e a l s p e r day,
p r o r a t i n g o f f a c u l t y p a r t i c i p a t i o n , e n t r a n c e f e e s t o performances, i nsurar~ce
and a d m i n i s t r a t i v e fee.
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Catalog, 1956-1958
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
AUGSBURG COLLEGE AND
THEOLOGICAL SEMINARY
Minneapolis 4, Minnesota
Founded 1869
CATALOG RECORD FOR
1956
-
1957
and
1957
-
1958
ANNOUNCEMENTS FOR
1958
- 1959
and
1959
VOL. XX, NO. 1
-
1960
CATALOG NUMBER
JANUARY-FEBRUARY, 1958
THE AUGSBURG BULLETIN
Published bimonthly and one...
Show more
AUGSBURG COLLEGE AND
THEOLOGICAL SEMINARY
Minneapolis 4, Minnesota
Founded 1869
CATALOG RECORD FOR
1956
-
1957
and
1957
-
1958
ANNOUNCEMENTS FOR
1958
- 1959
and
1959
VOL. XX, NO. 1
-
1960
CATALOG NUMBER
JANUARY-FEBRUARY, 1958
THE AUGSBURG BULLETIN
Published bimonthly and one additional
issue in April
by Augsburg College and
Theological Seminary at Minneapolis, Minnesota. Enfered as second-class matter March
21. 1947, at the post osce at Minneapolis, Minnesota, under the act of August 24, 1912.
LMLLNUAK
1957
1958
SEPTEMBER
S
M
T
W T
F
MAY
JANUARY
S
S
M
T
W
T
F
S
S
M
T
W
T
F
S
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4
1 2 3
8 91011121314 5 6 7 8 91011 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 0
15161718192021 12131415161718 11 121314151617
29 23 24 25 26 27 28 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
99 30
95 26 27 28 29 30 31
26 27 28 29 30 31 -
OCTOBER
FEBRUARY
1 2 3 4 5
1
6 7 8 9101112 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
13141516171819 9 1011 1213 1415
2021 2223242526 161718192021 92
93 24 25 26 27 28
27 28 29 30 31
JUNE
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 91011121314
15161718192021
22232425262728
29 30
MARCH
NOVEMBER
1
1 2
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
1011 1213141516 9 1011 1213 1415
1 7 1 8 1 9 2 0 2 1 2 2 ~ 161718192021 22
24 25 26 27 28 29 30 $: 32; 25 26 27 28 29
JULY
1 2 3 4 5
6789101112
13141516171819
20912223242526
27 28 29 30 31
DECEMBER
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 9 1011 1 2 1 3 1 4
15161718192021
29 23 24 95 26 27 28
29 30 31
APRIL
AUOUST
1 9
1 9 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 1011 751 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
13141516171819 I011 1P13141516
20 21 22 23 24 25 96 t J 10 1990 21 29 23
27 28 29 30
g 2526Q7282930
M
T
W T
F
MAY
JANUARY
SEPTEMBER
S
S
S
M
T
W
T
F
S
1 2 3
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 910111213 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 0
14151617181920 11 121314151617
91222324252627 18192021222324
35 26 27 28 29 30 31
28 29 30
S
M
T
W
T
F
S
1 2
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
1011 12131415 16
17181920212223
$: 25 26 27 28 29 30
FEBRUARY
JUNE
OCTOBER
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8 9 1011 8 9 1011 191314 7 8 9 1011 1213
12131415161718 15161718192021 14151617181920
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 19 23 24 25 26 27 28 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
98 29 30
96 27 28 29 30 31
NOVEMBER
MARCH
JULY
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4
1
9 3 4 5 6 7 8 8 9 1011 121314 5 6 7 8 9 loll
9 1011 12131415 15161718192021 12 1314151617 18
161718192021 22 92232425262728 192021 22232425
96 27 28 29 30 31
24 25 26 9 7 28 29 99 30 31
::
DECEMBER
APRIL
AUGUST
I 2 3 4 5 6
1 9 3 4
1
7 8 9 1011 1213 5 6 7 8 9 1011 4 3 4 5 6 7 8 ,
1415 161718 1920 19 13 1415161718 9 1011 1 2 1 3 7 4 1 5
21222324252627 192021 22232425 u 1 7 ' I 8 1 9 9 0 1 1 22
9 8 29 30 31
2627282930
g i g 9596372%29
TABLE OF CONTENTS
PAGE
4
Academic Calendar
-
General Information
5
----
Financial Information
14
Student Community Life The College -
-
Academic Administration
-
21
34
--34
-
42
Curriculums
-
Courses of Study
53
Division of Religion and Philosophy
55
Division of the Humanities ....-.
59
--
Division of the Social Sciences
Division of the Natural Sciences and Mathematics
General Requirements
96
-.--.
Courses of Study
.
96
1
0
0
-----
Board of Trustees
Administration
86
...........-...-----
--
The Theological Seminary
107
-
,.--lo8
-109
Committees of the Faculty
The Faculty
--
Graduates
Student Enrollment
Index
72
1
D
-m
-
1
0
-
-120
1
2
3
.--.I26
,
CALENDAR
1958 - 59 and 1959 - 60
FIRST SEh4ESTER
Sept. 11-16
Freshman Days
Sept. 10-15
Sept. 11, 16
Registration
Sept. 14, 15
Sept. 17
College classes begin
Sept. 16
Sept. 17
Seminary convenes
Sept. 16
s p t . 17
Late registration fee
Sept. 16
Oct. 24-26
Homecoming
Oct. 23-21
Nov.
End of first half of semester
Nov.
Nov. 27, 28
Thanksgiving recess
Nov. 26, 27
Dec. 19, 4:zo p.m.
Christmas ,recess begins
Dec. 18, 4:zo p.m.
Jan. j, 8:00 a.m.
Classes resume
Jan. 4. 8:00 a.m.
Jan. 19-23
College examinations
Jan. 20-26
Jan. 20-23
Seminamry examinations
Jan. 21-26
Jan. 23
First Semester ends
Jan. 26
Jan. 16-29
Registration for Second
Semester
Jan. 18-Feb.
12
I2
I
SECOND SEMESTER
Feb. 2, 8:00 a.m.
Classes begin
Feb. 3. 8:00 a.m.
Feb.
2
Late registration fee
Feb. 3
Feb.
12
Lincoln's Birthday
Washington's Birthday
April 3
End of first half af semester
Feb.
22
April
I
Maroh 2j, 4:20 p.m. Easter recess begins
April 13, 4:zo p.m.
March 3 I , 8:oo a.m. Easter recess ends
April 19, 8:00 a.m.
May
Seminary Commencement
May 27
May 25-29
Collage Examinations
May 27-June 3
May 30
Memorid Day
May 30
May 31
Bac,cala.ureate Service
June 5
June
College Commencement
June 6
22
I
GENERAL INFORMATION
PURPOSE
Augsburg College is a four-year liberal arts college sponsored by
the Lutheran Free Church for the purpose of giving young people
an opportunity to obtain a broad education in a Christian en\''Ironment. In addition to securing a general education at the college level,
students may prepare themselves for such vocations as high school teaching, business administration, social work, medical technolog!-, secretarial work, parish work, and missions. They may prepare for further
study in the fields of dentistry, engineering, law, medicine, nursing, and
theology, as well as for graduate study in various fields.
Augsburg Theological Seminary, with its facilities on the same campus, offers a three-year course of study leading to a Bachelor of
Theology degree. Its chief purpose is to prepare pastors and missionaries for the Lutheran Free Church.
LOCATION
Augsburg College and Theological Seminary is located in the Riverside Park area of hlinneapolis. rrithirl t r a l k i ~ pJ i s t a n c ~uf the main
I~usir~ess
section 01 tl~rcil!. Science Hall. containing the administration cifficeh. is located at lhe corner nf 5 e ~ e n t hStreet and Twenty-first
A\eriue South. .Iugshurg studenb have tlic a d r a ~ ~ t a gofe getting their
~ o l l t : ~ ceducalion
:
i n a metropolitan renter pulsating with industrial.
social. and cultural activitira. They hare acre33 to libraries. museums.
a11tl art ccrllcctiarls. The! m a v hear the best in music and lectures.
Minneapolis is recognized throughout the nation as a vital center of
relieil~ui life and nctitily. Out5ta11dii1gleaders in many Gelds both
from ,,her part9 of hrncrica and from fureipri ct~untriesare frequent
vi~iit~rb.
College students iu t l ~ r . Twill Cities have abundant opportunity tn contact conternporar?- :llnerican life a t one of its foc:aI points.
ACCREDITATION
Augsburg College is accredited by the North Central Association
of Colleges and Secondary Schools, the regional accrediting agency
for colleges and universities. It is approved by the Minnesota Department of Education for the training of secondary school teachers. The
teacher education program in home economics has been approved for
the preparation of teachers of federally aided high school departments
in this field.
AUGSBURG
COLLEGE
AND
THEOLOGICAL
SE~ARY
HISTORICAL SKETCH
Augsburg was begun as a seminary in 1869, at Marshall, Wisconsin.
It was the first theological seminary founded by Norwegian Lutherans
in America. Through an arrangement with a private institution known
as Marshall Academy, the Seminary was at first housed in the academy
building. Students who needed further preparation in academic subjects were to obtain this in the academy. This arrangement failed to
work out satisfactorily; so the seminary moved to a private dwelling,
where classes continued until 1872. In the autumn of that year Augsburg Seminary was removed to Minneapolis, Minnesota, where a
building had been erected for its use. In the same year the school was
incorporated under the laws of Minnesota. The aim of the institution
was to train ministers for the Lutheran congregations which were being
organized in growing numbers in the pioneer settlements that were
spreading rapidly over the Northwest.
The college was established when it became evident that in order
to get students who were adequately prepared for theological study
a college department was needed. In 1874 a college curriculum was
planned which provided for one year of preparatory studies and four
years of college work along two lines, a classical course to prepare
students for theology, and a scientific course to prepare for other
professions. The latter course, however, was later discontinued, partly
for lack of funds and partly because too few students selected the
course. The first college students were enrolled in 1874 and the first
class was. graduated in 1879.
In 1900 a high school course covering three years was established
which in 1910 was expanded to a standard four-year course. This
was discontinued in 1933. In the years 1916-1919 the college course
was thoroughly revised. As a result of this and of subsequent growth,
the earlier classical course was greatly modified and supplemented by
social and scientific studies and a more general emphasis upon the
study of the humanities. In recent years there has been continuous
study and modification of the curriculum including the introduction
of a number of new majors to meet the developing needs of the students. The Divisional organization was adopted in 1945. At the present
time majors are offered in 17 fields.
Coeducation was introduced in the College in 1921.
Recent years, especially since the close of World War 11, have witnessed a greatly increased enrollment and a corresponding expansion of
physical facilities both in campus area and in buildings.
In the Theological Seminary there has likewise been a continuing
revision of the curriculum and the addition of new courses to meet
changing needs. The requirement of a six-month period of internship
was added in 1939. Standards of admission have been raised so
that a bachelor's degree or equivalent is now the required scholastic
preparation.
While the Theological Seminary has its own organization, the Seminary and the College continue to function in close cooperation and as
integral parts of one institution.
Five presidents have served Augsburg during the course of its history. The terms of office of two of these cover a span of over half a
century. The first president was August Weenaas, who served from
1869 to 1876. He was succeeded by Georg Sverdrup, 1876 to 1907.
Sven Oftedal served from 1907 to 1911 and was followed by George
Sverdrup, whose term extended from 1911 to 1937. H. N. Hendrickson
served as acting president from 1937 until 1938. Bernhard Christensen,
the present president, has served since that time.
FUNDAMENTAL AIMS
The educational purposes of Augsburg College and Theological
Seminary spring from the conviction that in the Christian religion
there are revealed the most basic truths concerning both man and
God, and that Christianity is the fundamental force for good in human
life and society. All the aims of the College, as well as those of the
Seminary, are integrated with this principle.
Students who enroll at Augsburg are invited to take up their college
work with the distinct understanding that the Christian spirit is determining in all things. They are expected to cooperate wholeheartedly in
the program of the school towards that end. The entire program of the
school, curricular and extra-curricular, and the discipline necessary to
make possible the carrying out of this program, spring from the aim
"to see all things through the eyes of Christ."
To express more distinctly some major aspects of its program of
Christian higher education, the following statement of aims has been
formulated by the college faculty:
T o lead the student to a deeper understanding; and personal experience of the truth and power of the Christian Gospel, to the end
that he may become both an effective participant in the work of
the Christian Church and an earnest adirocate of the Christian way
of life.
AIJGSBURGCOLLEGE
AND THEOLOGICAL
SEMINARY
T o familiarize the student with the culture of our own and other
civilizations, not only for the enjoyment this knowledge affords
but also for the development of a more sympathetic understanding
of our fellow men throughout the world.
T o develop the student's interest in the attainment of the common
purposes of our country, so that he may work for the welfare of
our institutions and for the preservation of our liberties in community and nation, and also develop an enlightened interest and
participation in human affairs throughout the rest of the world.
T o cultivate in the student a Christian social spirit, in order that
he may realize in his life a right balance between what he expects
of others and the service he will render his fellow men.
T o teach the student to discipline his own urges, interests, ambitions, and demands in a way that will effectively contribute toward
the development of good character.
T o train the student i n scientific methods of study and also develop his understanding of the relations of science to the welfare of
humanity.
T o stimulate intellectual interest and develop scholarly insight,
so that the student may learn to think with accuracy and comprehension at the same time as he experiences an understanding of
truth which will help him to integrate the findings of science with
the deepest spiritual reality.
T o awaken and foster i n the student an intelligent appreciation
and enjoyment of the best in-the fields of the fine arts.
T o guide the student in the understanding of social relatio'nships
in order that he may take his place in groups and gatherings with
propriety and grace, motivated in his conversation and conduct by
the principles of Christian courtesy and sincerity.
T o provide guidance for the student in the discovery and clarification of his aptitudes and his life purposes so that as early as
possible he may plan his educational program wisely.
T o train students in vocational and professional lines, giving full
preparation for high school teaching, business administration, home
economics, and parish work; furnishing partial training towards
the study of medicine, dentistry, nursing, engineering, law, and
social service, and offering a four-year college course preparing
for the study of theology.
T o help the student develop certain skills, as in language, music,
physical activities, use of the library, laboratory work, and typewriting, together with other skills, which will increase his efficiency
in the various relationships of life.
To afford the student wholesome recreational experience which
will contribute toward an effective use of leisure time and develop
such qualities as leadership, sportsmanship, and self-control, with
good recreational habits, thus providing a constant source of social
and personal satisfaction.
To instruct the student in principles, attitudes, and ideas pertuining to health, and also to train him in practices and skills which
will promote his physical and mental well-being and make him
better fit to meet the responsibilities of life.
FINANCIAL SUPPORT AND CORTTROL
From 1870 to 1890, Augsburg was supported by the NorwegianDanish Lutheran Conference. The merger of that church body with
two others, in 1890, resulted in the affiliation of Augsburg with the
newly created United Norwegian Lutheran Church. Due to differences
concerning the control of Augsburg, a division arose, and in 1897 congregations whose sympathies were deeply rooted in Augsburg formed
the Lutheran Free Church. The resulting close association, in educational and spiritual activity, of Augsburg and the Lutheran Free Church
has been marked by unity of purpose and ideals for more than half a
century.
The control exercised by the Lutheran Free Church is indirect. The
Annual Conference of the Church nominates the members of the
Augsburg Corporation and the Board of Trustees. The Corporation
through the Board of Trustees exercises direct control over property,
finance, and personnel. Academic control is vested in the President
and the Faculty.
In addition to the income from student tuition and fees, which has
materially increased with the growth and development of the College,
the chief financial support of the institution comes from the congregations of the Lutheran Free Church. In recent years a growing circle
oI friends also outside the Lutheran Free Church, both alumni and
others, have contributed financially to the school. Since 1951, business
and industry have given significant support through the Minnesota
Private College Fund. Augsburg welcomes and invites support on the
part of all who believe in her program of vital Christian education.
MEMBERSHIP IN EDUCATIONAL ASSOCIATIONS
Augsburg College is fully accredited by the North Central Association of Colleges and Secondary School as a degree-granting institution.
It is a member of the American Council on Education, the Association
of American Colleges, the National Lutheran Educational Conference,
the Association of Minnesota Colleges, and the Council of Minnesota
Private Colleges.
THE ALUMNI ASSOCIATION
The Augsburg Alumni Association has as its goal to enable the
graduates of the College and Seminary to maintain effective contact
and cooperation with one another and with their Alma Mater. The
annual meeting is held at Commencement time each year. Local Augsburg clubs are promoted, and a bi-monthly bulletin is published. The
affairs of the Association are under the leadership of the Board of
Directors. The Alumni Office is located in Science Hall.
THE AUGSBURG FOUNDATION
The Augsburg Foundation is an association of alumni, former students, and other friends of Augsburg, having as its purpose to give
united and systematic support, both spiritual and financial, to the
school. The Foundation was established in 1941 by join,t action of the
Board of Trustees and the Alumni Association. Since 1956 its activities
have been closely coordinated with the development program of the
college.
EDUCATIONAL PLANT
BUILDINGS
The Main, erected in 1900, ,contains a large number of classrooms
and offices, the Chapel, and the museum.
Science Hall, erected in 1948-49, is a large and completely modern
building. It includes the general administration offices, well-equipped
laboratories for Chemistry, Physics, Biology and Home Economics; the
student organization offices and the student center; a small auditorium,
and several classrooms and faculty offices. On the fourth floor is the
Tower Prayer Chapel.
The George S v e r d r u ~Library, named in honor of Augsburg's fourth
president, was erected and dedicated in 1955. Adjacent to Science Hall
and of similar contemporary architectural design, it contains spacious
reading rooms, seminars, work rooms, a visual-education center, the
Augsburg Archives, and a number of classrooms and faculty offices.
There is stack space for approximately 100,000 volumes.
The classrooms and offices of the Theological Seminary are located
in one section of the Librarv building.
Sverdrup-Oftedal Memorial Hall, erected in 1938, is a modem, fireproof dormitory affording living quarters for about 150 men. On the
ground floor of this building is the college cafeteria and dining hall.
Sivertsen Hall, acquired in 1939, and remodeled in 1955 as a wing
of Gerda Mortensen Hall, provides comfortable modern housing for 45
women students.
The beautiful new Gerda Mortensen Hall located at 6th Street and
24th Avenue, was erected in 1955. It provides excellent and completely
modern housing for 125 women students, as well as apartments for the
resident 'head and her assistants.
Morton Hall and Miriam House are smaller dormitory houses, each
accommodating about 20 students.
The Gymnasium, a temporary structure, was erected in 1947 for the
College of the Federal Works Agency as a part of a program providing
educational facilities for veterans.
The Music Hall was acquired by purchase, also in 1947, and ha?
been remodeled to serve the needs of the music and drama departments.
A large number of dwellings have also been acquired in recent years
in the expanded campus area, and are in use for faculty, staff, and
married student housing.
The President's Home, a residence of modern architectural design
located at the south of the Square, was erected in 1949.
The Museum is located on the ground floor of the Main. Members
of the Alumni Association have presented many valuable gifts. There
are several collections: a Madagascar Collection, a Santal Collection,
and a considerable collection of rare minerals, curios, etc. Contributions
to the Museum are invited. Professor Landa is the curator.
AUGSBURG
COLLEGE
AND THEOLOGICAL
SEMINARY
THE ARCHIVES
Archive Society was organized in 1929, for the purpose of gathering documents, books, and other articles of historical
value. For a number of years a fire-proof room in the Main housed the
archives collections. With the erection of the George Sverdrup Library
in 1955, adequate, fire-proof quarters for the achives were provided.
Here are now found a large collection of periodicals, old and rare
books, manuscripts, letters, and pictures, and also about 1,000 volumes
of Norwegian-American literature, affording extensive resources for
scholarly research. Contributions to the Archives should be sent to Prof.
Iver Olson, Archivist.
The beautiful and spacious new George Sverdrup Library provides
a central study-workshop for both faculty and students. It contains
about 30,000 volumes, exclusive of pamphlets, all available on open
stacks. The two large reading rooms have book stacks and reading
tables arranged in such a way that a place for study is always close
.to the books one may need. Additional conveniences include conference rooms, where from 2 to 6 students may study together, and
seminar rooms for larger groups or small classes. A typing corner is
provided in the ground floor reading room.
The library subscribes to about 325 of the best periodicals dealing
with a large variety of subjects, as well as a number of serials devoted
to the interests of special fields.
In the Twin City area other libraries are located which make their
holdings available to Augsburg students, notably, the St. Paul and
Minneapolis public libraries, the latter of which issues library cards to
out-of-town students for each school year; the James Hill Reference
Library in St. Paul, which has one of the finest reference collections
ir! the Northwest; and the University of Minnesota Library, which is
within walking distance of the Augsburg campus. Augsburg students
make extensive use of all these libraries.
The laboratories of the Natural Sciences are located in the Science
Hall. Three laboratories and two storerooms for Biology are located on
the second floor; three laboratories and a large storeroom for Chemistry, and a laboratory and two storerooms for Physics are located
on the third floor.
To facilitate instruction the college provides many excellent visual
and auditory aids. The audio-visual center is located on the ground
floor of the Library. Varied equipment is available for classroom use
and other college activities. This equipment includes: movie projectors,
slide and filmstrip projectors, a sound amplification system, a tape
recorder, an Episcope, phonographs, and a microcard reader. Records,
slides, maps, filmstrips, and microcards are also housed in this center.
Science Auditorium, as well as several classrooms, is equipped with
facilities for projection.
SPECIAL PROGRAMS OF STUDY
Evening classes are held as a community service for adults not enrolled in the day school. Announcement of courses to be offered are
made in the fall. Information about the evening school may be obtained from the office of the Dean.
Student nurses in the Schools of Nursing at the Lutheran Deaconess
and Swedish Hospitals in Minneapolis receive much of their first
semester of instruction at Augsburg College. Application for admission
to the Schools of Nursing should be made to the hospitals directly.
In cooperation with the Minneapolis General and Swedish Hospitals,
Augsburg offers work which enables the student to receive a college
degree with a major in Medical Technology. The first three years of
this work are taken at Augsburg and a final twelve-month program is
completed at the hospitals.
SPAN
Augsburg participates in the SPAN (Student Project for Amity
among Nations) program. This is a joint venture of the University of
Minnesota and several colleges in the state. Qualified students are
selected to spend a summer in informal study abroad. Applications are
made in the spring of the Sophomore year.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
A considerable part of the income on which Augsburg operates is
derived from endowment and from gifts, a major part of the latter
coming from the supporting church. Therefore, the fees charged the
student do not constitute the whole cost of his education, for he enjoys
the benefits of the gifts of those who believe in and support the work
of the school. For theological students, the church assumes the full
cost of tuition; a statement of other expenses in attending the seminary
is given in the Seminary section of the catalog.
GENERAL EXPENSES PER SEMESTER1
Tuition (Covers instruction, library, etc.) ..................................$250.00
Student activity fee (Covers school paper, annual, and other
.
9.00
student projects)
Health fee
6.00
5.00
Matriculation fee (for those registering the first time) .....
Key deposit (refundable)
1.00
Locker (optional)
1.00
Mail box fee
..
.
.50
.
Total
.$272.50
Books are estimated at $25.00 to $M.00.
Students registered for more than the maximum number of credit
hours (17 in the College) are charged at the rate of $12.00 for each
additional credit hour a week per semester.
Special students will pay at the rate of $22.00 per credit hour up
to 11credits. Those who register for 12 or more credit hours will pay
the regular tuition charge.
The fee for auditing a course is one-half the fee charged when it is
taken for credit.
Students and auditors enrolled for 7 to 11credit hours of class work
per week pay one-half of the student activity, and health fees.
ROOM AND BOARD PER SEMESTER1
Room
Board (estimate)
1
Subject to change.
..-$68.00 to 85.00
- 180.00
A limited number of rooms are available at the lower cost.
Men students are required to buy and use a minimum of
$150.00 of meal book coupons per semester. women students
$125.00.
SPECIAL FEES
Late registration fee per day (after classes begin) ......................
Change of registration after the beginning of the second week
of classes .
....
Registration with the Placement Bureau
Placement fee, depending upon the method
of placement ....
$3.00 to
Graduation fee, for seniors in both the College and Seminary..
Final examinations taken at another hour than the one
.......
scheduled -....
..........
.......
Examination making up an incomplete or a condition ............
Comprehensive examination -. . .
Transcript of credits (after first one which is free) ....................
MUSIC FEES PER SEMESTER
Piano
$35.00
Voice
35.00
.40.00
Organ
40.00
Brass or Wood wind (private instruction) Private instruction, per lesson
.
..
3.00
..........
14.00
Brass or Wood wind (class instruction)
. 8.00
Piano studio rental (one hour per day)
20.00
Qrgan rental (one hour per day)
4.00
Voice studio rental (one hour per day)
Choir ................................................................................................ 5.00
Concert Band
5.00
COURSE FEES PER SEMESTER1
4.00
Art 1. 2
2.00
Art7, 8 .3.00
Home Economics 2, 36, 75
.
5.00
Home Economics 39, 40
Biology 60 ....................................................................................1.OO. 2.00
2.50
Biology, 1, 2, 3N, 4, 52, 53, 56 -........
.
.
5.00
Biology 7N, 13, 14, 25, 26, and 54
.
1 Subiect ta change
AUGSBURG
COLLEGE
AND THEOLOGICAL
SEMINARY
1
Chemistry, 3N, 4
Chemistry 5, 6, 53, 54, 61, 62, 66, 71, 91, 92
Physics 3, 5, 6, 6 , 73, 74 .
.
Secretarial Studies 2, 8, 51, 52
Secretarial Studies 1, 53, 54
Education 97
A
5.00
7.50
5.00
.. 2.50
1.50
15.00
..
.
,
Note: These fees cover cost of material and repair of equipment but
not breakage.
ESTIMATED EXPENSES PER SEMESTER1
Resident students
General expenses .......................................................................$272.50
Room and Board ......................................................$ 2 . 0 0 to 265.00
Special, music, course fees, and books .................... 27.50 to 75.50
Total, approximately ............................................. 548.00 to 613.00
Off-campus students
-General expenses .
Special, music, course fees, and books --A
Total, approximately -
$ 2 7 2 . 5 0
27.50 to 75.50
300.00 to 348.00
These estimates do not include transportation, clothing, or
personal expenses.
PAYMENT OF ACCOUNTS
Student accounts are due in full at the time of registration in September and February. Parents may deposit money in advance at the
school or the student may make the payment when he registers. Recognizing that payment of fees in full at registration poses a financial
problem in some cases, the college has instituted a "deferred payment
plan." In this plan the college will accept, at the time of registration
in September and again in February, a payment of $200.00 in the
case of resident students and $100.00 for off-campus students. The
balance may be paid in monthly installments during the semester. To
defray the cost of the plan a charge of $1.00 is made for each payment
on the student's account after registration.
The college reserves the right to with-hold transcript of record or
diploma until all college bills have been paid.
1
Subiea to change.
REFUNDS
Tuition and fees for a student cancelling his registration before the
middle of any semester will be charged at the rate of 10 per cent per
week or fraction thereof, except for matriculation and special fees,
which are not refundable. There is no fee refund after the middle of
the semester.
Payments for board and room are refunded in proportion to the
time students have been in residence. Students who move out of dormitories but do not cancel out of school are charged the full semester
room rent.
FINANCIAL ASSISTANCE
Financial aids in the form of loan funds, scholarships, grants-in-aid,
and employment assistance are available at Augsburg. Students must
complete an application form and meet certain requirements to qualify
for financial aids. The college gives assistance to students in securing
work both on and off the campus.
LOAN FUNDS
Several loan funds have been established to assist students in working out their financial problems. Loans may be arranged at a reasonable rate of interest for various periods of time.
The General Student Loan Fund, established through the gifts of
many individual donors, is chiefly maintained by contributions from
the Augsburg College Women's Club.
The Olaf Rogne Fund, established in 1954, extends assistance to
students in the Seminary.
The Charles and ~lloraCrouch Student Loan Fund, established in
1954, extends assistance to members of all classes.
The Senior Loan Fund, established by the class of 1955, is available
to selected graduating seniors.
T h e John and Anna Jorgine Gregory Theological Student Loan Fund
is available to students who are preparing for the ministry.
T h e Student Aid Fund of the Zion Lutheran Hour, established by the
Zion Lutheran Church of Minot, North Dakota, likewise extends loans
to students preparing for the ministry.
Arrangements for the loans are made through a conference with the
Dean of Students, chairman of the faculty committee on student loans.
In addition to arranging loans, the committee counsels students on
financial matters with the objective in mind of helping the student work
out a satisfactory plan for his finances.
SCHOLARSHIPS AND PRIZES
Forty Freshman Scholarships of $300 each are available to outstanding high school graduates. Half of the $300 is applicable on the tuition
for the second semester of the Freshman year. The remainder is divided
between the Sophomore and Junior years provided the student's scholastic record is 2.0 or better.
The American Indian Scholarship was established in 1955 by Spring
Lake Park Lutheran Church, Minneapolis. It is a scholarship of
$200.00 to be applied on tuition at Augsburg College. It is to be
awarded to an American Indian student selected on the basis of
scholarship and economic need.
The Henry P . Opseth Music Scholarship was established in 1953 in
memory of Henry P. Opseth, former head of the Music Department
and director of the Augsburg College Choir. It is awarded annually
to a sophomore or junior student of outstanding promise or achievement in the field of music.
The Marilyn Solberg Voice Scholarship in memory of Marilyn
Yvonne Solberg, a member of the Augsburg College Choir from 1950
until the time of her death in 1953, was established in 1955 by her
parents, Mr. and Mrs. Iver Solberg and her brother, Dorvan. It is
awarded to an Augsburg student who has music as a major or minor
and who s h w s outstanding promise or achievement i-n -the -a-rt of
singing.
The George Sverdrup Graduate Fellowship was established by the
Board of Trustees of Augsburg in 1947 to honor the memory of
George Sverdrup, President of Augsburg from 1911 to 1937. It is
awarded annually to an Augsburg graduate of outstanding character
and ability who plans to prepare further for the vocation of teaching.
The amount of the Fellowship is five hundred dollars.
The Keith E . Hoffman Memorial Scholarship was established in
1945 by Mr. and Mrs. Charles S. Hoffman of Minneapolis in memory
of their son who gave his life in the conquest of Okinawa. The scholar-
ship is awarded annually to a student selected on the basis of academic
achievement, personal character, and ability in the field of athletics.
T w o Luthran Brotherhood Scholarships of $300 each are provided
by the Lutheran Brotherhood Life Insurance Society and awarded each
fall to outstanding Lutheran college seniors. The students are selected
by the college in the spring of the junior year on the basis of religious
leadership and scholastic standing.
The Augsburg College Women's Club Scholarship awards, totaling
$400, are granted each year to two or more students of outstanding
character and excellent scholarship.
The Adolph Paulson Memorial Prize, from a fund established by
members of the Paulson family in memory of Professor Adolph Paulson who taught Social Science at Augsburg from 1930 to 1935, is
awarded annually to a college student for the best essay written on an
assigned subject in the field of Christian Sociology. The amount of
the prize is $50.00.
The Iver and Marie Iversen Scholarship was established in 1957
through a grant from Mr. Iver Iversen of Brooklyn, New York. It is
awarded annually to a student in the College or Seminary. The award,
in the amount of $250, is made on the basis of need, scholarship, and
interest in Christian service.
The Celiu Fredrickson Scholarship consists of the income from a
fund of one thousand dollars. It is awarded annually to an Augsburg
student from the Lamberton, Minnesota, parish of the Lutheran Free
Church.
The Greater Augsburg Alumni Association Scholarship of $500 is
awarded annually to an outstanding alumnus of Augsburg in order to
encourage and assist promising students in the carrying out of projects
of graduate study.
The Women's Missionary Federation Scholarship is awarded by the
Federation to returned missionaries or to Lutheran students of recognized Christian character and good scholastic records who are making
preparation for mission work. The scholarship varies from $50.00 to
$250.00 per year. Higher awards are possible for graduate work or
rrledical study.
20
AUGSBURG
COLLEGE^
AND
THEOLOGICAL
SEMINARY
GRANTS-IN-AID
A few grants-in-aid are made to students in good standing who are in
special need of financial assistance. To qualify for a grant, a student
must make application, providing information about his own and his
family's resources and anticipated expenses.
EMPLOYME!NT SERVICE
The employment service, located in the Placement Office, has been
successful in placing hundreds of men and women students in parttime positions. The types of work secured are of many kinds, including recreational leadership, restaurant work, domestic service, sales
work, and secretarial and clerical work.
Students are employed by the college in many activities. For these
positions preference is given to upper-class students who have maintained a good scholastic average.
Assistance in securing summer employment is also provided each
spring by the Employment Service.
Application forms for part-time employment on or off campus may
be secured from the Admissions or Placement Offices.
STUDENT COMMUNITY LIFE
The influences which mould life and character on a college campus
are of many kinds. While the exercises of classroom, laboratory, and
library form the organizing basis of college activity, they need to
be supplemented by other than academic forces. These intangible but
very real supplementary influences have much to do with creating the
spirit of an institution. At Augsburg definite emphasis is placed upon
the maintenance of a wholesome spirit of Christian community living.
Students are urged to give conscious attention to this personal and
spiritual side of their development and thus contribute toward the
prevalence of a vital and happy Christian atmosphere on the campus.
It is the earnest desire of those who direct the policies of Augsburg
that the institution may constantly be permeated by an atmosphere in
which the quest for Truth as it is in Christ is prayerfully fostered in
each life.
All students are required to register for two class hours per week
in one of the courses offered in Religion. There are numerous voluntary religious activities in which students are encouraged to participate. Spiritual Emphasis Week is held twice each year. It is assumed
that every Augsburg student will find a church home in Minneapolis
and attend its services regularly.
It is expected of each student that his life, conduct, and influence,
both on and off campus, shall be worthy of a member of a Christian
College. Those who do not feel drawn to this quality of life and to the
fellowship in which it is nourished should not seek to be enrolled at
Augsburg. A truly Christian spirit and environment must be the
product of the united effort and prayer of faculty, students, and
administration.
The heart of Augsburg's program of Christian education is the daily
Chapel Service, where the faculty and students gather for united worship, prayer, and a brief meditation upon the Word of God. Regular
attendance is expected of all students.
The Religious Life Committee, composed of students and faculty,
endeavors to promote a religious program' that will stimulate growth
of Christian life in the Augsburg community. Co-chairmen of this
'
council are the student Director of Religious Activities and the College
Pastor. Areas for which this committee carries primary responsibility
are the Mid-Week services, Spiritual Emphasis Weeks, prayer meetings, and informal group meetings.
This committee also serves as a coordinating agency for all volunteer
Christian organizations on campus. The two principal organizations
are the Lutheran Student Association and the Mission Society.
The Mission Society promotes interest in missions through a program of study, fellowship, worship, and serdice. A highlight of the
year is the Mission Festival, a week-end conference devoted to the
study of missionary activity, and recruitment of workers. The Lutheran
Student Association seeks to serve as a stimulus and outlet for Christian faith and life. Students participate in regional and national LSA
Conferences, and conduct a schedule of meetings on campus.
The Concordia Society is an organization for all the students in the
Theological Seminary.
Regular convocation programs are held at Augsburg throughout
the year. These programs acquaint the campus community with outstanding personalities in various fields. A wide range of interests is
covered, including the scientific, political, social, religious, and artistic.
Students at Augsburg are given many opportunities for social training and recreation. The Student Council through the Chairman of
Social Activities, assisted by a Comlnittee on Social Education, sponsors each month an all-school social activity which all students may
attend. Most of these are informal. The Sophomore and Junior classes
sponsor semi-formal banquets. The Associated Women Students and
a number of other organizations sponsor teas, dinners, and social
affairs on and off campus. Social dancing is not approved of at
Augsburg.
"No man is a hypocrite in his pleasures." To learn to enjoy the
right form of recreational activities is an important aspect of preparation for life. At Augsburg there is a definite attempt to encourage the
formation of helpful recreational habit-patterns, not only with regard
to the planned play program supervised by the Director of Recreation
and the Department of Physical Education, but also with regard to
the use of leisure time in general.
STUDENT
COMMUNITY
LIFE
'C
MUSICAND THE FINEARTS
Augsburg's location in Minneapdis gives its students unique oppqrtunities to make use of some of the finest educational and cultural
advantages which the Northwest has to offer. Excellent art collections
are to be found in the Minneapolis Institute of Arts and the Walker
Art Center. The Twin City libraries are .extensive in their services.
The Historical Museum in St. Paul gives access to large collections of
historical material. The Minneapolis Symphony Orchestra programs
and other concerts afford rich opportunity for the enjoyment of music.
Many students and faculty attend Minneapolis Symphony Orchestra
concerts by virtue of a special college season ticket arrangement.
Season tickets are available also for other University concerts and
the University Theater drama programs.
A bi-weekly bulletin, Events of Interest in Minneapolis, listing programs, concerts, art displays and exhibitions is compiled and issued
from the Student Personnel Office.
STUDENT PERSONNEL SERVICES
Institutional services to students are organized and administered
in accordance with plans and policies established by the Student Personnel Committee. Included are such services as Counseling, Testing,
Freshman Orientation, Student Records, The Student Health Service,
Housing and Food Service, Placement, Student Employment, and Coordination of Student Activities. The administration of these services
is centered in the Office of the Dean of Students.
Under the counseling program at Augsburg each student is assigned
a faculty counselor to assist him in the planning of his total college
program. All faculty members participate in counseling. The broad
intellectual interests of the faculty member are combined with the
professional skill and techniques of trained counselors to provide
counseling- at various levels, and in many areas of student needs. Personal, social, and spiritual problems as well as vocational choice and
financial needs are given consideration.
As far as possible, the work of obtaining the necessary data about
the individual student and organizing the total program of counseling
is carried out by the Office of the Dean of Students in accordance with
the plans and policies established by the S t d e n t Personnel Committee.
These plans include testing, assignment of counselors, scheduling of
group conferences and counseling periods. Each new student is assigned a faculty member who is his counselor for two years. When
a student enters the Upper Division, he chooses a major field of study.
The major adviser then becomes his counselor. Faculty counselors
confer with their counselees at regular intervals throughout the year
and at other times as the needs of the individual student appear. If a
serious problem develops which demands professional skill and more
time than the professor has to spend in counseling, the student is referred by way of the Office of the Dean of Students to professionally
qualified counselors. The Dean of Women and the Dean of Students
are special counselors to the women and the men, respectively.
- -
Students receive vocational counseling in conference with their
counselors, and have frequent opportunities to confer with persons who
are eminently successful in the particular professions selected by
students as their tentative occupational choices. An Occupational Information file in the college library provides materials for a study of
vocations. The Orientation course, required of all freshmen, includes a
unit on vocational planning. The results of a vocational interest test
are available for all students.
Students who have various personal problems are encouraged to seek
help through counseling conferences. Often students have been able
to solve problems of finances, social adjustment, and personality
through counseling sessions.
Those who have spiritual problems may confer with the College
Chaplain, or with members of the Department of Religion as well as
with their faculty counselor. By a system of referral, students may
receive counsel from any member of the faculty, or from qualified
persons beyond the college community. The Personnel deans are available at all times for special counseling conferences.
The collegt physician is consulted in regard to all problems pertaining to physical and mental health.
Counselors and major advisers strive to help students develop their
latent ability. Students who distinguish themselves acad'imically are
named on the Dean's List, and are thereby qualified to participate
in a study program designed to develop their special talents to the
highest degree. Honor societies such as the Augsburg Guild o j Honor
and Lambda Iota T a u recognize students who have excelled in several
areas.
All new students are given a battery of tests during Freshinan Days.
College aptitude scores, English, and reading ability scores are used
by counselors to help students plan their initial programs. Personal
adjustment scores and the vocational interest test profile help the
students learn to know more about themselves, in order to make the
best choice of subjects and occupational goals. Sophomores participate in a nation-wide testing program. Seniors also take a nationally
standardized test.
Freshmen and other new students participate in Freshman Days
before the beginning of classes each semester. The students take tests,
inspect the college facilities, and become acquainted with their fellow
students, with the faculty, and especially with their own faculty counselors. The faculty counselors and students have several conferences
during which they plan the student's program of study.
All freshmen enroll in a class in Orientation. In this course, the
students learn about standards and requirements of various areas of
college life. Methods and habits of study and related techniques are
explored. Personal health, social adjustment, personal finances, and
vocational aims are discussed.
Individual student records are kept in the Records Office under the
supervision of the Registrar. These records include admissions data,
academic achievement, student participation and achievement in nonacademic activities, test scores, reports of counseling and other information.
The Student Personnel Office maintains a file of clubs and societies,
including the constitutions, activities, schedules, and membership roster.
The Student Health Service provides campus dispensary service
with a registered nurse in charge. The college physician has daily office
l~ours on campus for consultation and for emergency treatment.
Physical examinations are given all entering students and seniors.
Corrective treatment is prescribed where needed, including psychiatric
referral. Infirmary rooms are adjacent to the dispensary. The Health
Service is housed in a first floor section of Memorial Hall, the men's
residence hall.
Students, faculty, and staff have chest X-rays taken semi-annually
through the cooperation of the Hennepin County Tuberculosis Association Mobile Unit. The Department of Physical Education conducts a
program of recreation for all students. All freshmen are required to
take a course in personal and community health.
-
-
In its residence program, the college aims to develop in the students
Christian character, self-control, and thoughtful consideration of others.
All students not living at home must live in college operated or college
approved housing and take their meals in the college dining room.
Under certain conditions students may make other arrangements after
consultation with the Dean of Women or the Dean of Students. Single
students are not permitted to live in apartments.
Residence halls are open to students a day before regular schedules
become effective, and they close a day after. the term closes. Students
who wish to stay in residence during vacations must apply for the
privilege. Rooms are furnished except for bed linen, towels and blankets.
Laundry facilities are available in each residence. Bed linens and towels
may be rented with laundering service at a reasonable cost. This service
is required of all women students. An optional linen service is available
to men students.
Gerda Mortensen Hall, the residence for women, located at Sixth
Street and Twenty-fourth Avenue South, houses 160 women and provides a lounge, recreation facilities, and a room with grill service available to all students. Sverdrup-Oftedal Memorial Hall houses 150 men
and also contains the college dining rooms and the student health
service.
Students engage a room at the beginning of the fall semester for
the entire school year. Room reservations with deposit of $15 are required of all single students residing outside the Twin Cities. This
deposit is applied to the first semester's room rent. For new students it
should accompany the Admissions Deposit. Rooms for new students are
assigned in the late summer according to the date of application. Present
students must make room application and submit the deposit by May
15. After May 15 reservations for present students are assigned on
the same basis as for new students. Students who find it necessary to
cancel their room reservation will receive full refund of the deposit
if the cancellation is received by August 1, and half refund if it is
received by September 1.
City or suburban students may make application for residence housing. Their names will be placed on the waiting list, and they will be
assigned to rooms in regular order as vacancies occur. The room
deposit of $15 is required and is refundable in full should no room
become available.
PLACEMENT
GRADUATE
The Placement Bureau assists seniors and alumni in securing positions. Continuous contact is maintained with business, governmental,
welfare, and educational institutions and organizations at the local
as well as the state and national levels. Interviews are arranged both
on and off the campus. A registration fee and a small placement
fee are charged.
EMPLOYMENT
STUDENT
An employment service, located in the Placement Office, assists students in obtaining part time remunerative work.
OF STUDENT
ACTIVITIES
COORDINATION
The Coordinator of Student Activities assists student officers to
maintain effective functioning of student activities, and keeps on file
the club constitutions, rosters, and schedules of meetings. Faculty
sponsors are approved by the Coordinator.
The program af student activities is a primary responsibility of the
Student Council, legislative and executive body of the Augsburg Student Society. Faculty concern and responsibility for all student activities and the co-curricular program is assigned to the Faculty Council.
Liaison between the Student Council and the Faculty Council is the
function of the Student-Facdty Committee, whose special responsibility it is to promote student activity, and to keep the college activities
calendar. The Calendar is kept in the office of the Coordinator of Student Activities.
A weekly bulletin of events is furnished all college personnel by
the office of Student Personnel.
COMMUNITY STANDARDS AND DISCIPLINE
The Christian life implies an intimate relation to the person of Christ.
Although the claims of this life may not be indentical to, in fact may
go far beyond, the claims of any particular community, every community operates under some standards of life and conduct that give
character to it. Out of the religious and cultural traditions of Augsburg
has grown a way of life which is approved by the college and which it
regards as helpful in the development of its particular type of community. Those who elect to enroll at Augsburg are expected to be
guided by these general standards of conduct.
Confidence is placed in the individual student, but his habits and
conduct are matters of sincere concern and attention. It is the aspiration
of Augsburg to strengthen in each student the highest standards of
honesty, integrity, and charity in all his relationships and activities. Although the college does not accept full responsibility for the enforcement of all regulations as they pertain to the off-campus life of the
student, it is concerned about his behavior in every situation. It also
recognizes the original jurisdiction of the parent in the home.
Disciplinary problems are first dealt with through counseling. Those
not solved in this way are channeled to a faculty-student Committee on
Discipline through the office of the Dean of Students. In all such cases,
careful investigation and the privilege of a hearing precede any disciplinary action. The college reserves the right to dismiss any student whose
continuation in college is deemed undesirable.
In dealing with the alcohol problem, Augsburg seeks to have its students refrain from all use of alcoholic beverages. It specifically forbids
the possession or consumption of alcoholic beverages in dormitories, in
any college-approved place of residence, or at any college-sponsored
event. Any student who appears under the influence of alcohol is subject
to severe disciplinary action.
Every student is expected to know the college regulations, those
stated in the catalog as well as any additional ones that may be issued
for a given year.
STUDENT GOVERNMENT
The Augsburg Student Society, comprising the whole student body
of Augsburg College and Theological Seminary, is organized to conduct student affairs, develop student initiative and leadership, and
provide opportunity for practical experience in the democratic processes of group activity.
The administration of student government is delegated to the Student
Council, a representative group elected by the Student Society and the
various classes. Each of the college classes has its own officers and participates in student government through its representative on the
Council.
Augsburg is a member of the National Student Association.
The Student Council directs several projects of interest to the college
community. These projects include the annual One Appeal Campaign,
Leadership Training workshops, Courtesy Week, and Political Action
Week.
Counseling of freshmen by upper class students is conducted through
a College Brother-College Sister program.
Associated Women Students, composed of all the women students,
provide.; opportunity for the women to develop a degree of seIf government. It aims to create a sense of harmon? and fellowship, to promote and maintain high standard5 of honor and integrity in personal
conduct, and it encourages participation in all college activities. It is
affiliatd with the Intercollegiate Associated Women Students, a national
organization.
The Student Council office and the Council Room adjoin the Augsburg Echo and Augsburgian offices on the ground floor of Science
Hall. The student post office and Student Center occupy a prominent
place on the same floor, and serve as a focal point for student activities.
PUBLICATIONS
The Augsburg Echo, the college newspaper, is published by a student
stsff. The Faculty adviser teaches courses in journalism. Staff members
enrolled in the class earn academic credit.
Augsburg's yearbook, the A u g b u r g h , pra~-idesa pictorial record
of the activities of the year. Work on the annual provides opportunity
for creative expression in artietic dwign a5 we11 as in photography.
The top staff members of the Augsburg Echo and the Augsburgian
constitute the Board of Publication.
A student editor, named by the Board of Publications, with the
assistance of the Registrar, compiles the annual S t u d e ~Handbook
a r ~ dDirectory.
CO-CURRICULAR PROGRAM
The enthusiasm and energy of students motivate them to pursue
their interests beyond the classroom. For most effective participation,
students with similar interests have united to form clubs. Several of
these are extensions of courses beyond the class room. Others are
devoted to interests not offered in the curriculum. New clubs are
formed as the occasion demands.
r
AUGSBLJRG
COLLEGE
AND THEOLOGICAL
SEMINARY
STUDENT
CLUBS
The Alpha Delta Theta, Sigma Chapter, is a professional sorority
open to students preparing for medical technology. Membership is
based upon scholarship, character and professional potential.
The Aristotelian. Society unites those who have a common interest
in scientific knowledg,e and experimentation. Thus they may develop
their interest in the various branches of science and perhaps infuse
some of that spirit of interest throughout the college.
The Art Club is organized to satisfy the student's creative urge in
the field of art, to educate members, as well as others, in the field of
art and all that it contains, and to promote an interest in art among
the student body.
The Business Club draws membership from the Business and Secretarial Studies classes. The development of professional interests is
the major objective.
The Camera Club is composed of camera fans who meet regularly
to exchange ideas about their hobby and to develop skill in photography.
The Cosmopolitan Club brings together foreign and American students who have a mutual interest in the culture, language and people
of the various countries.
The Augsburg Society for Dramatic Arts provides for its members an
opportunity to learn from participation in stage presentations and from
field trips, as well as from reading and seeing plays produced. Membership is open to all students.
The F ~ u r eTeachers of America, Martin Quanbeck Chapter, offers to
its members associate membership in professional education associations
and strives to acquaint future teachers with the importance of teaching
as a profession. Interest in education or in the teaching profession is
the only requirement for membership.
The Home Economics Club, open to all students in the Home Economics Department, aims to promote professional attitudes toward all
aspects of home and community life.
The Public Aflairs Federation aims to stimulate interest in public
affairs and give students opportunity to participate actively in local,
state, and national politics, and in other human relations activities.
The Social Service Club is an organization of students preparing for
professional work in the field of Social Service.
The Writers Club includes students who enjoy creative expression
in various forms of writing. The members share their literary efforts
in an informal atmosphere, and benefit from mutual criticism.
THE AUGSBURG
COLLEGECHOIR
The Choir has about sixty members selected from all classes. In
addition to local concerts, the choir goes on tour each year to various
parts of the United States and occasionally to Canada.
The band meets for rehearsal at a regularly scheduled period four
times per week. The concert band makes an annual tour and presents
public concerts in Minneapolis. There are also a Varsity Band and
Imstrumental Ensembles.
THE AUGSBURG
COLLEGECANTORIANS
This Women's Chorus participates in school programs and concerts
and makes short tours annually.
THE MALECHORUS
The Chorus sings at various churches in the Twin City area and
makes short tours in the vicinity.
FORENSICS
Augsburg College participates in intercollegiate debating, both in
Minnesota and in the neighboring states. Students may also participate
in local and intercollegiate oratorical contests.
THE 'A" CLUB
Membership in the "A"- Club is limited to men who have won a
major A at Augsburg. The aim of this organization is "to bind the 'A'
men of the past, present, and future into a more intimate bond of
fellowship, and to keep the athletics of Augsburg on the highest possible
plane."
WOMEN'SATHLETICASSOCIATION
Membership in the Women's Athletic Association is gained by participation in individual and group recreational activities with awards
given on a point basis. The Augsburg W.A.A. is a member of the
Minnesota Athletic Association of College Women.
PHYSICAL
EDUCATION
AND RECREATION
Under the direction of the Department of Physical Education, a
wide range of recreational activities is arranged for general student
participation. Every student is urged to participate in some activity
for his own recreation and relaxation.
An intramural program provides competition in a variety of team
sports as well as individual performance activities. Climaxing the intramural program is the Extramural Meet, a tournament for the winners
of intramural schedules in various colleges.
INTERCOLLEGIATE
ATHLETICS
Augsburg is a member of the Minnesota Intercollegiate Athletic
Conference. The college is represented annually by teams in football,
basketball, hockey, wrestling, baseball, track, tennis, and golf.
PURPOSE AND PHILOSOPHY OF INTERCOLLEGIATE
ATHLETICS
It is the purpose of Augsburg College to provide an intercollegiate
athletic program which is in harmony with its Christian philosophy.
This philosophy is to be reflected in the conduct and outlook of both
the players and the spectators. The educational program of the college.
recognizes that recreation and play are a fundamental part of human
life, and that this phase of life needs to be cultivated if physical,
mental, and emotional health are to be maintained. Intercollegiate
athletics, as a phase of that program, gives recognition to the fact that
competitive pIay can contribute to the development of student interests,
skills, insights, and loyalties.
More specifically, the following outcomes are sought: (1) The student participating in athletics should acquire and exhibit, both in and
out of athletics, such basic qualities of character as self-discipline,
honesty, sense of fair play, and cooperation. (2) The participant
should develop the knowledge, interests, and skills which will be of
special use to him in such vocations as teaching and coaching or re-,
creational leadership, or in his own recreational activities. Far from
being set apart from his educational goal or in. any way competing
with it, the student's participation in intercollegiate athletics must
either contribute directly to this goal or be complementary to his
other educational activities. ( 3 ) The student spectator should acquire
and exhibit some of the finer qualities of Christian character, such
as self-restraint, sense of fair play, appreciation of high grade performance on the part of both opponents and fellow-students, and respect for individual personality. (4) The intercollegiate athletic program should contribute to the development of a unified and healthy
"school spirit." Enthusiasm for intercollegiate athletics or other cocurricular activities should not overshadow pride in high scholastic
achievement, nor can it take the place of a well-rounded and effective
intramural and general recreational program.
HONORS AND AWARDS
The 1925 Class Cup i n Athletics is awarded to the athlete who has
made outstanding records both in athletics and in scholarship.
The Harold A . Johnson Trophy, presented by Gerald L. Johnson
in 1943, is awarded annually to the student who is judged to be the
most valuable player on the -basketball team.
The Class of 1918 Oratorical Cup was presented to the college as a
prize t o arouse interest in oratory. The name of the winner of the
annual contest ishengraved upon the cup, which is to remain in the
possession of the college and is placed on exhibition in the Science
Hall.
The 1927 Class Cup for Scholarship is awarded to the senior student
of highest scholastic standing who has attended Augsburg for at least
two years.
Omicron Chapter of Lambda Iota Tau, a national honor society, is
open to English majors who have attained a high scholastic average
and have presented a paper on a literary topic before a public audience.
The Augsburg Guild of Honor is an organization to recognize and
honor those members of the senior graduating class who have shown
themselves to be individuals excelling to an outstanding degree in
scholarship, leadership, and participation in extra-curricular activities.
-
-
The Dean's List includes students who have achieved an honor point
ratio of 2.5 or better in the previous semester of work at Augsburg
College.
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
ACADEMIC ADMINISTRATION
ADMISSION PROCEDURE
Application for admission should be made on the regular admission
form, which can be secured from the Office of Admissions. This
form is generally available also in Minnesota high schools. The application, together with the high school record, previous college record,
if any, two letters of recommendation, a small photograph, and an
admissions deposit of 815.00 should be sent to the Office of Admissions.
The deposit, which will be applied on first semester tuition, is partially
refunded if the application is not accepted or if it is withdrawn by the
applicant before August 1. A student seeking admission in the fall
semester should apply not later than September 1 and for the spring
semester by January 15.
REQUIREMENTS FOR ADMISSION
Augsburg College admits as students, men and women of good
moral character and sound health who appear to have the ability to
succeed in college. Estimate of ability is determined by rank in the
high school graduating class and college aptitude tests, and by the
high school record or previous college record.
The normal basis for admission is the completion of the courses of
grades nine to twelve in an accredited high school. No definite pattern
of subjects is required, but it is recommended that the last four years
of high school include four units of English, or three units of English
and two of a foreign language, two units of social studies, one
uuit of mathematics and one or two units of science. A unit is defined
as a course covering one academic year and equivalent to at least 120
hours of classwork. Graduates of unaccredited high schools are considered for admission on the basis of their rank in high school and
their achievement in a college aptitude examination and an English
achievement test.
Applicants who are not high school graduates but who give evidence
of sufficient maturity are considered for admission upon recommendation and on the basis of achievement in a college aptitude test, English achievement test, and General Educational Development Tests on
literary materials, social science materials, and natural science materials.
For most graduates of Minnesota high schools the results of the
college aptitude and English achievement tests are available in advance if they have been taken in the state-wide testing program. The
General Educational Development tests are available to service men
through the Armed Forces Institute. All tests may, however, be taken
at Augsburg by arrangement with the Registrar.
The College reserves the right to reject the applications of students
whose previous records or aptitudes, as measured by tests, indicate
they may have difficulty in doing college work.
TRANSFER AND ADVANCED STANDING
Students are accepted by transfer from other institutions if they
did satisfactory work and were otherwise in good standing there. If
their previous work was unsatisfactory, they are admitted to Augsburg
only under special circumstances.
Advanced standing, that is, credit for courses completed, is granted
to students who present satisfactory transcripts from accredited institutions. In certain cases advanced standing is granted on the basis of
comprehensive examinations.
ADMISSION OF VETERANS
Veterans, qualified for educational benefits under any of the government programs, may study at Augsburg and receive these benefits.
The veteran must secure a certificate of eligibility from the regional
office of the Veterans Administration. Application for benefits must
be made in advance of registration, except that veterans who are
eligible for assistance under Public Law 550 may make application
for entitlement when they enroll at the college.
In order to receive credit for experience in the military services,
the veteran must present a photostatic or certified copy of his Separation Record at the Registrar's Office. Evaluation is made according to
the recommendation of the American Council on Education. Some
college credit is given for the completion of the work in certain service
schools and for some courses taken through the Armed Forces Institute.
REGISTRATION
Students who have been accepted for admission should regi..qter on
the days designated in the Calendar for this purpose. Students who
register late are charged a late registration fee of $1.00 per day after
classes begin. No student may registe~f o r OF enter a course later than
two weeks after the beginning of classes.
In registering, care should be taken to include the Lower Division
requirements during the first two years. However, if such registration
is delayed beyond the second year, a student will neither be required
nor permitted to register beyond the allowed number of credit hours
per semester in order to make it up.
No credit will be given a student for any subject for which he has
not registered. The college reserves the right to cancel any course for
which there is not sufficient registration.
Registration means that the student accepts all the rules and regulations established by the school.
The normal registration is 16 credit hours. A credit hour is defined
as one recitation period a week throughout a semester.
The privilege of registering for more than 1'7% credit hours may
be granted only to students who have gained an average record of B,
or two honor points per credit, in their previous college studies. Exceptions to this rule may be made under certain conditions determined
by the Admissions and Scholarship Committee. No student is permitted to carry work for more than 20 credits per semester.
Students working part-time are urged to arrange the amount of
their registration accordingly.
CHANGE OF REGISTRATION AND CANCELLATION
In case a student desires to make any changes in his registration,
he must obtain a form from the Registrar's office on which he may
make application, stating clearly his reasons for desiring the change.
Approval of the teachers concerned and the student's adviser and the
Registrar must be obtained before a change will be permitted. A
course which is abandoned without being cancelled through the Registrar's Office will result in a grade of F.
No course may be added after the first two weeks of classes. A course
may not be cancelled after the first six weeks of classes. A fee of $1.00
is charged for each change of registration after the first week of classes.
A student who finds it necessary to leave school before the end of
a semester must cancel his registration at the Registrar's office in
order to remain in good standing.
UNIVERSITY COURSES
By arrangement with the University of Minnesota, students may
register for courses at the University. But such registration will not
be allowed unless the student has a grading of C average, or 1 honor
point per credit, in his courses at Augsburg. Also, the combined number of credits in any semester must not exceed 17. The credits thus
gained at the University may be transferred to Augsburg College and
counted towards graduation.
CLASSIFICATION
In order to be classified in one of the college classes, a student
must be carrying a minimum of twelve hours of work in which college
credit is given. Classification is based on the attainment of the following number of credit hours together with an equal number of
honor points: Sophomore, 24; Junior, 58; Senior, 92. Students are
classified by this regulation at the time of their registration each
school year.
PROBATION AND ELIMINATION
The Admissions and Scholarship Committee meets at the end of each
semester to consider the status of students who are doing unsatisfactory work. Freshmen who obtain honor point ratios of .5 or below,
Sophomores .6 or below, and Senior College students .8 or below, as
well as students with 6 or more credits of F, at the end of a semester
are placed on probation during the semester that follows. They remain
on probation until an honor point ratio of 1 is attained. A student is
not allowed to remain in college on probation for more than two semesters consecutively, except by special permission. He is dropped for low
scholarship if he fails to maintain a satisfactory scholastic record.
CLASS ATTENDANCE
Regular attendance in class is required. Students who find it necessary to be absent because of illness or for other reasons should confer
with their teachers.
Students are expected to arrange the hours of part-time employment so that work does not conflict with classes. Any exception to this
rule must be agreed to by the teacher of the class affected and must
be approved by the Dean of the College.
A record of attendance is kept by each teacher, and periodic reports
are submitted to the Registrar. At the end of the semseter, a record
is made of the total absences of each student for the semester.
Absences for tours, field trips and other instructor-arranged activities are cleared with the Dean of the College. Lists of participants,
with information as to exact periods absent, are issued by the Dean
to all instructors involved.
Teachers deal with tardiness as they see fit. Students arriving in
class late must assume responsibility for reporting their presence to
the teacher.
EXAMINATIONS
Tests are given periodically throughout the semester. In the course
of each semester, reports of the grades attained are made to the
Registrar who forwards them to the counselors and students. Final
reports are sent at the close of each semester to the parents and
students.
Written examinations are regularly scheduled at the close of each
semester. No student or class may arrange to take a final examination
in any course before the examination week.
Absence from a final examination without a sufficient reason will
result in a grade of failure in the course concerned.
A student who has to be absent from a final examination because
of a conflict with outside work from which he cannot obtain an excuse
may arrange to take such an examination during some period after
the time on which the subject is scheduled.
If a student has obtained permission from the Dean of the College
to take a final examination at another hour than that scheduled, he is
charged
a fee of two dollars for such an examination. Before the student takes the examination, he must obtain a statement from the Registrar's office and bring it to the teacher concerned. The teacher will
give no examination before he has this statement.
CONDITIONS AND INCOMPLETES
A condition or an incomplete received at the end of the semester
must be removed before the end of the following semester or within a
year if the student has not re-enrolled. If incompletes and conditions
are not removed within the time allowed, the condition automatically
becomes a failure and the incomplete may be changed to a passing
grade only when the average of the previous work is sufficiently high.
The final grade after the condition examination is taken may not be
higher than D. A fee of $2.00 is charged for an examination making
u p an incomplete or a condition received at the end of a semester.
COMPREHENSIVE EXAMINATIONS
Compre)lensive examinations may be permitted in courses in which
the Admissions and Scholarship Committee feels the student has adequate preparation or background. Students who wish to take a comprehensive examination must apply in writing to this committee.
When permission is granted, the necessary approval forms may be
secured at the offiee of the Registrar. A fee of $5.00 is charged for
each examination and must be paid in advance. Examination questions and the answers will be filed in the Registrar's office.
GRADE VALUES
3 honor points per credit
A-Superior,
&Very
good, 2 honor points per credit
C-Satisfactory,
D-Passable,
F-Failure,
1 honor .point per credit
no honor points per credit
minus 1 honor point per credit
GRADUATION REQUIREMENTS
In order to qualify for the Bachelor of Arts degree, certain requirements must be met with regard to credits, courses, and grades. A
student who plans to graduate from Augsburg is urged to study the
requirements as outlined in this section of the catalog and in the
department in which he plans to major. It is the responsibility of the
student to see that he includes the required subjects at the right time
in his program of studies. The faculty advisers, the Dean, and the
Registrar will gladly assist him in planning his program.
Lower Division Requirements
1:or a general college education and as a basis for study in professional
fields, students are required to complete the following credits in lower
division courses:
Religion
Each semester, 2 credits
English
6 credits
Course 1-2. Students exempted from
Freshman English must earn 6 credits
above Freshman English.
3 credits
Course 11.
Fine Arts
2 credits
H.Ec. 3, 64, Mu. 7, 3, Phil. 60, Sp. 29,
or any literature course satisfies this requirement.
Foreign Langzmge
8 credits
Students who have studied a foreign language for three years in high school and
students with majors in Home Economics
are exempted from this requirement.
Social Sciences
Hist. 1-2; 21, 22; or Soc. 1, 2.
6 credits
Natural Sciences
8 credits
Health and Physical Education
3 credits
Courses 2, 3 and 4. Students with majors
in Home Economics will substitute H. Ec.
63 for P. E. 2.
Orientation is required of all Freshmen.
Major and Minors
A student is required to complete a major and one or more minors
for graduation. The major subject is determined by the student's
aims as well as by his particular interests and aptitudes as shown in
the quality of work he does in the Lower Division.
It is well for the student to know in his Freshman year what major
line of study he will pursue. Students who are still undecided as to
their major choice when they appear for registration in the junior
year, should, before they register, consult with a faculty counselor
and with heads of the various departments to determine their field
of major work. In planning the major, a student is required to consult with the Head of the Department offering the major. Majors are
offered in the following areas: Religion, Philosophy, English, Speech,
Music, History, Sociology, Social Science, Business Administration,
Business Education, Secretarial Studies, Home Economics, Biology,
Physics, Chemistry, Natural Science, Mathematics, and Physical Education.
For major and minor requirements as to hours of credit see devartmental statements.
Electives
Electives are planned with the purpose of properly distributing a
student's choices among the fundamental fields of knowledge and culture, as well as among the correlatives of the major. Juniors and
Seniors should, as a rule, choose their electives from courses designated as Upper Division Courses, that is courses numbered 50 or
above. At least thirtv credits in Upper Division Courses must be completed for graduation.
Total Credits and Honor Points
The amount of work required for graduation comprises a minimum
of 128 credits with an average grade of C, or one honor point for each
c:.edit. A credit equals one recitation period a week throughout one
semester.
Honor points are computed at the rate of one honor point for each
credit with a grade of C, two honor points for each credit with a
grade of B, and three honor points for each credit with a grade of A.
English Proficiency
In order to qualify for the A.B. degree a student must demonstrate
2 proficiency in the writing and speaking of English.
Residence Requirement
To receive the A.B. degree the candidate must spend at least the
concluding year for such a degkea in residence.
DEGREE WITH DISTINCTION
The A.B. degree with distinction is conferred as follows:
Distinction
Honor point n&
Summa Cum Laude
Magna Cum Laude
Cum Laude
To be eligible for these honors, the student must have completed
at least two years of work at Augsburg, and his record at Augsburg,
as well as his total record must meet the requirements as given above.
CURRICULUMS
The following courses of study are outlined as guides for the student
and his adviser in plann,ing a program which will prepare him for the
vocation of his choice.
THE CHRISTIAN MINISTRY
Completion of the pre-seminary curriculum qualifies the student for
admission into the three-year course in the Theological Seminary,
which prepares students for the Christian ministry as pastors or missionaries. The following program gives the approximate pre-seminary
course. It does not include a major or a minor. The student should seek
the counsel of the Seminary adviser as early as possible since the major
selected by the student may affect the choice of courses even in the
Freshman year.
The Seminary adviser for candidates for Augsburg Seminary is Mr.
Stensvaag; for candidates for other Seminaries, Mr. Helland.
Sophomore
Freshman
.
Basic Bible
Orientation
. .
Freshman English .
Foreign Language
..
Healcth .
European Civilization
Physical Education
.
Electives
4
I
6
8
z
6
I
4
Junior
New Testament Greek
Speech
. .
.
History
.
Sociology or Economics or Political
Science or Education
.
Electives
. ..
Natural Science
Psychology
Foreign Langua,ge .
Typewriting .
New Testament Greek
Electives .
8
4
6
I
8
6
Senior
6
6
6
6
8
32
.... .
Religion
Youth Work in the Church
Philosophy
. .... ....
English Li,terature
..
Electives
. . . . . .
z
2
6
6
16
32
The foreign language requirement includes 14 semester credits in
Greek, and 14 smester credits in Latin, German, or Norwegian.
PARISH
AND
MISSIONARY WORKERS
The purpose of this course is to train men and women for effective
service in the Church at home or abroad; that is, as teachers in vacation, week-day and Sunday schools, as youth leaders, and as parish
workers. The course is so arranged that the student will, upon its satisfactory conclusion, receive the A.B. degree and also a certificate
indicating that he is a qualified parish worker.
Students interested in becoming parish workers should consult with
Mr. Stensvaag, parish work adviser.
The suggested schedule provides for a minor in Religion and makes
it possible to plan for a major in Home Economics, History, English
or Sociology. It is also possible to plan for a major in Religion with a
minor in some other field. The courses essential for the securing of the
Parish Worker's Certificate are italicized in the outline below.
Freshman
Basic Bible . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Freshman English . . . . . . . . . .6
Natural Science . . . . . . . . . 8
Typewriting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Principles of Sociology
..... . 3
Social Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Orientation
................. I
Physical Activities . . . . . . . . . . . . . I
Electives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3
-
Sophomore
Religion . .
. . . . .
Beginning Speech . . . . .
Types of Public Speech .
Foreign Language . . . .
General Psychology . .
Health
. . . . . . . . . .
First Aid . . . . . . . . . .
Electives
..........
32
Junior
The Missionary Enterprise . . . . . . z
Principles of Christian Education . 2
The Christian Churches
. . . . z
The Lutheran Church . . . . . . . r
Social Psychology or Urban Sociol......... 3
OgY - Actiltg
, ,
, , . .
. 3
Story Telling . .
,
. . . .I
Elementary Shorthand . . . . . . . . 6
Recreational Activities
. . . I
Electives
. .
.
10
Senior
Parish Work
............ z
Youth Work in the Church
. .
z
Edt~caticmal Psychology . . . . . . . 3
Hymns and Music of the Church
z
Fzindamentals of Jozrmalism . . . . . z
Crafts . . . . . . . . . . :', . . . . . . . . s
Fields of Social Work . . . . . . . 3
Secretarial Practice . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Fine Arts
, ,
........ 2
Electives
. . . . . . . . . . . . 11.
-
HIGH
SCHOOL TEACHING
Each state sets certain requirements for obtaining a teacher's certificate. The course outlined below satisfies the requirements for a certificate for teaching in Minnesota at the junior and senior high school
level. The same program will meet the demands set by most of the
neighboring states. The student should apply to the Department of
Education for admission to the Education curriculum during his Sophomore year. Admission will be determined by a committee on the basis
of scholarship and other qualifications. Students should usually prepare
for competency in at least two subject-matter fields in which high
schools offer work. In addition to departmental majors, broad majors
for teaching may be secured in natural science, social science, and
business education.
Freshman
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Freshman English . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
European Civilization . . . . . . . - . . . 6
Foreign Language or Natural
Science . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Orientation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I
Physical Education . . . . . . . . . . . . . I
Health . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.2
Electives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . , .
Speech . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Foreign Language or Natural
Science . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Psychology . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fine Arts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Junior
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Educational Psychology . . . . .
Teaching in High School
.
,
Philosophy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Group Activity . . . . . . . . . .
Electives in Major or Minor . . .
Senior
............... 4
Religion
Principles of Guidance . . . . . . . . . . 3
Issues in Contemporary Education. 3
Student Teaching . . . . . . . . . . . 4 or I
Special Teaching Methods . . . . . . . . 4
Electives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 4
Sophomore
VOCATIONS IN HOME ECONOMICS
f o r k in the Deparhent of Home Economics is intended to prepare
students for homemaking, ta e q i p them for the teaching of home
economics in high school. and to give them the first two years of the
training required for such vocations as dietetics. institution manage~ e n t home
.
economics and journalism, and home manomics in business.
Each student who plans for a vocation in this field should consult
members of the home economics staff about the details of the program
when she begins her college work. X curriculum for a home economics
education major is given below. A graduate who completes this curriculum qualifies for certification by the Minnesota State Board for
Vocational Education to teach in federally aided secondary school home
economics departments. Courses in italics are not required for a general
home economics major.
Freshman
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Orientation
. . . . . . - - - . . . - . . .I
P.hysica1 Education . . . . . . . . . I
English . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Sociology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 or 6
Zoology* or Anatomy . . . . 8 or 4
Art in Daily Living . . . . . . . . . 3
Clothing Selection . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Nutrition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Clothing Constraction . . . . . . . 2
-
3 4 or 33
Junior
Religion . . . . . . . , . . . .
4
Educational Psychology . . . . . . . 3
Group Activity . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Tefiching in Secondary Schools . . . . 3
Bacteriology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Textiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . z
Color and Design . . . . . . . . ., . . . . . 3
Home Planning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Family Health . . . . . . . . . . . . z
Sociology or Elective . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Principles of Economics . . . . . . . . 3
Sophomore
Religion
.................... 4
Pspcholagy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Marriage and Family Relations . . 3
Principles of Physiscs . . . . . . . . - - 4
Chemistry 5-6* or
Chemistry 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 or 4
Child Development . . . . . . . . . z
Foods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Speech . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Elective . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . o or z
-
Senior
Religion
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . , .. 4
Special Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Student Teaching . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Principles of Guidance . . . . . . . . . . 3
Issues in Contemporary Education . 3
Home Management Problems . . . . . 2
Home Management La'bora.tory ... 2
Advanced Clothing Construction . . 2
Electives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Electives must be in the minor field which the student selects.
*Strongly recommended for students who contemplate graduate study
in home economics or work in the areas of nutrition, foods or textiles
research.
BUSINESS
The program in business administration is intended for students
who are planning to work in the fields of business and industry. In
addition to giving preparation for a business vocation the following
suggested course of study leads to the Bachelor of Arts degree.
Sophomore
Freshman
Religion
Freshman English
Foreign Language
Principles of Accounting
Introduction to Business
Orientation
Henlrh
Physical Education
Elective
Junior
.
Religion
United States History
. ..
Business Law
Public Finance or Money and
.
. . .
Banking
Taxation or Cost Accounting
Electives
Religion
Psychology
. . ,
Speech
. .
....
Principles of Economics
Introduction t o Statisti,cs
Natural Science . .
Electives .
.
3
3
13
Senior
Religion
. . .
4
Business Finance or Marketing . . 3
Industrial Mana)gement or Labor3
Management Relations . . .
Seminar in Business Administration . 3
Fine Arts
,
. . 3
Electives
. .
. 16
32
32
4
6
3
-
-
LAW
The following two-year program is suggested for students who plan
to study law.
Freshman
Religion
.
. .
Freshman English
Principles of Accounting
. .
Sociology .
European Civilization
. .
Orientation
General Psychology
Pihysical Aotivities
Sophomore
Reli,gion
Christian Ethi,cs
.
Principles of Economics
American Government .
Logic
.
. . ... .
Introduction to Philosophy
History or Literature
..
Natural Science
.
.
SOCIAL WORK
A rapid expansion of the field of social work during the past twenty
years has created an acute need for trained social workers. Positions
are available in pubIic agencies an federal, state, county, and municipal
levels; in private agencies sponsored by churches or other community
organizations; in goup work, case work, or community organization.
In response to this need, Augsburg College has developed a curriculum designed to do two things: (a) equip graduates for immediate
employment in social work positions that do not erequire post-graduate
training, and (b) prepare students for further study in graduate schools
of social work.
Augsburg College is an active member of the Minnesota Conference
on Social Work Education. During recent years graduates of Augsburg
have secured positions in both public and private welfare, in probation work, child welfare, group w o ~ k ,and case work.
The following courses are recommended for students interested in
Social Work. The courses which are italicized should be taken by all
such students.
Sophomore
Freshman
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . .
Freshman English . . . .
European Civilization
American Government . . . . . . . . . . 6
Natural Science . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Psychology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Principles of Sociology
Social Problems . . . .
...........
Foreign Language . . . .
Orientation . . . . . . . .
Physical Education . . .
Health . . . . . . . . . . . .
Elementary Statistics
Junior
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Principles of Economics . . . . . . . . . 3
Senior
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Fields of Social Work . . . . . . . . . . .
History of Philosophy . . . . . . . . . .
Criminology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Public Welfare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electives
3
Rural Sociology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Urban Sociology ...............
3
Speech . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
3
6
3
3
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Introduction to Methods of Social
Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Social Psychology . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Abnormal Psychology . . . . . . . . . 3
Fine A ~ t s . . . . . . . . . . . .
. 3
Electives . . . . . . . . . . . . . , . . . . . . .16
32
MEDICAL TECHNOLOGY
Students may complete a course leading to the Bachelor of Arts degree with a major in Medical Technology by completing three years
of work at Augsburg College and twelve months at General Hospital
or Swedish Hospital, Minneapolis. This course prepares them for
examination for certification in Medical Technology. It is recommended
that students in this curriculum choose a minor in an unrelated field.
The following program is suggested.
Sophomore
Freshman
................ 4
Religion
Freshman English . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Chemistry $-6 . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Social Science . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Orientation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .I
Physical Education . . . . . . . . . . I
Foreign Language - . . . . - . . . . . . . . 8
Junior
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Onganic Chemistry . . . . . . . . .
General Psychology . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Speech . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
General Zoology
..............
Health . . . . . . . . . , . . . . . . . . . . . .
Elective . . . . . . . . ., . . . . . . . . . . . .
4
.8
4
3
8
2
3
Senior
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Chemistry 61 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Bacteriology . . . . . . . . , . . . . . . . . 4
Fine Arts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.
Electives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 6
-
Lectures, lzboratory and ~ractical
work at General or Swedish Hospita1 for twelve months . . . . . . 3 2
-
Students taking this program must register at Augsburg as well as at
the affiliated hospital in their senior year.
DI ACONATE
A program whereby a Deaconess candidate can prepare for service
in the areas of parish work, social service, high schod teaching, missionary work, nursing, or secretarial work may be arranged in consultation with the Directing Sister of the Lutheran Deaconess Home, the
Dean of Women and the Registrar.
NURSING
Most hospitals prefer that applicants to their school of nursing have
at least one year of college. In many instances two or more years of
college work are desirable. The following pre-nursing curriculum is suggested for those planning to enter a four-year school of nursing. Those
who plan on a three-year nursing program should try to select courses
in college which will not duplicate the courses they will study in the
school of nursing which they plan to attend.
Freshman
,
~
,
Religion . . . . . .
4
Freshman English
. . . . . . . . .6
General Zoology
. . . . . . 8
Health . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
sociology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Elements of Nutrition .
- 3
Orientation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I
Physical Education . . . . . . . . . . . . I
Electives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
-
,
~
Religion
. . . . . . . . . . . .4
History or Political Science . . . . . . 6
Psychology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Child Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
General Chemistry and Qualitative
Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Physical Education . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Electives
................7
-
33
34
The following courses of the School of Nursing of the Lutheran
Deaconess Hospital, Minneapolis, Minnesota, are offered at Augsburg
College. This is a part of the three-year course offered by the hospital.
Application for admission to the School of Nursing should be made to
the Lutheran Deaconess Hospital, Minneapolis, Minnesota.
First Year
Anatomy and
Bacteriology
Chemistry .
Psychobgy .
Second Year
Physiology . . . . . . . . 4
. . . . . . . . ., . 3
. . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
. . , . . . . . . . . . .2
I2
Sociology
.
.
-
. . . . . .
2
2
Students enrolled in the School of Nursing at Swedish Hospital, Minneapolis, take courses in Chemistry, and Human Anatomy and Physiology at Augsburg College. Applications for admission to this program
should be made directly to Swedish Hospital.
ENGINEERING
A student may take two full years of pre-engineering at Augsburg
before transferring. The course outlined below applies 'to the fields of
aeronautical, electrical, agricultural, civil, and mechanical engineering
and engineering mathematics at the University of Minnesota. The
chemistry and chemical engineering programs will be slightly different. Students planning to enter this program should complete higher
algebra and solid geometry in high school.
Freshman
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Freshman English . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Introduction to Mathematical
Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Engineering Drawing and Descriptive Geometry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
General Physics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Orientation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I
Physical Education . . . . . . . . . . . . . I
-
Sophomore
Reli3gion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Elementary Calculus and Differential Equations . . . . . . . . . . . . .. l o
Introduction to Atomic and Nuclear
. . . . . . . . 4
Physics . . .
Electricity and Magnetism
..
4
General Chemistry and Qualitative
Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Psychology or Sociology I , 2 . 4 or 6
-
Statics may be taken at the University of Minnesota in the first
quarter of the junior year, except for the courses in civil and mechanical engineering, in which case it may be taken in evening school or
summer session.
DENTISTRY
Preparation for the study of dentistry can generally be completed
in two years. The following schedule will meet the requirements for
admission to most dental schools. Students planning to enter this curriculum should take higher algebra and plane geometry in high school.
Freshman
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Freshman English . . . . .
. 6
General Chemistry and Qualitative
Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Introduction to Mathematical
Analysis
. . .lo
Orientation
.............. I
Health . . . . . . . . . ., . . . . . . . . z
Physical Education
. . . . . , .. I
Sophomore
Religion
.......- European Civilization . . .
Zoology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Organic Chemistry . .
...
General Physics
. . . .
4
6
8
8
8
MEDICINE
Most medical schools require a minimum of three years of college
education, but premedical students often find it advantageous to complete their college work before entering the medical school. The following program will meet the requirements of most medical schools,
but it is advisable for the student to study the requirements of the
medical school to which he plans to apply.
Students who have not had higher algebra in high school will need
to add Second Course Algebra to the curriculum given below.
Sophomore
Freshman
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Freshman English . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
General Chemistry and Qualitative
Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Introduction to Mathematical
Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Orientation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I
Health . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Physical Education . . . . . . . . . . . . . I
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - . . . . - 4History or Philosophy , , ,
,
6
Zoology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
General Psychology . . . . . . . . . . . 4
0r.ganic Chemistry . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Speech . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
35
33
-
Junior
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - - 4
Social Science . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
German . . . . : . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Quantitative Analytical C,hemisrrg j
General Ph,ysics . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Electives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
34
-
Senior
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . - - 4
Sociolagy . . . . . . . . . ,. . . . . . . 3
Fine Arts . . . . , . . .- . . , . . . . . . . . 3
Physical Chemistry . . . . . . . . . . - . - 4
Genetics . . . . . . . . . . . . . ., . 4
Electives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..1 4
32
SECRETARIAL
WORK
The first year of the following program provides preparation for
certain office positions. Completion of the second year provides more
advanced training. A student who has had similar courses in high
school may be admitted to advanced classes on the basis of his proficiency in the subject. An outline of the requirements for teaching business subjects in high school appears under Secretarial Studies.
First Year
Religion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Freshman English . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Elementary Shorthand . . . . . . . . . . 6
Elementary Typewriting . . . . . . . . I
Intermediate Typewriting . . . . . . . 2
Principles of Accounting . . . . . . . . 6
Orientation . . . . . . - . . . . . - . - . . . I
Physical Education . . . . . . . . . .I
Health . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Electives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
-
Second Year
Religion . . . . . . . . . . .
Speech . . . . . . . . . . . .
Advanced Typewriting
Advanced Shorthand .
Psychology . . . . . . .
Secretarial Practice . .
Offi,ce Machines . . .
Consumer Education .
Electives . . . - , . . . . .
COURSES OF STUDY
COURSES OFFERED
Descriptions of the courses offered in 1958-60 are given on' the
following pages. Unforeseen circun~stances may necessitate making
changes. Courses with inadequate registration may be cancelled. Students should consult the schedule of classes to determine definitely the
current course offerings.
NUMBERING OF COURSES
Odd numbers are used for first semester courses and even numbers
for second semester courses. The Roman numerals I, I1 after the
descriptive title also indicate the semester in which the course is to
be offered.
Numbers 1 through 49 indicate lower division courses which are
primarily for freshmen and sophomores. Numbers 50 through 99 are
upper division courses intended for juniors and seniors.
Two course numbers joined by a hyphen (1-2) indicate that the
course is a continuation course and both semesters of it must be
completed before credit is given. Course numbers separated by a
comma (1,2) indicate that it is a year course, but students may receive
credit for one semester without completing the other.
CREDITS
Credits shown are in terms of semester credits. For continuation
courses, the total credits for the year are given. A two-credit course
generally meets twice a week and a three-credit course three times a
week. In the case of laboratory courses, the hours of meeting per week
are more than the credits given. A semester is approximately 1 8 weeks
in length. The normal load for a student is 16 credit hours per semester.
DIVISIONAL ORGANIUTION
The college courses are organized into four divisions in order to
make interdepartmental coordination more convenient and cooperative
aims more easily achieved. A chairman is appointed for each division.
Major and minor requirements are indicated in the departmental
statements.
DIVISIONOF RELIGIONAND PHILOSOPHY
Religion
Philosophy
DIVISIONOF THE HUMANITIES
Greek, Latin, Hebrew
English, Journalism, Speech
German, Scandinavian, French, Spanish
Music, Art
DIVISIONOF THE SOCIAL
SCIENCES
History, Political Science, Geography
Sociology
Psychology, Education
Library Science
Business Administration and Economics
Secretarial Studies
Home Economics
Biology
Chemistry
Physics
Mathematics
Health and Physical Education
DIVISION OF RELIGION AND PHILOSOPHY
MR. STENSVAAG,
Chairman
the individual is apprised of
Through the study of religion and
the central realities of life and encouraged to build on the certainties of the
Christian faith. The work proceeds on the assumption that Christianity alone
can furnish a unifying principle which gives meaning to human existence. The
student is challenged to accept this point of view-to
relate himself to Christ
as the center, to evaluate all his studies and experiences in the light of revealed
truth, and to make consistent use of all his talents and training. The goal to
be desired is the development of an informed and integrated Christian personality dedicated to the realization of God's kingdom on earth.
Department of Religion
The courses in Religion are designed to give the student a working knowledge of the Bible, to acquaint him with the history, doctrines, and ethics of the
Church, and to prepare him for effective service in the congregation. The fundamental aim in instruction is to lead as many as possible to personal faith in
Christ, and to nurture the Christian life.
All full time students are required to register for two class hours per week
in one of the courses offered in religion during each semester of their studies.
Registration in New Testament Greek satisfies this requirement.
Major, 28 credits. Minor, 2 2 credits. Credits in New Testament Greek, except the first semester, Course I , may be applied toward a Religion major or
minor.
I, 2.
BASICBIBLE. Fr. I, 11.
2, 2 Cr.
A brief introduction to the Bible followed by the study of the Gospel of Mark
and of one or two books in the Old Testament. The second semester is devoted
to the study of two or three books in the New Testament, including Romans,
and of ;brief portions from the Old Testament. Reading assignments include the
emire New Testament.
CHURCHHISTORY.I.
2 Cr.
A brief survey of the main events in the history of the Church for the purpose of developing a more intelligent and appreciative church membership.
3.
z Cr.
4. THE CHRISTIANFAITH IN THE MODERNWORLD.II.
A study of the Christian faith in its relationship to the secular movements and
rival .faiths of modern Western civilization. The course is designed to give to
the student an understanding, from the standpoint of the Christian faith, of
the present conflicts and crises in Western culture.
5. THEMISSIONARY
ENTERPRISE.
I.
2 Cr.
The missionary motives, means, and results are studied as these are seen in their
varied emphases in the history of missionary work in heathen lands. (Offered
1959-1960.)
7. PRINCIPLESOF CHRISTIANEDUCATION.
I
z cr.
Seeks to develop a fundamental understanding of Christian Education, its history,
objectives, and methods, especially as applied to Sunday School and Vacation
Bible School teaching.
2 Cr.
8. GREATMEN AND WOMENOF THE CHRISTIAN
CHURCH.11.
The lives of outstanding Christian men and women from the days of Christ
until the present are studied. Special reports, class discussion.
g. CHRISTIAN
ETHICS.I.
z Cr.
The problems of human duty are studied in the light of various human philosophies of morals. Validity is determined by reference to the Word of God.
The main emphasis is on the new life in Christ, its creation, development and
presemation, and its manifestation in the various phases of life.
lo. HYMNSAND MUSICOF THE CHURCH.11.
See Course l o under the Department of M&c.
2
cr.
23. GROUPACTMTY.
See Course 53 under Education.
I
Cr.
Upper Division Courses
5 I , 52. COMPARATIVE
RELIGION.I, 11.
2, z Cr.
A study of the origin, growth, teachings, and social results of some ten or
twelve of the great non-~hristian religions of the world.
5 3. THECHRISTIAN
CHURCHES.I.
z Cr.
This course aims to give the student an insight into the origin, development,
doctrinal position, and practices of the vafious branches of the Christian Church.
54. THE LUTHERANCHURCH.TI.
2 Cr.
A study of the Lutheran Church, its doctrines and practices. Attention is
given to Lutheranism in America and to the basic principles of the Lutheran
Free Church.
2 Cr.
56. YOUTHWORKIN THE CHURCH.11.
A study of ~rinciples,methods, and materials in youth work for the purpose
of developing effective Christian leadership in this sphere.
57.
QROBLEMS
IN CHRISTIANL.IVING. II.
2
Cr.
A consideration of some of the fundamental questions connected with living
the Christian life: such as, the assurance of salvation, the devotional life,
standards of conduct, the use of the Bible, stewardship, choice of vocation, life
in the local congregation. The Epistle to the Philippians is studied.
5 8.
PARISHWORK.I1
s Cr.
This course seeks to familiarize the student with the work of parish organization and visitation. It ranges in scope from soul-care to surveys. Class lectures
are supplemented by actual field work.
I. Sr.
2 G.
59. GODAND MAN IN THE OLDTESTAMENT.
The rich and varied aspects of the Hebrew life with God discovered and made
significant for our day through the study of a number of great passages, including selections in Isaiah and the Psalms.
60. THE MESSAGE
OF THE NEWTESTAMENT.
11. Sr.
2 cr.
A discovery of the essence of the Christian Faith through a careful study of
representative sections, including passages in the Gospel of John and the Letters
to the Ephesians and the Hebrews.
Department of Philosophy
The courses in philosophy seek to assist the student in becoming familiar with
the thoughts of the great men and intellectual movements in the history of
Western civilization, to create an understanding of the principles of sound
reasoning, and to develop a Christian philosophy of life.
Major, 24 credits. Minor, 16 credits. Courses 2 5 , 26, 41,42, 58 are required
for the major. Courses 41,42 are required for the minor.
35. 'LFrmo~ucm
TO ~ I L O S SO.
~ I.
.
3 Cr.
By means of reading selected scarce materiaf, supplemented bp cIassroom lecture
and discussion, zhe srudmc is acquiinted with rhe terminology of philosophical
discussion. Selected phitowphkal problems are rreated, including the of
ethics, mer*ph~sics, and theory of knowledge.
26. LOGIC.SO. 11.
3 Cr.
A study of the formal rules governing valid inference. Topics considered include: immediate inference, syllogism, scientific method, and a brief introduction
to the notation of symbolic logic.
41, 42. HISTORY OF PHILOSOPHY. I, n.
3. 3 Cr.
!in historical survey of the outstanding men and movements in the development
of philosophical thought from the Greeks through Kant.
U,pper Division Courses
2.
$2
n.
RELIGION.I,
under Department of Religion.
COMPARATIVE
See course 5 I,
2, 2
Cr.
j 5. CONTEMPORARY
PHILOSOPHY.Prereq. 42. I.
3 fie
An historical survey of the main currents of philosophical thought since Kant.
Topics dealt with include: German idealism and romanticism, existentialism,
Marxism, ,positivism, and pragmatism. (Offered I 9 5 8- 5 9.)
n.
56. KIERKFGAARD.
Prereq. 41 or 42.
3 Cr.
A study of selected writings of the Danish existentialist with emphasis on his
ccntribution to theory of knowledge as it relates to philosophy of religion and
theology. (Offered 1958-59.)
cr.
5 8. PLATO.Prereq. 41. 11.
3
A careful study and analysis of a number of the dialogues of Plato, including
selected portions of the Republic. (Offered 1959-60.)
3 Cr.
60. FORMSAND PHILOSOPHYOF ART. 11.
The spirit and substance ofi art and the art experience in their various forms
through demonstrations, lectures, and readings in the philosophy of art. (Offered 1959-60.)
3 Cr.
61. PHILOSOPHY
OF RELIGION.Prereq. 3 credits in Philosophy. I.
An inquiry into the nature of religious faith and the religious experience from
the viewpoint of philowphy and psychology. (Offered 1959-60.)
Jr., Sr. 11.
74. HISTORYOF POLITICALTHOUGHT.
See course 74 under Political Science.
3 Cr.
I , I Cr.
81, 82. SEMINARIN PHILOSOPHY.
Jr., Sr. I, 11.
An advanced discussion of a thinker or topic chosen by the instructor and
students. Arranged when there is sufficient demand. (OfEered 1918-59.)
DIVISION OF THE HUMANITIES
MR. THORSON,
Chairman
It is the purpose of the Division of Humanities to transmit to the students
a knowledge of and interest in the cultural heritage of mankind, and to assist
the student in &ding his place within this culture. The Division seeks to
stimulate the student's desire to acquaint himself with the cultural treasures
as chese are found in language, literature, and the fine arts, and to seek an expression of these upon the basis and within the framework of the Christian faith.
Department of Ancient and Classical Languages
The courses in classical and ancient languages aim to give the students a real
insight into our classical heritage. Hebrew and New Testament Greek are tools
by which a student may gain a more complete understanding of the Scriptures.
A knowledge of New Testament Greek is a standard ,prerequisite for adrnission to most theological seminaries.
N e w Testament Greek
Minor, I 6 credits.
I-Z? ELEMENTS
OF NEW TESTAMENT
GREEK.I, 11.
8 Cr.
111 adldition to the theoretical and practical study of the grammar of the Greek
language of the New Testament, the course will cover the manuscript transmission of ,the Greek text of Ithe New Testament with the description of the
main uncial manuscripts and ancient versions.
5 r, 52. ADVANCED
NEW TESTAMENT
GREEK.I, 11.
3 , 3 Cr.
Selections from the Synoptic Gospels and Acts. Special emphasis is given to
parsing and syntax ai the Greek text.
53, 54. GREEKEXEGESIS.
I, 11.
I , I Cr.
Selections from the Pauline and Catholic Epistles. Special emphasis is given to
the syntactical and exegetical approach to the Greek text.
?Continuation course. To receive credit for this course, a student must complete
both semesters.
Latin
8 Cr.
I-2.t BEGINNING LATIN.
Fr. I, II.
Grammar, easy prose, composition.
3, 4. GSAR, AND ST. AUGUSTINE.
SO. I, n.
3, 3 Cr.
Continuation of grammar and syntax. Reading from Caesar's Gallic War and
Sr. Augusthe's Confessims. (Offered I 9 5 9-60.)
Hebrew
E3-E4.1
HEBREW
FOR BEGINNERS.I,
n.
6 Cr.
See Course 9-10 under Theological Sminary.
S f , 86. HEBREW
EXEGESIS.
I, 11.
See Course 17, I 8 under Theological Seminary.
2,2
cr.
Department of English
The Department of English aims to train students in the proper use of
English in oral and written expression; to increase proficiency in reading and
in analyzing literary texts; to acquaint the students with the development of
the literature of England and America; and to instill a deeper understanding
of the fundamental truths and realities of life revealed in great literature.
The department prepares specifically for the teaching of English in secondary
schools and for graduate study.
Freshman English is required of all students. The department annually may
exempt a few well qualified students from this requirement. Those exempted
from Freshman English must register for 6 credits above Freshman English.
Major: 27 credits pbove Freshman English, including courses 31, 32, 51, 52,
61, 62, 74, and one of the ,following: 59, 81, 83, or 85.
Minor: zo credits above Freshman English, including courses 31, 32, 51, $2,
61, and 62.
Teaching major: 27 credits a'bove Freshman English, including courses
listed for the non-teaching major plus 71.
Teaching minor: 2 0 credits above Freshman English, including courses listed
for the non-teaching minor plus 71.
A minor in speech, library scien.ce, or a foreign language is recommended for
those who plan to teach English in high school.
Students who plan to do gaduate work in English should include courses 76,
78, and 92.
$Continuation course. To receive credit for this course, a student must complete
Loth semesters.
A. IMPROVEMENT
OF READING.
I, 11.
o Cr.
A developmental program for students who wish to improve speed and
comprehension in reading. Open to all students.
I-2.f
FRESHMANENGLISH.I, 11.
6 Cr.
A study of language, composition, and literature. Themes and a reference paper.
Required of all students. Students who do not meet the minimum requirements
in the entrance English tests are 'placed in special sections meeting five hours a
week.
21.
MASTERPIECES
OF WORLDLITERATURE.
Prereq. 2. I.
2 Cr.
Reading, analysis, and discussion of some of the world's great classics. Recommended for non-English majors.
25. EXPOSITORY
WRITING.Prereq. 2 . I.
r Cr.
Practice in the writing of exposition and argumentation. Reading and analysis
of models.
26. CREATIVE
WRITING.Prereq. 2. 11.
2 Cr.
Writing of description and narration. Study of techniques in the composition
of fiction, poetry, and drama. Individual and group projects.
31. F O U N D A ~ OOF
N SLITERATURE.
Prereq. 2. I.
3 Cr.
Study of Greek and Roman masierpieces, tracing the influence of the classical
tradition in modern British and American literature.
MEDIEVALAND RENAISSANCE
LITERATURE.
3 Cr.
Prereq. 3 I or consent of instructor. 11.
English literature from Beowulf through Shakespeare. Some attention paid to
non-English works.
3 2.
Upper Division Courses
50. CORRECTIVE
WRITING.hereq. 2. Offered both semesters.
I Cr.
Designed to develop correctness in writing and usage. Required of all students
who rank low in the sophomore Cooperative English Test.
AMERICAN
LITERATURE.
2, 2 Cr.
Prereq. 3 1 or consent of instructor. I, 11.
The growth of American literature from colonial times to the present. Its
themes, techniques, and place in intellectual movements.
5 I, 5 2.
5 7. THEMODERNSCANDINAVIAN
NOVEL.1.
See course 5 5 under Scandinavian Language and Literature.
z Cr.
icontinuation course. To receive credit for this course, a student must complete
both semesters.
L
AUGSBURG
COLLEGE
rn
DRAMA.
11.
5 6. THEMODERNSCANDINAVIAN
See course 56 under Scandinavian Language and Literature.
2
Cr.
Prereq. 3 I or consent of instructor. I.
z Cr.
57. THEBRITISH NOVEL.
The development of the novel in England. A study of the major novelists and
their novels. (Offered I 9 59-60.)
POETRY.Prereq. 3 I or consent of instructor. I.
59. CONTEMPORARY
Analysis of: the techniques of modern poetry. (Offered 19y 8-59.)
z Cr.
BRITISH LITER~TURE
OF THE SEVENTEEN^ AND EIGHTEENTHCENTURIES.
3 Cr.
Prereq. 3 I . I.
The principal authors from John Donne through Samuel Johnson. Discussion
of literary movements and historical backgrounds.
61.
OF THE NINETEENTH
CENTURY.
Prereq. 3 I . 11. 3 Cr.
Gr. BRITISHLITERATURE
Romantic and Victorian literature in England. Stress placed on major writers of
prose and poetry.
TO MODERN
ENGLISH.Prereq. z. I.
z Cr.
71. INTRODUCTION
The study of American English vocabulary, sounds, and grammar. Designed to
give prospective high-school English teachers an introduction to the study
of language.
t Cr.
72. LITERARY
CRITICISM.Prereq. 2 . 11.
A study of basic :texts, winh emphasis on principles and issues which have
special relevance for modern thought. (Offered I 9 5 9-60.)
74. SHAKESPEARE.
F r e q . 3 2 . 11.
3 Cr.
Reading of some of the plays. Attention given to the principles of drama and
the historical background.
76. MILTON. Prereq. 61. H.
z Cr.
A study of Milton's major poems and selected prose works in relation to the
important intellectual movements of the seventeenth century. (Otfered
1959-60.)
78. CHAUCER.Prereq. 3 2 . 11.
2 Cr.
Chaucer's poetry in relation to the thought and culture of the Middle Ages.
Emphasis on The Cmterbu~yTales. (Offered 1958-59.)
z Cr.
8 I. MODERNDRAMA.Prereq. 3 I . 11.
A survey of the chief dramatists from the time of Ibsen. Representative plays
studied as literature and as theater. (Offered 1958-59.)
8 3 . MODERNBRITISHLITERATURE.
Prereq. 3 I. I.
2 Cr.
The irmpo~tantli,terary movements of the present century in England, concentrating on leading authors and nota'ble productions. (Offered 1959-60.)
AMERICAN
LITERATURE.
Prereq. 5 I, 5 2 . 11.
85. CONTEMPORARY
Major writers since World War I. (Offered 1959-60.)
2
Cr.
2 Cr.
92. ENGLISHSEMWAR.Prereq. Sr. and English major or minor. 11.
Methods and problems of bibliography and research. Selected topics in American
and British literature. Intended for students preparing for graduate study in
English.
TEACHING
OF ENGLISH. I.
See course 93 under Education.
93.
2
Cr.
Journalism
I.
FUNDAMENTALS
OF JOURNALISM. I.
2 Cr.
An introduction to the theory and practice of journalism, with emphasis on
reporting and writing. Some attention given to editing and headline writing.
2.
EDITING THE SMALLPAPER.I1
2 Cr.
The mechanics of newspaper production. Designed especially for prospective
advisers of high-school publications. (Offered 1959-60.)
5 . Echo STAFF MEETINGS.I, 11.
I, I Cr.
Students who are regular members of The Augsburg Echo stag and who may
receive credit for their work must register for the weekly staff meetings. These
meetings are also open to members of Course I. Hour arranged.
A,
Augsburgian STAFF MEETINGS.I, 11.
I , I Cr.
Students who are regular members of the Augsburgian staff and who may receive credit for their work must register for the schduled weekly stag meetings.
5, 7 .
Department of Speech
This department aims to foster in students those speech skills whidh contribute to meaningful self-expression and effective leadership. It seeks to
develop platform skills, intelligent speech compositions, and critical listening
habits. It aims, through courses in interpretative reading and drama, to stimulate an appreciation of h e literature and drama.
The department offers a major in general speech which prepares the student
teach speech in the secondary schmls and to take graduate work in speech,
radio, theater, or speech pathology.
ta
All students are required to earn 3 credits in speech
is designed especially for this requirement.
Major: 21 credits above Speech I I , including courses
Also required is Phil. 26. English is recornmenKed as a minor.
Minor: 1 5 credits above Speech I I. For Education students courses 66 and 76,
and st least one course f r m each of ~ h following
e
groups: 12,5 1 ; 31, 32; 61, 62.
II
Students needing help with speech problems such as stuttering, lisping, foreign
dialect, and excessive stage fcight should contzct the head of rhe department
for individual attention.
i I. BEGINNING
SPEECH.Fr., So. Offered both semesters.
3 Cr.
A study of basic problems of effective speaking and critical listening, with
emphasis on informative speaking.
I z. TYPES
OF PUBLICSPEECH.Prereq. I I . Fr., So. 11.
3 Cr.
An introduction to argumentation and persuasion, discussion, debate, interpretative reading, and parliamentary procedure. Participation in various speaking
activities.
I 5.
STORYTELLING.
I.
I Cr.
Selection and preparation of stories for various age groups. Observation and
practice in story telling. (Offered I 9 5 8- J 9.)
21-2z.t INTERCOI-LEGIATE
DEBATE.I, 11. Open to all students.
2 Cr.
Practice in debating the intercollegiate debate question of the year. Participation
in intercollegiate debate tournaments.
ZJ, 26. PUBLICSPEAKING
SEMINAR.Open to all students. I, 11.
I, I Cr.
Advanced work in public speaking. Participation in collegiate oratory contests.
Arranged.
TO DRAMATIC
ARTS.Open to all students. I.
3 Cr.
zg. INTRODUCTION
An introduction to the history of the theater and to the theories of drama and
dramatic production. (Offered I 9 J 8- 5 9.)
3 I. INTERPRETATIVEREADING.SO. I.
3 Cr.
Basic principles of oral interpretation of literature. Practice in reading various
kinds of prose, .poetry, and drama. (Offered 1959-60.)
32. ACTING.SO. 11.
3 Cr.
An introduction to the art of .acting. Practical work in pantomime and improvisation; participation in dramatic presentations.
Upper Division Courses
5 I. GROUPDISCUSSION.
Jr., Sr. I.
z Cr.
Principles and types of discussion. Practice in group discussion techniques. (Offered 1958-1959.)
5 j. RADIOSPEECH.Jr., Sr. I
2 Cr.
Exercises and projects in preparation and prodnction 04 radio programs. (Offered 19j9-60.)
+Continuation course. To receive credit for this course, a student must conlplete
both semesters.
61. ARGUMENTATION
A N D DEBATE.Prereq. I I . Jr., Sr. I.
2 Cr.
Applications of logic in public address. Preparation and delivery of argumentative speeches and participation in debates. (Offered 1959-60.)
62.
PERSUASION.
Prereq. I I . Jr., Sr. I.
2 Cr.
Applications of psyahology in public address. Preparation and delivery of persuasive speeches. (Offered 195 8-59.)
2 Cr.
64. STAGECRAFT.
Jr., Sr. 11.
A stu'dy of stage design, scene construction and theatrical lighting, with emphasis on the problems of the amateur stage. Laboratory exercises. (Offered
1559-6b.)
3 Cr.
66. STAGEDIRECTION.
Prereq. 3 2 . Jr., Sr. 11.
Theory and ,practice of stage direction with laboratory exercises in planning
anmd conducting rehearsals. (Offered I 9 5 8-59.)
76. SPEECHPATHOLOGY.
Jr., Sr. I1
3 Cr.
Physical and psychological factors underlying normal and abnormal speech. An
introduction ,to principles and methods of speech correction.
OF SPEECH.Sr. I.
95. TEACHING
See course 95 under Education.
2
Cr.
Department of Modern Languages
This ~ e ~ a r t m e n
aims
t to impart to the student the knowledge of a modern
language as a factor in stimulating a sympathetic interest in the people for whom
it is the main channel of expression. It also aims to aid the student in developing
an understanding of the idiom of a particular language and' a mastery of tshe
rules of grammar and rpronunciamtion. It furthermore seeks t o develop an interest
in the histony, literature and life of the people whose language he is learning,
and to transmit to American life the best of their cultural and religious
heritage. A special ai,m is to provide language facility and technical training
for such a plan to teach, study theology or become candidates for higher
academic degrees.
German
Minor, so credits.
I-2.t
BEGINNINGG E F ~ A NI, . 11.
8 Cr.
A study of the grammar and vocabulary of the German language so that the
student attains a reading knowledge.
3,4. MODERNGERMANPROSEAND POETRY.I, 11.
3, 3 Cr.
This course continues to build up the vocabulary of the student through the
study of easy prose and poetry.
fantinuation course. To receive credit for this course, a student must complete
both semesters.
Upper Division Courses
5 I, 1Z. GERMANLITERATURE.
I, 11.
3, 3 Cr.
Reading of standard authors. Brief survey of German literature. (Wered
1919-60.)
Scandinavian Language and Literature
24 credits.
I-2.t BEGINNINGNORWEGIAN.Fr. I, 11.
8 Cr.
Reading, translation, spelling, and exercises in writing and in pronunciation.
j, 4. INTERMEDIATE
NORWEGIAN.
SO. I, 11.
3, 3 c r .
Further study of grammar. Reading of standard authors. Brief survey of
Norwegian literature. Composition. (Offered I 9 18 - 5 9.)
I I. SCANDINAVIAN
HISTORY.I.
3 Cr.
A !brief survey of the history of the Scandinavian peoples, with history of
Norway as the core. (Offered 1919-60.)
r 6. MODERNSCANDINAVIA.
11.
3 Cr.
A survey of social thought and life in Scandinavia since 1814, with special
emphasis upon recent developments. (Offered I 9 19-60.)
Upper Division Courses
5 5 . THEMODERNSCANDINAVIAN
NOVEL.Jr., Sr. I.
2 Cr.
The course includes selected novels by Jonas Lie, Sigrid Undset, Selma La.gerl@f,
and others. Knowledge of a Scandinavian language not required. (Offered
1958-19.)
DRAMA.Jr., Sr. 11.
z Cr.
56. THE MODERNSCANDINAVIAN
The course includes dramas 'by Bjgirnson, Ibsen, and Strindberg. Knowledge of
a Scandinavian language not required. (Offered 19 18-19.)
French
Minor, zo credits.
I-2.t
BEGINNING
FRENCH.I, 11.
8 Cr.
The course includes the study of French sounds and their spelling, the essentials
of grammar, oral and written work, and the reading of suitable selections from
French literature. (Offered 1919-60.)
3, 4. INTERMEDIATE
FRENCH.I, 11.
3, 3 Cr.
One half of the time is devoted to the further study of grammar, composition,
and oral work. The other half is spent in reading representative types of French
literature. ( m e r e d 195 8-59.)
+Continuation course. To receive credit for this course, a student must complete
both semesters.
Upper Division Courses
y I. SURVEY
OF FRENCHLITERATURE.
I.
3 Cr.
A study of the authors and literary movements of the seventeenth, eighteenth,
and nimeteenth centuries. (Offered only as an honors course for selected
students.)
FRENCH PHONETICS,CONVERSATION,
AND COMPOSITION.
11.
3 Cr.
A thorough study of French sounds, phonetic symbols, drill on pronunciation,
honet tic readings, various types of oral work, memorization, dictation and
composition. (Otfered only as an honors course for selected students.)
52.
Spanish
Minor,
20
credits.
I-2.i
BEGINNINGSPANISH.I, 11.
8 Cr.
Stresses pronunciation, the essentials of grammar, elementary conversation,
and background reading in Spanish on the Latin American countries.
3, 4. INTERMEDIATE SPANISH.I, 11.
3, 3 Cr.
Includes further study of grammar, oral and written work, and the reading of
short stories, novels, and plays in the Spanish language.
Upper Division Courses
5 I. SURVEY
OF SPANISHLITERATURE.
I.
3 Cr.
A study of Spanish literature from the Poema del Cid to modern times. Lectures in Spanish, reading of representative works and reports. (Offered 1959-60.)
52. SPANISHCONVERSATION
AND COMPOSITION.
11.
3 Cr.
A course aiming to facilitate free expression in Spanish through conversation
2nd composition, including original themes. Laboratory, including audio-visual
aids, in'tegrated with classroom work and instruction. (Offered 1959-60.)
TEACHING
OF MODERN
LANGUAGES.
Sr. I.
See course 73 under Education.
73.
z Cr.
+Continuation course. To receive credit for this course, a student must complete
both semesters.
Department of Music
The Department of Music offers training to students who wish to become
teachers of music, soloists, and directors of choral and instrumental ensembles,
as well as preparation for those who expect to pursue specialized study in the
field of music. General instruction is aflorded students who are interested in
the appreciation and understanding of the music of the masters. Emphasis is
laid upon (the rich musical heritage of the Christian Church.
Graduation Major, 36 credits, including courses I , 2, 7, 8, I 5-16, 55-56,
57, 58, 61-62 or 63-64;4 credits from 10, 77, 78; and 8 credits in applied
music, 2 of which must be in piano or organ.
Teaching Major, 3 2 credits in addition to 88, 89; including courses I, 2, 7,
2 credits from 77, 78; and 6
credits in applied music, 2 of which must be in piano or organ.
8, 15-16, 55-56, 57, 58, 61-62' or 63-64';
Two public recitals, at least one of which must be in the junior or senior
year, is required of all music majors.
Graduation Minor, 26 credits, including courses I, 2, 7, 8. I 5-16, 78; 4
credits from 10, 15-56,57, 58, 77 and 2 elective credits; and 6 credits in applied
music, 2 of which must be in private lesms in either vocal or instnunend
music.
Teaching Minor, 22 credits in addition to 88, 89; including courses I, 2,
15-16,55, 57, 58, 61-62 or 63-64;and 4 credits in applied music.
Two credits are given for membership for one year in the Choir or the
Concefit Band. One credit is given for membership for one year in the Women's
Chorus or Male Chorus. Credit in Choir is not granted for less than two
com(p1ete semesters within an academic year.
One credit per semester is granted to studeqts taking a minimum of sixteen
thirty-minute lessons per semester in either voi'ce, #piano,organ, brass, or woodwinds. Occasional lessons are available without credit.
For statement of fees see under Financial Information.
3 , 2. THEORY,
I, 11.
2, 2 Cr.
A 'basic course in the fundamentals of music, including the prinoiples of
notation, major and minor scales, intervals, triads, rhythms: aural skills: sight
reading, dictation, and part singing. Should be taken ,concurrently with I 5-1 6
whenever possible.
.
*A student wirh a major for teaching should 'be prepared for both vocal
and instrumental work. Unless he takes 'bo& technique courses, his work in
applied music, excepting the required credits in piano, must be in instrumental
music if he registers for Choral Technique, and in vocal music if he registers
for I n s t m e n t a ~ lTechnique.
AND LITERATURE
OF MUSIC.I, 11.
2, 2 Cr.
;, 8. HISTORY
,4n historical approach to the appreciation of the world's greatest musi,c.
Supplemented by musical scores and record illustrations. For students with or
without a musical background. Students should complete 7 before regisrering
&or 8, or have consent of instructor.
10. HYMNSAND MUSICOF THE CHURCH.11.
2 Cr.
A survey course dealing with the development of the music of the Christian
Church, with special attention to Protestant hymnody. Designed for the
ginera1 student, the course also will prove helpful to organists, choir directors,
and pre-~heologicalstudents. The course is accepted as fulfilling the requirements
of a course in religion.
15-16.? HARMONY.I, II.
4 Cr.
Application of the study of scales, intervals, and chord formation in written
exercises. Written work includes harmonization of figured bass and given
melodies as well as opportumty for simple creative writing.
Upper Division Courses
HARMONY.
Prereq. z, I 6. I, 11.
2, 2 Cr.
5 5, 56. ADVANCED
Continuation of the work begun in Course 15-16,with advanced work in harnlonization of figured bass and given melodies. Thorough study of modulation,
advanced ,chord formations, #theuse of suspensions, retardations, and ornaments
of music.
Prereq. z, or z Cr. in piano, organ, or equivalent.
57, 58. CONDUCTING.
Jr. I, 11.
2, r Cr.
course designed for students planning to enter the field of public school
music, as directors of vocal or instrumental music or both, and for those who
wish training in church choir administration and direction. Students in music
education are advised to take the course in their junior year.
61-64.? INSTRUMENTAL
TECHNIQUE.
Prereq. z. I, II. Sr.
4 Cr.
Class instruction in string, reed, brass, and percussion instruments, preparing the
prospective public school music teacher an,d director for work in band and
orchestra.
65-64.? CHORALTECHNIQUE.
Prereq. 2. I, 11.
4 Cr.
Class instruction in the fundamentals of voice as related to singing, preparing
the prospective public school music teascher and director for work in vocal music.
77. COUNTERPOINT.
Prereq. 5 5. I. Sr.
2 Cr.
Strict counterpoint in one, two, three and four-part writing in all the species.
-
f(=ontinuation course. To receive credit for this course, a student must complete
both semesters.
78.
MUSICALANALYSIS.Prereq.
2,
$5,
and 7 7 or consent of instructor.
TI. Sr.
2
Cr.
A detailed study of the structure and form of music, together with the study
of the harmonies constituting any musical composition.
88. TEACHING
OF GRADESCHOOLMUSIC.
Jr. TI.
See course 888 under Education.
t
Cr.
OF HIGH SCHOOLMUSIC. Sr. I.
89. TEACHING
See course 89 under Education.
2
Cr.
I,
z Cr.
cr.
I
%. % c r .
%, %, Cr.
o Cr.
These organizations exist not only for fihe benefit of the music student but
for anyone enrolled as a student who wishes to ,participate in groups affording
opportunity for musical expression.
I , I Cr.
PREPARATORY
PIANO.I, 11.
Keyboard fundamentals. Major and harmonic minor scales, sight reading, hymns,
and simple repertory.
I , I Cr.
INTERMEDIATE
PIANO.Prereq. Prep. Piano or equiv. I, 11.
Melodic minor scales, chords, and arpeggi. Repertory including Bach-Carrol,
Burgmuller Opus 100, and Sonatina album.
I , I Cr.
ADVANCED
PIANO.Prereq. Interm. Piano or equiv. I, 11.
Technique as needed, using Cramer, Loeshorn, Bach Two-Part Inven,tions,
Sonatas of Haydn, Mozart, Beethoven, etc. Repertory from Classical, Romantic,
and Modern Composers.
I , I Cr.
ELEMENTARY
ORGAN.Prereq. Prep. Piano or equiv. I, 11.
General coordination and technique of playing the organ. Study of the Baoh
Eight Little Preludes and Fugues, Dupre's 79 Chorales, and hymn playing.
I , I Cr.
ADVANCED
ORGAN.Prereq. Elem. Organ or equiv. I, II.
Technique as needed. Repertory from pre-Bach, Baroque, Romantic, and modern
organ composers.
I'OICE.
I, 11.
I , I Cr.
Voice instruction includes correct habits of pronunciation and articulation,
brea,th control, flexibility, ear training in some cases, and interpretation of song
classics, both sacred and secular. One thirty-minute lesson per week.
:Continuation course. To receive credit for this course, a student must complete
both semesters.
%
BRASSINSTRUMENTS.
I, TI.
or
% or
WOOD-WIND
INSTRUMENTS.
I, 11.
I
Cr.
I
Cr.
Private or class instruction in these instruments is offered as follows:
a) Private instruction+nk
per semester. I credit.
thirty-minute lesson per week (or its equivalent)
b) Class instruction-ne
thirty-minute lesson per week (or its equivalent)
per semester, in groups of not less than three pupils. f/Z credit.
Opportunities for participation in Brass, String, and Woodwind ensembles are
offered each year on a non-credit basis.
Art
I . 2.
MODELING
AND SCULPTURE.
I, 11.
2, z Cr.
Design in three-dimensional form. Modeling of portraits, human figures and
animal Iforms. Plaster casting.
3. ART IN DAILYLIVING.I.
See course 3 under Department of Home Economics.
3 Cr.
7, 8. PAINTING.I, 11.
2 , z Cr.
Still life and landscape painting. Theory of composition and color. Problems
in line, form, space, color mixing, and practic,al problems.
Upper Division Courses
AND APPRECIATION
OF ART. 11.
64. HJSTORY
!ke course 64 under Department of Home Economics.
3 cr.
tcontinuation course. To receive credir. for this course, a student must complete
both semesters.
DIVISION OF THE SOCIAL SCIENCES
It is the general purpose of t h e work in this division m improve rhe student's
understanding of human relationships and his appreciation 0: rheir imporeance
2nd value, especially in their Chrktian interpretation. T h e work pmceeding
under the guidance of the faculty in this division i s therefore mwldsd to
develop a higher grade of citizenship and to improve the individual's adaptation to his vocation.
Department of History and Political Science
The work of this Department is designed to give the student an understanding and appreciation of the events, functions, motivations, and operations of
the phenomena in the fields of History and Political Science. It affords preparation for graduate study and for .teaching in secondary schools.
History
Major, 30 credits; minor, 21 credits. Students with a major or minor in
history x p l a n to teach in this field must include History 21 and 22. For
non-majors, prerequisites may be waived on consent of the instructor.
I-r.? EUROPEAN
CIV~IZATION.
Fr. I, 11.
6 Cr.
This course is a rapid survey of European history from ancient times and up to
the present. Desfgned to lay the foundation for future work in History.
I I.
SCANDINAVIAN
HISTORY.
I.
See Course I I under Scandinavian Language and Literature.
3 Cr.
UNITEDSTATESHISTORY.
SO., I, TI.
3. 3 Cr.
A survey of the life of the American people, and the development of their
ideas and institutions. First semester to 1865, second semester to present.
2 1 , 22.
Upper Division Courses
3 Cr.
AND THE REFORMATION.
Prereq. 1-2. Jr. I.
5 I . THE RENAISSANCE
A study of the economic, social, political, cultural, and religious movements
that marked the transition from medieval to modem civilization and culture.
(Offered 1959-60.)
3 Cr.
TO 1800. Prereq. 1-2. Jr., Sr. 11.
52. ENGLAND
Emphasis placed upon the constitutional development of England and the
factors which shaped the background of U. S. History. (Offered 1958-59.)
f-Continuation course. To receive credit for this course, a student must complete
both semesters.
53. LATIN-AMERICAN
HISTORY.
Prereq. 1-2. Jr., Sr. I.
A swdy of Latin America and its development. (Offered lr58-59.)
3 Cr.
$4. MODERNRUSSIA.Prereq. 1-2. Jr., Sr. 11.
3 Cr.
Particular emphasis on the period since Peter the Great. (Offered 1958-59.)
UNITEDSTATES.Prereq. 21, 22. Jr., Sr. I.
3 Cr.
5 5 . CONTEMPORARY
The United States drom about 1900 to 'the present. Seminar offered in connection with this course may be taken for one additional credit on approval
of instructor. (Offered 1959-60.)
DIPLOMACY.
Prereq. 6 cr. in Hist. or Pol. Sci. Jr., Sr. 11. 3 Cr.
56. AMERICAN
A consideration of foreign relations of the United Sta,tes from the Revolutionary
War to ,the :present. Seminar offered in connection with .ahis course may be
taken for one additional credit on approval of instructor. (Offered 1959-60.)
61. ANCIENTHISTORY.Prereq. 1-2. Jr., Sr. I.
3 Cr.
A cu1,tural and political history of ancient civilizations and their contributions
to modern cultures. (Offered I 9 5 8 - 59.)
62. HISTORY
OF CANADA.
Jr., Sr. I.
3 Cr.
The development of Canada from early exploration to the present, with
emphasis on Canadian-United States relations. (Offered
I 9 59-60.)
64. MEDIEVALHISTORY.Prereq. 1-2. Jr., Sr. 11.
3 Cr.
The medieval period of Europe and the Mediterranean area. (Offered 1958-59.)
71.
FRENCH REVOLUTIONAND EARLY NINETEENTH CENTURY EUROPE.
3 Cr.
Prereq. 12 credits in Hist. Jr., Sr. I.
Poli,tical, economic, social, and cultural developmen,t in Europe from 1789 to
I 850. The French Revolution, Napoleon, the Restoration, *he Revolution of
1848. (Offered 1959-60.)
credits in H i t . Jr. Sr. 11.
3 Cr.
Politi,cal, economic, social, and cultural ,deveIopment in Europe from I 848 to
1914. The national unification of Germany and Italy, che rise of imperialism,
and the ,background of World War I. (Offered 1959-60.)
72.
LATENINETEENTHCENTURY
EUROPE.Prereq.
74.
HISTORYOF POLITICAL
THOUGHT.
Jr., Sr. 11.
12
3 Cr.
Sec course 74 under Political Science.
CENTURY.
Prereq. 1 2 cr. in Hist. Sr. I, 11. 3, 3 Cr.
8 I , 82. THETWENTIETH
A survey of recent developments in (the world, extending from che ourbreak of
Vorld War I to vhe present. Seminar offered in connection wich this course
may 'be taken for one ~d~ditional
credit ,per semester on approval of instructor.
(Offered 1958-59.)
SEMINARIN NORTHWESTHISTORY.Jr., Sr. I. Prereq. consent of instructor.
2 Cr.
A st,udy of various areas of the history of Minnesota and the Northwest. A
research paper is required of each member of the class. (Offered 1958-59.)
99.
Political Science
Minor,
I1
credits.
I, 11.
6 Cr.
41-42.t AMERICANGOVERNMENT.
A study of the Constitution; civil rights; federal, state, and local governments;
citizenship; and popular control of government. Contemporary issues are
stressed.
Upper Division Courses
S THE UNITEDSTATES.Jr., Sr. I.
53. POLITICAL P A R ~OF
3
American parties, their organization, methods, functions, pressure groups. (Offered 1958-59.)
&=r.
16. AMERICAN
DIPLOMACY.11.
See course 56 under History.
3 Cr.
6 I.
PUBLICFINANCE.Prereq. 4 1-42 or Econ. I 5 for Political Science minors.
Jr., Sr. I.
3 Cr.
See course 61 under Business Administration and Economics.
74. HISTORY
OF POLITICAL
THOUGHT.
Jr., Sr. II.
3 Cr.
-4 study of .political philosophy and its influence and historical signi,ficance
from ancient Greeks to the present. (Offered I 959-60.)
OF THE SOCIALSTUDIES.Sr. I.
81. TEACHWG
See course 85 under Education.
2
Cr.
Geography
14. HUMANGEOGRAPHY.
Fr., So. II.
A study of geographical factors affecting mankind.
3 Cr.
Combined Major in Social Sciences for Teaching
Requirement: 21 credits in History (including History 21 and 22) and
Geography; Sociology I, 2; Economics 15, 16; Political Science 41-42.
Minor in Social Science
Requirement: 6 credits each in History and Sociology; Political Science 41-42;
and 3 credi,ts in Economics.
-'Continuation Course. To receive credit for this course, a student must complete
both semesters.
Department of Sociology
The objectives of this Department are to help students attain a better understanding of society and its social problems, as well as to prepare students for
social service, for graduate training in social work, and for graduate study in
Sociology. Beyond understanding of society and its problems and beyond
academic competence, the Department aims to explore the relevance of' Christianity to effective social service.
Major, 24 credits including Sociology I , 2. Required in addition are History
1-2, or 21, 22.
Minor, 1 5 credits including k i o l o g y I , z. Required in addition are History
1 - 2 , or 21, 22.
Introduction to Statistics is re~om~mended
for majors and minors in k i o l o g y .
For other recommended courses see under Social Work curricu1,un.
I.
PRINCIPLES
OF SOCIOLQGY.
Fr., So. I.
3 Cr.
fin introduction to the field of Sociology, examining its methods, techniques,
and general concepts as they apply to an analysis of American society.
2. SOCIALPROBLEMS.
Fr., So. 11.
3 Cr.
The dynamic processes at the root of contemporary problems. Problems of
personal, family and community disorganization are selected for special study.
TO STATISTICS.
Fr., So. 11.
4. INTRODUCTION
See course 4 under Business Administration and Economics.
YN. SOCIOLOGY.
I.
4 course in general sociology for nurses.
16. MODERNSCANDINAVIA.
11.
See course 16 under Scandinavian Language and Literature.
3 Cr.
2
Cr.
3 Cr.
2I.
RURALSOCIOLOGY.
SO. I.
3 Cr.
Structure, function and change of rural society with special attention to the
problems of contemporary rural America.
22. URBANSOCIOLOGY. SO. n.
3 Cr.
Study of the city as to historical background, causes of growth, social communities, maladjustments, urban planning, housing problems, health factors,
cultural centers, and rural-urban relationships.
AND FAMILYRELATIONSHIPS.
11.
42. MARRIAGE
See course 4 2 under Department of Home Economics.
3 Cr.
Upper Division Courses
51. CRIMINOLOGY.
Prereq. I . Jr., Sr. I.
3 Cr.
A study of the nature of delinquency and crime in our contemporary world. An
examination of causal factors, methods of apprehension, treatment, and prevention of delinquency and crime.
RACERELATIONS
A N D MINORITY
PROBLEMS.
Prereq. I . Jr., Sr. 11. 3 Cr.
5
The dynamics of prejudice, racism, and discrimination, together with an examination of social action programs. (Offered I 9 5 8-5 9.)
56.
RELATIONS.
Jr., Sr. 11.
LABORAND MANAGEMENT
3 Cr.
An analysis of the socio-economic roles of labor and management in a dynamic
society. (Offered 1959-60.)
57. FIELDSOF SOCIALWORK.Prereq. I. Jr., Sr. I.
3 Cr.
An introductory course to acquaint the student with the scope, nature, and
fanctions of social work. A survey of private and publjc social agencies in
the field of family welfare, child welfare, medical social work, group work,
and other community agencies.
60. PUBLICWELFARE.Prereq. I . Jr., Sr. 11.
3 Cr.
An introduction to the historical development, basic concepts, legislative policies,
organizational structure, and institutional functions of social welfare, including
a survey of c o n t e m p o r a ~public welfare and social security. (Offered 1958-59.)
61. SOCIALPSYCHOLOGY.
Prereq. I , Psy. 5, 6. Jr., Sr. I.
3 Cr.
Society and the individual, the socialization process, the development of personality, the impact of group norms. Selected forms of collective behavior
such as crowd, rumor, and audiences.
62. ABNORMAL
SSYCHOLOGY.
See course 62 under Psychology.
3 Cr.
64.
INTRODUCTION
TO METHODS
OF SOCIALWORK. Prereq. consent of in3 Cr.
structor. 11.
Principles and procedures of case work and group work designed especially for
students who anticipate entering the field of social, work. (Offered 1959-60.)
Department of Psychology and Education
Psychology
Courses in orientation are offered to freshmen as a part of the total program
to assist in the adjustments tha* the in-coming student needs to make. The
work in psychology is designed to aid the student in more ,adequately understanding, p r e d i c ~ g ,and modifying his own behavior as well as that of his
fellow men.
I.
ORIENTATION.
Required. Fr. Offered both semesters.
I Cr.
Designed to assist freshmen in making the proper adjustment to their work as
college students. I t includes units on orientation to the college, methods of
study, irnprovemeht of reading speed and comprehension, and vocational and
educational guidance.
5 , 6. GENERALPSYCHOLOGY.
I, TI.
2, 2 Cr.
A study of the basic processes underlying human behavior. The general prin-
ciples, metho& and problems of psychology are discussed. The second semester
emphasizes mental health and the application of the principles of psychology to
other problems of everyday life.
7N. GENERALPSYCHOLOGY.
I.
An introductory course intended for nurses.
2
cr.
Upper Division Courses
SOCIALPSYCHOLOGY.
I.
See course 61 under Department of Sociology.
61.
3 Cr.
3 Cr.
ABNORMALPSYCHOLOGY.
Prereq. f , 6. Jr., Sr. 11.
The sociological, psychological, and biological factors involved in neurotic and
psychotic behavior. Modem methods of diagnosis, treatment, and prevention.
Community organization for mental hygiene.
62.
Education
The education curriculum has been designed primarily for those preparing
to do high school teaching, although any student who is preparing to work
with youth is encouraged to study in this area. The work in this department
will qualify the teaching graduate for a Minnesota Teacher's certificate on the
junior and senior high school level, as well-as for further study in the field of
education.
Admission to the teacher education curriculum requires an application to be
approved by the Committee on Teacher Edu,cation. Application must be made
during the second semester of the sophomore year if the student is to complete
the program in the regular time of two years. Approval is granted on the
basis of a satisfactory health report, favorable personality characteristics, and
a minimum in scholastic achievement of 1.5 honor point ratio in the major, a
1.0 ratio in the minor, and a 1.0 ratio for the over-all average. The applicant
should be preparing for competency in at least two subject-matter fields that are
also taught on the high school level.
All students admitted to the teacher education curriculum must secure
two credits of Group Activity usually to be taken in connection with Ed. 5 1
and $ 2 . I n addition to the regular lower division requirements, students in
teacher education are required to have four semester hours in general psychology, these credits to be ,completed before taking Ed. 5 I .
N o student will be permitted to modify the two-year teacher education
curriculum in his program unless that change is approved by the Committee
on Teacher Education. All questions regarding the teacher education curriculum
should be referred to the Committee on Teacher Education.
3 Cr.
PSYCHOLOGY.
Prereq. Psy. 1, 6. Jr. I.
y I. EDUCATIONAL
.4 study of human development, learning, and adjustment in order to better
understand human behavior, especially the behavior of adolescents in a school
context.
$2.
TEACHING
IN SECONDARY
SCHOOLS.Prereq. I . Jr. II.
3 Cr.
This course has three parts: a study of the purposes and programs of secondary
schools; developing personal competency in planning instructional activities;
and developing the ability to evaluate the outcome of instruction.
53, $4. GROUP ACTIVITY.
I , I Cr.
This is not given as a separate course, but offered in connection with Education
5 i , $ 2 ; Religion 7 , 57. $ 8 ; Physical Education 6 , I I , 1 3 , 1 4 , 8 1 , 8 2 . The nature
of the experience will vary with the course with which i t is associated, and
may include such activities as teaching, supervising recreation, and advising
clubs. The cooperation of the agencies involved is necessary, with reports from
the supervisor and the student to the teacher of the course with which the
work is connected. A student may not receive more than 2 credits in Group
Activity.
3 Cr.
56. PRINCIPLESOF GUIDANCE.Prereq. 5 I . Sr. 11.
A study of the guidance function of the classroom teacher, tools and techniques used in studying students, and methods appropriate .for student guidance,
including counseling.
58. ISSUES
m CONTEMPORARY
EDUCATION.Sr. II.
3 Cr.
The purpose of the course is to develop skill in perceiving and defining current
problems in education, to gain an understanding of possible solutions, and to
develop some ability to evaluate the various solutions proposed. The relation
of the problems to the development of American education and to a philosophy
of education is stressed.
73.
TEACHING
OF MODERNLANGUAGES.
Sr. I.
z Cr.
79.
TEACHING
OF NATURALSCIENCES.Sr. I.
z Cr.
8 I.
TEACHING
OF BUSINESS.Sr. I.
z Cr.
83.
TEACHING
OF MATHEMATICS.
Sr. I.
z Cr.
81.
TEACHING
OF SOCIALSTUDIES.
Sr. I.
67.
TEACHING
OF HEALTHEDUCATION
AND PHYSICAL
EDUCATION.
Sr. I. z Cr.
$8.
TEACHING
OF GRADESCHOOLMUSIC.Jr. 11.
z Cr.
89.
TEACHING
OF HIGH SCHOOLMUSIC.Sr. I.
z Cr.
91.
TEACHING
OF HOMEECONOMICS.
Sr. I.
z Cr.
92.
EVALUATION
AND ADULTEDUCATION
IN HOMEECONOMICS. Sr. 11.
2
Cr.
53.
TEACHING
OF ENGLISH.Sr. I.
2
Cr.
y5.
TEACHING
OF SPEECH. Sr. I.
z Cr.
z Cr.
Courses 7 3 through 95 include the study of the materials, organization, and
teaching procedures of the field for which they are given; applications of the
principles of teaching are made in the specific field. Usually, each student is
required to take two of these courses to prepare for student teaching; this
means one course related to the major and one to the minor. Prerequisites are a
major or a minor in the field and Education 52.
4 to 5 Cr.
Prereq. $ 2 . Sr. I.
97. STUDENTTEACHING.
Observation, participation in teaching activities, and experience in actual control of the classroom situation. Direction of the program is shared by the
college supervisor and selected critic teachers.
Library Science
The dollowing courses prepare the student to meet the state requirements
for a minor in library science. They train him in making a wise choice of
bmks for the school library, in preparing books and other library materials for
circulation, in administering a school library, and in making intelligent and
effective use of library tools for his own needs as a teacher.
Minor,
I6
credits.
3 Cr.
OF THE SCHOOL
LIBRARY.
So., Jr. I, 11.
5 ~ - 5 6 . t BASICFUNC~IONS
Designed to &paint the student with the place of the library in the school
and community; local public, county, state, and national services; standards;
relations with school admin,istration, faculty, students, and community; the
budget; planning, housing, and equipment; library records; organization of
materials; school library administration. Two credits first semester; one credit,
second.
+Continuation course. To receive credit for this course, a student must complete
both semesters.
57-58.? ELEMENTARY
MATERIALS.
Jr., Sr. I, 11.
4 Cr.
Library materials for the elementary school library; book selection, prin,ciples
and standard lists; correlating the library holdings with the grade curriculum;
reviewing of individual titles. Sources. (Offered I 9 5 8- 5 9.)
59-60.? SECONDARY
MATERIALS.
Jr., Sr. I. 11.
6 Cr.
Introduction to book selection; book selection in subject fields, including reference books and related fiction;
and other non-book materials, standard dists for book selection; reviewing of individual titles. Sources. (Offered
1959-60.)
I Cr.
METHODS.Prereq. 5 6 . Sr. I.
6 1. PRACTICAL
Giving the student practice experience in school limbraries; teaching the use
of the library; weeding and withdrawal procedures.
2 Cr.
62. READING
GUIDANCE.
Prereq. 56. Sr. 11.
Remedial reading in the school as it relates to the school library, reading ladders;
student's personal library; professional literature in the field; lists, testing,
and records; guiding individual students in their recreational reading.
Department of Business Administration and Eccrnomics,
and Secretarial Studies
The objective of this department is to help students gain a broad knowledge
and sound perspective of business and our economic society. Such knowledge
and perspective are necessary for success in specific positbns in our complex
business world and .should provide the background to facilitate advancement,
with experience, to positions of respons2bility. A degree with a business major
is a common requirement of business firms and government agencies.
Together wich secretarial studies, the department also provides a teaching
major or minor, and it ,prepares for graduate work in business. Furcher, it
recognizes the need for trained people in &e social sciences and presently offers
a minor in economics.
Business Administration and Economics
Major in Business Administration, 36 credits, including courses I,
16, 53, 72.
2,
3, 4, 15,
In addition, History 21, z t and Psychology 5, 6 are required.
Minor in Business Administration,
21
credits, including courses I , 2, 3,
I 5,
16, and six credits in Upper Division courses.
Minor in Economics, I 5 credits, including courses
from 4, 51, 56, 6 1 , 62.
I
1, I 6,
and nine credits
I, 2.
P ~ C I P L EOF
S ACCOUNTING.Fr. I, 11.
3, 3 c r .
An introduction to the principles of accounting and their application to the
single proprietorship, partnership, and corporate forms of business; preparation
and analysis of financial statements; procedure in recording business transactions;
and an introduction to manufacturing and cost accounting. Two lectures and
one double laboratory hour per week.
3. INTRODUCTION
TO BUSINESS.
Fr. I.
3 Cr.
An introductory survey of business and business management including a study
of the variety, nature and interrelationsship of problems of business operation.
Finance, personnel, production, marketing, internal organization and control,
and governmental relationships are a few of the :topics covered.
4. INTRODUCTION
TO STATISTICS.
SO. 11.
3 Cr.
A course in scientific met,hods of dealing with the collection, organization,
comparison and interpretation of numerical data. The technique of constructing
gaphs and tables, as well as fin,ding measures of central tendencies, variability,
correlation and sound methods of sampling.
I 1: I 6. PRINCIPLESOF ECONOMICS.
SO. I, 11.
3. 3 Cr.
The foundations of economic analysis; production, employment and prices; and
public poli,cy. The objective is to promote interest in economic problems and
the ability to use economic analysis in reaching judgments about economic
poli,cy problems.
Upper Division Courses
3 Cr.
5 I . MONEY AND BANKING.Prereq. 2, 4, I 5, 16. Jr., Sr. I.
The influence of money and banking on economic activity and of monetary
and fiscal policies which might be adopted to yield a stable general price level
with high levels of output and employment. (Offered 1958-19.)
5 3 . BUSINESSLAW. Jr., Sr. I.
3 Cr.
Legal rules relating to contracts, agency, negotiable instruments, property and
business organizations.
54. MARKETING.
Prereq. z, 4, 15, 16. Jr., Sr. 11.
3 Cr.
Marketin,g :from a businessman's standpoint, winh emphasis on ways in which
management decisions are made con,cerning product .planning, merchandise
selection, channels of distribution, promotional activities, pricing and selling.
(Offered 1959-60.)
RELATIONS.
Prereq.
56. LABORAKD MANAGEMENT
See course 56 under Department of Sociology.
I
5, 16. Jr., Sr. 11.
3 Cr.
3 Cr.
MANAGEMENT.Prereq. I 5, 16. Jr., Sr. 11.
18. INDUSTRIAL
The more important production procedures commonly employed in progressive
manufacturing plants, and their relationship to the attainment of management
objectives. (Offered 1958-59.)
59. COST ACCOUN.I?NG.
Prereq. I , 2. Jr., Sr. I.
3 Cr.
Essential features of accounting for manufaoturing concerns with particular
reference to the securing of unit costs of manufactured products; order method;
process costs; and cost reports. (Offered 195 8-59.)
3 Cr.
61. PUBLICFINANCE.Prereq. 15. Jr., Sr. I.
Governmental taxation, spending and borrowing, and ,the impact of governmental finance on economic activit,~.
62. BUSINESSFINANCE.Prereq. 59. Jr., Sr. 11.
3 Cr.
The various objectives in financing of private businesses, with major emphasis
on administrative tools of finance and means of financing short-term, intermediate-term, and long-term asset requirements. (Offered 1958-59.)
6 3 . TAXATION.
Prereq. I , z. Jr., Sr. I.
3 Cr.
This course will cover several types of taxation, wich particular emphasis on
the income tax, attempting to give a knowledge of tax requirements, proced,ures and problems as they relate .to business and individuals. (Offered
1959-60.)
Sr. 11.
3 Cr.
72. SEMINARIN BUSINESSADMINISTRATION.
This seminar will cover special problems of concern to business majors which
are not considered in the regular curriculum. Lectures will be given by local
business leaders. The course will encourage advanced study by students in
areas of particular interest to them.
Secretarial Studies
These courses are pIanned to prepare students for stenographic =nd secretarial
positions in business o&ces, to assist in the preparation &or the teaching of
buiness edmcation in high schools, for parish secretarial work, and to provide an
opportunity for the development of business skills for personal use.
Graduation major, 31 credits above I , including z, 3-4, 8, 51, 52, 53-54,
Eusiness Administration I , z, 3, 53. Business education major, 37. credits above I
including courses listed f o r grad,uation major plus Business Administration I 5, 16.
Minor, 25 credits a~bove I , including 2, 3-4, 8, 51, 52, 53-54, and Business
Administration I , 2, o r I 5 , 16.
I.
ELEMENTARYTYPEWRITING.
Offered both semesters.
I Cr.
A course f o r the development of the fun.damental skills of typewriting. Three
hours per week.
2.
INTERMEDIATE
TYPEWRITING.
11
2 Cr.
Problems in typing tabulations, manuscript typing, use of carbons, addressing
envelopes, and in letter arrangements. Four hours per week.
SHORTHAND.I, 11.
6 Cr.
3- 4 . t ELEMENTARY
Fundamentals of Simplified Gregg Shorthand. Dictation and transcription. Four
hours per week.
i-.Gntinuation course. T o receive credit for this course, a student must complete
both semesters.
8. OFFICE MACHINES.Prereq. 2. Offered both semesters.
2 Cr.
The operation of the calculator, adding machine, mimeograph, mimeoscope,
spirit duplicator, and the transcription machine. Two hours per week.
Upper Division Courses
TYPEWRI~NG.
Prereq. 2 or equivalent. I.
2 Cr.
5 I. ADVANCED
Further development of typewriting technique in business letter qrrangernent,
billing, tabulating, and the typing of legal documents. Open to students having
attained a speed of 50 words per minute. Four hours ,per week.
52. SECRETARIAL
PRACTICE.Brereq. 2, 3-4,11.
3 Cr.
Dictation, business letterwriting, filing, telephoning, use of business and legal
forms, personality development, writing application letters, and making application for a job. Mimeographing also taught for those who include this as a
part of the parish worker's course. Four hours per week.
ADVANCED
SHORTHAND.
Prereq. 4 or equivalent. I, 11.
4 Cr.
5 3-54.f
Advanced study of Gregg shorthand. Rapid dictation. Open to students who
can take dictation at a minimum of 80 words per minute. Four hours per week.
81. TEACHING
OF BUSINESS.
Sr. I.
See course 8 I under Education.
z Cr.
Department of Home Economics
The objectives of .the department are threefold: first, to provide courses that
will help students to solve personal, home, and family living problems; second,
to offer training for homemaking; and third, to offer training for the teaching
of home economics. Graduates are qualified to teach in federally aided home
economics departments. Courses are open to all students and recom.mended for
general education.
Non-teaching major, 33 credits; courses are I, 2, 3, 8, 39, 40, 42, 44, 57,
66, 67-71, 73. Also required are Chemistry 4 or 5-6, Physics 3, Economics I 5,
k i o l o g y I, Biology 4 or 13-14,and 54, Psychology 5, 6, and 3 additional
credits in Social Science.
Non-teachin,g minor,
22
credits including courses
I,
2, 3, 7, 39,40, 42, and 44.
Teaching major, 3 8 credits; courses listed for n o n - t e a c h g major plus 3 3 and
75.
I. CLOTHINGSELECTION,
CARE, AND REPAIR.I.
3 Cr.
-4 study of the factors involved in the choice, care, and repair of clothing.
Beauty in design, becomingness, appropriateness, and some of the textile f2brics
suitable for different uses are topics considered.
'Continuation course. To receive credit for this course, a sudent must complete
both semesters.
n.
2.
CLOTHINGCONSTRUC~ON.
z Cr.
This course provides laboratory experience in making simple garments in cotton
and rayon. It includes experiences in planning, cutting, fitting, and suitable
techniques in making garments, the use of the sewing machine, alteration of
garments. Home Economics I prerequisite for Home Economics education majors.
Two double lrboratory periods, one lecture discussion period per week.
3 Cr.
3. ART IN DAILY LNING. I.
A study of art as it is met in the activities of everyday living. Open to all
students.
E. ELEMENTS
OF NUTRITION.11.
3 Cr.
Normal human nutrition applied to food selection for the promotion and
maintenance of health will be considered; student and recommended dietaries
will be analyzed.
3 3. COLOR
AND DESIGN.I.
3 Cr.
A study of the principle of design and color related to selecting, arranging,
and designing of household furnishings. Lettering and simple poster designing.
Some craft experience. Home Economics 3 prerequisite for Home Economics
majors. Three double laboratory periods per week.
11.
z Cr.
36. CRAFTS.
Laboratory experience in various crafts which can 'be done at home or at camps
with simple equipment. Principles of design and color in their application to
crafts will be studied. Two double lrboratory periods per week. (OfTered
1959-60.)
PRINCIPLESOF FOODPREPARATION
AND MANAGEMENT.
Prereq. 8 or
permission of instructor. I, 11.
3, 3 Cr.
Laboratory experience in menu planning, meal service, food purchasing, and
f m d preparation. Three double laboratory period9 a week.
39, 40.
42. MARRIAGE
AND FAMILY
RELATIONSHIPS.
11.
3 Cr.
A course applying principles of cultural living to everyday problems of home
life. Discussions of personal family relationships, preparation for marriage, the
Christian home and its influence in the community, and related subjects. Regular
lectures, talks by guest speakers, illustrated lectures, and tours.
11.
2 Cr.
44. CHILDDEVELOPMENT.
A study of the care and training of the young child as to his physical, mental,
and social development. One lecture period plus one double laboratory period
per week.
Upper Division Courses
57. TEXTILES.
I.
r Cr.
Study of textile fibers, fabrics, and finishes with special emphasis on selection,
use, and care of common household an,d clothing textiles. Two double laboratory
hours a week. (Offered 1959-60.)
64. HISTORY
AND APPRECIATION
OF ART. 11.
3 Cr.
A study of the historical development of archi,tecture, decoration, costume,
furniture, painting, and sculpture. Two regular hours scheduled and field trips
arranged. ( m e r e d 1958-59.)
66. HOMEPLANNINGAND FURNISHING.
11.
3 Cr.
This course includes a consideration of housing, an analysis of floor plans, a
study of the design of exteriors and interiors, and problems in selecting,
arranging, and conserving home furnishings. Home Economics 3 and 3 3 prerequisite for Home Economics Education majors. Three double laboratory periods per
week.
67. FAMILYHEALTH.
I.
r Cr.
Basic facts and practical application of home care of the sick. Problems relating
to environmental disease, prevention of illness and safety measures, as well as to
individual health problem within ,the family group.
HOMEMANAGEMENT
PROBLEMS.
I.
2 Cr.
Con~i~deration
of problems relating to planning, directing, guiding, and COordinating ohe resources of the home for happy, satisfying family living.
71.
73. HOME
MANAGEMENT
LABORATORY.
I.
2 Cr.
Actual experience in ,the regular activities of homemaking such as meal preparation and service, entertaining, care of the house and equipment. Also experience
in various aspects of management met in home living such as management of
money, time, energy, and equipment.. Six weeks residence in a home management house with one conference hour per week. Food costs .to be detemined
by the group.
74. CONSUMEREDUCATION
AND INCOMEMANAGEMENT.
11.
2 Cr.
The wise choice of consumer goods and s e ~ i c e savailable on the market and
the necessity of a careful plan for spending are topics which will be considered
for the purpose of helping the student receive greater satisfaction from the use
of money income.
75. ADVANCED
CLOTHING
CONSTRUCTION.
Prereq. z. I.
2 Cr.
This course provides labrstbry experience in making garments in wool. More
advanced problems in fitting and construction are used than those in Course 2.
Some experience in planning and constructing garments for children is also
given. Two three-hour laboratory periods per week. (Offered 1958-59.)
Sr. I.
91. TEACHINGO F HOME ECONOMICS.
See course 91 under Education.
z Cr.
EVALUATION
AND ADULTEDUCATION
IN HOMEECONOMICS.
Sr. 11.
See course gz under Education.
2
92.
Cr.
AUGSBURG
COLLEGE
DIVISION OF NATURAL SCIENCES
AND MATHEMATICS
It is the purpose of the division of Natural Science to provide training in
scientific methods and techniques; .to interpret Natural Science in t h e light of
the Word of God; to acquaint the student with the significance of Natural
Science in a modem, changing world; to emphasize a sound mind and a strong
body; to train for vocations in various fields of Natural Science; and to equip
the student with a scientific background which will enrich his life and the lives
of his fellow men.
Department of Biology
MR. NASH, MR. URDAHL,MR. MICKELBERG
The aim of this Department is to give the student a broader scientific background through the study of Biology, to further the use of leisure ,time, and to
prepare for vocations or graduate study.
Major, 24 credits, at least 8 credits in Upper Division courses; minor, 16
credits. Courses 1-2, 3 ~ 7~
, do not count toward the major or minor.
I-2.t THENATURALWORLDAND MAN. Fr. I, 11.
8 Cr.
The development of scientific foundations in the physical and biological sciences.
Five periods per week consisting of lectures, lecture demonstrations, laboratory
work, and discussions.
A N D PHYSIOLOGY.
Fr. I.
4 Cr.
3N. HUMANANATOMY
A professional course in human anatomy and physiology with special emphasis
on structure. Two lectures and two double laboratory periods per week. Students
who have credit for Biol. 4 will not receive credit for Biol. 3N.
4.
HUMAN
ANATOMY
AND PHYSIOLOGY.
Fr. 11.
4 Cr.
A professional course in human anatomy and physiology with emphasis on
h t h structure and function.. Two lectures and two double laboratory periods
per week. Students who have credit for Biol. 3N will not receive credit for
Biol. 4.
I.
3 Cr.
7 ~ .GENERALBACTERIOLOGY.
'
1 course in general bacteriology for nurses. Two lectures and two double
laboratory periods per week.
8 Cr.
13-14.? GENERAL
ZOOLOGY.
Fr. I, II.
A survey of the animal kingdom with emphasis on the habitat, morphology,
physiology, ada~tarion,and reproduction of type animals. Biological ~rinciples
are emphasized. Two lectures and two double laboratory periods per week.
?Continuation course. To receive credit for this course, a student must complete
tmth semesters.
4. 4 Cr.
25, 26. GENERAL
BOTANY.SO., Jr. I, TI.
A study of the morphology and physiology of higher plants, followed by a
survey of the plant kingdom. Emphasis is also placed on botanical principles.
Fiowering plants are identified in the spring. Three lectures and two single
laboratory periods per week.
3 2. COMPARATIVE
ANATOMY
OF VERTEBRATES.
Prereq.
1 3 - 14.
11.
4 Cr.
A comparative study dealing with the taxonomy, morphology, and evolution
of the larger vertebrate ,phyla. Two lectures and two double laboratory periods
per week.
Upper Division Courses
4 Cr.
51. GENETICS.Prereq. 13-14,or 25, 26. So., Jr. I.
A study of the laws involved in heredity and variation. Special emphasis is
placed on the practical application of the genetical laws. Four le~turesper week.
(Ogered 1959-60.)
4 Cr.
Prereq. I 3-14 or 2 5 , 26. So., Jr. 11.
5 2. ECOLOGY.
A survey of local ecological communities, and a study of the general principles
of biological association and succession. Two lectures and one double laboratory
period or field trip per week. (Offered 1959-60.)
;Cr.
Prereq. I 3-14. Sr. I.
5 3. GENERALENTOMOLOGY.
A study of the habitat, morphology, physiology, reproduction, and classification
of insects. Two lectures and one double laboratory period per week. (Offend
1958-59.)
54. GENERALBACTERIOLOGY.
Prereq. Chem. 5-6. 11.
4 Cr..
A review of the general field of bacteriology, including the cause, control, and
prevention of important diseases. Training in modern laboratory techniques. TWO
lectures and two double laboratory periods per week.
3 Cr.
OF FLOWERING
PLANTS.Prereq. 25, 26. Sr. 11.
56. TAXONOMY
Taxonomy of flowering plants. Special emphasis is placed on systematic principles,
systems of classification, rules of nomenclature, etc. Two lectures and' one
double laboratory period per week. (Offered 1958-19.)
60. BIOLOGICAL
TECHNIQUES.
Sr. TI.
I or 2 Cr.
Practical work in mounting of microscopic slides, photography, and doing
projects useful to teachers. (Offered 195 8-59.)
OF NATURAL
SCIENCES.Sr. I.
79. TEACHING
See course 79 under Education.
z Cr.
Department of Chemistry
I t is the purpose of this department ,to give students an understanding and
an appreciation of the nature of matter and the ways (by d i u h this has {been
elucidated. The curriculum in chemistry provides an opportunity .to examine
the chemical aspect of ehe structure, the power and the beauty of one of the
great intellectual accomp1ishmen.t~of man-modern
science, and it provides
dramatic exa,ples of effective ways to handle certain types of ,problems.
Courses in this department are designed to prepare students for teaching
,chemistry in secondary schools, {to provide background for graduate study in
chemistry and f,uroher study in medicine, dentistry, engineerin,g, nursing,
pharmacy, ,medical technology, and other related fields.
Major, 25 credits; minor, 16 credits. Courses 1-2,3N and 4 do not count
tow,ard the major or! minor.
Pre-medical students are required to com,plete the following courses and
should take them in the order shown: Fr. 1-6;Soph. 53-54;Jr. 61, 66. Medical technologists should complete, in the order shown: Fr., 5-6; Soph., 53-14;
Jr., 61.Prospective teachers of chemistry in secondary schools should complete
5-6 and 53-54;61 and 66 are highly recommended, and may ,be substituted for
53-54.Prospective chemists and graduate students should complete 5-6, 53-54,
61,62, 71, 91-92.
1-2. THE NATURALWORLDAND MAN. Fr. I, 11.
For course description see Department of Biology.
8 Cr.
j ~ CHEMISTRY
.
FOR NURSES.
Fr. I.
3 Cr.
A lecture and laboratory course coverin'g subjects related to nursing in the
fields of inorganic, organic, physiological and pa~hola~ical
ohemistry. Designed
to meet 'the needs of the ,&hools of N'ursing of Lutheran Deaconess Hospital
and Swedish Hospital. Two lectures and two hours of laboratory ,per week.
4. INTRODUCTION
TO CHEMISTRY.
Fr. 11. Prereq. High School algebra (or
4 Cr.
permission of instructor).
A lecture and laboratory course designed for the non-major and to meet the
needs of students in home economics. A study of laws and theories of chernistq
with descriptive material selected from the fields of inorganic, organic, physiological and physical chemistry. Students who complete 1-6 may not receive
credit for Chem. 3N or 4. Students who had chemistry in high school may not
receive credit for Chem. 4 except by permission of instructor. Three lectures and
two hours of laboratory per week.
5-6. GENERALCHEMISTRY
AND QUALITATNE
ANALYSIS.Prereq. Math. I or
equiv., or concurrent registration in Math. I. Fr., So., I, 11.
8 Cr.
A study of laws and theories of chemistry and of non-metals and metals and
their compounds. Systematic semimicro qualitative analysis of cations. Three
lectures and four hours of laboratory per week.
Upper Division Courses
53-54.
ORGANICCHE~IISTRY.
Prereq. 5-6. So., Jr., Sr., I, 11.
8 Cr.
A discussion of the important classes of aliphatic and aromatic compounds.
Correlations based on elementary molecular orbital theory and modern concepts
of reaction meohanisms. Laboratory work in study of technique and in the
preparation and study of typical organic compounds. Three lectures and two
two-hour laboratory periods per week.
61.
Q U A N ~ T A T I VANALYTICAL
E
CHEMISTRY.
Prereq. 5-6,and ability t o use
logarithms. (Students receiving less than C in 5-6 may register with
y Cr.
,permission of instructor only.) So., Jr., Sr. I.
Classical methods of gravimetric and volumetric ana1,ysis. Study of ionic equilibrium. Three lectures, one hour of recitation and six hours of laboratory per week.
62.
INSTRUMENTAL
ANALYSIS.
Prereq. 61. (Students receiving less than C in
61 may register with permission of instrucmtor only.) So., Jr., Sr. 11. 4 Cr.
Modern menhods of anaNlysis. Electrochemical and optical met.hods; emphasis on
use of instruments. Recent developments in analytical methods. Two lectures
and six hours of laboratory per week.
66.
TO PHYSICAL
CHEMISTRY.
Prereq. Math. 14, Chem. 61 and
INTRODUCTION
Physics 6. Jr., Sr. 11.
4 Cr.
A course designed t o meet the needs of pre-medical students. A kinetic approach to gas laws, liquids, solutions, chemical equilibrium, rates of reactions,
colloids, and electrochemistry. Three lectures and one three-hour laboratory
period per week. Students completing 91-92 may not receive credit for 66.
71.
ORGANIC
QUALITATIVE
ANALYSIS.
Prereq. 5 3-54. Jr., S r I.
4 Cr.
Methods of q~alita~tive
analysis of organic compounds and mixtures. A study
of theories and mechanisms of substitution and elimination reactions. Two class
discussions and six hours of laboratory per week.
91-92.
PHYSICALCHEMISTRY.
Prereq. Math. $2, Chem. 61 and Physics 6;
Ghern. 53-54 is himghly recommended. Jr., Sr., I, 11.
8 Cr.
A course &or ,prospective graduate students and chemists. An advanced course
in ph'ysical chemistry emphasizin.g ,the thermodynamic approach to the properties of matter. Gas laws, liquids, solids, solutions, !phase rule, thermodyna,mics,
kinetics, and electrochemistry. Three lectures and two three-hour laboratory
periods per week. (Offered on demand, 1959-60.)
Department of Physics
Recent developments in the field of Physics make it imperative that more
than adequate training be provided for those who intend .to continue their
studies in graduate school 04 who intend to pursue a career in the teaching of
,physisics.It is the aim of this department to assure the needed training for both
of these groups and to provide the non-science major with sufficient background
to make i't !possible for him to fallow with some degree of comprehension the
developments in .the field of science as they come to hi,m from # h emedium of
semi-scientific publications.
Major,
28
credits, including courses 5 I , 52, 63, 64, 73, 74.
Minor, 16 credits.
1-2. THE NATURALWORLDAND MAN. Fr. I, 11.
For course description see Department of Biology.
3.
PRINCIPLESOF PHYSICS.Prereq. elementary algebra. Fr. I.
8 Cr.
4 Cr.
A lecture demonstramtion-laboratory course in the principles of physics including mechanics, fluids, heat, electrici.ty, magnetism, 1igh.t and sound. This
course is intended for students of home economia but may be taken by others
who wish. some basic information in ,the field of Physics. Three lectures, cwohour 'laboratory. Students with high school physics may nat receive credit for
Physics 3 except by ,permission of instructor.
5. GENERALPHYSICS.Prereq. Mach I 3 or concurrent registration in Macth I 3.
Fr., So. I.
4 Cr.
A general elementary course in mechanics, sound, and hea,t. Three lectures,
one quiz, and one two-hour laboratory period per week.
6. GENERALPHYSICS.Prereq. 5. Fr., So. 11.
4 Cr.
This course is a continuation of Phys. and covers electricity, magnetism, and
light. Three lectures, one quiz, and one ,two-hour laboratory period per week.
Uspper Division Courses
N ATOMICAND NUCLEARPHYSICS.Prereq. 6, and Math.
5 I. I N ~ O D U C T I OTO
5 I or concurrent registration in Math. 5 I. So., Jr. I.
4 Cr.
The hydrogen atom, optical and X-ray spectra determination of "e" and "eY'/m,
radioactivity, disintegration of nuclei, nuclear fission. Four hours lecture per
week.
~
MAGNETISM.Prereq. 6, and Math. 5 1 or concurrent
52. E L E C T R I C IAND
4 Cr.
registration in Math. 5 I.So., Jr. 11.
Electric and magnetic fields, potential, D.C. circuits, A.C. circuits, electrical
instruments, electmnics. Four hours lecture per week.
61.
OPTICS.Prereq. 6 and Math. 51 or concurrent registration in Math. 51.
Jr. I.
4 Cr.
Geometrical and physical optics dealing with topics such as reflection and refraction by both plane and spherical surfaces, less aberrations, interference,
diffraction, polarized light. (Offered 1958-59.)
62.
MECHANICS. Prereq. 6 .and Ma&. 5 I . Jr. 11.
4 cr.
Introduction to vector algebra and vector analysis, forces, motion of a particle,
motion o'f a rigid 'body, work, kinetic energy, vibra~tions in one dimension,
motion in a conservative field. (Offered 1958-59.)
63-64.
ADVANCED
PHYSICSLABORATORY.
Prereq. concurrent registration in an
upper division physics course. Jr., Sr. I, 11.
z Cr.
Experiments will be performed in electricity and ,magnetism, atarnic and nuclear
physics, optics, heat and mechanics. One three-hour period per week. (Offered
1958-59.)
71.
HEATAND THERMODYNAMICS.
Prereq. 6, and Math. 51 or concurrent
registration- in Math. 5 I . Jr., Sr. I, 11.
4 Cr.
A study of temperature, heat, expansion, change of state, ideal gases, first and
secon,d laws of thermodynamics, heat engines. (Offered 1959-60.)
72.
MATHEMATICAL
PHYSICS.Prereq. 6, and Math. 51. Sr. II.
4 Cr.
Discussion of the equations of mathematical physics wirh applications to various
fie1:ds such as mechanics, thermodynamics, heat flow, electricity and magnetism,
optics. (Offered 1959-60.)
73-74.
ADVANCED
PHYSICSLABORATORY.
Prereq. concurrent registration in an
upper division physics course. Jr., Sr. I, 11.
z Cr.
Experiments will be performed in electricity and magnetism, atomic and nuclear
physics, optics, heat and mechanics. One three-hour period per week. (OSered
1959-60.)
OF NATURAL
SCIENCES.
Sr. I.
74. TEACHING
See course 79 under Education.
t
Cr.
Combined Science Major for Teaching
Requirement: 40 credits in Natural Science, including Chemistry 5-6 and
either 53-54 or 61, 66; Biology 13-14 and 25, 26; Physics 5 and 6.
Department of Mathematics
The Department of Mathematics aims to give students a working knowledge
of mathematics sugcient for solvi,ng the simpler problems of life, also to afford
studens in special fields the mathematical foundation needed for a fuller understanding of their subjects. It aims to open to those who major in the subject a
wider horizon with experience chat will make them e6cient workers in their
chosen fields and also give them confidence to pursue further study.
Major, 26 credits; minor,
20
credits.
Courses I, 2, 5 and 6 'do not count toward the major or minor in mathematics, but I and 2 must be completed as prerequisites to other ,courses.
I.
SECOND
COURSEALGEBRA.
Prereq. elem. algebra. Fr. I.
3 Cr.
Fundamentals of algebra continued and proper foundation laid for more advanced work in mathematics. Four hours per week. Students who had higher
algebra in high school may not receive credit for this course.
i . SOLID GEOMETRY.
Prereq. plane geometry. Fr. TI.
3 Cr.
Geometry applied to solids and planes. Area and volume ~hrmulas developed.
Spherical triangles and polygons introduced. Four hours per week.
5 . ENGINEERING
DRAWING.Prereq. 2. I.
3 Cr.
Elements of drafting with an i n t d u c t i o n to the use of graphs and formulas.
Eight hours o week.
3 Cr.
6. ENGINEERING
DRAWING
AND DESCRIP~VE
GEOMETRY.
Prereq. 5. TI.
Methods of representation. Graphical and algebraic solutions. Eight hours a
week.
13,
INTRODUCTION
TO MATHEMATICAL
ANALYSIS.Prereq. Math.
I or
equivalent. Fr., So. I, 11.
5. 5 Cr.
This is an integrated course including college algebra, trigonometry and plane
analytical geometry.
14.
Upper Divisi0.n Courses
ELEMENTARY
CALCULUS
AND DIFFERENTIAL
EQUATIONS.
Prereq. I 3,
14. so., ~ r I,
. 11.
5, 5 Cr.
Fundamental concepts are introduced. Formulas for differentiation and integration, and solutions for various types of ordinary differential equations are
developed and applications made.
5 I,
J 2.
53. SOLD ANALYTICAL
GEOMETRY.
Prereq. 14. Sr. I.
3 Cr.
Lines and planes in space are studied and their equations developed. Quadratic
surface and transformation are given their proper emphasis.
3 Cr.
OF EQUATIONS.
Prereq. Math. 51.Sr. ll.
54. THEORY
This course includes the study of complex numbers, determinants and other
topics that aid in the solution of equations of higher degree.
OF MATHEMATICS.
Sr. I.
83. TEACHWG
See course 83 under Education.
z Cr.
Department of Health and Physical Education
The aim of the Department of Heal,th and Physical Education is to promote
health and physical fitness through a well-rounded physical education program,
to develop character and good sportsmanship, to further the worthy use of
leisure time, and to provide an effective training program for prospective
teachers of health and physical education.
All students are required to take a physical examination by the college
physician as a part of the registration procedure before participating in any
phase of che physical education program.
One year of physical activities, courses 3 and 4, is required of all students.
Major for men, 32 credits, including courses 2, 3, 4, 5 , 6, 8, I I, 12, 23,
all upper division courses. Biology 4 also required.
Major for women, 29 credits, including courses 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 8, 13, 14, 17,
I?,23, 17, $8,66, 73, 74, 84, 86. Biology 4 also required.
Minor,, 2 1 credits, includinmg courses 2, 3, 4, 1, 6, 8, 1 I, 12, y 1, 73, 74 for
men; 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 8, 13, 14, 17, 18, 73, 74 for women.
2. PERSONAL
AND COMMUNITY
HEALTH.Fr. Offered both semesters.
2 Cr.
-2 study of modern concepts and practices of health and heakhful living applied
to the individual and the community.
ACTIVITIES.
(Men). Fr., So. I,
3, 4. PHYSICAL
II.
ACTIVITIES.(Women). Fr. I,
3, 4. PHYSICAL
n.
%, % Cr.
INTRODUCTION
TO HEALTHEDUCATION,
PHYSICALEDUCATION,AND
RECREATION.
Fr. I.
2 Cr.
P, brief preview of the three present day interrelated fields of heal,th education,
physical education, and recreation.
1.
6. RECREATIONAL
A c m m s . Fr. II.
I Cr.
Theory and practi,ce in teaching recreational activities, social recreation, quiet
games, low organized games, noon hour activities, camp nights, relays, and
modified games. Two hours per week.
K. F ~ AID.
T Fr., SO. 11.
American Red Cross F i a t Aid Course.
I
Cr.
I I.
TEAMSPORTSAND LEAD-UPGAMES.(Men). So. I.
2 Cr.
A study of technique, rules, and teaching of lead-up games for soccer, speedball,
and volleyball. Team Games: Touch football, softball, speedball, soccer, and
:rolleyball. Three hours per week.
I 2. INDIVIDUALAND DUAL
SPORTS.(Men). So. 11.
2 Cr.
Theory and practice in teaching badminton, shbffleboard, handball, Aerial darts,
table tennis, horsehoes, tennis, archery, golf, and bowling. Three hours per week.
2, 2 Cr.
13, 14. TEAMSPORTSFOR WOMEN.So. I, TI.
Theory and practice in the coaching and o6ciating of field hockey, soccer,
basketball, volleyball, and softball. Three hours per week. (OfTered 1959-60.)
17. SELF-TESTING
ACTIVITIES.
(Women). SO. I.
I Cr.
Theory and technique of t e a ~ h i n stunts
,~
and tumbling. Two .hours per week.
(Offered 1958-59.)
AND DUAL SPORTS.(Women). So. 11.
2 Cr.
18. INDIVIDUAL
Theory and practice in teaching skatin~g,skiing, badminton, table tennis, shuffleboard, acchery, tennis, golf, and bowling. Three hours per week. (Otfered
1958-59.)
23. RHYTHMS.So. I.
Folk games and gymnastic rhythms.
I
Cr.
(Men). So. I.
2 Cr.
29. OFFICIATING.
Instruction and application of technique and rules of ofliciating in football,
hockey, basketball, baseball, and track.
Upper Division Courses
5 I . SELF-TESTING
ACTIVITIES.
(Men). Jr, I.
2 Cr.
Theory and practice in teachin,g individual and dual stunts, apparatus, tumbling,
boxing, and wrestling. Three hours ,per week.
57. KINESIOLOGY.
Prereq. Biology 4. So. I.
2 O.
This is a study of ,body movements and the mechanics in the effectinlg of
eflicient movements.
PHYSICAL
EXAMINATIONS
A N D ADAPTEDPHYSICALEDUCATION.
Prereq.
2 Cr.
Biol. 4, and P.E. 57. Jr. 11.
Procedures and interpretation of physical examinations. Analysis of functional
and onganic abnormalities and suggested adapted activities for atypical cases.
58.
COURSEm FIRSTAID. Prereq. 8. Jr. 11.
66. INSTRUCTOR'S
I Cr.
Methods and materials in .teaching ahe American Red Cross First Aid Cowst.
73.
PRINC~PLES
A N D CURRICULUM
OF HEALTH EDUCATION
A N D PHYSICAL
EDUCATION.
Prereq. 5. Sr. I.
3 Cr.
Aims, scope and objectives d health and physical education. Analysis and
evaluation of the elementary and secondary school healrh education and physical
education curriculum.
74.
ORGAN~ATION
A N D ADMINISTRATIONOF HEALTH EDUCATION A N D
PHYSICAL
EDUCATION.
Prereq. y. Sr. TI.
3 Cr.
Problems of organization, administration, and supervision of health education
and physical education.
81.
COACHING
OF SPORTS:
FOOTBALL
AND BASKETBALL.
Sr. I.
z Cr.
Theory and techniques of coaching. Seniors only, or approval of instructor.
82.
&ACHING
OF
SPORTS:BASEBALL
AND TRACK.
Sr. 11.
2
Cr.
Theory and techniques of coaching. Seniors only, or a,pproval of instructor.
M PHYSICAL
EDUCATION.
Sr. 11.
I Cr.
84. TESTSAND MEASUREMENTS
A survey and, evaluation of tests in physical education. (Offered 1958-59 and
1959-60. Alternate years after 1959-60.)
86.
COMMUNITY
RECREATION.
Jr., Sr. 11.
z Cr.
Problems of community recreation including programs and program planning,
a survey of activities, and the organization and ad,ministration of recreational
work. (Offered 1958-59.)
OF HEALTH
EDUCATION
AND PHYSICAL
EDUCATION.
Sr. I.
87. TEACHING
See couqe 87 under Education.
2
Cr.
AUGSBURG THEOLOGICAL SEMINARY
INTRODUCTORY
Augsburg Theological Seminary is the training school for the pastors
and missionaries of the Lutheran Free Church. It offers a regular threeyear course of preparation for the Christian ministry, including both
theoretical and practical training. In harmony with the Principles of
the Lutheran Free Church it aims to stress particularly the training of
pastors and spiritual leaders dedicated to the ideal of building Lutheran
ccngregations where the Gifts of Grace are freely cultivated and
nurtured under the authority of the Word and the guidance of the
Holy Spirit.
APPLICATION FOR ADMISSION
Application for admission to the Seminary should be addressed to
the Secretary of the Theological Faculty, and should include the
following:
1. A formal letter of application for admission as a student in the
Seminary, including a personal statement by the candidate concerning
his background, including baptism, confirmation, spiritual experience,
doctrinal convictions, and church membership.
2.
A transcript of the candidate's record in college.
3. Two letters of recommendation from pastors. Normally one of
these should be from the candidate's local church.
4.
A certificate of good health.
These documents should be in the hands of the Secretary of the
Seminary Faculty before July first.
The Committee on Admissions consists of the Faculty and the Seminary Committee of the Board of Trustees.
The first year of study is always considered a probationary year.
ADMISSION REQUIREMENTS
The normal requirement for admission to the Seminary is the Bachelor's degree from a liberal arts college. The college course must have
included the following prerequisite subjects:
2 years
Greek
Philosophy
1 year
German, or
Latin, or
2 years
Norwegian
In the case of mature students of outstanding ability and experience,
an occasional exception from these requirements may be made by
special action of the Committee on Admissions.
SUGGESTED PRE-THEOLOGICAL COURSES
In order that students may derive the greatest possible advantage
from their theological studies, it is recommended that their college
course of study, besides fulfilling requirements as to a major and a
~iiinorand, in addition to the subjects indicated above, include as many
as possible of the following:
2 years
English
1 year
Speech
1 year
Psychology
2 years
History
1 semester
Youth Work
1 year
Natural Science
Sociology, or Economics, or
Political Science, or
1 year
Education
1 year
Typewriting
All candidates for admission to the Seminary must have achieved a
good academic record in their preparatory studies in college.
TRANSFER OF CREDITS AND ADVANCED STANDING
Students are admitted to the Seminary with the understanding that
their studies are to be pursued under the direction of the Theological
Faculty. Any arrangement to take a part of the theological course at
another seminary must have the prior approval of the Theological
Faculty at Augsburg.
Advanced standing is granted in certain instances, when a student
applying for admission presents a transcript of credits indicating work
done in other theological seminaries of recognized standing.
EXPENSES
Seminary students pay no tuition. They do, however, pay a Seminary
fee of thirty dollars ($30.00) per semester. This includes the general
library, health, student activities and mail box fees. Unmarried students
living in the dormitory receive a special grant to cover the cost of
room rent. The cost of board is the same as for the College students.
See under Financial Information. A graduation fee of $7.50 is payable
a month before graduation.
CLASS ATTENDANCE
A student is expected to attend all classes regularly. Unavoidable
absences may be excused by the Dean. Attendance at any conference
involving absence from classes must have the approval of the Dean
well in advance of the conference.
EMPLOYMENT
The work in the Seminary should be regarded as a full time vocation.
However, when a student's circumstances require it, a limited amount
of remunerative work will be permitted. This must be arranged in
consultation with the Dean. Occasional preaching engagements may be
accepted, but a student is not allowed to supply a vacant parish more
frequently than every other Sunday.
CONDITIONS AND INCOMPLETES
A condition or an incomplete received at the end of the semester
must be removed before the end of the following semester or within a
year if the student has not re-enrolled. If incompletes and conditions are
not removed within the time allowed, the condition automatically
becomes a failure and the incomplete will be recorded as a passing
grade only if the average of previous work is sufficiently high.
SEMINARY INTERNSHIP
In addition to the three years of theological study in the Seminary
each student is required to spend six months in practical service, as
appointed and supervised by the Committee on Service. This work is
done during the summer vacations between the beginning and conclusion of the Seminary course.
A limited amount of assigned collateral reading is required during
the in-service period.
The Seminary students are also encouraged to engage in a limited
amount of practical church work during the school year either in the
Twin Cities or in nearby communities.
STUDENT ACTIVITIES
All seminary students are members of the Concordia Society. A
principal purpose of this organization is "to promote and strengthen a
deeper spiritual fellowship among its members." The weekly meetings
are devoted to prayer and to the consideration of student affairs. The
Seminary joins with the College in a daily chapel service.
During his seminary years, each student is associated with a specific
congregation and is encouraged to serve there. As a united project,
the Concordia Society has recently assumed responsibility for conducting Saturday noon services at the Gateway Mission.
The Concordia Society promotes student participation in the InterSeminary Movement and in the Association of Lutheran Seminaries in
America. On a more local level, the student body participates in a
fellowship of five Protestant seminaries in the Twin Cities.
The wives of the seminary students have organized as the Seminettes.
They meet once a month for fellowship and for instruction in subjects
relevant to their vocation.
The Concordia Society publishes a semiannual magazine called
Concord.
GRADUATION AND DEGREES
The Seminary course consists of a three-year cycle of lectures and
study plus six months of practical service in the congregations. Students
who complete all the requirements of the regular course are graduated
with the degree of Bachelor of Theology. These requirements may be
summarized as follows:
1. A minimum of 98 semester credits, including a seminar course
in each of the following four major fields: Old Testament, New Testament, Church History, and Systematic Theology.
2. Courses in the Biblical languages, Hebrew and Greek, as regularly
offered.
3. The attainment of an honor-point rati.0 of at least 1.5 (C+
average) throughout the three years of Seminary work.
4. Six months of practical Christian service under the direction of
the Faculty C~mrni~ttee
on Service.
5. The preparation of a scholarly thesis, approximately 8,000 words
in length, on an approved theological subject. The subject must be
submitted for faculty approval before April 15 of the Middler year
and the thesis must be completed by January 10 of the Senior year.
6. A comprehensive examination, written and oral, in Old Testament, New Testament, Church History, and Systematic Theology taken
during the third week of March. Written and oral examination sermons.
The degree of Graduate in Theology is conferred upon the students
who have fulfilled the requirements listed above with an honor point
ratio of not less than 1.0 !C average) in their academic work but who
have not met all the normal prerequisites for admission to the Seminary,
or who have not attained an honor point ratio of 1.5 in their Seminary
studies. Candidates for the Graduate in Theology degree are not required to write a thesis.
COURSES OF STUDY*
Theological Orientation Courses
Junior Year
I.
THE BACKGROUND
AND STRUCTURE OF THE BIBLE. A reading course
giving the student a preliminary orientation in the Book which is the chief
source in theological study. Geography of Bible lands. General outline of Biblical
History an,d contemporaneous secular history. Brief survey of the historical
t Cr.
origin of the Biblical writings.
THEOLOGICAL
PROPAEDEUTIC.
A survey of the main ,divisions of Chfistian
Theology; their subdivisions; their relation to the entire field of Theology and
I Cr.
to the whole realm of human knowledge.
A.
'With the exception of the Theological Orientation Courses, offered amual1.y
for Juniors, the Seminary courses are rotated in a three-year cycle.
r. INTRODUCTION
TO DOGMATICS.
A preliminary study of the Ecumenical
Creeds, the Augsburg Gnfession, Luther's Large Catechism, and the Life of
I Cr.
I.ucher.
Old Testament
FOR BEGINNERS.
A study of the essentials of Hebrew grammar,
9-10. HEBREW
using Creager and Alleman's text, and the reading of selected passages from
6 Cr.
Deuteronomy. (Offered I 9 5 8- 59).
11.
THE PENTATEUCH.The course includes a general introduction to the
books and a careful exegetical study of selected passages. (Offered 195 8-59.)
3 Cr.
THE HISTORICAL
BOOKS.A survey of the history of Israel with emphasis
12.
on religious values and -the rise of ~mphetism. Selected passages from the
3 Cr.
historical books are studied. (Offered I 9 5 8-59.)
13. THE PROPHET ISAIAH. A careful study of the Biblical data concerning
the political and religious conditions of Israel and Judah, together with a survey
of the contemporary history of Assyria, Syria, and Egypt. Attention is given
to the beauty, sublimity, and spiritual richness of the book. (Offered 1959-60.)
3 cr.
14. THEPROPHETJEREMIAH.A studY of the political, moral, and religious
trends of the time of Jeremiah. Special attention is given to Jeremiah's personal
character, his Messianic hope, and to his portrayal of the struggle for spiritual
freedom. (Offered 1959-60.)
3.
I T . THE BOOK OF JOB. A course which aims to make clear the teaching of
the Wisdom Literature of the Old Testament in regard to fundamental problems
2 Cr.
of life. (Offered 1960-61.)
16. PSALMS.The course includes an historical survey, a general introduction to
the larger groups, and a careful exegetical study of a number of Psalms. Reading
assignments give special attention to the religious developments of the post3 Cr.
Exilic period. (Offered I 960-6 I .)
EXEGESIS.Review of the grammar followed by an exegetical
17, 18. HEBREW
study of Amos and the cursory reading of selected passages from other books
z, z Cr.
in ,the Old Testament. (Offered 1 9 ~ 9 - 6 0 . )
A study of archaeological ,discoveries
19. SEMINARIN BIBLICALARCHAEOLOGY.
and their significance in relation to the Bible. The co'urse consists of a number
of introductory lectures followed by student presentations of assigned topics
I Cr.
and class discussion. (Offered 1960-61.)
4
New Testament
20-21.
NEW TESTAMENT
GREEK. Two years of Greek is a requirement f o r
admission to the Seminary; in exceptional cases a remedial course may be taken
without credit in the Seminary, with no reduction of normal load.
r t . INTRODUCTION
TO THE NEW TESTAMENT.
A survey of the contents of
the New Testament, together with the authorship, date, and purpose of the
various books. The process by which these books became a New Testament
Canon will be considered and also the transmission of the text in Greek manu3 Cr.
scripts and early versions. (Offered 19 59-60.)
i3. THE GOSPEL OF MARK. Readings from the Gospel of Mark in Greek,
with selections from Luke, considered irn the historical frame of Jesus' ministry.
Each student will be expected to master a knowledge of the historical outline
3 Cr.
of Jesus' ministry: (Offered 1959-60.)
24. THE GOSPEL OF MATTHEW.Translation from the Greek texf with commentary of the more important discourse passages of this Gospel. Special emphasis on the study of the Jewish background of the times and of this Gospel's
3 Cr.
appeal to the Jews. (Offered 1958-59.)
25. THE GOSPEL OF JOHN. The purpose and special characteristics of the
Fourth Gospel, its authenticity and peculiar value. The latter part of the
semester is devoted to the study of the account of Christ's passion, based on
2 Cr.
the English text with the ai,d of a Gospel harmony. (Offered 1960-61.)
26.
THEJEWISHSECTIONOF
THE APOSTOLICCHURCH. Rapid survey of Acts
This will be followed by a study of the Epistle to the Hebrews and the
Epistle of James as literature written especially for Jewish Christians. (Offered
3 Cr.
1960-61.)
1-12.
27. LIFE AND EPISTLESOF PAUL. A rapid study of the life of Paul as given in
Acts, the historical occasion of his epistles, and the study of selected portions
in English. (Offered 1958-59.)
3 G.
28. INTERPRETATION
OF ROMANS.Reading of the doctrinal portion in Greek
with use of commentaries; the essence of the Gospel as set forth by Paul. T h e
problem of Israel's rejection of Christ (chs. 9-1 I ) , and the section o n the
Christian life (chs. 12-16) will be studied as time permits. (Offered 1960-61.)
t Cr.
OF EPHESIANS.In the study of Ephesians special em29. INTERPRETATION
phasis is laid upon the' place of the universal Christian Church as the Body of
t Cr.
Christ and the spiritual goal of history. (Offered 19jg-60.)
OF THE REVELATIONOF JOHN. The course aims a t a
jo. INTERPRETATION
mastery of the contents of the book and its interpretation in the light of Holy
Scriptures in general. Special study of the forms of apocalyptic literature.
(Offered 1958-59.)
t Cr.
Church History
l o . THE EARLYCHURCH. The History of the Christian Church from the
Apostolic Age to the time of Gregory the Great (590). The organization,
doctrine, government, and worship of the Early Church; the downfall of
heathenism in the Roman Empire, and the rise of the Papacy. The course begins
with a brief survey of the Book of Acu. (Offered 1958-59.)
2 Cr.
41. THE CHURCHOF THE MIDDLEAGES. A general survey of the development of Christianity in Western Europe from 590 to the period of the
Protestant Reformation. The course includes the study of the development and
decay of Papacy, monastic orders, scholasticism, and of movements toward
3 Cr.
reform. (Offered I 9 59-60.)
A study of the causes which led to the Protestant
42. THE REFORMATION.
Reformation; the Reformation itself and its results, including the Roman
3
Catholic Counter-Reformation. ( m e r e d 195 6-5 7,)
This course covers the period
43. THE CHURCHAFTER THE REFORMATION.
from the Reformation and up to the present time, with special emphasis on
2 Cr.
the h,istory of the Lutheran Church. (Offered 1960-61.)
HISTORY.Early colonization; planting of churches;
44. AMERICANCHURCH
church government, religious life and worship; separation of church and state;
revivals; denominationalism. The history of the Lutheran Church in America
3 Cr.
is studied with special care. (Offered 1960-61.)
OF CHRISTIAN
DOCTRINE.A study of. the development
45, 46. THEHISTORY
of Christian doctrine and its crystallization into creeds and confessions, including
the Patristic, Scholastic, and Reformation periods. (Offered 1958-19.) 2 , 2 Cr.
CHURCHIN THE WORLDTODAY.
A study of the consti47. THE#LUTHERAN
tution and work of the Lutheran Churches in the various countries of the
world. Special attention to the work of the Lutheran World Federation. I Cr.
Systematic Theology
An inquiry into the field, sources, and
50. BASICPRINCIPLESOF THEOLOGY.
2 Cr.
methods of systematic theology. (Offered 1960-61.)
A N D ANTHROPOLOGY.
A systematic examination of the teach5 I. THEOLOGY
ings of the Bible concerning God and man. The course includes a study of the
Trinity, creation, and man's fall into sin. (Offered 1960-61.)
2 Cr.
A careful study of the teachings of the Bible concerning
f z . SOTERIOLOGY.
Christ-His Person, states, and ofice; the Person and work of the Holy Spirit;
3 Cr.
the order of salvation. (Offered I 9 5 8-59.)
AND ESCHATOLOGY.
A study of the nature and function
53. ECCLESIOL~GY
of the Church; t h e Sacraments; the doctrine of the last things. (Offered
1958-59.)
z Cr.
54, 55. CHRISTIANETHICS. A study of the religious and ethical implications
of the Christian experience. Special attention is given TO the application of
Christian ethics t o individual, group, and public life. (Offered 1959-60.)
2, 2 Cr.
j6. SYMBOLICS.A careful study of the Book of Concord. Attention is given
to the genesis and development of each creed, its doctrinal significance, and
its place in the present life of the Church. (Offered 1960-61.)
2 Cr.
SYMBOLICS
~
AND RELIGIOUSCULTS. A comparative study
57. C Q M P A R A
of ,the creeds of the great divisions of the Christian Church, and the teachings
2 Cr.
of various modern religious sects and cults. (Offered 1959-60.)
Practical Theology
All members of the Theological Faculty give instruction in this field.
A. Pastoral Theology
Go. PRINCIPLESOF PASTORAL
THEOLOGY.
This course, which is based o n the
Pastoral Epistles, comprises the historical and theoretical study of the foundations of .the pastoral office and the New Testament ministry. (Offered 1960-61.)
t Cr.
61. SOUL-CAREAND THE SPIRITUALLIFE. A study of Christian experience
and its varied expressions, and of the basic principles of soul-care. Collateral
2 Cr.
reading from the great classics of the spiritual life. (Offered 1958-59.)
62. INTRODUCTION
TO PASTORALCOUNSBLING.A course dealing with the
dynamics ,underlying human behavior. Various pastoral counseling techniques
are studied. The course attempts to help the student recognize deviations of
personality, and to know which ones he can handle, and which ones should
I Cr.
be referred to more competent help. Middlers. (Offered annually.)
TRAINING.The purpose of this course is 'to provide an
63. CLINICALPASTORAL
opportunity for the student to learn Pastoral Care through interpersonal relations in a hospital setting. I t will include ward calling, writing of clinical notes,
I Cr.
special seminar and lecture sessions. Middlers. (Offered annually.)
The propagation of the Gospel in new areas, including a
64. EVANGELISTICS.
short survey of the methods and history of Foreign Missions, and inner missions,
2 Cr.
and various types of evangelism. (Offered in 1958-59.)
B. Homiletics
65. PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICEOF PREACHING.Technical and psychological
r Cr.
elements of preaching. Emphasis upon sermons. Juniors.
66. HOMILETICS.
The application of the principles of preaching to the outlining and presentation of ,brief sermons. Emphasis upon thorough preparation
and constant practice in delivery. Middlers.
z Cr.
67. SERMONS.A course in the prepara~ionand delivery of sermons. Both the
structural and spiritual elements are emphasized. Sermons by great preachers
r G.
are studied. Seniors.
C. Polity, Worship, and Parish Work
70. CHURCHPOLITY.A course dealing with the Biblical theory of the congregation; o6cers, organization, and government in the epostoli~c'times; the
growth of the idea of ,the Church; the idea of a free church. I and 11 Corinr Cr.
thians are studied as the best source. (Offered 1960-61.)
A study of the various aspects of congrega71. CHURCH ADMINISTRATION.
tional organization. Methods of increasing e6ciency in the performance of
the pastor's duties. Effective o6ce procedures. The practice and teaching of
Christian stewardship. (Offered 1960-61.)
I Cr.
PROBLEMS.A series of lectures and discussions dealing with
72. PASTORAL
practical problems in the pastor's work in the parish and the local community.
The approach ,to the unchurched. Congregational evangelism. Making the
occasional services effective. Problems of pastoral ethics. (Offered 1959-60.)
I Cr.
The principles and forms of public worship. A study of liturgy
73. LITURGICS.
as a means of expressing and moulding religious life with emphasis on its
relation to varying conceptions of the Church. (Offered 1959-60.)
I Cr.
An historical survey of the best selections of hymns from
74. HYMNOLOGY.
the early Christian Church and the Church in Germany, Scandinavia, England,
and America. Special attention is given to Lutheran hymnody. (Offered
1960-61.)
I Cr.
AUGSBURG
THEOLOGICAL
SEMINARY
D. Christian Education and Sociology
76. METHODSOF PARISH EDUCATION.Studies in the application of basic
principles and .methods of education to the subject matter used in catechetical
instruction, Sunday schwls, Parochiai schools, and Bible classes. Emphasis upon
an educational program which includes the whole parish. (Offered 1959-60.)
2 Cr.
78. THE CHURCHAND HUMANSOCIETY.A study of the relation between
the Christian Church and present-day civilization and culture, and of the
organized movements in contemporary society with which the Church must
deal. Emphasis upon the social duties of Christians and upon the world-wide
r Cr.
task of the Church. The Ecumenical Movement.
AND SOCIALWORK.This course is designed .to give the
79. CHRISTIANITY
candidate for the ministry contact with the field of social work, and to enable
him to appreciate its close relation to the work of the Church. Lectures,
r Cr.
reports, and institutional visits.
BOARD OF TRUSTEES
Officers of the Board
. .President
Vice-President
. . Secretary
. Treasurer
Term Expires in 1958
MR. G. S. MICHAELSEN,Minneapolis, Minnesota
Education, Universic~r of Minnesota
Duluth, Minnesota
The REV. D. W. LYNGDAL,
Pastor, Trinity Lutheran Church
Term Expires in 1959
MR. EVEN OSE, Thief River Fdls, Minnesota
Contractor (retired)
The REV. C . T. OLSON,Spicer, Minnesota
Business Manager, Bethesda Homes
Term Expires in 1960
MR. R. F. PAUTZ, Minneapolis, Minnesota
Real Estate, Pautz-Franklin Realty Company
Term Expires in 1961
The REV. GEORGEJ. KNUDSON,
M,arinette, Wisconsin
Pastor, Our Savior's Lutheran Church
Austin, Minnesota
MR. L. S. HARBO,
Superintendent of Schools, Austin, Minnesota
Tenn Expires in 1962
MR. GILBERTBERG,Seattle, Washington
Business, Berg Fuel Company
The REV. CLIFFORDM. JOHNSON,Minneapol,is, Minnesota
Pastor, Oak Grove Lutheran Churoh.
Advisory Members
The REV. DR. T. 0. BURNTVEDT,
Minneapolis, Minnesota
President, The Lutheran Free Church
DR. BERNHARD
CHRISTENSEN,
Minneapolis, Minnesota
President, Augsburg Colle,ge and Theological Seminary
AUGSBURG
COLLEGE
AND
THEOLOGICAL
SEMINARY
ADMINISTRATlON
. President
Dean of the College
Dean of the Theological Senzinary
. Bzlsiness Manager
Dean o f Stzldents
Dean o f W o m e n
Registrar; Secretary of the General Faculty
Secretary o f the Theological Faculty
. . . . . . Librarian
Director of Placement and Testing
Assistant Treasurer
Director of Dez'elopment Fund
..
Director of Public Relations
Agent; Szcperz'isor of Buildings and Grounds
Assistant Business Manager
Director o f Food Services
Curator of the Museum
. .
.
.Archivist
Director o f Admissions
Assistant Registrar
ADMINISTRATIVE STAFF
Ofiice Sfaff: Beatrice Nelson, Secretary to the President; Mrs. R u t h Gamm,
Office Manager, Public Relations; Mrs. Mildred Cleveland, Secretany, Public Relations M c e ; Banbara Cole, Secretary, Admissions Ofice; Mrs. Valborg Ellingson,
Audio-Visual Assistant; Borghild Estness, Secretary, Registrar's O&e; Lilly
Gerhard, Cashier, Treasurer's Office; Mrs. Mary Jean Holmquist, Recorder,
Registrar's Oflice; Randi Langfeldt, Bookkeeper, Treasurer's Office; Bertha Lillehei, Secretary, Student Personnel Ofice; Tena Mehus, Clerk, Registrar's Office;
Violet Myers, Secretary, Development Office; June Nelson, Secretary to t,he Dean
of the College; Mildred Nelson, Receptionist and Switchboard Operator; Marilyn
Petersen, Secretary, Placement Bureau; Lillian Peterson, Faculty Secretary,
Mimeographing; Delores Rotramel, Secretary to Business Manager; Mrs. Erna
Staub, Clerical Assistant, Library.
Resident Counselors i n Dormitories: Memorial Hall, Philip Nelson; Gerda Mortensen Hall, Mrs. Irene G. Wolf, Delores Rotramel, Joanne Rotramel.
Supervisor of Housekeeping: Olga Hermunslie. Manager of Grill: Arthur C.
Engen.
---
Dr. C. R. Wall and Dr. S. V. Thorson, Physicians; Ali,ce Swensen, R. N.,
Nurse; Myrna Hundtoft, R. N., Assistant Nurse.
COMMITTEES OF THE FACULTY
I
I
-1957-1958-
Administration: Christensen, M. Quaekck, Stensvaag, Fosse, Dahlen, Miss
Mortensen, Miss Joel.
I Curriculum: M . Quanbeck, Christensen, Nash, Olson, Stensvaag, Miss Segolson,
II
I
Miss Joel.
Library: Helland, Nash, Landa, A. Anderson, Chrislock.
I
4
Admissions and Scholarship: Miss Joel, M. Quanbeck, J. Thut, Miss Pederson,
Hammarberg.
I
-.
Student Personnel: Hammarberg, Miss Mortensen, Trautwein, P. Quanbeck.
E. Anderson, Dahlen.
I
Athletics: %berg, E. Anderson, Kleven, Hanwick, Savold.
1
Social: Mrs. L. Peterson, Miss Mortensen, Miss Tangjerd, Otolins, Mickelberg.
I
Institutional Studies: R. Anderson, Kleven, Urdahl, Nelson, Wckelson.
Imvocations: Holum,
C h r i s l d , Thut, Miss Mortensen. (Student members
also included in this committee.)
Student-Faculty: M. Quanbeck, Miss Mortensen, Torstenson, Miss Cole.
meinbers also included in this committee.)
Reliaiozls Life: P. Ouambeck, Ozalins, Mrs. L. Peterson. (Student
I
Teacher Education: Johnson, Thorson, Sateren, Urdah(1.
q a c u l t y Council: M. Quanbeck, A. Anderson, Miss Pederson, Landa, Holum,
Trautwein.
I
THE FACULTY
AUGSBURG THEOLOGICAL SEMINARY
BERNHARD
Xi. CHRISTENSEK,
Th.l,I., Ph.D., President and Professor of Theology
A.B., ?rugsburg Collcgr, 1911: Aupsburg Theo:ogical Seminary, 1922-25;
Th.M., I'rinceton T h ~ l o g i c 3 l Seminary, 1927; Ph.D., Hartford Seminary
Foundarion, r 9 zg. Additional study: Columbia, Chiago, Berlin, G~ttingen.
Teaching: Oak Grove Seminary, Fargo, North Dakota, 1925-26. Pastoral
work, 1928-30. At Augsburg since 1930. President since 1938.
MELVINA. HELLAND,S.T.M., Ph.D., Professor of New Testament
A.B., Augsburg College, 1915; C.T., Augsburg T,heological Seminary,
19 I 8 ; S.T.M., Hartford Seminary Foundation, 1919; Ph.D., 1930. Additional study: Grenoble, Chicago. Educational Missionary in Madagascar,
192 1-3 8; Professor of New Testament, Lutheran Theological Seminary,
Ivory, Madagascar, 1938-40. At Augsburg since 1941.
IVER
B. OLSON,AM., Th.D., Professor of Systemtic Theology
A.B., Augsburg College, 1931; Th.B., Augsburg Theological Seminary,
1936; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1945 ; Th.D., Chicago Lutheran
Theological Seminary, 1957. Teaching: Oak Grove Seminary, 1936-39;
Universitv of Minnesota, 1945-46. Pastor, Sand Creek, Wisconsin, 1939-44.
Adviser to SPAN Group in Scandinavia, 1950. At Augsburg since 1945.
PHIL~PA. QUANBECK,Th.D., Assistant Professor of New Testament and
Rrligiotr; College Cbuplain
A.B., Augsburg College, 1 9 ~ o ;Th.B., Augsburg Seminary, 195I ; Th.M.,
Princeton T!xuIopical Seminlry, 1914; 'I'h.D., 1957. Pastoral work, 195 1-5 3.
Teaching Fellow, Princeron Theological Seminary, 1954-57. A.t A u g s b q
since 1957.
PAULG.
~ O K X A C K , A.B., Th.B., Assoriait- Pr~frsroro j Cb~trchHistory
A.B., Augsburg Gllesr, 1942; C.T.,Augsburq Thmbgica1 Seminary, 1945;
Th.B., 1947. Addition31 study: University of Chic~go.Pastor, Moose Lake,
Minn., 1945-47. At Augsburg since r949.
STEXSVAAG,
S.T.M., Ph.D., Profrssor of OIJ Tcston:mt
A. B., Augshurg Callegt, r g 3 6 ; ThB., Augsburg ~ e o l c - g i c a lSeminary,
1939; 5.TII.I.. Nzrrford Seminary Foundzrion, 1940; Ph,D., 1941. Additional study: Johns HopBins, Oslo. Pastor, Mimespolis. Mim., 1942-46.
At Augsburg since 1942.
J ~ H NM.
DORRISFLFSNER,Ph.D., 1 , ~ c t a r r rin Church Hirf0r.y (Seminary)
,\.B., Car1h3~cCollege, r 9 3 6 : B.D., Hamma Diviniry Schoa!, 1939; S.T.M.,
Wsrtburg Lutheran Seminary, 1950; A.M., Univenitp of Chicago, 1953;
Ph.D.. Hartford S e m i n ~ r y , 1956. Associate Professwr of Church History,
Northwestern Lutheran Theological Seminary, I 9 57.
LAWRENCE
M. GUDMESTAD,
A.B., S.T.M., Lecturer in Pastoral Counseling
A.B., Augsburg College, 1939;C.T., Awgsburg Theologi3cal Seminary, 1942;
S.T.M., Andover Newton 'heological Schools, 1955. Pastoral work, 19421954.Chaplain, Lutheran Deaconess Hospital, 1955-. At Augsburg since
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
MANNALDALDRE,M.S., Assistant Professor of Chemistry
Diploma of Chemical Engineer, Estonian State University of Technology,
Tallin, Estonia, 1941; M.S., University of Minnesota, 195 I. Additional
study: Minnesota. Teaching: Assistant in Chemistry, Estonian State University of Technology, 1941-42.At Augsburg since 1949.
ALBERTB. ANDERSON,
A.M., Th.B., Instructor in Philosophy
A.B., Concordia College, 195 I ; l%.B., Luther Theological Seminary, I 95 6.
A.M., University of Minnesota, 1957. Additional study: University of
Capenhagen. Teaching: Concordia College, 1954-5 5 ; Luther College,
1956. A t Augsburg since 1956.
ERNESTW. ANDERSON,M.Ed., Associate Professor of Health and Physical
Education, Basketball Coach
A.B., Augsburg College, 1937; M.Ed., University of Minnesota, 1947.
Teaching: High School, 1937-41.U. S. Army, 1941-46.At Augsburg
since 1946.
RAYMOND
E. ANDERSON,
A.M., Associate Professor of Speech
B.S., University of Minnesota, 1946;A.M., 1950.Additional study: Minnesota. Teaching: University of Vermont, 1949. U. S. Navy, 1946. At
Augsbwg since 1949.
JOHN BATES,M.S., Instructor in Chemistry
B.S., B.S.Ed., Ohio University, 195I ; M.S., University of M i e s o t a , 1952.
Additional study: University of Minnesota. At Awgsburg since 1957.
HAROLDJ. BELGUM,A.M., M. Soc. Work, Instructor in Sociology
A.B., Luther College, Decorah, Iowa, 1933; A.M., University of Iowa,
1937; M. Soc. Work, University of Minnesota, 195 I. Teaching: Mission
House College, Plymouth, Wis., I 934-38; Elrnhurst College, 1938-42;Lakeside School for Boys, Seattle, Wash., 1942-44.Assistant Executive Secretary,
Director off Social Work Services, Lutheran Welfare Society of Minnesota.
At Augsbung since 1954.
HENRYJ. BERTNESS,
Ph.D., Associate Professor of Education
A.B., Augsburg College, 1947; A.M., University af Minnesota, 1948;
Ph.D., 1955. U. S. IVavy, 1943-46.Teaching: Tacoma Public Schools,
1948-49.Teaching and pidance work: Hyline Public Schools, University
of Washington, Pacific Lutheran College, Tacoma Public Schools, I 95 6-58.
At A,ugsbung since 1949. (On leave of absence, 195 6-58.)
CARLCHRISLOCK,
Ph.D., Associate Professor of History and Polifical Science
A.B., Augsbung College, 1937; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1947;
Ph.D., 1955. Teaching: High School, 1939-44; Tracy Junior College,
1947-48;Augwtana College, Sioux Falls, S. D., 1948-51.At Augsburg
since 1952.
MARIOCOLACCI,
Th.D., D.Litt., Associate Professor of Classical Languages
Pontificium Atheneum Roman Major Seminary, Th.D., 1932; Pontifical
Biblimcal Institute de Uibe, Rome, L.R.B., 1934; University of Naples,
D.Litt., 1940. Teaching: Regional Seminary, Benevento, Itamly, 1935-40;
Mario Pagano College and Normal Institute, Campobasso, Italy, 1941-49.
At Augsbucg since 1952.
AILENE COLE, A.M., Assistant Professor o f Speech
A.B., Gustavus Adolphus College, 1936; A.M., University of Minnesota,
1949.A,dditional study: University of Minnesota. Teaching: High Schools,
1936-56. At Augsburg since 1956.
K. BERNERDAHLEN,A.M., Associate Professor of English
A.B., Augsburg College, 193I ; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1940.Additional study: Minnesota. Teaching: High School, 193I -39; Crosby-Ironton
Junior College, 1940-41.U. S. Army Air Forces, 1942-45.At Augsburg
since 1941.
IVANDOSEFF,B.S., 1nstru.ctor in Art
B.S., University of Chicago, 1907. Additional study: Art Institute of
Chicago. Teaching: Cornell College, 19I 8-I 9; Iowa State Teachers College,
1919-21; Luther College, I 922-23; Minneapolis Art Institute, 1928-30;
University of Minnesota, 1926-53. At Augsburg since I 95 y .
CHARLESG. EAKIN,A.M., Instructor in M71sic
A.B., Manhattan School of Music, 1 9 ~ 0A.
; M. Carnegie Institute of Tech.,
1955. Additional study: University of Minnesota. At Augsburg since 1957.
JACK FISHER, S.M.M., Instructor in Organ
B.M., University of Texas, 1946; S.M.M., Union Theological Seminary,
1948.At Augsburg since 1955.
BURTONP. FOSSE,B.B.A., B.M.E., Business Manager
B.B.A., and B.M.E., University of Minnesota, 1949. U. S. A m y , 1943-46.
Ind,ustrial Engineering work, 1949-53.At Aug~burgsince I 95 3.
DARYLGIBSON,Ph.D., Instructor in Brass Instruments
B.S., University of Minnesota, 1934; A.M., 1941;Ph.D., University of
Iowa, 1947.Member of Minneapolis Symphony Orchestra, 1934-44.Teaching: University of Iowa, 1943;University of Montana, 1947-48;Gustavus
Adolsphus College, 1948-52. At Augsburg since 1954.
ORLOUEGISSELQUIST,
A.M., Instructor in History
A.B., University of Minnesota, 1943;A.M., University of Minnesota, 1956.
Tea~hin,~
Bethel
:
College, I 954-56. At Augsburg since I 956.
HARVEYH. GLOMMEN,A.B., Jnstructor in Debate
A.B., Concordia College. Ad'ditional Study: University of Minnesota. Teaching: Oak Grove High School. A t Awgsburg sinmce 1917.
A.M., Assistant Professor of Psychology
CARLR. HAMMARBERG,
A.B., Gustavus Adolphus College, 1932; A.M., University of Minnesota,
1948. A,d'ditional study: Minnesota. Teac'hing: Bethany College, Lindsborg,
Kan., 1948-53. A t Augsburg since 1953.
THEODORE
J. HANWCK,Ph.D., Professor of Physics
B.E.E., Polytechnic Institute of Brooklyn, 1933; M.S., Polytechnic Institute of Brooklyn, 1937; Ph.D., New York University, 1950. Teaching:
Polytechnic Institute of Brooklyn, 1937-38; New York University, 193842; U. S. Naval Academy, 1942-46. Rutgers University, 1946-1956. At
Augsburg since I 9 5 6.
MELVINA. HELLAND,S.T.M., Ph.D., Professor of Religion
For statement of academic preparation and experience, see Theological
Seminary Faculty listing.
A . ROBERTHEMMINGSON,
A.M., instructor in Economics and Business Ad-
ministration
A.B., Dana College, 1953; A. M. University of Nebraska, 1957. Teaching:
University of Nebraska, 19 56-57. At Augsburg since 19 57.
Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Chemistry
JOHN R. HOLUM,
A.B., St. Olaf College, 1950; Ph.D., University of Minnesota, 1954.
Teaching Assistant, University of Minnesota, 1950-52. University of Maryland, 1956. U. S. Armed Forces, 1955-57. At Augsburg since 1957.
MILDREDV. JOEL, A.M., Registrar, w i t h raltk of Assistant Professor
A.B., Augsburg College, 1940; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1947.
A,dditional study: Saskat,chewan, Minnesota, Denver. Teaching: High School,
1941-46. At Augsburg since 1947.
EINAR0. JOHNSON,A.M., Assistant Professor of Edu.cation
A.B., Concordia College, 1938; A.M., University of Washington, 1950. Additional study: University of Oslo, Norway and University of Washington.
At Augsburg since 195 6.
RALPH KERSTEN,D.D.S., Instructor in Health
D.D.S., School of Dentistry, University of Minnesota, 1939. Priva,te practice, 1939-42; O s c e r , U. S. Navy, 1942-46. A.t Augsburg since 195 5.
~ I I M B.
I KINGSLEY,A.M., Assisfmf P ~ U ~ P S SofMSfimtish
A.B., h f a v i l l e College, 1936; A.M., Universiry of Mexico, 1944. Additional study: Co!urntia, Midne~ora, Teaching: Wagner College, Staten
Lland, N. Y., rg41-42; Friends School, Brooklyn, N. Y., 1946-47. At
Augsburg since 1947.
BERNHARDT
J. KLEVEN,Ph.D., Professor of History and Political Science
A.B., Augsbung College, 1922; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1930;
Ph.D., 1941. Additional study: Harvard. Teaching: High School, 192235; Wheaton College, 1946-47. At Augsburg, 1937-46, and since 1947.
BJARNEE. LANDA,Ph.D., Associate Professor o f Germanic Languages
A.B., Voss State College, Norway, 1925; A.B., University of Southern
California, 1928; A.M., 1930; Ph.D., University of Minnesota, 1952.
Teaching: High School, 1930-31; University of Minnesota, 1938-42; Fisk
University, 1945-47. U. S. Office of Censorship, 1942-45. A t Augsburg
since 1947.
CARLW. LANDAHL,M.Mus., Assistant Professor o f Music
A.B., University of Minnesota, 1931; B.Mus., Columbia School of Music,
Chicago, 1933; M.Mus., 1934; B.D., California Baptist Theological Serninary, 1950. Teaching: Private Teaching, Chicago, 1931-40; Dakota Wesleyan University, Mitchell, S. D., 1940-42; Northwestern Schools, Minneapolis, 1 9 5 e . A t Augsburg since 1952.
RAMONAH. LEER, A.B., Assistant Librarian
A.B., Concordia College, 1954. Additional study: University of Minnesota.
Teaching: Long Prairie High School, 1 9 ~ 4 - 5 6 A
. t Augsburg since 1957.
BERTHALILLEHEI,A.B. lnstrzrctor in English
A.B., Augsburg College, 1934; Additional study: University of Minnesota.
A t Augsburg 1937-40 and since 1957.
GERTRUDE
S. LUND, A.M., Assistant Professor of S~cretarial Science
A.B., Augsburg College, 1936; A.M., University of Minnesota, 195 I .
Teaching: High School, 1943-45. West Central School of Agriculture,
Morris, 1945-47; Duluth Business University, 1947-48; High School, 194849. At. Augsburg since 1950.
SUE LUND, A.M., 17zstrz~ctorin Edz~cation
A.B., Iowa State Teachers College, 1939; A.M., University of Wisconsin,
1940. -4dditional Study: University of Minnesota. Teachin'g: Oregon, Ill.
Community High School, Iowa State Teachers College, University of Minnesota General College. At Augsburg since 1958.
RUTH A. MARFELL,A.M., lnstructor in Library Science
B.S., University of Minnesota, 1940; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1954.
Teaching: High Schools in Minnesota, 1941-56; University of Minnesota,
Summers 1952, 1953. At Augsburg since 1957.
ERWIND. MICKELBERG,
A.B., Instructor in Anatomy
A.B., Augsburg College, 1954. A,dditional study: Columbia, Minnesota.
Teaching: Atwater High School, 19 54-5 6. A t Augsburg since 19 5 6.
JOEL C. MICKELSON,Ph.D., l n s t r ~ ~ c t oinr English
A.B., University of Minnesota, I 9 5 I ; A.M. University of Pennsylvania,
1955; Ph.D., 1956. A t Augsburg since 1956.
RAYMONDMIESNIEKS,A.M., lnstrurtor in German
A.B., Concordia College, 195 I ; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1913.
Teaching: University of Minnesota, 19 5 5-57. At Augsbung since 1957.
GERDAMORTENSEN,A.M., Dean o f W o m e n w i t h rank o f Professor
B.S., University of Minnesota, 1923; A.M., Columbia University, I 928.
Additional study: Minnesota. Teaching: Junior High School, 1917-21; Hankow Private School, Hankow, China, 1934-35. A t Augsburg since 1923.
ARTHURNASH, Ph.D., Professor o f Biology
A.B., Augsburg College, 1922; Ph.D., University of Minnesota, 1938.
Additional study: Minnesota; Seminar to Australia, 1934-35. U. S. Army
Air Force, 1942-46. Dean, Augsbung College, 1946-50. A t Augsburg since
1922.
EDORC. NELSON,M.Ed., Associate Professor o f Physical Education and Coach
o f Football and Baseball
A.B., Augsburg College, 1938; M.Ed., University of Minnesota, 1948.
Teaching: High School, 1938-41. U. S. Army, 1941-46. At Augsburg since
'946.
CATHERINENICHOLL, A.M., Instructor in English
A.B., Hope College, 1953; A.M., University of Michigan, 1954. Teaching:
Colby Jr. College, 1954-55; Bradford Jr. College, 1955-56; South Oregon
College, 1956-57. A t Aug~bur.gsince 1957.
IVERB. OLSON,M.A., Th.D., Professor o f Scandinavian
For statement of academic preparation and experience, see Theological
Seminary Faculty listing.
KARLISOZOLINS,A.B., Th.B., Instrzrctor in Religion
A.B., Augsburg College, 1 9 5 1 ; B.Th., Augsburg Theological Seminary,
I 9 5 2. Additional study: Minnesota. A t Augsburg since I 9 5 5.
HOWARDE. PEARSON,A.M. lnstructor in Physical E d ~ c a t i o n
A.B., Augsburg College, 1953 ; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1957. A t
Augsburg since I 9 5 6.
ANNE PEDERSON,A.M., Associate Professor of English
A.B., Augsburg College, I 93 2; A.M., University of Minnesota, I 947. Additional study: Minnesota, 'Columbia. Teaching: High School, I 945 -46;
San Mateo Junior College, Calimfornia, one semester, 1946. A t Augsburg
1932-44, and since 1946.
K A ~ E R I NPETERSON,
E
M.S., Assistant Professor of Home Economics
B.S., South Dakota State College, 1936; M.S., State University of Iowa,
1939. Additional study: University of Minnesota. Teaching: High Schools
in South Dakota, 1936-38; University of Minnesota, 1940-56. A t Augsburg since 195 6.
LAVONNE PETERSON, A.M., Assistant Professor of Physical Ed?ccation for
Wmen
A.B., Augsburg College, 1950; A.M., University of Montana, 1953. Additional study: Minnesota, Montana, Ma,cPhail School of Music. A t Augsburg
since 1950.
1952. High School administration, hfantorville, Minn., I 929-36. Teaching:
Waldorf College, 1936-3 8 Registrar, Augsburg College, I 939-46; Dean,
1942-46 and since 1950. A t Augsburg since 1938.
A. QUANBECK,Th.D., Assistant Professor of New Tcstnrnelzt arzd Religion; College Chaplain
For statement of academic preparation and experience, see T h
Seminary Faculty listing.
ILIP
. t Augsburg since 1957.
of Minnesota, 1 9 ~ 5 - 5 7 A
LAND
B. SATEKEN,A.M.,. Professor of Music
University of Minnesota, 1940-43. Educational Director, Ci
Service, 1944-46. A t Augsburg 1941-43, and since 1946.
MAYOSAVOLD,A.B., Associate Professor of Mz~sic
of Minnesota, :928-44; Washington State College, Summer 19 3
burg since 1944.
SOBERG,A.B., C.T., Professor of Mathematics
A. B. Augsburg Col,lege, 1926; C.T., Augsburg Theological
Additional study: Minnesota. A t Augsburg since 1926.
ORGE
G. SONNACK,A.B., Th.B., Associafe Professor of Religion
For statement of academic preparation and experience, see Theologi
inary Faculty listing.
UL
SONSTENG,A.B., Instrzlctor in Home Economics
A.B:, Augsburg College, 1974. Additional study: Universi
Teaching: Hinckley High School, 195 5-5 6; Graduate- Assi
TH
JOHN M. STENSVAAG,
S.T.M., Ph.D., Professor of Religion
For statement of academic -preparation and experience, see Theological
Seminary Faculty listing.
MERTONP. STROMMEN,A.M., Th.B., Lecturer i n Religion
A.B., Augsburg College, 1913; C.T., Augsburg Theological Seminary, 1944;
Th.B., 195 I ; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1955. Additional study: Minnesota. Pastor, Mora, Minnesota, 1944-47. At Augsburg since 1947.
OLAF H. SWENSON,A.M., Assistant Professor of Sociology
A.B., Gustavus Adolphus College, 1943; A.M., University of Minnesota,
1950. Teaching: Gustavus Adolphus College, 1947-49, 1950-51. Probation
OBce, Hennepin County, 195 I - . A t Augsburg since 1953.
AGNESB. TANGJERD,
A.M., Associate Professor of Library Science
A.B., St. Olaf College, 1920; B.S., in L.S., University of Minnesota, 1939;
A.M., 1944. Additional study: Minnesota. Zion Society for Israel, 1922-28.
Teaching: High School, 1929-36. Eau Claire Public Library, 1936-38. A t
Augsburg since 1940.
Ph.D., Associate Professor of English
GERALDH. THORSON,
A.B., Augsburg College, 1943; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1948;
Ph.D., Columbia University, 1957. U. S. Army, 1943-46. Teaching: Wagner College, 1951. A t Augsburg since 1946.
JOHN THUT,A.B., M.Mus., Associate Professor of Voice
A.B., Goshen College, 1923; B.Mus., American Conservatory of Music,
1929; M.Mus., 1936. Additional study: Minnesota; Northwestern University. Private work in singing with Rollin Pease, Charles LaBerge, Aksel
Schiotz. Special studies with Theodore Harrison and Martial Singher.
Teaching: Bethel College, 1924-27; American Conservatory of Music, 193144; Colorado State College of Education, 1946-47. YMCA War Prisoners
Aid, England and Belgium, 1944-46. At Augsburg since 1947.
VERATHUT,B.Mus., Instructor in Piano
B.Mw., American Conservatory of Music, 1927. Additional study: American Conservatory of Music and Minnesota; Master Class Work with Silvio
Scionti; Robyn Normal Teachers Training Course; studied under Kurt
Wanieck. Teaching: American Conservatory of Music, 1926-46; Colorado
state College of Education, 1946-47. A t Augsburg since 1947.
JOEL
S. TORSTENSON,
A.M., Associate Professor o f Sociology
A.B., Augsburg College, I 9 3 8 ; A.M., University of Minnesota, I 940. Additional stud(y: Minnesota. Director of Education and Public Relations, Midland Cooperative Wholesale, 1945-47. A t Augsburg I 93 8-42, and since
1947.
MARVINE. TRAUTWEIN,
A.M., Associate Professor of Psychology
A.B., University of Nebraska, 1935; A.M., Columbia, 1940. Addi,tional
studmy: Hamard, Hawaii, Minnesota. Teaching: High School, 193 6-42;
Dean, Norfolk Junior College, 1942. Staff, Education and Training O&cer,
V. A., Fort Snelling, 1946-48. Research Assistant and Counselor, Universiny of Minnesota, 1948-50, and 1 9 5 3 - 5 ~ .U. S. A m y Air Force, 1942-46.
A t Augsburg since 19 50.
ERLINGJ. URDAHL,A.M., Associate Professor o f Biology
A.B., Conmrdia College, 1930; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1940. Additional study: Minnesota. Teaching: High School, 193 1-3 1 Principal, Cannon Falls, Minnesota, 193 5-41. A't Augsburg since 1943.
CAROLL
0. SATRE,A.B., Th.B., lnstrzlctw in Religion
A.B., University of Iowa, 1943; Th.B., Luther Theological Seminary, 1945.
Pastor of St. Paul's Lutheran Church, Minneapolis, since 1957. A t Augsburg first semester, 1957.
ARLENSTENSLAND,
A.B., Graduate Assistant in Mathematics
A.B.. Augsburg College, I 9 5 6. Additional study: Luther Theological Seminary. At Augsbung since 1956.
ALP EIKAAS,A.M.. fnstructor in Norwegian
Statens Larersk, Oslo, 1946; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1950. Additional study: Oslo University and Minnesota. Teaching: Elementary and
high schools in Norway, 1946-48; Adult Ed. Dept., (Evening classes) ;
YWCA, Minneapolis, 1952-56; University of Minnesota, 1948-52. A t
Augsburg, 1956-57.
MARYHELEN HAAS,M.S., Assistant Professor of Home Economics
A.B., Upland College, 195 1 ; M.S., University of California, 1952. Additional study: University of Minnesota. Teaching: Upland Academy, 195152; Upland College, 1912-54; University of Minnesota, 1954-56. A t
Augsburg, 1956-57.
DONALDHELLAND,B.S., Instrz~ctorin Accounting
B.S., Lewis & Clark College, 1950. Additional study: Au,gsburg Theological
Seminary. At Augshurg, I 9 56-57.
R A D O ~ NJONES,
A
B.S., ln~tructorin Library Science
B.S., University of Minnesota, 1952. Additional study: University of
Colorado. Teaching: Elementary schools, Great Falls, Mont., Edina, Minn.
At Augsburg, 1956-17.
FACULTY
BRUCELUNKLEY,B.S., Instructor in Music
B.S., University of Minnesota, I 95 I. Additional study: Minn
A~gsburg, 1 95 5 - 5 7.
MILTON, AM., Instructor in English
A.B., University of Minnesota, 1948; A.M., 1951. Additional study:
Minnesota. Armed Forces, 1943-46. At Augsburg, I 949-57.
JOHN
JAMESW. NOEHL,
B.B.A., Instructor in Business Administration
B.B.A., University of Minnesota, I 95 5. Additional study: University of
Minnesota. A.t Augsburg, 19 56-57.
ROLFE KERMIT VANDERBILT,
Ph.D., Instri~ctorin English
A.B., Lucher College, 1947; A.M., University of Minnesota, 1949; Ph.D.,
195 6. Teaching: Wartburg College, I 95 I - 5 3 ; University of Minnesota,
1954-57.At Augsburg, 1956-57.
SCOTTD. WALTON, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Business Administration and
Economics
B.S., University of Minnesota, 1947; M.B.A., Harvard University, 1949;
P,h.D., Iowa State College, 1953. Teaching: Iowa State College, 1949-52.
Universi,ty of Minnesota, I 95 2-53. At Augsburg, 195 3-57.
COLLEGE, 1956
With the degree of Bachelor of Arts
Anderson, Curtis R.
Anderson, Deloris Ann .
Anderson, Norman E.
.
Anderson, Edward William
Andress, I. Shelby
Barber, Robert Eugene
Bartel, Henry Paul
.
.Minneapolis
Lamberton
Ashland, Wis.
Fargo, N. D.
Saginaw, Mich.
.Hastings
Boraas, J. Sherman
.
.
.Dawson
Britton, Paul R.
Leavenworth, Kansas
Brodin, Arlen George . . . . . . .Minneapolis
Brue, Donald Wayne . . . . . . .Minneapolis
Carrelli, Robert A. . . .
Christensen, Orla J. . . .
Christianson, Mary Joyce -
Minneapolis
. .Clarkfield
Knapp, Wis.
Dickens, Claire Mae
Harrisburg, S. D.
Dongoske, Robert Frank .
Mound
Dreyer, Earl Edwin
Ferndale, Wash.
Dumpys, Hans George
. . .Hutchinson
Eckhoff, Donald E.
Field, Marvin William
Fitch, Gary D. . .
Fowlds, Carol Marie
. . . . . .Osseo
Minneapolis
Gehring, Farolyn Johnson
Minneapolis
Gilbert, Verner Lloyd . . . . . . . .Duluth
Gilbertson, Nora M.
Frontier, Sask., Canada
Gjengdahl, Robert Allen . . . . .Minneapolis
Grinde, Lloyd C. . . . . . . Estherville, Iowa
. Rugby, N. D.
Gunderson, Eulah Irene
Hagen, Elizabeth Gerda
. .Montevideo
Hagen, Harold L. . . . . . . . . . .Minneapolis
Hanggi, Glen &en
. . . . . . . . . . .St. Paul
Hanson, Ruth Ellen .
.
.
. Aikin
Haugen, James S. . . . . . . . . . Minneapolis
Haynes, John W. . . . . . . . . . . .Minneapolis
Helgerson, Luurayne Renoro
Mt. Sterling, Wis.
Holzinger, Robert A.
. . . . .Minneapolis
Honstad, Janet Marie .
Hoversten, momas H. . .
Howard, Charles Henry .
Hsiao, Andrew Keh-hsieh
. Alden, low
. .Lake Crysta
Hunt, Elaine Helen
Jha, Anil Kumar
Larson, Donald Rae
Larson, Melvin W. .
Larson, Robert Duane
Newman Grove, Nebr.
Lee, Russell Curtis
. . . . . . Fosston
Lockwood, Robert Rae
. . .Minneapolis
Lower, Carolyn Elizabeth . . Minneapolis
Ludviksen, Stanley B.
.Portland, Ore.
Lundin, Harvey Allen
Main, Ronald C.
.Portland, Ore.
. .
Meredith, Patricia Jo-Anne . . .Minneapolis
Moen, Ardell John . . . . .Hillsboro, N. D.
Mortensen, Elizabeth Anne . Minneapolis
Moylan, Robert Laverne . Spokane, Wash.
Ose, Roger
.
Overlund, Ervin K.
,
Pearson, James Kenneth
Pederson, James Lowell
Petersen, Marilyn J.
Peterson, Russell Jerome
Radde, Robert Edward
Roos, Robert Allen
Rorvig, Bruce W.
.
Rundquist, Bertil . .
Rykken, Franklyn E.
Saastad, Jerrald A.
Sar5, Donohue R.
Solem, Duane J. .
Sorum, Ann Carlson
.
Steenberg, Evelyn Chanco
. Minneapolis
Stensland, Arlen H. . . Portland, N. D.
Stoa, Harold Merlyn . . . .
. Minneapolis
Swanson, Allen John . .
. Cloquet
Tader, David Leon
Thompson, John .
,
. Staples
. .Minneapolis
.McGregor
Madison, Wis.
Thompson, Theodore T.
Twiton, Margaret Halen
. . . . . Stephen
Estherville, Iowa
Warnes, Wanda E.
Woiden, Gerhard P.
. Fargo, N. D.
Ysteboe, Ruth
COLLEGE, 1957
With the degree of Bachelor of Arts
Anfinsen, Arthur Morris Jr.
Armstrong, James William
Aranson, Donald W. . .
.
Arvidson, Kenneth
Baker, Stanley B.
Berg, Richard Lloyd
Berg, Sidney
. .
Bernier, Jack L. . .
Berntsen, Rita Maxine . .
Beyers, James Russell M.
Bockhaus, Mary Gail
Borman, Dennes L.
.
Braseth, Mary Ann
.
Burke, Dorothy Ann .
Hopkins
St. Paul
Minneapolis
Rockford, Ill.
.
Minneapolis
.Minneapolis
,
.Minneapo!is
. . .Minneapolis
Escanaba, Mich.
.St. Louis Park
... .
Mound
,
.Minneapolis
. .Amery, Wis.
Minneapolis
,
.
Ingebretson, E. Arlene
Minneapolis
Jamieson, Robert Grant
Jensen, Carl A. . . . . .
Jespersen, Morris Gene
Johanson, Eldri Ruth .
Johnson, Marshall Duane
Johnson, Ralph Stanley
Johnson, Ronald Clarence
Johnson, Wilgard G.
,
Koltved, Leon M.
Koupins, Alfreds Egons
Knox, Philip S. . . .
Kolden, Lois Jeanette
Minneapolis
Racine, Wis.
St. Paul
. .
Dalton
Middle River
. . . . . Duluth
. . St. Paul
. . . Herman
Rockford, Ill.
.Minneapolis
. .Minneapolis
Portland, Ore.
. . Bagley Loidig, Anneliese . . . . . . . willmar
Christianson, Harlan Charles
James
William
Minneapolis
~
~. . ~
l
i
conyers,L ~ ~ R ~~ . ~ ~ ~ b i ~~ Lanning,
~~
t~
.
.Minneapolis
Larson, Patricia Ann
st. paul
Co[nelius, Jane Collins
Larson, Richard John . . . . . Kerkhaven
Larsson, Nancy Elaine . Wahpeton, N. D.
Dahl, Linnea M.
Minneapolis
Laufenburger, Barbara A. . . . . . . .Roseau
Lecander, Roger V. . . Menomonie, Wis.
Emery, Curtis V. .
Minneapolis
. ..
. . . . . . Fasstan
Lee, Harris W.
Engedal, C. Gayle
,
Minneapolis
.
.Minneapolis
Lindsley, Dale A.
Faust, Daniel Gordon
Valley City, N. D.
. . . . .Lake Lillian
Flann, Duncan D. . .
Forss, Grace Lois
.
. .Minneapolis
Franzmeier, Richard Allan
Minneapolis
Minneapolis
Freedland, David A. Jr. . .
Gehring, Virgil Robert
Minneapolis
Gibson, '~ruce Allen
. . . . Lamberton
. . Minneapolis
Gilbert, Barbara Ann
Glasoe, James Lowell
. .Minot, N. D.
Grant, Gloria Helen . Cumberland, Wis.
Graus, Gilbert L.
. .
. .McGregor
. . . Benson
Grimstad, Jason .
.
Minneapolis
Grinde, Raymond A.
Gutzmann, Gordon Keith
.
St. Paul
Hamre, Paul Andrew
Hofflander, Thomas M.
Holmes, Dean Karstens
Holmgren, Charles Gordon
Holt, Evereti V.
Minneapolis
Minneapolis
Cannon Falls
St. Paul
. . Carver
Mackey, Roger Clarence
Main, Christine Munson
Manguson, Jean Marie
Martin, Gerald A.
.
Mindrum, Gerald . .
Moe, Erwin John .
.
Monson, Harley C. . .
Moren, Orval Kenneth
.
Nelson, David J.
Nelson, Victor E. .
Nielsen, Bernard G.
Norman, James A.
Nyhus, ,Paul Luther
Ohlin,
Olson,
Olson,
Olson,
Olson,
Olson,
...
John L.
Beverly JoAnn
David W. .
Jeanetie I. .
John H. .
Oscar E. Jr.
.
Minneapolis
. .Atwater
. .Tracy
.Minneapolis
Minneap~lis
Excelsior
Minneapolis
.Mentor
. . Minneapolis
Whitehall, Mich.
. .Minneapolis
. . . . .Minneapolis
Cumberland, Wis.
.
Minneapolis
Cottonwood
New London
Minneapolis
Cottonwood
. .Mound
~
Ose, Gaylen
Oslund, Robert C.
Thief River Falls
..
. St. Paul
Paton, Richard James
Peterson, W. Fred .
Pickering, Donald M. . .
Plumedahl, James Duane
.Minneapolis
Minneapolis
St. Paul
Robbinsdale
Rasmussen, Joyce Marie
. .
Rodvik, Marvin S.
Rokke, Robert John .
Rovick, Doris Jean . .
Minneapolis
.Minneapolis
Strandquist
.Minneapolis
.
. . Donnelly
Sather, Judith Ann
Schuldt, Kenneth Edward
Minneapolis
Seaver, Raymond E. .
Minneapolis
, .Minneapolis
Sherry, Richard J. . .
Skovholt, Verna Joanne
Mooreton, N. D.
Snider, Neal E. . .
Pembina, N. D.
Sorenson, Peggy-Joyce
Sunde, John P.
Swenson, Darwin Warren
Minneapolis
Minneapolis
Lake Lillian
Tamminen, Joon Katherine
Stambaugh, Mich.
Tebben, Peter J.
Sebeka
Bod@, Norway
Thomassen, lvar .
Thompson, Rodney F.
Minneapolis
Trelstad, Gordon Anthony
Minneapolis
Vevle, Richard Harold
Minneapolis
Warme, Thomas Martin
Welckle, John Edwin
Welde, Ronald 6.
Minneapolis
Woad Lake
Minneapolis
Zinn, Wilton Harley
.
St. Paul
SEMINARY, 1956
With the degree of Bachelor of Theology
Berntsan, Rudolph E.
Carlsen, Glenn T. .
Goodrich, Quentin A.
.
Edinburg, N. D.
Minneapolis
.Minneapolis
Lyngdal, Lloyd W.
Duluth
Rimmereid. Arthur V.. New Rockford, N. D.
With degree of Graduate in Theology
Unseth, Malcolm Wulff
Rockford, Ill.
SEMI NARY, 1957
With the degree of Bachelor of Theology
Hanska
Minneapolis
Newfolden
Evenson, Leland E.
Helland, Donald E.
Huglen, Erling S. B.
Nyhus, Edward 0.
Sandness, Albert J
Shiell, James L.
Cumberland, Wis.
La Moure, N. D.
Hoffman
With degree of Graduate in Theology
Anderson, Eugene C.
Elness, Jerome
Willmar
Garfield
Nelson, Maynard L.
Salem, Ore.
STUDENT REGIS=
STUDENT ENROLLMENT, 1956-1957
College
First Semester
Class
Men
Women
Second Semester
I
Total
Men
..
Senior
Junior . .
Sophomore
Freshman
Speciol
.
Fr. Nurse (S. H.)
Fr. Nurse (D. H.)
Jr. Nurse (D. H.)
Total
Total College Enrollment, 1 956-1957
Clan
Men
Senior . . . . .
Junior
. . .. .
Sophomore
. .
Freshman
....
Special
. . . ...
Fr. Nurse (S. H.)
Fr. Nurse (D. H.)
Jr. Nurse (D. H.)
Total
Women
-
-
523
433
Total
Theological Seminary, 1956-1957
Semester II
Semester I
Men
Third Year
Second Year
First Year
Special
Total
Women
8
I
Men
10
8
8
10
8
I
-
-
-
27
1
26
Women
Total
Women
Total
TOTAL ENROLLMENT, 1956-1957
COLLEGE
Men Students
Women Students
Total
SEMINARY
Men Students .
Women Students
Total
Total enrollment
,
,
STUDENT ENROLLMENT, 1957-1 958
COLLEGE
First Semester
Class
Men
Women
Second Semester
Total
Men
Senior
Junior . . . . . .
Sophomore . . .
Freshman . . . . .
Special
.....
Fr. Nurse (S.H.)
Fr. Nurse (D. H.)
Jr. Nurse (D. H.)
Total
Total College Enrollment, 1957-1958
Class
Men
Senior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .&3
Junior . . . . . . . . . . . . . W
Sophomore . . . . . . . . . . I29
Freshman . . . . . . . 195
Special . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Fr. Nurse (S. H.) . . . . .
Fr. Nurse (D. H.) . . . . .
Jr. Nurse (D. H.)
......
Total
...........
520
Women
27
39
81
130
16
88
38
32
451
Total
Women
Total
Theological Seminary, 1957-1958
Semester I
Semester II
Men
Men
Third Year .
Second Year
First Year . .
Special
.
.
Total
Men
8
8
7
Total
TOTAL ENROLLMENT, 1957-1958
COLLEGE
Men Students
Women Students
Total
SEMINARY
Men Students
Women Students
Total
Total enrollment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . , .
Deducting those counted more than once
SUMMARY OF GRADUATES
SEMINARY
Total
COLLEGE
Total
Total Graduates
Page
Page
Academic Administration
. . . . . 34
Accounts, Payment of . . . . . . . . . 16
Accreditation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Admission. College .
.
. 34
.
.
. 96
Admission. Seminary .
Administration . . . . . .
. . 108
Administrative Staff . . . . . . 108
Advanced Standing . . . . .
Aims. Fundamental . . . . . . .
Alumni Association. The . . . . . .
Ancient and Classical Languages .
Archives. The
. . . . . . . . . . .
Art
. . . . . . . . . . . .
Athletics . . . . . . . . . .
Attendance. Chapel
..
..
Attendance. Class .
. .
AudieVisual Education
....
Augsburg Foundation. The . . .
Awards
. . . . . . . . . .
Diaconate . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Dining Hall . . . .
2 11. 6
Discipline . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . 27
Distinction. Degree with . . . . . . . . 41
Divisional Organization .
.
..54
Dramatics . .
. . .
30. 64
Band
31. 7 0
Biology. Department of . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Board. Estimate of Cost . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
. . . . 107
Board of Trustees .
Buildings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Business Administration. Curriculum . . . 46
Business Administration and Economics 80
Calendar
. . . .
4
.
.
36
Cancellation
31. 7 0
Cantarians . . . . .
.
21
Chapel Service. The
. 88
Chemistry. Department of
Choir
. . . . . . .
31. 7 0
Church History (Seminary)
. . . . 103
..
59
Classical Languages . . . .
Classification of Students .
. . . . . 37
Clubs
. . . .
30. 31. 99
. . . 29
Cc-curricular Program .
. 109
Committees of the Faculty .
Community Standards and Discipline . 27
Conditions . . . . . . . . . . 38. 98
.
9
Control. Financial Support and
. . . . . . . .
. 22
Convocation
. 27
Coordinator of Student Activities
Counseling . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Course Fees . I . . . . .
15
Courses of Study. College . . . . 53
Credits .
.
.
41. 53
.
.
.
42
Curriculums
.
Degrees
Dentistry. Pre-Dental Courses
.
39. 99. 100
.
50
Economics
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Education . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Educational Plant . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Electives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Elimination of Students . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Employment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20. 98
Engineering. Pre-Engineering Course . . 5 0
English. Department of . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 0
Enrollment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Entrance Requirements. College . . . . 34
Evening School . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Examinations
.............
38
Expenses
..........
Faculty. The
Fees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Financial Assistance . . . . . . . . .
Financial Information . . . . . . . .
Financial Support and Control
...............
Fine Arts
Food Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Forensics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Foundation. Augsburg . . . . . . . . . . . . .
French . . . . . . . . . . . .
...
26
31
10
66
General Information . . . . .
5
Geography
........
-74
German
......
. . . 65
Grade Values . . . .
39
Graduates . . . . . . . .
120
Graduates--(1870-1957)
Summary of 125
Graduation Requirements
,
.39. 99
Grants-in-aid
. . . .
20
Greek
.
...........
59
.
Health and Physical Education . .
73
25
Health Service . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hebrew . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60. 101
High School Teaching. Curriculum
44
Historical Sketch . . . . . . . . . .
6
History. Department of . . . . . .
72
Home Economics. Department of
83
45
Home Economics. Vacations in
Homiletics
. . . . . . . . .
105
Honor Pbnfs
. . . . .
39. 41
Honors
. . . . . . . . .
Hospital Affiliation . . . . .
Housing . . . . . . . . . . . .
Humanities. Division of the
Page
Page
. . . . .33. 41
. . . . . . . . 13
. . . . 26
Polity. Worship. and Parish Work . . . .105
Practical Theology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Prizes. Scholarships and . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Probation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Psychology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Publications
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Purpose
.................... 5
. . . 59
.
Incompletes
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38. 98
Intercollegiate. Athletics. Purpose and
Philosophy of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Journalism
. . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Lower Division Requirements .
Laboratories. Natural Science
Latin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Law. Pre-Law Courses . . . .
Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Library Science
.........
Loan Funds . . . . . . . .
Location
. . . . . . .
Majors .
.............
40
Male Chorus . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31, 70
Mathematics, Department of
92
Medical Staff . . . . . .
109
Medical Technology . . . . . . . .13, 48
Medicine, Pre-Medic Courses . . . . . . 5 l
Membership in Educational Associations 10
Ministry, Preparation for the . . . .42, 97
Minors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40.
Missionary Work. Preparation for . . 43
Modern Languages. Department of
. 65
Museum. The
...
. . 11
Music. Department of
. . .
68
Music Fees . . . . .
15
Music. Organizations
31 70
.
Natural Sciences and Mathematics.
Division of . . . . .
New Testament (Seminary) . .
Norwegian. Courses in .
.
.
Numbering of Courses
.
.
Nursing. Pre-Nursing Courses . .
Nursing. Affiliation with Schools of
Old Testament (Seminary)
Oratory
.........
Organ . . . . . . . . . .
.
Organizations. Student
. .
Orientation
. .
86
1 02
66
53
49
13
. . . . 101
31, 64
. . . . . 70
30. 99
25 77
.
Parish Work. Preparation for
Pastoral Theology . . . . . .
Payment of Accounts . . . . . . .
Personnel Services. Student
Philosophy. Department of . . . . .
Physical Education. Department of
Health and . . . . .
Physics. Department of
...
Piano . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Placement Service for Graduates .
Political Science . . . . . . . . . .
.
Recreation
. . . . . . . . . . . . ..22. 32
Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Refunds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Registration
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Registration. Change of . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Religion and Philosophy. Division of . . 55
Religious Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Residence Requirement . . . . . . . . . 41
Room Costs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Scandinavian Language and Literature 66
Scholarships and Prizes . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Secretarial Studies . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Secretarial Work Curriculum . . . . 52
Seminary. Admission . . . . . . 96
Seminary. Faculty
. . . . . . . . . . .110
Seminary. Courses of Study . . . . . . 100
Seminary. Expenses . . . . . . . ..14. 98
Seminary. Graduation and Degrees . . 99
. Seminary
. . . .
Internship . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Social and Recreational Activities . . . . . 22
Sociology. Department of
. .
75
Social Sciences. Division of the . .
72
Social Work Curriculum . .
. . . . 47
Span . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Spanish
. . . . .
. . . . . . . . 67
Special Programs of Study
.....
13
Speech. Department of . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Student Activities. Coordination of .
27
Student Community Life
. . . . . 21
Student Government . . .
2 8
Student Personnel Services .
. . 23
Student Society. The .
. 27
Systematic Theology . .
103
Table of Contents
.
Teacher's Certificate . . . . . .
Teaching Curriculum .
. . .
Testing
. . . . . . . . . .
Theology. College Preparation for
Theological Orientation Courses
Theological Seminary. Augsburg
Transfer and Advanced Standing .
Trustees. B w r d of . . . . . . . . . .
Tuition and Fees . . . . . . . . .
37
41
University Courses . . .
Upper Division Requirements
Veterans. Admission of
Voice .
.
35
70
Augsburg College is located on Twenty-first Avenue South between Seventh and Eighth
Streets South with administrative ofices located in Science Hall on Seventh Street a t
Twenty-first Avenue South.
The college may be reached, via public transportation on the following lines:
1 . The Franklin bus t o Twenty-first Avenue South and Franklin
2. The Minnehaha Falls or Fort Snelling bus t o Twenty-first Avenue South and Riverside
3. The Plymouth-East Twenty-fifth Street bus to Seventh Street and Cedar Avenue
4. The Olson Highway bus t o Seventh Street and! Cedar Avenue
&h+mdkce
may de a&ued
a a &ellowa;
ADMISSION TO THE COLLEGE-Requests for bulletins, application blanks, application
for employment blanks, information regarding registration and admission procedure and
requirements for admission.
OfFice of Admissions
ADMISSION TO THE
Theological Seminary.
SEMINARY-Information
and
requests for
admission
t o the
Secretary of the Theological Faculty
EVALUATION OF CREDITS-Transcripts of credits, requirements for graduation, transfer
of credits, scholastic progress, and withdrawal of matriculated students.
O f i c e of the Registrar
HOUSING OF STUDENTS-Questions
pertaining specifically to housing and dormitory life.
Dean of Students
For information that does not appear t o be covered above
Augsburg College and Theological Seminary
Minneapolis 4, Minnesota
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Undergraduate Catalog, 1980-1981
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
This publication is designed to answer most of the questions which might be asked about
Augsburg College and its curriculum. Although information was current at the time of
publication, it is subject to change without notice.
It is the responsibility of each student to know the requirements...
Show more
This publication is designed to answer most of the questions which might be asked about
Augsburg College and its curriculum. Although information was current at the time of
publication, it is subject to change without notice.
It is the responsibility of each student to know the requirements, and academic policies
contained in this publication. If questions arise concerningany matterpublishedherein, the
student should consult with a faculty adviser, the Dean of the College, or the Registrar.
Table of Contents
PAGE 4, GLOSSARY OF TERMS
PAGE 5, INTRODUCTION
PAGE 6, THE COLLEGE
PAGE 10, CAMPUS MAP
PAGE 12, THE PHYSICAL PLANT
PAGE 14, ACADEMIC LlFE
PAGE 24, STUDENT LlFE
PAGE 31, ADMISSION T O THE COLLEGE
PAGE 35, FINANCIAL AID
PAGE 44, EXPENSES
PAGE 47, ACADEMIC ADMINISTRATION
PAGE 54, GENERAL INFORMATION
PAGE 56, COURSE DESCRIPTIONS AND OFFERINGS
PAGE 147, FACULTY
PAGE 156, ADMINISTRATIVE PERSONNEL
PAGE 158, INDEX
BACK COVER, ACADEMIC CALENDAR
Glossary of Terms
This Augsburg College catalog i s designed to give you the information you need to know
as a student or prospective student. I n it you will find most of the answers t o questions
you may have about Augsburg. If you have others, please feel free to write or phone the
Office of Admissions at the College.
Certain terms used in this catalog may be unfamiliar t o you. We hope the following brief
definitions will be helpful.
ACADEMIC..
. . . . . . . .The
practices, principles, regulations, and customs which
characterize school and college.
... .. .. ... .A subject
studied during one semester or an interim such as
"Community Development and Organization." In general, four
courses are taken each semester at Augsburg and one during the
interim i n January. Thirty-five courses are required for
graduation.
COURSE..
.
........A concentration of study in one area. Augsburg offers majors i n
MAJOR . ... .
20 departments.
-......, ...A concentration i n a field or study i n less depth than the major.
MINOR.. .
.. .. .... ....A course not required for the major or minor but taken by the
ELECTIVE
student from any college department as his or her interests
dictate.
FEE
.............,....
Charges made by the College for special services such as
laboratory equipment or locker rental.
.... ... , . ...Money a student borrows for college expenses and later repays.
LOAN . . .
See "Financial Aid."
SCHOLARSHIP
. . .....Financial assistance received by a student based on high school
performance in and out of the classroom, college standing, or
the result of special kerb such as the SAT or ACT. Scholarships
vary in amounts and lengrh of duration. The amount generally
depends upon the financial need of the student. There i s no
obligation to repay. The same criteria are used for Grants-In-Aid.
SEMESTER..
... .......The College operates on a 4-1-4 calendar. Each semester is 15
weeks i n length and the interim i s 4 weeks.
PREREQUISITE
.... ...A course which a student i s required t o complete before another
one may be taken. The prerequisite course may be either in the
same or another department.
Introduction
Few liberal arts colleges combine the
excitement and vitality of a metropolitan
center with the smallness and intimacy of
the rural setting. Augsburg is one of the
few, very special Christian colleges which
can offer you both.
The small college atmosphere enables
you to be a participant or a spectator at a
variety of events and activities. Exhibitions, concerts, films, and lectures are
regularly available to you on campus,
as are intercollegiate or intramural athletic
programs.
Religious activities are a vital part of the
campus. The Religious Life Commission
has been established by the Student
Government to oversee, stimulate and
perpetuate religious life on the Augsburg
campus. Its primary purpose and goal i s
neither self-serving nor self-sustaining,
but rather furthering the ministry of
Christ on the Augsburg campus.
You, the student, are an individual at
Augsburg. You design your own learning
experience. While distributional and
major requirements act as guidelines,
there is latitude to design a portion o f
your own education.
At Augsburg, the innovative and experimental as well as the individual are
central. The college follows the calendar
known as the "4-1-4."
I n the study of the liberal arts, you will
encounter ideas and experiences from
the whole range of human knowledge.
The liberal arts education, however, is
more than an education of knowledge
from a number of fields. Augsburg recognizes that concentration is necessary in
your chosen field. You may choose from a
variety of majors for hundreds of career
possibilities.
Augsburg is i n the center of the Twin
Cities of Minneapolis and St. Paul. In this
metropolitan setting, a rich kaleidoscope
of resources and activities i s available t o
enrich your education, if you choose. You
may select an evening at the Guthrie
Theater, the Brave New Workshop, or at
any of the many galleries or coffee
houses. You might spend an afternoon
touring the Minneapolis Institute of Arts.
You may choose a concert by the Minnesota Orchestra or one by the many professional touring groups that appear i n
the Twin Cities. There are numerous
opportunities for individual and team
sports. Professional sports are also available - the Twins, the Vikings, the North
Stars, and the Kicks.
Thus, we feel Augsburg i s a distinctive
combination: a strong academic program, a capable and dedicated staff, an
eager student body and a remarkable
location.
The College
Identification
Augsburg is afour-year liberal artscollege
affiliated with the American Lutheran
Church (ALC).
more than loo
years
A u g s b u r g celebrated its
centennial i n 1969 and i s i n i t s second
century of Christian higher education.
The current study body of about 1600 is
largely of Lutheran background though
many denominations are represented on
campus. About 65% are resident students,
while others commute daily from the surrounding metropolitan area.
Reaching the Twin Cities i s easy. Several
major airlines provide daily service to
Minneapolis-St. Paul International Airport, including united, ~~~~h~~~~orient,
Eastern, Braniff, Republic, Ozark and
Allegheny. Bus or train connections can
be made from all areas of the United
States.
The Augsburg campus i s just five minutes
east of downtown Minneapolis via Interstate 94 which forms the southern border
of the campus. (Directions are given in the
map section of this catalog.)
History
Location
You and your education will have the
option of benefiting from Augsburg's
location in the Twin Cities. Excellent art
collections are available to you in the
Minneapolis Institute of Arts, the Walker
Art Center, and many other galleries.
Augsburg was the first seminary founded
by Norwegian Lutherans i n America.
Minneapolis replaced Marshall, Wisconsin, as Augsburg's home in 1872. The first
college students were enrolled i n 1874
and the first college graduation was held
in 1879.
The Minnesota Orchestra and other area
performing organizations afford rich
opportunities for the enjoyment of music
of many types. The Twin CitjesaIsoappear
regularly on the itineraries of major performing artists.
The school wasofficially namedAugsburf3
College in 1963 when its former sponsor,
the Lutheran Free Church, merged with
the American Lutheran Church. Augsburg Seminary joined with Luther Theelogical Seminary in St. Paul that same year.
A variety of dramatic and musical presentations is provided by several theaters
in the area such as the nationally known
Cuthrie Theater, Theater in the Round,
the Old Log Theater, the St. Paul Opera,
Chimera Theater and the Chanhassen
Dinner Theater.
Nature and Objectives
Recreational activities abound. You can
play tennis at parks near the campus or
swim in one of the many area lakes. I n the
winter you may join other students on
skiing trips. Professional sports are available the year around.
Augsburg is a four-year liberal arts college
of the American Lutheran Church. It i s
committed t o an open, honest, competent inquiry into the sciences, arts, and
humanities i n the context of the Christian
faith.
Augsburg emphasizes t h e f o l l o w i n g
primary objectives:
To expose students to a wide variety o f
ideas and disciplines, while assisting
them to become proficient i n one area
or major.
Department of Health, Education and
Welfare, Washington, D.C.
t o h e l p students understand the
Christian faith i n relation to the contemporary world.
The College and i t s faculty subscribe to
the Statement of Principles on Academic
Freedom as promulgated by the American Association of University Professors
and the Association of American Colleges.
to develop students' love o f learning
and their faculties o f reason, criticism,
curiosity a n d imagination b y encouraging and maintaining academic
excellence.
to increase students' understanding o f
the urban environment and culture,
and to enable them to gain the skills
needed to respond creatively to the
problems and potentialities o f the
modern city.
to encourage students to ascertain
their interests and abilities, and to aid
them i n discovering the occupational
opportunities which exist for them.
to assist students i n their intellectual,
emotional, and spiritual growth; to
encourage them to develop attitudes
and qualities o f character compatible
with the Christian faith.
Policies
It i s the policy of Augsburg College not t o
discriminate on the basis of race, creed,
national or ethnic origins, age, marital
status, sex or handicap as required by Title
IX of the 1972 Educational Amendments
or Section 504 of the Rehabilitation Act of
1973 as amended i n i t s admissions policies, educational programs, activities and
employment practices. Inquiries regarding compliance with Title IX may be
directed t o Bonnie-Jean Mork, Memorial
Hall (330-1023), or Marianne Sander,
M e m o r i a l H a l l (330-1160), o r t o t h e
Director of the Office for Civil Rights,
The Campus
Augsburg's campus i s located i n the heart
of Minneapolis surrounding Murphy
Square, the first of 155 parks i n the "City of
Lakes." The College currently has 16
major buildings with a number of cottage
housing units that are very popular with
the students. The Universitv of Minnesota
and two of the city's largest hospitals,
Fairview and St. Mary's, are adjacent to
the campus.
Accreditation
Augsburg has achieved full accreditation
i n the following associations that set
standards by which excellence i s judged:
North Central Association of Colleges
and Secondary Schools
The National Council for the Accreditation of Teacher Education (Secondary and Elementary)
The American Chemical Society
Visiting t h e Campus
The purpose of the campus visit is t o
permit students to learn, first-hand, about
t h e College program, facilities, and
admissions requirements. A personal
interview affords candidates, parents, and
the admissions counselor the opportunity
t o exchange information vital i n the
process of selecting a college and i n
making admissions decisions. A campus
tour and an interview with an admissions
officer are strongly recommended but are
not mandatory.
with a member of the faculty and to
attend classes, Monday through Friday,
when school i s in session.
Students who wish to arrange for a tour
and an interview are asked to write for an
appointment or call the admissions office
(330-1001). Preferred times for campus
visits are 9 a.m. - 4 p.m. weekdays. Arrangements also may be made t o meet
School, church, and other groups are
welcome to visit the College. Arrangements may be made by writing the Office
o f Admissions, A u g s b u r g College,
Minneapolis, Minnesota, 55454.
I
,
I
::-
'
I,:
DRIVING T O THE CAMPUS. Augsburg i s easily reached by Interstate 94. If you are coming east
from Minneapolis, take the 25th Avenue exit, turn left t o Riverside Avenue, and left again t o 21st
Avenue South. (You'll see the Augsburg sign.)
If you are coming west from St. Paul, take the Riverside Avenue exit (right after you cross the
Mississippi River) and then turn right onto Riverside. Watch for the Augsburg sign and turn left at
21st Avenue South.
-_--
3. Science Hall
4. Old Main
5. West Hall
6. Mortenson Tower
7. Urness Tower
8. College Center
9. Memorial Hall
10. Music Hall
11. Studio Building
12. Melby Hall
13. Ice Arena
14. Old Music Hall
15. Little Theater
16. East Hall
A. Admissions Parking
B. Student Parking
C. Main Entrance-Tunnel/Ramp/
Skyway
D. Quadrangle
E. Faculty-Staff Parking
F. Murphy Square
G. Practice Field
H. Fairview-St. Mary's Parking Ramp
Offices
-
--..
Admissions (628 21st Ave. S.)
Alumni/Parent Programs (Memorial 2nd floor)
American Indian Programs Counselor (Memorial 2nd floor)
Arts Coordinator (Music Hall 2nd floor)
Audio-visual (Memorial ground floor)
Augsburgian (College Center ground floor)
Black Student Affairs Counselor (Memorial 2nd floor)
Bookstore (College Center 1st floor)
Business Affairs (Memorial 2nd floor)
College Pastor (College Center 1st floor)
Career Planning and Placement (Memorial 1st floor)
C.H.R. (Memorial ground floor)
Continuing Education (Memorial 2nd floor)
Data Processing (Science 32)
Dean of the College (Memorial 2nd floor)
Development Office (Memorial 2nd floor)
ECHO (College Center ground floor)
Financial Services (Science 156)
Foreign Student Counselor (Memorial 2nd floor)
->
/.
A
*,>4<
4-
.< -?A
,
1
+..&-+--
.
*.,
;. ,
-
.
- ,
-...
,--
- --.
-,
.
,
?
.
d
i
,-
--
8
7.
.:
-./y-
-
<
-.
, -
-,
-
--
-
-
*.
? ,
,
*,T'-.
,.:. -"----.
/~-//~T~cc<F-,
-
<,/ER
.-
--
Housing (College Center 1st floor)
Intercultural Center (Memorial 2nd floor)
Interim Director (Memorial 2nd floor)
Internship Office (Memorial 2nd floor)
Little Theater (Speech Building)
News Bureau (Memorial 2nd floor)
Personnel Office (Memorial 2nd floor)
Plant Services (Science 156)
President's Office (Memorial 1st floor)
Printing and Mailing (Science 9)
Public Relations (Memorial 2nd floor)
Publications (Memorial 2nd floor)
Residence Programs (College Center 1st floor)
Registrar (Science 114)
S.O.S. (College Center Office)
Special Programs (Memorial 2nd floor)
Student Government (College Center Office)
Student Programs (College Center Office)
Study Abroad (Memorial 2nd floor)
Summer School Office (Memorial 2nd floor)
Treasurer's Office (Science 147)
The Physical Plant
Instruction facilities and student housing
at Augsburg are conveniently located in
relation t o each other.
Remodelling and construction work to
eliminate architectural barriers is expected t o be completed during 1980. This will
include street level access from 21st
Avenue South t o a tunnel/ramp/skyway
system that connects the tower dormitories and the five buildings on theQuadrangle.
Remodelling of academic and administrative space will result in relocations of
some departments and offices by 1980-81.
Following are descriptions of buildings.
The Admissions House, located at 628-21st
Avenue South, provides offices for the
admissions staff and a reception area for
prospective students and their parents.
The George Sverdrup Library, named in
honor of Augsburg's fourth president,
was erected and dedicated in 1955. Adjacent t o Science Hall and of similar
contemporary architectural design, it
provides excellent resources for research
and study. It contains reading rooms,
seminars, work rooms, a visual-education
center, the Augsburg Archives, classrooms, and a number of faculty offices.
Science Hall, erected in 1948-49, includes
general administration offices; the Computer Center; well-equipped laboratories
for chemistry, physics, and biology; a
medium-sized auditorium; and several
classrooms and faculty offices. The Lisa
Odland Observatory on the roof of
Science Hall was completed in the summer of 1960.
O l d Main, erected i n 1900, contains a
large number of classrooms and offices.
West Hall is an apartment building purchased in 1966 shortly after it was constructed. It provides excellent housing for
married students.
Mortensen Tower, erected i n 1973,
named in honor of Miss Gerda Mortensen, dean of women at Augsburg from
1923 to 1964, contains 104 one and twobedroom apartments providing housing
for 312 upperclass students. A spacious
lounge area as well as conference rooms
are located i n this building.
Urness Tower, completed in 1967, i s an
eleven-story building providing living
quarters for 324 students. The building
was named i n honor of Mr. and Mrs.
Andrew Urness who have given several
generous gifts to the college. A unique
feature of the building i s that each floor i s
considered a "house unit" providing the
36 residents, housed two to a room, with
their own lounge, study and utility areas.
The Augsburg College Center, completed
i n 1967, i s a center of non-academic
activity on campus. The building houses
the Commons, which i s the main dining
area, plus private dining rooms and a
coffee shop. Student government and
student publications have quarters in this
building. The bookstore i s also located
here. Spacious lounges and recreational
areas are provided in this three-story
building containing 55,000 square feet of
space.
Sverdrup-Oftedal Memorial Hall, erected
in 1938, was named in honor of Augsburg's second and third presidents. The
building provides space for administrative
and faculty offices and houses about 40
students.
The Music Hall, erected i n 1978, i s the
newest building on the campus. It con-
tains classroom facilities, two rehearsal
halls, a music library, practice studios,
offices for the music faculty and a 217-seat
recital hall.
The Art Studio Building, dedicated i n
1964, houses the Department of Art on i t s
two floors.
Melby Hall, the auditorium-gymnasium,
was completed i n 1961. This building,
named in honor of Professor J.S. Melby,
dean of men from 1920 t o 1942, basketball
coach and head of the Christianity department, provides excellent facilities for
the health and physical education program, intercollegiate athletics, chapel
services, and general auditorium purposes.
The Ice Arena, built i n 1974, provides two
large skating areas for Augsburg and the
metropolitan community. It is used for
hockey, recreational skating, and figure
skating.
The Speech and Drama Building was acq u i r e d i n 1959 and remodeled f o r
dramatic and other speech activities. A
theater wing addition t o Melby Hall, replacing the old music hall, is proposed for
completion late i n 1980.
Annex Houses, located i n the campus
area, provide accommodations for students, faculty, a n d staff members.
Academic Life
Augsburg i s a modern well-equipped
college which aims to provide i t s students
with a broad liberal arts education as well
as prepare them for a career. A strong
academic program in the arts and sciences
and in theology i s available. Pre-professional preparation for such fields as
engineering, medicine, law and t h e
Christian ministry is offered. The College
prepares students for graduate study in
several disciplines. Preparation f o r
careers in business, communications,
medical technology, music, nursing,
occupational therapy, social work, and
teaching i s available.
Augsburg seeks to assist i t s students
through their academic experience to
better understand themselves and the
world and to equip them to serve according t o their individual interests and
abilities.
The Student as Learner
A great deal has been written during the
last few years describing the responsibilities of a college to its students. Augsburg
recognizes its task to provide consistently
high quality opportunities for learning
along with support systems which enhance the teaching-learning process.
Learning i s not, however, a commodity
which can be purchased. It i s not equal t o
simply buying so many courses and being
exposed to the activities of professors.
Learning involves t h e solitary inner
struggle of the student who investigates,
analyzes and synthesizes the materials
and insights offered. When these have
become one's own and when the learner
moves on to new personal insights, then
learning has taken place.
Both the school and the student have
responsibilities in this process. Neither
party can elude its basic task.
Faculty
Augsburg has an able faculty who try to
take a personal interest in their students.
The student-faculty ratio i s approximately
15.5 to 1, with class size averaging 25 or
less.
Augsburg faculty members serve as
academic advisers and are available for
help on individual problems. They often
join students in discussing the political
climate, comparing notes on a visiting
speaker, or talking over the latest sports
victory while having coffee.
Library Services
Augsburg has a well-equipped library.
A relaxed atmosphere, a helpful staff and
friendly student library assistants make
the library a favorite place t o study. The
main library, centrally located next to the
Science Hall, houses over 160,000volumes
including books, periodicals, records and
various other media. The Music and
Chemistry libraries are located within the
departmental areas.
Access t o over a million volumes i s available via daily interloan and courier service
among the seven private liberal arts colleges and the Hill Reference Library.
Through Minitex, the statewide network,
the additional resources of Minnesota
and Wisconsin libraries are accessible to
the Augsburg faculty and students.
A s e r v i c e - d e d i c a t e d staff p r o v i d e s
students with assistance to meet diverse
information needs including instruction
i n the use of the library, standard reference service, guidance in pursuing term
paper topics, and directions to other local
sources of information.
The AV Center of the Library provides
facilities for classes in broadcasting and
audio-visual materials. Assistance with the
production of slides, transparencies, filmstrips and audiohide0 tape recordings
are available f o r b o t h faculty and
students. Equipment such as movie and
slide projectors and tape recorders may
be borrowed for limited periods; film
bibliographies and other advice o n
materials selection are also available.
The 4-1-4 Calendar
Augsburg follows the 4-1-4 calendar. Two
15-week semesters are separated by a 4week interim in January. During each
semester the student generally enrolls in
four courses; during the interim concentration is on one subject.
The interim period i s an especially exciting time. The whole world becomes an
arena of learning. Creative energies and
individual interests determine the course
of study. Innovation and experimentation
are encouraged i n this change from the
general academic schedule. Interest in
music may take form i n the study and
presentation of a concert program. Interest in people may find form in the study
and participation in activities of a social
agency. Newspapers and advertising
agencies provide opportunities for those
interested in communications. Whether
your interests are sedate or spectacular
the interim will afford the opportunity t o
experience and experiment while learning.
General Education
Requirements
Distribution requirements for graduation
are minimal, affording the student considerable f r e e d o m i n t h e choice o f
courses. A student seeking a liberal arts
education would probably choose many
of them even if they were not required.
In selecting courses t o meet the general
distribution requirements, students may
select an approved course in the areas of
mathematics or physics, chemistry or biology, psychology or sociology, economics o r p o l i t i c a l science, history o r
philosophy, and English or speech, communication and theater arts. The study of
a foreign language is required. Proficiency in English writing must be demonstrated. One course from an approved list
of courses containing an emphasis on
urban concerns i s required as is prof i c i e n c y i n t w o l i f e t i m e sports.
For details on general education requirements, see the Academic Administration
section.
Majors
Augsburg offers the following majors:
American Studies
Studio Art
Biology
Business Administration
Chemistry
Communications
Economics
Economics/Business
Administration
Elementary Education
Engineering
English
French
German
Health Education
History
Mathematics
Medical Technology
Metro-Urban Studies
Music
Music Therapy
Natural Science
Norwegian
Nursing
Philosophy
Physical Education
Physics
Political Science
Psychology
Religion
Scandinavian Area
Studies
Social Science (Special Emphasis in History, Behavioral Science, Non-Western
Studies, International Relations)
Social Work
Sociology
Spanish
Speech
Theater Arts
Transdisciplinary
Majors in East Asian Studies and Russian
Area Studies are available t h r o u g h
cooperative programs with the Associated Colleges of the Twin Cities (ACTC).
Consult directors of these programs for
further information. It i s possible for
students t o complete other majors also
through ACTC. Students who wish to
complete a major offered at one of the
other ACTC colleges must make application for such a major through the Office
of the Registrar.
Pre-Professional Training
Students who plan to enter the fields of
law, medicine, dentistry, the ministry, and
engineering, can profit from a liberal arts
education at Augsburg. It i s suggested
that requirements for admission t o graduate schools or seminaries be reviewed and
then the course of study at Augsburg be
planned accordingly. Augsburg offers a
wide scope of courses in the natural and
social sciences, i n the humanities, and in
religion and philosophy which will provide the necessary preparation for future
professional study.
the United States, t o help determine
whether they possess an interest i n law.
Since law schools encourage students t o
maintain a high grade point average, the
pre-law student should be aware that
many graduate schools consider the
grade P/N given for a course as a "C". This
information may help students in planning their class schedules.
Pre-Dentistry at Augsburg
Pre-Medicine at Augsburg
English, 2 courses; Biology 111, 112;
Physics 121, 122; Chemistry 115, 116 (or
105,106), 351, 352; Mathematics124; Genera1 Psychology, 1 course.
Students are encouraged to consult with
in the freshman
the faculty adviserearly
year. Requirements have been designed
to fulfill the minimum requirements of
the School of Dentistry at the University of
Minnesota. Requirements at other universities may vary.
Pre-Engineering at Augsburg
Augsburg offers a dual-degree program
of liberal arts and engineering in cooperation with the Washington University
School o f Engineering and A p p l i e d
Science and the Michigan Technological
University. See under Engineering for
information on the course requirements
in this Three-Two Plan of studies.
Pre-Law at Augsburg
Students planning to pursue a career i n
law should consult the handbook published by The Association of American
Law Schools. Early consultation with the
pre-law adviser, Dr. Myles Stenshoel, i s
strongly suggested. Students may wish to
take the political science course, Law in
Biology 111, 112, 355; Chemistry 115, 116
(0r105,106), 351,352,353; English l l l , a n d
o n e or more w r i t i n g and literature
courses; Mathematics 124, 125; Physics
121, 122; Biochemistry 367; sociolog~,
behavioral sciences and humanities, 5
s recorncourses. General P s ~ c h o l o gi ~
mended.
students arc encouraged to consult with
the faculty adviser early in the freshman
year.
Programs have been designed t o fulfill the
minimum requirements of the Medical
School of the University of Minnesota.
Requirements at other universities may
vary.
Pre-Pharmacy at Augsburg
Biology 111,112; Chemistry 115,116, 351,
352; Economics 122,123; English 111, and
a second course; Health Ed. 110; Mathematics 124; Physics 121, 122. Electives t o
fulfill the 60 semester-hour requirements
should be chosen from humanities, literature, and the arts. Please refer to the
bulletins published by the College of
Pharmacy of your choice.
Students are encouraged t o consult with
the faculty adviser early i n the freshman
year.
This two-year program has been designed
to fulfill minimum requirements of the
College of Pharmacy at the University of
Minnesota. Requirements at other universities may vary.
Pre-Seminary at Augsburg
One may enter a theological seminary
with any of several different majors, e.g.,
history, philosophy, English, psychology,
sociology, religion. The student planning
t o enter seminary should include Religion
111, 221 among the courses selected. A
pre-seminary curriculum should include
at least two semesters of history (Western
Civilization) and one or more courses in
the history of philosophy. It should also
include Greek in the junior and/or senior
year.
Pre-Veterinary Medicine at Augsburg
English, 2 courses; Mathematics 124;
Public Speaking, 1 course; Chemistry 115,
116 (or 105,106), 351,352,353; Biology 111,
112; Physics 121, 122; Economics, 1
course; artistic expression, 2 courses (art,
literature, music, humanities, theater, and
upper division foreign languages); ant h r o p o l o g y , economics, geography,
history, political science, psychology, and
sociology courses t o fulfill the remainder
of the distribution requirements.
Students are encouraged to consult with
the faculty adviser early in the freshman
year.
Programs have been designed tofulfill the
minimum requirements of the College of
Veterinary Medicine at the University of
Minnesota. Requirements at other universities may vary.
Inter-lnstitutiona( Programs
Augsburg cooperates with other colleges
and institutions in the Twin Cities area on
several programs.
Library and Media Center. Through C.L.I.C.,
the Twin Cities private colleges library
consortium, and Minitex, the statewide
library network, the Augsburg community has access to over 5,000,000 volumes. Augsburg's library works with a
collection of education materials including approximately 160,000 books, periodicals, records, tapes, scores and films.
Associated Colleges of the Twin Cities.
Full-time students at Augsburg and the St.
Paul colleges of Hamline, Macalester, St.
Catherine and St. Thomas may elect a
course each semester at another campus.
No additional fee is required for such an
exchange, except for private instruction
in music and some independent studies.
See under "Independent Study" for
further details. Students may elect to
participate in the cooperative program t o
gain new perspectives, t o get better acquainted with the other schools, or to
undertake a specific course or major not
offered on the home campus. The colleges have coordinated calendars. The
interim term may also be taken on
another campus. A regularly scheduled
bus shuttles students b e t w e e n t h e
campuses.
Augsburg College also cooperates with
other colleges in planning study opportunities for the January interim. For
example, Augsburg and St. Olaf jointly
plan a number of foreign study opportunities for the interim. Since the interim
program i s new each year, the Interim
Director should be consulted regarding
planned programs.
The Higher Education Consortium. This
group i s composed of colleges and universities i n Minnesota, Iowa and South
Dakota. Planned activities include innovative curricular programsfor students,
interchange and sharing of academic personnel and o t h e r college resources,
cooperative research projects, foreign
study, joint sponsorship of a metro-urban
affairs conference, and development of
programs consistent with the needs and
resources of the community organizations of the Upper Midwest.
Chemical Dependency Program. A cooperative effort between Augsburg College and Metropolitan Community College in downtown Minneapolis has resulted i n the establishment of a four-year
program in social work, sociology or
psychology with a chemical dependency
specialty. The program i s designed t o train
specialists to help professional people i n
dealing with chemical dependency
problems. Courses are taken both on the
Augsburg and Metropolitan campuses.
Conservation of Human Resources
(CHR). These co-learning classes bring
together Augsburg students, prison inmates, mental hospital patients, guards,
and students at rehabilitation centers.
Classes are held at such places as the
Shakopee Institution for Women, Stillwater State Prison, Trevilla of Robbinsdale
(a center for the severely physically handicapped), or on the Augsburg campus. The
classes offered through several departments give students first-hand views of
the prisons, hospitals, and rehabilitation
centers. The response o f students
involved in the courses, both from Augsb u r g and t h e institutions, has been
extremely favorable.
Computer Programming. Augsburg and
Control Data Institute have an arrangement whereby students may transfer the
equivalent of three courses in computer
programming taken at CDI to Augsburg
College.
Affiliation with School of Nursing. Nursing students in the school of nursing at
Lutheran Deaconess Hospital receive instruction in biology, chemistry, and other
basic courses at Augsburg. Applications
for admission t o the school of nursing
should be made directly to the hospital.
Medical Technology. In cooperation with
Hennepin County General, Metropolitan
Medical Center, and Northwestern hospitals, Augsburg offers work which
enables qualified students to receive a
college degree with a major in Medical
Technology. The first three years of this
work are taken at Augsburg, and a final
twelve-month program is completed at
one of the three hospitals when the
student i s accepted by the participating
hospital for i t s program. Augsburg College does not guarantee acceptance by
the hospitals.
Engineering. Affiliation with Washington
University School of Engineering and
Applied Science in St. Louis, Missouri, and
Michigan, enables a student to receive
the Bachelor of Arts degree from Augsburg College and an engineering baccalaureate degree from Washington University or Michigan Technological University, i n a five-year program. The first
three years are spent at Augsburg and the
last two at the affiliated university.
Corrective Therapy. A program in Corrective Therapy worked out in cooperation with the Minnesota Veterans' Home,
is available t o students who complete a
major in physical education with specialization in Corrective Therapy.
Admission to this program requires an
application t o be approved by t h e
director of the program. Application
should be made during the spring semester of the sophomore year. Candidates are
r e q u i r e d t o have a 2.5 grade-point
average i n work completed in the major
and a 2.0 grade-point average overall. All
candidates should, as soon as possible,
consult w i t h t h e Director regarding
proper sequence of courses.
ROTC. While Augsburg does not offer
Reserved Officers Training programs for
the various armed services of the United
States, such programs are available i n the
metropolitan area and may be pursued,by
Augsburg students. For information, confer with the Dean of the College.
Opportunities for Study
Abroad
Several types of international experience
are available to Augsburg students. Some
of them are briefly described below. For
application procedures and further information, request the special brochure on
International Study at Augsburg from the
Director of International Programs. Since
there i s a limit on the number of students
who may study abroad each year it i s wise
to apply in the fall prior to the year one
wishes to participate in an international
program.
Program in Global Community. Augsburg's 3 1/2 month living/learning program based i n Cuernavaca, Mexico,
focuses on the study of issues related to
global justice and human liberation in the
light of Christian proclamation. Includes
intensive Spanish instruction, group trips,
home stay with a family, and cultural
activities. The cost, including travel, is
equivalent to full room, board, and tuition for one term at Augsburg. Application and interview required, enrollment
limited.
Student Project for Amity Among
Nations. Augsburg participates in the
SPAN program. This is a joint venture of
the University of Minnesota and several
colleges i n the state. Each year three or
four countries are selected, and qualified
students are granted partial scholarships
to enable them to spend a summer in
informal study in one of the countries
chosen. Applications t o the program are
made i n the spring of the freshman or
sophomore year. The SPAN program consists of three stages: language study and
group meetings during the school year
before departure, independent study
abroad on a topic of one's choice during
the following summer, and the writing of
a paper upon return.
Semester or Year Abroad. Arrangements
have been made under which Augsburg
students may spend their sophomore or
junior year in study at a number of foreign
educational institutions. These institutions are the University of Oslo, Norway;
Schiller College in London and Heidelberg; Warnborough House College at
Oxford, England; the lnstituto Allende at
San Miguel de Allende in Mexico; the
lnstitute for American Universities at
Aix-en-Provence and Avignon i n France;
The Goethe lnstitute in Germany; the
University of Hamburg, Germany; the
University of Seville, Spain; and the University of Laval i n Quebec. I n addition,
through the Higher Education Consortium for Urban Affairs, Augsburgstudents
may take part in the Scandinavian Urban
Studies Term, and through the Experi-
ment in International Living, Augsburg
students are offered study programs i n
Columbia, Denmark, England, France,
Germany, Ghana, Greece, Guatemala,
India, Ireland, Italy, Japan, Nepal, Spain,
Taiwan, Turkey, and Yugoslavia. This type
of study must be approved before
departure by the Director of International
Programs, one's faculty adviser, and the
Committee on Admissions and Student
Standing. Credit earned through foreign
study may be applied to the student's
graduation requirements as electives, as
elements of the major sequence, or t o
satisfy some of the general education
requirements.
Summer School. Again there i s a wide
variety of possibilities for those who wish
to spend a summer studying abroad. Recently Augsburg students have spent
summers i n Norway, Spain, Mexico,
France, Greece, Germany, and England.
Those interested in further information
should contact the Director of International Programs.
gram. Classes are generally in the evening. Since continuing education courses
are offered o n a semester-hour basis, the
courses vary in length from four weeks t o
fourteen weeks. Students wishing t o
know more about Augsburg's continuing
education offerings should call or write
the Office ofthe Associate Dean of the
Faculty.
Interim. Study abroad during the interim
i s planned for each year. See listings
under the Augsburg Interim Catalog and
in the brochure on Interims Abroad
issued each spring for the following
January.
New Dimensions Program
Honors Program
Honors Program at Augsburg is designed to provide opportunities f o r
qualified students t o pursue an enriched
and sometimes accelerated course of
study. Special seminars, colloquia, honors
student forums and options in completing
the general education requirements are
all parts of the Honors Program. Inquiries
should be addressed to Dr. Carry Hesser,
Honors Director.
lnternship Program
The lnternship Program is a college-wide
program. It provides students in almost all
fields of study an opportunity to gain
practical on-the-job experience that can
be related to their academic program or
personal interests. Internships are available with a variety of companies,agencies
and community organizations.
Continuing Education Program
Augsburg College offers a number of
courses, both credit and non-credit,
through i t s Continuing Education Pro-
The New Dimensions Program i s for
adults who have not attended or who
have not graduated from college. The
program provides admissions counseling,
career guidance and planning, a simplified time-saving registration procedure,
on-the-job experience prior t o graduation, and, for those who desire it, a special
course to ease the transition to academic
life,
The transitional course, "The A d u l t
Student: Issues and Challenges," is offered several times a year. It includes selfassessment, testing, counseling, training
and practice in study skills, career exploration, and discussion of personal and
family problems arising from the return t o
schooll The course enables returning
adults t o get to know each other through
sharing experiences, problems, hopes
and aspirations.
For further information, contact the New
Dimensions Office at Augsburg.
Certification Programs
Special programs certifying skills and
knowledge have been established t o increase vocational possibilities and/or to
enhance personal growth. At the present
time, there are offerings in Art, Women's
Studies, and Church Staff Work.
Certification in Art requires eight courses,
one of which must be in art history.
Special professional or avocational concerns are addressed. See Art Department
Chairperson.
The Women's Studies Certificate may be
earned by completing six courses oriented towards women's perspectives. Each
individually planned program should include courses in the social sciences and
t h e humanities. Interested students
should contact Professor Toni Clark.
The Church Staff Worker Certification
Program i s designed t o help persons
prepare for full-time specialized lay work
in the Lutheran Church. It consists of a
"Church Staff Worker Major" in Religion
(9 courses) plus additional specialized
courses in departments such as psycholo-
gy, sociology, speech, and physical education. The program i s designed to meet
or exceed criteria used in the American
Lutheran Church in its certification program. See Religion Department Chairperson.
Degrees
Augsburg College offers the Bachelor of
Arts, the Bachelor of Music, and the
Bachelor of Science degrees. The degree,
Bachelor of S-cience, i s awarded t o
graduates with majors in Medical Technology, Music Therapy, Nursing, and
Social Work. Majors in Music may select
the program for either the Bachelor of
Arts or the Bachelor of Music degree.
Graduates with majors i n other fields
receive the Bachelor of Arts degree.
Student Life
Your experiences in the classroom are a
major aspect of your college life, but
learning and development also occur in
formal and informal activities and opportunities of the college and metropolitan
area. Whether you are a resident or commuter student, you'll find that the climate
for learning and living at Augsburg can
add dimension to your education.
Religious Life
An important part of daily life at Augsburg
is religious activity. The Religious Life
Commission, chaired by students and
composed of students and faculty, sees its
major responsibility in relation t o worship, devotional life and the stimulation of
faith. Chapel services are held three times
a week and are both experimental and
traditional in character. The Wednesday
evening Eucharist service in the College
Center is a valued worship experience for
many students. Students, faculty and staff
participate voluntarily. Special events are
sponsored throughout the year and a
number of groups having a religious
emphasis meet regularly. The College
Pastor has an office in the College Center
to be readily available for counseling,
consultation or ways to get more involved
in religious activity and groups.
Social and Cultural
Throughout the year, a variety of social
and cultural activities takes place on campus as well as in the Twin Cities. These
activities include dances, special dinners,
name entertainment, and visiting personalities in various fields.
The College Center is the focus of leisuretime activity on campus. Offices for the
College newspaper, the Augsburg Echo,
and the yearbook, the Augsburgian, are
on the lower level. Many of the clubs that
unite classroom or non-classroom related
interests meet in the Center.
There are several opportunities for participation in music and drama. In addition
to performing on campus and in the city,
the Augsburg Choir, Concert Band, and
Orchestra tour. The String Ensemble, the
Chorale, the Jazz Ensemble and several
student-organized groups such as the
Cabaret Singers also perform on and off
campus. Several plays are given o n
campus each year under the direction of
the theater arts department.
Recreation
Every student is urged t o participate in
some activity for recreation and relaxation. An intramural program provides
competition in a variety of team sports as
well as individual performance activities.
Broomball has been an especially popular
coed sport. Check schedules for times
when there i s open use of the gymnasium
and ice arena.
lntercollegiate Athletics
Augsburg is affiliated with the Minnesota
lntercollegiate Athletic Conference
(MIAC) and i s a member of the National
Association of lntercollegiate Athletics
(NAIA). The College annually competes
in ten sports, including football, soccer,
cross-country, basketball, hockey,
wrestling, baseball, track, tennis, and golf.
Augsburg is also a member of the Minnesota Women's lntercollegiate Athletic
Association (MWIAA) and the Association
for lntercollegiate Athletics for Women
(AIAW). The women annually compete i n
volleyball, cross country, gymnastics,
basketball, tennis, track & field, and
softball.
Student Services
Augsburg College i s concerned with educating the whole person and recognizes
that the context in which learning takes
place i s a critical factor in achieving optimal growth. Knowledge grows from more
than intellectual endeavors. Expanding
relationships, exploring values, identifying life styles, developing autonomy and
interdependence, finding purpose and
commitment - all combine with intellectual content and skills to produce the
desired educational impact of the college
on its students.
The Division of Student Affairs has been
created to support this task. During the
summer before your freshman year, or at
the time of transfer, you will receive a
copy of SEMAPHORE: Student Guide to a
College Education. This book will help
you assess the possibilities in your education, choices to make, directions to
consider and different destinations for
which t o plan. SEMAPHOREwas designed
to act as a sort of road map for you.
The Center for Student Development
provides a variety of services to help make
your journey as rich and meaningful as
possible. Some of the opportunities you
may wish to participate i n are listed
below.
Summer Orientation. You can plan your
first academic year and register for classes.
You and your parents get acquainted with
classmates, faculty, and staff as well as with
the campus. You stay in the dormitory,
attend events in the metropolitan area
and seek answers to the many questions
you have about college life.
Career Planning and Placement. You may
be uncertain about where you want to be
when you finish your undergraduate experience, whether your life style will be a
balanced one, how work will provide
opportunity for service and fulfillment.
Augsburg has a four-year career development plan to help you assess yourself,
explore possibilities, test realities and prepare for entry into the next phase of your
life. All new students will have a chance t o
review their interests with a counselor.
Human Development Seminars. A series
of informal "mini-courses" are offered
each year t o help you grow in understanding of yourself and your relationship
to others. Such topics as PEER (Positive
Educational Experiences i n Relationships), Issues i n Men's and Women's
Identity, Assertiveness, Job Seeking, and
Sexuality are available. Information on
current offerings and opportunity t o
register are provided several times during
the year.
Academic Enrichment. You may want t o
improve your skills i n such areas as
reading, studying, note-taking, and
testing by attending one or more of the
workships offered. You also will have an
opportunity t o meet with a counselor to
diagnose your needs. If a particular
course proves difficult, you can arrange
for tutoring through the Center.
Counseling and Guidance. Situations
occur for all of us where we can handle
challenges more effectively discussing
things with someone who has more expertise. Counselors are available to help
you think through how you can handle
major or minor problems i n a constructive
way. Consultation is provided on questions of policy and procedure.
Learning for Living. A series of miniclasses designed for the person who has a
desire t o explore new interests, enhance
leisure time, and meet others doing the
same. This i s a non-profit effort of the
Student Activities program.
Intercultural Center
As a college in the city, committed t o the
values and insights of cultural diversity,
Augsburg offers special advocacy and
counseling for all minority students in
close cooperation with administrators,
faculty and community. At the present
time these efforts concentrate in two
major areas:
American lndian Programs. Augsburg offers an American lndian student support
program to meet the special needs of
lndian students. The American lndian
Programs Counselor provides recruitment, courses, supportive services, community service and activities to improve
educational opportunities for American
Indians.
Black Student Programs. A counselor with
responsibilities i n recruitment, supportive services, community service and
activities coordinates black student activities. The Black Student Union (BSU) provides a focus for many activities and
programs.
The other facet of Augsburg's Intercultural Center focuses on students who are
from or are interested in studying in other
countries, and i n planning activities and
events which can increase intercultural
awareness of students, faculty and staff.
Foreign Study. If you are interested in
study abroad, consult the faculty member
who serves as Director of International
Programs to check on the many opportunities available.
lnternational Students. If you are a student from another country or would like
to be part of the activities of this group,
contact the faculty member who is appointed lnternational Student Advisor.
Residence Life
Because Augsburg recognizes that a student's ability to respond to the learning
environment depends, in part, upon his
or her living conditions, a variety of
housing alternatives is provided. The residence hall program is designed to promote student growth through relationships with other students and being an
active participant in group decisionmaking. Each residence unit has one or
more Resident Staff who are able to
facilitate the process of group living as
well as discuss personal concerns with
individual students.
All new freshmen and some upperclass
students live i n Urness Tower. This
eleven-story high-rise houses 324. Each
floor is considered a house unit providing
36 students, two to a room, with their own
lounge, study and utility areas.
Mortensen Tower, the newest residence
hall, is an alternative to traditional residence-hall living. It contains 104 one and
two-bedroom apartments t o accommodate 312 upperclass students.
West Hall contains 12 one-bedroom
apartments housing 24 upperclass
students.
Another alternative option i s Annex
Housing which provides a unique opportunity to try group living. Groups of
upperclass men or women share living
space, house responsibilities, and cooking.
Houses are located in the campus area.
One way to maximize the living-learning
aspects of your housing situation i s to avail
yourself of the opportunity to bid for a
house as a Special Interest House. Groups
of students have created exciting projects
by writing and implementing educational
impact proposals on such topics as
Environmental Concerns, Men's and
Women's Awareness, International Living,
Simplified Life Styles, and Scandinavian
Studies.
Married student housing is available in
annex housing and Kueffner Apartments.
All freshmen and sophomores not living
at home are required to live in collegeoperated housing.
Mortensen Tower i s carpeted, air conditioned, and contains kitchen units. It i s
otherwise unfurnished. In other residence halls or houses, rooms are furnished except for bed linens, towels,
blankets, and bedspreads. Laundry facilities are available in each residence.
Students engage a room at the beginning
of the fall term for the entire school year.
New students receive room assignments
during the summer before they enroll at
Augsburg. Upperclass students make
housing arrangements i n the spring. All
resident students must sign housing
contracts.
Freshmen and transfer students are urged
to make the tuition deposit by June 1 in
order to secure housing. Students who
deposit after June 1 will be provided
housing only if space i s available.
All students living on campus are required
to pay a $100 advance payment when they
sign the housing contract. The fee is
credited to the students' account when
they move into the residence.
Student Activities
A variety of interests are served by groups
and clubs and by events sponsored by the
student government. If you need information or wish to initiate a new group or
activity, contact the Student Activities
Director.
Advising
All members of the Augsburg faculty
serve as academic advisers. Advisers are
assigned on the basis of academic interests, and students are encouraged t o
establish close working relationships with
their adviser. Secondary Education students have available a second adviser, one
in the major and one i n the area of
education.
tures small table units for easy conversation and overlooks the College Quadrangle and Murphy Square. The portions
are generous and modestly priced.
Students on board plan who live i n residence halls eat t h e i r meals i n t h e
Commons.
The Chinwag, located on the ground floor
of the Center, features short orders and i s
open through the noon hour and i n the
evenings.
Augsburg provides a variety of board plan
options for those living i n College houses
or nearby apartments.
Student Government
Your health needs will be met by the staff
of Smiley's Point Clinic located on Riverside Avenue across the street from the
campus. Visits are free except for special
testing or service, and prescriptions are
available through the Fairview Pharmacy
at cost. Be sure to check your family
health coverage t o determine if you are
included; if not, a student health insurance plan is available.
Student government i s t h e vehicle
through which students can secure a
closer relationship and better understanding with the administration and
faculty, and provide better input into the
decision-making process at Augsburg.
Student government also sponsors and
directs student activities, protects student
rights, and provides the means for discussions and action on all issues pert a i n i n g t o student l i f e at Augsburg.
Student government i s organized into the
executive branch, the legislative branch,
and the judicial branch. Elections are
held in the spring except for freshmen
who elect their representatives in the fall
of their first year. Many kinds of involvement are possible from program planning
to writing or editing to service opportunities. If you want t o get involved,
contact the President or Vice President i n
their offices in the College Center.
Food Service
Student Rights
The Commons, situated on the top floor
The College has adopted a statement of
student rights and responsibilities and
has provided for due process in matters of
Student Financial Services
You may wish to contact this office for
information o n types of assistance available and for answers t o questions about
deadlines and procedures. Work opportunities both on and off campus are also
recorded. If you have financial problems,
this is a good place to work them out.
Health Service
of the College Center i s the main foodservice facility. This pleasant room fea-
disciplinary action and grade appeal. The
judicial Council is elected by student and
faculty and serves t o conduct hearings
and review matters of concern. Any
student who wishes to identify appropriate procedures for complaint should
contact the Vice President for Student
Affairs.
The College operates i n compliance with
the Family Rights and Privacy Act and Title
IX. Students have the right to inspect all
official records, files and data which pertain to them and which are maintained in
the office of the registrar and the place-
ment office and t o challenge inaccurate
or misleading information. Exceptions are
parents' financial records and confidential letters and statements placed in
the record before January 1, 1975, or
placed under conditions where students
have signed a waiver of right of access.
Students have the right to experience
education free from discrimination based
on sex, race, ethnic, or cultural background, creed, marital status or age.
Persons seeking additional information
on these topics should contact the Center
for Student Development.
Admission t o the College
Applying for admission to Augsburg College is a simple procedure. Each application is reviewed by the Admissions
Office and students are accepted on the
basis of high school performance, promise
of Success i n college as shown by college
entrance examination scores, other motivational factors, and personal
recommendations.
1973 as amended in its admission policies,
educational programs, activities and
employment practices.
It is the policy of Augsburg College not to
discriminate on the basis of race, creed,
national or ethnic origin, age, marital
status, sex or handicap as required by Title
IX of the 1972 Educational Amendments
or Section 504 of the Rehabilitation Act of
The ~ ~ ~ Process
l i ~
for ~~~~h~~~
A ,isit to the campus is highly recomare availmended: admissionscounse~ors
abletohelpyou,answeryourquestions,
and arrange for you to see the campus.
~
1. From the Admissions Office secure an
official application for admission and
complete it.
t
2. Hand the completed application to
your high school counselor, along with
the $10.00 application fee, and ask that
these be sent with your official high
school transcript to:
Admissions Office
Augsburg College
731 21st Ave. South
Minneapolis, M N 55454
3. Submit scores from the SAT or ACT or
PSAT. The College recommends that candidates sit for the examination as early as
possible during the senior year. Your high
school counselor can tell you when these
tests are scheduled in your area.
4. Admissions to the College are made on
a "rolling" basis: soon after an application
file is complete, a decision will be made
and the student notified. A non-refundable $50.00 tuition deposit i s required by
April 1 after acceptance has been made
and/or financial aid (if applied for) has
been awarded.
5. After the deposit has been made, the
student must complete a medical data
form, which will be sent by the College.
6. Room assignments for those who have
requested to live on campus. and matriculation information will be mailed to the
student during the summer.
Transfer
Students are accepted by transfer from
other colleges and universities on the
basis of their academic record. College
credit is granted for liberal arts courses
satisfactorily completed at accredited
institutions. The College reserves the
right not to grant credit for courseswhere
it considers the work unsatisfactory, and
to grant provisional credit for work taken
at unaccredited institutions.
The grade average for graduation is based
on work taken at Augsburg only.
Transfer students with the A.A. degree are
considered as having met all general education requirements at Augsburg except
for two courses in religious studies.
Registered Nurse Students seeking a
Bachelor of Science degree in Nursing
must-also complete the Department of
Nursing entrance tests.
The Application Process For
Transfer Students
1. From the Admissions Office, secure
and complete, an official application for
admission. This should be sent to the
Admissions Office with a $10.00 application fee.
2. Request official transcripts from all
colleges or universities attended to be
sent directly to:
Admissions Office
Augsburg College
731 21st Ave. South
Minneapolis, M N 55454
3. Admissions to the College are made on
a "rolling" basis: soon after an application
file i s complete, a decision will be made
and the student notified. A non-refundable $50.00 tuition deposit is requested
within one month after acceptance has
been made and/or financial aid (if applied
for) has been awarded.
4. After a deposit has been made, the
student will be requested to complete a
medical data form, which will be sent by
the College.
5. Room assignments for those who have
requested to live on campus and matriculation information will be mailed during
the summer.
The Application Process For
Returning and Special
(Non-degree) Students
1. Obtain an application form from the
Office of the Registrar.
2. Request that official transcripts from all
colleges or universities attended be sent
directly to:
Registrar's Office
Augsburg College
731 21st Ave. South
Minneapolis, Minn. 55454
(Returning students need t o have sent
only the transcripts of colleges attended
since the last enrollment at Augsburg.)
4. Room assignments for those who have
requested to live on campus will be made
i n the housing office.
Foreign Student Admission
Citizens of other countries are welcomed
at Augsburg College. A foreign student
adviser i s available to help them i n the
transition to college and t o the United
States. Admission is based upon performance i n secondary school and previous
college work, if any. Evidence of proficiency in English and satisfactory financial
sponsorship i s required. A very limited
number of scholarships i s available.
Medical insurance i s required of all nonimmigrant foreign students attending
Augsburg. I f they have an internationally
valid health insurance policy, a copy of
the policy is required.
For application forms and further information, write to the Office of Admissions.
Early Decision
An Early Decision Program i s offered for
students who select Augsburg as their first
college choice and who will accept an
offer of admission if it is extended. An
Early Decision candidate must apply by
November 15 of the senior year and will
receive the admission decision about
December 1. The admissions decision is
based upon the academic record through
the junior year, test scores and recommendations.
Early Decision candidates applying for
financial aid are encouraged t o complete
the Augsburg Early Decision Financial Aid
Application, which enables our Financial
A i d Office t o compute a preliminary
award. Candidates will be notified of their
award by January 1.
After notification of admission and financial aid, if needed, the student is encouraged t o withdraw applications t o
other colleges.
A $50.00 nonrefundable tuition deposit i s
required by January 1 or within 15 days of
financial aid notification.
Early Admission
An Early Admission Program is offered for
a few high school juniors. To apply for
Early Admission, a student must have a
high academic record and test scores,
recommendation from the high school
and the maturity t o cope with a college
course after the junior year i n high school.
Also, it i s recommended that the student
complete the requirements for a high
school diploma during the summer or
during the first year of college. A student
applying for Early Admission can take the
Scholastic Aptitude Test in January or
March of the junior year.
Project Ahead
months of financial assistance under the
G.I. Bill.
A cooperative program between Augsburg College and the United States Army
makes provision for an individualized
plan of education. A prospective student
who qualifies for the program may choose
Augsburg as a home school and carry on a
pre-planned course of study at other
colleges while i n the Army. An adviser at
Augsburg Gsists the student in the selection of courses which will transfer and
apply toward graduation when the student matriculates at Augsburg. A registration fee of $100 is charged. This fee will
apply toward the student's tuition, provided he or she matriculates as a full-time
student at Augsburg College within five
years from initial registration with the
college in Project Ahead.
The Army provides up to 75% of the
tuition for courses under Project Ahead.
After enlistment, when the student enrolls at Augsburg, the Army provides 36
Advanced Placement
Advanced placement is granted t o students who qualify, on the basis of work
taken in high school or elsewhere, to
enroll in courses beyond the beginning
level. Placement may be determined by
tests, or by the level and length of the
study previously completed.
Advanced Standing
College credit i s granted to high school
students who have successfully completed
a college level course and who have
scored high on the Advanced Placement
Examinations. Augsburg will also award
credit on the basis of scores received on
the College Level Examination Program
(CLEP) offered by the College Entrance
Examination Board. Requests for detailed
information may be addressed to the
Registrar at Augsburg.
Financial Aid
About 85% of all Augsburg students receive financial assistance from the college
t h r o u g h some f o r m o f scholarships,
grants, loans, campus employment, or a
c o m b i n a t i o n o f these. Assistance i s
awarded on the basis of financial need
and academic record. Application for aid
i s made by completing the Family Financial Statement (FFS) of the American College Testing Program. While Augsburg
College prefers the FFS, which is required
for students applying t o the Minnesota
State Scholarship and Grant Program, students may instead submit the Financial
Aid Form (FAF)of the College Scholarship
Service. Upperclass students must also
complete the Augsburg Application for
Financial Aid.
For the academic year 1978-79, approximately 85% of the students at Augsburg
received scholarships, grants, or loans
totaling over $3,900,000 from Augsburg
and all other sources.
Augsburg participates i n the Minnesota
State Scholarship and Grant Program t o
which all Minnesota residents are expected t o apply, and the following federal
programs: Supplementary Educational
Opportunity Grant, Basic Opportunity
Grant, National Direct Student Loan, College Work-Study and Guaranteed Student Loan. Both on-campus and offcampus w o r k opportunities are also
available. Applications for financial aid
received by April 1 will be considered
first. For further information, contact the
Office of Student Financial Services at
Augsburg.
PREPARING A BUDGET
Writing down realistic estimates of all
expenses and of all potential financial
resources i s the best way to do your
financial planning. Both your own financial ability and that of your family are
considered in evaluating your need for
financial aid. Your budget should include
amounts for tuition and fees and for
books and supplies. Tuition and fees for
1980-81 are $3660 per year. Books and
supplies may be estimated at $225 per
year. Room and board i s $1760 per year.
Other college-related expenses are those
for transportation to and from the campus. Estimates should be based on nine
months.
Personal maintenance costs vary, but
amounts should be budgeted for:
Clothing, cleaning
Recreation, entertainment
Personal spending, cosmetics,
incidentals
Medical (doctors, dentists, eyeglasses,
etc.)
After you have written down estimates of
your expenses, make a list of all possible
sources of income, such as: contributions
from parents' earnings; personal and
family savings; personal earnings during
vacation periods; earnings from part-time
jobs during academic year; benefits from
Social Security and/or Veteran's Administration; aids or loans from sources other
than family, friends or Augsburg (i.e.,
scholarships from state, church, civic and
school).
Students should check with their employers, their parents' employers and any
union t o which a family member belongs
for possible scholarship programs. High
school guidance counselors may have
information about student aid offered by
church, civic, professional, or fraternal
organizations i n a given locality. Following
you will find a summary of financial aid
programs.
Information on a deferred payment plan
i s available from the Augsburg College
Office of Student Financial Services.
OTHER SOURCES OF FINANCIAL AID
Basic Educational Opportunity Grant
(BEOG)
For students with proven financial
need. Available t o full-time and parttime students. Up to $1800 per year
depending on the institutional costs
and the student's eligibility. Obtain
application from high school guidance
office or college financial aid office.
Veteran's Administration Benefits/
G.I. Bill
Veterans, widows of veterans, and children of disabled or deceased veterans
may qualify f o r special benefits.
Amount is dependent upon eligibility
as d e t e r m i n e d by t h e Veteran's
Administration. To apply, contact the
Federal Veteran's A d m i n i s t r a t i o n
Office in your area.
Social Security Benefits
For unmarried full-time students if one
parent (covered by Social Security) i s
retired, deceased or disabled. Amount
i s dependent upon eligibility as determined by the Social Security Administration. To apply, contact the Federal
Social Security Administration Office
in your area.
Vocational Rehabilitation
Students with certain physical or emot i o n a l disabilities may qualify f o r
special assistance. A m o u n t is d e pendent upon eligibility as determined by the Vocational Rehabilitation
Office. To apply, contact your local
Vocational Rehabilitation Office.
National Scholarship and Grant Program
for Minority Students (sponsored by the
American Lutheran Church)
For members of American racial and
ethnic minorities and other eligible
groups who are either seeking admission t o an American Lutheran Church
(ALC) college or are members of an
ALC congregation. Up to $1000 per
year. Renewable.
American lndian Scholarships
American lndian students who meet
federal and state requirements may
apply for Bureau of lndian Affairs,
Tribal and/or lndian State Scholarship
monies. lndian grants are supplemental
to all other sources of financial aids. For
assistance in application, contact the
American lndian Programs Counselor.
Guaranteed Student Loans/Minnesota
State Student Loan
For students carrying at least one-half
the normal full-time academic load, the
Federal Government pays the full interest on the loan while thestudent is in
college. When repayment begins, the
student pays the full 7% interest. The
maximum loan is $2500 per year or the
cost of education, whichever is less. The
aggregate maximum i s $7500.
Loan applications are available at the
College, at some banks, and from
Minnesota State Student Loan Office.
PROGRAMS ADMINISTERED BY THE
MINNESOTA HIGHER EDUCATION
COORDINATING BOARD
Minnesota State Scholarship
Awarded to Minnesota residents o n
the basis of scholastic achievement and
need. High School seniors who are
Minnesota residents are expected t o
apply. Range: $100 t o $1250; but shall
not exceed one half of the applicant's
demonstrated financial need.
for twelve months prior to the deadline date may apply.
Awarded to Minnesota residents on
the basis of evident need. High school
seniors and community/junior college
transfer students who are Minnesota
residents are expected t o apply.
Applications for the Minnesota State
Scholarship/Grant will be mailed t o all
Minnesota high school seniors. If you
do not receive an application by December 30, contact your high school
guidance counselor or the college
financial aid office.
In addition, persons who have not
attended a post-secondary institution
Return completed application and FFS
t o The American College Testing Pro-
Minnesota State Grant-in-Aid
gram, Financial Aid Operations, P.O.
Box 1000, lowa City, lowa 52240.
Be sure to list Augsburg College (Code
2080) and the Minnesota State Scholarship/Grant Program (Code 6500) t o
receive the FFS analysis.
NOTE: Unsuccessful Scholarship applications are automatically c o n sidered for the State Grant.
DEADLINE: March 1.
FINANCIAL AID PROGRAMS
ADMINISTERED THROUGH THE
COLLEGE
Honor Scholarships
For entering freshman students ranking i n the top 15% of their high school
class with above average aptitude test
scores.
Up t o full tuition per year. Available
for a maximum of 4 years based on 2.5
cumulative grade-point average and
continued financial need.
Academic Grants
For entering freshman students who
have shown academic potential and
have financial need.
Up t o full tuition per year. Available for
a maximum of 4 years based o n 2.0
cumulative grade-point average and
continued financial need.
Federal Supplementary Educational
Opportunity Grants (SEOG)
For students having exceptional financial need who could not otherwise
attend college, and who carry at least
one-half the normal academic load.
Range $200 t o $1500 per year. Renewable for 3 years. Will be matched
by other financial assistance such as
loans, scholarships, employment.
National Direct Student Loans (NDSL)
For students with proven financial
need and who carry at least one-half
the normal academic load.
Averages approximately $1000 per
year. Can be reapplied for each year
although renewal i s not guaranteed.
College Work Study Program
For students with proven financial
need and who carry at least one-half
the normal academic load.
A maximum of 15 hours of on-campus
employment per week is recommended.
Augsburg Opportunity Grant
For any graduate of a Minnesota Junior
College entering Augsburg for further
full-time study and with proven financial need.
Range from $100 to $1000. Renewable
for a second year.
How to Apply
1. Apply for admission; for new students this application i s also the
financial aid application.
2. Obtain a Family Financial Statement
(FFS) from high school counselor or
Augsburg College Financial Aid
Office*
3. Complete and return the FFS to:
American College Testing Program
Financial Aid Operations
P.O. Box 1000
lowa City, lowa 52240
Request that a copy be sent t o Augsburg College. Augsburg's ACT code
number i s 2080. Financial statements
received by April 1 will be considered
first.
*Although Augsburg prefers the FFS,
the College will accept the Financial
Aid Form FAF) of the College Scholarship Service. Augsburg's CSS code
number i s 6014.
SPECIAL SCHOLARSHIPS
Available t o upperclassmen (Soph, Jr, Sr,
next year). Descriptions of awards are
copied verbatim from statements of the
donors' wishes.
GENERAL SCHOLARSHIPS
Winners selected by Student Personnel
Committee:
1. The Eleanor Christensen Edwards
Memorial Scholarship - established
in 1978 for upperclass students preparing for a career in medicine or
health.
2. The Alma Jensen Dickerson Memorial
Scholarship - awarded annually t o
two deserving junior/senior students
as recommended by the committee.
3. The Elias B. Eliason, Sr. M e m o r i a l
Scholarship -established in 1979 by his
family. One or more scholarships will
be awarded annually t o needy and
deserving upperclass students.
4. The O l i v e r M. a n d Alma Jensen
Dickerson Memorial Scholarship - awarded annually t o two deserving
junior/ senior students.
5. T h e M.J. Estrem Scholarship awarded annually t o a worthy student
of the College selected by the scholarship committee.
6. The Catha Jones Memorial Scholarships - awarded annually to female
students transferring from Waldorf
College. Preference given to those in
music and/or elementary education.
7. Memorial Scholarship -awarded annually to an able and deserving upperclass student as recommended by the
scholarship committee.
8. Minnesota M i n i n g & Manufacturing
Scholarships - established i n 1972 t o
be distributed by the scholarship committee t o needy students.
9. The Rev. Horace E. Nyhus Memorial
Scholarship - awarded annually to a
deserving senior.
10. Douglas Ollila Memorial Scholarship
- $250 awarded to a senior.
11. The Quanbeck Scholarship Fund established in 1963 by a bequest of John
G. Quanbeck, awarded annually t o
freshmen students who without assistance would be unable t o pursue higher
education.
12. The Reader's Digest Endowed Scholships - awarded t o able and
deserving upperclassmen.
13. The Johan H.O. Rodvik Memorial
Scholarship - distributed annually t o
needy and deserving students preparing for a career in professional Christian
service.
14. The Tozer Foundation Scholarships up t o $1000 each - awarded o n the
basis of scholarship, personality, and
need. Winners must be junior or
senior students who are residents of
the State of Minnesota but not residents of Pine, Kanabecor Washington
Counties. Separate application required of semi- finalists selected by
the scholarship committee. FFS must
be sent t o Tozer Foundation (code
6577)
15. The Edward Yokie Memorial Scholarship - awarded t o an able and
deserving junior or senior student.
SPECIAL SCHOLARSHIPS
Winners selected by Student Personnel
Committee
1. A i d Association f o r Lutherans awarded to able and deserving upperclass students who are policy holders
with Aid Association for Lutherans Insurance Company.
2. M i l d r e d Ryan Cleveland M e m o r i a l
Scholarship - awarded annually t o
able and deserving students, who have
physical disabilities and have demontrated financial need.
MINORITY STUDENT SCHOLARSHIPS
Winners selected by Student Personnel
Committee:
1. A i d Association for Lutherans M i n o r i t y
Scholarship P r o g r a m - awarded
annually t o Lutheran American minority students who show financial need.
2. Minnesota M i n i n g & Manufacturing
M i n o r i t y Student Scholarship - established i n 1973 to be awarded to a Black
student.
3. T h e M a r l y s J o h n s o n S i m e n g a a r d
Memorial Scholarship - Awarded
periodically t o a Black American
student.
4. National Scholarship & Grant Program
for M i n o r i t y Students -sponsored by
the American Lutheran Church (ALC).
Awarded annually to membersof racial
and ethnic minorities.
5. The Marilyn Petersen Memorial Scholarships awarded annually t o upperclass
Oriental students.
6. Homecoming Auction Scholarship awarded annually to two minority students by contributions from faculty,
administration. staff and students at
the Homecoming auction.
RELIGION & CHRISTIAN SERVICE
SCHOLARSHIPS
Winners selected by Student Personnel
Committee:
1. The Thorvald Olsen Burntvedt M e m o rial Scholarship - awarded annually to
a student(s) in the senior class who is
preparing for the ministry.
2. The lver and Marie lverson Scholarship
- awarded on the basis of need, character and interest i n Christian service.
3. The Reverend Olaf Rogne Memorial
Scholarship - awarded on the basis of
need, scholarship and interest i n
Christian service.
4. The Morris C.C. and Hanna Vaagenes
Missionary Scholarship F u n d awarded t o a junior/senior student
preparing for service as a missionary
through the World Missions Depart-
ment of the American Lutheran
Church.
5. Onesimus Scholarship - awarded
periodically to students preparing for
the Christian ministry.
6. The Marguerite Hamilton Storley
Memorial Scholarship - awarded
annually t o an able and deserving
juniorhenior student recommended
by the scholarship committee. Semifinalists are interviewed and selected
by donor.
7. Cerda Mortensen Memorial Scholarship - Winners are selected on the
basis of scholarship, characteristics of
service and devotion t o the Christian
faith.
DEPARTMENTAL SCHOLARSHIPS
ART
- winners
selected by Art faculty.
Crown Princess Sonja Art Scholarship established by the Crown Princess of
Norway to be awarded annually to a
talented art student with financial need.
ATHLETIC - winners recommended by
Physical Education faculty to the Student
Personnel Committee.
3. The Magnus A. Kleven Family Scholarship - awarded annually t o a male
student on basis of achievement, personal character, and promise i n field of
physical education.
4. The JamesWinkler Memorial Scholarship - awarded annually t o a male
student on basis of personality, character, athletic ability and academic
achievement.
5. The Peterson Football Scholarship awarded t o a freshman football player
on basis of financial need.
6. The Sandbo Football Scholarship awarded t o a football player on basis of
financial need.
7. Keith Hoffman Memorial Scholarship
- awarded t o a student because of his
academic achievement, personal character, and ability in field of athletics.
8. David Cronner Memorial Scholarship
Fund - awarded t o two or more students participating in athletics or music.
The award is "made t o students who
have demonstrated financial need"
and/or "of high Christian character".
The athletic scholarship i s for a male
candidate only, with a preference for
basketball.
1. The Paul Dahlen Memorial Scholarship
- awarded annually to an able and
deserving male student on basis of
Christian purpose, athletic and academic achievement.
BIOLOGY - Winners selected by the
Biology Department faculty.
2. The Paul Dahlen - Gerald Pryd
Memorial Scholarship - awarded
annually t o a male student or students
on basis of personality, character,
athletic and academic achievement.
Biology Scholarships - established in
1972 by the faculty of the Biology Department to honor outstanding students who
intend to major in Biology, Natural Science
or Medical Technology.
BUSINESS - Winners recommended by
the Business Administration faculty to the
Student Personnel Committee.
1. The Gamble-Skogmo Foundation
Scholarship - awarded t o one or more
upperclass students interested i n the
field of business.
2. The Reid Scholarship - awarded t o
one or more upperclass students who
are interested i n business and/or
education.
CHEMISTRY - Winners selected by the
Chemistry faculty.
Awarded t o students whose academic
record indicates promise of achievement
in the field of Chemistry.
ENGLISH - Winners selected by English
faculty.
1. Anne Pederson English Scholarship awarded annually t o junior/senior students who are majoring in English with
preference given to those who plan t o
teach English as a career.
2. Professor P. A. Sveeggen Memorial
Scholarship -awarded t o an outstanding student i n the field of English.
HISTORY
faculty.
- Winners selected by History
The H. N. Hendrickson History Scholarship - awarded annually to students
majoring i n history with preference
given t o those who plan a career in the
field.
1. The Manivald Aldre Memorial Chem-
istry Scholarship.
2. The Carl Fosse Memorial Chemistry
Scholarship.
3. The Frederick C. and Laura E. Mortensen Chemistry Scholarship.
4. The Dr. W.M. Sandstrom Chemistry
Scholarship.
5. The Walter Gordon Schell Memorial
Chemistry Scholarship.
6. The Walter E. Thwaite, Jr. Memorial
Chemistry Scholarship.
7. The Covey Hendrickson Memorial
Chemistry Scholarship.
EDUCATION - Winners selected by
Education faculty.
The David Mathre Scholarship -awarded
t o qualified full-time students in need of
financial assistance during the term in
which they are student teaching.
LIBRARY SCIENCE - Winnersselected by
Library staff.
1. The Library Science Scholarship established in 1971 to honor one or
more outstanding student(s) choosing
librarianship as a career.
MATHEMATICS - Winners r e c o m mended by Mathematics faculty t o the
Student Personnel Committee.
1. Minnesota Gas Company Scholarship
- generally awarded t o able and deserving juniorhenior students majoring in mathematics or the sciences on
basis of need and academic ability.
2. Mathematics Scholarship - awarded
to an able and deserving student in the
field of mathematics.
MODERN LANGUAGE - Winners selecte d by M o d e r n Language faculty.
1. The Mimi Baez Kingsley Modern Language Scholarship - awarded annually
t o juniorhenior students who are
majoring in a modern language with
preference given t o those who plan t o
teach language as a career.
2. Foreign Travel Scholarship - available
to language majors studying a language
abroad during the academic year, t o
help with travel expenses. A special
application i s required by the Foreign
Language Department.
MUSIC
faculty.
-
5. The Leonard and Sylvia Kuschel
Scholarship - awarded t o upperclass
students seeking t o acquire musical
and performance skills i n instrumental
music with preference given to those
candidates who have shown proficiency in keyboard instruments.
6. David Cronner Memorial Scholarship
Fund - awarded t o two or more students participating in athletics or music.
The award i s "made t o students who
have demonstrated financial need"
and/or "of high Christian character."
7. Peggy Christensen Benson Memorial
Scholarship - awarded annually t o a
student studying choral music.
Winners selected by Music
1. 0.1. Hertsgaard Scholarship awarded annually to junior/senior students who have demonstrated proficiency i n choral and/or instrumental
music, who show interest or potential
in conduaing and who show promise
of overall academic success.
2. The Henry P. Opseth Music Scholarship -awarded tOaso~homore/junior
student of outstanding promise in the
field of music.
3- The
solberg
SchO1arshi~
- awarded to an Augsburg student
who has music as a maior/minor and
who shows outstanding promise for
achievement i n the art of singing.
NURSING -winners
faculty.
selected by Nursing
Donna Henke Hendershot Memorial
-awardedtoagraduateof
the Abbott Northwestern School of
Nursing enrolled in the Upper Division
Nursing Program at Augsburg.
PHYSICS - Winners selected by Physics
faculty,
The Theodore J.Hanwick Scholarship awarded annually
to an upperc~ass
stu-
dent majoring in
SOCIOLOGY
4. The lngaborg C. Christenson Scholarship - awarded to a student on the
basis of skilled performance or aptitude
in stringed instruments.
Adolph Paulson Memorial Prize awarded annually to a student in the
general field of Christian Sociology.
Expenses
Costs listed here are for the 1980-81
academic year, and are subject to change
without notice.
T U I T I O N - $3,660
This full-time rate applies to new freshmen, transfer or returning students (not
on a prior year guarantee plan) entering
the academic year beginning September,
1980. Students are considered full-time
when they take three or more courses
during the semester terms for a total of
seven courses in the year.
Under the 4-1-4 calendar, the student
must register for the semester periods. If
the student elects to omit an interim or to
graduate in December, a refund is not
authorized.
A part-time rate of $510 per course is
charged the student taking less than three
courses i n a semester or registering for an
interim course only.
Full-time students may audit a course
without charge. For part-time students,
the charge for auditing is one half the
part-time rate per course. Part-time
students who take Lifetime Sports are
charged the audit rate for that course.
SPECIAL FEES - N O T REFUNDABLE
Students enrolled in the music therapy
program will arrange their internship
with Music Department faculty. The
charge for this one-course credit is $510.
Fee for change in registration after the
first three days of classes i s $2.00 for each
course cancelled or added. Late registration fee after classes begin is $5.00 per day.
SPECIAL COURSE FEES - N O T
REFUNDABLE
Cinema Arts, $35
Computer Science, $30 per course
Student Teaching, $35
Film Making, $90
Life Drawing, $20
Stagecraft, $30
Psychology of Music, $10
Nursing Admission Test, $20
Study Abroad - See Study Abroad
Adviser.
Music lessons i n addition to tuition are
$140 a semester (14 lessons), or $10.00
per lesson during Interim.
Class piano lessons, $70 per term
Practice Studio rental for each semester
for one hour a day, $35.00 ($15.00 an
interim).
Band - Orchestra instrument rental
$30.00 a semester.
An application fee of $10.00 i s required
from all new students.
Nursing students are required to have a
name pin, available at cost through the
Department of Nursing.
A registration fee for students studying
abroad on approved non-Augsburg programs i s $125.00.
OTHER COSTS
Seniors enrolled in the Medical Technology program at one of the hospitals
must register at Augsburg. The charge is
$510.00.
Transcript fee: first copy free; additional
copy, $1.00.
Locker rental for commuter students:
$5.00
Arrangements for special examinations
are made in the Registrar's Office with
charges according t o the schedule on file.
Books and supplies are available from the
Bookstore o n a cash or charge account
basis.
BOARD A N D R O O M
Full Board and Room
- $1,760.
Other plans are available as defined in the
Room and Board Contract Booklet at the
Office of Auxiliary Services.
I n the event of excessive increases i n the
cost of operation, these board rates may
be increased at any time before or during
the contract year.
Linen service i s available in residence halls
on a direct contract basis from a local
linen supply company.
R O O M RESERVATION DEPOSIT - All
resident students: $100.00 advance deposit required at time of signing a contract to reserve a housing assignment for
the t e r m beginning in S e p t e m b e r .
charge. New 'OnApplied to the
tracts may be terminated for Fall or
Spring term by notifying the Office of
student Life in writing by the first day of
registration. The resident will be responsible for all costs incurred due to late
cancellation or lack of proper
notifica. .
tion. If the new contract i s cancelled prior
to
(Fall semester) or
(Spring semester), $35.00 will be forfeited
from the $100 advance payment
as a
.
.
service charge. If the new contract is
cancelled after July or January
the
entire amount will be forfeited.
BREAKAGE A N D FINE DEPOSIT - All
students at registration: $25.00. Refundable upon graduation, transfer to another
institution, or discontinuing education
program at Augsburg.
1979-80 COST SUMMARY
Settlement of Account
Application Fee - $10.00
A statement of estimated charges for the
year will be prepared and forwarded t o
the student early i n August. Payment of
the first half-year billing period i s due
August 20, and the second half-year isdue
January 20. Variation from this schedule
must be arranged with the Office of
Student Financial Services prior to August
Tuition - $3,660
Board and Room
- $1,760
Breakage and Fine Deposit - $25.00
(Refunded o n termination o f studies at
Augsburg)
Deposits
T U I T I O N DEPOSIT - New students,
$50.00 (not refundable). Required of
students whose application for admission
has been accepted; to be paid by April 15,
1979. (Payment is due February 1 under
Early Decision Program). The deposit is
applied to the tuition charge.
No student is permitted to register if hisor
her account for a preceding term has not
been paid in full.
A student cancelling part or all of his/her
registration and/or being released from
his/her housing contract will be refunded
charges for tuition and room except for
the minimum deduction of $100 of feesto
cover administrative costs according to
the following schedule:
100% through the first five daysof classes.
90% from the sixth day through the
tenth day of classes.
80% from the eleventh day through the
fifteenth day of classes.
70% from the sixteenth day through
the twentieth day of classes.
60% from the twenty-first day through
the twenty-fifth day of classes.
50% from the twenty-sixth day through
the middle of the term.
No refund will be made after the middle
of the term.
Should a student be forced to cancel his/
her registration during the first one-half
of the term due to illness or accident,
upon submission of a report from the
attending physician stating the inability or
inadvisability of continued matriculation,
the charges will be reduced by one-half.
In all cases board refunds a r e made on a
proportionate basis.
All refunds of charges will beapplied back
to the account of the student and all
adjustments for aid, loans, fines and
deposits, etc. shall be gathered in the
student's account before eligibility for a
cash refund shall be determined.
Academic Administration
Students who enroll at Augsburg College
are encouraged to plan their own course
of study with the help of faculty
advisers
who are readily availablefor consultat;on
and guidance. A well-planned program of
liberal arts studieswillinclude courses in
the humanities, the natural sciences, and
the social sciences.
Augsburg graduates are expected t o be
able to write effectively; they are also
expected to be knowledgeable about
urban concerns and have some understanding of cultures outside the United
States.
The general recreational activities courses
at Augsburg are designed to acquaint
students with and t o equip students for
lifetime sports.
Courses in religion are intended to assist
students i n their reflection on the meaning of the Christian Church through the
study of its beliefs, its scripture, and its
mission.
Augsburg College offers the Bachelor of
Arts degree, the degree of Bachelor of
Music, and the Bachelor of Science degree. The degree, Bachelor of Science, is
awarded to graduates with majors in Medical Technology, Music Therapy, Nursing
and Social Work. Students who enter the
nursing program with a Bachelor of Arts
degree and who wish t o earn a Bachelor
of Science degree should contact the
Office of the Registrar for information on
the specific requirements for a second
bachelor's degree. Majors in Music may
select the program for either the Bachelor
of Arts or the Bachelor of Music degree.
Graduates with majors i n other fields
receive the Bachelor of Arts degree.
Divisional Organization
The college curriculum is organized into
four divisions in order to make interdepartmental coordination more convenient and cooperative aims more easily
achieved. A chairperson for each division
is elected for a two-year term.
Major and minor requirements are indicated i n the departmental statements in
the course listing section.
NATURAL SCIENCE A N D
MATHEMATICS
Chairperson:
Earl R. Alton
Department
Department
Department
Department
Biology
Chemistry
Mathematics
Physics
of
of
of
of
SOCIAL A N D BEHAVIORAL SCIENCES
Chairperson: Myles Stenshoel
Department of Business Administration,
Business Education, and Economics
Department of History
Department of Political Science
Department of Psychology
Department of Sociology
PROFESSIONAL STUDIES
Chairperson:
Marie 0. NcNeff
Department of Education: Elementary
Education, Geography, Library Science,
Secondary .Education
Department of Physical Education and
Health Education
Department of Music
Department of Nursing
Department of Social Work
HUMANITIES
Chairperson: Eugene Skibbe
Department of Art
Department of English
D e p a r t m e n t o f Foreign Languages:
Chinese, French, German, Greek,
Japanese, Linguistics, Norwegian,
Russian, Spanish
Department of Philosophy
Department of Religion
Department of speech, Communication
and Theater Arts
Minimum Graduation
Requirements Include the
Following:
1. A total of 35 courses of which 11 must
be upper division (numbered in the
300s and 400s) and not more than 13 in
one department, except in certain approved majors for the Bachelor of
Science/Arts degree and 17 for these
degrees: Bachelor of Music, Bachelor
of Science i n Music Therapy, and
Bachelor of Science in Nursing.
No more than these maximums may be
the 35
'Ourses
required: CHR
courses
independent study or directed study or
a combination of directed and independent study, 4 courses of internship
and 8 courses with a grade of P (two in
the major except Elementary Education
and one in the minor if approved by the
department chairperson).
Students who enter the nursing program with a B.A. degree and who wish
t o earn a B.S. degree should contact
the Office of the Registrar for specific
requirements for a second bachelor's
degree.
For transfer students, the maximum in
the areas listed in the paragraph above
is an average of two courses per year of
attendance at Augsburg.
2. Completion of a major. Requirements
for each major are listed under departmental headings.
3. A grade point average of 2.0 in all
courses taken and in courses which
apply toward the major (except for
Elementary Education and Nursing,
where 2.5 averages are required).
4. The last year of full-time study at Augsburg College.
5. Three interim courses. For transfer
students, the number o f i n t e r i m
courses is one less than the number of
years at Augsburg.
6. The responsibility for seeing that all
degree requirements are satisfied rests
with the student. Academic advisers,
department chairpersons, the Academic Dean and the Registrar are available for counsel and assistance in program planning.
7. Each student must apply for graduation
at the time specified by the Registrar.
Application forms are availableinthe
Registrar's Office.
8. All degree and course requirements
must be completed prior to the anticipated date of graduation (i.e., there
may be no incompletes or open courses
on the academic record).
9. Satisfactory completion of distribution
requirements as follows:
A. A course in writing (EnglishI l l ) or
certification of demonstrated
proficiency by the Department of
English. Exemption tests are administered .during the summer
and fall orientation periods.
B. An approved course from each of
the following seven areas (onecourse
may fulfill the requirement in one
area only):
courses in a semester are classified as fulltime students. Students must petition and
receive permission t o register for more
than 4.5 courses.
Mathematics - Physics
Chemistry - Biology
Psychology -.Sociology
Economics - Political Science
History - Philosophy
English -Speech, Communication &
Theater Arts
Art - Music
Although a student may register up t o two
weeks after the semester begins, it i s
advantageous to register at the regularly
scheduled time. A fee is charged for late
registration. A fee i s also charged for
changing registration, i.e., cancelling or
adding courses after the first five days of
the semester.
C. Students without prior study of a
foreign language will complete two
courses (111 and 112) of one foreign
language. Students who test above
111 level of a foreign language will
take one additional course at placement level in that language or two
courses (111 and 112) of another
foreign language.
Students are urged n o t t o abandon
courses for which they are registered.
Abandoned courses result i n a failing
grade. Cancellation of courses or cancellation from College must be done in the
Registrar's Office. Cancellations from
college and resulting adjustments i n
accounts are effective as of the date the
completed Cancel From College form i s
returned to the Office of the Registrar.
D. Three approved courses in religious
studies of which not more than one
may be an interim course. For transfer students, the number required is
one for each year of study (or equivalent) at Augsburg.
E. A course related t o urban concerns.
Courses approved t o meet this requirement are published each term.
F. Two lifetime sports or demonstrated
proficiency i n two lifetime sports.
Registration
A student must be registered for a course
i n order t o receive credit for it.
A normal load i s four courses per semester and o n e course i n t h e interim.
Students registered for three or more
Students who have completed at least
7 courses with a 2.0 average are classified
as sophomores, 16 as juniors, and 25 as
seniors.
Probation and Dismissal
A student may be placed on scholastic
probation at the end of a term if his or
her achievement i s unsatisfactory.
below 1.6 or 2 zero
grades having taken 6 or
fewer courses
SOPHOMORE, below 1.7 or 3 zero
grades having taken 7-15
courses
JUNIOR,
below 1.9 having taken
16-24 courses
SENIOR,
below 2.0 having taken
25 or more courses
FRESHMAN,
If a student has been on probation two or
more semesters consecutively, he/she i s
subject to dismissal at the end of the
following spring term. A student who has
a poor academic record may be strongly
advised t o withdraw before the end of the
spring term.
Dismissal from the College will not be
automatic. Each case will be reviewed by
t h e Committee o n Admissions and
Student Standing.
A student who has been o n probation for
two terms and withdraws from the Cod
lege voluntarily must havespecial permission to re-enroll.
Evaluation and Grading
Student achievement in courses i s measured primarily by means of final examinations. Shorter examinations or tests,
written papers, oral reports, and other
types of evaluation are also used.
Most courses are graded on a scale of 4.0
to 0 with definitions as follows:
4.0 Achieves highest standards o f
excellence.
3.5
3.0 Achieves above basic course
standards.
2.5
2.0 Meets basic standards for the
course.
1.5
1.0 Performance below basic course
standards.
.5
0. Unacceptable performance ( n o
credit for the course).
Most courses are also offered on a Pass/
N o Credit system, with P meaning a grade
of 2.0 or better and N meaning no credit
and a grade of less than 2.0. O n the P/N
grading system the grade is recorded but
not computed in the grade point average.
A student may count a maximum of eight
courses of P toward graduation. For transfer students the maximum is an averageof
two courses per year. Two courses in the
major (except Elementary Education) and
one in the minor may be on P/N grading
system if approved by the department
chairperson.
Sociology 383 and several interim courses
are graded only on the P/N grading system. Some education courses are graded
only on the P/N system or only o n the
traditional system. English 111 is graded P
or N, or 2.0-4.O/N. Some other courses are
graded only P, 1.0, N. Students may select
the traditional grading system i n most
other courses. Students are cautioned t o
use the P/N grade option with care since
some graduate and professional schools
do not look favorably on a large number
of P-graded courses.
Students must indicate on their registration form those courses which they wish
to take on the P/N grading system. Any
changes in choice of grading system must
be made according t o dates published
each term. A fee i s charged after the first
five days of classes.
Music organizations and performance
studies, Chemistry Seminar and Lifetime
Sports are graded P/O.O.
An incomplete grade (I) may be given
only in the caseof extreme emergency. To
receive an I grade, a student must file a
petition with the Committee on Admissions and Student Standing stating the
reasons for requesting it, the plan and
date for removing it, and comments from
the instructor of the course. If permission
to receive an I grade is granted, it must be
removed during the following semester.
If the incomplete is not removed during
the following semester, it becomes the
grade submitted by the teacher along
with the incomplete.
A grade of X may be given for an Independent Study or Directed Study course
that i s t o be spread over more than one
semester. Such a course must be completed during the second semester or the
grade of X will remain on the record.
A course in which a grade of 0,1.0,1.5, N,
1, or X has been received may be repeated
for credit. All courses taken remain on the
academic record. Only the credits and
grades earned the second time arecounted toward graduation and i n the grade
point average. Courses in which higher
grades have been earned may not be
repeated for credit; they may, however,
be audited.
Students who wish t o fake courses without credit or grade may do so by registering for Audit (V). Such students should
confer with the professor within t w o
weeks of the beginning of the term to
determine expectations, attendance requirement, etc. If expectations have been
met, the course will be listed on the
student's transcript as having been
audited. If expectations have not been
met, the course will be listed witti a grade
of W (withdrawn).
Full-time students may audit a course
without charge. The charge for part-time
students i s listed under Expenses.
Dean's List
The Dean's List i s composed of students
whose grade point average for a semester
is 3.5 or better based on a minimum of
three full courses (or equivalent) graded
on the traditional grading system, with no
incompletes i n courses offered for credit.
The Dean's List i s published in the Augsburg College Now, and students receive a
letter of commendation from the Dean of
the College.
Graduation with Distinction
Graduation with distinction is determined
as follows:
Summacumlaude
Magnacumlaude
Cum laude
3.8 - 4.0 g r a d e
average
3.6 - 3.79 grade
average
3.3 - 3.59 grade
average
To qualify for graduation with distinction,
transfer students must have completed
two years (14traditionally graded courses)
of work at Augsburg.
Independent Study
An opportunity for independent study i s
offered through many departments. This
i s available to conscientious students who
demonstrate sufficient background and
preparation in a given field to carry out
work on an independent basis.
Most departments also offer an opportunity for directed study. As the term
suggests, this requires considerably more
faculty direction than for independent
study, and a student i s not expected t o
have as much background as for independent study. Directed study is offered
on a lower division level.
Students interested in registering for
either independent study or directed
study must first secure permission from
the faculty who will direct the study.
A student who registers for independent
study should normally expect to complete
it i n one semester but may extend it into
the next term by permission of the instructor. I n such cases, a grade of X i s
given at the end of the first term, and the
student will register again for the course
i n order t o receive the final grade.
A maximum of two courses in Independent Study and/or Directed Study may
count toward the 35 courses required for
the degree.
In the Five College Cooperative Program,
students may cross-register for independent studies only when the major field i n
which the independent study is proposed
is not available on their home campus.
Requests for exceptions t o this policy
should be made directly to their own
academic dean. The student will be
charged for any special costs attached t o
independent study by the host campus.
Veterans
Augsburg College is approved by the
State Approving Agency for Veterans
Training.
Veterans should consult with the Office of
the Registrar regarding completion of the
enrollment certificate and the forwarding
of other information t o the Veterans
Administration.
Students registered for three or more
courses are classified as full-time students.
It i s the responsibility of each veteran t o
report any change i n registration and/or
academic load to the Office of the
Registrar.
Veterans will be referred to the State
Approving Agency after any period of two
consecutive terms in which they did not
earn a minimum of three courses per
term. An incomplete grade (I) may be
given only i n t h e case of extreme
emergency. See section o n Grading.
Grade reports are issued t o students following each term.
A non-punitive grade which brings a
veteran'; academic load for the term
below three courses will be reported t o
the Veterans Administration. Veterans
will need to meet the requirements of the
Veterans Administration regarding repayment of educational assistance funds
received.
General Information
Credit by Examination
Students who are interested i n earning
credit by examinations should consult
with department chairpersons or with the
Registrar. Credit may be earned through
the College Level Examination Program
(CLEP) or by comprehensive examinations.
Classification
Sophomore.. . 7courses . .I4 grade pts.
Junior . . . .. .16courses . - 3 2 grade pts.
Senior. . . . . .25courses . -50 grade pts.
..
..
To be considered full time for the year, a
student must register for at least three
courses each of the two semesters and
one course during the interim (for a total
of seven courses). To be considered full
time for a semester, a student must register for at least three courses.
Courses
A full course i s offered for one course
credit. A few fractional courses (one-half
course credit) are offered i n the Division
of Professional Studies.
A full course has the approximatevalue of
4 semester credits. A total of 35 courses i s
required for graduation.
Most courses meet for three sixty-minute
periods or two ninety-minute periods a
week in addition t o laboratories. Each
semester is approximately 15 weeks in
length.
Unforeseen circumstances may necessitate
making changes in course offerings.
Courses with inadequate registration may
be cancelled. students shouid consult the
schedule of classes to determine definitely the current course offerings.
Numbering
Courses numbered below 300 are lower
division courses; those numbered 300and
above are classified as upper division. I n
general, courses numbered i n the 100's are
primarily for freshmen; 200's for sophomores; 300's for juniors; and 400's for
seniors. In some departments course
numbers also designate areas within the
deDartment
symbol
#Consent of instructor
T o t a l Student E n r o l l m e n t
Academic Year, 1978-79.. ............................................
Summer Session,1979 ...........................................
Summary o f Graduates
Graduates, 1870-1978 ................................................
Graduates, 1979 (August 31, 1978 - May 20, 1979).
.....................
1,712
408
7,290
337
Course Descriptions
The descriptions of courses listed in the
following pages are to be understood as
general characterizations of topics t o
be considered. For a more precise description and clarification of content and
requirements f o r individual courses,
please consult the respective instructors
bf the courses.
Consult Schedule of Classes for precise
offerings each term.
Courses and terms listed are subject t o
change.
The symbol # indicates "by consent of
instructor".
See preceding pages for information on
numbering and credit value.
American Studies
Director: Grier Nicholl
MAJOR: 13 courses including 295 or 495
and 399 or 499, plus 11 courses i n U.S.
History, Literature and the Fine Arts in the
U.S., and Social Sciences i n the U.S. (5
courses i n one of these areas and 3 i n each
of the others).*
History of the United States
American Studies, 231, 260
History 227, 222, 337, 332, 353, 495
(American Emphasis)
Religion 353, 363
Humanities i n the United States
American Studies 232, 265
Art 102, 389
English 241 (also Speech 247), 250,351,
490 and497 (
A
~
~
~
;
Philosophy 344
Social Sciences i n the United States
Economics 120, 122, 723, 251
Education 478#
Political Science 127,122,170,325,326,
370, 371, 427
Sociology 171, 373, 381, 383
Social Work 361, 463
*American area oriented courses taken
during the Interim, Summer School and at
other colleges should be approved by the
director for inclusion i n the major.
TEACHING M A J O R : 16 courses. Same as
above, plus 3 courses in foreign civilization to be approved by director.
M I N O R : 7 courses including 295 or 495
plus 2 courses in each of the above
groupings under MAJOR.
231 RELIGION IN AFRO-AMERICAN
HISTORY
An examination of selected topics related
to the black experience, e.g. African
backgrounds, religion under slavery~
evangelicalism.
Course content subject t o
~
~
~
change from year to year. Meets one
religion requirement. (Fall)
232 AFRO-AMERICAN HUMANITIES
Focuses on a significant period of the
black experience in urban America, e.g.
Harlem Renaissance, post-World War II,
with emphasis upon the contributions of
literature, art and music of the period.
Course content subject t o change from
year to year. (Spring. Offeredon demand)
260 CONTEMPORARY AMERICAN
INDIANS
The situation of Indians in the United
States sipce the Indian Reorganization Act
(1934) with an emphasis upon current
issues, e.g. tribal sovereignty, treaty rights,
and education. Examples of the persistence o f religious/cultural traditions
among selected Indian tribes today.
(Spring)
phenomenon in American life. Includes a
study of the approaches of several disciplines to the topic and practice in the
integration of primary source materials.
Occasional use of Twin Cities resource
persons and the co-learning model when
appropriate to topic. Open to freshmen
and sophomores. (Fall)
399 INTERNSHIP
A field project of an interdisciplinary
nature in area of student's choice. Consult
director to determine conditions of contract. lntended for majors only. Others#.
(Fall, Interim, Spring)
265 W O M E N IN AMERICAN CULTURE
495 TOPICS I N AMERICAN STUDIES
Through a discussion of works by women
historians and selections from women's
journals, speeches, articles, short stories,
poems, plays, and other aesthetic creations, the class will collectively assess the
position of black and white women i n
American culture from the founding of
the colonies to the present. (Fall)
295 TOPICS IN AMERICAN STUDIES
Focuses on a significant problem or
For description, see course 295. Open t o
juniors and seniors who will do a different
level of work (Fall)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
A research project of an interdisciplinary
nature in area of student's choice. Consult
with director to determine conditions of
contract. I n t e n d e d f o r majors only.
Others#. (Fall, Interim, Spring)
Art
Chairperson: Philip Thompson
STUDIO ART MAJOR: 9 studio courses
including 107, and 3 art history courses.
TEACHING M A J O R : Same as studio art
major but 250 required and 132 recommended.
STUDIO ART M I N O R : 4 studio courses
including 107, and 1 art history course.
Two required from 118,221,223,225,250;
one from 240,382,385,386,387,388,389.
ART HISTORY M I N O R : 5 art history
including 386, 3 8 7 ~388.
100, 300 SPECIAL TOPICS Occasional
courses dealing with subjects not usually
offered by the department.
102 ENVIRONMENTAL AESTHETICS
225 VISUAL C O M M U N I C A T I O N S I
Fine arts in the urban world setting. Concern for the visual content of experience
i n t h e environment leading toward
appreciation and criticism. (Spring 7980)
The theory and practice of visual perception and communication using elements
such as color, line, shape, texture, and
pictorial images. (Fall, Spring)
STUDIO ART
107 DRAWING
Drawing in pencil, charcoal, ink, and
pastels. Subjects include still-life, figures,
building interiors and exteriors, and
experimental work. (Fall, Spring)
118 PAINTING I
I n t r o d u c t i o n t o painting media and
technique in acrylic and oil. (Fall, Spring)
242 FILM M A K I N G
Film making through practical laboratory
experience. Discussion and observation
of the expressive and structural elements
of film. (Summer, Interim)
250 CERAMICS I
An introduction to the making of pottery
with an emphasis on handbuilding and
glazing. (Fall, Spring)
330 VISUAL C O M M U N I C A T I O N S I1
132 PHOTOGRAPHY
The camera used as a tool for visual
creativity and expression with attention
t o black and white photographic process.
Need access to 35 mm. camera.
A study of visual communications i n
magazines, television, film, advertising
symbols, and other mass media. Practice
in areas of photography, typography, and
illustration. (Prereq.: 225. Fall, Spring)
150 JEWELRY
351 CERAMICS I1
An introduction t o the making of jewelry
i n copper, brass, pewter, and silver.
(Spring)
Advanced work i n ceramics with an
emphasis on throwing or handbuilding
and a continuation of glazing. (Prereq.:
250. Fall, Spring)
221 SCULPTURE I
355 PAINTING II
An introduction t o sculpture. Choice of
media: clay, welded steel and bronze,
plaster, and stone. (Fall, Spring)
Advanced study of painting.(Prereq.: 778.
Fall, Spring)
223 PRINT M A K I N G I
360 WATER-COLOR PAINTING
Principles and methods of print making i n
a variety of media including etching, silkscreen and woodcut. (Fall, Spring)
Seven weeks of descriptive and experimental drawing followed by seven weeks
of water-color painting with emphasis o n
the landscape. The functions of perception, structure, and gesture i n drawing
and transparent water-color. (Prereq.:
107. Offered alternate years).
368 PRINT M A K I N G I1
Advanced work in various media, including silk-screen, etching, and engraving.
(Prereq.: 223. Fall, Spring)
399 INTERNSHIP
Consult chairman or internship director
t o determine project.
478 SCULPTURE 11
Advanced work in sculpture. Choice of
media: clay, welded steel and bronze,
plaster, and stone. (Prereq.: 221. Fall,
Spring)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Advanced study in area of the student's
choice, intended for senior art majors.
(Fall, Spring)
ART HISTORY
proto-Renaissance painting, sculpture,
and architecture i n Europe. (Offered
7 982-83)
240 ART HISTORY SURVEY
A survey of art from prehistoric to modern
times. Includes reading, research, viewing
of slides, visits to museums. (Offered
7 980-87)
387 RENAISSANCE A N D BAROQUE ART
European painting, sculpture, and architecture through the 18th century.
(Offered 7987-82)
382 SCANDINAVIAN ARTS
388 19TH A N D 20TH CENTURY ART
Survey of the visual arts in Scandinavia
f r o m pre-history t o m o d e r n times.
(7 982-83)
European painting, sculpture, and architecture from neoclassic is^ through the
present. (Offered 7987-82)
385 PREHISTORIC A N D ANCIENT ART
389 AMERICAN ART
The art of the Ice Age through the Roman
period t o the 4th Century A.D. (Offered
7980-87)
386 MEDIEVAL ART
A study of early colonial art through
contemporary American art, with specific
emphasis on 19th and 20th century art and
its relationship to European art as well as
indigenous movements.(7980-87)
Early Christian through late Gothic and
Biology
Chairperson: Neal Thorpe
MAJOR: Option One: 7 courses, including 111, 112, 491 and at least one
course from each of the following three
groups: 351, 353, 361 (Group 1); 355,473,
474 (Group 11); 440, 471, 476 (Group Ill);
Chemistry 115,116 (or 105, 106), 351, 352;
Mathematics 124, 125; Physics 121, 122
also required. Students intending t o enter graduate school should ordinarily
choose this major.
MAJOR: Option Two: 9 courses,
cluding 111, 112, 491 and at least
course from each of the following
groups: 351, 353 (Group 1); 355,
inone
five
474
(Group 11); 361, 481 (Group 111); 471, 473
(Group IV); 440, 476, (Group V); Chemistry 115,116 (or 105,106), 223 (or 351,352)
also required. Students who plan to teach
in secondary schools often select this
major. Licensure for teaching after July,
1979, also requires three courses in earth
and life sciences. Students are advised to
consult with the Education Department
early in their planning.
M I N O R : 5 courses, including Ill,
ll2and
three upper division courses. Chemistry
115, 116 (or 105, 106) also required.
PRE-MEDICAL BIOLOGY MAJOR: The
same as Option I major. In addition,
medical schools usually require Chemistry 353 (Quantitative Analytical Chemistry).
H O N O R S M A J O R : GPA of 3.5 in biology
and 3.0 overall; active participation in
seminar; one course of approved independent study with an oral defense of the
research report. Application f o r t h e
honors major should be made no later
than the first term of the senior year.
101 H U M A N B I O L O G Y
Basic biological concepts from an anthropocentric point of view. An attempt to
answer such questions as: What makes
man just another member of the biotic
fold? Does man have a niche in .the
ecosystem? What influence does man
have on the environment? What influence
does the environment, especially the
urban environment, have on man? (3
hours lecture, 1-1/2 hours laboratory. A
student may not receive credit for both
Biology 707 and 103. Does not apply to the
major or minor).
103 H U M A N A N A T O M Y A N D
PHYSIOLOGY
A professional course in the structureand
function of the human body. Lecture and
laboratory. (Fall for nursing and certair;
other paramedical students, or #; Spring
for Physical Education, Music Therapy
and other interested students. A student
may not receive credit for both Biology
101 and 103. Does not apply to the major
or minor).
105 B I O L O G Y A N D SOCIETY
What are some of the biologically-based
problems with which our society must
deal?What threats are posed by pollution,
the prospect of war, and by shortages of
food, water and non-renewable resources? What are the implications of
genetic research, scientific racism, sociobiology, and inequities in the delivery of
health care? (3 hour lecture. Does not
apply to the major or minor. Spring)
108 M I C R O B I O L O G Y
Basic microbial features are considered as
well as applications of microbiology to the
fields of medicine and sanitation. (3 hours
lecture, 3 hours laboratory. For student
nurses, health majors, or #. Prereq.:
Chemistry 103. Spring. Does not apply to
the major or minor).
109 SPECIAL TOPICS IN B I O L O G Y
Offered periodically through Augsburg's
Conservation of Human Resources (CHR)
program. Generally conducted off campus with community people taking the
course together with college students i n a
co-learning model. Topics will vary depending upon needs and interest. Applies
towards the Natural Science requirement.
111,112 GENERAL B I O L O G Y
A comprehensive introduction t o biological science. For biology and other science
majors. The course includes an introduction to molecular biology, cellular
b i o l o g y , genetics, d e v e l o p m e n t a l
biology, evolutionary mechanisms, anatomy, physiology, ecology, and phylogenetic relationships of organisms. Must be
taken in sequence except by permission
of instructor. (3 hours lecture; 4 hours
laboratory. 771, Fall; 712, Spring)
323 EXPERIMENTAL H U M A N
PHYSIOLOGY
A laboratory-based course i n which the
principles of human function are learned
by experimentation and class discussion
of the theory and results. Clinical applications will also be considered. Intended
for students i n nursing, medical technology, c o r r e c t i v e therapy, health,
physical education and related programs
as well as biology majors (primarily
Option 11). (3 hours lecture-discussion, 4
hours laboratory. Prereq.: 703 or 772. Fall,
7980. Offered alternate years.)
361 PLANT BIOLOGY
A survey of the major divisions of the
plant kingdom including the study of
anatomy, physiology, life histories, taxonomy and ecology. (3 hours lecture, 4
hours laboratory. Prereq.: 772, Fall)
367 BIOCHEMISTRY
An introductory consideration of the
chemistry of proteins, carbohydrates,
lipids and nucleic acids including intermediary metabolism. (3 hours lecture.
Prereq.: 772, Chernistry 352 or #. Fall)
440 PLANT PHYSIOLOGY
351 INVERTEBRATE ZOOLOGY
A study of the invertebrate groups stressing classification, morphology, behavior,
life history, and evolutionary relationships. (3 hours lecture, 4hours laboratory.
Prereq.: 772. Spring, 1981 and alternate
years).
353 COMPARATIVE VERTEBRATE
ZOOLOGY
A comparative study dealing with the
classification, morphology, distribution,
evolution, behavior and population dynamics of the vertebrates. (3 hours lecture, 4 hours laboratory. Prereq.: 772.
Spring)
A consideration of the chemical and
physical mechanisms involved i n photosynthesis, respiration, growth and development, and water relations i n vascular and nonvascular plants. The relationships of these processes t o plant structures. (3 hours class, 4 hours laboratory.
Prereq.: 772. Spring, 7980 and alternate
years)
471 CELLULAR BIOLOGY
A study correlating cell function with
ultrastructure. Laboratory work includes
microtechnique, cytological studies, cell
physiology and tissue culture. (3 hours
class, 4 hours laboratory. Prereq.: 772,367
or #. Spring)
473 ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY
355 GENETICS
The principles of heredity with emphasis
on recent advances in human genetics.
Laboratory w o r k stressing Drosophila
genetics. (3 hours lecture, 4 hours laboratory. Prereq.: 772, Spring)
A study of animal function with emphasis
on the vertebrates. Wherever possible,
functions are explained on the basis of
physical and chemical principles. (3 hours
class, 4 hours laboratory. Prereq.: 772;
Chernistry 706 or 776; Physics 703 or 722or
#. Fall, 7979; offered alternate years.)
474 DEVELOPMENTAL BIOLOGY
481 ECOLOGY
A consideration of the physiological and
morphological changes which occur
during the development of organisms
with emphasis on the vertebrate animals.
Experimental as well as descriptive studies
are included i n the laboratory work. In
addition to embryonic development, the
topics of malignancy, aging, and regeneration are discussed. (3 hours class, 4
hours lab. Prereq.: 772. Spring)
A survey of representative biological
communities; the study of reciprocal relationships between organisms and their
environments. (3 hours class. 4 hours
laboratory, some Saturday field trips. Prereq.: 772, 367 or #. Fall)
491 SEMINAR
Oral presentations and written papers
relating t o recent biological literature and
research. (For seniors m a j o r i n g i n
biology)
476 MICROBIOLOGY
An introduction t o the study of microorganisms with emphasis on bacteria and
viruses. M i c r o b i a l taxonomy, m o r phology, physiology, genetics, and pathogenicity are considered as well as certain
methods. (3 hours class, 4 hours laboratory. Prereq.: 772, 367 or #. Fall)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Individual laboratory, field, or library research under the direction of an instructor. Intended for biology majors
who are juniors or seniors. (Prereq.: 772,
and previous arrangement with instructor. Fall, Interim, Spring, Summer)
Business Administration and Economics
BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION
Chairperson: Edward M. Sabella
M A J O R I N ACCOUNTING: 9 Business
Administration courses (101,102,131,261,
262, 263, 379, 381, and 483 or 484); 4
Economics courses (122,123,251, and one
from 258, 391, 392). At least three upper
division courses are required. For those
planning careers in accounting, completion of the two remaining courses in the
sequence 381, 382, 483, 484 is recommended. Courses in data processing and
computer programming are strongly recommended.
M A J O R IN FINANCE: 9 Business Administration courses (101, 102, 131, 261, 262,
373,379,478, and one from 381,382,483; 4
Economics courses (122,123,251, and one
from 258, 391, 392). At least five upper
division courses are required. Economics
392, Mathematics 114 and courses in data
processing and computer programming
are strongly recommended.
M A J O R IN MANAGEMENT: 10 Business
Administration courses (101,102,131,145,
250, 261, 340, 379, 440, and 373 or 478; 5
Economics courses (122, 123, 251, 340,
445); Philosophy 120; Psychology 371,373;
Sociology 241 and 375 or 383; Speech 111
or English 223; Communications 354 or
355. Math. 114 i s strongly recommended.
M A J O R IN MARKETING; 9 B,usinys A$ministration courses (101, 102, 131, 135,
.,
J
0
250, 261, 330, 379, 430); 5 Economics
courses (122, 123, 251, 258, 445); Philosophy 120; Speech and Communications
351 or 352 and also 353. Mathematics114 is
strongly recommended.
Majors in Marketing and Management
are strongly encouraged t o take other
courses offered in the department in
addition to those listed above.
NOTE: The department is currently planning to introduce a new major in management information systems.
In addition to the courses listed below,
these are offered under Business Administration 295, 495 Topics: Research Methods for Economics and Business, Computer Simulation for Business, Income
Taxes for Individuals, and Computer Applications.
MINOR: 6 courses, including Business
Administration 101, 102, and one of 261,
373,379,478; and one of 262,379,381; and
Economics 122 and 123.
HONORS MAJOR: GPA of 3.50 i n the
major and 3.0 overall; a senior thesis
and comprehensive oral examination i n
the major field of concentration.
C.P.A. CERTIFICATION: Graduates who
wish t o take the Certified Public Accountants (C.P.A.) examination prior to fulfilling the experience requirement must
have completed the major in Business
Administration-Accounting, taken all
accounting and business-law courses
offered, fulfilled the Mathematics-Physics
general college requirement by taking
mathematics, and completed at least 5
courses but not more than 12 courses of
related business subjects (Economics,
Finance and Mathematics). Students who
have completed the above requirements
are qualified under the rules of the
Minnesota State Board of Accountancy t o
sit for the examination immediately after
graduation.
Students who plan t o major in thedepartment are strongly encouraged to select a
department advisor as soon as possible, i n
order to carefully plan their program of
study.
101 PRINCIPLES OF FINANCIAL
ACCOUNTING
lntroduction to business activities, basic
concepts and fundamentals of accounting,
the accounting cycle and preparation of
financial statements. (Fall, Interim, Spring)
102 PRINCIPLES OF MANAGERIAL
ACCOUNTING
Introduction to business activities, basic
concepts and fundamentals of managerial
accounting. Planning and controlling
processes, decision-making and behavioral considerations. (Prereq.: 101, Fall,
Interim, Spring)
131 BUSINESS LAW
Legal rules relating to contracts, agency,
negotiable instruments, property and
business organizations under the Uniform Commercial Code. (Spring)
135 INTRODUCTION TO MARKETING
Principles of basic policy and strategy
issues in marketing. Legal, ethical, competitive, behavioral, economic and techn o l ~ g i c a lfactors as they affect product,
promotion, marketing channel and pricing decisions. (On Demand)
145 FUNDAMENTALS O F MANAGEMENT
Development of the theory of management, organization, staffing, planning and
control. The nature of authority, accountability and responsibility, analysis of the
role of the professional manager. (On
Demand)
250 DATA PROCESSING
An introduction t o COBOL and other
non-scientific programming languages.
Does not apply toward a major or minor in
economics. (Fall, Interim, Spring; Laboratory Fees)
261 FUNDAMENTALS O F FINANCE
Theory of acquisition, allocation, and
management of funds within the firm;
sources and uses of long and short term
funds, cost of capital, capital budgeting,
leverage, dividend policy, and related
topics. (Prereq.: 707, 702, Fall)
262 INTERMEDIATE ACCOUNTING I
search methodology; marketing research
results; evaluation of the effectiveness of
research in marketing. (Prereq.: Bus. Ad.
135 or consent o f instructor. O n Demand)
340 PERSONNEL ADMINISTRATION
Personnel function in business, acquisition and utilization of human resources;
desirable working relationships; effective
integration of the worker with the goals of
the firm and society. (Prereq.: Bus. Ad. 745
or consent of instructor. O n Demand)
373 FINANCIAL MANAGEMENT:
THEORY A N D CASES
Advanced financial theory: a systems
approach to financial structure and policy.
Emphasis on decision-making, presentation through literature, readings, lectures
and case material. (Prereq.: 267, Spring)
379 QUANTITATIVE METHODS FOR
ECONOMICS A N D BUSINESS
An analysis of accounting theory pertaining to financial statements, income
concepts, capital stock and surplus
accounts, current and long-term assets.
(Prereq.: 707, 702, Fall)
An introduction t o quantitative reasoning,
descriptive measures, probability, sampling distributions, inference and estimation with emphasis on their use in applied
problems in business and economics.
(Prereq.: High School Afgebra. Fall)
263 INTERMEDIATE ACCOUNTING I1
381 MANAGERIAL COST ACCOUNTING
An analysis of accounting theory pertaining t o investments, tangible and intangible fixed assets, liabilities and
reserved, actuarial topics. Additional
emphasis on income determination considering price level changes. (Prereq.:
262, Spring)
Accounting tools for planning and control of economic activities. Planning,
budgeting, standard cost systems, as well
as other quantitative and behavioral
topics. (Prereq.: 707, 702. Spring)
330 MARKETING RESEARCH A N D
ANALYSIS
The more common and important provisions of federal income taxes for individuals and various forms of business
enterprises. (Prereq.: 107, 702. Spring.
Offered alternate years.)
Research process as an aid to decision
making i n marketing management; re-
382 TAX ACCOUNTING
399 INTERNSHIP PROGRAM
A student may receive course credits
through an internship program which i s
applicable to graduation, but not to the
major. This program will afford the student the opportunity t o spend one full
t e r m w o r k i n g w i t h some industrial
organization. In addition the student will
write a report o n his or her activities.
(Prereq.: #. Fall, Interim, Spring, Summer.
Cannot be taken i n Interim only).
viewpoint of both individual and institutional investors. Extensive coverage of
capital markets and portfolio management. (Prereq.: 267. Economics 392 is
strongly recommended. Fall)
479 INTERMEDIATE QUANTITATIVE
METHODS FOR ECONOMICS A N D
BUSINESS
Integration of marketing with other business functions; marketing management
and decision making, planning marketing
programs, channels of distribution, pricing, product selling and promotion policies. (Prereq.: Bus. Ad. 330 or consent o f
instructor. O n Demand)
Provides the opportunity to become familiar with statistical research methods
through use of the electronic computer.
This course stresses the understanding of
statistical methods and computer programming techniques. The materials to be
presented in the course are: Computer
Programming Techniques; Statistical
Methods: General Linear Models, Analysis of Variance, etc. (Prereq.: Bus. Ad. 379
or equivalent or consent o f instructor. N o
lab fee. Spring, O n Demand)
440 OPERATIONS MANAGEMENT
483 AUDITING
Concepts and principals related t o the
management of operating functions. Examples from service industries, non-profi t organizations and manufacturing.
Taught from a managerial point of view.
Topics include: an overview of operations, planning operation processes, productivity measurement, standards, forecasting, concepts of quality, inventory
management, principles of scheduling,
and operational control information systems. (Prereq.: lunior or Senior or consent o f instructor. O n Demand)
Internal and external auditing procedures.
Emphasis on internal checks and controls
for accounting systems. (Prereq.: 263. Fall)
430 MARKETING MANAGEMENT
484 ADVANCED ACCOUNTING
Accounting for business combinations,
governmental accounting, partnership
accounting and fund accounting. (Prereq.:
263. Fall, Spring. Offered alternate years.)
295,495 TOPICS
Lecturer, discussions, meetings with
478 INVESTMENTS A N D FINANCIAL
INSTITUTIONS
Appraisal of the risk/return relationships
of various types of securities from the
members of the staff or visiting faculry
regarding research methodology and
readings in the areas of Accounting,
Finance or General Business. (Prereq.: ".
FaSI, Interim, Spring]
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
The student may earn independent study
credits through individually supervised
projects designed t o afford him or her the
opportunity t o analyze some topic or
issue i n depth. (Prereq.: #. Fall, Spring)
NOTE: In addition to the courses listed
below these topics are offered under 295,
495 Topics: Consumer Economics, History
of Economic Thought, Research Methods
for Economics and Business and Advanced Economic Theory.
MINOR: Economics 122,123,251,258 and
one other upper division economics
course.
ECONOMICS
MAJOR I N ECONOMICS: 8 Economics
courses (including 122,123,251,258,454);
Business Administration 101, 102, 379;
Mathematics 114. Mathematics 373 may
be substituted for Business Administration 379. The complete calculus sequence
is very strongly recommended for those
planning graduate study in economics.
I n addition, Mathematics 114 and courses
i n data processing and computer programming are strongly recommended.
MAJOR I N APPLIED ECONOMICS:
9 Economics courses (122, 123, 251, 258,
454 and 445 or 453 and three other upper
division);Business Administration 101,
102, 379, 479; Philosophy 130; Mathematics 124, 125, 215, 224, 314. Mathematics 211 is strongly recommended.
Mathematics 373 may be substituted for
Business Administration 379. The student
i s strongly encouraged t o take other
Economics courses in addition t o those
listed above.
-
COMBINED MAJOR I N ECONOMICS
BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION: 5 Economics courses (including 122, 123, 251,
258); 6 Business Administration courses
(including 101,102,261,373,379). Courses
in data processing and computer programming are highly recommended. The
student is very strongly encouraged t o
take additional courses both in business
administration and economics.
HONORS MAJOR: GPA of 3.50 in the
major, and 3.0 overall; a senior thesis
and comprehensive oral examination
in the major field of concentration.
Economics 120, 122 and 123 will satisfy
general education requirements.
Economics 120 will satisfy the urban concerns requirement.
Students who plan t o major in the department are strongly encouraged t o
select a department adviser as soon as
possible, i n order to carefully plan their
program of study.
120 ECONOMICS OF URBAN ISSUES
Study of economic implications of many
problems facing a metro-urban environment. Some of the topics to be discussed
are: Population "Crisis", Crime Prevention, Ecology and Income ~ i s t r i b u t i o n ;
Distributing Free Bread; Mass Transit
Systems, e t c . F u n d a m e n t a l m i c r o economic tools introduced t o facilitate
discussion of t h e above-mentioned
topics.
NOTE: Economics 120 is a basic course
designed for those students who do not
plan to major in Economics or Business
Administration. It does not apply toward
an Economics major or minor. Students
who plan to major in Business Administration and/or Economics should instead
enroll in 122 and 123, which also are open
to non-majors. (Fall, Interim, Spring)
122 PRINCIPLES O F ECONOMICS
(MACRO)
An introduction t o macroeconomics;
national income analysis, monetary and
fiscal policy, international trade, economic growth. Application of elementary
economic theory t o current economic
problems. May be taken independently
of Economics 123 or 120. Economics 122
and 123 may be taken in either order, or
may be taken in the same term i n order for
the student to progress more rapidly to
the other courses. (Fall, Interim, Spring)
123 PRINCIPLES O F ECONOMICS
(MICRO)
An introduction to microeconomics, the
theory of the household, firm, market
structures and income distribution. Application of elementary economic theory
to market policy. May be taken independently of Economics 122 or 120. Economics 122 and 123 may be taken in either
order, or may be taken in the same term
in order for the student t o progress more
rapidly to other courses. (Fall, Interim,
Spring)
250 DATA PROCESSING
An introduction t o COBOL and other
non-scientific programming languages.
Does not apply toward a major or minor in
economics. (Fall, Interim, Spring; Laboratory Fee).
251 INTERMEDIATE M I C R O ECONOMICS
Theory of resource allocation, analysis of
consumer behavior, firm and industry;
the pricing of factors of production and
income distribution; introduction t o welfare economics.(Prereq.: 123, Fall, Spring)
258 INTERMEDIATE M A C R O ECONOMICS
Determinants of national income, employment and price level analyzed via
macro-models. Attention paid t o areas of
monetary-fiscal PO"'YJ growth and the
business cycle. (Prereq.: 122. Fall)
340 MANAGERIAL DECISION M A K I N G
Provides a sound conceptual understanding of the modern techniques of management science to prepare students t o make
better business and economic decisions.
Emphasis is on applications, which are
taken from the areas of transportation,
marketing, portfolio selection, environmental protection, the shortest route,
inventory models, information systems,
etc. (Prereq.: Econ. 723, Bus. Ad. 101 and
h i g h school algebra o r equivalents.
Spring, O n Demand)
379 QUANTITATIVE METHODS FOR
ECONOMICS A N D BUSINESS
See under Department o f Business
Administration.
391 PUBLIC FINANCE
Analysis of the principles of taxation and
public expenditures; the impact of fiscal
policy on economic activity; debt policy
and its economic implications. (Prereq.:
122, 123. Fall)
392 MONEY A N D BANKING
Functioning of the monetary and banking
systems, particularly commercial banks,
the Federal Reserve System and i t s role i n
relation to aggregate economic activity.
Emphasis placed on monetary theory and
policy. (Prereq.: 122. Spring)
399 INTERNSHIP P R O G R A M
454 WELFARE E C O N O M I C S
A student may receive course credits
through an internship program which i s
applicable to graduation but not t o the
major. This program w i l l afford t h e
student the opportunity to spend some
time working with some organization. I n
addition, the student will write a report on
his or her activities. (Prereq.: #. Fall,
Interim, Spring, Summer. Cannot be
taken i n Interim only)
Basic concepts and propositions; Pareto
optimality, economic efficiency of alternative market structures; social welfare
functions; normative concepts of economic theory. (Prereq.: 257 or #. Spring,
alternate years)
442 LABOR E C O N O M I C S
Analysis of labor markets; labor as afactor
of production; determination of wagecollective bargaining; labor legislation
and effects upon society. (Prereq.: 257'or
#. O n Demand)
445 MANAGERIAL ECONOMICS
Integrates economic theory and corresponding practices in business. Among
the topics considered are theories and
practices i n forecasting, estimation of
demand and cost functions, price and
non-price competition, production and
cost considerations, and an analysis of
economic problems o f relevance t o
management. (Prereq.: Econ. 257 or
equivalent o r consent o f instructor.
Spring, O n Demand)
479 INTERMEDIATE QUANTITATIVE
METHODS FOR ECONOMICS A N D
BUSINESS
Provides the opportunity t o become
familiar with statistical research methods
through use of the electronic computer.
This course stresses the understanding of
statistical methods and computer programming techniques. The materials t o be
presented i n the course are: Computer
Programming Techniques; Statistical
Methods: General Linear Models, Analysis of Variance, etc. (Prereq.: Bus. Ad. 379
or equivalent or consent of instructor. N o
lab fee. Spring, O n Demand)
295, 495 TOPICS
Lectures, discussions, meetings w i t h
members of the staff or visiting faculty
regarding research methodology and
current national and international economic problems and policies. (Prereq.: #.
Fall, Interim, Spring).
453 MATHEMATICAL ECONOMICS
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Mathematical economics with emphasis
on the application of mathematical tools
t o the areas of micro and macro economic
theory. (Prereq.: Econ. 257, 258 and at
least Math. 722 or equivalent or consent
o f instructor. O n Demand)
The student may earn independent study
credits through individually supervised
projects designed to afford him or her the
opportunity t o analyze some topic or
issue in depth. (Prereq.: #. Fall, Spring)
Chemistry
Chairperson: Earl Alton
GRADUATION M A J O R IN CHEMISTRY:
115,116, (or 105,106) 351,352,353,361 and
one advanced course which may include
Biochemistry; participation in seminar.
Physics 121,122 and Mathematics 124,125
also required. Since upper division courses
have mathematics and physics prerequisites, students should plan t o take
Mathematics 124, 125 in the freshman
year; and Physics 121, 122 in the sophomore year.
A M E R I C A N C H E M I C A L SOCIETY
APPROVED MAJOR: 11 courses including
115, 116 (or 105, 106) and all chemistry
courses above 350. Chemistry seminar
participation; Mathematics 224; and
Physics 121, 122 (which should be taken
during the sophomore year). Reading
ability in German equivalent t o one
semester also required.
M I N O R : 5 courses which must include
115,116 (105,106) and 3additional courses
i n chemistry. Chemistry 223, 353, and 361
are recommended; biochemistry may be
substituted for 361.
TEACHING MAJOR: PHYSICAL SCIENCE
EMPHASIS - CHEMISTRY MAJOR:
Recommendation for licensure in Physical Science requires general chemistry
(115, 116 or 105, 106); 3 courses i n earth
and life sciences; Chemistry 351,352,353,
361, 362, 482, 491 (Biology 367 may be
substituted for 362); Physics 245. Students
are advised t o consult with the Education
Department early i n t h e i r planning.
PRE-MEDICAL CHEMISTRY MAJOR: The
same as the graduation major. In addition,
medical schools expect at least two courses
(and usually more) in biology. Students
should consult members of the chemistry
department for assistance i n planning a
course program early i n their college
career.
DEPARTMENTAL HONORS: Full ACS
major; average of 3.5 i n chemistry, mathematics, and physics; 3.0 over-all; one
summer or course of approved research;
participation i n seminar.
Credit will not be granted for both 105
and 115; 106 and 116; 223 and 351,352.
Concerning prerequisites: Most courses
in this department have prerequisites,
courses that must be completed before
enrolling i n the given course. A prerequisite must be completed with a grade of
2.0 or higher i n order t o count. Otherwise, permission of the instructor i s
necessary. These requirements must also
be met when using the first term of a twoterm course i n registering for the second
term.
103 ELEMENTARY CHEMISTRY
Designed for nurses at Lutheran Deaconess Hospital. Selected elements of
general, organic, and biological chemistry
around the theme: the molecular basis of
life. Does not apply toward the major.
(Credit cannot be earned for both Chem.
703 and any one o f Chem. 105, 106, 115,
176, 223, 351, 352, or Biol. 367.) (3 onehour lectures, 1 two-hour laboratory. Prereq.: high school chemistry within last 3
years or # . Fall
105,106 PRINCIPLES OF CHEMISTRY
Somewhat less rigorous than 115, 116;
designed especially for students who will
not major in chemistry, although students
may go from 106 into 351, 353. Concepts
and laws underlying chemistry illustrated
by a variety of examples including organic
and environmental systems. (3 one-hour
lectures, 3 hours of laboratory. 105, Fall;
106, Spring)
115, 116 GENERAL CHEMISTRY
An intensive course for premedical students and future chemists. First semester
includes chemical equations and calculations, energetics, and bonding theory
with examples from inorganic chemistry.
The second emphasizes equilibrium and
solution chemistry including kinetics and
electrochemistry. (One-hour lectures, 3
hours laboratory. Prereq.: high school
chemistry, algebra, plane geometry. 115
Fall, 116 Spring)
223 ELEMENTARY ORGANIC AND
BIOLOGICAL CHEMISTRY
Designed for non-chemistry majors and
those in allied health science programs
whose professional goals do not require
either the two-term organic or the oneterm biochemistry course. The organic
chemistry most relevant to a survey of
biochemistry is studied, followed by the
structures and metabolic reactions of
carbohydrates, lipids, proteins, nucleic
acids, enzymes and certain hormones. (3
one-hour lectures, 1 three-hour laboratory. Cannot serve as a prerequisite for
Biol. 367. Credit cannot be earned for
both Chem. 223 and any one of Chem.
103, 351, 352, or Biol. 367. Prereq.: 105 or
115, Spring)
351, 352 O R G A N I C CHEMISTRY
Important classes of organic compounds
with special emphasis on mechanisms and
multi-step synthesis. Descriptive material
i s correlated by means of modern theories
of chemical bonds, energy-relations, and
reactor mechanism; many applications of
organic chemistry t o biological, environmental and industrial fields. (3 one-hour
lectures, one 4-hour laboratory. Prereq.:
106 or 116, 351 Fall; 352, Spring)
353 QUANTITATIVE ANALYTICAL
CHEMISTRY
Covers g r a v i m e t r i c a n d v o l u m e t r i c
analysis and solution equilibrium in detail
and gives an introduction t o spectrophotometric techniques of analysis. The
laboratory involves quantitative analysis
of a variety of samples, and includes trace
analysis. (Prereq.: 106 or 116. Spring)
361, 362 PHYSICAL CHEMISTRY
The basic theoretical concepts of chemistry: thermodynamics, kinetics, quantum
theory, and states of matter are studied in
the first semester. Applications of these
concepts to areas of molecular structure,
equilibria and electrochemistry in the
second semester. (3 one-hour lectures,
one 4%-hour laboratory. Prereq.: 353;
Physics 121, 122; Mathematics 124, 125.
367, Fall; 362, Spring)
464 ADVANCED ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
Organized around t h e problems o f
identifying organic compounds in the
l a b o r a t o r y . Lecture t o p i c s i n c l u d e
structure-spectra correlations for IR, UV,
NMR, and mass spectroscopy; use of the
literature ( i n c l u d i n g Beilstein); and
further study of organic reactions. Infrared, nuclear magnetic resonance, and
ultraviolet spectra routinely used. (3
hours lecture, 6 hours laboratory. Prereq.:
352,353,351 or#; some reading knowledge
of German. Spring)
481 ADVANCED ANALYTICAL
CHEMISTRY
Emphasis upon advanced equilibrium
theory and principles of atomic and molecular spectroscopy as applied t o analytical
methods as well as chromatographic and
electroanalytical techniques of analysis. (3
hours lecture, one 4%-hour laboratory.
Prereq. : 353, 362, or #. Fall)
482 ADVANCED INORGANIC
CHEMISTRY
Correlation of inorganic reactions using
the electrostatic, valence bond, and
molecular orbital models. Coordination
chemistry is discussed i n terms of ligand
field theory. The laboratory involves preparations of inorganic compounds using a
variety of techniques. (3 o n e - h o u r
lectures, 1 three-hour laboratory. Prereq.: 362 or #. Spring)
483 Q U A N T U M CHEMISTRY
Presents quantum theory in terms of
Schrodinger's wave equation and uses the
equation to solve the problems of the
harmonic oscillator and the hydrogen
atom. Approximate solutions are introduced and used to develop molecular
orbital theory for molecules. Includes
commutators, electron spin, angular
momentum and group theory. (3 onehour lectures. Prereq.: 361 or #. Fall)
491 CHEMISTRY SEMINAR
This seminar, which has no course credit,
i s a weekly meeting of chemistry majors
under the direction of the Augsburg
Chemistry Society. Juniorsand seniors are
expected to participate, with seniors presenting papers. Outside visitors are occasionally invited to participate.
497 INTRODUCTION T O CHEMISTRY
RESEARCH
Chemistry majors planning research
careers need research experience before
graduation. Such experience may be obtained by working on a summer research
project i n the department (not counted as
a course) or by research participation
during the academic year (which may be
counted as a course). (Junior standing).
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Chemistry majors who are interested in
non-laboratory research such as theoretical or historical chemistry may pursue
their interest via independent study.
(Junior Standing)
East Asian Studies
Coordinator: Khin Khin Jensen
The major i n East Asian Studies i s a cooperative program of the Associated Colleges of the Twin Cities (ACTC). This
program enables students t o obtain a
broad exposure to Japan and China as
important world cultures. Componentsof
the program include language, history,
cultural specialization, comparative
studies, and seminar work or independent studies.
Requirements for the major consist of a
minimum of ten courses, distributed as
follows:
4 courses in Japanese or
4 courses in Chinese
2 introductory history courses
2 courses in cultural specialization or
comparative studies
2 seminars or independent studies
Each student's major program must be
submitted to the coordinator for approval.
Economics
Chairperson: Edward M. Sabella
74
See under Business Administration and
Economics.
Education
Chairperson: Lauretta E. Pelton
Augsburg College offers programs leading to licensure i n Education at these
levels: Elementary Education, Kindergarten, Early Childhood, and Secondary
Education.
Licensure programs for secondary education are offered i n the following areas:
American Studies, Art, Biology, Chemistry, English-Language Arts, French,
German, Health, History, Mathematics,
Music, Physical Education, Physics, Social
Studies, Spanish, Speech, and Theater
Arts.
Students wishing to become licensed
teachers are advised t o consult with the
Education Department for licensure requirements.
The courses, Orientation to Education,
both elementary and secondary, are open
t o all students of sophomore standing or
above. To enroll i n other education
courses, a student must first apply and be
admitted t o the teacher-education program. Students are advised t o apply for
admission in the spring semester of the
sophomore year, during or after the
Orientation course. Students who are
transferring from an education program
at another college must be re-admissable
to that program.
ELEMENTARY EDUCATION
1. A minimum of 8 education courses t o
include 255, 351, and two professional
semesters: 361,362,371 (1/2), 372 (1/2),
373 ( 1 4 , 374 (1/2); and 481, 482 and
electives.
2. Health Education 114 and 115.
3. Library Science 341 (%), 358
4. An academic minor. An academic
major i s recommended.
5. GPA of 2.0 overall and maintain at least
a 2.5 average in the major.
6. Fulfill State Department of Education's
EDU 521 Regulation i n Human Relations.
Requirements for Kindergarten License
are the same as those for elementary
education plus Education 375 and 483.
Courses 371,372,373,374 are offered o n a
traditional grading system only.
EARLY CHILDHOOD EDUCATION
Bobbie Anderson, Coordinator
Requirements for license in Early Childhood Education are the same as those for
Elementary Education plus the following
courses:
Sociology of the Family
Soc 231
Psych. 351 Developmental Psychology:
Child
Ed. 325
Contemporary Influences i n
Early Childhood Education
Ed. 425
Early Childhood Curriculum
Ed. 484
Student Teaching (160 hours)
Coordinator: Marie McNeff
Requirements for the major and for licensure i n Elementary Education:
For an Early Childhood License with other
than an education major, consult with the
Early Childhood Education Coordinator.
255 ORIENTATION T O EDUCATION I N
URBAN SElTING (ELEMENTARY)
371 ELEMENTARY CURRICULUM: Art,
Music ('/z course)
Investigation of various aspects of the
teaching profession and opportunity for
in-school work. Open to all students.
(Prereq.: sophomore standing or above.
Fall, Spring)
Examination and preparation of materials
and resources for art and music taught at
the elementary level. Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or 265, concurrent registration i n 361, 362. Spring)
325 CONTEMPORARY INFLUENCES I N
EARLY C H I L D H O O D EDUCATION
372 ELEMENTARY CURRICULUM:
Science, Mathematics (Y2 course)
Focus i s upon the young child as a person
and the importance of the early years of
his/her life in relation t o the effects of
present-day society and culture upon the
child. Current developments include innovations, Head Start, implementation of
planned variations, and o t h e r i n t e r ventions and compensatory programs.
Class sessions and two hours per week of
lab. experience in a day care center
and/or nursery school. (Spring)
Examination and preparation of materials
and resources for science and mathematics taught at the elementary level.
Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or
265, concurrent registration i n 361, 362.
Spring)
341
MEDIA TECHNOLOGY ('/z course)
(See Library Science)
351 TECHNIQUES O F TEACHING
READING
The study and utilization of a variety of
techniques and resources in the teaching
of reading at both secondary and elementary level. (Fall)
First Professional Semester (for juniors):
Courses 361, 362, 371, 372, 374.
373 ELEMENTARY CURRICULUM: Phys.
Ed., Health ('/z course)
Examination and preparation of materials
and resources for physical education and
health taught at the elementary level.
Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or
265. Fall)
374 ELEMENTARY CURRICULUM:
Social Studies, Language Arts
(Yi course)
Examination and preparation of materials
and resources for social studies and
language arts taught at the elementary
level. Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.:
255 or 265, concurrent registration i n 361,
362. Spring)
361,362 CREATlNG LEARNING
ENVIRONMENTS: ELEMENTARY
375 DISCOVERY IN THE WORLD O F
KINDERGARTEN
The mastery of theories and their applications for teaching in learning settings.
Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or
265 or #. Spring)
A study of the kindergarten curriculum,
exploration of materials, and review of
teaching approaches. The course requires
laboratory experience. Required f o r
Kindergarten licensure. (Prereq.: Orientation to Ed. and acceptance into the
Dept. o f Ed. Summer I)
382 TEACHING CHILDREN WITH
LEARNING PROBLEMS
Electives
483, 484 STUDENT TEACHING II
Additional experience in teaching. (Prereq.: 487, 482. Fall, Spring)
478 SCHOOL A N D SOCIETY
(See Secondary Education)
(See Secondary Education)
399 INTERNSHIP
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
The student may select
Opportunity for advanced and special-
A learning'Ontract
m~~~~ be developed and must have education faculty
approval.
ized research projects not otherwise provided for in thedepartmental curriculum.
A projected program must be outlined
which meets the approval of education
faculty.
a
situations for professional work experi-
425 EARLY C H I L D H O O D CURRICULUM
Learning a b o u t a n d d e m o n s t r a t i n g
knowledge and skills of teaching the
young child. The course concentrates o n
details essential t o the organization of a
good program for children: records, reports, physical facilities, equipment,
parental involvement, and working with
children who have uniquely different
needs. Class sessions and two hours per
week of lab experience in a day care
center and/or nursery school. (Fall)
SECONDARY EDUCATION
(TEACHER LICENSURE PROGRAM)
Second Professional Semester: Student
Teaching and Electives
Suggested four-year outline of coursesfor
meeting requirements i n a teaching major
and licensure are available through the
Augsburg Computer terminal. (See Education faculty for access t o computer.)
481, 482 STUDENT TEACHING I
Observing and directing learning at the
following levels: N, K, and/or elementary
levels under the supervision of college
and elementary school personnel. (Prereq.: Admission to student teaching and
program approval. Fall, Spring)
It is the responsibility of each student t o
meet all specific requirements of the
Education Department. Secondary Education students are advised to consult
with Education faculty regarding state
requirements for teacher licensure. This
consultation i s recommended in addition
t o conferring with the student's major
field adviser.
Requirements of the Augsburg College
Licensure Program for Secondary Education:
1. Application for admittance and acceptance into the Department of Edu-
2.
3.
4.
5.
cation. This may be made before, concurrently with, or after the Orientation
course. Application forms are available
in the Education Department office.
Before applying for admission students
should receive approval from the department or division of their declared
major. A student may take education
courses after the Orientation course
only if heor she has been admitted into
the program of the Department of
Education.
GPA of 2.0 overall and maintain at least
a 2.5 average in the major.
Application for admittance and acceptance into student teaching.
Completion of the State Department of
Education's EDU 521 Regulation i n
Human Relations (successful completion of Augsburg's Education program
meets this requirement.)
Successful completion of the required
courses of the education program:
Health Educ. 114 and 115; Educ. 265,
359, 388, 478; the required course(s)
in special methods i n t h e area
of t h e student's major, and two or
three courses in Student Teaching.
Requirements for State of Minnesota
Licensure for teaching i n Secondary
Schools (Through the Augsburg College
Education Department Program)
GENERAL INFORMATION:
1. For Art, Music and Physical Education
Licensure: Persons with teaching majors
in Art, Music and Physical Education
receive a special license which allows
them t o teach i n their area i n all grades
from Kindergarten through twelve
(K-12). A person preparing for licensure in one of these areas follows the
secondary education program even
though he or she plans t o teach at the
elementary school level. A person with
a major in one of these special areas
will take three courses in student
teaching and do some student teaching
at both the secondary and elementary
levels. In addition to Educ. 359, the
art major will register for Educ. 361
and 362; the P.E. major for Educ. 365;
and the music major for Educ. 373.
2. The professional term: Student Teaching i s taken concurrently with School
and Society in a one full-time term in
professional education. Special afternoon and/or evening seminars are
held during the term as part of the
professional work. A student taking
two courses in student teaching may
elect t o take one course in Independent Study. All students are expected to be involved full time in the
activities of the professional term.
1. B.A. or B.S. degree
2. College major i n a teaching area
3. Fulfull State Department of Education
EDU 521 Regulation in Human Relations (Successful completion o f Augsb u r g Education p r o g r a m meets
requirement)
4. Health Educ. 114 and 115
5. Successful completion of Augsburg
Education Department Licensure Program courses.
265 ORIENTATION T O EDUCATION IN
A N URBAN SElTlNG (Secondary)
Investigates various aspects of the teachi n g profession, with opportunity for
inschool work. Open t o all students.
(Prereq.: Sophomore Standing. Fall,
Spring)
341 MEDIA TECHNOLOGY (ficourse)
(See Library Science)
351 TECHNIQUES O F TEACHING
READING
(See Elementary Education)
359 CREATING LEARNING
ENVIRONMENTS: SECONDARY
(lh course)
The mastery of theories and their applications for teaching in learning settings.
Laboratory experiences, (Prereq.: Psychology 705, EDS 265)
With the general methodology course,
one or more of the following education
courses i n special methods must be taken
from the department in the major field.
Special Methods Courses ('/i to 1 course)
374 Natural Science Methods
% course (Spring)
375 Social Studies Methods
% course (Spring)
376 Speech and Theater Arts Methods
% course (Spring)
377 Mathematics Methods
% course (Spring)
410 Health Methods (See Health Ed. 410,
Adm. and Superv. of School Health
Program)
1 course
382 TEACHING CHILDREN W I T H
LEARNING PROBLEMS
This course will examine characteristicsof
different kinds of learning problems
found i n regular classroom environment.
The primary focus of the course will be on
teaching strategies, but attention also will
be given t o procedures for the identification of different kinds of learning
problems, prescriptive procedures, referral processes, and alternatives for programming "mainstreamed" students.
(Fa 11)
Methods and materials in teaching special
areas
388 H U M A N RELATIONS % course
360 American Studies Methods
'/Z course (Spring)
361 Art Methods (Elementary and junior
high school)
1 course (Fall)
362 Art Methods (Senior high school)
'/Z course (Fall)
364 English Methods
% course (Spring)
365 Physical Education Methods (K-12)
1 course (Fall)
366 Foreign Language Methods
(Consult with Language Department)
?hcourse
373 Music Methods (K-12)
1 course (Spring)
Emphasis o n the study of values, of
communication techniques, and of the
major minority groups i n Minnesota for
the development of interpersonal relations skills applicable to teaching and
other professional vocations. Open to all.
(Fall, Spring)
399 INTERNSHIP
The student may select from a variety of
situations f o r professional work experience. A learning contract must be
developed and must have education
faculty approval.
478 SCHOOL A N D SOCIETY
The emphasis in this course i s on the
school i n relation t o society with particular attention to urban education. Introduced by a study of educational philosophy and the development of American
education, current major issues in education will be studied. (Prereq.: senior
standing. Fall, Spring)
481, 482,483, 484
STUDENT TEACHING
Observing and directing learning at the
secondary level under supervision of
college and secondary school personnel.
(A minimum o f two courses, except three
courses required o f Art, Music, Physical
Education majors. Prereq.: Admission to
student teaching and program approval.
Fall, Spring)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Opportunity for advanced and specialized
research projects not otherwise provided
for in the departmental curriculum. A
projected program must be outlined
which meets the approval of education
faculty.
LIBRARY SCIENCE
M I N O R : Minimum of 4 courses, including 245, 358, 359, 475.
mensions of communication through the
use of instructional technology. Selection,
preparation, production and evaluation
of effective audio visual materials for
teaching/learning situations. (Spring)
358 THE ELEMENTARY SCHOOL
LIBRARY: MATERIALS SELECTION
A N D GUIDANCE
Characteristics and purposes of an elementary school library. Extensive study of
evaluation sources, book talks, storytelling, curriculum needs. Concentration
on guidance in use of print and non-print
materials (Fall, Spring)
359 REFERENCE SERVICES I N THE
LIBRARY
Study of basic information sources most
frequently used by students and librarians.
Includes preparation of bibliographies
and library instruction. (Spring)
399 INTERNSHIP
Open to juniors and seniors. An opportunity to do field work in a variety of
library situations i n the metropolitan area.
475 THE H I G H SCHOOL LIBRARY:
MATERIALS SELECTION A N D
GUIDANCE
245 THE MEDIA CENTER:
ORGANIZATION A N D
ADMINISTRATION
Survey and evaluation of library materials
on the secondary school level, with attention to their use in relation t o curricula
as well as for personal interest and needs
of adolescents. (Spring)
Organization of materials, including acquisition, processing and circulation.
Services of the media center and methods
of evaluation. (Fall)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
341 MEDIA TECHNOLOGY ('/2 course)
Psychological and philosophical d i -
Independent study and research o n some
topic of interest i n the field of school
library service, worked out in consultation
with a faculty adviser. Open to juniors and
seniors, with department approval.
Engineering
Ken Erickson: Adviser
Augsburg College i s cooperating with the
Washington University School of Engineering and Applied Science (St. Louis,
Missouri) and Michigan Technological
University (Houghton, Michigan), i n a
Three-Two Plan of studies which will
enable a student to earn the Bachelor of
Arts degree from Augsburg College and
an engineering baccalaureate degree
from Washington University or Michigan
Technological University in a five-year
period. The first three years are spent at
Augsburg followed by two years at the
affiliated university. Students accepted
into the program are guaranteed admission t o the engineering school, provided
they have met course requirements, have
a B average, and are recommended by a
designated representative of Augsburg
College. Students receiving financial aid
who are participants in the Three-Two
Plan will be encouraged to apply to the
engineering school of their choice for
continuing support. Their applications
will be evaluated using need and academic performance as criteria. Minimum
course requirements for admission t o the
Three-Two Plan are: Math 124, 125, 224,
226; Physics 121,122; Chemistry 115, 116;
Computer Science 245; English 111; additional courses to meet general education
requirements and a total of 27 courses at
Augsburg. Normally Math 124, 125 and
Physics 121,122 are taken i n the freshman
year. Students are encouraged t o apply
for admission t o the program during their
sophomore year. Early consultation with
the adviser, Ken Erickson, i s encouraged.
English
Chairpersons: Catherine Nicholl, Richard
Sargent
MAJOR: 9 courses (above I l l ) , including
one course i n American literature, one
course i n the Western literary tradition
(271 or 272) and three courses in British
literature. Of the British literature courses,
one must concentrate on literature before 1660 (for example, 331 or 438) and
one must survey a number of writers (for
example, 336,337, or 423). All majors must
take 225, Advanced Expository Writing.
Majors are encouraged to take, early in
their college work, course 245, Introduction t o Literature. Majors are strongly
urged t o consult their departmental
adviser regularly. A student with a double
major or special program that involves
considerable work in the English department should also work closely with an
adviser in the English department:
MAJOR FOR SECONDARY TEACHING:
English: 10 courses, including those listed
for the major and a course in the English
language. Courses i n early American litera t u r e , Shakespeare, a n d f i l m a r e
recommended.
Speech: (1) a course in public speaking:
Beginning Speech, Small Group Communication, Interpersonal Communication, Argumentation, Persuasion (2) Interpretative Reading or Stage Direction.
Library Science: 475, The High School
Library: Materials Selection and
Guidance.
In addition t o field experience and student teaching, as required by the Department of Education, English Education
majors will be required to gain practical
experience in the teaching of writing, t o
be arranged through the department
chairperson.
Students interested i n a teaching major
are encouraged t o take courses toward
their major during the freshman and
sophomore years, enroll in Orientation
to Education in the fall term of thesophomore year and apply for teacher education not later than the fall of their junior
year. In addition to planningtheir courses
of study with the department chairperson,
students should consult an advisor in the
Department of Education.
H O N O R S MAJOR: GPA of 3.5 in the
major and 3.0 overall; submit program t o
department chairperson early i n senior
year; defend honors thesis before faculty
committee in senior year. Honors thesis
may be an independent study program.
M I N O R : 5 courses (above I l l ) , including
one course in British literature, and one
writing course. Teaching minors must
include both 225 and a course in the
English language.
The English Department recommends
but does not require that English majors
consider developing an area of emphasis
broader than the major as listed above.
The most likely areas would be a British
concentration, an American concentration, a world literature concentration, and
a writing concentration. A student arranges a concentration by careful selec-
tion of electives in the major, by the
design of an independent study course
that applies t o the concentration, and by
the selection of some related courses
outside the English department.
BRITISH LITERATURE C O N C E N TRATION: Select from: History 412,416;
English 261,331,332,336,337,367,368,423,
438 and sometimes 490, 491.
AMERICAN LITERATURE CONCENTRATION: Select from: History 221, 222;
American Studies 232; English 241, 250,
351, 367, 368, and sometimes 490, 491. A
student with an American literature concentration should take some of t h e
courses listed under the American Studies
major w h i c h are selected f r o m t h e
offerings of several departments at Augsburg.
W O R L D LITERATURE C O N C E N T R A TION: Select from: History 102,360, 361;
Philosophy 110, 242, 343, 370; German
244; French 243; Spanish 249; Scandinavian Studies 351,352; and sometimes 490,
491.
WRITING CONCENTRATION: In addition t o Advanced Expository Writing,
Creative Writing, and Journalism, elect
Interim courses i n writing.
A student electing a concentration should
work closely with his or her adviser.
lnterim courses, special courses, and other
courses given at the other cooperating
colleges will often fit well into a concentration.
English 111 i s strongly recommended but
not a prerequisite for a lower division
literature course. Prerequisite for an
upper division course i s successful completion of a lower division literature
course or consent of the instructor.
101 DEVELOPMENTAL WRITING
226 CREATIVE WRITING
A preparatory course for effective writing
for students identified by an examination
as needing additional preparation. Instruction and practice in basic writing
skills will be given. Students will write
short papers based on their own observation, experience, and thought. P/N
grading only. (Fall, Spring)
The purpose of the course is t o encourage
and guide, by means of appropriate
models, theories, and criticism, writing i n
narrative and poetic modes of expression.
Short stories, personal narratives, and
poems may be selected by students for
experimentation and development, according t o the student's preference.
111 EFFECTIVE WRITING
227 JOURNALISM
The study of composition with emphasis
on expository writing. Attention to correct usage, logical organization, and the
research paper. The grading system for
this course i s either P/N or 2.0-4.O/N. I n
order t o hold a place i n the course the
student must either attend class the first
day or personally notify the instructor that
s/he cannot be present. (Fall, Spring)
An introduction t o newswriting, with
secondary emphasis on the feature and
the news feature. The student i s first
introduced t o the principles of writing the
news story, what constitutes news, copy
preparation, and editing practices, then
goes on t o write real and imagined obituaries, press releases, speech stories, and
communitv news stories. A unit on the
feature and the news feature concludes
the course. Throughout the semester,
attention is paid to ethics, comparisons
and contrasts with the electronic media,
and stylistic trends inside and outside
the journalism establishment.
223 WRITING FOR BUSINESS A N D THE
PROFESSIONS
A practical course designed to improve
writing skills for those preparing for
business and professional careers. The
writing of reports, letters, and proposals
w i l l be emphasized. Students will be
encouraged to use material from their
own areas of specialization. (Prereq.: 7 7 1
or Equivalent)
225 ADVANCED EXPOSITORY WRITING
241 I N T R O D U C T I O N T O CINEMA ART
'
The development of essays i n a variety of
rhetorical modes, which may include identification, definition, classification, illustration, comparison and contrast, and
analysis. Particular attention will be given
t o stylistic and organizational matters
through the course's workshop format, i n
which students' papers are read and discussed. (Prereq.: 777, Fall, Spring)
An investigation of the artistic qualities
and the historical development of the film
media. The course includes the viewing
and discussing of both feature length and
short films. See also description under
Speech, Communications and Theater
Arts.
245 I N T R O D U C T I O N T O LITERATURE
An introduction to the study of fiction,
drama, and poetry. Particular attention
will be devoted to developing critical and
analytical skills in reading and writing
about literature. Strongly recommended
for English majors. (Fall, Spring)
Moliere, Cervantes, Montaigne, Goethe,
Dostoyevsky.
331 CHAUCER A N D HIS AGE
250 AMERICAN LITERATURE T O 1920
Reading and analysis of some significant
works of selected American writers from
colonial times t o t h e emergence o f
literary naturalism. Attention is also given
to the writer's contribution to the historical development of American literature. (Fall, Spring)
While the primary study of the course will
be the writings of Geoffrey Chaucer,
attention will be given t o the medieval
literary milieu out of which Chaucer
wrote. Medieval poetry, romance, and
drama may be examined. (Alternate years,
1980-81)
332 M I L T O N A N D HIS AGE
261 M O D E R N FICTION
Significant works of selected prose
writers, chiefly European, of the twentieth
century. (Fall, Spring)
A study of Milton's major poems and
selected prose. I n addition the Renaissance literary tradition out of which
Milton created his works will be examined. (Alternate years, 1981-82)
271 EUROPEAN LITERATURE: HOMER
T O DANTE
A study of major works of Greek and
Roman literature,for example the epics of
Homer and Virgil, t h e tragedies o f
Aeschylus, Sophocles, and Euripides, the
comedies of Aristophanes and Ovid's
Metamorphoses. Dante's Inferno will be
studied as a work in which the Christian
and the classical traditions are combined.
These works will be studied with reference to their mythological foundations,
their cultural background, their influence
on later literature, and their enduring
relevance. (Fall)
272 EUROPEAN LITERATURE: F R O M
THE RENAISSANCE T O M O D E R N
PERIOD
Study of masterpieces of literature, chiefly
European, from the medieval t o the
modern period, including such authors as
336 BRITISH LITERATURE, F R O M
D O N N E T O BLAKE
Reading, analysis and discussion of works
of selected writers from the metaphysical
poets to Blake, with attention t o the
historical, intellectual, and social influences and the major literary movements. (Fall)
337 BRITISH LITERATURE, THE
ROMANTICS A N D THE
VICTORIANS
A study of major writers of the nineteenth
century, emphasizing Romantic poetry,
Victorian poetry, Victorian prose and two
or three novels of the period. Relationships among these writers and their influence on one another will be emphasized as well as their relationship t o their
own age and their lasting contribution t o
the forms of poetry and prose. (Spring)
351 AMERICAN LITERATURE SINCE 1920
A study of some recent and contemporary
writers and literary movements. Attention
i s given to the dynamics of American
society and i t s intricate relationship t o the
literature. Special emphasis i s given to the
city as setting and symbol i n modern
American literature. (Fall, Spring)
beginnings up t o the twentieth century.
Novels studied will be selected from the
works of such authors as Defoe, Richardson, Fielding, Sterne, Austen, Dickens,
Bronte, Thackeray, Eliot, Hardy, and
Butler. Attention will be given to the
conditions contributing t o the rise of the
novel and its emergence by the twentieth
century as the dominant literary form
(Alternate years. 1980-81)
367 M O D E R N POETRY
438 SHAKESPEARE
Study of major modern and contemporary poets and schools of criticism.
isc cuss ion may include the poetry and
aesthetics of the Imagists, French Symbolists, New Critics, Harlem Renaissance,
M o d e r n Romantics, Black M o u n t a i n
Poets, Beat Poets, Confessional Poets, and
other contemporary movements. (Alternate years, 1981-82)
368 M O D E R N D R A M A
Significant works of American, British,
and continental dramatists of the twentieth century, with emphasis on representatives from the major movements
such as Naturalism, Existentialism, Theater
of the Absurd, and Transformationalism.
Plays by women and minorities are included. (Alternate years, 1980-81)
399 INTERNSHIP
The department offers on-campus internships i n teaching writing and various offcampus internships. Interested students
should consult the department chairperson.
423 STUDIES I N THE BRITISH NOVEL
A survey of the development of the novel
i n England from its eighteenth century
Study of ten or twelve major plays comedies, histories, tragedies - with
attention to the development of Shakespeare's dramatic and poetic art. Additional plays assigned for reading analysis.
490,491 ENGLISH SEMINAR
Course 490, a theme or movement; course
491, a major writer or a major work.
Enrollment open t o juniors and seniors.
498 INDEPENDENT STUDY METROPOLITAN RESOURCES
Open t o junior or senior English majors
w i t h a grade of 3.0 or consent of
department chairperson. Provides directed independent study which makes
use of the resources of Augsburg's urban
location, such as theaters, poetry readings, and writers' groups.
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Open to junior or senior English majors
with a grade of 3.0 or consent of department chairperson. Provides directed
independent study in the area of the
student's choice.
Foreign Languages
Chairperson: Cunta Rozentals
Students with previous foreign language
study should register in courses suited to
their level of preparation. Basically, placement in foreign language courses follows
the formula: 1 year of high school foreign
language equals 1 course of college
foreign language. However, final placement is made according to the results of a
placement test which may be taken at preregistration time after consultation with
the department. Students who register
below their level may only d o so for a
grade of P/N.
., be:
,c.J/.
--
,;.I
-
For majors, a minimum of four upper
division courses at Augsburg College i s
required for graduation. A maximum of
four upper division non-Augsburg courses
may be accepted. N o fewer than two of
these four courses should be taken abroad.
For minors, a minimum of two upper
division courses at Augsburg College is
required for graduation.
For transfer students intending to major
or minor, a minimum of one upper division credit per year attended i s specified.
See department faculty for limits on nonAugsburg courses and career information.
Course 112 completes basic elements of
the language. Courses numbered 211,212
meet useable skill levels.
Course 311 i s prerequisite to all upper
division courses.
Teaching majors and minors must consult
with the Department of Education for
program. Methods courses by language
are joint five-college offerings and should
be taken in the fallof the senior year. ~ 3 . 0
average in Advanced Conversation and
composition i s a. departmental requirement for teachingmaiors. MLA Competency Exam needed for licensure.
Departmental Honors: Majors seeking
departmental honors must apply no later
than early in the senior year. Requirements: 3.3 GPA in the major, 3.0 GPA
overall, and honors thesis demonstrating
ability in independent study for one
course credit. Consult department chairperson for details.
Chinese
Offered in conjunction with the Five
College Cooperative Program. See Schedule of Classes for course offerings.
MINOR: 4 courses above 212, including
one in conversation-composition, one in
civilization, and one in literature. Interim
or summer of study in France strongly
recommended.
RECOMMENDED SUPPORTING
COURSES:
European History, a second language,
philosophy, linguistics, English literature.
Study Abroad. Also see Interim catalog.
/
111 BEGINNING FRENCH
Designed to introduce the student with
no previous background in French to the
language and to pench culture. The pronunciation system and basic sentence
structures are taught to enable understanding and expression on a rudimentary
level. Two hour? laboratory work. See
above on placehent. (Fall, Spring)
112 BEGINNING FRENCH
For those who have had 111or equivalent.
Through convepsations, sentence practice, and readings, the study of tenses and
forms i s completed to make possible basic
communication, beginning reading skills,
and acquaintaice with French culture
and way of life. Two hours laboratory
work. See above on placement. (Spring)
211 INTERMEDIATE FRENCH
French
MAJOR: 8 courses above 212, including
two in conversation-composition, one in
civilization, and three in literature, of
which one should be course 352. Study in
France strongly recommended.
20th Century selected articles and a grammar review are the-basis for practice in
communication, vocabulary building and
developing greater ease in reading. For
those who have studied most of the basic
structures. Two hours of laboratory work.
(Fall)
come acquainted with artistic qualities
and cultural-historical significance of
these works. Sophomore standing. Does
not count toward a French major or
minor. (Offered o n Demand)
212 INTERMEDIATE FRENCH
Through informative and controversial
articles, interviews and literary readings,
this course works toward the goals of oral
fluency, communication of ideas, and the
acquisition of sufficient skills t o pursue
general reading in French. Completes a
review of basic structures. Laboratory
work. (Spring)
311 C O N V E R S A T I O N - C O M P O S I T I O N
Explores topics of current interest in both
oral and written form to build fluency,
accuracy, a n d f a c i l i t y o f expression.
Emphasis o n vocabulary e n r i c h m e n t ,
grammatical refinements, effective
organization of ideas. Laboratory assignments. Post-intermediate level. A prerequisite to other upper division courses.
243 FRENCH LITERATURE I N
TRANSLATION
Major representative works of French
literature read i n English translation.
Through individualized background
reading and class discussion, students be.
.
--
.
,
.
a
.
-
-
%
.....
(Fall)
*
,,,...... . .
*
,
*
.
.
,
312 FRENCH EXPRESSION
A two-pronged approach t o coherent and
correct expression. Attention to grammatical structures, French turns of phrase
and elementary stylistics. French
phonology and speech groups practiced
to overcome inadequacies and incorrect
speech habits. (Prereq.: 311 or #. O n
demand)
331 FRENCH CIVILIZATION:
HISTORICAL PERSPECTIVE
A study of the diversified development of
the French from their beginnings to the
modern period. Special attention to cultural manifestations of their intellectual,
political, social and artistic self-awareness.
Readings, reports, extensive use of audiovisual materials. In French. (Prereq.: 317
or #. Alternate years)
332 FRENCH CIVILIZATION TODAY
Topics in twentieth-century problems,
ideas. Cultural manifestations that promote understanding of French people and
their contribution to the contemporary
scene. Readings, reports, extensive use of
audio-visual materials and periodicals. I n
French. (Prereq.: 311 or #. Alternate years)
350 INTRODUCTION T O LITERATURE
FOR LANGUAGE STUDENTS
Theory and practice of literary studies. A
theoretical component (in English) treats
the basic principles of literature, literary
genres, and different approaches t o literary analysis. I n the practical component,
students apply the elements of theory
through reading, analyzing, and discussing
selected works o f French literature.
Recommended for majors and minors.
Open to all qualified students. (Prereq.:
317 or #. Offered o n demand)
352 CREATIVITY A N D RESTRAINT
A survey of the major literary creators of
the Renaissance and Classical periods,
and the French intellectual, social and
ethical currents reflected in their works.
Poetry and the essay, theater, early novel,
letters and other prose forms. Classes, oral
and written reports, and laboratory work
i n French. Required of all majors.
(Prereq.: 317 or #. Alternate years)
354 REALITIES: INNER A N D
OUTER WORLDS
A survey of the romantics, major novelists,
Baudelaire and his successors i n poetry,
and the literature of ideas that led t o new
forms and emphases with the turn of the
century (Proust, Gide, Claudel, Apollinaire, etc.) Classes, oral and written
reports, and laboratory texts in French.
(Prereq.: 311 or #. Offered alternate years)
355 TWENTIETH CENTURY LITERATURE
A survey of the major French literary
movements since World War I, including
the novel, the theater, poetry, the essay,
and criticism. Classes, oral and written
reports, and laboratory texts in French.
(Prereq.: 377 or #. Alternate years.)
411 ADVANCED CONVERSATIONCOMPOSITION
By means of reading, speaking and writing
on topics of intellectual, social, or political
interest the student acquires extensive
training in the four skills at an advanced
level. Attention to accuracy and yffectiveness, characteristic levels of expression,
refinements in style and organization as
individual needs indicate. Provides for
self-improvement and self-evaluation.
Laboratory assignments. Required for all
majors. (Prereq.: 311 or #. O n Demand)
451 THE FRENCH NOVEL
A study of major authors (LaFayette,
Proust, Balzac, Gide, Flaubert, Zola,
Mauriac, Malraux, Sartre, Camus, etc.1
that shows the evolution of this genre i n
theme and form. Analyses, discussion,
and Papers in French- (Prereq.: 311 or #.
Recommended 337. O n demand)
495 FRENCH SEMINAR
an
Or
Study in depth
genre in French literature (i.e., 18th Century, poetry, medieval works, b m a n ticism). Student presentations i n French.
For advanced students. (See also Interim
offerings. Prereq.: 352, 354 or 355. O n
Demand)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Individual pursuit of a topic, movement,
or genre at an advanced level. Designed
to complete a balanced program, enhance
research, or meet individual interests. In
literature a major paper and its defense
are included. (Consultations with French
teachers required. junior standing. Fall,
Interim, Spring. Subject and plan to be
clarified early with study adviser.)
German
MAJOR: 8 upper division courses, including 311 and 411. lnterim and summer
in Germany strongly recommended.
M I N O R : 4 upper division courses, including 311 and 411. lnterim and/or summer i n Germany strongly recommended.
RECOMMENDED SUPPORTING
COURSES:
M e t h o d s i n M o d e r n Languages f o r
teachers; European History, a second
language, linguistics, English literature.
111,112 BEGINNING GERMAN
Course 111 is for students with no previous background; 112 isfor studentswho
have had 111 or equivalent or less
than
two years of high school German. Aims at
developing basic skills. Classroom practice in speaking, understanding and reading basic German.
Goals: Ability t o read extended narratives
in simple
G
~ insights
~ intoG~~~~~
~
~
culture and participation i n short conversations.
~~b~~~~~~~
materialsavailable.
(Fa//, spring)
211,212 INTERMEDIATE GERMAN
For students with two terms (or two years
high school) of previous German. Aims at
developing basic skills i n t o w o r k i n g
knowledge of German. Review of basic
structures with emphasis on extending
range of vocabulary and idiomaticexpression through reading and discussion of
materials representing contemporary
German life and literature. (211, Fall; 212,
Spring)
244 GERMAN LITERATURE IN
TRANSLATION
Principal works of German literature
representing various periods and movements are read and discussed i n English.
The readings are considered not only i n
the particular context of German cultural
history, but also discussed in terms of their
relevance t o perennial human problems.
Credit for this course does not apply t o
a German major or minor. (On Demand)
311 GERMAN CONVERSATION A N D
COMPOSITION
Aims at developing facility i n the use of
grammatical structures, vocabulary and
idiomatic expressions most common i n
colloquial German. Intensive practice in
speaking i s supplemented with exercises
i n written composition. (Fall)
331 GERMAN CIVILIZATION A N D
CULTURE I
The Early Background. Follows the cultural and social development of the German-speaking peoples from the prehistoric Indo-European origins (ca. 3,000
B.C.) t o the Thirty Years War (1643), with
emphasis on the impact of Roman civilization, the re-emergency of German cultural self-awareness during the Middle
Ages, and the intellectual and religious
upheavals of the Reformation. I n German.
(Prereq.: 311 or #. Alternate years)
350 INTRODUCTION T O LITERATURE
FOR LANGUAGE STUDENTS
Theory and practice of literary studies. A
theoretical component (in English) treats
the basic principles of literature, literary
genres, and different approaches t o literary analysis. I n the practical component,
students apply the elements of theory
through reading, analyzing and discussing selected works of German literature.
Recommended for majors and minors.
Open to all qualified students. (Prereq.:
311 or #. Offered o n demand)
351 GERMAN LITERATURE T H R O U G H
18TH CENTURY
Brief survey of heroic, courtly, Reformation, Baroque, Aufklarung and Sturm und
Drang literature. Extensive readings and
discussions i n Classic and Romantic
periods. Readings in German, supplemented by lectures on the history of
German literature in its cultural and geopolitical context. Class discussions help t o
improve students' ability to express ideas
in German. (Prereq.: 311 or#. O n demand)
352 GERMAN LITERATURE:
THE 19TH CENTURY
332 GERMAN CIVILIZATION A N D
CULTURE II
Survey of significant currents of development which have shaped present-day
Germany, Austria and Switzerland since
the Age of Enlightenment. The contemporary scene is considered i n view of its
roots in the intellectual, geopolitical,
artistic and scientific history o f t h e
German-speaking peoples. In German.
(Prereq.: 311 or #. Alternate years)
I n c l u d e s later Romanticism, J u n g Deutschland, poetic realism, Naturalism
and Impressionism. The literary reaction
to the decline of idealistic philosophy and
the importance of the individual and the
rise of materialism, technology and mass
man. Readings in German. Class discussions help t o improve students' ability t o
deal with concepts and express themselves i n German. (Prereq.: 311 or #. O n
demand)
353 GERMAN LITERATURE:
THE 20TH CENTURY
Literary responses to the crises and upheavals of our time. Writers of international stature are discussed : Kaf ka, Hesse,
Mann, Brecht. Readings in German with
class discussibns are designed t o aid students' self-expression i n German.
(Prereq.: 377 or #. O n Demand)
411 ADVANCED GERMAN
COMPOSITION A N D
CONVERSATION
literature, linquistics, which can apply
toward classics concentration in cooperation with Macalester College.
111,112 BEGINNING GREEK
Theoretical and practical study of Greek
grammar, w i t h special emphasis o n
morphology. Translation exercises from
and into Greek. (771, Fall; 772, Spring)
211 INTERMEDIATE GREEK
Review of basic structures of Greek, exand d e v e l o ~ m e n t
pansion of
Aims at developing and refining the stuof
reading
skills
through
selections from
use of German as a vehicle for
the New Testament and other Hellenistic
expressing his own ideas and opinions.
writings (early fathers, historians, etc.)
Emphasis on written composition includOn parsing and 'yntax
ingcontrolof style. Oral practicethrough
the
Greek
text.
(Prereq.:
772 0' #. Fall)
language,
use of German as classroom
(Prereq.: 317 or #. Alternate
350 INTRODUCTION T O LITERATURE
451 GERMAN PROSE
FOR LANGUAGE STUDENTS
Reading and discussion of German prose
masterpieces from Goethe to the present.
Lectures treat the development of the
epic genre as a mirror of cultural and
geopolitical history. (Prereq.: 311 or #. O n
Demand)
452 GERMAN D R A M A
Representative dramatic works from late
18th century to the present are discussed
and read as symptomatic of perennial
human concerns. Lectures treat the historical development of the drama. (Prereq.: 377 or #. O n Demand)
A first course i n the theory and practiceof
literary studies. A theoretical component
(in English) treats the basic principles of
literature, literary genres, and different
approaches to literary analysis. I n the
practical component, the class will divide
into small groups according to foreign
language, where the elements of theory
will be applied through reading, analyzing, and discussing selected works for
foreign literature in the langauge. Recommended for majors and minors.
Open t o all qualified students. (Prereq.:
272 or #. Offered on demand)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Japanese
Greek
See the instructor for supporting courses
at Augsburg in history, philosophy, art,
Offered in conjunction with the Five
C o l l e g e C o o p e r a t i v e Program. See
Schedule of Classes for course offerings.
Linguistics
289 I N T R O D U C T I O N T O LINGUISTICS
An introduction t o linguistic analysis and
general linguistic principles, with focus
on linguistic universals (organizational
principles and features common t o all
languages) and psycholinguistics (inquiry
in t o the mechanics of language learning
and the structure of the mind as revealed
i n language.) Theoretical questions will
be approached by studying samples of
various languages. No prerequisite. Recommended for all language majors and
minors. (Fall)
Norwegian
MAJOR: 8 courses above 211, including
311,312, 331,350,353,411, and 499 (independent study). Interim or summer in
Norway recommended. (Academic credit
may also be earned through the Camp
Norway program in Norway.) Consult
department for details.
M I N O R : 4 upper division courses including 311, and two of 331,350,353,411; plus
one course under Scandinavian Studies.
TEACHING M I N O R : 311, 331, 353, 411
plus required education courses, including special methods.
RECOMMENDED SUPPORTING
PREPARATION:
Study in Norway, a second foreign language, linguistics, additional courses under Scandinavian Area Studies.
writing. Stress on spoken rather than
literary Norwegian. Laboratory work expected. (117, Fall; 712, Spring)
211 INTERMEDIATE NORWEGIAN
Continued conversation and composition
to improve comprehension and facility of
expression. Selected readings in Norwegian used as basis for class discussion
and exercises. Laboratory work and some
field experience expected. (prereq.: 172
or equivalent.)
311 NORWEGIAN CONVERSATION
A N D COMPOSITION
Intensive practice in spoken Norwegian
with emphasis on pronunciation and
original composition. Some attention
given to regional variations i n spoken
Norwegian and t o differences between
the two official languages of Norway.
Some laboratory work and field experience required. (Prereq.: 211 or equivalent.)
312 O L D NORSE
An introduction t o the structure of O l d
West Norse through the study of selections from O l d Norse literature. Some
attention given to O l d East Norse and
aspects of the history of four modern
Nordic languages. Knowledge of one of
the latter i s desired but not required.
Norwegian language minors will have
special assignments. (Offered alternate
years)
331 NORWEGIAN CIVILIZATION A N D
CULTURE
111,112 BEGINNING NORWEGIAN
Introduction of the four basic language
skills: speaking, listening, reading and
This study of Norwegian cultural history
will include significant aspects of the
c o n t e m p o r a r y N o r w e g i a n society.
Through extensive readings (in Norwegian as far as possible), the domestic
and foreign influences at work in the
comparatively homogeneous population
of Norway will be examined. Written and
oral reports i n the Norwegian language
will be required along with some field
work. (Prereq.: 371 or #. Alternate years)
350 I N T R O D U C T I O N T O LITERATURE
FOR LANGUAGE STUDENTS
Theory and practice of literary studies. A
theoretical component (in English) treats
the basic principles of literature, literary
genres, and d i f f e r e n t approaches t o
literary analysis. In the practical component, students apply the elements of
theory through reading, analyzing, and
discussing selected works of Norwegian
literature. Recommended for majors and
minors. Open to all qualified students.
(Prereq.: 377 or #. Offered on demand)
353 SURVEY O F NORWEGIAN
LITERATURE
Selected readings in contemporary Norwegian literature provide a base for the
study of original works from earlier
periods extending back to O l d Norse
literature. All genres are examined, and
considerable attention i s given t o writings
i n the Nynorsk language, particularly
poetry. Lectures, readings, oral and
written reports are in Norwegian language. (Prereq.: 217 or equivalent. Spring
1981. Alternate years)
411 ADVANCED NORWEGIAN
CONVERSATION A N D
COMPOSITION
Further intensive practice i n spoken and
written Norwegian. Attention given to the
other Scandinavian languages and t o the
historical development of the Norwegian
language. Laboratory work and field experience required. (Prereq.: 377 or #.
Alternate years)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Russian
Offered in conjunction with the Five
C o l l e g e C o o p e r a t i v e Program. See
Schedule of class for course offerings, and
Russiam Area Studies in this catalog.
Spanish
MAJOR: 8 courses above 212, including
311,411, 456 or 457, two of 352, 353,354.
(Study i n Spain or Latin America i s
strongly recommended)
Recommended Supporting Courses:
Linguistics, a n o t h e r language, PreColumbian civilization, Latin-American
Area Studies. Consult department for
other supporting courses in humanities.
111,112 BEGINNING SPANISH
Aims t o develop the four basic skills:
understanding, speaking, reading, and
writing of elementary Spanish. Introduction to culture of Spanish-speaking world.
Laboratory work is an integral part of the
course (711, Fall; 112, Spring)
211,212 INTERMEDIATE SPANISH
A thorough review of grammar with
emphasis on active use of the language,
supplemented by readings in culture and
literature. (Prereq.: 172 or 2 years of high
school Spanish. 271, Fall; 212, Spring)
223 THE C H I C A N O EXPERIENCE
Through essays, short stories, and novels
written by Chicanos and leading sociologists, anthropologists, and psychologists,
the course will introduce the student t o
the world of the Chicano and his dual
struggle t o maintain his traditions and
culture on the one hand, and t o integrate
into American society on the other. (On
Demand)
249 SELECTED WORKS O F SPANISH A N D
LATIN AMERICAN LITERATURE I N
TRANSLATION
Major works of Spanish and Latin American l i t e r a t u r e r e p r e s e n t i n g various
periods and movements are read i n
English translation. Through background
reading and class discussion in English the
student i s acquainted with the salient
artistic qualities and cultural-historical
significance of the readings. Credit in this
course does not count toward a major or
minor in Spanish. Sophomore standing
preferred. (On Demand)
311 SPANISH CONVERSATION A N D
COMPOSITION
Thorough oral and written practice i n
correct expression with the aims of
fluency and facility. Enrichment of vocabulary. Laboratory work. This course isa
p r e r e q u i s i t e f o r all u p p e r - d i v i s i o n
courses. (Prereq.: 272 or equivalent. Fall)
312 SPANISH EXPRESSION
Intended for students who have a basic
command of writing and speakingskills i n
Spanish and wish to expand them. Intensive practice t o improve oral and written expression with emphasis on conversational facility, stressing idiomatic
usage and the finer points of grammar.
Readings t o stimulate discussion and
broaden cultural background from contemporary literary texts and magazine
articles. Conducted in Spanish. (On demand)
331 SPANISH CIVILIZATION A N D
CULTURE
Study of the Spanish character and of
Spanish contribution t o world civilization
through historical, intellectual, literary,
and artistic movements. I n Spanish. (Prereq.: 377 or #, Spring 7987, alternate
years.)
332 LATIN AMERICAN CIVILIZATION
A N D CULTURE
A study of the cultural heritage of the
Spanish American countries from the PreColumbian civilization~to the present. In
Spanish. (Prereq.: 377 or 272, with #.
Spring 7980, alternate years)
350 INTRODUCTION T O LITERATURE
FOR LANGUAGE STUDENTS
Theory and practice of literary studies. A
theoretical component (in English) treats
the basic principles of literature, literary
genres, and d i f f e r e n t approaches t o
literary analysis. I n the practical comp o n e n t , students a p p l y t h e t h e o r y
through reading, analyzing, and discussing selected works o f literature i n
Spanish. Recommended for majors and
minors. Open to all qualified students.
(Prereq.: 377 or #. Offered on demand)
352, 353 SURVEY O F SPANISH
LITERATURE I, II
A study of representative authors i n
Spanish literature, supplemented by lectures on the literary movements and de-
velopment of Spanish literature. Lectures, discussion, written and oral reports
in the language. (Prereq.: 311 or #. 352,
Fall, 1981; 353, Fall, 1982)
354 REPRESENTATIVE HISPANIC
AMERICAN AUTHORS
An introduction to Spanish-American literature. Lectures, discussions, written and
oral reports in the language. (Prereq.: 311
or #. O n Demand)
411 ADVANCED CONVERSATION A N D
COMPOSITION
Emphasis on increasing facility and correctness of written and oral expression
through conversations, discussions, reports, debates, and written compositions
and grammatical exercises. (Prereq.: 311
or #. Alternate years)
456 SPANISH D R A M A
Study of the masterpieces of dramatic
literature i n Spain. Oral and written reports i n the language. Emphasis on the
Golden Age and the ~ d d e r nPeriod.
(Prereq.: One survey course. O n demand)
457 SPANISH NOVEL
Study of the outstanding novelists of the
nineteenth and twentieth century i n
Spain. Oral and written reports i n the
language. (Prereq.: One survey course.
Alternate years)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
History
Chairperson: Orloue Cisselquist
MAJOR: 8 courses plus 1seminar. At least
four of these courses must be upper
division. A major must have at least one
course (either survey or upper level) from
each of the four areas. Ancient and
Medieval; Modern Europe; u.S.;
and
non-Western.
M A J O R FOR TEACHING: In addition t o
the regular history major a social science
major with history emphasis is also available. See "Social Science" in this catalog.
Students wishing to become licensed
teachers see "Education Department" in
this catalog and consult with Education
Department faculty for requirements.
HONORS MAJOR: GPA of 3.6 in the
major and 3.0 overall; except in special
instances, application before the end of
the first term of the junior year; two years
a
language at the college level
(0' i t s equivalent); an honors thesis
(equal t o One course credit) to be
defmded before a faculty committee.
M I N O R : 5 courses, at least three of which
must be upper division.
Students are required to take at least one
survey course (numbered below 300) before registering for an upper level course.
Lower level courses need not be taken i n
sequence.
There are16upper division courses (numbered 300 and up) in this department. Five
or six are offered each term, or 11 per
year. Offerings depend u p o n faculty
schedules and student registration.
101 THE BEGINNINGS O F THE
WESTERN CULTURE
An analysis of the primary civilizations i n
the Near East, the classical world of
Greece and Rome, and the middle ages of
Europe into the 13th century. (Fal1,Spring)
102 THE SHAPING O F WESTERN
CIVILIZATION
A consideration of European institutions
and values from the waning of the middle
ages through the remodeling of Europe
by Napoleon. (Fall, Spring)
103 THE M O D E R N WORLD
A study of the main currents i n western
civilization from the time of Napoleon to
the present. (Fall, Spring)
104 THE M O D E R N NON-WESTERN
WORLD
An introduction to various centers of
cultural and political power in Asia and
Africa of the last 200 years. (Fall, Spring)
221 U.S. HISTORY T O 1877
A survey of Americans from Jamestown
through the efforts t o reconstruct a nation
torn apart by The Civil War. (Fall)
222 U.S. HISTORY SINCE 1877
An assessment of the century which precedes our modern day. (Spring)
299 DIRECTED STUDY
An opportunity for a student t o do readings or study on topics not covered i n the
scheduled courses. The proposed study
must be approved by the directing faculty
member and the chairman of the department before registration. A maximum of
one course i n directed study may be
applied to the major.
331 TOPICS I N U.S. HISTORY
Exploration i n depth of selected topics i n
U.S. history (excluding foreign policy; see
History 332). The specific topics to be
offered will be announced prior to registration.
332 HISTORY O F AMERICAN
FOREIGN POLICY
The relationship of foreign policy t o
general American development is stressed
as is the period of the Cold War.
353 SELECT TOPICS I N MINNESOTA
HISTORY
A survey of topics relating t o the emergence of modern Minnesota: Indianwhite relations; immigration and ethnic
adjustments; rise of the Twin Cities;
economic and political development. Primary emphasis will be on the late 19th and
early 20th centuries.
360 THE ANCIENT NEAR EAST A N D
GREECE T O 338 B.C.
The development of civilization in the
Near East from earliest times through i t s
extension and elaboration by the Greeks.
Emphasis i s placed on the development of
writing, achievement in the arts and
sciences and political institutions.
361 HELLENISTIC GREECE A N D R O M E
T O 330 A.D.
A study of the development of Alexander's
Empire, the Hellenistic kingdoms and the
rise of Rome as the world's greatest power.
Emphasis is placed on personalities, the
arts and sciences and Rome's contributions in law and the political process.
370 THE LATE MIDDLE ACES T O 1560
A study of the scholastic tradition and the
role of the Church and state through the
changes forced on these institutions
during the Italian Renaissance and the
early years of the Reformation.
399 INTERNSHIP I N HISTORY
A limited number of internships may be
available for qualified upper-division
students majoring i n history. See department chairperson.
431 EUROPEAN URBAN HISTORY
A history of the dynamics of urban growth,
the distinctive institutions, and the culture
of cities in Europe from the Roman Empire
to the 20th century, with focus on specific
historic cities as examples. The course is
designed for history students, urban study
majors, and those who desire a background to enrich further travel.
440 TWENTIETH CENTURY TOPICS I N
WORLD HISTORY
This course emphasizes such topics as
Hitler's fascism, the collapse of colonial
empires and the rise of the third world.
~h~ emphasis will be on Western Asia,
Europe, and Africa in the lastfifty years.
450 NINETEENTH CENTURY
SCANDINAVIA
412 ENGLAND I N THE
TUDOR A N D STUART PERIODS
A study of English history from a 15th
century background through 1714. The
emergence of modern constitutionalism
is the major theme of the course. Emphasis
i s also placed on 16th and 17th century
aspects of England's subsequent role i n
the world economy and o n the English
literary renaissance of Elizabethan and
early Stuart periods.
416 EUROPE I N THE SEVENTEENTH
CENTURY
The study of this century as the most
critical period in the rise of the modern
state. Emphasis i s also placed on the
emergence of modern science and i t s
effect on intellectual history. The chronological boundaries may be listed as 15601714.
Emphasis is on the far-reaching changes in
the political, economic, cultural and social life of Denmark, Finland, Iceland,
Norway and Sweden during the nineteenth and early twentieth centuries.
Attention i s given to overseas emigration.
463 M O D E R N SOUTHEAST ASIA
A study of the major historical events,
personalities and political developments
i n this area. A comparative analysis of the
nationalist movements and the process of
decolonization will especially focus o n
Indonesia, the Philippines, Burma and
Vietnam.
464 M O D E R N CHINA
A selective treatment of Chinese history
since the Opium Warof 1839.Theerosion
of China's isolationism and collapse of the
imperial system. The Nationalist and
Communist revolutions o f the 20th
century.
465 M O D E R N JAPAN
An examination of the emergence of
Japan as a major world power i n the 20th
century. Components of the course will
include a study of the distinctive features
of t h e Pre-Meiji era, modernization
factors since 1868, interaction and encounter with China, urban development,
ecological problems, role of women and
Japan's trade i n Asia and Africa.
breakdown of these imperial systems at
the end of the 18th Century.
495 SEMINAR
Selected topics. Admission by permission
of the instructor. (Fall, Spring)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Majors with an average of 3.5 or above i n
history courses are encouraged t o apply
for directed independent study. A maximum of one course i n independent study
may be applied toward the major.
474 THE WORLD A N D THE WEST
114 H U M A N GEOGRAPHY
This course begins with Europe's discovery of the rest of the world, considers
cultural interaction and conflict, and the
building of European empires i n Asia and
the Americas, and concludes with the
An introduction t o the basicconceptsand
tools of geography followed by a survey of
the distribution patterns t o be found in
our physical and human environment.
MATHEMATICS
Chairperson: Beverly Durkee
MAJOR: 9 courses including 124,125,215,
224, 314, 324. Also required: Computer
Science 245. For teacher licensure,
courses 351, 373, 441 must be included.
Students wishing to become licensed
teachers are advised t o consult with the
Education Department for requirements.
M I N O R : 5 courses including 124,125,224.
H O N O R S MAJOR: GPA of 3.5 i n mathematics; 3.1 overall. Comprehensive oral
examination. Program must be submitted
t o department during first term of junior
year, and must include advanced study i n
areas of Analysis, Algebra, Topology, and
Mathematics-Education.
104 BASIC MATHEMATICS
A review of basic arithmetic concepts and
a study of algebraic expressions including
exponents, radicals, and rational expressions; algebraic processes including factoring; solving equations and inequalities
i n one variable, including linear and
quadratic; and graphs of linear and
quadratic equations and linear inequalities in two variables. Does not apply
toward a major or ,,,inor in mathematics.
Does not satisfy the general education
requirement
in mathematics.
114 [NTRODUC-lON T O COLLEGE
ALGEBRA A N D TRIGONOMETRY
Fundamental operations, factoring, factions, f u n c t i o n s a n d graphs, l i n e a r
equations, exponents a n d radicals,
quadratic equations, ratio and variation,
progressions, binomial theorem, logarithms
and trigonometric functions. Does not
apply toward a major or minor i n mathematics. Students who have completed 124
may register for credit only with consent
of instructor. (Fall)
121 FINITE MATHEMATICS
Topics of linearity and probability with
applications t o the social and behavioral
sciences. Does not apply toward a major
or minor in mathematics. (Fall)
122 CALCULUS FOR THE SOCIAL A N D
BEHAVIORAL SCIENCES
Differential and integral calculus of a
single variable with applications t o the
social and behavioral sciences. Does not
apply toward a major or minor in mathematics. Students who have completed 124
may not register for credit. (Spring)
124, 125, 224 CALCULUS, I, 11, 111
Topics of the elements of plane and solid
analytic geometry integrated with differential and integral calculus including
calculus of several variables and series
with applications primarily from the
physical sciences. Primarily for students i n
the natural sciences. (724, Fall; 725,
Spring; 224, Fall)
211 NUMBER THEORY
A transitional course from computational
to abstract mathematics. A study of the
integers and their properties. (Prereq.: #)
215 ELEMENTARY LINEAR ALGEBRA
A study of systems of linear equations,
determinants, vector spaces, linear transformations, and matrices. (Prereq.: 224.
Spring)
226 DIFFERENTIAL EQUATIONS
Solutions of ordinary differential equations with applications; solutions by
special integral transforms; systems of
differential equations with matrix algebra
techniques; series solutions. (Prereq.:
224. Spring)
242 BASIC CONCEPTS O F
MATHEMATICS
The structure of mathematics underlying
arithmetic and geometry. Emphasis is
placed on the inductive techniques of
discovery. Includes the ideas of modern
elementary school mathematics curricula.
Does not apply toward a major or minor in
mathematics. (Prereq.: Admission to Elementary Education Program)
314 INTRODUCTION T O MODERN
ALGEBRA
131 MATHEMATICS FOR THE ARTS
A n i n t r o d u c t i o n t o t h e structure of
mathematical systems and mathematical
models which have had a primary historical impact on the other liberal arts.
Primarily f o r students n o t i n t e n d i n g
further study of mathematics. Does not
apply toward a major or minor i n mathematics. (Fall)
A rigorous investigation of the basic structures of algebra including groups, rings,
integral domains and fields. (Prereq.: 275.
Fa/ I )
324,325 ADVANCED CALCULUS I, I1
A study of the fundamental concepts of
calculus for functions of several variables,
including the topology of Euclidean
spaces, transformations, sequences and
series of functions, improper integrals,
differential forms and manifolds, and
vector analysis. (Prereq.: 224.324, Spring;
325, Fall)
351 M O D E R N GEOMETRY
A study of Euclidean and other geometries
by synthetic, coordinate, vector and
transformation methods. (Prereq.: 122 or
125. Spring, 1982, and alternate years)
COMPUTER SCIENCE
145 INTRODUCTION T O GENERAL
COMPUTER PROGRAMMING
An introduction to computer methods
including flowcharts, algorithms, and data
representation. Extensive programming
in a non-scientific higher level language,
such as COBOL. Primarily for students in
non-science areas.
Does not apply toward a major or minor
in mathematics. (Spring. Computer fee)
373 PROBABILITY A N D STATISTICS
An analytic study of probability and statistics, including probability distributions
and densities, expectation, sampling distributions, central limit theorem, estimation, correlation and tests of hypotheses.
(Prereq.: 224. Fall)
399 INTERNSHIP
Consult Chairperson or Internship Director t o determine project.
441 FOUNDATIONS O F MATHEMATICS
Set theory, logic, axiomatic method, and
d e v e l o p m e n t o f n u m b e r systems.
(Prereq.: 314, 324, concurrent registration, or #. Spring, 1981. Offered alternate
years)
481 TOPICS I N MATHEMATICS
Study of advanced topics selected from
real or complex analysis, abstract algebra,
topology, probability, statistics, or computer science. (Prereq.: 314, 324, or #.
Spring)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Topics d e f i n e d throu.gh consultation
between student and department.
245 INTRODUCTION T O SCIENTIFIC
COMPUTER PROGRAMMING
An introduction to computer languages
and methods.Techniques studied include
flowcharts, algorithms, data representation and manipulation, hardware register
operations, and computer organization.
Programming in machine language, assembly language, and FORTRAN. Examples and applications primarily from
science areas. Does not apply toward a
major or minor in mathematics. (Prereq:
Math 125 or #. Fall. Computer fee)
355 COMPUTER SCIENCE A N D
NUMERICAL METHODS
A study of methods used to solve problems
on computers. Analysis of computational
problems and development of algorithms
for their solutions, application of a procedure-oriented programming language
in numerical analysis. Topics include the
general concept of iterative formulas,
solution of equations, Newton's method,
linear systems, interpolation, numerical
differentiation and integration. Credit
may be granted toward a mathematics
major or minor. (Prereq: C.S. 245 and
Math. 224 or concurrent registration. Fall)
Medical Technology
This major involves the completion of Required science courses: 1) Biology 111,
three years of academicwork at Augsburg 112 and two additional upper division
College and twelve months of internship (usually 367 and 476); 2) Chemistry: 105,
at Hennepin County Medical Center,
106 (or 115,116), 351, 352,353; 3) Physics:
Metropolitan Medical Center or North- 103 (or 121, 122); one math course; one
western Hospital. Specific recommended course in immunology.
courses vary t o some extent depending
on the hospital with which the students
Students transferring to Augsburg Colplan to affiliate. I t i s important to work
lege with an Associate of Artsdegreeor i t s
closely with the Medical Technology
equivalent should expect to spend two
adviser. Augsburg College does not guaryears at Augsburg before participating in
antee that all students will be accepted by
the internship year. The Medical Technothe hospitals for the 12-month internship.
logy major is not designed for persons
Students must negotiate directly with the
w h o already have t h e baccalaureate
hospitals involved.
- degree from another institution.
Metro-Urban Studies Clnterdisciplinaryl
Director: Carry W. Hesser
MAJOR: 15-courses including the following core requirements: Economics
123; Political Science 122; History 431;
Sociology 111, 381; Either Economics 379
or Sociology 362; Political Science 384 or
Sociology 363; a minimum of one course
of internship or independent study; plus
two urban-related non-social science
courses with an urban emphasis, at least
one of which must be i n the humanities
(current options include: Art 102, Religion 354, English 351, Speech 342, Physics
103, Biology 101, 105).
To complete the major, the student has a
choice among three emphases or tracks:
Planning, Public Administration, or
GeneraVLiberal Arts. These five courses
must include a minimum of three disciplines. Options include a wide variety of
courses, interims, internships, independent studies, and urban courses at other
ACTC colleges, as well as those offered
through the Higher Educational Consortium for Urban Affairs (see below).
M I N O R : To be linked with appropriate
majors (such as business administration,
history, political science, psychology, religion, sociology, speech). The following
core courses are required forthe Concentration: Economics 120; Political Science
122; Sociology 111; Sociology 381; an
a p p r o v e d Social Science Research
course; an approved internship and/or
independent study.
498 INDEPENDENT STUDY METROPOLITAN RESOURCES
An independently designed course a student (or group of students) develops,
making extensive, systematic and integrated utilization of resources available in
t h e m e t r o p o l i t a n c o m m u n i t y , e.g.
lectures, symposia, performances, hear-
ings. These resources become the core of
the course, supplemented by traditional
college resources. The course is designed
in consultation with and evaluated by a
department faculty member.
consultation with MUST faculty, student
selects a specific topic for library and/or
field research related t o subjects of
seminars and/or major academic interests.
Other Urban Studies options available
through the Higher Educational Consortium for Urban Affairs (HECUA):
B. Scandinavian Urban Studies Term
(SUST)
A. Metro-Urban Studies Term (MUST)
This program focuses upon the Twin City
metropolitan area.
358 READINGS SEMINAR: URBAN
ISSUES
Reading materials are assigned to complement morning field seminar topics. Included are government and institution
publications, journal articles and books.
359 FIELD SEMINAR: T W I N CITIES
METROPOLITAN AREA
Using the community as a classroom,
students visit agencies, talk with specialists i n various fields, and investigate current issues in the Twin Cities area. Topics
include: geography, government, economics, historic preservation, populations, ethnic communities, transportation, planning and social services.
399 INTERNSHIP
Students are placed in a variety of public
and private agenciesfor work experience.
A learning contract is developed with
MUST faculty approval. Students may
choose an internship of one or two
courses.
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY (Optional)
Independent Study i s done in conjunction with a one-course internship. In
This program is located at the University
of Oslo and focuses upon Scandinavian
urbanization and city planning.
372 NORWEGIAN LANGUAGE
A N D CULTURE
Students are placed in beginning, intermediate or advanced study. depending
on
.
proficiency. Instruction emphasizes conversational vocabulary t o support student
course work and daily living i n Oslo. An
orientation t o current issues in Norwegian life and society i s coordinated
with the language instruction.
373 G R O W T H A N D DEVELOPMENT O F
SCANDINAVIAN CITIES
Themes on the growth, function, distribution, and social organization of Scandinavian cities are approached through a
combination of lectures, guest speakers,
and field work. Emphasis is placed o n
Norwegian urban development w i t h
comparative analysis of other Scandinavian countries.
396 URBAN PLANNING IN
SCANDINAVIA
Theory and practice of Scandinavian approaches to urban development are
viewed through a series of topical lectures, field trips, and guest speakers.
Course focus is on the Norwegian planning system with comparative analysis of
other Scandinavian countries.
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
363 FIELD SEMINAR: WEALTH,
POVERTY, A N D C O M M U N I T Y
DEVELOPMENT I N THE LATIN
AMERICAN CITY
In consultation with SUST faculty, student
selects a specific topic for library and field
research related to subjects of seminar
and/or major academic interests.
Structured field course focusing on plight
and prospects of the urban poor in Bogota,
with field trips to other Colombian and
foreign cities for comparison. Visits t o
various types of barrios and to public and
private agencies dealing w i t h urban
problems.
C. South American Urban Semester
(SA U S)
This "semester in the city" program is
located i n Bogota, Columbia. I t
focuses upon urbanization and development in the Third World.
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
I n c o n s u l t a t i o n w i t h SAUS faculty,
student .elects a specific topic for library
and/or field research related to subjects
o f seminar and/or major academic
interests.
261 SPANISH LANGUAGE
Spanish instruction at intermediate or
advanced levels.
D. San Francisco Summer Term
An eight-week program integrating a
field seminar, an internship, and in-
362 PROSEMINAR: URBANIZATION I N
LATIN AMERICA
-
Readings.
discussions, and lectures in
" ,
both English and Spanish, with aid of
SAUS staff and v i s i t i n g C o l u m b i a n
urbanists.
-382
dependent study.
FIELD EN'ERlENCE
383 FIELD SEMINAR: sAN FRANCISCO
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Music
Chairperson: Robert Karlen
Students wishing t o major in Music at
Augsburg College must make application
t o the Music Faculty for acceptance into
the programs. Such application should be
made by the beginning of the sophomore
year. (See Music Department handbook
for further details.)
CORE CURRICULUM: All music majors
must take the Core Curriculum of 6 music
courses: 101,102,223,224,260,261;
pass a
piano proficiency test, perform in music
organizations for 3 years, participate i n
Performance Workshop, and pass 3 music
repertoire tests.
MAJOR: 12 courses: Core Curriculum
described above, plus 350 or 476; 354 or
355; 365 or 375; 457, 458; 4 years of
Performance Studies; recital performance.
TEACHING M A J O R : 11 courses: Core
Curriculum plus 350 or 476; 457,458; two
of 354,355,365,375; 3 years of Performance
Studies; education courses; and recital
performance. Consult with Department
of Education for requirements i n
education.
BACHELOR O F M U S I C DEGREE:
17
courses: Core Curriculum plus 350, 457,
458,476; two of 354,355,365,375,499 and
electives; 4 years of Performance Studies
with double periods in the last two years,
and junior and senior recitals.
MAJOR IN MUSIC THERAPY (Bachelor of
Science Degree): Core Curriculum plus
350 or 476; 354; 355 or 365; 457 or 458; 3
years of Performance Studies in'cluding at
least one term of voice; recital performance optional: Music Therapy 360, 382,
383, 395, 399, 435, 495; Psych. 105, 362,
and one of 264, 351, 355, 356, 357; Soc.
241 and one of 111,121,231,375; elective
in physical education (232 recommended);
elective i n speech (116 recommended). A
maximum of 17 courses in Music and
Music Therapy may be applied toward the
35 courses required for graduation.
Students need t o apply for internshipsites
nine months in advance of starting date.
Since the number of sites in Minnesota i s
limited, students may need to seek outof-state internship placements.
This major normally requires four and
one-half years for completion. Upon satisfactory completion of the program, the
student i s eligible to apply for certification/registration with the National Association for Music Therapy, Inc.
M I N O R : 5 courses, 101, 102, 260 or 261,
458 and elective; plus 1 year of Performance Studies; 2 years in music organ-
izations; piano proficiency; and 2 music
r e p e r t o i r e tests. A t t e n d a n c e at all
Performance Workshops during the year
of Performance Studies and 8 campus
recitals also required.
Those wishing t o minor in music should
declare their intent by the end of their
sophomore year, or at the completion of
Theory 102.
H O N O R S MAJOR: Students may qualify
for graduation honors i n music if they (1)
provide leadership in: the promotion of
higher music performance standards
within the Department of Music; breadth
of musical interests by attendance at concerts both on and off campus; the performing organizations; the creation and/
or promotion of smaller performing
ensembles; (2) have earned a GPA of at
least 3.3 i n music courses; and (3) apply for
the Honors Program at the beginning of
the second term of the junior year.
Honors may be achieved by any one of
the following ways: (1) two solo recitalsof
graduate quality; (2) a musical composit i o n f o r vocal and/or instrumental
ensemble of not less than 15 minutes
duration and either a senior thesis and its
defense before a faculty committee of a
solo recital of graduate quality; (3) a
senior thesis and i t s defense before a
faculty committee and a solo recital of
graduate quality.
Performance Workshop and Recital Requirements: Attendance at Performance
Workshop and 14 campus faculty and
student recitals is required of sophomore,
junior and senior music majors. Music
minors must attend 8 faculty and student
recitals as well as all Performance Workshops during the year of their Performance Studies. All music majors and
minors must register for Performance
Workshop at no credit. A recital in their
area of Performance Studies concentration
is required of majors during either the
junior or senior year, except Music Therapy majors. A recital in their area of
Performance Studies concentration is
required of Bachelors of Music in both
their junior and senior years.
Piano Profiency Requirement: All majors
and minors are required to pass a piano
proficiency examination by the end of the
sophomore year. Confer with department
regarding specific requirements.
During the junior and senior years, a
student who has been certified by the
Department of Music as a major for the
Bachelor of Arts or Bachelor of Music
degree, receives required lessons in the
area of his concentration without extra
cost. The total of Performance Studies
credits earned under this provision may
not exceed four semesters of weekly halfhour lessons.
TRANSFER STUDENTS I N MUSIC: A
junior or senior student transferring to
Augsburg College as a music major must
take a placement test in music theory
before registration. Application f o r
acceptance into a music program should
be made at the end of the student's first
term at Augsburg, after passing the piano
proficiency test.
101,102, 223, 224 THEORY
Music Theory i s an integrated course
extending over four terms. Taught by a
team of instructors, the various aspects of
musical theory (i.e., ear training, harmony, counterpoint, and analysis) are
presented i n parallel, rather than i n
sequence. (101,223, Fall. 102,224, Spring)
350 CHORAL TECHNIQUE A N D
ARRANGING
Fundamentals of voice culture as related
to choral ensemble; methods, materials,
techniques and arranging. (Spring)
354 INSTRUMENTAL TECHNIQUE
The technique of playing and teaching
brass and percussion instruments. (Fall)
230 INTRODUCTION T O THE FINE ARTS
355 INSTRUMENTAL TECHNIQUE
The development of music through the
study of selected works of great composers from each period. Emphasis i s
placed upon relationships between music
and the other fine arts. For the non-music
major (Fall, Spring)
260 HISTORY A N D LITERATURE
OF MUSIC
The technique of playing and teaching
woodwind instruments. (Spring)
365 INSTRUMENTAL TECHNIQUE
Elementary technique i n the playing and
teaching of string instruments. (Fall)
375 INSTRUMENTAL TECHNIQUE
Music of the Baroque and Classical eras.
(Fa 11)
261 HISTORY A N D LITERATURE
O F MUSIC
Music of the Romantic and Modern eras.
(Spring)
325 SCANDINAVIAN M U S I C
I n a historical approach to the study of
music in the five Nordic countries, opportunity is offered for investigation into
topics of particular interest. Suitable for
both non-music and music majors.
330 VOCAL REPERTOIRE
A historical survey of solo vocal literature
from 1600 to the present. The study includes such aspects of concern for the
performer as interpretation, style, and
diction. (Fall)
Advanced technique i n the playing and
teaching of string instruments. (Spring)
380 MUSIC O F THE WESTERN C H U R C H
Development and influence of the music
of the Christian church. Designed for the
general student as well as for organists,
choir directors, and pre-theological students. (Fall)
440 ADVANCED MUSICIANSHIP
Offers an opportunity to apply information and techniques acquired i n music
theory and history classes t o the study of
20th century music. (Prereq. :224. Spring,
alternate years)
457 CONDUCTING
Techniques of conducting, preparation
of and conducting choral scores, organization of choral ensembles. (Fall)
458 CONDUCTING
Preparation of and conducting instrumental scores, organization of instrumental ensembles. (Spring)
476 ORCHESTRATION
The craft of orchestrating and arranging
music for instrumental ensembles of
varying sizes and types. (Fall)
488,489 PIANO TEACHING METHODS
Instruction in the principles, methods,
and techniques for teaching piano. students will give individual lessons to
d r e n under t h e supervision o f t h e
instructor. No course credit. (Fall, Spring)
382 PSYCHOLOGICAL FOUNDATIONS
OF MUSlC I
An objective approach t o musical stimuli
and response, with an emphasis on the
socio-psychological aspects of music. An
understanding of the research process
and development of an experimental research project.
383 PSYCHOLOGICAL FOUNDATIONS
O F M U S l C II
Implementation of group and individual
research projects, emphasis on music in a
clinical setting. Various theories of learning music, musical talent, and performance. (Prereq.: 382)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
395 INFLUENCE O F M U S I C O N
BEHAVIOR
Permits advanced and specialized studies
and projects not otherwise provided for
in the departmental curriculum. Open
only to advanced students upon approval
of a member of the faculty. (Fall, Spring)
A study of man as he relates to music, with
emphasis on psychological, cultural, and
biological aspects of musical behavior.
MUSIC THERAPY
110 INTRODUCTION T O M U S l C
THERAPY
A survey of the music therapy programs in
the surrounding area, with field trips to
various institutions; an i n t r o d u c t o r y
course for the freshmen and sophomores
considering music therapy as a major;
gives the students a broad background in
the ways in which music is used as a
therapy. (Interim)
360 THERAPEUTIC RECREATIONAL
MUSlC
Study of guitar and other non-symphonic
instruments; basic understanding of OrffSchulwerk; applications t o clinical settings. (Fall)
399 MUSICAL THERAPY CLINICAL
INTERNSHIP
Full-time placement in an internship setting approved by the National Association
for Music Therapy for six months. This is
started after completion of thesenior year
and is necessary for registration by the
NAMT. Applications for internship sites
must be made nine months i n advance.
Sites i n Minnesota are limited.
435 MUSlC I N THERAPY
The study and application of the uses of
music with the emotionally ill, mentally
retarded, and physically handicapped.
(Prereq.: 395)
495 PRACTICUM
IN
THERAPY
Volunteer work in a clinical setting, two
hours a week, six terms. No credit.
PERFORMANCE WORKSHOPS
An informal setting for student performmces, seminars, and guest lecture dem~nstrations.
Voice
Correct habits of pronunciation and articulation, breath control, flexibility, ear
training as needed, interpretation of
songs.
RECITALS
Woodwind, Brass, String, and Percussion
Student recitals afford an opportunity for
public performance and acquaint
students with all aspects of preparation
a quality perforand presentation
mance.
Instruments: Technique as
ertoire~performance.
rep-
MUSIC ORGANIZATIONS
The music organizations exist not onlyfor
the benefit of the music student, but for
any student of the college who wishes t o
PERFORMANCE STUDIES
participate in groups affording
- opportun. .
Vocal and instrumental instruction i s
ity for musical expression. The student
available t o all students. For statement of
must be carrying at least two courses each
fees, see under Financial Information. No term. Participation for the full Year is
course credit. (Fall, Spring)
required. No course credit.
Brass Ensemble**
Piano
Choir*
Technique as needed, repertoire, perforChorale**
mance, accompanying. Only those lessons Concert Band*
in piano taken after the piano proficiency
Jazz Ensemble**
examination has been passed may be apOrchestra*
plied toward the music major or minor.
String Ensemble**
Woodwind Ensemble**
Organ
*Membership by audition.
Technique as needed, repertoire, per**Membership by audition or consent
formance, hymn-playing, accompanying. - o f instructor.
Natural Science
Chairperson: Earl R. Alton
NATURAL SCIENCE MAJOR for teaching
in Secondary Schools.
The Minnesota Board o f ~ e a c h i nhas
~
approved the licensure program for
science teachers and has authorized
Augsburg to recommend candidates for
licensure in:
Life Science, grades 7-12
Life Science, (minor) grades 7-12
Physical Science, grades 7-12
Earth Science, grades 7-12
Earth Science, (minor) grades 7-12
Chemistry, (minor) grades 7-72
Physics, (minor) grades 7-12
Middle School Science, grade 5-9
PROGRAM COMPONENTS
The program of courses i s designed t o
provide a broad, basic background i n
science and allow for specialization in an
area. The following programs assume that
the student will meet the general educa-
tion requirements of the college and, i n
the physical science, have at least one year
of calculus.
BROAD BASE COURSES
7 COURSES
-
Seven courses comprise the set for the
broad base background.
1. Earth Science - 1 course
Physics 101 - Astronomy OR Physics
161 - Understanding the Weather
2. Life Science - 2 courses
Biology 111, 112 - General Biology
3. Physical Science - 4 courses
Physics 121, 122 - General Physics
Chemistry 115, 116 (or 105, 106) General Chemistry
I n order t o make the program slightly
more flexible, it i s recommended that
students with emphasis in life science
have both courses in earth science and
substitute Physics 103 - Physics for
Physics 121, 122 - General Physics.
LIFE SCIENCE EMPHASIS - 8 COURSES
1. Cognate - Chemistry 223 - Elementary Organic Chemistry
2. Biology Component - 7 courses
Biology 491 - Seminar
At least one course from each of the
following groups:
Group I Biology 351 - Invertebrate Zoology
OR Biology 353 - Comparative
Vertebrate Zoology
Group II Biology 355 - Genetics OR Biology
474 - Developmental Biology
Group 111 Biology 361 - Plant -Biology OR
Biology 474 - Ecology
Group IV Biology 471 - Cellular Biology OR
Biology 473 - Animal Physiology
Group v Biology 440 - Plant Physiology OR
Biology 476 - Microbiology
SCIENCE
- 7 COURSES
Candidates may be recommended for
licensure i n Physical Science upon comp l e t i o n o f e i t h e r Physical Science
Emphasis-Chemistry major or Physical
Science Emphasis-Physics major. The
student licensed in Physical Science may
teach chemistry and/or physics in grades
7-12.
1. Chemistry Major
Chemistry 351,352 - OrganicChemistry
Chemistry 353 - Quantitative Analytical Chemistry
Chemistry 361,362 -Physical Chemistry OR Biology 367 - Biochemistry
in place of Chemistry 362
Chemistry 482 - Advanced Inorganic
Chemistry
Chemistry 491 - Seminar (no credit)
Physics 245 - Modern physics
2. Physics Major
Physics 245 - Modern Physics
Physics 351 - Mechanics I
Physics 362 - Electromagnetic Fields I
Physics 395 - Comprehensive Laboratory
Three additional Physics courses t o be
selected from the following: Physics
261, Electronics; Physics 270, Optical
Physics; Physics 352, Mechanics II;
Physics 363, Electromagnetic Fields II;
Physics 481, Thermal Physics; Physics
486, Quantum Mechanics.
BROAD BASE FOR TEACHING SCIENCE
Grades 5-9 - 7 courses
1. Earth Science - 2 courses
Either Physics 101 - Astronomy OR
Physics 161 - Understanding t h e
Weather (the alternative course not
taken i n the BROAD BASE section)
2. Life Sciences - 2 courses
Any two biology courses above 112.
3. Physical Science - 3 courses
Chemistry 223 - Elementary Organic
Chemistry
Chemistry 353 - Quantitative Analytical Chemistry
Physics 245 - Modern Physics
CERTIFICATION W I T H M I N O R
Candidates requesting certification bas'ed
upon minor preparation in life science
shall complete 7 courses in Biology i n
addition to the BROAD BASE.
Candidates requesting certification based
upon minor preparation i n chemistry or
physics shall complete the broad basic
competencies and shall have an additional 4 courses in either Physics or Chemistry. For Chemistry, these are Chemistry
351,352 or 223,353,361 and 362 or 482. For
Physics, these are any four courses above
122.
Nursing
Chairperson: Beverly Nilsson
Augsburg offers an upper division major
i n nursing leading t o a Bachelor of
Science degree.
Requirements for admission to the major
are: completion of an associate degree or
diploma program i n nursing with a minimum overall grade point average of 2.5; a
current license to practice as an R.N. i n
the state of Minnesota; and completion of
courses i n inorganic chemistry, organic or
biochemistry, anatomy and physiology,
microbiology, English composition, introductory sociology and introductory psychology. Students must take these courses
at Augsburg or another accredited college or university prior t o admission t o the
nursing
- major.
.
I n addition, each applicant must successfully complete theoretical and simulated
clinical performance testing prior t o acceptance t o the major. These tests are
given at Augsburg through the Department of Nursing.
Applicants must give evidence of current
nursing clinical practice, i.e. within the
past five years. This may include I ) graduation from a school of nursing, 2) work
experience, or 3) completion of a nursing
refresher course or an acceptable equivalent.
MAJOR: 11 courses (10 course credits) i n
nursing including 303, 304, 310, 311, 325,
350,403,404,423,427, and 430. Speech 354
( I n t e r p e r s o n a l C o m m u n i c a t i o n s ) is
highly recommended. The required
courses i n sociology, psychology, English,
chemistry, and biology listed above may
apply toward distribution requirements as
well as toward admission t o the major. An
upper division science course is required
and must be completed during the first
year of study in the nursing major. This
is to be selected after consultation with a
nursing faculty advisor.
Courses in the nursing majoraredesigned
so that they may be completed within two
academic years. However, more than two
years may be required to complete the
total course of study, depending on the
number of credits transferred from other
colleges or universities.
303 CONTEMPORARY NURSING I
(!h course)
This course will present principles of
teaching and learning within a process
framework of assessment, planning, imp l e m e n t a t i o n a n d evaluation. The
students will have an opportunity t o assess
their own learning style, write behavioral
objectives and develop a teaching plan
for a selected client. (Fall-Junior year.
Prereq.: Acceptance into nursing major.)
304 CONTEMPORARY NURSING II
(1/2 course)
325 NURSING ASSESSMENT
I n this course the student will examine
elements of assessment and selected assessment tools in the nursing process.The
student will expand the use of communication skills for obtaining a health history
and negotiating health goals. A developmental framework will be used t o do a
holistic assessment of an elderly person.
(Fall-Junior year. Prereq.: Acceptance into the nursing major.)
350 INTRODUCTION T O NURSING
RESEARCH
Students will assess their own leadership
style and examine concepts of management as they relate t o the professional
nurse's role. (Spring-Junior year. Prereq.:
303.)
The research process and methods appropriate t o nursing are the focus of this
course. Issues of ethics i n nursing research are explored. Students will critique
nursing research and design a research
project. (Spring-Junior year. Prereq.: Acceptance into the nursing major.)
310 C O M M U N I T Y HEALTH NURSING I
403 CONTEMPORARY NURSING Ill
Focuses on systems theory, change theory
and concepts of health as they apply to
current community health issues and the
practice of nursing. Students will do a
health assessment of a client and will
explore a community health issue related
t o the course content. (Fall-Junior year.
Prereq.: Acceptance to the nursing major.)
This course will examine the diversity of
American families. Content includes the
structure and the role, rule and communication patterns of families in light of
situational and developmental crisis
events. The emerging role of the nurse in
providing family health care will be explored. (Fall-Senior year. Prereq.: 304,
377, 325, 350. To be taken prior to or
concurrently with Nursing 423.)
311 C O M M U N I T Y HEALTH NURSING II
404 CONTEMPORARY NURSING IV
This course provides a knowledge base
for understanding community values of
cultural groups as they relate to health
care and the nurse's role in a community
health team. Strong clinical component
for application of knowledge from Community Health I and [I. (Spring-Junior
year. Prereq.: 303, 370, 325.)
This course deals with the integration of
communication, leadership theory and
the professional nurse role in the context
of complex group interactions. (SpringSenior year. Prereq.: 403,430. To be taken
prior to or concurrently with Nursing
427.)
423 PRECEPTORSHIP IN NURSING I
The preceptorship practicum offers the
student an opportunity to implement a
negotiated learning contract in a selected
practice setting. This approach provides
opportunities for developing objectives,
selecting learning experiences and collaborating with faculty, preceptor(s),
client and agencies, in providing complex
nursing care. (Fall-Senior year. Prereq.:
To be taken concurrently with or followi n g Nursing 403.)
groups i n a selected practice setting.
(Spring-Senior year. Prereq.: 423, 430. To
be taken concurrently with or following
Nursing 404.)
430 TRENDS A N D ISSUES IN NURSING
A course designed t o investigate the current responsibilities of the professional
nurse. Contemporary social and professional trends and issues will be explored
in light of their implications for nursing
practice. (Interim. Prereq.: None.)
427 PRECEPTORSHIP IN NURSING I1
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
This course is designed in the same manner as Nursing 423. It i s a synthesis course
utilizing knowledge and skills from nursing and liberal arts courses. Opportunity
is provided to apply leadership theory t o
I n depth study of a learner-selected topic
or issue. Students must consult with
faculty and submit a written study proposal prior t o registration.
Philosophy
Chairperson: Kenneth Bailey
Courses 110, 120, and 130 are recommended for fulfilling the general education requirement.
MAJOR: 9 courses, including 130, 241,
242, 343, and 344.
110 I N T R O D U C T I O N T O PHILOSOPHY:
IDEAS A N D M E T H O D
M I N O R : 5 courses, including two courses
from 241,242, 343, and 344.
H O N O R S MAJOR: Admission t o the
Philosophy Honors program i s by recommendation of the philosophy faculty. Such
recommendations will be made at the end
of the junior year. The program will consist of an honors thesis on an approved
topic of the student's choice, involving
research above the course level, and a
defense of this thesis before the faculty of
the department.
Though each person has his own set of
ideas and beliefs, rarely have they been
critically analyzed or evaluated for their
consistency, adequacy or truth. One reason for this i s that individuals lack the
needed skills. Another is that they may
have had little opportunity to examine
critically some of the ideas basic to western culture. The purposes of this course
are to provide the student with some
experience i n examining ideas, and
thereby to sharpen the critical and analytical skills required t o evaluate and construct a system of ideas and beliefs. (Fall,
Spring)
120 ETHICS
Sometimes you say that a certain action i s
right or condemn it as wrong. Why do you
think it i s right? Because you like it? Are
there better reasons for thinking something right or wrong? This course takes a
long, hard look at possible grounds for
making moral decisions, and at the moral
judgments about personal and social
issues resulting from them. (Fall, Spring)
130 L O G I C
Suppose someone gives you reasons, and
then says you must accept a particular
conclusion. Must you? When does a conclusion follow from premises? Here we
examine the rules which govern valid
arguments and work to develop your
ability to recognize and construct sound
arguments. (Fall, Spring).
241 HISTORY O F PHILOSOPHY I: P L A T 0
A N D ARISTOTLE
How, when and why did philosophy begin? Who were Socrates, Plato, Aristotle
and the Stoics; what did they believe?
Why did Plato think that the physical
world was not overly important, and what
did he value? How did Aristotle, the
scientist, respond to this? The answers to
these and other questions will be considered as to reveal what these great
philosophers can contribute to our contemporary problems and ideas. (Fall)
242 HISTORY O F PHILOSOPHY 11:
MEDIEVAL A N D RENAISSANCE
PHILOSOPHY
The Middle Ages are often regarded as a
period of darkness, whereas the Renaissance was a time of rediscovery and
enlightenment. H o w dark were t h e
Middle Ages; how enlightened the Renaissance?We shall attempt t o discover the
grandeur of the Medieval philosophers,
learn how the Christian tradition was
carried forward i n the Age of Faith, explore the worship of the world and the
individual i n the Renaissanceand the new
methodology of the 17th Century rationalists. (Spring. Suggested prior course,
247.)
343 HISTORY O F PHILOSOPHY Ill:
ENLIGHTENMENT A N D 19TH
CENTURY PHILOSOPHY
Where does knowledge begin? I n innate
ideas or with experience? What can we
really know about the world? What impact did Romanticism have on philosophy? This course studies the major
empiricists of the 18th century (Locke,
Berkeley, Hume). Kant's synthesis of philosophy, 19th century idealism, and the
reaction to idealism in men such as Marx,
Kierkegaard and Nietzsche. (Fall. Suggested prior course, 247 or 242.)
344 HISTORY O F PHILOSOPHY IV:
C O N T E M P O R A R Y PHILOSOPHY
What lies behind 20th century philosophy's love affair with language? I s truth
that which works? Can we remake philosophy as a rigorous science? These and
other issues are dealt with in astudy of the
m a j o r representatives o f l i n g u i s t i c
analysis, pragmatism, existentialism, and
phenomenology. (Spring. Suggested
prior course, 247, 242, or 343.)
350 PHILOSOPHY O F RELIGION
What is the relation between faith and
reason? Does God exist, and what can be
said about him if he does? Can we reconcile the goodness of God with human and
animal suffering? I s man really immortal?
Are miracles possible?We intend to conduct a systematic inquiry into these questions which form the basis of religious
beliefs. (Suggested: one prior course in
philosophy.)
355 ORIENTAL PHILOSOPHY
A study of the basic concepts and philosophies which underlie Hinduism, Buddhism, Confucianism and Taoism. (Suggested: one prior course in philosophy.)
360 PHILOSOPHY O F LANGUAGE
Every day we use language to buy and sell,
praise and berate, communicate with
friends. What i s language? Could an individual be fully human without it? How
does language relate to the world - can
we really learn about the nature of things
from words? Do the mathematician and
the scientist have a language?I s it possible
to have a language which only one individual can understand?We shall explore
how philosophers have responded to
these and other important questions
about language. (Suggested prior course,
730 or 344.)
365
PHILOSOPHY O F SCIENCE
The scientist's knowledge of the world i s
purported to be profoundly different and
better than that of the non-scientist. I s this
true? What constitutes scientific knowledge? Are there certain real questions
which science cannot answer? How certain are the methods used by the scientist
to recover knowledge? In addition to
dealing with these questions,students will
work in researching and developing philosophical problems i n the special
sciences. (Suggested prior course, 730 or
one course in natural science.)
370 EXISTENTIALISM
Studies in the writings - both philosophical and literary - of prominent
Existentialist authors. We will examine
what it means to be a being-in-the-world,
and explore such themes as absurdity,
freedom, guilt, despair and paradox.
(Suggested: One prior course in philosophy)
380 MEDICAL ETHICS
Application of ethical principles to
problems which arise in the areas of
health care and delivery, human experimentation, human engineering, abortion,
care for the dying and euthanasia.
410 TOPICS I N PHILOSOPHY
Advanced studies covering a specific area
of philosophy, such as studies in the
thought of individual philosophers, philosophical movements, the history of an
idea or specific problem, or interdisciplinary problems. Seminar format. May
be taken more than once for credit.
(Suggested prior courses, any from 247,
242, 343, 344 or #.)
430 STUDIES I N INDIVIDUAL
PHILOSOPHERS
Advanced studies in the philosophy of
particular philosophers, e.g., Plato,
Descartes, Marx, Hegel, Kierkegaard,
Wittgenstein, etc. Seminar format. (Suggestion prior courses: 247, 242, 343, or #)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Individual study and research on some
philosophical topic of interest to the
student, worked out in consultation with
the faculty adviser.
Physical Education and Health Education
Chairperson: Ernest Anderson
PHYSICAL E D U C A T I O N
PHYSICAL E D U C A T I O N M A J O R : H.Ed.
114, 115, 354, 355; P.E. 223, 231, 232, 350,
351, 471, 472, 474, 475; Biol. 103.
PHYSICAL E D U C A T I O N T E A C H I N G
M A J O R : H.Ed. 114, 115, 354,355; P.E.223,
231, 232, 243, 350, 351, 365, 471, 472, 474;
Biol. 103. Students wishing to become
licensed teachers should consult with the
Education Department for requirements.
PHYSICAL E D U C A T I O N M A J O R W l T H
SPECIALIZATION I N CORRECTIVE
THERAPY: H.Ed. 114, 115, 354, 355; P.E.
223, 231, 232, 243, 350, 351, 471, 472, 474,
491, 495; Biol. 103; Psychology 105, 355,
362. Approval for admission to Corrective
Therapy major must be secured from the
corrective therapy coordinator.
PHYSICAL E D U C A T I O N M A J O R W I T H
SPECIALIZATION IN ADAPTED PHYSICAL
EDUCATION: H.Ed. 114,115,354,355; P.E.
223, 231, 232, 243, 350, 351, 365, 471, 472,
474, 485, 491; Biol. 103.
PHYSICAL EDUCATION M I N O R : H.Ed.
114,115; P.E. 223,231,232 or 472, and 243.
C O A C H I N G ENDORSEMENT: H.Ed. 114,
115; P.E. 243,350,351,475, one of 476-480,
and practicum in coaching (Practicum
requires registration for Independent
Study 499).
Physical education major plus coaching
practicum meets the coaching requirement.
234 O U T D O O R EDUCATION
This course will look at a wide variety of
outdoor activities that can be taught in a
school setting. The following activities will
be emphasized: Canoeing, back-packing,
cycling, outdoor cooking, camping and
water safety. Students must be prepared
t o spend some weekends participating in
these activities. (7/2 course. Spring)
243 HISTORY A N D PRINCIPLES O F
PHYSICAL EDUCATION
Coaches e n t e r i n g t h e i r f i r s t h e a d coaching assignment i n Minnesota high
schools are required t o have at least a
coaching endorsement in the field of
physical education and athletics.
102, 103 LIFETIME SPORTS
Three hours per week.Two lifetime sports
meet the general education requirement.
No course credit. (Fall, Spring)
History, principles, and philosophy of
physical education. (Spring)
Mechanics of movement with special
emphasis upon the action of the muscular
system. (Prereq.: Biology 703; Fall)
351 PHYSIOLOGY O F EXERCISE
Theory and practice i n skills, teaching,
and officiating team sports. (Spring)
The major effects of exercise upon the
systems of the body and physiological
principles applied to exercise programs
and motor training. (Prereq.: Biol. 703.
Spring)
231 INDIVIDUAL A N D DUAL SPORTS
354 TEACHING THE EXCEPTIONAL
223 TEAM SPORTS
CHILD
Theory and practice i n skills, teaching,
and officiating individual and dual sports.
(Fall)
(See Health Education)
355 TESTS A N D MEASUREMENT
232 RECREATIONAL ACTIVITIES A N D
RHYTHMS
Theory and practice i n teaching recreational activities, social recreation, quiet
games, low organized games, noon-hour
activities, camp nights, modified games,
simple rhythmic games, folk and square
dancing. (7/2 course. Interim)
(See Health Education)
365 PHYSICAL EDUCATION METHODS
(K-12)
Procedures, materials, and issues for
teaching physical education at the elementary and secondary levels. (Fall)
373 MODERN DANCE
An introductory course in modern dance
technique and creative composition. Exploration of movement, energy, form,
and design. No previous dance experience
necessary. (1/2 course. Interim)
476 COACHING OF FOOTBALL
'/Z course
Theory, technique and administrative aspects of coaching football. (% course. Fall,
1st half of term, odd # years only)
477 COACHING OF BASKETBALL
% course
399 INTERNSHIP
Consult department chairperson
471 PHYSICAL EDUCATION PROGRAMMING
Curriculum analysis and preparation. Administrative techniques and procedures.
(Prereq.: 243. Fall)
472 GYMNASTICS
Theory and techniques of teaching gymnastics, stunts, tumbling, and special fitness activities. (7/2 course. Fall)
474 SWIMMING AND AQUATICS
Theory and practice in teaching swimming, life-saving, and water safety. Open
only to junior and senior P.E. majors and
minors. (Prereq: Swimming competence
as determined by pre-test or satisfactory
completion of Lifetime Sports, Swimming.
1/2 course. Fall)
475 PREVENTION AND CARE OF ATHLETIC INJURIES1/2 course
Emphasis placed on preventing injuries.
Treatment of common athletic injuries.
Practical experience in taping and training-room procedures. (Prereq.: 350. Spring,
1st half of term)
Theory, technique and administrative
aspects of coaching basketball. (Fall, 2nd
half of term, odd # years only)
478 COACHING OF HOCKEY '/2 course
Theory, technique and administrative
aspects of coaching hockey. (Fall, 2nd half
of term, odd # years only)
479 COACHING OF TRACK AND FIELD
'/Z course
Theory, technique and administrative aspects of coaching track and field. (Spring,
2nd half of term, odd # years only)
480 COACHING OF BASEBALL/SOFTBALL % course
Theory, technique and administrative aspects of coaching baseball and softball.
(Spring, 2nd half of term, odd years)
485 APPLIED ADAPTED ACTIVITIES
Course includesconsideration of ambulation, self care, adapted sports and games,
and swimming for the handicapped. (Prereq.: 350, 351; H.Ed. 354. Summer school
only)
491 THERAPEUTIC EXERCISE
A study of the treatment of disease and
injury. Includes general principles and
administration of neuro-muscular re-
education. (Prereq.: 350, 351; H.Ed 354
Summer school only)
HEALTH EDUCATION
HEALTH EDUCATION MAJOR: 110,114,
495, 496, 497 pROFESSlONAL
AFFILIATlON
115, 320, 354, 410; ~ i ~103,
l . 108, 111;
Hospital affiliation of 444 hours required.
Chem. 103 or 105;
105;
231,
Includes actual hospital experience i n
241.
four areas of corrective therapy: (1) Psychiatry, (2) Orthopedics, (3) Neurology,
and (4)Rehabilitation. Course497 isstudy
o f Neurology and Pathology (Prereq. 485,
HEALTH EDUCATION TEACHING M A 491 and approval o f department.)
]OR: Same as health education major plus
H.Ed. 35% and Educ. sequence for teachi n g license.
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Directed intensive study i n an area of
physical education. O p e n only t o junior
or senior majors.
HEALTH EDUCATION MINOR: 110,114,
115, 320; Biol. 103; Soc. 231,
110 PERSONAL A N D C O M M U N I T Y
HEALTH
354 T E A C H I N G T H E E X C E P T I O N A L
CHILD % course
Modern concepts and practices of health
and healthful living applied t o the individual and the community. (Fall)
Education of the exceptional child with
special reference t o the analysis of functional and organic abnormalities and the
role of school health and physical education programs. (Prereq.: P.E. 350. Spring)
114 SAFETY EDUCATION % course
Princi~lesand practices of safety education i n school and community life. Includes American Red Cross First Aid
course. (Fall, Spring)
115 CHEMICAL DEPENDENCY EDUCAT l O N '/z course
An analysis of chemical abuse and what
can be done for the abuser. (Fall, Spring)
320 SCHOOL HEALTH CURRICULUM
Techniques for developing a course of
study based upon growth and development for grades K-12. Special work units
in nutrition and diseases. (Prereq.: A l l
courses i n the major sequence numbered
i n the 700 and 200 series; also #.)
355 TESTS A N D MEASUREMENT '/2 course
Survev of basic statistical ~roceduresand
evaluation of tests in heaith and physical
education. (spring)
410 ADMINISTRATION AND SUPERVIS l O N O F THE S C H O O L HEALTH
PROGRAM
Historical background,legal bases,school
health services, and relationships t o community health program and resources.
Methods and materials in health education with laboratory experience i n classroom and community. (Prereq.: 320)
Physics
-
Chairperson: Kenneth Erickson
M A J O R : 9 courses, including 121, 122,
245, 351, 362 and 395 plus three courses
above 122. I n planning their courses of
study, students are encouraged to work
closely with members of the physics
faculty. Normally, students should have
Mathematics 124,125, and Physics121,122
the freshman year, and Mathematics 224
and 226 the sophomore year.
M I N O R : 5 courses, including 121, 122,
and three courses above 122.
-
-
H O N O R S MAJOR: A GPA of 3.6 i n physics and 3.0 overall. An independent
investigation of a physics topic with an
oral defense of the written research report. Application for the honors major
should be made no later than the first
term of the senior year.
TEACHING MAJOR: The same as the
major. Students are advised to refer to the
Education Department section of the
catalog and consult with the Education
Department early i n their planning.
SOCIETY OF PHYSICS STUDENTS: The
Augsburg chapter of Society of Physics
Students provides students the opportunities of membership in a national physics society and of participating i n the
physics community o n a professional
basis. Membership in SPS i s open to all
students interested in physics.
SIGMA PI SIGMA: Membership in the
Augsburg chapter of this national physics
honor society is open t o those students
who have completed the equivalent of a
minor i n physics and have a GPA of 3.0 in
physics and 3.0 overall.
101 ASTRONOMY
A descriptive course requiring elementary
algebra. Our solar system, stars and
galaxies. The necessary optical instruments are explained and use i s made of a
12-inch reflecting telescope, and eightinch Celestron, as well as a 3-inch Questar.
Occasional night viewing. (3 one-hour
lectures. Fall, Spring)
103
FOR
LIFE SCIENCES
An introductory course in which the
applications, problems, and experiments
are selected not only to illustrate fundamental principles, but also t o demonstrate the relevance of physics t o the life
sciences. The course i s designed to serve
students i n biology, psychology, physical
education (therapy programs), medical
technology and other health science programs. The course i s also a very suitable
elective or distribution requirement for
the liberal arts student. (3 one-hour lectures, 2-hour laboratory. Prereq.: Elem.
algebra. Fall)
121,122 GENERAL PHYSICS I, II
A rigorous study of the concepts of
mechanics, fluids, heat, sound, optics,
electricity and magnetism, and some
aspects of modern physics. For majors i n
physics and other specified majors. Must
be taken in sequence. (4 one-hour lectures, 3-hour laboratory. Prereq.: Mathematics 124 or concurrent registration. 121,
Fall; 122, Spring)
245 MODERN PHYSICS
An introduction to modern physics from
a historical and experimental basis. Relativity, quantum effects, atomic and molecular physics, nuclear and solid state
physics. This course indicates the need
for, and develops the experimental basis
of quantum mechanics. (3 one-hour lectures. Prereq.: 122. Fall)
261 ELECTRONICS
The emphasis is on basic electronic principles and instrumentation. A review of
D.C. and A.C. circuits before introducing
"
solid state devices. The study of diodes,
transistors and integrated circuits, with
applications t o both digital and analog
circuits. (3 one-hour lectures, 3-hour
laboratory. Prereq.: 122 o r 103 plus
Mathematics 122 or 125 and conseni o f
instructor. Spring)
270 OPTICAL PHYSICS
The emphasis is on physical optics, using
t h e complex expression f o r a wave
throughout. Interference, diffraction,
polarization, and an introduction to the
electromagnetic theory. (3 one-hour lectures, 3-hour laboratory. Prereq.: 122.
Fall)
A careful study of classical mechanics i n
terms of Newton's laws of motion and the
Lagrangian and Hamiltonian formalisms.
Topics include conservation principles,
single particle motion, systems of particles,
oscillatory systems, central-force motion,
dynamics of rigid bodies, gravitation,
kinematics of two-particle systems and
noninertial reference frames. (3 one-hour
lectures. Prereq.: 122; Mathematics 226.
351, Fall; 352, Spring)
362,363 ELECTROMAGNETIC FIELDS I, II
The classical electromagnetic field theory
is developed using the vector calculus
t h r o u g h o u t . Electrostatics, magnetostatics, solution of Laplace's and Poisson's
equations, electric and magnetic properties of materials, and the theory of
electromagnetic radiation based o n
Maxwell's equations. (3 one-hour lectures. Prereq.: 122; Mathematics 226.. 362,
Fall; 363, Spring)
395 COMPREHENSlvE
An emphasis on independent laboratory
investigations, including participation in
physics seminars. Experiments i n the area
of mechanics, thermodynamics, vacuum
physics, electronics, electricity, magnetism, optics, and modern physics.(2 threehour laboratory and Iseminar hour per
week. Prereq.: junior standing or consent
o f instructor. Spring)
481 THERMAL PHYSICS
The study of properties of systems and
processes for which temperature is an
important variable. The subject is developed from two independent yet complementary viewpoints; the experimental, macroscopic classical t h e r m o dynamics and the theoretical, microscopic statistical mechanics. (3 one-hour
lectures. Prereq. : 351. Spring)
486 Q U A N T U M MECHANICS
A development from first principles, inc l u d i n g de Broglie's postulates, t h e
Schroedinger equation, operators, wavefunctions, expectation values, angular
momentum, and approximation
methods. Specific problems studied include potential wells and potential barriers, the harmonic oscillator, and the
hydrogen atom. (3 one-hour lectures.
Prereq.: 245, 351, 352. Fall)
488 TOPICS I N M O D E R N PHYSICS
The application of quantum mechanics t o
specific topics chosen from the areas of
solid state physics, atomic and molecular
physics, nuclear physics, and particle
physics. (3 one-hour lectures. Prereq.:
486. Spring)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
An opportunity for students to explore
systematically a problem in experimental
or theoretical physics, worked out in
consultation with a faculty adviser. Open
to juniors and seniors with departmental
approval.
Political Science
Chairperson: Norma Noonan
M A J O R : 9 courses, plus Statistical
Analysis (Soc. 362). Required are 121 or
122 or 160 or 170; 158; 384; and at least 5
other upper division courses i n 4 out of 5
areas.* A seminar in one of the five areas
may be counted for that area.
M I N O R : 5 courses, including: 121 or 122
or 170; 158; and at least 3 upper division
courses i n 3 out of 5 areas.*
H O N O R S MAJOR: The Honors Major i n
Political Science includes the requirements listed above, plus the following:
The student's grade-point average must
be 3.5 in the major and 3.0 overall. The
student must take an Honors Independent Study and a seminar, and must submit, not later than March 1 of the senior
year, an Honors Thesis to be defended
before a faculty committee. Students may
work with any member of the Department on their Honors Thesis. For specific
requirements, consult the Honors Adviser, Dr. Noonan. Students should apply
for the Honors Major no later than the
first term of the junior year.
See the class schedule for precise listing of
terms in which courses are offered.
I. AMERICAN GOVERNMENT
A N D POLITICS
121 AMERICAN GOVERNMENT A N D
POLITICS
The politics of American government including the pattern of participation; the
dynamics of congressional, executive,
and bureaucratic policymaking; the contemporary structure of federalism; and
current issues in American society.
122 METROPOLITAN COMPLEX
Politics in the urban setting, including
important issues, actors, and structures
influencing public policy in the modern
urban complex. Discussion-lecture,simulation, and meetings with political experts
and activists.
160 W O R L D POLITICS
Introduction t o the processes and issues
of international politics, including the
dynamics of the international system,
theories of international relations, and a
focus on recent problems.
*The five areas are American Government
and Politics, Comparative Politics and
Analysis, International Politics, Public
Law, and Political Theory and Analysis.
(Any course listed i n more than one area
may be counted i n only one area toward
major or minor requirements.)
325 AMERICAN POSITIVE STATE
Students interested i n secondary education may take a political science major
in combination with specified social
science courses, i n compliance with state
requirements. For more information, see
the department chairperson or the Social
Studies Education adviser.
The politics of public administration and
bureaucratic policy-making in the American welfare-warfare state; governmental
regulation, promotion and management,
emphasizing political and economic interaction. (Prereq.: 7 ' course i n Political
Science or #)
326 POLITICAL PARTIES A N D
BEHAVIOR
158 POLITICAL PATTERNS A N D
PROCESSES
The political behavior of the electorate
emphasizing public opinion and political
parties in th: electoral process. Field work
with political parties and interest groups
and media i n presidential elections
(optional i n non-presidential election
years). (Prereq.: 121 or #. Fall term o f
election years.)
An analysis of basic patterns i n the political system and decision-making process with some comparison of major political systems and discussion of contemporary issues.
342 MASS C O M M U N I C A T I O N S I N
SOCIETY
Effects of mass communications on individual behavior; the uses and control of
mass media for political and social purposes including a study of censorship,
newsmaking, entertainment and public
affairs programming.
370 CONSTITUTIONAL LAW I
(Offered alternate years. See Section IV
for description).
350 COMPARATIVE DEMOCRACIES
The emergence, maintenance and decline of selected democracies, focusing
on political behavior, institutions, and
processes. (Prereq.: One course i n Political Science or #)
351 C O M M U N I S T POLITICAL SYSTEMS
A comparative analysis of the Soviet
Union and other communist states i n
terms of political behavior, institutions,
processes and politics. (Prereq.: One
course i n Political Science or #.)
381 DEMOCRATIC THEORY A N D
PRACTICE
(See Section V for description)
371 CONSTITUTIONAL LAW I1
(Offered alternate years. See Section IV
for description).
421 TOPICS I N AMERICAN POLITICS
Selected themes, including legislative,
executive or judicial process, and policy
process in American politics; national,
urban or state focus; topic to be included
i n subtitle. (Prereq.: Two courses i n
Political Science or #. Offered on demand.)
11. COMPARATIVE POLITICS A N D
ANALYSIS
459 TOPICS I N ELITE A N D MASS
BEHAVIOR
In-depth study of the elite and/or mass
participation i n the political system.
( O f f e r e d o n demand. Prereq.: O n e
course i n Political Science or #.)
Ill. INTERNATIONAL POLITICS
160 ISSUES IN WORLD POLITICS
Contemporary issues and problems in
international politics in the context of
democratic values and processes; moralism, legalism, and realism i n foreign
policy.
363 C O M M U N I S T FOREIGN POLICIES
V. POLlTlCAL THEORY A N D ANALYSIS
Analysis of the motivation, formulation,
and implementation of foreign policies of
Communist nations with emphasis upon
the Soviet Union and China. (Prereq.:
One course i n Political Science or #.)
158 POLITICAL PAlTERNS A N D
PROCESSES
(See Section II for description)
380 WESTERN POLITICAL THOUGHT
461 TOPICS I N INTERNATIONAL
POLITICS
Selected themes i n c l u d i n g i n t e r p r e tations of international politics, foreign
policy decision-making, simulations of
international problems. Topic t o be included i n subtitle. (Prereq.: One course i n
Political Science or #. Offered alternate
years.)
IV. PUBLIC LAW
170 LAW I N THE UNITED STATES
A survey of American law and legal process. Theories of law; law and society;
roles of courts, police, lawyers, and juries;
t h e U n i t e d States C o n s t i t u t i o n as
"supreme" law; law as politics; historic
and contemporary legal issues.
A study of influential political philoSophers f r o m Plato t h r o u g h Rawls,
emphasizing t h e values, goals, and
assumptions which continue t o inform
and t o rationalize human governance.
(Prereq.: One course i n Political Science
or #.)
381 DEMOCRATIC THEORY A N D
PRACTICE
A study of democratic theory and public
policy practice with focus on the emergence of political democracy, capitalism
and the welfare state i n comparative
perspective. (Prereq.: One course i n Political Science or #.)
382 MARXIST VISIONS: PAST,
PRESENT, A N D FUTURE
370 CONSTITUTIONAL LAW I
The legal-political-philosophical role of
the judiciary in the American constitutional system, emphasizing significant
Supreme Court cases involving the United
States government and the federal system. (Prereq.: 170 or #. Offered alternate
years.)
371 CONSTITUTIONAL LAW II
Constitutional limitations of the Bill of
Rights and of the Fourteenth Amendment
as applied by the Supreme Court to the
protection of human rights and civil liberties of individuals. (Prereq.: 170 or #.
Offered alternate years.)
Origins and evolution of Marxist theory
and movements emphasizing Marxism as
developed in Russia and China. Consideration of the political, social, and
economic dimensions of the theories,
with some focus on the preferred futures
envisaged in the doctrine. (Prereq.: 158 or
#. Offered alternate years.)
384 POLITICAL ANALYSIS
Theory and methods of empirical political
analysis, i n c l u d i n g c o m m u n i c a t i o n s
theory, simulation, systems' theory, structural-functionalism, power concepts,
psychological and economic approaches
to political study, and a survey of the
methods common to empirical social
science.(Prereq.:StatisticalAnalysis;Political science 158 and two upper division
courses, or #.)
399 INTERNSHIP
Consult Chairperson or Internship
Director t o determine project. (Prereq.:
#. Fall, Interim, Spring)
495 SEMINAR
VI. SEMINARS, INDEPENDENT STUDY
A N D INTERNSHIPS.
Selected topics. Consult department
chairperson concerning terms and subject matter. (prereq.: #,)
498 INDEPENDENT STUDY:
METROPOLITAN RESOURCES
199 INTERNSHIP
Lower division internship. Consult Internship Supervisor in the department t o
determine project. (Fall, Interim, Spring.)
295 LOWER DIVISION SEMINAR
Special topics. Consult department chairperson concerning terms and subject
matter. (Offered on demand)
An independently designed course a
student (or group of students) develops,
making extensive, systematic and integrated utilization of resources available i n
the metropolitan community, e.g. lectures, symposia, performances, hearings.
These resources become the core of the
course, supplemented by traditional college resources, and designed in consultation with and evaluated by afccijliy member of the department. (Prereq.: #. Fall,
Interim, Spring)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
299 DIRECTED STUDY
Independent study for lower division students. (Prereq.: #. Fall, Interim, Spring)
Topics d e f i n e d t h r o u g h consultation
between instructor and student. (Prereq.:
#. Fall, Interim, Spring)
Psychology
Chairperson: Norman Ferguson
M A J O R : 10 courses including 105, 264,
265, 381 or 399, and 493, with-a minimum
of 5 courses at Augsburg. Physics 103 is also
required. The major program should include 105 i n the freshman year, 264 and
265 in the freshman or sophomore year,
381 or 399 in the junior year, and 493 i n the
senior year. The major program i s planned in consultation with an adviser i n the
psychology department and it i s approved
by the department chairperson. The overall plan is directed toward a basic understanding of the discipline of psychology
and toward the particular educational,
vocational and professional goals of the
individual student. A written plan for the
major should be completed and approved by the beginning of the junior
year.
Not more than two courses from among
299, 399 and 499 may be counted toward
the minimum 10 psychology courses required for a major. I t should be noted that
this restriction applies toward the minimum requirement only. The stu.dent may
actually take more such courses.
I t i s recommended that psychology
majors take additional course work from
other areas that will complement and
strengthen their particular interests i n
psychology. For example, developing a
minor in business administration, biology,
or communication i s recommended for
many students.
M I N O R : 5 courses including 105, with a
minimum of 2 courses at Augsburg. Not
more than one course from 299,399, and
499 may be counted toward the minor.
H O N O R S M A J O R : Students may qualify
for honors i n psychology with a 3.5 grade
point average in the major, a 3.0 grade
point average overall, and completion of
a high quality research project culminating the major program. Application for
honors consideration must be made
during the junior year. Please consult the
department chairperson for more detailed
requirements.
105 GENERAL PSYCHOLOGY
An introduction t o the methods and
approaches used in psychology for the
purpose of understanding behavior. The
structure of the field of psychology, including its major sub-areas, i s emphasized. (Fall, Spring)
251 SENSING A N D PERCEIVING
An ecologically oriented approach to the
study of perceptual systems. Emphasis on
the processing of environmental information and how this relates t o adaptive
behavior and subjective experience. Major topics include: adaptation to novel
environments such as outer space, animal
& machine intelligence, and anomalous
perception such as illusions. (Prereq.: 705)
264,265 RESEARCH METHODS: DESIGN,
PROCEDURE, A N D
ANALYSIS I, II
A' two-term sequence including experimentation in human and animal learning,
problem solving, social psychology, and
sensation-perception. Emphasis will be
placed on both statistical and experimental design methodology. Research
Methods I may be taken for credit without
c o n t i n u i n g i n Research M e t h o d s II.
Majors i n psychology must take both
terms of the two-term sequence; 264 must
precede 265; 265 should be taken i n the
term immediately following 264. (Prereq.:
705. 264, Fall, Spring; 265, Fall, Spring)
299 DIRECTED STUDY
Limited registration by special permission. Specific planning for the study must
be completed and approved well in advance of the time of registration.
351 DEVELOPMENTAL PSYCHOLOGY:
CHILD
Emphasis on normal child development
and behavior. Consideration of theoretical systems used for viewing the developmental sequence and process. Active inquiry into practical implications and
applications of data and theory i n respect
to the development of children. (Prereq.:
7 05)
352 DEVELOPMENTAL PSYCHOLOGY:
ADOLESCENT A N D ADULT
Emphasis on normal development and
behavior of the adolescent and adult.
Theoretical bases used f o r b u i l d i n g
understanding of and appreciation for the
developmental process. Active consideration of the meaning that data and theory
have for the development of people in
the adolescent and adult periods of life.
(Prereq. : 357)
359 MEASUREMENT
Theory and principles of measurement.
Analysis and practicum with achievement, interest, personality and intelligence tests. (Prereq.: 105)
361 PERSONALITY
An introduction to the field of personality
study with special attention directed
toward personality theories and contemporary application of those theories. (Prereq.: 705. Fall)
355 BRAIN & BEHAVIOR
362 BEHAVIOR DISORDERS
A survey of the functions of the nervous
system which are responsible for behavior
in animals and human beings. Major
topics include: sleep & wakefulness, motivation & emotion, learning & memory,
and mental disorders. (Prereq.: 705 and
one course i n biology. Fall)
A review of maladaptive human behaviors
from the social, organic and psychological
points of view. Experience in a variety of
community service units will accompany
classroom learning. (Prereq.: 367. Spring)
356 ENVIRONMENT A N D BEHAVIOR
A study of the influence which the environment, both natural and man-made,
has on behavior. Major topics include:
overcrowding and environmental stress,
territoriality, defensible space & crime,
and built environments such as rooms,
buildings & cities. (Prereq.: 705. Spring)
357 LEARNING
Learning concepts, behavior change
principles and psychology of instruction.
Behavior change and individualized instruction projects. (Prereq.: 705)
371 PSYCHOLOGY O F THE
INDIVIDUAL: FEMALE A N D MALE
A study involving knowledge of materials
bearing on the development of sex differences and roles, the effect of society
upon values and goals, differential legal
status and feminist movement views, and
physiological data bearing on these differences. (Prereq.: 705 or #)
373 ORGANIZATIONAL PSYCHOLOGY
Theoretical conceptualizations of organizational behavior. Factors and practices
such as management styles, evaluation
and maintenance of work effectiveness,
and social influences. An organizational
field experience. (Prereq.: 705)
375 SOCIAL PSYCHOLOGY
See under Department of Sociology.
381 PSYCHOLOGY IN HISTORICAL
PERSPECTIVE
490 CURRENT TOPICS IN PSYCHOLOGY
Historical development of psychological
viewpoints and theoretical positions.
(Prereq.: two psychology courses)
Study of selected areas and topics i n
psychology that are not treated extensively through current course offerings.
Specific topics will be published prior t o
registration. (Prereq.: 705 and #).
399 INTERNSHIP
493 SEMINAR: CONTEMPORARY
ISSUES
Interested students should consult with
the departmental internship coordinator
regarding requirements and permission
to register.
Discussion of contemporary societal
Issues from a psychological viewpoint.
Consideration of the approaches and
m e t h o d s used by psychologists i n
studying such issues. (Prereq.: 5 courses.
.
485 COUNSELING PSYCHOLOGY
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Principles, methods, and attitudes involved i n the counseling process. Consideration given t o goals and ethical
guidelines for a counseling relationship.
(Prereq.: 5 courses and senior standing.
Spring)
Limited registration by special permission
for advanced students i n psychology.
Students must present a written plan prior
t o registration including carefully considered rationale and purpose for the
proposed study.
Religion
Chairperson: Eugene M. Skibbe
Religion 111 or 221 i s prerequisite t o all
other courses.
Department approval i s necessary before
courses taken in other colleges can be
accepted for Religion Department and/or
general education course credit.
ACADEMIC M A J O R : 8 courses, including
111, 221, 356, 4 8 1 a n d a s e m i n a r
especially for majors to be taken i n the
junior or senior year. Only one interim
course may be applied to the major. One
upper division New Testament Greek
course may be applied t o the major. One
course required from those numbered
361-363 and one from those numbered
471-475.
C H U R C H STAFF WORKER RELIGION
M A J O R : 9 courses, including 111, 221,
356, 362, 399, 481, 354 or 358, 360 or 483,
471 or 473. These together with specified
courses in other departments can lead t o
Augsburg certification.
PUBLIC SCHOOL RELIGION MAJOR:
The Minnesota Department of Education
does not at the present timegrant teacher
certification for a religion major or minor.
To prepare for teaching about religion in
public schools, the student should work
closely with the Religion Department t o
design a program which includes: a) a
major in an academic field which i s certifiable by the state for elementary or
secondary teaching, and b) a religion
major of 8courses, includinglll,221,355,
356, 360, 363 and 471.
H O N O R S MAJOR: GPA of 3.3 in the
major and 3.0 over-all; research project
approved by the department and colloquim with the department.
M I N O R : 5 courses. Not more than one
interim course may be counted for the
minor.
sects. Some contemporary cultic movements will also be considered.
354 LlFE O F THE CHURCH I N
THE LlFE O F THE CITY
The Gospel and various forms of ministry
evident in urban structures.
355 THE STUDY O F RELIGION I N THE
PUBLIC SCHOOLS
The history of studying religion in public
schools, the problems associated with
such efforts, the resources available to the
teacher and the actual teaching itself will
be examined. The theological, as well as
the legal and educational implications will
be analyzed and discussed. (Spring, 798087)
111 INTRODUCTION T O THEOLOGY
356 HISTORY O F RELIGIONS
An introduction to the academic discipline of theology and to the dialogue
between the church and the world which
concerns Christian doctrine. (Fall, Spring)
221 BIBLICAL STUDIES
The origin, literary character, and transmission of the biblical documents. The
task of biblical interpretation. The history
of Israel and the emergence of the
church. (Fall, Spring)
An introductory survey of some of the
major living religions of the world, inc l u d i n g Hinduism, Buddhism, Conficianism, Taoism, Shinto, and Islam. Lectures plus some discussion of primary
documents from these religious communities.
358 LlFE A N D WORK O F THE C H U R C H
350 PHILOSOPHY O F RELIGION
Congregational life in its varied character
with attention directed to Christian education and curriculum, youth work and
parish work. (Offered 7987-82)
See under Department of Philosophy
360 RELIGION A N D SOCIETY
353 DENOMINATIONS A N D SECTS I N
AMERICA
An examination of the interaction of religion and society in terms of sociological
analysis with particular emphasis o n contemporary sociological research on religious movements in American society.
A study of the beliefs and worship practices of the major denominations and
361 C H U R C H FATHERS
471 JESUS A N D HIS INTERPRETERS
A study of the early Christian Church in
the context of the Roman Empire, including such topics as persecution and
martyrdom, the development of the
creeds, Christianity i n c o n f l i c t w i t h
Gnosticisms and mystery religions, monasticism and mysticism, early Christian
worship; also including the theology of
several early Christian leaders and a
special unit on the life and thought of
Augustine.
Consideration of the New Testament
Documents, particularly the Gospels,
dealing with their context, literary structure and relationships. Attention t o the
variety of interpretations given the person
of Jesus, including the "quest for the
historical Jesus." (Fall)
362 THEOLOGY O F THE REFORMERS
A n i n t r o d u c t i o n t o t h e theological
thought of the Protestant reformersof the
sixteenth century. Special attention to the
writings of Martin Luther and other representative figures. (Fall)
363 RELIGION I N AMERICA
A study of the development of religion i n
America. Special attention to the rise of
religious liberty, revivalism, d e n o m i nations and the responses of religion t o
the challenges of its environing culture.
364 SCANDINAVIAN I M M I G R A N T
CHURCH HISTORY
Topics and themes related t o church history and Scandinavian immigration t o this
country.
380 MUSIC O F THE WESTERN C H U R C H
(See under Department of Music)
399 INTERNSHIP
Limited t o students who have completed
at least four academic courses, have at
least first semester Junior standing, and
satisfy department guidelines.
472 THEOLOGY O F PAUL
A study of the Apostle Paul including his
historical background, his relationship t o
the early church, and some of the themes
to be found i n his writings. (Offered
1981-82)
473 THE MESSAGE O F THE O L D
TESTAMENT
The various types of O l d Testament literature. The distinctive ideas of Hebrew
thought with emphasis on the message of
the prophets. (Offered 1980-81)
475 JUDAISM
A survey of the history of Judaism from
the end of the O l d Testament period to
modern times, with emphasis placed upon
the religious development. A special
interest in such modern Jewishthinkers as
Buber and Heschel. The JewishChatauqua
Society annually makes a grant to Augsburg College i n support of this course in
Judaism offered in the religion department. (Fall)
481 CONTEMPORARY THEOLOGY
An introduction to some representative
trends i n Christian theological thought
today, as seen from the systematic perspective, i n the light of the continuing
theological task of the Christian Church.
(Spring)
482 CONTEMPORARY R O M A N
CATHOLIC THEOLOGY
structive perspective for critical reflection
upon moral action.
New trends of Roman Catholic theology
as expressed i n the writings of some of i t s
representatives. Relation of new theological and biblical insights t o the dogmatic
definitions of the church. (Fall)
495 SEMINAR
Selected topics. Required of majors in the
junior or senior year. Others by permission of instructor. (Fall)
483 CHRISTIAN ETHICS
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
The bases of Christian social responsibility,
in terms of theological and sociological
dynamics. Emphasis on developing a con-
Limited to students who are religion majors and satisfy departmental guidelines.
Russian A r e a Studies
Coordinator: Norma C. Noonan
The major i n Russian Area Studies i s a
cooperative program of the Associated
Colleges of the Twin Cities (ACTC). It
seeks t o give the student the broadest
possible exposure t o Russian and Soviet
life, history, politics, literature, tradition,
and philosophy. In addition to providing a
good liberal education, the program can
enable students to prepare for graduate
study, or careers i n areas such as government, international business, or teaching.
MAJOR: 11 courses
4 courses (2 years) of basic college
Russian (or equivalent competencies)
2 courses i n Russian history
1 course i n Marxist theory
1 course in Russian literature
1 course i n Soviet politics
2 other courses of approved electives.
M I N O R : 6 courses
2 courses (1 year) of basic college
Russian (or equivalent competencies)
1 course i n Russian history
1 course i n Soviet politics
1 course in Marxist theory
1 other course from the approved list
of electives
Each student's major program must be
approved by the Coordinator.
Scandinavian Area Studies
Director: Mildred l o e l
MAJOR: 8 upper division courses.
M I N O R : 4 upper division courses.
Major programs must contain 4 courses
listed in the Augsburg Catalog or transferred t o Augsburg as upper division
Scandinavian Area Studies courses, i.e.,
courses taught by a Scandinavian language department or subdepartment regardless of their content, which may be
linguistic, literary or cultural. Students
graduating with a major or minor must
also present the equivalent of intermediate level competence in a Scandinavian language. See Norwegian courses
under Department of Foreign languages.
312 O L D NORSE
An introduction t o the structure of O l d
West Norse through the study of selections from O l d Norse literature. Some
attention given t o O l d East Norse and
aspects of the history of four modern
Nordic languages. Knowledge of one of
the latter is desired but not required.
Norwegian language majors and minors
will have special assignments. (Offered
Spring, 1981.)
325 SCANDINAVIAN M U S I C
See under Department of Music.
330 CONTEMPORARY SCANDINAVIA
A broad survey of Scandinavian culture
with special emphasis o n conditions and
developments i n the twentieth century.
Knowledge of a Scandinavian language
desirable but not required.
345 SCANDINAVIAN
EXPERIENCE
- AMERICAN
The O l d World background and use of
"America Fever," adaptation t o the New
Land, aspects of Scandinavian - American culture. (Offered on Demand)
351 THE M O D E R N SCANDINAVIAN
NOVEL
Lectures provide a survey of the Scandinavian novel. Class discussion based on
assigned reading of selected novels by
Jonas Lie, Sigrid Undset, Selma Lagerlof,
Par Lagerkvist, Knut Hamsun, Halldor
Laxness and others. Knowledge of a Scandinavian language desirable. Language
majors and minors will be required t o d o
assigned readings and written work i n a
Scandinavian language. (Offered alternate
years. Spring, 7987)
352 THE M O D E R N SCANDINAVIAN
DRAMA
Readings include dramaticworks by Ibsen,
Bjornson, Strindberg, Lagerkvist, Munk
and other twentieth century dramatists.
Lectures provide a survey of Scandinavian
drama with emphasis on lbsen and Strindberg. Knowledge of a Scandinavian
language desirable.
Language majors and minors will be req u i r e d t o d o assigned readings and
written work i n a Scandinavian language.
(Offered alternate years. Fall, 7980)
364 SCANDINAVIAN I M M I G R A N T
CHURCH HISTORY
396 URBAN PLANNING I N
SCANDINAVIA
Offered under Department of Religion.
Offered under Higher Education Consortium for Urban Affairs. See MetroUrban Studies,Scandinavian Urban Studies
Term (SUST).
372 NORWEGIAN LANGUAGE A N D
CULTURE
Offered under Higher Education Consortium for Urban Affairs. See MetroUrban Studies, Scandinavian Urban Studies Term (SUST).
373 G R O W T H A N D DEVELOPMENT O F
SCANDINAVIAN CITIES
450 NINETEENTH CENTURY
SCANDINAVIA
Offered under Department of History.
495 SEMINAR: ETHNIC/IMMIGRATION
EXPERIENCE
Offered under Higher Education Consortium for ~ r b a ; Affairs. See M e t r o - - Offered periodically under Department
Urban Studies, Scandinavian Urban Studies of History 495 Seminar.
Term (SUST).
382 SCANDINAVIAN ARTS
See description under Department of Art.
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
I n consultation with a faculty member,
student selects a specific topic for study.
Social Science
Adviser: Orloue N. Cisselquist
MAJOR: 14 courses. Particularly designed
for those preparing for secondary school
teaching i n social studies. The Social
Science major i s also recommended for
others, such as pre-law students, who
desire a broad major in this area. This
major may be earned i n any one of four
distributions. A student may not list a
double major in Social Science and one of
the several component disciplines unless
the distribution selected in the Social
Science major i s significantly different
from the other major.
Students wishing t o become licensed
teachers are advised to consult with the
Education Department for licensure requirements.
A. HISTORY EMPHASIS
1. 7 history courses; 2 American, 2 Anc i e n t - M e d i e v a l - M o d e r n Europe, 2
non-Western, 1 seminar. At least 4 of
these must be upper division.
2. 2 political science courses.
3. 1 social science methodology course
from: Bus. or Econ. 379, Quantitative
Methods for Economics and Business;
Psych. 264, Research Methods I; Soc.
362, Statistical Analysis: Soc. 365,
Quantitative Analysis and Program Evaluation.
4. 4 courses from any 4 of these disciplines: anthropology, economics,
geography, psychology, sociology.
vant topic; Philosophy 355; Religion
356; Sociology 241.
3. 1 social science methodology course
from: Bus. or con. 379, psych. 264, SOC.
362 or 365.
D. INTERNATIONAL RELATIONS
EMPHASIS
6. BEHAVIORAL SCIENCE
1. 4 lower division courses: Econ. 122,
14 courses, at least 5 of them upper diviHist. 103 or 104, Poli. Sci. 158 or 160,4th
term of collegework in a modern
sion, from economics, history, political
foreign
language.
science, psychology, and sociology (including anthropology). These must in- 2. 3 upper division courses: Hist. 332,
clude:
Poli. Sci. 363, 461.
I.2 or more courses from each of 30f the 3. 7 electives, no more than 5 from any
disciplines.
one discipline, from: Econ. 251, 258,
2. 5 or more courses from another of the
495, seminar, independent study or
disciplines other than history.
interim course on a relevant topic;
3. 1 American history course (may be Part
Hist. 416,404,463,464,465,474, seminar,
of requirement 1).
independent study or interim course
4. 1 social science methodology course
on a relevant topic; Poli. Sci. 350, 351,
from: Bus. or Econ. 379, Psych. 264, Sot.
380, 381, 382, seminar, independent
362 or365 (may be Part of requirement
study or interim course on a relevant
1 or 2).
topic; Sociology 241; 4th term of colC. NON-WESTERN STUDIES EMPHASIS
lege work in a second modern foreign
language.
1. Hist. 103, The Modern World.
2. 12 courses in non-Western studies,
Social Science Minor: 5 courses, one from
with at least 4 disciplines represented,
each of five disciplines, selected from the
from the following: Econ. 122, 258;
f o l l o w i n g : anthropology, economics,
Hist. 104, 440, 463, 464, 465, 474, semigeography, history, political science,
nar, independent study, or interim
psychology, and sociology. The selection
course on a relevant topic; Poli. Sci.
of courses must be approved by one of
351, 363, 382, 461; seminar, independthe faculty supervising the social science
ent study, or interim course on a relemajor.
Social W o r k
Chairperson: Edwina Hertzberg
The core program of Social Work begins
i n the junior year, but all students are
advised to take Social Work 257 as freshmen or sophomores unless exempted by
the faculty, and should seek advisement
from faculty as to sequence of requisite
courses from other departments.
MAJOR: The Augsburg Social Work Program is a professional program in preparation for social work practice leading t o a
Bachelor of Science degree. The core
program consists of Bio. I O I * ; Psych. 105*,
351*, and 352*; Soc. 121*, 231*, 365,375*,
and 383*; and Social Work 257, 361, 363,
364, 461, 462, 463, 464, 465, 466 and 467.
Recommended courses are: one CHR,
Soc. 111, Econ. 123, Poli.Sci. 121,325,326,
Speech 354 and/or 355.
*These courses are to be completed before the beginning o f the senior year.
SPECIALIZATION: Specializations i n
Aging Chemical Dependency, Youth and
Crime and Corrections are possible. Specialization consists of courses descriptive of
functional, dysfunctional and programmatic aspects, plus field work placement
in the senior year in the special area.
Completion of aspecialization i s noted on
the transcript.
SCHOOL SOCIAL WORK: State Department of Education required Human Relations Certification for school social work
i s available through successful completion of Ed. 388.
257 PRACTICUM IN THE H U M A N
SERVICES
With faculty approval, student selects a
placement for 30 hours per week as a
volunteer in a social agency or institution.
.:
..
I..
.. -,:. ' -
Opportunity t o know social work professionals, social service delivery systems,
and career aspects of the helping vocations. Independent study with a term
paper report and weekly review conferences. Especially recommended for freshmen and sophomores. Open to all students. (Interim)
viduals and small groups; development of
the student's repertoire of relationship
building skills. Two class periods of lecture-discussion sessions and/or laboratory
exercises per week. (Prereq.: 367, Junior.
Spring)
340 POLICIES, PROGRAM A N D
SKILLS FOR THE A G I N G
Beginning supervised professional experience in a social work agency focusing on
interviewing experience and relationship
building. Ten hours per week, plus one
small group supportive/discussion seminar per week. (Prereq.: 367, Junior, concurrent with 363. Spring)
This course will include the study of the
impact of social policy on the older population, older population impact on social
policy, services planned to address needs
of older population and skills needed t o
work with this population. Class conducted i n Senior Citizen Residence.
(Prereq.: Course work i n Human Development, Systems o f Social Welfare, experience i n work with the aged, #.)
361 SYSTEMS O F SOCIAL WELFARE
An examination of fundamental aspects
of the various systems of social welfare i n
the U.S. and the role of social work i n
them. Special emphasis on analysis of the
major assumptions and movements contributory to the rise of the welfare state;
description of a selection of modern service systems, the profession of social
work, its ethics, values, and historical
development. Three class periods per
week; guest lectures, research paper.
(Prereq.: Junior, o r #. Fall)
363 METHODS A N D SKILLS O F
SOCIAL W O R K
Basic features of the helping process;
theoretical foundations, principles and
techniques of social work interventive
methods, and practical experience necessary for social work practice with indi-
364 FIELD W O R K I
461 ADVANCED METHODS A N D SKILLS
IN SOCIAL W O R K
Enlargement and refinement of practice
skills through lecture, classroom exercise
and regular class work. Enlargement of
social group work skills, emphasis o n
development of generalist practice skills
and eclectic approaches. Two two-hour
class lectures, and/or laboratory exercises
per week. (Prereq.: 2.0 i n 363 and 364, or #.
Fa11)
463 C O M M U N I T Y DEVELOPMENT A N D
ORGANIZATION
Locality development and social change
through community organization, social
planning, and social action. Emphasis on:
1 ) surveyance of historical forms of social
change, 2) understanding the basic issues
and strategies relevant t o social protest
and change, 3) examination of the structure, function and dysfunction of various
community organizations and other corporate and political systems, and 4)
knowledge of the essential principles and
techniques of organizing. (Prereq.: senior
or #. Fall)
462, 464, FIELD W O R K I1 A N D IV:
Ten hours per week in a Social Service
agency. Progressively responsible supervised professional social work experience
including work with individuals, families,
groups and/or communities. Ten hours
per week, plus one supportive/discussion
seminar per week. (Prereq: completion
and 2.0 i n 361, 362; concurrent with 467
and 467; Fall and Spring)
465 SOCIAL POLICY: ANALYSIS A N D
DEVELOPMENT
This course will include the study of
theories of Social Policy formulation and
methods of analysis associated with needs
and services and analysis of the impact of
policy on social work practice. Develapment and implemenration will be viewed
first hand through work with a public
policy maker, 4 hours per week. One class
period per week, readings, analytical
paper integrating class concepts with
practical experience. (Prereq.: 361, 463,
and senior or #. Spring)
466 FIELD WORK Ill
Continuation of 462 conducted during
Interim. ('/z course. Interim.)
467 THE SOCIAL WORKER AS
PROFESSIONAL
Ethical practice, bureaucratic survival,
professional job attainment, personnel
policies and practices, organizational
theory, and resource development will be
studied in the course. The field work
practice becomes the laboratory for class
exercises. (Prereq.: 467, 462, 463, 464;
Spring)
468 SPECIAL TOPICS
Current issues in social work theory or
practice. To be announced. (#half or full
credit. Interim)
498 INDEPENDENT STUDY METROPOLITAN RESOURCES
An independently designed course a
student (or group of students) develops,
making extensive, systematic and integrated utilization of resources available in
the metropolitan community, e.g. lectures, sympolia, performances, hearings.
These resources become the core of the
course, supplemented by traditional college resources, and designed in consulattion with and evaluated by a faculty member of the department.
Sociology
Chairperson: G . Nelson
MAJOR: 10 courses including 121, 362,
363, 375, 485. Highly recommended: a
CHR course, internship, independent
study or upper division interim course i n
sociology. This recommendation is made
in the hope that the student will take ad-
vantage of the variety of learning models
offered through the department. Consult
department chairperson concerning
areas of concentration.
M I N O R : 5 courses including 121 and two
upper division courses (i.e., 300 and
above.)
H O N O R S MAJOR: The student must
have a minimum GPA of 3.5 i n the major
and 3.0 overall. Application for honors i n
sociology candidacy shall consist of submission of thesis proposal to Department
Chairperson before April 1 of the junior
year. Candidacy i s contingent upon departmental approval of proposal by April
30 of junior year. After acceptance as a
candidate, the student will register for
"Independent Study" (Sociology 499)
through which work on thesis will be
completed. Honors degree i n sociology
will be granted to a candidate if he/she
successfully defends the thesis before
March 31 of senior year and maintains
GPA through graduation.
111 H U M A N C O M M U N I T Y A N D THE
M O D E R N METROPOLIS
The cultural and structural dynamics of
the modern world viewed from the perspective of the metropolitan situation,
with a focus on the possibilities of human
community i n the context of urban institutions and processes. (Fall, Spring)
121 PRINCIPLES O F SOCIOLOGY
Sociology as a mode of analysis or way of
knowing. I t s applications to an understanding of basic aspects of society;
socialization, family life, social inequalities, large-scale institutions, etc. Sociology as an academic discipline and profession. (Fall, Spring)
241 INTRODUCTION T O CULTURAL
ANTHROPOLOGY
An examination of the idea of culture; the
person's relation to culture; language as a
major organizing element i n the way we
see the world. An examination of the
ideas of "primitive", "civilized", and
"progress"; a comparison of alternate
realities as found in different cultures and
varying social contexts. An analysis of
selected aspects of US. culture. (Fall,
Spring)
300,301,302,303,304
SPECIAL TOPICS
I N SOCIOLOGY
Offered periodically through Augsburg's
Conservation of Human Resources (CHR)
program. Generally conducted off campus in such places as institutions for adult
felons, physically handicapped, emotionally disturbed, and senior citizens.
Residents and staff of these institutions
take the course together with college
students i n a co-learning model. Topics
will vary depending upon needs and
interest.
360 RELIGION A N D S O C I E N
An examination of the interaction of religion and society i n terms of sociological
analysis with particular emphasis on contemporary sociological research i n religious movements and institutions i n
American society.
362 STATISTICAL ANALYSIS
231 SOCIOLOGY O F THE FAMILY
An examination of the family as a social
institution. The process of dating, mate
selection, marital adjustment and divorce.
The relationship of the family t o its institutional and cultural context.(Fall,Spring)
The first course in atwo-coursesequence.
Analysis of attempts to build a body of
k n o w l e d g e by way o f a s c i e n t i f i c
approach. Tools and approaches used to
evaluate ideas and describe social life
through the use of quantitative informa-
tion. Use of data processing equipment
and computers for statistical analysis.
Designed especially for political science
and sociology majors. Sociology majors
should take Soc. 363 the following term.
(Prereq.: high school algebra. Fall)
363 RESEARCH METHODS
The second course in a two-course sequence. Overview of commonly-used research designs and measurement techniques. Applications for program evaluations. Practice doing research by. wav. of
class activities and individual projects. To
be taken immediately after Soc. 362.
(Prereq.: Soc. 362 or #. Spring)
365 QUANTITATIVE ANALYSIS A N D
PROGRAM EVALUATION
Consumer overview o f methods o f
organizing, comparing and interpreting
quantitative information. Use of dataprocessing e q u i p m e n t f o r statistical
analysis. Overview of commonly-used research methods, especially experimental
designs and applications t o program
evaluations. Designed for social work
majors. (Prereq.: high school algebra.
Spring)
373 CRIME A N D CORRECTIONS
An examination of the criminal and juven i l e justice systems and t h e various
theoretical components of criminology
and corrections. M a j o r attention is
focused on the causation and prevention
of crime and delinquency, and the various
modes of treatment. (Prereq.: 721, Fall)
375 SOCIAL PSYCHOLOGY
An examination of the idea of "group", its
relationship to individual behavior and
society. An analysis of the ideas of "self"
and "identity" and what part they play i n
understanding interpersonal relations
and human behavior. A sociological view
of mental health. A look at the major
assumptions and processes underlying
our everyday life - a look at the trivial,
the ordinary and the taken-for-granted.
"Symbolic interaction", an important
orientation in social psychology, will be
used as a way of dealing with the major
issues in the course. (Prereq.: 721 and
Psych. 105. Fall, Spring)
381 THE CITY A N D METRO-URBAN
PLANNING
The changing city i n history and various
cultures; major theoretical perspectives
i n urban sociology; the metropolis as an
eco-system; metro-urban planning and
policy systems; major issues related to
shaping the future metropolis. The Twin
Cities metropolitan area i s utilized as an
important learning laboratory. (Prereq.:
777 or 127 or #. Spring)
383 RACIAL A N D MINORITY GROUP
RELATIONS
The dimensions of racial and minority
g r o u p relations. M a j o r attention i s
focused upon prejudice, racism, and the
role of self-understanding. (Fall, Spring.
P/N grading only)
388 SOCIAL INEQUALITY
Analysis of inequality i n regard t o wealth,
status and power in the U.S. and other
selected countries. Causes and ramifications of the amount and typeof inequality.
Detailed analysis of current issues and
policies concerning inequality i n the U.S.
(Prereq.: Soc. 721. Spring)
399 INTERNSHIP
Consult the Department Chairperson or
Internship Director for details. (Prereq.: #.
Fall, Interim, Spring)
485 M O D E R N SOCIOLOGICAL THEORY
An examination of the major theoretical
traditions within sociology, tracing the
course of their development in the nineteenth and twentieth centuries. (Prereq.:
2 courses i n sociology including 721 or #.
Fall)
-
498 INDEPENDENT STUDY
METROPOLITAN RESOURCES
An independently designed course a
student (or group of students) develops,
making extensive, systematic and integrated utilization of resources available in
the metropolitan community, e.g. lectures, symposia, performances, hearings.
These resources become the core of the
course, supplemented by traditional college resources, and designed in consultation with and evaluated by a faculty
member of the department.
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY
Student must present written proposal
contai'ning rationale, objectives and
methodology of the proposed study
according t o department guidelines.
(Prereq. :721 and permission of instructor.
Fall, Interim, Spring)
Speech, C o m m u n i c a t i o n and T h e a t e r A r t s
Chairperson: Raymond Anderson
DEPARTMENTAL HONORS: GPA of 3.25
in the major, 3.0 overall, two independent study projects of honors quality,
distinguished performance in at least one
of the communication arts, comprehensive examination in field of concentration.
Application to be made early in the senior
year.
Courses 116 and 476 are strongly recommended for all students in elementary
education.
Supporting courses required but not
counting toward the major: Speech 111;
Philosophy 130; Psychology 105; Sociology 121 or 241; Sociology 375.
The communication major is a flexible
interdisciplinary program which allows
for different emphases -journalism, advertising and public relations, radio-television-film, human relations, and supervisory management. Program guides for
each area are available from the Department Chairperson or the Office of
Admissions.
C O M M U N I C A T I O N ARTS
C O M M U N I C A T I O N MAJOR: 10 courses,
including 342, 351 or 352, 354, 399 and
English 225 or 226 or 227, and satisfactory
performance on competency tests in
writing and typing.
Prospective majors should contact the
department as early as possible to work
out a plan for the major and a personal
career action plan. Freshmen should take
Speech I l l , Psychology 105, Sociology 121
or 241, and Philosophy 130.
C O M M U N I C A T I O N M I N O R : 5 courses.
243 RADIO-TELEVISION PRODUCTION
MAJORS FOR TEACHING: Students preparing to teach speech in secondary
schools may specialize i n any of three
majors: speech, theater arts, and speechtheater arts. Any of these must be combined with at least an English minor,
preferably a major. The communications
major or minor does not qualify one for
teaching speech.
An introduction to radio and television
with an emphasis on the director's role;
emphasis on producing, programming,
writing, acting, casting, and lighting.
(Laboratory fee: $70. Fall)
SPEECH M A J O R FOR TEACHING: 10
courses, including 111, 241 or 243,351 or
355, 352, 354, 360, 476. Participation in
forensics, and a minor in English.
SPEECH M I N O R FORTEACHING: Course
111 and six of the following: 241 or 243,
351 or 355,352, 354, 360,476 and participation i n forensics.
342 MASS C O M M U N I C A T I O N S IN
SOCIETY
See under Department of Political Science.
351
Application of logic in public speaking,
discussion, and debates. (Fall)
352 PERSUASION
Theory of persuasion and propaganda,
practical work in speech and promotional
projects. (Spring)
111 BEGINNING SPEECH
Basic problems of effective speaking and
critica.1 listening. (Fall, spring)
132 PHOTOGRAPHY
See under Department of Art
227 ADVANCED WRITING:
JOURNALISM
See under Department of English
353 ADVERTISING
An introduction to print and broadcast
advertising and promotion as important
elements in modern marketing and communications. (Prereq.: /r., Sr., Communication major or #. Spring)
354 INTERPERSONAL
COMMUNICATION
A study of the dynamics of human inter2259 230 "ISUAL
COMMUNICATlONS
action through verbal and non-verbal
I, II
messages; emphasis on factors that build
relatiokhips and help to overcome comSee under Department of Art
munication barriers. (Spring)
241 INTRODUCTION T O CINEMA ART
355 SMALL GROUP C O M M U N I C A T I O N
See under Department of English
A study of group dynamics and leadership
242 FILM-MAKING
with emtlhasis on factors involved in effective functioning within small groups
See under Department of Art.
and organizations. (Spring)
373 ORGANIZATIONAL PSYCHOLOGY
See under Department of Psychology.
399 INTERNSHIP
Consult the Department Chairperson for
details.
476 SPEECH PATHOLOGY
Physical and psychological factors underlying normal and abnormal speech. An
introduction t o principles and methods of
speech correction. (Spring, a!ternate
years.)
480 SEMINAR I N C O M M U N I C A T I O N
Cooperative investigation o f topics i n
speech and communication. (Fall)
495 INDEPENDENT STUDY I N
COMMUNICATION
Selected topics i n speech and communication, with emphasis on the use
of primary sources and methodology of
research. (Fall, Spring)
THEATER ARTS
THEATER ARTS MAJOR: 10 courses, plus
Beginning Speech. This major should be
supported by an English minor or at least
by several courses in literature including
Shakespeare and M o d e r n Drama o r
Scandinavian Drama.
Majors should take part i n dramatic productions every year. Freshmen planning
t o major i n theater arts should begin with
courses 111, 116, and 228. Course 111 is
not part of the major.
A. ACTING EMPHASIS: 116,228,232,233,
243, 360, 361, 362, 366, and the children's
theater interim. Strongly recommended:
courses i n voice and movement, dance,
cinema, art, and dramatic literature. Performance requirements for the acting
emphasis include 6 units of acting, 4 of
crew work, and 1 internship.
B. DIRECTING EMPHASIS: 116, 228, 229,
232, 360, 361, 362, 366, 367, plus the children's theater interim. Courses strongly
recommended: courses in voice and
movement, cinema art, and dramatic
literature. Performance requirements for
the directing emphasis include 4 units of
crew work, 3 units of acting, 2 of directing,
1 in stage management, and 1 internship.
DESIGN EMPHASIS: 228, 229, 361,
362,366,428,429, plus courses 225 and 290
C.
in Art. Strongly recommended: courses i n
cinema art, art, and dramatic literature.
Performance requirements for the design
emphasis include 5 units i n crew work, 2
in technical supervision, 1 in acting, 1 in
assistant design, 1 i n design, and 1 internship.
THEATER ARTS M A J O R FOR TEACHING:
10 courses, including 111, 116, 228, 229,
232,241 or 243,360,361,366,467, or a voice
and diction course, the experience requirement specified above for theater arts
majors, and a minor i n English.
THEATER ARTS M I N O R FOR TEACHING:
courses 111,228,232,361,366, one of the
following: 241,243,476, and participation
i n dramatic productions.
THEATER ARTS M I N O R : 5 courses including 228, 232, 360, 361, 366.
SPEECH-THEATER ARTS M A J O R FOR
TEACHING: 12 courses, 111,228,229,232,
241 or 243, 351 or 355, 352, 354, 360, 361,
366,476 or a voice and diction course,and
participation in two activities (forensics,
interpretation, theater broadcasting), and
a minor i n English.
and Non-realism, Epic, and the Absurd.
(Spring, alternate years)
116 CREATIVE DRAMATICS
360 INTERPRETATIVE READING
A study of creative improvisation using
stories, poetry, nature, concepts, the self,
human relations, etc. Uses of creative
dramatics i n theater, school, church, recreation, therapy, and other settings. (Fall)
Basic principles of oral interpretation of
literature. Practice i n reading prose,
poetry, and drama. (Fall)
228 TECHNICAL PRODUCTION I
An introduction to the backstage world of
the theater: its organization,crafts, magic,
and art. Practical craft projects, theater
tours, and production experience. Open
to all students. Should be taken in freshman or sophomore years. (Lab fee.
Offered alternate years).
229 STAGE DESIGN I
lntroduction t o scenery and lighting
design; basic tools of the designer (drafting, drawing, painting, theory); practical
studio projects. (Open to all students.
Should be taken i n freshmen and sophomore years. Offered alternate years.)
232 ACTING
An introduction to the art of acting.
Practical work in pantomime and improvisation; participation i n dramatic presentations. (Spring)
361 THEATER HISTORY
Overview of theater history; examination
of plays from various periods. Attendance
at local theater productions. Introduction
to theories of drama and dramatic production. (Fall, Alternate years.)
362 THEATER CRITICISM
A study of forms and ideas as they are
expressed through the art of drama.
Attendance at local theater productions;
classical, experimental, and new plays.
Lectures and discussions on theory and
criticism using theater productions as
focus for discussion. (Fall, alternate years.)
366 STAGE DIRECTION I
Basic directorial process: choice of plays,
casting, organizing rehearsals and technical production; application of play
analysis, blocking, and characterization to
a specific play chosen by the class. Term
project: direct a one-act play. Upper
dividion students only. Spring)
233 ADVANCED ACTING
367 STAGE DIRECTION I1
This course explores t h e elements o f
characterization through improvisation
and extensive scene study. Emphasis is on
a variety of roles from the classics, including Shakespeare, French Neoclassicism, Restoration Comedy, Realism and
In-depth analysis and practice i n directing types of plays: serious, comic, experimental, musical. Term project: direct a
one-act or exerpt from a longer play.
(Prereq.: 366 or consent o f instructor.
Spring.)
429 STAGE DESIGN II
399 INTERNSHIP
Consult faculty in area of emphasis.
428 TECHNICAL PRODUCTION I1
Advanced construction and problemsolving techniques in costume, scenery,
and/or lighting. (Prereq.: 228 or consent
of instructor. Lab fee. Fall)
- Advanced design projech based on Stage
Design I course material. Introduction to
costume design. (Prereq.: 229 or consent
of instructor. Offered alternate years.)
499 INDEPENDENT STUDY IN D R A M A
Individual projects in oral interpretation
and theater. (Fall, Spring)
Transdisciplinary M a j o r
- -
-
.
Students wishing to develop their own
major by combining appropriate portions
of two majors may consider the Transdisciplinary Major. The Transdisciplinary
Major enables students to respond t o a
particular career interest. While such an
individually developed major may satisfy
the particular interests of a student, broad
majors may not be suitable for those
wishing to pursue graduate study or preprofessional programs in some academic
fields. Students wishing to develop a
Transdisciplinary Major are to observe the
following:
a. The major program should include at
least two-thirds of the courses required
in the normal major programs of two
major fields offered at the college;
b. The student should design and sign a
contract for such a major prior to the
end of his or her sophomore year
(contract forms are available in the
Office of the Registrar)
c. The contract must be approved by the
student's adviser and by the Faculty
Committee on Admissions and Student Standing.
BOARD OF REGENTS+'
Charles W. Arnason
Senior Vice President and
Secretary
Minneapolis Star and Tribune
Company
Minneapolis, Minnesota
Clayton 1. LeFevere
Attorney
LeFevere, Lefler, Pearson,
O'Brien & Drawz
Minneapolis, Minnesota
Chairman
Oscar M. Austad
President
The Austad Company
Sioux Falls, South Dakota
James C. Lindell
Treasurer
West Publishing Company
St. Paul, Minnesota
Treasurer
Chairman, Finance and
Management Committee
Dr. Paul B. Batalden
Program Director, Health
Services Research
St. Louis Park Medical Center
St. Louis Park, Minnesota
Arley R. Bjella
Chairman of the Board
Lutheran Brotherhood
Minneapolis, Minnesota
Norman R. Carpenter
Attorney
Faegre & Benson
Minneapolis, Minnesota
Donald R. Crangaard
Chairman of the Board and
C.E.O.
First Bank System, Inc.
Minneapolis, Minnesota
Lawrence 0. Hauge
Chairman of the Board
Citizens State Bank of St. Louis
Park
St. Louis Park, Minnesota
Norma E. Knutson
Minneapolis, Minnesota
The Rev. Harris W. Lee
Pastor
Lutheran Church of the Good
Shepherd
Minneapolis, Minnesota
Vice Chairman
Chairman, Academic and
Student Affairs
Committee
*as of September, 1979
Dr. Harold I. Lunde
Executive Vice PresidentAdministration
Kobacker Stores, lnc.
Columbus, Ohio
Dr. Arthur Naftalin
Professor, Public Affairs
University of Minnesota
Minneapolis, Minnesota
William A. Nelson, jr.
Chairman of the Board
Nelson Resource Corp.
Secaucus, New Jersey
Dr. Oliver H. Peterson, jr.
Minneapolis Ob-Gyn Associates,
Limited
Minneapolis, Minnesota
Secretary
Chairman, Development
Committee
Dr. Carl N. Platou
President
Fairview Community Hospitals
Minneapolis, Minnesota
The Hon. Martin 0. Sabo
Member of Congress
Fifth District-Minnesota
Washington, D.C.
Bertil Sandberg
President, N. H. Sandberg
Erection Company
St. Paul, Minnesota
The Rev. Paul G. Sonnack
Professor, Church History
Lut.her Theological Seminary
St. Paul, Minnesota
N. Stanley Stake
Group Vice President
Honeywell, Inc.
Minneapolis, Minnesota
Howard E. Olson
Mary Lou Williams
President
Sonford Products Corporation Minneapolis, Minnesota
St. Paul Park, Minnesota
Donald G. Padilla
Chairman of the Board and C.E.O.
Padilla and Speer, Inc.
Minneapolis, Minnesota
George T. Pennock
Chairman
Tennant Company
Minneapolis, Minnesota
Augsburg College Faculty
R U T H L. AASKOV, Associate Professor of Foreign Language, Ph.D. 1970, University of
Wisconsin (French)
COURTLAND ACRE, Professor Emeritus, Ph.D. 1937, University of Minnesota
EARL R. ALTON, Professor of Chemistry, Ph.D. 1961, University of Michigan, Department Chairperson
LYLA M A E ANDERECG, Associate Professor of Psychology, M.A. 1947, Northwestern
University
BARBARA L. ANDERSEN, Associate Professor of English, M.A. 1954, Northwestern
University
CHARLES S. ANDERSON, Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean of the College,
Ph.D. 1962, Union Theological Seminary
ERNEST W. ANDERSON, Professor of Health and Physical Education, M.Ed. 1947,
University of Minnesota, Department Chairperson
MARGARET J. ANDERSON, Head Librarian, Assistant Professor, M.A. 1970, University
of Minnesota
OSCAR A. ANDERSON, President of the College, B.D. 1942, Luther Theological
Seminary, L.L.D. 1963, Concordia College
R A Y M O N D E. ANDERSON, Professor of Speech, Ph.D. 1959, University of Minnesota
(Communications), Department Chairperson
*SCOTT L. ANDERSON, Lecturer i n Business Administration, B.A. 1976, Augsburg
College
B
*JAMES BACON, Lecturer in Library Science
KENNETH C. BAILEY, Professor of Philosophy, Ph.D. 1960, University of Minnesota,
Department Chairperson
VALERIA BALTINA, Assistant Professor Emeritus, Magester der Philologie 1933,
University of Latvia
*RABBI STEPHAN F. BARACK, Visiting Professor of Religion, Ph.D.
*MICHAEL BEERY, lnstructor i n Theater Arts, M.F.A. 1975, University of Minnesota
*ALLEN C. BENSON, Artist i n Residence i n Music (Percussion)
JOHNE. BENSON, Associate Professor of Religion, Ph.D. 1967, Columbia University
*ROBERT E. BEVERLEY, Artist in Residence in Music (Woodwinds), M.M. 1948, Northwestern University
* D O N A L D F. BIBEAU, Lecturer i n American Studies
*JAMES BILLINGS, Lecturer in Economics, M.A. 1967, University of Minnesota
VERNON B L O O M , Director of the Conservation of Human Resources Program, M.S.W.
1959, University of Minnesota
R I C H A R D BORSTAD, Instructor i n Health and Physical Education, M.A. 1969, University of Minnesota
*MARGARET SMITH BRAND, Artist i n Residence i n Music (Voice)
*MICHAEL BRAND, Artist i n Residence i n Music (Trumpet)
LOWELL BRANDT, College Pastor, M.Div. 1970, Luther Theological Seminary
*ROGER A. BROOKS, Lecturer i n Political Science, Ph.D. 1973, Michigan State University
*LAINE BRYCE, Artist i n Residence i n Music (Bassoon), B.A. 1969, University of
Minnesota
*DOLORES BURTNESS, Visiting Lecturer i n Religion, M.A. 1979, Luther Seminary
*WAYNE CARROLL, lnstructor in Economics, M.S. 1976, University of Minnesota
CARL H. CHRISLOCK, Professor of History, Ph.D. 1955, University of Minnesota
BERNHARD M. CHRISTENSEN, President Emeritus, Ph.D. 1929, The Hartford Seminary
Foundation
ROSALIE V. CLARK, Instructor, M.S.W. 1978, University of Minnesota
T O N I CLARK, Assistant Professor of English, Ph.D. 1973, University of California
Barbara
-Santa
ROBERT W. CLYDE, Associate Professor, Ph.D. 1964, University of Iowa (Director of the
Social Science Research Center)
AILENE COLE, Professor of Speech, Ph.D. 1974, University of Minnesota (Theater Arts)
BENJAMING. COOPER, Assistant Professor of Mathematics, Ph.D. 1971,Yale University
* J O H N COSGROVE, Guest Lecturer i n Business Administration, B.A. 1965, University of
Minnesota
*LIV DAHL, lnstructor i n Foreign Language, M.A. 1973, University of Minnesota
(Norwegian)
K. BERNER DAHLEN, Associate Professor Emeritus, M.A. 1940, University of Minnesota
*C. WILLIAM DOUGLASS, Director of Augsburg College Orchestra, M.M. 1965, Northwestern University
*JULIE H. DRIVER-BOLTON, lnstructor i n Speech and Theater Arts, M.F.A. 1969,
University of Minnesota
BEVERLY C. DURKEE, Associate Professor of Mathematics, Ph.D. 1972, Arizona State
University, Department Chairperson
GRACE B. DYRUD, Professor of Psychology, Ph.D. 1963, University of Minnesota
*EDGAR E. EKLOF, Artist i n Residence i n Music (Voice), M.M. 1956, Manhattan School of
Music
M A R K J. ENGEBRETSON, Assistant Professor of Physics, Ph.D. 1976, University of
Minnesota
*ROBERT A. ENCELSON, Director of Augsburg Chorale, B.A. 1972, Augsburg College
*KENNETH N. ERICKSON, Associate Professor of Physics, Ph.D. 1970, Colorado State
University, Department Chairperson
*ROLF ERIKSEN, Soccer Coach
F
SHELDON FARDIG, Associate Professor of Education, Ph.D. 1966, Northwestern
University
N O R M A N B.L. FERGUSON, Associate Professor of Psychology, Ph.D. 1972, University of
Wisconsin, Department Chairperson
LARRY P. FLEMING, Associate Professor of Music and Director of Choral Activities,
Ph.D., University of Minnesota
HENRY G. FOLLINGSTAD, Associate Professor o f Mathematics, M.A. 1971, Northwestern University
*ROBERT A. FORNANDER, Artist i n Residence i n Music (Voice), M.F.A. 1979, University
o f Minnesota
BURTON P. FOSSE, Director of Facility Development, B.B.A., B.M.E. 1949, University of
Minnesota
*FABIOLA FRANCO-STEINMIXZ, Assistant Professor of Foreign Language, Ph.D. 1979,
University of Minnesota (Spanish)
BARRY M. FRANKLIN, Assistant Professor of Education, Ph.D. 1974, University of
Wisconsin
*ROBERT FRIEDERICHSEN, Instructor i n Art, M.A. 1970, Pennsylvania State University
M A R K 1. FUEHRER, Assistant Professor o f Philosophy, Ph.D. 1974, University of
Minnesota
STEPHEN M. GABRIELSON, Associate Professor of Music, M.A. 1966, University of
Minnesota (Organ)
JERRY GERASIMO, Professor o f Sociology, Ph.D. 1966, University of Chicago
ORLOUE GISSELQUIST, Associate Professor of History, Ph.D. 1968, University of
Minnesota, Department Chairperson
ROBERT GRAMS, Assistant Professor of Sociology, Ph.D. 1975, University o f Minnesota
PAUL H. GRAUER, Assistant Professor of Health & Physical Education, M.A. 1973,
University of Minnesota
*BRIAN GRIVNA, Artist i n Residence i n Music (Saxophone)
*JOHNGRYGELKO, Wrestling Coach
SATYA P. GUPTA, Assistant Professor o f Economics, Ph.D. 1975, Southern Illinois
University
D O N A L D R. CUSTAFSON, Associate Professor of History and Director of Interim, Ph.D.
1969, University o f Wisconsin
ARLlN E. GYBERC, Associate Professor of Chemistry, Ph.D. 1969, University of
Minnesota
LElF E. HANSEN, Associate Professor of Foreign Language, M.A. 1950, University of
Minnesota (Norwegian)
THEODORE J. HANWICK, Professor Emeritus, Ph.D. 1950, New York University
MlLDA K. HEDBLOM, Associate Professor of Political Science, Ph.D. 1973, University of
Minnesota
*DOUGLAS HEIDENREICH, Lecturer in Business Law, L.L.B. 1961, William Mitchell
College of Law
MELVIN HELLAND, Professor Emeritus, Ph.D. 1930, The Hartford Seminary Foundation
KATHERINE HENNIC, Artist in Residence Emeritus, M.A. 1956, University of Minnesota
ROBERT S. HERFORTH, Associate Professor of Biology, Ph.D. 1968, University of
Nebraska
EDWINA 1. HERTZBERG, Assistant Professor of Social Work, M.S.W. 1972, University of
Minnesota, Department Chairperson
CARRY W. HESSER, Associate Professor of Sociology, Ph.D. 1972, University of Notre
Dame
CAROL HOFFMAN, Instructor in Nursing, M.S.N. 1976, University of Minnesota
NORMAN D. HOLEN, Associate Professor of Art, M.F.A. 1962, University of Iowa
(Sculpture)
JOHNR. HOLUM, Professor of Chemistry, Ph.D. 1954, University of Minnesota
I. KHlN KHlN JENSEN, Professor of History, Ph.D. 1956, University of Wisconsin
MILDRED V. JOEL, Professor Emeritus, and Director of Scandinavian Area Studies, M.A.
1947, University of Minnesota
DUANE E. JOHNSON, Professor of Psychology, Ph.D. 1967, University of Minnesota
ElNAR 0. JOHNSON, Professor Emeritus, Ph.D. 1961, University of Washington
GLEN W. JOHNSON, Vice President for Development, B.S.E. 1952, University of
Nebraska, and B.D. 1959, Luther Theological Seminary
JAMESD. JOHNSON,Assistant Professor of Music, M.S. 1958, Juilliard School of Music
(Piano)
JAMES LEE JOHNSON, Assistant Professor of Mathematics and Computer Science,
Ph.D. 1973, University of Minnesota
*LEOLA JOHNSON, Visiting Lecturer i n Political Science, M.A. 1976, University of
Kentucky
MARY ELIZABETH JOHNSON, Associate Professor in Foreign Language, M.A. 1950,
University of Minnesota, M.A. 1950, Columbia University (French)
REES M. JOHNSON, Assistant Professor of Health and Physical Education, M.S. 1971,
Winona State University, Head Basketball Coach
A M l N KADER, Assistant Professor of Business Administration, M.B.A. 1965, University
of Michigan
ROBERT KARLEN, Associate Professor of Music, M.A. 1959, University of Minnesota,
Department Chairperson
*JOANNE KARVONEN, Lecturer i n English, M.A. 1962, University of Georgia
* D I A N A LEE KENNELLY, Artist i n Residence i n Music (Piano), M.A. 1969, University of
Minnesota
M A R Y MARIE KINCSLEY, Assistant Professor of Foreign Language, M.A. 1964, Middlebury College (Spanish)
BERNHARDT J. KLEVEN, Professor Emeritus, Ph.D. 1941, University of Minnesota
ALVIN L. KLOPPEN, Assistant Professor of Health and Physical Education, M.A. 1970,
University of South Dakota (Head Football Coach)
SUSAN J. KNUST, lnstructor i n Nursing, M.S. 1979, Wright State University
* N O R M A KNUTSON, lnstructor i n Religion, M.A. Columbia University
B O Y D N. KOEHLER, Librarian, Assistant Professor, M.A. 1967, University of Minnesota
*ANITA SUE KOLMAN, Assistant Professor of Sociology, Ph.D. 1977, University of
Minnesota
*ROY H. LAFAYETTE, Lecturer i n Business Administration, B.S.B. 1965, University of
Minnesota
ROBERTA LAMMERS, Assistant Professor of Biology, Ph.D. 1976, University of Minnesota
LORRAINE K. LIVINGSTON, Associate Professor Emeritus, M.A. 1932, University of
Minnesota
GERTRUDE S. LUND, Associate Professor Emeritus, M.A. 1951, University of Minnesota
*MARY ELLEN LUNDSTEN, lnstructor i n Political Science, Ph.D. 1976, University of
Minnesota
M
J U D I T H MACCANELLI, Assistant Professor of Nursing, M.Ed. 1965, University of
Minnesota
NANCY S. MALCOLM, Assistant Professor of Nursing, M.P.H. 1969, University of
Minnesota
RICHARD MARKEN, Assistant Professor of Psychology, Ph.D. 1973, University of
California - Santa Barbara
KElSHlRO M A T S U M O T O , Assistant Professor of Business Administration, M.B.A. 1965,
University of Michigan
M A R T H A M. MATTSON, Associate Professor Emeritus, M.A. 1932, University of
Minnesota
*MARIE MCNEFF, Associate Professor of Education, Ed.D. 1967, University of Nebraska
*LYNNE E. MEDCALF, Guest Lecturer i n Business Administration, M.B.A. 1975, University
of Minnesota
ROBERTA A. METZLER, Assistant Professor of Music, M.M.Ed. 1971, University of Kansas
(Music Therapy)
ERWIN D. MICKELBERC, Professor of Biology, M.A. 1964, University of Minnesota
J O H N R. MITCHELL, Assistant Professor of English, M.A. 1971, University of Tennessee
*AUGUST MOLDER, Artist i n Residence i n Art, L.L.D. 1944, University of Tartu, Estonia
(Stained Glass)
JOEL MUCCE, Assistant Professor of Speech and Communications, M.A. 1976,
University of Minnesota
SUSAN K. NASH, Assistant Professor of Nursing, M.S. 1974, University of Minnesota
*DOUGLAS NELSON, Athletic Trainer - Manager
EDOR C. NELSON, Associate Professor Emeritus, M.Ed. 1947, University of Minnesota
Head Baseball Coach
C O R D O N L. NELSON, Associate Professor of Sociology, Ph.D. 1972, University of
Chicago, Department Chairperson
RICHARD C. NELSON, Associate Professor of History, Ph.D. 1975, University of
Minnesota
*CATHERINE C. NICHOLL, Assistant Professor of English, Ph.D. 1971, University of
Minnesota, Department Co-Chairperson
*CRIER NICHOLL, Professor of English, Ph.D. 1964, University o f Minnesota, (American
Studies)
BEVERLY NILSSON, Associate Professor of Nursing, M.S. 1973, University of Minnesota,
Department Chairperson
N O R M A C. N O O N A N , Professor of Political Science, Ph.D. 1965, Indiana University,
Department Chairperson
*CELESTE O'BRIEN, Artist i n Residence i n Music, B.A. Hamline University (Piano)
RICHARD D. OLMSTED, Assistant Professor of Chemistry, Ph.D. 1974, University of
Wisconsin
ESTHER OLSON, Professor Emeritus, Ph.D. 1956, University of Minnesota
JAMES F. OLSON, Librarian I, M.A. 1977, University of Minnesota
*JACK OSBERC, Assistant Football Coach
*WILLIAM OYLER, Assistant Professor of Foreign Language, M.A. 1963, University of
Minnesota (German)
R O N A L D G. PALOSAARI, Associate Professor of English, Ph.D. 1970, University of
Minnesota
PATRICIA PARKER, Associate Dean of the College and Director of Special Programs,
Ph.D. 1974, University of Minnesota
KERMIT E. PAULSON, Associate Professor of Physics, M.S. 1963, University of Wisconsin
*PAMELA PAULSON, lnstructor i n Health and Physical Education, M.A. 1974, University
of Illinois - Urbana
ANNE PEDERSON, Professor Emeritus, M.A. 1945, University of Minnesota
WAYNE D. PEDERSON, Vice President for Finance and Management, B.S. 1963,
Concordia College
LAURETTA E. PELTON, Assistant Professor of Education, M.Ed. 1966, Marquette
University, Department Chairperson
DOUGLAS D. PERRY, lnstructor in Social Work, M.S.W. 1977, University of Minnesota
DANIEL PETERSON, lnstructor i n Physics, Ph.D. 1978, Iowa State University
LAVONNE J. PETERSON, Associate Professor of Health and Physical Education, M.A.
1953, Montana State University
JOYCE PFAFF, Assistant Professor of Health and Physical Education, M.Ed. 1969,
University of Minnesota
*GEORGE L. POWELL, lnstructor i n Business Administration and Economics, M.B.A.
1960, Dartmouth College
*ALICE PREVES, Artist in Residence i n Music, M.S. 1964, University of Illinois - Urbana
(Strings)
M A R T I N QUANBECK, Professor Emeritus, Ph.D. 1952, University of Minnesota
PHILIP A. QUANBECK,
Seminary
Professor of Religion, Ph.D. 1958, Princeton Theological
BRUCE R. REICHENBACH, Associate Professor of Philosophy, Ph.D. 1968, Northwestern
University
*BARBARA RICHARDS, lnstructor i n Political Science, B.A. 1972, Vanderbilt University
* J O H N F. RILEY, Associate Professor of Religion, Ph.D. 1964, CathoEc University of
America
*DENISE R. RIVET, Women's Gymnastics Coach
GUNTA ROZENTALS, Associate Professor of Foreign Language, Ph.D. 1968, University
of Minnesota (Spanish), Department Chairperson
*PAUL RUSTEN, Adjunct lnstructor i n Art (Film Making)
-
EDWARD M. SABELLA, Associate Professor of Business Administration and Economics,
Ph.D. 1971, University of Minnesota, Department Chairperson
MARIANNE SANDER, Vice President for Student Affairs, M.A. 1969, University of
Minnesota
RICHARD B. SARGENT, Assistant Professor of English, Ph.D. 1974, University of Exeter
(England), Department Co-Chairperson
LELAND B. SATEREN, Professor Emeritus, L.H.D. 1965, Gettysburg College, D. Mus.
1965, Lakeland College
E D W I N 1. SAUGESTAD, Associate Professor of Health and Physical Education, M.A.
1964, University of Minnesota (Head Hockey Coach)
A. M A Y 0 SAVOLD, Associate Professor Emeritus, M.Mus. Ed. 1963, MacPhail School of
Music
*WILLIAM 6. SCHEELA, Guest Lecturer i n Business Administration, M.B.A. 1974,
Mankato State University
*MARIA S. SCHWEIKERT, lnstructor i n Foreign Language, M.A. 1974, University of
Pittsburgh
IRENE SCHILLING, Librarian I, M.A. 1973, University of Minnesota
MARJORIE H. SIBLEY, Librarian, Associate Professor, M.A. 1943, University o f Illinois,
M.A. 1961, University of Minnesota
EUGENE M. SKIBBE, Professor of Religion, D.Th. 1962, University of Heidelberg
(Germany), Department Chairperson
* D A N A SKOGLUND, Artist i n Residence i n Music, B.M. 1975, Augsburg College (Piano)
* E M M A SMALL, Artist in Residence i n Music (Voice)
* H O W A R D D. SMALL, Artist i n Residence i n Music (Organ)
*LOUISA A N N SMITH, Lecturer i n Library Science, M.A. 1969, University of Minnesota
*PAUL C. SONNACK, Visiting Professor of Religion, M.A. 1960, University of Chicago
*SOTERIOS STAVROU, lnstructor i n Foreign Language (Greek), B.A. 1966, Augsburg
College
PAUL T. STEEN, Professor Emeritus, Ph.D. 1962, University of Minnesota
D O N A L D 6. STEINMETZ, Associate Professor of Foreign Language, Ph.D. 1973,
University of Minnesota (German, Linguistics)
MYLES C. STENSHOEL, Professor of Political Science, Ph.D. 1965, University of Colorado
*VAL STRACHAN, Women's Basketball Coach, B.A., Mankato State University
*BRUCE STUART, Visiting Lecturer i n Religion
GRACE KEMMER SULERUD, Librarian, Assistant Professor, M.A. 1968, M.A. 1970,
University of Minnesota
RALPH L. SULERUD, Professor of Biology, Ph.D. 1968, University of Nebraska
*MARY T. SWANSON, Assistant Professor of Art, Ph.D. 1978, University of Minnesota
LARRY TALLMAN, Instructor i n Music, M.S. 1978, Michigan State University, Director of
the Augsburg Concert Band and the Jazz Ensemble
*JAMES TEN BENSEL, Artist i n Residence i n Music (Brass)
*PAUL THOMAS, Artist i n Residence i n Music (Cello)
PHILIP J. THOMPSON, Professor of Art, M.F.A. 1958, University of Iowa (Painting)
Department Chairperson
RICHARD J. THONI, Associate Dean of Students, Ph.D. University of Minnesota 1977.
NEAL 0. THORPE, Professor of Biology, Ph.D. 1965, University of Wisconsin, Department Chairperson
J O H N THUT, Associate Professor Emeritus, M.Mus. 1934, American Conservatory of
Music
VERA THUT, Instructor Emeritus, B.Mus. 1927, American Conservatory of Music
*MARY T I M M , Women's Volleyball and Softball Coach
JOEL S. TORSTENSON, Professor Emeritus, Ph.D. 1959, University of Minnesota
BEVERLY A. WEGGE, Registrar, M.A. 1974, University of Minnesota
*DOROTHY WILLIAMSON, Lecturer i n Art, M.A. 1963, University of Minnesota
*MARY WILSON, Artist i n Residence i n Music, B.A. 1938, Macalester College (Flute)
HELEN A. WOELFEL, Assistant Professor of Nursing, M.S. 1962, Marquette University
D A V I D C. W O O D , Professor of English, Ph.D. 1969, Bowling Green State University
*NANCY ZINGALE, Visiting Professor of Political Science, Ph.D. University of Minnesota
Administrative Personnel
GENERAL ADMINISTRATION
President ............................................. .Oscar A. Anderson
Director of Facility Development ........................ Burton P. Fosse
College Pastor ........................................ .Lowell Brandt
Secretary and Executive Assistant to the President..
.Avalon Okerson
......
FINANCE A N D MANAGEMENT
Vice President for Finance and Management ............ .Wayne Pederson
Director of Plant Services .............................. .Gerald Johnson
Director of Food Services .............................. .Carl Stromer
Manager, College Center .............................. .Mildred Nelson
Manager, Purchasing/Book Store/Vending .............. .Robert Gores
Director of Student Financial Services ................... .Herald Johnson
Director of Personnel.. ................................ .Bonnie-Jean M o r k
Manager, Ice Arena ................................... .James Carey
Custodial Supervisor. .................................. .Joseph Roberts
Maintenance Supervisor ............................... .Alfred Sandau
Grounds Supervisor ................................... .Fred Wolter
Chief Accountant ..................................... .Ronald Scherman
ACADEMIC AFFAIRS
Vice President for Academic Affairs and Dean
of the College .....................................Charles S. Anderson
Associate Academic Dean .............................. .Pat Parker
.Beverly Wegge
Registrar .............................................
Head Librarian ........................................ .Margaret Anderson
Director of Audio Visual Services ....................... .James Olson
Coordinator, New Dimensions Program ................. .Charlene Weidenbach
.Bonnie Wallace
Counselor/Advocate, American Indian Programs
Coordinator, Black Student Affairs ...................... .Valerie Geaither
Recorder ............................................. .Hope Schutte
.Pamela Louisa
Assistant Registrar .....................................
Executive Secretary t o the Dean ........................ .Carolyn Magnuson
.........
DEVELOPMENT
........................ .Glen W. Johnson
...........................Sigvald Hjelmeland
............................. .Michael Walgren
Vice President for Development
Director of Deferred Giving..
Director of Annual Fund..
Asst. t o the Vice-president ..................... ,
Associate Director, Alumni and
Parent Giving .......................................
Executive Secretary ....................................
....... .A. B. Batalden
.Jeroy Carlson
.Irene Steenson
PUBLIC RELATIONS
Director of Public Relations ............................ .Lois G. Wollan
Coordinator of Parent/Alumni Programs ................ .Janice Rykken
Coordinator of News Bureau and Sports Information..
Fine Arts Coordinator ................................. .Monica Maye
Manager, Graphic Center .............................. .Therese Morrison
....
ADMISSIONS
Director of Admissions.. ............................... .Kathryn E. Lange
Assistant Director
Bill Ross
.Sue Bonner
Coordinator of Transfer Programs..
Admissions Counselor ..................................Eric Anderson
Admissions Counselor ................................. .Sally Hough
Admissions Counselor ................................. .Tom Jackson
.....................................
.....................
STUDENT AFFAIRS
Vice President for Student Affairs and
Dean of Students.. .................................. .Marianne Sander
Associate Dean of Students ............................ .Rick Thoni
Director of Student Life (Housing) ...................... .Linda Schrempp-Alberg
Director of Career Planning and Placement ............. .Patricia M. Olsson
Director of Student Activities.. ......................... .Joan Slater
Head Resident, (UrnesdMortensen) .................... .Cindy Ragen
Director of Human Development.. ..................... .Judy Essman
Coordinator, Academic Enrichment ..................... .Don Warren
Area Apartment Manager .............................. .John Augustine
INDEX
...........
Academic Administration
47
Academic Life ..................... 14
Accreditation ....................... 7
Administration ................... 156
Admission to the College ........... 31
Advanced Placement ...............34
Advanced Standing ................ 34
American Indian Programs
26
American Studies .................. 56
Anthropology .................... 139
Art, Department of ................. 57
Biology. Department of ............. 60
Black Student Programs ............ 26
Board of Regents ................. 116
Business Administration ............ 63
Calendar ...................... Cover
Campus Map ...................... 70
Certification Programs .............. 22
Chemistry. Department of .......... 71
Chinese ........................... 87
Classification ...................... 54
Communications ................. 141
Computer Science ................ 101
Conservation of Human
Resources (CHR) ................. 19
Continuing Education .............. 22
Corrective Therapy ................ 19
Costs .......................... 35. 44
Course Descriptions ................ 56
Course Value ...................... 54
Credit by Examination .............. 54
Dean's List ........................ 52
Degrees ........................... 23
Divisional Organization ............ 47
East Asian Studies .................. 74
Economics ........................ 67
Education. Department of .......... 75
Engineering ....................... 81
English. Department of ............. 81
Enrollment ........................ 55
Expenses ....................... 35, 4
Faculty ........................... 147
Financial Aid ...................... 35
Five-College Cooperative ........... 18
Food Service ...................... 29
Foreign Language,
Department of ................... 86
French ............................ 87
44
Full-Time Student Defined
General Education
Requirements ................... 15
..........
..........
Geography ........................ 99
German ........................... 90
Glossary of Terms ................... 4
Grading ........................... 50
Graduates ......................... 55
Graduation Requirements
48
Graduation with Distinction
32
Greek ............................ 92
Health Education ................. 719
Health Service ..................... 29
History of Augsburg College
6
History. Department of ............. 96
Honors Program ................... 22
Housing ....................... 27, 45
Independent Study ................ 52
Intercollegiate Athletics ............ 25
Intercultural Center ................ 26
Inter-Institutional Programs
75
International Students .............. 27
Internship Program ................ 22
Japanese .......................... 92
Journalism ........................ 83
Library Science .................... 80
Location ........................... 6
Majors ............................ 15
Mathematics, Department of ........ 99
Medical Technology .............. 702
Metro-Urban Studies .............. 102
Music, Department of ............. 104
Music Therapy .................... 108
Nature and Objectives
.6
of Augsburg ...............
Natural Science ................... 109
22
New Dimensions Program
Non-Discrimination Policy ........... 7
Norwegian ........................ 93
Numbering of Courses ............. 55
Nursing .......................... 111
Personnel of the College .......... 147
16
Pre-Professional Training
113
Philosophy, Department of
Physical Education ................ 116
Physical Plant ...................... 12
Physics, Department of ............ 120
Political Science,
Department of .................. 123
Probation and Dismissal ............ 49
Psychology, Department of ........ 126
Regents, Board of ................. 146
45
Refunds .........................
Registration ....................... 49
..........
........
.........
.........
..,
..........
...........
........
Religion. Department of ........... 129
Religious Life ...................... 24
Russian Area Studies .............. 132
Scandinavian Area Studies ......... 133
Scholarships. Grants ................ 35
Social Science Majors ............. 134
135
Social Work. Department of
Sociology. Department of .......... 138
Spanish ........................... 94
Speech. Department of ............ 141
Student Life ....................... 24
Student Rights ..................... 29
.......
Student Services ................... 25
Study Abroad ...................... 20
Summer School .................... 22
Symbol (#) ........................ 55
Theater Arts ...................... 143
Transdiciplinary Major
145
Transfer t o Augsburg
32
Tuition and Fees ................ 35. 44
Veterans .......................... 53
Visiting the Campus ................. 7
Work-Study ....................... 35
............
...............
CATALOG
1980-82
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
This material was published t o supply information on additions and changes to the
1980-82 Catalog. Material i s arranged in the same order as in the 1980-82 Catalog,
with page number references. Although information was current at the time of
publication, it i s subject to change without notice.
It is the responsibility of each student to know the requirements and academic
policies contained i n this publication and the main 1980-82 Catalog. If you have
questions about anything in this bulletin, you should consult with a faculty adviser,
the Dean of the College, or the Registrar.
Accreditation and Memberships
National League for Nursing
National Association for Music Therapy, Inc.
College Costs 1981-82
Tuition (full-time enrollment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $4,300.00
600.00
Tuition (part-time enrollment) per course ...........................
300.00
Audit Fee (for part-time students) per course ........................
Room Rent (includes telephone) ................................... 1,091.00
986.00
Full Board (19 meals a week) .......................................
Other board plans are available as defined in the housing contract booklet available
from the Office of Student Life.
Other Special Fees (not refundable)
ACTC Bus (Full-time students
only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Medical Technology
(Senior Fee)
..............
5.00
Music Lessons
Private, per semester
(14 lessons) ............
Class, per semester
.......
150.00
50.00
600.00
Music Therapy Internship (one
course credit) ............ 600.00
POSTMASTER
Volume 112, Number 2
Summer 1981
612/300-1001
AUGSBURG COLLEGE (USPS #490-310) i s published four times a year in Spring,
Summer, Fall, and Winter by AugsburgCollege,73121st Avenue South, Minneapolis
M N 55454. Second-class postage paid at Minneapolis, Minnesota.
Financial Aid/l7-18
Gift Assistance
Augsburg Tuition Grant - Available to students w h o have shown academic
potential and have financial need. A grant may pay u p t o full tuition and fees. A
student's scholastic standing, test scores, and high school and community involvement 'are taken into consideration.
Minnesota State Scholarship and Grant - Awarded by the state to Minnesota
residents w h o have financial need. For 1981-82, they range f r o m $100 to $1050. All
applicants f r o m Minnesota are expected to apply before the priority deadline of
April 23.
Supplemental EducationalOpportunity Grant - A federal program administered by
the College. To be eligible, a person niust: (1) be a U.S. citizen or permanent
resident; (2) have sufficient financial need as defined by the program and
demonstrated by the FFS (or FAF); (3) be capable of maintaining satisfactory
academic standing at the College; and (4) be accepted for admission.
Pel1 Grants [formerly Basic Educational 0 portunity Grants) - A federal program
ihat provider Rasic Grant awards to stufents who attend eligible institutions of
higher education. The maximum grant eligibility for each student for 1981-82 i s
$1670. minus t h c a m o u n t the studentand family can beexpected tocontribute. The
grants are based o n need as determined by the program guidelines. Application i s
made by filing the F F S (or FAF) and requesting o n the application f o r m that the
necessary information be sent t o the appropriate BEOG office.
Bureau of lndian Affairs Scholarships/Grants - American Indian students whomeet
federal and state requirements may apply for Bureau of Indian 4ffairs.fribal and/or
lndian Stare Scholarship monies. You must be "1 degree lndian ancesrrv and be
enrolled with a federally recognized tribe. lndian grants supplement a l l other
sources of financial aid. For assistance in application contact Augsburg's American
lndian Program Director or your tribal agency.
National Scholarship and Grant Program for Minority Students (sponsored by The
American Lutheran Church) - Members of American racial and ethnic minorities
and other eligible groups who are either seeking admission to an American
Lutheran Church (ALC) college OR are members of an ALC congregation may be
considered. Winners are selected by Augsburg's Student Affairs Committee.
Scholarships/20-23
Religion & Christian Service Scholarships
Norman and Louise Bockbrader Scholarship - awarded to students preparing for full-time
service careers in the church.
The Reverend Lawrence and Gertrude Sateren Scholarship -awarded to students preparing
in fields leading to full-time service in the church.
Departmental Scholarships
Chemistry
Ellenand Courtland Agre Chemistr Award -given toa chemistry major, preferably one going
into graduate studies to earn the dbctorate in chemistry.
Health-Related
Ellen and Courtland Agre Pre-Medicine Award - given to a student of any major who is
planning on entering medical school to earn a doctorate in medicine.
History
Dr. Carl H. Chrislock History Scholarship -awarded
The Rev. and Mrs.
study of history.
annually to a history major.
0.1. Haukeness Award - given t o a senior student for excellence i n the
Music
Edwin W. and Edith B. NorbergScholarship - awarded to music majors preparing for careers in
church music.
Schubert Club Scholarship -awarded
annually to a music therapy student.
Political Science
Political Science Scholarship - An award of recognition to an outstanding senior majoring in
political science.
Majors, Licensure/33
Majors and Minors
Majors, or concentrations of study. may be wirhin ane department, within one
division. or cror5 academic disciplines. Some students decide on a major or majors
before they enter coIlege. Others test a variety of disciplines before deciding.
Normally a majorshould be elec~edby rhe end of the Fourth semester and earlier in
some disciplines. Details of majors and minors are in the course description section.
Majors available at Augsburg are:
Art History
Studio Art
Biology
Business Administration
(Accounting, Finance,
International Business,
Management, Marketing)
Chemistry
Communication
East Asian Studies'
Economics
Economics-BusinessAdministration
Elementary Education
Engineering'
English
Foreign Languages
Chinese,l French
German, Japanese,'
Norwegian, Russian,l
Spanish
Health Education
History
International Relations
Mathematics
Medical Technology3
Metro-Urban Studies
Music
Music Therapy
Natural Science
Nursing
Philosophy
Physical Education
Physics
Political Science
Psychology
Religion
Russian Area Studies'
Scandinavian Area Studies'
Social Science
Social Work
Sociology
Speech
Theater Arts
Transdisciplinary
I t is possible for students to complete other majors through the ACTC. Students who wish to
complete a major offered at one of the other ACTC colleges must apply through the Augsburg
Registrar's Office.
1 - Cooperative Program of the Associated Colleges of the Twin Cities and agreements with
the University of Minnesota
2 - Three-Two Plan with Washington University Schooi of Engineering and Applied Science
and Michigan Technological University
3 - Cooperative program with Metropolitan Medical Center and Abbott-Northwestern
Hospital
Teaching Licensure
Teaching Licensure programs are offered a t Augsburg in Elementary Education,
Kindergarren. Earlv Childhood Education, and these fields in secondarv Education:
Arf. English-Language Arts, French, German. Health, L ~ f eSc~ence,Mathematics.
Music, Fhvsical Education, Physical Science (Chem~srrvor Phvsics\, Science (Grade5
5-9)) Social Studies, Spanish. Speech. Theater Arts. A minor is offered i n Librarv
Science. 5tudcnts planning to teach on the secondarv level have advtjers both in the
Education department and the area of their academic majnrisl.
Graduation Requirements/39-40
Graduation Requirements
The responsibility for seeing that all degree requirements are satisfied rests with the
student. Academic advisers, department chairpersons, the Academic Dean and the
Registrar are available for counsel and assistance in program planning.
Each student must apply for graduation at the time specified by the Registrar.
Application forms are available i n the Registrar's Office.
All degree and course requirements must be completed prior to the anticipated
date of graduation (there may be no incompletes or open courses o n the academic
record).
1. Completion of 35 courses.
4r least 11 courses must be upper division, numbered in the 300sand 400s. Not more
than 1 3 may be i n one de artmenl, except i n certain approved majors for the
Bachelor of Science/Ani g g r e e . 17 for ,he Bachelor of Music a n d Bachelor of
Sc~encern Music Thera y degrees. and 18 in r he Bachelor oi Science in Nursing
degree. The course fotafmcsl include three l n ~ e r i r nfor
i i1udenr5 whore complete
academic work i s at Aupburg. For transfer studenrc. the course oral must include
one less interim course than the number of years at Augsburg.
No rnorerhan these maximums mav beapplied toward the 35 rota1 courses required:
4 Conservation of Human Resources (CHR] courses: 2 courses bv independent/
directed study: 4 courses of internship; and 8 courses w ~ t ha grade of Pass (P).
Non-traditional g r a d ~ n g( P ) also has these limits: 2 In the major except Elementary
Educar~on:7 i n the minor i f approved bv the departmen! chairperson.
Students who enter the Nursing program with a Bachelor of Arts degree should
contact the Office of the Registrar for specific requirements for the equivalent of a
major i n Nursing.
2. Completion of a major.
Requirements for each major are listed under the departmental headings. A minor
or double-major i s not required, but i s encouraged.
3. Grade Point average - 2.0 for most majors.
A grade point average of 2.0 i s required in all courses taken and in courses which
apply toward the major, except tor Nursing and licensure i n education, where 2.5
averages are required.
4. Residence
The last year of full-time s:udy or equivalent must be at Augsburg.
5. Distribution requirements
Writing - A course i n writing (English 111) or certification of demonstrated
proficiency by the Department of English. Exemption tests are given during the
summer and fall orientation periods.
Liberal Arts
An approved course from each of these seven areas:
Mathematics-Physics
Chemistry-Biology
Psychology-Sociology
English-Speech, Communication
& Theater Arts
Economics-Political Science
History-Philosophy
Art-Music
Foreign Languages - Two courses (111 and 112) of one foreign language at
Augsburg. Students who test above the111 level of a foreign language will take one
additional courseat placement level i n that language or two courses (111and 112) of
another foreign language.
Religious Studies -Three approved courses i n religious studies, of which not more
than one may be an interim course. For transfer students, the number required is,
one for each year of study or equivalent at Augsburg.
Urban Concerns, or Women's Studies, or Minority Studies - Courses approved to
meet this requirement are published each term. Information i s available at the
Office of the Registrar.
Lifetime Sports - Two lifetime sports or demonstrated proficiency in two lifetime
sports.
Evaluation a n d Grading/40-41
Evaluation and Grading
Student achievement in courses i s measured primarily by final examinations. Shorter
tests, written papers, oral reports, and other types of evaluation also are used.
Most courses are offered with grading options - traditional grading on a 4.0 to 0.0
scale or the Pass/No Credit system, in which P means a grade of 2.0 or better and N
means no credit and a grade of less than 2.0. Students are cautioned to use the P/N
grade option with care since some graduate and professional schools d o not look
favorably on a large number of P-graded courses, or rank each as a "C". See P/N
limitations under Graduation Requirements.
Certain courses are offered on one grading system only. Sociology 383 and several
interim coursesare graded only on the P/N grading system. Some education c.ourses
are graded only on the P/N system or only o n the traditionalsystem. English 111 i s
graded P or N, or 2.0-4.O/N. Some other courses are graded only P, 1.0, N.
Music organizations and performance studies, Chemistry Seminar, and Lifetime
Sports are graded P/O.O.
In courses where there i s a choice, students will be graded on the traditional system
unless they indicate on their registration that they wish to use the P/N grading
option. Any changes i n choice of grading system must be made according to dates
published each term. A fee is charged for any changes after the first five days of
classes.
Explanation of Grades
Number grades are used with these definitions:
4.0
3.5
3.0
2.5
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0
Achieves highest standards of excellence
Achieves above basic course standards
Meets basic standards for the course
Performance below basic course standards
Unacceptable performance (no credit for the course)
Grades of P (Pass) or N (No credit) are not computed in the grade point average. .4
grade of P represents work at or above the 2.0 level; N represents work at the 1.5 or
below level.
A n incomplete rade may be given only i n the case of extreme emergency. To
receive i r , a 5;tu ent must file a petition with the Committee on Admissions and
Student Standing stating he reasons for the request, the plan and date for removing
it,and comments from rhe instructor. If permission is granted. the incomplete must
be removed during the following semester, or i t becomes the grade submitted b v
the teacher along with the incomplete.
J
A grade of X may be given for an independenr or directed study course or internship
that is to be spread over morethan one semester. Such a course must be completed
during rhe second semester or the grade of X will remain on the record.
A course in which a grade of 0,1.0,f -5,N, I, or X has been received may be repeated
for credit. Courses i n which higher grades have been earned may not be repeated
for credit, but may be audrted. All courses taken remain on the academic record.
Onlythe credits and gradesearned thesecond time are counted toward graduation
and i n the grade point average.
A course i s given a grade of W when it is dropped after the deadline for dropping
classes without a notation on the record.
Art/49
352 Women's Art History
A study of women's image in the visual arts in relationship to women's place within the
cultural, economic, and sociological environment of each period.
Education
Marie McNeff (Chairperson), Bobbi Anderson, Sheldon Fardig, Barry Franklin, Einar
Johnson, Sallye Cooke McKee, Lauretta Pelton
Augsburg College offers programs leading to licensure i n Elementary Education,
Kindergarten, Early Childhood, and Secondary Education.
Students wishing to become licensed teachers are advised to consult with the
Education Department for licensure requirements. For students transferring t o
Augsburg College from other institutions of higher education, i t i s within the
jurisdiction of the Education Department and/or other appropriate departments t o
determine essential equivalency of course content taken at other institutions as
applicable to requirements of the approved teacher education program at Augsburg
College.
Orientation to Education, both elementary and secondary, and Techniques of
Teaching Reading are open to all students of sophomore standing or above. To
enroll i n other education caurse5.a student must first apply and be admitted to the
teacher education program. Students are advised to apply for admission in the
spring semester of the sophomore vear, during or after the Orientation course.
Students transferring from an education program at another college must be
readmissible to that program.
Elementary Education
Marie McNeff (Coordinator)
Major and Licensure Requirements: Minimum of 8.5 education courses (255, 351,
383,and two professional semesters); Health Education 114,115; Library Science341,
358; Academic minor (major recommended); GPAof 2.0 overall and 2.5 in major and
academic minor for licensure; fulfill Minnesota Board of Teaching 5 MCAR 3.041 in
Human Relations. The first professional semester, for juniors, includes Educ. 341,
352,353,381,382,384. (Courses 381,382,383,384 are one-half courses offered on a
traditional grading system only.) The second professional semester includes Educ.
481,482 and electives (483, 484,.478, 499).
Kindergarten License Re uirements: Elementary Education requirements plus
Educ. 385 and student t e a 3 i n g at the Kindergarten level.
Early Childhood Education
Bobbi Anderson (Coordinator)
License Requirements: Elementary Education requirements plus Soc. 231; Psych.
351; Educ. 325,425,483 or484(160 hoursof studentteaching). Foran Early Childhood
license with other than an education major, consult with the program coordinator.
255 Orientation to Education in Urban Setting (Elementary)
Investigation of various aspects of the teaching profession and opportunity for in-schoo[
work. Open to all students. (Prereq.: sophomore standing or above)
282 Introduction to Special Education
(See Secondary Education)
325 Contemporary Influences in Early Childhood Education
Focus is upon the young child as a person and the importance of the early years of his/her
life i n relation t o the effects of present-day society and culture upon the child. Current
developments include innovations, Head Start, implementation of planned variations.and
other interventionsand compensatory programs. Classsessions and two hours perweek of
lab. experience i n a day care center and/or nursery school. (Spring)
341 Media Technology (1/2 course)
(See Library Science)
351 Techniques of Teaching Reading
The study and utilization of a variety of techniquesand resources i n the teaching of reading
at both secondary and elementary level. (Fall)
352, 353 Creating Learning Environments: Elementary
The mastery of theories and their applicationsfor teaching in learning settings. Laboratory
experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or 265 o r d. Spring)
381 Elementary Curriculum: Art, Music (1/2 course)
Examination and preparation of materials and resources for art and music taught at the
elementary level. Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or 265, concurrent registration i n
352. 353. Spring)
382 Elementary Curriculum: Science, Mathematics (1/2 course)
Examination and preparation of materials and resources for science and mathematics
taught at the elementary level. Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.: 255 o r 265. concurrent
registration i n 352. 353. Spring)
383 Elementary Curriculum: Physical Education, Health (1/2 course)
Examination and preparation of materialsand resources for physical education and health
taught at the elementary level. Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or 265. Fall)
384 Elementary Curriculum: Social Studies, Language Arts, (1/2 course)
Examination and preparation of materialsand resourcesfor social studies and language arts
taught at the elementary level. Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or 265. concurrent
registration i n 352. 353. Spring)
385 Discovery in the World of Kindergarten
A study of the kindergarten curriculum, exploration of materials. and review of teaching
approaches. The course requires laboratory experience. Required for Kindergarten
licensure. (Prereq.: Orientation to Ed. and acceptance into the Dept. of Ed.. Summer I)
399 Internship
The student may select from a variety of situations for professional work experience. A
learning contract must be developed and must have education faculty approvdl.
425 Early Childhood Curriculum
Learning about and demonstrating knowledge and skills of teaching the young child. The
course concentrates on details essential to the organization of a good program for
children: records, reports, physical facilities, equipment. parental involvement. and
working with children who have uniquely different needs. Class sessionsand two hours per
week of lab experience i n a day care center and/or nursery school. (Fall)
181,482 Student Teaching I
Observing and directing learning at the following levels: N. K, and/or elementary levels
under the supervision of college and elementary school personnel. (Prereq.: Admission to
student teaching and program approval. Fall. Spring)
483,484 Student Teaching II
Additional experience In teaching. (Prereq.: 481. 482. Fall. Spring)
478 School and Society
(See Secondary Education)
499 Independent Study
Opportunity for advanced and specialized research projects not otherwise provided for in
the departmental curriculum. A projected program must be outlined and approved by the
elementary education faculty.
Secondary Education
Sheldon Fardig (Coordinator)
It i s the responsibility of each student to meet all specific requirements of the
Education Department. Secondary Education students are advised ta consult with
Education faculty regarding state requirementsfor teacher licensure, This consultation is recommended in addition to conferring with the student's major field
adviser.
Licensure Program Requirements for Secandary Education: ( 7 1 Application for
admittance and acceptance into the Department of Education teacher [icensure
program. This mav be made before, concurrently or afrer rhe Orierrtarion course.
Application formsare ava~lablein the Education Department office. Before applying
f o r admission, students should receive approval from the departmenr ordivision of
their declared major. A student may take education courses after the Orientation
course only if he or she has been admitted into the program of the Department of
Education; (2) GPA of 2.0overall,2.0 in required education courses,and at least 2.5 in
the major; (3) Application for admittance and acceptance into student teaching; (4)
Completion of Minnesota Board of Teaching 5 MCAR 3.041 in Human Relations
through Augsburg's Education program; (5) Successful completion of the required
courses of the education program: Psychology 105; Health Education 114, 115;
Education 265,354,388,478,special methods in the area of the student's major,and a
minimum of two or three courses in student teaching as required.
Requirementsfor State of Minnesota Licensurefor Teaching in Secondary Schools:
(through the Augsburg College Education Department Program): (1) 6.A. or F.S.
degree: ( 2 )Co[tege major i n a teaching a r e a ; 431 Fulfill Minnesota Board of Teaching
5 ,!VICAR 3.041 i n Human Relations (sucressfut completion of Augsburg Education
program meets requirement); (4) Psvchologv 105; ( 5 ) Health Educatton 114.175: (6)
Stlcce~sfulcompletion of Augsburg Education Program EOUTSPS.
Art, Music and Physical Education Licensure: A person preparing for licensure in
one of rhese areas tollowsthe secondary education pragram even though h e or she
plans ta teach az t h e e l e m e n t a r y school level. A penon with a major in one of rhese
5petial areas will take three courses in student reach~ngand do some student
teach~ngarboth the secondary and elementarv levels. In addition to Edur. 354.rhe
art major will register { o r Educ. 361,362; the Phrsrcal Education major for Educ, 365:
and the music major for Educ. 373.
The Professional Term: Student Teaching is taken concurrently with Educ. 478 in
one full-rime term i n professional education. Special afternoon and/or evening
seminarsare held during the term a 5 par1 of the professional work. A studenr: taking
two courses in srudent teaching may elect to take one course i n Inde endent Study.
All studenrrare expected to be insolred full-time in the artivitim of tee professional
term.
265 Orientation to Education in an Urban Setting (Secondary)
Investigates various aspects of the teaching profession, with opportunity for in-school
work. Open to all students. (Prereq.: Sophomore Standing)
282 Introduction to Special Education
Introduction to the field of special education. An examination of the nature, causes, and
educational interventions for such exceptionalities as mental retardatinn, physical disability, hearing and vision impairment, LD dnd ED and giftedness. (Spring)
341 Media Technology (1/2 course)
(See Library Science)
351 Techniques of Teaching Reading
(See Elementary Education)
354 Creating Learning Environments: Secondary
The mastery of theories and their applicationsfor teaching in learning settings. Laboratory
experiences. (Prereq.: Psychology 105, EDS 265)
Note on Special Methods Courses: With the general methodology course, one or
more education courses in special methods must be taken from the department of
the major field. (Prereq.: Educ. 255 or 265 and 354 or concurrent with 354. Courses
361,365,373 and 410 are one course; others are 1/2 course.)
361 Art Methods (Elementary and Junior High School)
Procedures, materials and issues relating to the teaching of art i n the elementary, middle,
and junior high schools. For art teaching majors only. (Fall)
362 Art Methods (Senior High School) (1/2 course)
Procedures, materials and issues relating to the teaching of art in the senior high school.
'
(Fall)
364 English Methods (1/2 course)
Materials and methods suitable for students in secondary schools. Emphasis on the
preparation of lesson and unit plans. Teaching in a local high school. (Spring)
365 Physical Education Methods (K-12)
(See Physical Education Department)
366 Foreign Language Methods (1/2 course)
Language learning theory.The theory and practice of language teaching. (Consult with the
Foreign Language Department.)
373 Music Methods (K-12)
Trends and issues in music education. The development of music skills and teaching
procedures for school music K-12. Workshops and laboratory experience. (Spring)
374 Natural Science Methods (K-12) (1/2 course)
Course structures, goals, and procedures in science education. Consideration of ability
levels of students. Survey and assessment of classroom textbooks and materials. Development of a file of teaching materials and references. (Fall)
375 Social Studies Methods (1/2 course)
Introduction to the teaching of social sciences and history in secondary school classrooms.
Emphasis on instructional strategies and curriculum development. (Spring)
376 Speech and Theater Arts Methods (1/2 course)
The teaching of basic speech, interpretative reading, discussion, and theater and the
directing of co-curricular speech and theater activities. (Spring)
377 Mathematics Methods (1/2 course)
Study of the basic techniques and materials for teaching secondary school mathematics,
and the consideration of trends and issues in mathematics education. (Spring)
410 Health Methods
-.
(See Health Education 410 Administration and Supervision of the School Health Program)
388 Human Relations (1/2 course)
Emphasis on the study of values, of communication techniques, and of the major minority
groups in Minnesota for the development of interpersonal relations skills applicable to
teaching and other professional vocations. Open to all.
399 Internship
The student may select from a variety of situations for professional work experience. A
learning contract must be developed and must have education faculty approval.
478 School and Society
-.I he emphas~si n this course is o n tne school in relation to society with particular ~ t t e n t i o n
to urban education. Introduced by a study of educational philosophy and the development of American education. current major issues i n education will be studied. (Prereq.:
senior standing)
481,482,483,484 Student Teaching
Observing and directing learning at the secondary level under supervision of college and
secondary school personnel. (A minimum of two courses, except three courses required of
Art, Music, Physical Education majors. Prereq.: Admission t o student teaching and
program approval)
499 lndependent Study
Opportunity for advanced and specialized research projects not otherwise provided for in
the departmental curriculum. A projected program must be outlined which meets the
approval of education faculty.
Library Science
M a r j o r i e Sibley, G r a c e S u l e r u d ( C o o r d i n a t o r s ) , K a r e n H a r w o o d , B o y d K o e h l e r ,
James O l s o n , I r e n e Schilling, Louisa S m i t h
Minor: M i n i m u m o f 4'12 courses, i n c l u d i n g 341. 345,358, 359,475.
341 Media Technology (1/2 course)
Psychological and philosophical dimensions of communication through the use of
instructional technology. Selection, preparation, production and evaluation of effective
audio visual materials for teaching/learning situations. (Spring)
345 The Media Center: Organization and Administration
Organization of materials, including acquisition,cataloging,classification.and processing.
Services of the media center and methods of evaluation. (Fall)
358 The Elementary School Library: Materials Selection and Guidance
Characteristics and purposes of an elementary school library. Evaluation of materials
related to curriculum support and recreational needs. Study of selection sources and
guidance i n use of print and non-print materials. (Fall)
359 Reference Sources and Services
Study of basic English language reference sources. Students learn h o w to select and
evaluate reference books for home, school and other libraries; h o w to find information
and use libraries effectively.'(Spring)
399 Internship
Open to juniors and seniors. An opportunity t o d o field work in a variety of library
situations i n the metropolitan area.
475 The High School Library: Materials Selection and Guidance
Survey and e\,aluation of library materials on the secondary school level. with attention to
their use i n relation to curricula as well as for personal interest and needs of adolescents.
(Spring)
499 lndependent Study
Independent study and research on some topic of interest i n the field of library service.
worked out i n consultation with a faculty adviser. Open to juniors and seniors, with
department approval.
Germad75
301 German Business Communication
German trade correspondence. (Prereq.: 212 or #. O n Demand.)
Major for Teaching: Students interested in secondart education may take a history
m a j o r i n c o m b i n a t i o n w i t h specified social s c i p n c ~courses a n d rhe r e q u i r e d
e d u c a t i o n courses, i n c o m liance with the state requiremenrs For m o r e information, see t h e d e p a r t m e n t c R i r p e r r o n o r t h e Social Srudiei Coordinator.
226 Asian and Asian-American Women in Public Life i n the 20th Century
An exploration of the experiences and contributions of selected women i n China, Japan,
India, Korea, Philippines, and the state of Hawaii. Includes cross-cultural perspective,
responses to impact of modernization and Western education.
345 Scandinavian-American Experience
(See under Scandinavian Area Studies)
M a t hematics/89-90
361 Numerical Analysis (Formerly CSC 355)
A study of merhods used 10 50h.e problems on comprlters. lnalys~sof computat~onal
ofoan procedures
problems and developnienr 0 1 alaorithms Inr [heir ~ u l u t i ~ n s , a p p l ~ c a t ~
l
Topics tnclude the general concept
or~entedprogrammrny ti:n$uapc In n u m ~ r i c aanalysr~.
of lteratlve tnrmulae, inlu;~anor squarrons. Newton's method. l~nearsystems, ~nterpolariiiierentiatinn and Integrallnn, IPrereq.: M 4 T 224, CSC 245)
tlon, numer~r-a1
Computer Science
Augsburg College offers a n e w p r o g r a m i n C o m p u t e r Science that w i l l prepare
students f o r f u r t h e r study i n c o m p u t e r science at a major university o r f o r entry i n t o
a substantial variety o f c o m p u t e r related jobs.
Augsburg has a PDP 11-60 with central memory at 256 kitobvtes and terminals a t
several campus locations. The College also has several Apple I1 microcomputers, a
Tektronix 4051 graphics m i c r o c o m p u r c r , a n d KEY(-1 l a b o r a ~ o r vmicrocomputers.
Augsburg also has access to large
r h r o u g h both Minnesota Educational
C o m p u t i n g Consortium a n d the Univers~ryof ~Minnesota.
~~~~~~~r.
Minor: 5 courses i n c l u d i n g 245, 261, 345, 350 a n d Mathematics 361 (formerly
C o m p u t e r Science 355) o r Business Administration 479 o r Sociology 363 o r
C o m p u t e r Science 395 o r 495.
Note: Business Administration 250 is strongly r e c o m m e n d e d f o r those p l a n n i n g a
career i n business a n d is an additional prerequisite if Business Administration 479 is
t o c o u n t t o w a r d the C o m p u t e r Science minor.
145 Introduction to General Programming
An introduction to computer methods including flowcharts, algorithms, and data
representation. Extensive programming i n a general higher level language. Primarily for
students in non-science areas. Does not count toward a computer science minor.
245 An Introduction to Computer Science
An introduction to computer languages and methods. Techniques studied include
flowcharts, algorithms, data representation and manipulation, hardwate register operations, and computer organization. Programming is done in machine language, assembly
language, and a higher level language such as PASCAL. (Prereq.: MAT 125)
261 Electronics
(See under Department of Physics)
345 Computer Systems
Survey of computers, languages, systems, and applications. Comparison of batch, timesharing, and real time operating systems. Study of the social implications and applications
of computers through the use of various applications packages. Continued development
of competence in structured programmingand algorithms will be emphasized throughout
the course. (Prereq.: 245)
350 Data Structures and File Processing
Conceptsand algorithms used in thesolution of non-numerical problems. Applications to
data management systems, file organization, information retrieval, list processing, programming languages, and storage devices. (Prereq.: 245)
355 Computer Science and Numerical Methods
(See Mathematics 361, new number for this course)
395 and 495 Topics in Computer Science
Specific topics are selected each year. Prerequisites will depend on the topics selected. 395
for Interim, 495 for fall and/or spring terms.
Music
L. L. Fleming (Chairperson), Robert Adney, Robert E. Beverley, Michael Brand, Laine
Bryce, Stephen Gabrielsen, Thomas Cilkey, Cynthia Coetz, James D. Johnson,
Robert Karlen, Diane Kennelly, Merilee Klemp, Nicholas Lenz, Paul Lohman,
Cynthia Melson, Roberta Metzler, Celeste O'Brien, Alice Preves, Dana Skoglund,
Emma Small, George Stahl, Daniel Sturm, James ten Bensel, Paul Thomas, David
Tubergen, Mary Wilson, Angela Wyatt.
See ~ u s i cDe artment Handbook for additional and explanatory information,
guidelines an8requirements. Students wishing t o major or minor i n music must
apply to the department.
Specific Music Major Requirements
Bachelor of Arts: 12 courses: Core Curriculum plus 457,458,350 or 476,354 or 355,
365 or 375, music elective. French or German.
Bachelor of Arts (Music Education): 11 courses: Core Curriculum plus 457,458,350
or 476, 354 or 355, 365 or 375. Consult with Department of Education for
requirements in education.
Bachelor of Music (Performance or Composition): 17 courses: Core Curriculum
plus 350, 457, 458, 476, 499, 354 or 355, 365 or 375, music electives. 4 years of
Performance Studies with double periods i n the last 2 years, and junior and senior
recitals; French o r German.
Bachelor of Science - Music Therapy: 17 courses: C o r e Curriculum plus 354.360,
382,383,395,399,435,457,495,350
or476, one of 355,365,375, and 470 Introduc!ion
to MusicTherapy (Interim).Spanish E Srecommended. Other requiremenrs: B i o l o g
103, Education 262: 2 Physical Educat~on(232 and 373 recommended); 3 Prychologv
and 1Sociology. ~ncluding
Psych. 105,362 and Psych. 264or 50c. 362 {Recommended
courses include Psych. 264,357,352,355, 356, 357, and Sac. 211,121,237,741, 362,
3751; 1 Speech (116 recommended],
Music Minor: 5 courses: 101,102, 260 or 261,457 or 458, elective. Applied Music:
Major Ensemble 2 consecutive years, Performance Studies 4 semesters, concurrent
with Ensemble; Examinations: 2 Music Repertoire Tests, Piano Proficiency Test.
Honors Major: Studenrs may qualify far graduation honors if they have earned a
GPA of at least 3.0 in music courses and have demonstrated leadership in
performance. Honors may be achieved by one oithefollowing: Senior thesisand i t s
defense before a faculty committee; presentation of an addi~lonalSenior recital of
graduate qua2ity: composition of a work for vocal and/orinstrurnental ensemble of
not less than 15 minutes duration. Application should be made before the senior
year.
Core Curriculum (Required of all Majors)
1. Courses: 101, 102, 223, 224, 260, 261.
2. Applied Music: Major Ensemble, 8 semesters; Performance Studies, 8 semesters;
Recital appearance.
3. Examinations: 3 Music Repertoire Tests, Piano Proficiency Test.
Applied Music
Ensembles: Membership is determined by audition during the first week of the fall
semester. Times and locations are posted on the department bulletin board. These
organizations exist nol only for the benefit of the musicstudent, but for any student
who wishes to particrpate:
Augsburg Choir
Brass Ensemble
Chorale
String Ensemble
Concert Band
Jazz Ensemble
Woodwind Ensemble
Orchestra
Performance Studies: Four synergistic elements are required: lessons, jury examinations, performance and listening.
Private Lrsxlns: Vocal and rnstrumental insrruction is avaifable to at! student5 in any area.
MUSICstudents must reqister on the traditional gradlng system and take a jury exam at the
end of each semes~erto fulfill the requiremen1 of prlvare studv toward a mus~cdegree.
Other students m a y register for private lessons in the same manner ur use P/N grading.
D ~ ~ r l nthe
g junior and senior vear. a studern accepted by the Department of Mucrc as a
major receives lessons In rhe area of concentration wirhaut ewrra cost. Practice rooms and
Instruments are available for rent.
jury Examination: All students taking private lessonsfor credit are required to perform each
semester for a faculty jury.
Performance Workshop: An informal setting for student performances,seminarsand guest
lecture demonstrations. All students studying applied music for credit must attend weekly
workshops and, once a semester, perform on their instrument.
Listening: All students studying applied music for credit must attend 30 (out of 50)
designated music events each year.
Recital: One-half recital i s required of B.A. and B.S. candidates. B.M. students must
present full Junior and Senior recitals.
Examinations
All music majors and minors are required to pass a Piano Proficiency Test. Music
majors must pass three Music Repertoire Tests, and Music minors must pass two.
101,102,223,224 Theory
MUSICTheory i s a n integrated course ewtcndlng over four terms. Taught by a team of
~nstructors.the variausaspectsoi mus~caltheory (1.e , eartralnlng, harmony, counterpolnt,
and analysis) are presenred rn parallel, rather than In sequence (101, 223. Fall 102. 224.
Spr~ng)
110 lntroduction to Music Therapy
A survey of the music therapy programs in the surrounding area. with field trips to various
institutions; an introductory course for the freshmen and sophomores considering music
therapy as a major; gives the students a broad background in the ways in which music i s
used as a therapy. (Interim)
230 lntroduction to the Fine Arts
The development of music through the study of selected works of great composers from
each period. Emphasis is placed upon relationships between music and the other fine arts.
For the non-music major. (Fall)
260 History and Literature of Music
Music of the Baroque and Classical eras. (Fall)
261 History and Literature o i Music
Music of the Romantic and Modern eras. (Spring)
325 Scandinavian Music
I n a historical approach to the study of music in the five Nordic countries. opportunity is
offered for investigation into topics of particular interest. Suitable for both non-music and
music majors. (Fall)
330 Vocal Repertoire
A historical survey of solo vocal literature from 1600 to the present.Thestudy includessuch
aspects of ccncern for the performer as interpretation, style. and diction. (Spring)
331 Diction for Singers
(Spring, alternate years)
350 Choral Technique and Arranging
Fundamentals of voice as related to choral ensemble; methods, materials, techniques and
arranging for various combinations of voices. (Spring)
354 lnstrumental Technique
The technique of playing and teaching brass and percussion instruments. (Fall)
355 Instrumental Technique
The technique of playing and teaching woodwind instruments. (Spring)
360 Therapeutic Recreational Music
Study of guitar and recorder.Orff instrumt.nts,applications of recreational musicactivities
to clinical settings. Practicum/experience required as part of course work.
365 lnstrumental Technique
Elementary technique in the playing and teaching of string instrument^. (Fall)
375 Instrumental Technique
Advanced technique in the playing and teaching of string instruments. (Spring)
380 Music of the Western Church
Development and influence of the music of the Christian church. Designed for the general
student as well as for organists, choir directo-s. and pre-theological students. (Spring)
382 Psychological Foundations of Music I
An objective approach to musical stimuli and response. with an emphasis on the sociopsychological aspects of music. An understanding of the research process and development of an experimental research project.
383 Psychological Foundations of Music II
Implementation of group and individual research projects. emphasison music i n a clinical
setting. Various theories of learning music, musical talent. and performance. (Prereq.: 382)
395 Influence of Music on Behavior
A study of man as he relates to music, with emphasis on psychological, cultural, and
biological aspects of musical behavior.
399 Music Therapy Clinical Internship
Full-rime placement In an inrernrhip setting approved by the National Association for
Music Therapy for rix months. This ir started after completion of the senior year and is
nece5sary for regisrration by the NAMT. Appl~cationsfor ~nternsh~p
sites must be made
n i n e m o n t h In advance. 5ttes In Mrnne5o;a are lim~ted.
435 Music in Therapy
The study and application of the uses of music with the emotionally ill, mentally retarded.
and physically handicapped. (Prereq.: 395)
440 New Music Seminar
Offers an opportunity to apply information and techniques acquired in music theory and
history classes to the study of 20th century music. (Prereq.: 224. Spring)
457 Conducting
Techniques of conducting, preparation of and conducting choral scores. organization of
choral ensembles. (Fall)
458 Conducting
Preparation of and conducting instrumental scores, organization of instrumental
ensembles. (Spring)
476 Orchestration
The craft of orchestrating and arranging music for instrumental ensembles of varying sizes
and types. (Fall)
488,489 Piano Teaching Methods
instruction in the principles, methods, and techniques for teaching piano. Students will
give individual lessons to children under the supervision of the instructor. No course
credit.
495 Practicum in Music Therapy
Volunteer work in a clinical setting, two hours a week, s i x terms. No credit
499 Independent Study
Permits advanced and specialized studies and projects not otherwise provided for in the
departmental curriculum. Open only to advanced students upon approval of the faculty.
Natural Science/99
Science (Grades5-9): 7 courses,2 i n Earth Science (Physics 101 or 161.thealternative
course not taken i n the Broad Base section); 2 i n Life Science (and two biology
courses above 112); 3 i n Physical Science (Chemistry 223,353; Physics 245).
Nursing/99
Augsburg offers an u p p e r division major i n nursing leading t o a Bachelor o f Science
degree. The p r o g r a m is accredited by the National League f o r Nursing.
261 Electronics
A review of AC and DC circuits and study of analog electronics comprises the first half of
the semester. The second half includes study of digital electronics culminating i n analysis
and use of microprocessors and microcomputer systems. (Prereq.: 103 or 122 and
Mathematics 122 or 125)
486 Prvchology of Religion and Thenlogy
-\ rrtrdv ot cvrrenl pr-ychnlogiralvicrvsof religion in the context of the traditional Christian
riew o i human nature. Spec~alartention will be given to the classics in the field by Freud.
lung.and Wil[lamlames,~ncito thos~Christiantheologians who have been influenced by
them. (Spring 1982)
Scandinavian Area Studies/ll6
345 Scandinavian - American Experience
The O l d World Background and rise of "America Fever." adaptation to the New Land.
aspects of Scandinavian - American culture. (Alternate years. Spring, 1982)
Social Science/l17
Social Science
M y l e s C. Stenshoel (Division Chairperson)
T w a ernphafes exist w i t h i n the S o c ~ a Science
l
major: t h e General M a j o r and the
Van-Western emphasis. A student may n o t l ~ sat d o u b l e major I n Social Science a n d
es
t h e d ~ s t r ~ b u t ~selected
on
In the Soc~al
I n one of the componen7 d ~ s c ~ p l ~ nunless
Science major i_c s~gniticantlydifferent f r o m the other major.
GeneraIMajor: IScotrrses: 10 required courres(Ecanom1cs1~,1?3:
Hi5tory221,222;
G ~ o g r a p h v714: 5ociology 221,241: Psvchologv 105: Roltrical5r1ence158 and121 or
710t. 4 upper d ~ ~ ~ s courses
i o n
in one of rhe l o l l o w i n g d ~ s c i p l ~ n e rEconomics.
:
Hisrorv. Political Science, Psychobogy or Socrvlogy: a stat~sricscourse approved bv
the d~partrnentin which the 4 upper d i v i s ~ o ncourses are taken. The student should
rhnose an adviser who 1s a m e m b e r of ( h e d e p a r t m e n t i n w h i c h the upper division
course5 are ro be taken. (For supplementary information and a[rernatiwe ways to
fulf~llrhestate-approved competency-hared program tor secondary teacher educarlnn, sce the f o l [ o w i n g section on Social Studies tor Secondary education.^
Non-Western Major: 14 courses: History 703; 1social science methodology course
(Economics 379, Psychology 264, Sociology 362 or 365): and 12 courses,i n a t least 4
disciplines, from the followrng: Economics 122,258; History 104,322,323,324,440,
474: Political Science351,363,382,461; Philosophy 255; Religion356: Sociology241 :
seminars, independenr study or interim courses on relevant topics in History and~'or
Political Science. The student planning to fulfill this soc1a1science major should
consul^ the chairperson of the Department of Hisrory tn choosing a major adviser.
Social Studies
Myles C. Stenshoel (Coordinator)
on rhe high school level must complete, in
Students preparing10 teach social s t u d i e ~
addition t o the professional requirements to be met within the Department of
Education, a competencv-based program designed to provide a broad foundation
in the social sciences.
Social Studies ticensure: 7 courser; (Economic.; 122 or 123, Geographv 174, History
222, Political Science 756, Psychology 105, Sociology 121 and 141) plusa ma'or in one
of five fields - Economics, History. Political Sricnce, ~ r y c h o l o g or
v sociology - o r
incorporated in a Social Science Teaching Major. described in section above\.
Students considering a career in social studies education should consult, as soon as
possible, the Augsburg Department of Education and the Social Studies Coordinator.
Social Work 118-119
Major: The Augsburg Social Work Program i s a professional program i n preparation
for social work practice leading to a Bachelor of Science degree. The core program
consists of Bio. 101'; Psych. 105*, 351*, and 352*; Soc. 121*, 231*,365,375*,and 383*;
and Social Work 257*, 361*, 363*, 364*, 461,462,463,464,465,466 and 467. At least
one Conservation of Human Resources (CHR) course is strongly recommended. A
minimum grade of 2.0 is required i n each upper division social work course required
in the major.
*These courses are to be completed before the beginning of the senior year.
Concentration: Concentrations i n Aging, Chemical Dependency, Crime and Corset tions, sorial Ministries,and Youth a r e possible. Concentration consists of courses
descriptive of functional. dy~functianal,and programmatic aspects, plus field work
placcment i n the senior year in the special area. Completion of a concentration i s
noted on the transcript.
Social Welfare Minor: 6 courses including 257 or department approved alternative
internship: 361; 364; Psych. 351 or Soc. 375; Soc. 383; and Pol. 121 or 158 or 325 or
Social Work 465.
School Social Work Certification: State Department of Education-required Human
Relations Certification for school social work is available through successful
completion of Education 388.
466 Field Work 111 (1/2 or 1 course)
Continuation of 462 conducted during Interim.
AUCSBURC COLLEGE
Official publication of
Augsburg College
731 21st Avenue S.
Minneapolis, M N 55454
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Undergraduate Catalog, 1969-1970
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
AUGSBURG COLLEGE / MINNEAPOLIS, MINNESOTA
CATALOG FOR THE ACADEMIC YEARS 1968-69 AND 1969-70
RECORD FOR THE ACADEMIC YEARS 1966-67 AND 1967-68
AUGSBURG
COLLEGE
AFFl LlATlON
Augsburg College is a fouryear liberal arts college affiliated
with
The
American
Lutheran Church. The College
offers...
Show more
AUGSBURG COLLEGE / MINNEAPOLIS, MINNESOTA
CATALOG FOR THE ACADEMIC YEARS 1968-69 AND 1969-70
RECORD FOR THE ACADEMIC YEARS 1966-67 AND 1967-68
AUGSBURG
COLLEGE
AFFl LlATlON
Augsburg College is a fouryear liberal arts college affiliated
with
The
American
Lutheran Church. The College
offers a broad education in a
Christian environment.
ACCREDITATION
Augsburg College is fully accredited by the North Central
Association of Colleges and Secondary Schools, the National
Council for the Accreditation
of Teacher Education, the
American Chemical Society, and
the American Association of
University Women.
MEMBERSHIPS
Augsburg College holds membership also in the American
Council on Education, the Association of American Colleges, the
American Association of Colleges for Teacher Education, the
National Lutheran Educational
Conference, the Association of
Minnesota Colleges, the Minnesota Private College Council and
the Association of Protestant
Colleges and Universities.
COURSES OF STUDY
Augsburg College offers a Liberal Arts education with courses leading to a Bachelor d Arts
degree offered in 29 major fields
of study. Students are prepared
for teaching, business administration, social work, medical
technology, secretarial work,
parish work, and missions. Students may prepare for further
study in the fields of engineering, theology, dentistry, medicine, nursing, and law, and for
graduate study in various fields.
LOCATION
Augsburg College is located
along Interstate Highway No.
94, just 20 blocks from the
downtown loop area of Minneapolis. Students have easy access to libraries, museums, and
art collections. They also have
the opportunity t o attend lectures, musical programs and
other cultural activities in the
Minneapolis-St. Paul area.
SETTING
The twelve-block Augsburg
campus is located in the heart
of Minneapolis and is adjacent
t o the University d Minnesota
West Bank campus and two of
the city's largest hospitals. In
this urban setting, Augsburg
students prepare for careers in
our increasingly urban society.
A friendly atmosphere prevails
on the Augsburg campus. Students participate in all phases
of campus community life under
the direction of a capable, wellprepared faculty.
DEVELOPMENT
A comprehensive development
program is in operation which
will, over the years, add additional land and buildings t o the
Augsburg College campus.
THE AUGSBURG COLLEGE CAMPUS
Augsburg College is located
near the Minneapolis loop and
the University of Minnesota.
The Administrative offices are
in Science Hall at the corner of
7th Street and 21st Avenue
South.
Prospective students and other interested persons are cor-
dially invited to visit the
campus. Visiting hours are
9 a.m. to 5 p.m., Monday through
Friday; Saturday by appointment. A letter or telephone call
in advance is recommended.
Write to the Office of Admissions, Augsburg College, Minneapolis, Minnesota 55404; or
telephone 332-5181.
ACADEMIC CALENDAR,
AUGUST 1968
S M T W T F
1 2
4 5 6 7 8 9 1
11 12 13 14 15 16
18 19 20 21 22 23
25 26 27 28 29 30
S
3
0
17
24
31
JANUARY 1969
S M T W T F S
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8 9 1 0 1 1
12 13 14 15 16 17 18
19202122232425
26 27 28 29 30 31
SEPTEMBER 1968
S M T W T F S
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
891011121314
15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26 27 28
29 30
OCTOBER 1968
S M T W T F S
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 1 0 1 1 1 2
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22 23 24 25 26
27 28 29 30 31
NOVEMBER 1968
S M T W T F S
1 2
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23
24 25 26 27 28 29 30
DECEMBER 1968
S M T W T F S
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
891011121314
15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26 27 28
29 30 31
FEBRUARY 1969
S M T W T F S
MARCH 1969
S M T W T F S
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
16171819202122
23 24 25 26 27 28 29
30 31
APRIL 1969
S M T W T F S
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 1 0 1 1 1 2
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
20212223242526
27 28 29 30
MAY 1969
S M T W T F S
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 9 1 0
11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18192021222324
25 26 27 28 29 30 31
2 3 4 5 6 7 :
9 10 11 12 13 14 I 5
16171819202122
23 24 25 26 27 28
SUMMER SESSION 1968
June 24
July 4
Aug. 2
........... (Mon.) ............
............
Final registration and
beginning of classes
(Thurs.) ........................ Holiday
(Fri.) ................. Final examinations
............
ACADEMIC YEAR 1968-69
FALL TERM
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Nov.
Nov.
Nov.
5-9 .......... (Thurs.-Mon.) ... Freshman Welcome Week
9, 10 ......... (Mon., Tues.) ................ Registration
11 .......... (Wed.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Classes begin
19 .......... .(Tues.) ............... Last day of classes
20-26 ........ (Wed.-Tues.) ......... Final examinations
27-Dec. 3 . . . . (Wed.-Tues.) .......... Thanksgiving recess
WINTER TERM
Dec. 3 ............. (Tues.) ...................... Registration
Dec. 4 ............. (Wed.) ..................... Classes begin
Dec. 20, 9:00 p.m. ... (Fri.) ............. Christmas recess begins
Jan. 6, 7:45 a.m. . . . (Mon.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Classes resume
Feb. 25 ............ (Tues.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Last day of classes
Feb. 26-March 4 . . . (Wed.-Tues.) ......... Final examinations
March 5-10 . . . . . . . (Wed.-Mon.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Term break
SPRING TERM
March 10 . . . . . . . . . . (Mon.) ...................... Registration
March 11 .......... (Tues.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Classes begin
April 2, 9:00 p.m. . . (Wed.) ............... Easter recess begins
April 8, 7:45 a.m. ... (Tues.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Classes resume
May 23 . . . . . . . . . . . . (Fri.) ............... Last day of classes
May 2 6 3 0 ......... (Mon.-Fri.) . . . . . . . . . . . . Final examinations
June 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . (Sun.) . . . . . . Baccalaureate, Commencement
ACADEMIC CALENDAR, 1969-1970
AUGUST 1969
S M T W T F
1
3 4 5 6 7 8
10 11 12 13 14 15
17 18 19 20 21 22
24 25 26 27 28 29
31
S
2
9
16
23
30
JANUARY 1970
S M T W T F S
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 910
11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24
25 26 27 28 29 30 31
SEPTEMBER 1969
S M T W T F S
1 2 3 4 5 6
78910111213
14 15 16 17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24 25 26 27
28 29 30
S
1
8
15
22
FEBRUARY 1970
M T W T F S
2 3 4 5 6 7
91011121314
16 17 18 19 20 21
23 24 25 26 27 28
,
OCTOBER 1969
S M T W T F S
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8 9 1 0 1 1
12 13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 23 24 25
26 27 28 29 30 31
NOVEMBER 1969
S M T W T F S
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
16 17 18 19 20 21 22
23 24 25 26 27 28 29
30
MARCH 1970
S M T W T F S
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 91011121314
15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26 27 28
29 30 31
APRIL 1970
S M T W T F S
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8 91011
12 13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 23 24 25
26 27 28 29 30
FIRST SUMMER SESSION 1969
Final registration and
beginning of classes
July 4 ............ (Fri.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Holiday
July 18
(Fri.) ................. Final examinations
June 9
............ (Mon.) . . . . . . . . . . . .
............
July 21
Aug. 8
SECOND SUMMER SESSION 1969
(Mon.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Classes begin
............ (Fri.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Final examinations
............
ACADEMIC YEAR 1969-70
FALL TERM
Sept. 4-8 .......... (Thurs.-Mon.) ... Freshman Welcome Week
Sept. 8, 9 . . . . . . . . . (Mon., Tues.) ................ Registration
Sept. 10 ...........(Wed.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Classes begin
Nov. 18 . . . . . . . . . . . (Tues.) ............... Last day of classes
Nov. I S 2 5 ........ (Wed.-Tues.) ......... Final examinations
Nov. 26-Dec. 2 ..... (Wed.-Tues.) ......... Thanksgiving recess
WINTER TERM
Dec. 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . (Tues.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Registration
Dec. 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . (Wed.) ..................... Classes begin
Dec. 19, 9:00 p.m. .. (Fri.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Christmas recess begins
Jan. 5, 7:45 a.m. . . . (Mon.) ................... Classes resume
Feb. 24 ............ (Tues.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Last day of classes
Feb. 25-March 3 . . . .(Wed.-Tues.) . . . . . . . . . Final examinations
March 4-9 ......... (Wed.-Mon.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Term break
SPRING TERM
March 9 . . . . . . . . . . . (Mon.) ....................... Registration
March 10 . . . . . . . . . . (Tues.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Classes begin
March 25, 9:00 p.m. . (Wed.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . Easter recess begins
March 31, 7:45 a.m. . (Tues.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Classes resume
May 22 . . . . . . . . . . . .(Fri.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Last day of classes
May 25-29 ........ (Mon.-Fri.) . . . . . . . . . . . Final examinations
May 31 . . . . . . . . . . . (Sun.) . . . . . . Baccalaureate, Commencement
DECEMBER 1969
S M T W T F S
1 2 3 4 5 6
78910111213
14 15 16 17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24 25 26 27
28 29 30 31
MAY 1970
S M T W T F
1
3 4 5 6 7 8
10 11 12 13 14 15
17 18 19 20 21 22
24 25 26 27 28 29
31
S
2
9
16
23
30
AIMS AND OBJECTIVES
Augsburg College is a Christian liberal arts college of The
American Lutheran Church. The
faculty and the Board of Regents of the College affirm the
following as their understanding of the aims, philosophy, objectives and character of this
institution.
ULTIMATE AlMS
TO contribute to the true good
of human life and society.
To contribute to the building
of free and living congregations
in the community of the Christian Church.
BASIC PHILOSOPHY
The Christian message concerning the redemptive act of
God in Christ constitutes the
greatest potential for good in
human life and society; but this
potential is realized only insofar
as it is actualized in the minds
and hearts of individuals.
The redemption of the mind
constitutes the unique educational task laid upon the Christian
Church; in seeking to relate all
learning to the truth of the
Christian faith, the Christian college performs its greatest service both to the Church and to
society.
Where there is an atmosphere
of free and honest inquiry, truth
has the overwhelming advantage;
the Christian college, therefore,
pursues its purposes not by indoctrination or coercion, but by
inviting teachers and students
to join in a common search for
truth and in a common attempt
to see all truth in relation to
ultimate Truth.
PRIMARY OBJECTIVES
To attract to the college students of high ability and genuine religious concern who can
reap the maximum benefit from
a program of Christian higher
education.
To provide a campus setting
that is conducive to the spiritual,
mental, moral and physical wellbeing of its students.
To stimulate its students' intellectual interest, and to assist
them to develop the habits and
skills necessary for sound academic work.
To acquaint its students with
the spiritual, cultural and intellectual riches of mankind, both
for the sake of the enrichment
of their own lives and, through
them, for the enrichment of their
homes and communities.
To confront its students with
the problems and benefits of
living and serving in an increasingly urban culture.
To lead its students to a deeper understanding and experience
of the Christian Gospel in its
relati,on to every area of life
and learning.
To assist its students in discovering and clarifying their
peculiar aptitudes and interests,
and to provide training and
counsel that will assist them
in preparing for a life work appropriate thereto.
To aid its students in the development of Christian attitudes
and Christian qualities of character; and to encourage each
GENERAL
INFORMATION
student to look upon his life
as a Christian vocatio,n, and an
opportunity for service t o God
and man.
DISTINCTIVE CHARACTER
Augsburg College is a Christian community of life and learning.
As a Christian academic community, Augsburg seeks that
high level of excellence which
is appropriate to such a community.
Augsburg treasures its religious and cultural heritage as an
institution founded by Lutheran
immigrants from Norway who
sought t o play a creative role
in American life and society,
and seeks to preserve the enduring values of this heritage
in the life of the college community today.
As a metropolitan college,
Augsburg attempts to relate its
faculty and students t o an urban
culture by utilizing the educational, social, cultural and religious resources of the growing
metropolitan
community
in
which it is located.
THE PHYSICAL PLANT
Instructional facilities and student housing a t Augsburg are
conveniently located in relation
to each other.
Old Main, erected in 1900, contains a large number of classrooms and offices.
Science Hall, erected in 194849, includes the general administration offices; well-equipped
laboratories for chemistry, phys-
ics, and biology; a medium-sized
auditorium; and several classrooms and faculty offices. The
Lisa Odland Observatory, on the
roof of Science Hall, was completed in the summer of 1960.
The George Sverdrup Library,
named in honor of Augsburg's
fourth president, was erected
and dedicated in 1955. Adjacent
to Science Hall and of similar
contemporary architectural design, it contains spacious reading rooms, seminars, work
rooms, a visual-education center,
the Augsburg Archives, classrooms, and a number o~f faculty
offices. There is stack space for
approximately 100,000 volumes.
Melby Hall, the new auditorium-gymnasium, was completed in 1961. This building,
named in honor of Professor J. S.
Melby, dean of men from 1920
to 1942, basketball coach and
head of the Christianity department, provides excellent facilities for the health and physical
education program, intercollegiate athletics, chapel services and
general auditorium purposes.
East Hall, purchased in 1966,
provides a rehearsal hall for the
Concert Band and Repertoire
Band as well as rehearsal and
instruction rooms for instrumentalists.
The Music Hall was acquired
by purchase in 1947 and has
been remodeled to provide vocal, string and piano rehearsal
rooms together with a rehearsal
room for large groups.
The Speech and Drama Building was acquired in 1959 and remodeled to make an extremely
functional building for dramatic
and other speech activities.
The Augsburg College Center,
completed in 1967, is a center
of non-academic activity on
campus. The building houses the
Commons, which is the name for
the main dining area, plus private dining rooms and coffee
shop. Student government and
student publications have quarters in this building. The bookstore is also located here. Spacious lounges and recreational
areas are provided in this threestory building containing 55,000
square feet of space.
Urness Tower Residence for
Women, completed in 1967, is
an eleven-story building providing living quarters for 324 women students. The building was
named in honor of Mr. and Mrs.
Andrew Urness who have given
several generous gifts to the
college. A unique feature of the
building is that each floor is
considered a "house unit" providing the 36 residents, housed
two to a room, with their own
lounge, study and utility areas.
The second floor level with
main lounge, also provides an
apartment for the head resident.
There is an observation lounge
a t the top of the structure.
Sverdrup-Oftedal
Memorial
Hall, erected in 1938, was
named in honor of Augsburg's
second and third presidents. The
building houses about 65 men
students and provides for some
faculty and administration offices in one wing.
Sivertsen-Mortensen Hall in-
corporates a building donated
to the college in 1939 from the
late Dr. Iver Sivertsen and Mrs.
Sivertsen, and a larger addition
erected in 1955 and named in
honor of Miss Gerda Mortensen,
dean of women at Augsburg
from 1923 to 1964. The building
provides housing for about 144
men students as well as apartments for the resident head.
The Studio Building, dedicated
in 1964, houses the Department
of Art on its two floors.
West Hall is an apartment
building purchased in 1966
shortly after it was constructed.
The building houses 38 women
students and an apartment for
the head resident.
Cottage Houses. A large number of dwellings have been acquired in recent years in the
expanded campus area to provide accommodations for men
or women students, married students and for faculty and staff
members.
The President's Home, an attractive colonial residence, is
located on the West River Road.
THE ARCHIVES
The Augsburg Archives seeks
to gather and make available
for use documents, books, and
other articles of historical value.
The George Sverdrup Library
provides adequate, fire-proof
quarters for the archives. Here
are found a large collection of
periodicals, manuscripts, letters
and pictures, affording extensive
resources for scholarly research.
-
LIBRARY FACILITIES
The beautiful and spacious
George Sverdrup Library provides a central study-workshop
for both faculty and students.
It contains about 70,000 volumes, exclusive of pamphlets,
and is adding approximately
7,000 new volumes each year.
Students and faculty working in
either of the two large reading
rooms find the atmosphere conducive to quiet study and research materials close at hand.
All books are kept on open
shelves. Reference service, provided by an able and welltrained staff, is available to
students.
Special collections have been
developed in the Music Library,
the Chemistry Library, the Curriculum and Library Science Libraries, and in the Audio-Visual
Center. In 1966, the AmericanScandinavian Foundation presented its collection of Scandinavian music to the College. Additional conveniences
include conference rooms for
larger groups or small classes. A
typing comer is provided in the
first-floor reading room.
The library subscribes to
nearly 600 of the best periodi-
cals dealing with a large variety
of subjects, as well as a number
of serials devoted to the interests of special fields. Current
issues are displayed in a pleasant browsing area.
The library plays an active
role in promoting general reading, presenting regular book displays, and sponsoring monthly
book discussions for faculty,
staff, and students.
In the Twin City area are
other libraries which make their
holdings available to Augsburg
students, notably, the St. Paul
and Minneapolis public libraries,
the latter of which issues library
cards to out-of-town students
for each school year.
NATURAL SCIENCE
LABORATORIES
The laboratories of the Natural Sciences are located in the
Science Hall. Four laboratories
and storeroom and office space
for bidogy are located on the
second floor; three larger laboratories and two special research
laboratories for chemistry and
two laboratories for physics are
located on the third and fourth
floors. A chemistry library is
located near the research facilities. Storerooms and faculty offices are also located here.
FINANCIAL
INFORMATION
1968-69
COMPREHENSIVE FEE
Includes tuition, board and room and General fee
as described below.
(per year)
TUITION
New freshmen entering September, 1969
(per year)
This rate is guaranteed for four consecutive years.
In case of time lost due to illness or accident, the rate,
upon application and approval, may be extended for a
fifth year.
Transfer students and returning students not on a prior
year-guaranteed plan.
(per year)
Part-time students (carrying less than 12 credits per
term)
(per credit hour)
Fee for auditing is one-half the fee for credit.
Students carrying more than 51 credits for the academic
year are charged $25.00 per credit hour for excess hours.
BOARD AND ROOM
Residence Halls
Honor Houses (upper-class students only)
The board plan provides 21 meals per week.
(per year)
(per year)
OTHER REQUIRED FEES
General Fee
(per year)
(Covers subscription to yearbook, newspaper, admissions to all regularly scheduled athletic events, dramatic
productions, convocations, and the support of Student
Society activities and the College Center.) Part-time
students are charged on a proportionate basis.
Application Fee
Required of all new students, non-refundable.
Initial Payment-New Students
Required of students whose application for admission
has been accepted; to be paid by May 1, 1969. The payment is applied to the tuition fee, but is not transferable
or refundable.
Room Reservation Deposit-Returning
Students
Required by July 1, 1969, to reserve a housing assignment for the term beginning September, 1969.
Breakage Deposit
Required of all students. Refundable upon graduation,
transfer to another institution, or discontinuing educational program at Augsburg College.
SPECIAL FEES
Change in registration after classes begin (per cancel
or add)
Late registration after classes begin
(per day)
Graduation fee
Transcript fee: first copy free, additional copy
Arrangements for special examinations are made in
Registrar's office, with charges according to schedule
on file.
SPECIAL COURSE FEES
Computer Science
Student Teaching
Improvement of Reading
Music Lessons (10 per term)
Practice Studio Rental
Organ (one hour per day)
Piano or Voice (one hour per day)
Books and supplies are available from the Bookstore.
Estimated costs
(per year) $
Linen service, required in residence halls
(per year) $
Personal expenses for clothing, entertainment and transportation vary from student to student. In planning a
yearly budget, a student should add
(per year) $
(7 SETTLEMENT OF ACCOUNT
A statement of charges for the year will be prepared
and forwarded to the student early in August. Payment of one-third of the annual charge is due a t the
beginning of each term except that for the fall term
payments will be due on or before August 20, so that
all necessary processing of financial arrangements can
be completed in time to clear the student for registration.
Variation from this schedule must be arranged with the
Treasurer's Office prior to August 20. No student is permitted to register if his or her account for a preceding
term has not been paid in full.
REFUNDS
If a student decides to cancel his registration, refunds of tuition and room charges are allowed as
follows: during the first week of classes, 80%; during
the second week, 70%; during the third week, 60%;
during the fourth week, 50%; and during the fifth week,
40%. No allowance is given after the fifth week.
If a student is forced to cancel his registration because
of accident or illness during the first five weeks of
the term, the charge is one-half of the rate indicated.
Students required to enter military service will
receive a full refund of tuition and a proportionate refund on room charges.
In all cases, board refunds are made on a proportionate
basis.
FINANCIAL ASSISTANCE
Financial aid in the form of loan funds, scholarships, and parttime employment is available a t Augsburg College.
Augsburg participates in the College Scholarship Service (CSS) of
the College Entrance Examination Board. Participants in CSS subscribe to the principle that the amount of financial aid granted a
student should be based uposn financial need. The CSS assists the
college's financial aid officer in determining the student's need for
financial assistance. Entering students seeking financial assistance
are required to submit a copy of the Parents' Confidential Statement
(PCS) form to the College Scholarship Service, designating Augsburg College as one of the recipients, by March 15. The PCS form
may be obtained from a secondary school or the College Scholarship
Service, Box 881, Evanston, Illinois 60204. All upper-class students
are required to submit a Parents' Confidential Statement-Renewal
form each year.
Several loan funds have been established to assist students in working out their financial problems. Loans may be arranged at a reasonable rate of interest for various periods of time.
The General Student Loan Fund, established through the gifts of
many individual donors, is maintained chiefly by contributions from
the Augsburg College Women's Club.
National Defense Student Loans, established by the National Defense Education Act of 1958, are available t o students capable of
maintaining good standing in their chosen course of study. Special
consideration will be given to all students with a superior academic
background. Loans will normally be granted for the academic year,
September through June, or the remaining balance thereof. Reapplication will be necessary for each succeeding loan period.
United Student Aid Funds is a program of endorsing loans made
by local banks to college students requiring financial assistance. A
grant to the college by the Gamble-Skogmo Foundation provided
the funds to establish the initial reserves required. The United
Student Aid Fund Incorporation also handles the Federal Insured
Loan program.
Arrangements for all types of loans are made through a conference
with the Dean of Students, chairman of the faculty committee on financial aid. In addition to arranging loans, the committee counsels
students on financial matters with the objective in mind of helping the student work out a satisfactory plan for his finances.
SCHOLARSHIPS
SCHOLARSHIPS AVAILABLE TO FRESHMEN
Foundation Fellowships are offered to students with outstanding
high school records and high scores on the Scholastic Aptitude Test
of the College Entrance Examination Board. Recipients are guaranteed enrollment in hon,ors course work. These awards range in
amount from $100 to full tuition and are renewable for four years
for students with a grade point average of 3.0 (B average). TO
qualify for a Foundation Fellowship a student should rank in the
upper five percent of his high school class and have a combined
score of 1200 or higher on the Scholastic Aptitude Test. The scholarship committee also considers an individual's interests, abilities,
and character.
Honor Scholarships are offered to good students who have strong
potential for academic success at Augsburg College. These awards
range in amount from $100 to full tuition and may be renewed for
four years for students with a grade point average of 2.50.
Students who rank in the upper fifteen percent of their
high school class and have above average scores in the Scholastic
Aptitude Test are eligible for Honor Scholarships.
Chemistry Scholarships and Research Awards are offered each year
by the Department of Chemistry to students strongly interested in
chemistry or medicine. The six awards vary in amount from $2,000
to $4,000 over four years. A student qualifies for a Chemistry
Scholarship on the basis of his high school performance, a special
chemistry examination, financial need, and vocational objective.
Summer Research Awards are also available t o students in chemistry. This award provides a stipend of $600 for each student
to do research under the guidance of the chemistry department.
Academic Grants are awarded to students on the basis of financial
need as demonstrated by the College Scholarship Service. Students who are admitted t o Augsburg College but do not qualify
for a scholarship may be considered for an academic grant or financial award'. These awards range in amount from $100 t o $600 and
may be renewable for four years with a grade point average of 2.0
(C average).
SCHOLARSHIPS AVAILABLE TO UPPERCLASSMEN
Departmental Scholarships of varying amounts are awarded each
year to students who are highly recommended by the chairman of
their maj,or department. These scholarships are renewable if the
student maintains a scholastic average of 2.75 or better.
Alumni Achievement Scholarships are awarded to outstanding students in the freshman, sophomore, and junior classes for use the
following academic year. The scholarship fund., which is equivalent to three half-tuition scholarships, is awarded on the basis of
previous academic performance. No award will be in excess of
financial need.
The Augsburg College Women's Club Schdarship awards, totaling
$400, are granted each year to two or more students of outstanding
character and excellent scholarship.
The Peggy Christensen Benson Memorial Scholarship was established in 1965 by her husband, Thomas I. Benson. The Scholarship
is awarded annually to a student studying choral music.
The Thorvald Olsen Burntvedt Memorial Scholarship Fund was
established in 1960 by gifts from the Burntvedt family and through
a church-wide offering, to honor the memory of Dr. T. 0. Burntvedt
who was President of the Lutheran Free Church from 1930 to 1958.
One or more scholarships are awarded annually to a student or
students in the senior class who are preparing for the ministry.
The Alma Jensen Dickerson Memorial Scholarships were established in 196.1 by Mrs. Alma Jensen Dickerson, a member of the
Augsburg faculty from 1943 to 1954. One or more scholarships are
awarded annually to able and deserving junior or senior students.
The M. J. Estrem Scholarship was established in 1965 by Mr. and
Mrs. M. J. Estrem of Minneapolis to provide an annual scholarship
for some worthy student of the College, such student to be selected
upon the recommendation of the Scholarship Committee of the
College.
Augsburg awards Foreign Student Scholarships each year to deserving students from other countries. These scholarships may be
awarded in amounts up to the equivalent of full tuition.
The Gamble-Skogmo Foundation Scholarship Fund, established
in 1965, makes possible the awarding of one or more scholarships
each year to upperclass male students interested in careers in the
field of business.
The 0. I. Hertsgaard Scholarship was established in 1966 by Mr.
and Mrs. 0 . I. Hertsgaard. One or more scholarships will be awarded
annually to junior or senior students who have demonstrated a
proficiency in choral and/or instrumental music, who show interest
or potential in conducting and show promise of overall academic
success.
The Keith E. Hoffman Memorial Scholarship was established in
1945 by Mr. and Mrs. Charles S. Hoffman of Minneapolis in memory of their son who gave his life in the conquest of Okinawa.
The scholarship is awarded annually to a student selected on the
basis of academic achievement, personal character, and ability in
the field of athletics.
International Milling Company Scholarships are funded by contributions made by the International Milling Company to the Minnesota Private College Fund. These scholarships of variable amounts
are awarded annually to able and deserving upper-class students.
The American Indian Scholarship was established in 1955 by Spring
Lake Park Lutheran Church, Minneapolis. It is a scholarship of
$200 to be applied on tuition at Augsburg College. It is to be awarded
to an American Indian student selected on the basis of scholarship
and economic need.
The Iver and Marie Iversen Scholarship was established in 1957
through a grant from Mr. Iver Iversen of Brooklyn, New York. It
is awarded annually to a student in the College. The award, in the
amount of $250, is made on the basis of need, scholarship, and
interest in Christian service.
The Magnus A. Kleven Family Scholarship was established in 1956
by members of the family to honor their parents. The scholarship
is awarded annually t o a student on the basis of academic achievement, personal character, and promise of achievement in the field
of physical education.
Lutheran Brotherhood Scholarships of $500 each are provided
by the Lutheran Brotherhood Life Insurance Society and awarded
each fall to outstanding Lutheran college seniors. The students are
selected by the College in the spring of the junior year on the basis
of religious leadership and scholastic standing.
Aid Association for Lutherans Scholarships were established in
1966 from funds given by Aid Association for Lutherans Insurance
Company. These scholarships of variable amounts are awarded
annually to able and deserving upper-class students who are policy
holders.
David Mathre Memorial Scholarship for Student Teachers is available to qualified full-time students in need of financial assistance
during the term in which they are doing student teaching.
The Onesirnus Scholarship, established in 1962 by Mr. and Mrs.
James Helleckson, is awarded annually in the amount d $300 to
an Augsburg student or graduate who is preparing for service in
the Christian ministry.
The Henry P. Opseth Music Scholarship was established in 1953
in memory of Henry P. Opseth, former head of the Music Department and director of the Augsburg College Choir. It is awarded
annually to a sophomore or junior student s f outstanding promise
in the field of music.
The Adolph Paulson Memorial Prize, from a fund established by
members of the Paulson family in memory of Professor Adolph
Paulson who taught social science at Augsburg from 1930 to 1935,
is awarded annually to a college student for the best essay written
on an assigned subject in the field of Christian sociology. The
amount of the prize is $50.
The Quanbeck Scholarship Fund was established in 1963 by a bequest of John G. Quanbeck. The income from this fund is awarded
annually to freshman students who, without assistance, would be
unable to pursue higher education.
The Reader's Digest Endowed Scholarship Fund, established in
1965, provides an annual scholarship for a deserving and able upperclassman.
The Reverend Olaf Rogne Memorial Scholarships were established
in 1958 by two anonymous donors to honor the memory of Reverend Olaf Rogne, business administrator of the college from 1940
to 1952. Three awards of $500 each are made annually to selected
students preparing for Christian service.
The Marlys Johnson Simengaard Memorial Scholarship was established in 1964 by her family and friends to honor her memory.
As an expression of Christian concern for the problems of social
injustice, this scholarship is awarded periodically to an American
Negro student.
Social Service Scholarship Program is sponsored by the Division
of Charities of the American Lutheran Church. Two scholarships of
$300 or three scholarships of $200 will be awarded each year to
students at Augsburg College. The recipients must be juniors or
seniors of the Lutheran faith who are enrolled in social work
courses and plan to continue training in a graduate school of social
work. In addition to scholastic achievement, a student's interests,
aptitude, and skills in working with people are considered in making this award.
The Marilyn Solberg Voice Scholarship in memory of Marilyn
Yvonne Solberg, a member of the Ausgburg College Choir from
1950 until the time of her death in 1953, was established in 1955
by her parents, Mr. and Mrs. Iver Solberg and her brother, Doman.
It is awarded to an Augsburg student who has music as a major
or minor and who shows outstanding promise or achievement in
the art of singing.
The Marguerite Hamilton Storley Memorial Scholarship was established in 1965 by her family and friends to honor her memory.
A scholarship of $300 will be awarded annually to an able and
deserving junior or senior student recommended by the scholarship
committee.
The Professor P. A. Sveeggen Memorial Scholarship was established in 1959 by friends t o honor the memory of P. A. Sveeggen,
professor of English at Augsburg from 1915 to 1952. The award
of variable amount is made annually to an outstanding student in
the field of English.
Tozer Scholarships of $500 each are awarded annually to outstanding Junior or Senior students who are residents of the state of
Minnesota. Monies for these scholarships are provided by the Tozer
Foundation, Inc., of Stillwater, Minnesota.
The Edward Yokie Memorial Scholarship was established in 1962
by E. Lorraine Yokie and Doris E. Yokie, daughters of Edward
Yokie. A scholarship will be awarded annually t o an able and deserving junior or senior student recommended by the scholarship
committee.
Memorial Scholarship Foundation. Undesignated memorial gifts are
placed in the Foundation Fund. Income from these endowment gifts
is used to provide scholarships of varying amounts. The scholarship committee selects students who are able and deserving.
The Crown Prince Harald Scholarship was created by the Augsburg College Board of Regents on the occasion of the visit by Crown
Prince Harald o'f Norway to the Augsburg campus in October,
1965. This annual scholarship provides one year's full tuition for
a student from Norway who wishes to s,tudy at Augsburg. The
recipient is chosen from applicants by a committee in Norway
set up for this purpose.
The Manivald Aldre Memorial Chemistry Scholarship was established in 1960 by friends and the Department of Chemistry t o honor
the memory of Manivald Aldre, assistant professor of chemistry
at Augsburg from 1949 t o 1958. The annual award is made t o a
student whose academic record indicates promise of achievement
in the field of chemistry.
The Carl Fosse Memorial Chemistry Scholarship was established in
1960 by the Department of Chemistry to honor the memory of Carl
Fosse, professor d chemistry at Augsburg from 1921 to 1942. The
annual award is made to a student whose academic record indicates
promise of achievement in the field of chemistry.
The Covey Hendrickson Memorial Chemistry Scholarship was
established in 1967 by the family and friends and the Department
of Chemistry to honor the memory of Covey Hendrickson, a student of chemistry at Augsburg until his death in June, 1966. The
annual award is made to a student whose academic background
indicates promise of achievement in the field of chemistry.
The Dr. Frederick C. and Laura E. Mortensen Chemistry Scholarship
was established in 1961 by the chemistry staff. The award is made
annually to a chemistry student whose record indicates promise
in the field of chemistry.
The Dr. W. M. Saudstrom Chemistry Scholarship was established in
1963 by a gift from Dr. Sandstrom, retired professor of bi,ochemistry
at the University of Minnesota. The annual award is made to a student whose academic background indicates promise of achievement
in the field of chemistry.
The Walter Gordon Schnell Memorial Chemistry Scholarship was
established by friends and the Department of Chemistry in 1960
to honor the memory of Walter Gordon Schnell, a student of chemistry at Augsburg until the time of his death in January, 1960. The
annual award is made to a student whose academic background indicates promise of achievement in the field of chemistry.
The Walter E. Thwaite, Jr., Memorial Chemistry Scholarship was
established in 1963. This annual award is made to a student whose
academic background indicates promising achievement in the field
of chemistry.
GRADUATE SCHOLARSHIPS
The Greater Augsburg Alumni Association Scholarship of $500 is
awarded annually to an outstanding alumnus of Augsburg in order
to encourage and assist promising students in the carrying out of
projects of graduate study.
The George Sverdrup Graduate Fellowship was established by the
Board of Trustees of Augsburg in 1947 to honor the memory of
George Sverdrup, President d Augsburg from 1911 to 1937. It is
awarded annually to an Augsburg graduate of outstanding character
and ability who plans to prepare further for the vwation of teaching. The amount of the Fellowship is five hundred dollars.
STUDENT
ElMPLOYlVIENT
An employment service, located in the Student Personnel Office,
assists students in obtaining part-time remunerative work during
the school year, Christmas vacation, and summer. Both on-campus
and off-campus jobs are available.
ADMISSION
APPLICATION PROCEDURE
Applications for admission are provided by and submitted to the
Office of Admissions, Applications may be obtained by visiting,
writing, or calling (332-5181). A majority of the applications are
received between September and January of the students' senior
year in high school. Although the closing date for making application for the fall term is August 1, the class may be filled well
in advance of this date.
An early decision plan is available for highly-qualified applicants
who apply before December 1. These applicants are notified concerning admission on the basis of grades through the junior year
and college aptitude test scores. Students applying after December 1 will generally not be notified concerning admission until after
the Scholastic Aptitude Test scores have been received by the
college. A $100 tuition deposit is due before May 1, with earlier
payment giving preference in the assignment of campus housing.
Students admitted after May 1 are required to make the $100 tuition deposit within two weeks of notification of acceptance. The
tuition deposit is not refundable but applies to the cost of tuition.
An interview on campus is encouraged.
Instructions for applying for admission:
1. Return the application form with a $10 application fee
(non-refundable) and a photograph to:
Off ice of Admissions
Augsburg College
Minneapolis, Minnesota 55404
2. Request your counselor or principal to send us a transcript
of your high school record and all test results. Transfer
students will request the previous college or colleges to
send an official transcript of grades together with results
of standardized tests taken.
3. The Scholastic Aptitude Test (SAT) of the College Entrance
Examination Board is required for admission. The test should
be taken early in the senior year or late in the junior year.
See your counselor or principal about registering for the
SAT or write to College Entrance Examination Board, c/o
Educational Testing Service, Box 592, Princeton, New Jersey. Transfer students are not required to take the SAT.
ADMISSION REQUIREMENTS
The quality of a student's work in high school, type of course program, scores on college aptitude tests, extra-curricular participation, and recommendations are important factors in considering an
application for admission. Augsburg College seeks students who
rank high in their high school graduating class, at least in the upper half, and who have satisfactory scores on the Scholastic Aptitude Test of the College Entrance Examination Board.
It is recommended that a student have a least 12 academic subjects in his college preparatory curriculum, which should include
four units of English, and a t least two units each of a foreign language, social studies, mathematics, and science. A unit is defined
a s a course covering one academic year and equivalent to at least
120 hours of classwork.
A recent physical examination is also required. Students will be
provided with blanks early in the summer to be filled out and returned to the Student Personnel Office by August 1. The health
report must be received before the student will be permitted to register.
TRANSFER
Students are accepted by transfer from other colleges and universities if their academic record and test results are satisfactory
and they are in good standing. College credit is granted for liberal
arts courses satisfactorily completed a t accredited institutions. A
maximum of 95 quarter credits is allowed on transfer from a junior
college. The college reserves the right not to grant credit for
courses where it considers the work unsatisfactory, and to grant
provisional credit for work taken in unaccredited institutions. The
grade point average for gra-duation is based on work taken a t
Augsburg.
ADVANCED PLACEMENT
Advanced placement is granted to students who qualify, on the
basis of work taken in high school or elsewhere, to enroll in courses
beyond the beginning course. Placement may be determined by
tests, or by the level and length of the course previously completed.
ADVANCED STANDING
Advanced standing, that is, college credit, is granted t o high school
students who have successfully completed a college-level course
provided they received a grade of 3, 4, or 5 on the Advanced Placement Examinations.
MPUS
There are many influences which mould life and character in c01lege. While the exercises d classroom, laboratory, and library
form the organizing basis of college activity, they need to be supplemented by other than academic forces. These intangible but very
real supplementary influences have much to do with creating the
climate of an institution. At Augsburg definite emphasis is placed
upon the maintenance of a wholesome spirit of Christian community living.
THE CHAPEL SERVICE
At the center of Augsburg's program is the daily chapel service,
where the faculty and students gather for united worship, prayer,
and a brief meditation upon the Word of God. Regular attendance
is expected of all students and faculty.
COMMISSION OF
RELIGIOUS ACTIVITIES
The Commission of Religious Activities, composed of students and
faculty, is responsible to the Augsburg community for the implementation of the religious program. Chairman of this Commission is a student, who is also a member of the Student Council.
Although Augsburg College does not believe that religious life
can be separated from the rest of life, this Commission does see
its major responsibility in relation to worship, devotional life, and
the stimulation of faith through discussion and service.
RECREATION STANDARDS
AND DISCIPLINE
At Augsburg all of the work of the college rests on certain Biblical affirmatives about human nature and man's relation to God.
As a Christian liberal arts college, Augsburg takes these relationships seriously and therefore seeks to educate the whole man.
It follows that one of its important responsibilities is to establish
programs and policies that contribute to this end.
It is expected of each student that his life, conduct and influence, both on and off campus, shall be worthy of a member of a
Christian college, and students who do not feel drawn to this
quality of life should not seek to be enrolled at Augsburg.
Without attempting to dictate to the individual conscience, the
college reserves the right to ask its students to adapt themselves
to the social and recreational program approved by the college.
It reserves the right to dismiss any student whose continuation
in college is deemed undesirable for social as well as for academic
reasons.
It is the policy of the college that such action shall be taken only
after the available campus resources of counseling and judicial
processes have been utilized. Thus, disciplinary problems are first
dealt with through counseling. Those not solved this way are
channeled to a student-faculty Judicial Council through the Office of the Dean of Students. In all cases, careful investigation and
the privilege of a hearing precede any disciplinary action.
In seeking to develop a constructive recreational program, some
limitations have been placed on certain activities. The college is
opposed to all forms of gambling. The college does not allow
the possession or consumption of alcoholic beverages in residence
halls, in any college-approved place of residence or at any collegesponsored event. Minnesota state law forbids the possession or
consumption of alcoholic beverages by people who are not 21
years of age.
CONVOCATION
Convocations are held on Wednesdays throughout the year. These
programs acquaint the campus community with outstanding personalities in various fields. A wide range of interests is covered,
including the scientific, political, social, religious, and artistic.
SOCIAL, CULTURAL
AND RECREATIONAL
PROGRAM
In attempting to meet the needs and interests of Augsburg students, use is made of all existing facilities on campus and many
of those which are available in the Twin Cities. Much activity
outside the classroom occurs in the College Center. There the college community is drawn together by social, recreational, and cultural activities. The activities program is designed to complement
the classroom experience and to enhance the student's college experience.
Throughout the year a variety of social activities are held in the
center, in residence halls, and elsewhere on campus. These social
activities include parties, teas, picnics, films, banquets, dances,
talent shows and special dinners and big-name entertainment.
Traditional highlights of the year are Homecoming, the Christmas
Buffet, Sno-Days, the Carnival, and the spring formal dance.
Many students take part in the social society system at Augsburg
by joining either a men's or women's society. These societies are
small groups which provide a natural contact between upperclass
students and freshmen, and commuter and residence students,
as they plan activities. The society system is governed by the InterSociety Council which, in turn, is responsible to the Student Council.
The recreation program has activities for both participants and spectators. The intramural program under the direction of the Physical
Education Department features touch football and basketball. On
campus such recreational facilities as pool tables, ping-pong, and
bicycles are available in addition to the facilities in Melby Hall.
Students also enjoy tennis at nearby parks and swimming at Fairview Hospital. In the winter, students go on skiing outings or stay
on campus to ice skate. There are informally organized soccer and
boot-hockey teams. For the spectator there are the intercollegiate
athletic contests. Students may attend home games on their activity card. For many of the away games bus transportation is
arranged for those wanting to attend.
The cultural program includes activities from the creative and performing arts. In the College Center there are art exhibits, discussions, music listening facilities, small recitals, concerts, drama
readings and films. Art works are also exhibited in the Studio and
the Scholarshop. Augsburgians also enjoy the annual choir, orchestra, and band concerts in Melby Hall. The college also features
a major dramatic production each term in the Little Theatre. Students are admitted free to on-campus dramatic and musical programs by their activity card.
Major responsibility for programming is handled by the Program
Commission. The committees under the Program Commission are
Social, Recreation, Fine Arts, Forum and Lecture, Hospitality, and
Promotion.
METROPOLITAN OPPORTUNITIES
Augsburg's location in Minneapolis gives its students unique opportunities to make use of some of the finest educational and cultural advantages which the Northwest has to offer. Excellent art
collections are to be found in the Minneapolis Institute of Arts,
the Walker Art Center and several other art galleries. The Twin
Cities' libraries are extensive in their services. The Historical Museum in St. Paul gives access to large collections of historical material. The Minneapolis Symphony Orchestra programs and other
concerts afford rich opportunity for the enjoyment of music. Several theaters in the Twin Cities such as the Tyrone Guthrie Theater,
Theater-in-the-Round, the Old Log Theater, the Firehouse Theater,
and St. Paul Civic Opera Company provide a variety of dramatic
and musical presentations.
Many students and faculty attend Minneapolis Symphony Orchestra concerts by virtue of a special college season ticket arrangement. Season tickets are available also for other University concerts and for drama productions at the University and Tyrone
Guthrie Theaters. Students also enjoy Minnesota Twins baseball
and Viking football games a t Metropolitan Stadium.
The Student Society consists of all full-time and part-time students
enrolled a t Augsburg College.
The central concern of student government is focused on education
to the end that individuals may develop their full capabilities
through intellectual growth. The student government relates to
this broad objective by assuming responsibilities for furthering
student affairs, educating members to the democratic process, developing a sense of community, fostering intellectual activity, and
participating in policy making.
STUDENT
GOVERNMENT
The administration, under the direction of the president, resides in
the executive branch. Seven commissioners are each responsible
to the president for one of the major areas of student life. Eight
boards also assist him in his work.
The Student Council, presided over by the vice-president, is the
twenty-member legislative branch of the government. Each of the
college classes has its own officers and participates in student
government through its representatives on the council.
The Judicial Council is a student-faculty judiciary whose rulings are
subject to appeal only to the President of the College.
The Student-Faculty Council, composed of students, administration
and faculty, discusses campus problems, considers legislation
adopted by one group or the other which affects the college as
a whole, and promotes cooperation and understanding between the
students, the faculty, and the administration. The students also
have representation on college committees such as the President's
Cabinet, the College Center Cabinet, and several faculty committees.
The Student Society is a member of the National Student Association, the largest representative national union of students in the
United States. Through this organization the students receive programming aids for use on the campus, and add their voice to the
voice of all American students before the national government and
other organizations in matters of student concern.
The Student Government directs several projects of interest to
the college community. These projects include the annual OneAppeal Campaign, Leadership Training Workshops, Political Action Week, Homecoming, Student Lecture Series, Development
Council, Welcome Week, Sno-Days, International Students Program, Faith-in-Life-Week, College Center Programming, relationships with community organizations and contacts with
neighboring institutions of higher education.
Associated Women Students, composed of all the women students,
provides opportunity for the women to develop meaningful selfgovernment. It aims to create a sense of harmony and fellowship,
to promote and maintain high standards of honor and integrity
in personal conduct, and to encourage participation in all college
activities. It is affiliated with the Inter-collegiate Associated Women Students, a national organization. AWS has an on-campus council and an off-campus council which deal with the problems and
programs of their respective areas.
The college newspaper, The Augsburg Echo, is published by a student staff. The Echo serves as a voice of the student body as well
as a medium of information. It provides an opportunity for experience in the many phases of journalistic work.
PUBLICATIONS
Augsburg's yearbook, the Augsburgian, provides a pictorial record
of the activities of the year. Work on the annual provides opportunity for creative expression in artistic design as well as in
photography.
The Publication Commission is comprised of the editors, business
managers, and advisers of the Augsburgian and the Echo. The chief
responsibility of the Commission is to select editors and business
managers for the campus publications.
The Auggie is a directory of students, staff, and faculty and is
published under the direction of the Office of Public Relations.
The enthusiasm and energy of students motivate them to pursue
their interests beyond the classroom. For most effective participation, students with similar interests have united to form clubs.
Several of these are extensions of courses beyond the classroom.
Others are devoted to interests not offered in the curriculum.
All these organizations are co-ordinated through the Student Organizations Commission of the Augsburg Student Society. This
Commission acts to evaluate club activities, to approve annual
schedules, and to represent clubs at Student Council and Executive
Council meetings.
The Augsburg Chemical Society is open to both majors and minors
in chemistry. The meetings consist of seminars on current topics
in this specific area.
The Augsburg College Association for Childhood Education is an
organization especially for students in the elementary education
program. It is concerned primarily with professional standards in
the teaching profession, educational changes, and needs of children in the field of elementary education.
CO-CURRICULAR
PROGRAM
Augsburg College Children's Groups involves students who meet
weekly with a group of neighborhood children. The students provide such activities as games, crafts, field trips, and sports as they
show their concern for these children by their own personal invoIvement.
The Augsburg YGOP Club and YDFL Club aim to stimulate interest
in public affairs and give students opportunity to participate actively in local, state, and national politics, and in other human relations activities.
The Augsburg Society for Dramatic Arts provides for its members
an opportunity to learn from participation in stage presentations
and from field trips, as well as from reading and seeing plays
produced. Membership is open to all students. Membership in
National Collegiate Players represents recognition for continued
excellence in drama participation. It is open to qualified upperclassmen.
The "A" Club is limited to men who have won a major "A" at
Augsburg. The aim of this organization is "to bind the 'A' men
of the past, present, and future into a more intimate bond of
fellowship, and to keep the athletics of Augsburg on the highest
possible plane."
The Cosmopolitan Club brings together foreign and American students who have a mutual interest in the culture, language, and
people of various countries.
The Debate Club fosters debate activity at Augsburg as it meets
to develop skills necessary in debating. Members of the club
represent Augsburg in the Twin Cities Debate League and other
intercollegiate tournaments.
The French Club is composed of students interested in the French
language and culture.
The German Club is open to all students who are studying or
have studied German. In addition to providing opportunity for
conversational practice, the club also promotes understanding
and appreciation of the German people, their achievements and
customs.
Karate Club is organized to provide instruction in classical Karate
for Augsburg men and women students. It also promotes better
understanding of Karate itself and of the various schools of Karate.
The Norse Club is composed of students who are interested in
Norwegian culture as reflected in Norwegian literature, music,
art and history.
The Pre-Sem Club, composed of all pre-seminary students at Augsburg, is an organization that expresses concern for spiritual life
at Augsburg, as well as acquaints its members with the vocation
of the Christian ministry.
The Psychology Club promotes interest in various fields of psycholowThe Ski Club is a recreation group promoting interest and developing skills in skiing.
The Spanish Club serves as a means of interpreting Spanish culture to students in an informal way.
The Sociology Forum is an organization of students preparing for
professional work in the field of Social Service.
The Student National Education Association, Martin Quanbeck
Chapter, offers to its members associate membership in professional education associations and strives to acquaint future teachers with the importance of teaching as a profession.
The Ushers' Club is a service organization providing trained ushers
for public events scheduled for the campus.
The Writers' Club includes students who enjoy creative expression in various forms of writing. The members share their literary efforts in an informal atmosphere, and benefit from mutual
criticism. They publish The Arkai, a collection of the best creative writing each year.
The Women's Recreation Association at Augsburg is a member of
the Minnesota Athletic Association of College Women. Membership in this organization is gained by participation in individual
and group recreational activities with awards given on a point basis.
The Augsburg Concert Band numbers fifty members selected by
audition from all classes. In addition to local appearances, the
band tours annually to various parts of the United States.
The Augsburg Choir has sixty-five members selected by audition
from all classes. In addition to local appearances, the choir goes
on tour each year to various parts of the United States and occasionally to Canada. The choir toured Norway and other European countries in 1965.
The Augsburg College Choral Club performs frequently in campus
programs and concerts and sings at various churches in the Twin
City area. Membership is by audition or consent of the director.
The Augsburg College Orchestra presents programs of standard
repertoire for orchestra alone as well as with soloists and choral
groups. In addition to campus and local appearances, the orchestra tours in the Midwest. Membership is by audition.
Larger campus musical groups also include the Repertoire Band
and the Symphonia.
MUSIC
ORGANIZATIONS
PHYSICAL
EDUCATION
AND
RECREATION
Under the direction of the Department of Health and Physical Education, a wide range of recreational activities is arranged for general
student participation. Every student is urged to participate in some
activity for his own recreation and relaxation.
An intramural program provides competition in a variety of team
sports as well as individual performance activities. Climaxing the
intramural program is the Extramural Meet, a tournament for the
winners of intramural schedules in various colleges.
INTERCOLLEGIATE ATHLETICS
Augsburg is a member of the Minnesota Intercollegiate Athletic
Conference. The college is represented annually by teams in football, cross country, basketball, hockey, wrestling, baseball, track,
tennis, and golf.
PURPOSE AND PHILOSOPHY
OF INTERCOLLEGIATE ATHLETICS
It is the purpose of Augsburg College to provide an intercollegiate
athletic program which is in harmony with its Christian philosophy.
This philosophy is to be reflected in the conduct and outlook of both
the players and the spectators. The educational program of the
college recognizes that recreation and play are a fundamental part
of human life, and that this phase of life needs to be cultivated if
physical, mental, and emotional health are to be maintained. Intercollegiate athletics, as a phase of that program, gives recognition to
the fact that competitive play can contribute to the development of
student interests, skills, insights, and loyalties.
More specifically, the following outcomes are sought: (1) The student participating in athletics should acquire and exhibit, both in
and out of athletics, such basic qualities of character as self-discipline, honesty, sense of fair play, and cooperation. (2) The participant
should develop the knowledge, interests, and skills which will be
of special use to him in such vocations as teaching and coaching
or recreational leadership, or in his own recreational activities.
Far from being set apart from his educational goal or in any way
competing with it, the student's participation in intercollegiate
athletics must either contribute directly to this goal or be complementary to his other educational activities. (3) The student
spectator should acquire and exhibit some of the finer qualities of
Christian character, such as self-restraint, sense of fair play, appreciation of high-grade performance on the part of both opponents
and fellow-students, and respect for individual personality. (4) The
intercollegiate athletic program should contribute to the development of a unified and healthy "school spirit." Enthusiasm for intercollegiate athletics or other co-curricular activities should not
overshadow pride in high scholastic achievement, nor can it take
the place of a well-rounded and effective intramural and general
recreational program.
ELIGIBILITY
REQUIREMENTS
In order to participate in certain extra-curricular activities, students must meet established eligibility requirements. Organizations
check eligibility of candidates by submitting a list to the Director
of Student Activities for approval.
Eligibility f w participation in intercollegiate athletics is governed
by the rules of the Minnesota Intercollegiate Athletic Conference.
A student on academic probation may not be a member of the
Augsburg College Choir, Concert Band, or the Orchestra. He is not
eligible to participate in a major dramatic production, cheerleading,
student publications, societies, or to accept elected or appointed
student-government otfices or chairmanships. This list is not inclusive and o,ther activities may be designated.
HONORS
AND
AWARDS
The purpose of Beta Chi Epsilon is to honor those senior
women who have maintained a high level of academic achievement and who have shown loyalty by giving service and
leadership to the college community. In turn, it is the responsibility
of these women to foster the development of academic excellence,
leadership, and service among women students of Augsburg College.
On the 1927 Class Cup for Scholarship Trophy is engraved the
name of each s.tudent who has achieved the highest scholastic standing in his college graduating class. He must have attended Augsburg for a t least two years.
Omicron Chapter of Lambda Iota Tau, a national honor society,
is open to students with a major or minor in English or a foreign
language, who have attained a high scholastic average and have
presented a paper on a literary topic before a public audience.
The purposes of the Timia Society, the Augsburg honor society, are
to recognize academic achievement and to promote scholarship.
Juniors and seniors who have earned a 3.5 grade point accumulative average are eligible for membership, while freshmen and
sophomores with a 3.25 grade point average may be admitted as
pledges.
Augsburg has a Chapter of Pi Gamma Mu, the National Social
Science Honor Society, which is affiliated with the Association of
College Honor Societies. A high level of scholarship in the social
sciences is required for election to membership.
The Dean's List includes students who have achieved a grade point
average of 3.5 or better in the previous term of work a t Augsburg
College.
The 1925 Class Cup in Athletics is awarded to the athlete who has
made outstanding records both in athletics and in scholarship.
The Harold A. Johnson Trophy, presented by Gerald L. Johnson
in 1943, is awarded annually to the student who is judged to be
the most valuable player on the basketball team.
Outstanding seniors are nominated annually by a Student-Faculty
Committee for membership in Who's Who Among Students in
American Colleges and Universities. Special attention is given
to scholarship, leadership and participation in extra-curricular activities such as athletics, drama, music organizations, societies,
student government and community activities.
Institutional services to students are organized and administered
in accordance with plans and policies established by the Student
Personnel Committee. Included are such services as Admissions,
Counseling, Testing, Freshman Orientation, Student Records, The
Student Health Service, Housing and Food Service, Placement,
Student Employment, and Coordination of Student Activities. The
administration of these services is centered in the Office of the
Dean of Students.
ADMISSIONS
Pre-college counseling concerning admissions requirements, college entrance examinations, financial aids, and career planning
is available from qualified personnel in the Office of Admissions.
Counseling can be obtained either on campus or in schools and
homes as the counselors travel throughout the Upper Midwest.
In addition to high school seniors, sophomores and juniors are
encouraged to use these services and also to visit the campus if at
all possible.
STUDENT
PERSONNEL
SERVICES
COUNSELING
Counseling services are maintained in an effort to assist each
student to obtain the maximum benefits from the learning experiences offered a t Augsburg College. Matters such as uncertainty
over vocational choice or educational planning, religious uncertainty, health or financial problems, personal and social adjustment and personal deficiencies can interfere with the learning
process and are dealt with in counseling sessions. It is hoped that
through counseling, students will develop a more realistic understanding of themselves and the surrounding world, and keener
awareness of resources available to them as they meet the problems of daily life.
At Augsburg the counseling process is carried on a t several levels.
All faculty members participate in the counseling program, and
each new student is assigned to a faculty counselor who works
with him until he chooses a major field of study. At that time,
the major adviser becomes his counselor. In addition, there are staff
members who have specialized training in counseling and techniques
for dealing with problems of adjustment. The personnel deans
serve as special counselors. The counseling program is coordinated
through the Director of Psychological Services in the Office of
the Dean of Students in accordance with the plans and policies
established by the Student Personnel Committee.
RECORDS
Individual student records are kept in the Records Office under
the supervision of the Registrar. These records include admission
data, academic achievement, student participation and achievement
in non-academic activities, test scores, reports of counseling, and
other information.
The Student Personnel Office maintains a file of student government
officers, of clubs and societies, including the constitutions, activities, schedules, and membership rosters.
THE STUDENT HEALTH SERVICE
The Student Health Service provides dispensary service with
two registered nurses on duty. The college physician has daily
office hours for consultation and for emergency treatment.
Infirmary roloms are provided. The Health Service is located in
Fairview Hospital, adjacent to the campus.
Physical examinations are given to all seniors. Before registering,
each entering student is required to have on file the report of a
physical examination given by his family physician. Corrective
treatment is prescribed where needed.
Students who have personal problems are encouraged to seek help
through counseling conferences. If a serious problem develops
which demands professional skill, the student is referred to the
offices of the personnel deans. Referrals may be made to the College Chaplain, or the College Psychologist.
FRESHMAN ORIENTATION
Freshmen and other new students participate in Freshman Days
before the beginnkg of classes each year. The students take tests,
attend classes, inspect the college facilities, and become acquainted
with their fellow students, with the faculty, and especially with
their own faculty counselors. The faculty counselors and students
have several conferences during which they plan the student's
program of study.
All new students are given a battery of tests during Freshman
Days. Scholastic Aptitude Test scores and special placement test
scores are used by counselors to help students plan their initial
programs. Personality inventories and the vocational interest profiles help the students to know more about themselves, in order to
make a good choice of subjects and occupational goals.
A special course in improvement of reading is offered for interested students. Freshmen who expect difficulty with the increased
quantity and complexity of the reading material encountered in
college are especially urged to enroll in this course.
IJ HOUSING AND FOOD SERVICE
In its residence program, the college aims to develop in the students
Christian character, self-control, and thoughtful consideration of
others. At the same time, the college realizes that students' happiness, comfort, and emotional adjustment in the residence halls
are direct influences on their general efficiency in the classroom.
In an effort to provide these opportunities for development, student
residence councils assume the responsibilities for the administration of dormitory life policies in consultation with the head residents and personnel deans.
Upper-class students serve as counselors in the residences and attempt to help residents with problems of personal adjustment. The
head residents and personnel deans serve as resource people for
these counselors and handle cases referred to them.
All students not living at home are required to live in collegeoperated housing. Students desiring to reside in the city with
relatives must first secure approval for such an arrangement from
the Student Personnel Office. All students living in residences
take their meals in the Commons. The college also provides a
number of houses for men and women with a cooperative houseplan option.
Residence halls are open to students a day before regular schedules become effective, and they close a day after the term closes.
Students who wish to stay in residence during vacations must
apply for the privilege. Rooms are furnished except for bed linen,
towels, blankets, and bedspreads. Laundry facilities are available
in each residence. Bed linens and towels may be rented with
laundering service a t a reasonable cost. This service is required
of all students in residence halls. An optional linen service is
available to students living in houses.
Students engage a room a t the beginning of the fall term for the
entire school year. A room deposit is required of upper-class students to hold a room. This fee is payable a t the Treasurer's Office
by May 15. Students who have not paid the room deposit by this
date are automatically removed from the housing roster. No refunds are made after August 1.
All men living in Memorial Hall, Mortensen-Sivertsen Hall and
cottage housing, are required to pay a $20 key and breakage fee
a t the beginning of each school year. At the end of the year the
fee is refunded if the condition of the room and furniture is satisfactory and the key is returned.
GRADUATE PLACEMENT
The Placement Bureau assists seniors and alumni in securing positions. Continuous contact is maintained with business, governmental, welfare, and educational institutions a t the local, state,
and national levels. The services of the Placement Bureau are free
t o graduating seniors. Alumni seeking the services of the Placement
Bureau will be charged a re-registration fee of $5. There is no
placement fee.
CO-ORDINATION OF STUDENT ACTIVITIES
The Director of Student Activities assists student officers to
maintain effective functioning of student activities, and keeps
on file the club constitutions, rosters, and schedules of meetings.
Faculty advisers to student organizations are approved by the Director. The program of student activities is a primary responsibility of the Program Commission and the Student Organization
Commission in addition to other Boards and Commissions under
the Augsburg Student Society.
A weekly bulletin of events is prepared for the Echo by the Student Personnel Office. The college Master Calendar is kept in the
Office of Student Activities.
GRADUATION REQUIREMENTS
Following are the requirements for graduation with the Bachelor of
Arts degree from Augsburg College:
1. Satisfactory completion of the General Education Requirements
described below.
2. Completion of a major.
3. A total of 180 quarter credits. (186 for students above junior
standing in fall of 1968)
4. At least 54 credits in courses numbered above 50.
5. A minimum of "C" average in all courses taken.
6. Proficiency in English.
7. The last year of course work a t Augsburg.
GENERAL EDUCATION REQUIREMENTS
The general education program a t Augsburg College consists of
core and distribution requirements as follows:
1. English 11, 12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
2. History 1 or 2 or 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
3. Religion 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
4. Sociology 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
5. Physical Education 1, 2, 3 (one year) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
6. Art 1 or Music 30 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
7. Philosophy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
8. Religion 21 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
9. Foreign Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-18
10. Natural Science or Mathematics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12
11. Political Science or Economics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
12. Speech or Literature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
13. Religion (upper division) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
credits
credits
credits
credits
credit
credits
credits
credits
credits
credits
credits
credits
credits
The first five courses listed above should be taken in the freshman
year, except that students with majors in biology, chemistry, music,
or medical technology may postpone history or sociology until the
sophomore year. Religion 21 is required in the sophomore year. It is
recommended that the general education requirements be completed
in the first two years of college, except item 13 above. One upper
division religion course should be taken in each of the junior and
senior years.
Students who enter college with a high proficiency in English will
enroll in English 15 instead of English 11 and will substitute a literature course for English 12.
The number of credits required in a foreign language is determined
by proficiency examinations. The student is required to have the
equivalent of four terms of a foreign language for graduation, that
is, two terms of the beginning course and two terms of the intermediate level course. He is exempt from this requirement if he
has had four years or more of one foreign language.
In the natural sciences, two courses in biology, chemistry, mathematics, or physics satisfy the requirement. It is recommended
that the two courses be taken in the same department. Students
ACADEMIC
ADMINISTRATION
who obtain a grade of A or B in the first course of science have
the option of taking Philosophy of Science for the second course.
Philosophy 21 and 22 are designed to meet the philosophy requirement. Philosophy 23 may be used also.
Students may choose from Political Science 20, 21, 22 or Economics 22 for the requirement in political science or economics.
The general education requirement in speech or literature will be
satisfied by: Speech 11 or 51; English 35, 40, or 45. Upon request
a student may substitute another literature course by permission
of the instructor.
MAJORS AND MINORS
The following majors are offered:
American Studies
Art
Biology
Business Administration: Accounting
Business Administration: Finance
Business Education
Chemistry
Economics
Elementary Education
English
French
German
Greek
Health and
Physical Education
History
Mathematics
Medical Technology
Music
Natural Science
Philosophy
Physical Education
Physics
Political Science
Psychology
Religion
Scandinavian Studies
Social Sciences
Sociology
Spanish
Speech
Students are required to prepare a plan for the major with the
head of the department offering the major. This is normally done
in the spring term of the sophomore year.
A student may earn a minor in any of the fields listed above except
Elementary Education and Medical Technology. Minors are also
offered in Library Science and Latin.
For major and minor requirements, see departmental statements.
ELECTIVE CREDITS
Most courses of study are designed to give the student an opportunity t o elect credits beyond those which are required for the
major and for general education.
To ensure a bro'ad range 08felectives, a limitation of 60 credits has
been set as the maximum number of credits from one department
which may count toward the Bachelor of Arts degree. (Exception
is made for music majors who may count 68 credits in music.
Business Administration and Economics are c o n s i d e ~ dseparate
departments for this purpose.) A student may earn up to five
credits in independent study courses in one year. A maximum
of ten credits earned by independent study may be applied toward
the 180 (or 186) credits required for the degree.
PROFICIENCY IN WRITING
All students are required to take an English test a t the end of the
sophomore year and must demonstrate a proficiency in writing in
order to qualify for the A.B. degree. See under Department of English.
DEGREE WITH DISTINCTION
Graduation with distinction is determined as follows:
Summa Cum Laude . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8-4.0 grade average
grade average
Magna Cum Laude . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.5-3.79
Cum Laude .......................... 3.1-3.49
grade average
+
+
To be eligible for these honors, the student must have completed
a t least two years of work a t Augsburg, and his record at Augsburg, as well as his total record, must meet the requirements as
given above.
GRADE VALUES
A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Superior, 4 grade points per credit
B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Very good, 3 grade points per credit
C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Satisfactory, 2 grade points per credit
D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Passable, 1 grade point per credit
F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Failure, 0 grade points per credit
E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Condition
I . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Incomplete
WP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Withdrew-Passing
WF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Withdrew-Failing
W . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Course withdrawn during first four weeks;
or student withdrew from college.
S (satisfactory), P (pass), N (no credit) indicate level of achievement; they do not affect grade point average.
CONDITIONS AND INCOMPLETES
A condition or an incomplete received at the end of a term must
be removed within the first five weeks of classes of the following
term. If conditions and incompletes are not removed within five
weeks of the following term, the condition automatically becomes
a failure and the incomplete becomes the grade submitted by the
teacher along with the Incomplete. The final grade after the con,dition examination is taken may not be higher than D. A fee of
$5 is charged for an examination making up an incomplete or a
condition received a t the end of a term.
REPEATING COURSES
A course which has been failed or in which a D has been earned
may be repeated for credit. Only the credits and grade earned the
second time are counted toward graduation. Courses in which
higher grades have been earned may not be repeated for credit;
they may, however, be audited.
-
REGISTRATION
Students who have been accepted for admission should register
on the days designated in the Calendar for this purpose. Those who
register late are charged a late registration fee of $1 per day after
classes begin. The last date on which a student may register for
or enter a course is one week after the beginning of classes. Registration for audit requires the same procedure as registration for
credit. Audit registration is considered equal to one-half the credit
registration in determining load and fees.
Registration means that the student accepts all the rules and regulations established by the school.
No credit will be given a student for any subject for which he has
not registered.
The college reserves the right to cancel any course for whichthere
is not sufficient registration.
The normal registration is 15 credit hours. A credit hour is nonnally defined as one recitation period a week throughout a term. The
privilege of registering for more than 17 credit hours is granted to
students who have gained an average record of B, or three grade
points per credit, in the preceding term. No student is permitted to carry work for more than 19 credits per term. Students
working part-time are urged to arrange the amount omf their registration accordingly.
CHANGE OF REGISTRATION AND CANCELLATION
A student who desires to make a change in his registration should
obtain a form from the Registrar's Office. The approval of the
teachers concerned, the student's adviser, and the Registrar are
needed. A fee of $2 is charged for each change of registration after
the first three days of classes. No course may be added after the
first week of classes.
A course which is cancelled during the first four weeks of classes
is followed by W. After the first four weeks and before the last
three weeks of the term, a course which is cancelled is given a grade
of WP if the student is passing and WF if he is failing the course.
No course may be cancelled during the last three weeks of the
term.
A student who finds it necessary to leave school before the end
of a term must cancel his registration at the Registrar's Office in
order to remain in good standing.
CLASSIFICATION IJ
In order to be classified in one of the regular college classes, a
student must be carrying a minimum of 12 hours of work in which
college credit is given. Classification is based on the attainment of
the following number of credit hours with a t least twice that number of grade points:
Credits
Grade Points
36
72
Sophomore
84
168
Junior
130
260
Senior
Students are classified by this regulation a t the time of their registration each school year.
Students registered for less than 12 credits are classified as special
students.
PROBATION AND DISMISSAL
A student is placed on scholastic probation a t the end of any term
in which his achievement is unsatisfactory. The following guidelines are used in placing a student on probation with the overall
average entering in as an additional factor.
First-year students with a grade point average o,f 1.5 or below
Second-year students with a grade point average of 1.6 or below
Third-year students with a grade point average of 1.8 or below
Fourth-year students with a grade point average of 1.8 or below
All students with 7 or more credits of F.
In order to be removed from probation, a student must achieve a
grade point average of 2.1 or better for at least one term.
A student will usually be allowed to continue on probation for two
terms. If his academic achievement has continued to be unsatisfactory, he will be dropped for low scholarship.
CLASS ATTENDANCE
Regular class attendance is required of all students in lo'wer division courses. Attendance in upper division courses is voluntary
for juniors and seniors unless required by the teacher of the class.
In classes for which attendance is required, a record of attendance
is kept and periodic reports on absences are submitted to the Registrar.
Students wh'o find it necessary to be absent because of illness or
for other reasons should report the reasons for the absence to their
teachers. For prolonged absence of over one week due to illness,
the student may obtain an excuse signed by the Health Service if
this is requested by the teacher.
Students with an excessive number of absences not excused by the
teacher may be dropped from the course with a grade of F.
Absences for tours, field trips, and other instructor-arranged activities are cleared with the Dean of the College. Lists of participants, with information as to exact periods absent, are issued by
the Dean to all instructors involved, but the student is still responsible for any work missed.
Teachers deal with tardiness as they see fit. Students arriving in
class late must assume responsibility for reporting their presence
to the teacher.
EXAMINATIONS
Tests are given periodically throughout each term. In the middle
of the fall term, reports of the grades attained by freshmen are
made to the Registrar who forwards them to the counselors, parents, and students. Final reports are sent at the end of each term
to the parents and students.
Written examinations are regularly scheduled a t the close of each
term. No student or class may arrange to take a final examination
in any course before the examination week.
Absence from a final examination will result in a grade of failure
unless the student presents a reasonable excuse immediately to the
teacher concerned.
If a student has obtained permission from the Dean of the College
to take a final examination at another hour than that scheduled,
he is charged a fee of $5 for such an examination. Before the student takes the examination, he must obtain a statement from the
Registrar's office and bring it to the teacher concerned.
COMPREHENSIVE EXAMINATIONS
Comprehensive examinations may be permitted in courses in which
the Committee on Admissions and Student Standing believes the
student has adequate preparation or background. Students who wish
to take a comprehensive examination must apply in writing to this
committee. When permission is granted, the necessary approval
forms may be secured at the Office of the Registrar. A fee of $5
($10 for students not currently enrolled) is charged for each credit
hour and must be paid in advance. Examination questions and the
answers will be filed in the Registrar's Office.
UNIVERSITY COURSES
By arrangement with the University of Minnesota, students may
register for courses at the University. But such registrations will
not be allowed unless the student has a C average in his courses
at Augsburg. Also, the combined number of credits in any term
must not exceed 17. The credits thus gained a t the University may
be transferred to Augsburg College and counted towards graduation.
COURSES
OF
STUDY
Descriptions of the courses offered in 1968-70 are given on the
following pages. Unforeseen circumstances may necessitate making
changes. Courses with inadequate registration may be cancelled.
Students should consult the schedule o,f classes t o determine definitely the current course offerings.
NUlMBERING OF COURSES
Courses numbered below 50 are lower division courses; those numbered 50 and above are classified as upper division. In general,
courses numbered 1-19 are primarily for freshmen; 20-49 for
sophomores; 50-74 for juniors; and 75-99 for seniors.
SYMBOLS
# Course may be taken with consent of the instructor irrespective
of prerequisites.
CREDITS
Credits shown are in terms of quarter credits. Unless otherwise
stated a four-credit course meets four times a week and a fivecredit course five times a week. A term or quarter is 11 weeks in
length, and the normal load for a student is 15 credit hours per
term.
DIVISIONAL ORGANIZATION
The college courses are organized into four divisions in order to
make interdepartmental coordination more convenient and cooperative aims more easily achieved. A chairman for each division is
appointed for a two-year term.
Major and minor requirements are indicated in the departmental
statements.
DIVISION of the HUMANITIES
Mr. Raymond E. Anderson, Chairman
Department of Art
Department of Classical Languages
Greek; Latin
Department of English
Department of Modern Languages
French; German; Scandinavian Studies; Spanish
Department of Music
Department of Speech
DIVISION of NATURAL SCIENCES and MATHEMATICS
Mr. Theodore Hanwick, Chairman
Department of
Department of
Department of
Department of
Department of
Biology
Chemistry
Health and Physical Education
Mathematics
Physics
DIVISION of RELIGION and PHILOSOPHY
Mr. Philip A. Quanbeck, Chairman
Department of Philosophy
Department of Religion
DIVISION of the SOCIAL SCIENCES
Mr. Einar 0. Johnson, Chairman
Department of Business Administration, Economics, and Business Education
Department of Education
Elementary Education
Secondary Education
Library Science
Geography
Department of History
Department of Political Science
Department of Psychology
Department of Sociology
AMERICAN STUDIES
Mr. Nicholl, Director of Program
The aim of the program in American Studies is to develop the
student's understanding of American culture, past and present,
in breadth as well as some depth. The major is interdepartmental,
built primarily upon American area courses now offered in various
departments.
The program should offer the student a good foundation for graduate studies in law and the ministry, for the M.A. in library science
and the M.A.T. in secondary school teaching. The major would
also provide a good background for careers in the U.S. Government, particularly civil service positions and the foreign service.
Major: 56 credits, minimum
Requirements for the major include a core of foundation courses
(29 crs.); a program of elective courses for integrated study (minimum, 18 crs.) and American Studies 99 (5 crs.); and American
Studies 95 (4 crs.), a seminar of concentrated study.
The core of courses, to be taken in the departments of English,
History, Political Science, and Religion aim to give the student a
broad foundation of subject matter in major areas of American
culture, past and present, and introduce him to the methodologies
of various disciplines.
The following are required core courses:
English 45: Major American Writers (5 crs.) Prereq. Eng. 11-12
History 21-22: United States History (10 crs.) Prereq. Hist. 1
or 2 or 3
Political Science 20: American Government I, Foundations of
Amer. Dem. (5 crs.)
Political Science 21: Am. Gov't 11, Amer. National Gov't (5 crs.)
Religion 63: American Protestantism (4 crs.) Prereq. Rel. 11
and 21
In his program of elective courses the student would attempt to
achieve a measure of integrated study of major themes in American civilization. Papers written in Independent Study, Am. S. 99,
would attempt to accomplish this.
From the following elective courses the student must choose a
minimum of 18 credits from a t least 3 departments:
Education 87: School and Society (4 crs.)
English 82: The American Novel (4 crs.) Prereq. Eng. 45
History 55: Twentieth Century United States History (4 crs.)
History 56: History of American Foreign Policy (4 crs.) Prereq.
Hist. 21 or 22
Political Science 22: Amer. Gov't 111, State and Local Gov't;
Public Administration (5 crs.) Prereq. Political Science
20-21
Political Science 70: Constitutional Law I (4 crs.) Prereq.
Pol. Sci. 20, 21, 22
Philosophy 65: American Philosophy (5 crs.) Prereq. Phil. 21
Psychology 81: History and Theory (4 crs.) Prereq. #
Sociology 59: Religion and Society (4 crs.) Prereq. Rel. 11 and
21
Sociology 42: Rural American Community (4 crs.) Prereq. SOC.
11
Sociology 43: Modern Urban Community (4 crs.) Prereq. Soc. 11
Refer to course listings under the various departments for full
descriptions of the above elective courses in the program.
American Studies courses (required):
95 Seminar
4 crs.
Focuses on a limited, significant problem or phenomenon in American culture. Use of primary source material from various disciplines. Practice in the integrated use of these materials for an
understanding of the topic in depth. To be taken in the senior
year. For majors or #. (Winter)
99 Independent Study
5 crs.
Major themes or topics cutting across courses elected in the program are chosen by the student for integrated study. The writing
of several papers of an interdisciplinary nature. To be taken in the
senior year. For majors only. (Spring)
MR. THOMPSON, chairman, MR. HOLEN, MR. MOSAND,
MRS. JENSON; MR. MOLDER, MR. WESTPHAL, artists in residence
DEPARTMENT
The Department of Art endeavors to further the student's technical
and conceptual understanding of art. Besides experience in the disciplines
of drawing, print making, painting, sculpture, and ceramics, emphasis
is given to the function of art in history and religion. Because of the
place art has in contemporary life, students are encouraged to consider the areas of teaching, graduate study, commercial designing,
and avocational art.
ART
OF
In addition to the courses oirered for credit, students have the opportunity to study and discuss rr-ith -4ugust Molder, artist in residence,
problems of art related to the m a h g of stained gIass windows. David
Westphal, cinematographer in residence, is available to those interested
in film making as a fine art medium.
Major: 46 credits, including 7, 8, 12, 18, 21, 67, 83, 84, 85, 99.
Minor: 26 credits, including 7, 8, 12, 18, 21 or 50, and 83 or 84 or 85.
Majors prepanng for teaching in secondary or elementary schools are
required to take 50.
It is recommended that art majors and minors take Introduction to
Fine Arts under the Department of Music.
1 I INTRODUCTION TO FINE ARTS
4 crs.
Historical and topical studies in fine arts. The visual arts seen in relation to music. Participation in the cultural life of the community
leading towards appreciation and criticism. [3 lect., 1disc. Fall, Spring,
1 7 DRAWING
2 crs.
Drawing in pencil, charcoal, pastel, ink, and mixed media. Emphasis
on still-life and interiors. [2 double labs. Fall, Winter, Spring.]
1 8 DRAWING
2 crs.
Figure drawing. C2 double labs. Fall, Winter, Spring.]
1 12 COMPOSITION
6 crs.
A study of the elements of form and composition. Two- and threedimensional studies executed on a small scale. C4 lect., 2 double labs.
Fall, Winter.]
18 PAINTING I
4 crs.
Painting in aqueous media and oil. Emphasis on still-life, landscape,
and figurative painting. [4 double labs. Prereq.: 7. Fall, 1968-69. Fall,
Spring, 1969-70.1
1 2 I SCULPTURE I
4 crs.
Modeling head studies, figures, and animal forms in terracotta and
plaster. C4 double labs. Prereq.: 7. Fall.]
1 25 GRAPHIC DESIGN
4 crs.
A study of the techniques and goals of business art. A concern for
graphic design through calligraphy, typography and the preparation
of art work for reproduction. [Winter, 1968-69.1
UPPER DIVISION
COURSES
1 50 CERAMICS I
4 crs.
An introduction to the making of pottery with an emphasis on handbuilding and glazing. C4 double labs. Winter.]
51 CERAMICS II
4 crs.
A continuation of hand-building and glazing with an introduction to
throwing techniques. [4 double labs. Prereq.: 7, 8. Spring.]
1 55 PAINTING II
4 crs.
Further study of painting in oil and aqueous media. [4 double labs.
Prereq.: 12, 18. Spring.]
1 58 ART IN ELEMENTARY SCHOOLS
4 crs.
Theory, methods and materials of art in elementary education. C2 lect.,
2 double labs. Spring.]
4 crs.
1 67 PRINT MAKING I
Principles and methods of color printing and composition. Emphasis
on the woodcut. [4 double labs. Prereq.: 7, 8. Spring.]
4 crs.
1 68 PRINT MAKING II
Serigraphy and intaglio methods in plastic and copper. 14 double labs.
Prereq.: 12, 67. Winter.]
1 78 SCULPTURE II
4 crs.
Three major works in any three of the following media: steel (welding), plaster, lead, wood, fiberglass, and stone. [4 double labs. Prereq.
7, 8, 21. Winter, 196-9.
Spring, 1969-70.1
1 8 3 ART HISTORY I
4 crs.
Survey of architecture, sculpture, and painting in western civilization.
Prehistoric to Renaissance. [Fall.]
1 84 ART HISTORY II
4 crs.
Continued historical survey. Renaissance to the 1860's. [Winter.]
1 85 ART HISTORY Ill
4 crs.
Modern art and its developing trends from the 1860's to the present.
[Spring.]
1 99 STUDIO Ill
2-5 crs.
Advanced study in either painting, sculpture, print making, or ceramics.
Art majors will be granted up to 8 credits in this course. [Prereq. : second
course in the studio area and#.]
DEPARTMENT
OF
BIOLOGY
MR. SULERUD, chairman, MR. HERFORTH, MR. MICKELBERG,
MR. THORPE, MR. URDAHL
It is intended that the offerings of the Department of Eiology should be
extensive enough to meet the needs and interests of a tvide variety
of students. For the nan-science major the aim is to pmvidc a reliable
basic understanding nf biological science and, more generally, of the
character of scieniifie Colmvlcclgc. The more ad\-anced courses are designed to provide a good preparation for students who elect to pursue
the study of biological science for a career in the profession of biology
or in a related area such as the medical profession.
All students who intend to complete a major or minor in biology should
plan their program carefully with specific reference to their intended
career. It is important that a prospective binlogy major consult with
the biology staff concerning this planning as soon es possible. In
general, a broad background in the supportihg sciences and in mathematics is essential. Students who plan to enter graduate or medical
school or to teach secondary school upon graduation must be certain
to meet the appropriate preparatory requirements. Recommended fouryear programs for such students are given under Curriculums in the
catalog as are the programs for pre-dental, pre-nursing and medical
technology students.
Major: Two programs leading to a biology major are available. Option
I i s recommended, with few exceptions, for students who intend to
obtain an advanced degree in biology, medicine or related fields. Option
II may be preferable for potential secondary school teachers and others
whose intended careers require relatively more work in biology and
somewhat less in the related sciences.
Option I: 38 credits in biology, including 11, 12, 72, and two terms of
seminar; introductory chemistry (Chem. 15, 16; or 5, 6) and two terms
or organic chemistry (Chem. 51, 52); one year of physics (Physics 21,
22, 23); two terms of calculus (Math. 41, 42) in addition to introductory
math. Note: Medical schools also normally require quantitative analysis
(Chem. 53).
Option 11: 46 credits in biology, including 11,12, 72, one additional course
in the 70 series, and two terms of seminar; four terms of chemistry,
normally introductory chemistry (Chem. 15, 16; or 5, 6) and either two
terms of organic Chemistry (Chem. 51, 52) or one term of organic
chemistry (Chem. 23) and one term of analytical chemistry (Chem.
53); introductory mathematics (Math. 13, 14; or Math. 40; or equivalent).
Minor: 30 credits in biology including 11 and 12; introductory chemistry
(Chem. 15, 16; or 5, 6).
Biology 1, 3, 4, 6 and 8 do not count toward a major or minor in biology.
Biology 1and 6 satisfy the general education requirement in science; for
this purpose Biology 1must precede Biology 6.
H I PRINCIPLES OF BIOLOGY
5 crs.
The basic concepts of biology. A general education course, not intended
for majors in biology. Does not normally apply toward a biology major
or minor. Students who receive a grade of B or better may be allowed
to enter Biology 1 2 on consent of instructor. [4 lect., 1 double lab. Fall,
Spring.]
4, 4 crs.
3 , 4 HUMAN ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
A professional course in the structure and function of the human body.
Designed for student nurses only. [Biol. 3: 2 lect. and 2 double lab.
Fall; Biol. 4: 3 lect. and 1double lab. Winter.]
W 6 HUMAN ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
5 crs.
Designed to make the student aware of the structure and function of the
human body. Required for physical education majors. Does not apply
toward a biology major or minor, but does apply to the general education requirement in science if preceded by Biology 1. [4 lect., 2 double
lab. Spring.]
8 MICROBIOLOGY
4 crs.
Basic microbial features are considered as well as applications of microbiology to the fields of medicine and sanitation. For student nurses only.
[Prereq. :Chem. 3.3 lect., 2 double lab. Winter, Spring.]
1 1 , 12 GENERAL BIOLOGY
6, 6 crs.
A comprehensive introduction to biological science. For biology and other
science majors. First term. molecular and cellular biology, genetics
and development, evolutionary mechanisms. Second term: vertebrate
anatomy and physiology, phylogenetic relationships of organisms, ecology. Must be taken in sequence. C5 lect., 2 double lab. Prereq.: Chem. 5 or
15. 11, Winter. 12, Spring.]
5 1 INVERTEBRATE ZOOLOGY
5 crs.
The major invertebrate types stressing classification, morphology, behavior, life history, and evolutionary relationships. [4 lect., 2 double lab.
Prereq. :12. Fall.]
53 COMPARATIVE VERTEBRATE ZOOLOGY
6 crs.
A comparative study dealing with the taxonomy, morphology, and evolution of the larger vertebrate phyla. [4 lect., 2 double lab. Prereq.: 12,
Winter.]
61 PLANT MORPHOLOGY
5 crs.
The structure, reproduction, and development of the major taxonomic
plant groups. [4 lect., 2 double lab. Prereq.: 12. Fall, 1969.1
W 63 PLANT TAXONOMY
5 crs.
Principles of plant classification with special emphasis on the flowering
plants. Includes field collecting and classifying some plants indigenous
to our state. [4 lect., 2 double lab. Saturday field trips required. Prereq.:
12. Spring, 1968.1
W 71 CELLULAR BIOLOGY
6 crs.
A study of the ultrastructure, function, and genetics of cells. Laboratory
work includes microtechnique, cytological studies, studies in cell physiology, and a n introduction to tissue culture. [5 lect., 2 double lab. Prereq.:
12, Chem. 23 or 51. Fall.]
W 72 GENETICS
5 crs.
The principles of heredity with emphasis on recent advances in molecular,
cellular and human genetics. Laboratory, with work on Drosphila and
certain micro-organisms, is optional for one additional credit. [5 lect.,
1double lab. plus individual work if lab is taken. Prereq.: 12. Spring.]
W 73 GENERAL PHYSIOLOGY
6 crs.
A study of physical and chemical processes occurring in animals with
emphasis on the vertebrates. [5 lect., 2 double lab. Prereq.: 12, and
Chem. 23 or 51. Winter.]
74 DEVELOPMENTAL BIOLOGY
6 crs.
A consideration of the chemical, physiological, and morphological changes which occur during the development of organisms with emphasis on
the vertebrate animals. Experimental as well as descriptive studies are
included in the laboratory work. [5 lect., 2 double lab. Prereq.: 12.
Spring.]
UPPER DIVISION
COURSES
76 MICROBIOLOGY
6 crs.
An introduction to the study of micrclorganisms with emphasis on bacteria and viruses. Microbial taxonomy, morphology, physiology, genetics,
and pathogenicity are considered as well as certain methods. [5 lect.,
2 double lab. Prereq. : 12, Chem. 23 or 51. Fall.]
E 81 ECOLOGY
5 crs.
A survey of representative biological communities; the shtdy of reciprocal relationships between organisms and their environments. [4 lect.,
2 double lab. Saturday field trips required. Prereq.: 12. Spring, 1969.1
91, 92, 93 SEMINAR
I cr. each
Discussions of topics based on biological literature and research. Topics
may concern the history and philosophy of science as well as current
literature. Biology majors are required to register for at least two
terms in their senior year. [Fall, Winter, Spring.]
99 INDEPENDENT STUDY
1-5 crs.
Individual work on a research project. [Prereq.: Previous arrangement
with instructor. Fall, Winter, Spring.)
MR. BUDGE, chairman, MISS LUND, MR. SABELLA, MR. SLESNICK,
MR. TEDEFAIAK
Majors in this department supplement the liberal arts program with
general and specialized knowledge in business and economic affairs.
The business administration major offers a basic core of courses, and
then allows the student to choose a limited specialization in accounting
or finance, and hence to prepare for careers in these fields. The
economics major concentrates on fundamental theoretical and policy
matters so that the student learns to analyze economic issues. He
is prepared thereby for graduate study in economics. Either of these
majors also can provide the background needed for general administrative careers in business, government, or various public and private
institutions. In particular, either major could be the basis for graduate
study in such fields as hospital and public administration, industrial
relations, or law.
DEPARTMENT
OF
ADMINISTRATION,
ECONOMICS,
AND
EDUCATION
BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION
Major in Business Administration-Accounting : 38 credits, including Bus.
Ad. 1, 2, 31, 61, 62, 63, 81, 83. Major in Business Administration-Finance:
38 credits, including Bus. Ad. 1, 2, 31, 61, 62, 73, 78. Both programs also
require Econ. 22, 23, 51, 58 or 91 or 92; and Soc. 61.
Minor: 18 credits, including Bus. Ad. 1, 2 ; and two courses from Bus. Ad.
61, 62, 63, 73. Econ. 22, 23 also required. Other combinations may be
allowed by permission.
1 , 2 PRINCIPLES OF ACCOUNTING
4, 4 crs.
Basic concepts of accounting, accounting for individual proprietorships,
partnerships, and corporations. Special topics including manufacturing
accounting, taxes, and budgeting. [I, Fall. 2, Winter.]
31 BUSINESS LAW
5 crs.
Legal rules relating to contracts, agency, negotiable instruments, property and business organizations under the Uniform Commercial Code.
[Fall.]
W 61 FUNDAMENTALS OF FINANCE
5 crs.
Capital structures of business organizations, use of financial statements,
cash flow, raising and control of short and long-term funds for a
business enterprise. [Prereq.: 1 , 2 . Fall. 1
62 INTERMEDIATE ACCOUNTING
5 crs.
An analysis of accounting theory pertaining to financial statements,
income concepts, capital stock and surplus accounts, current and longterm assets. [Prereq.: 1, 2. Winter.]
63 INTERMEDIATE ACCOUNTING
5 crs.
An analysis of accounting theory pertaining to investments, tangible
and intangible fixed assets, liabilities and reserves, actuarial topics.
Additional emphasis on income determination considering price level
changes. [Prereq. : 62. Spring.]
73 FINANCIAL MANAGEMENT
5 crs.
Financial problems relating to budgeting, short and long-term fund
requirements, debt and equity choices, mergers and reorganizations
presented in case materials. [Prereq. : 62. Spring, 1969-70.1
UPPER DIVISION
COURSES
78 INVESTMENTS
5 crs.
The nature of various types of securities. Analysis of securities of
industrial, utility, and financial enterprises and various governmental
units. Portfolio management. [Prereq. :41. Spring, 196849.1
8 1 COST ACCOUNTING
5 crs.
Essential features of accounting for manufacturing
emphasis on management control. [Prereq. 1, 2. Fall.]
82 TAX ACCOUNTING
concerns with
5 crs.
The more common and important provisions of federal income taxes
for individuals and various forms of business enterprises. [Prereq.:
1, 2. Winter.]
83 AUDITING
5 crs.
Internal and external auditing procedures. Emphasis on internal checks
and controls for accounting systems. [Prereq.: 63. Spring.]
ECONOMICS
Major: 37 credits, including Econ. 22, 23, 51, and 58. Soc. 61 and Bus. Ad.
1, 2 also required. Mathematics through course 43 is highly recommended
for those planning on graduate study in economics.
Minor: 22 credits, including Econ. 22, 23.
22 PRINCIPLES OF ECONOMICS I
4 crs.
Analysis of economic institutions, problems, and policies. Emphasis
upon the foundations of economics, economic systems, and specific issues,
such as unemployment, poverty, monopdy, inflation, role of government. [Fall,Winter, Spring.]
23 PRINCIPLES OF ECONOMICS II
4 crs.
Micro- and macroeconomic theory examined with the analytical tools
of economics. Topics include determination of the level of national
income and employment, money and bankjng. monetary-fiscal policy,
economics of the firm, product and resource pricing and allocation, etc.
[Prereq. : 22. Spring.]
UPPER DIVISION
COURSES
E 5 1 INTERMEDIATE MICROECONOMICS
5 crs.
Theory of demand, theory of the firm, price and output determination
under various market conditions, factor price determination. [Prereq.:
23. Fall.]
52 ECONOMIC DEVELOPMENT
5 crs.
Determinants of growth, theories, and historic patterns. Analysis of
the present developing nations a s to characteristics, problems, and
policies to promote growth. [Prereq.: 22 or #. Winter, 196849.1
53 LABOR ECONOMICS
4 crs.
Economics of the labor market. Wage determination, collective bargaining, role of unions, level of total employment, economic security, and
governmental activity. [Prereq. : 22 or # Spring.]
.
E 58 INTERMEDIATE MACROECONOMICS
5 crs.
Determinants of national income, employment, and price level analyzed
via a macro-model. Some consideration of macremeasurement, the
business cycle, growth, monetary-fiscal policy. [Prereq.: 23. Winter,
1961)-70.1
91 PUBLIC FINANCE
5 crs.
Governmental taxation, spending, borrowing, and the impact of governmental finance on economic activity. [Prereq.: 22 o r #. Fall.]
92 MONEY AND BANKING
5 crs.
Functioning of the monetary and banking system, particularly commercial banks, the Federal Reserve and its role in relation to aggregate economic activity. Emphasis upon monetary theory and policy.
[Prereq. : 23. Winter.]
9 9 INDEPENDENT STUDY
2-5 crs.
Individual supervised projects designed to give the student opportunity to analyze some topic or issue in depth. [Prereq.: #. Fall,
Spring.]
BUSINESS EDUCATION
These courses a r e planned to prepare students to teach business
education in high school, for stenographic and secretarial positions in
business offices, for parish secretarial work, and to provide a n o p
portunity for the development of business skills for personal use.
Major: 51 credits, including 8, 10, 21, 22, 50, 53, 63; Bus. Ad. 1, 2, 31;
Econ. 22, 23.
Minor with secretarial emphasis: 26 credits, including 8, 10, 21, 22,
50 and 53.
Minor with accounting emphasis: 25 credits, including 8, 50; Bus. Ad.
1, 2 ; and Econ. 22, 23.
For those who have had elementary shorthand in high school, the
major may be 47 credits and the minor, 22 credits. Students with two
years of shorthand from high school may be exempted from a total of
8 credits in shorthand, but they must elect one other course in the
business field.
I ELEMENTARY TYPEWRITING
2 crs.
The fundamental skills of typewriting. Emphasis on personal use. Not
open to students who have had one year of high school typewriting.
[5 hours. Fall.]
8 CALCULATING MACHINES
4 crs.
Operation of ten-key and full-key adding machines and the rotary calculator. Introduction to automation. [4 hours. Fall, Winter.]
10 DUPLICATING, TRANSCRIPTION, AND
RECORDS MANAGEMENT
4 crs.
Operation of transcription machines, stencil and spirit duplicating machines. An introduction to and application of basic principles of filing
and organization of records in the office. 14 hoilrs. Prereq.: 1 or equiv.
Spring.]
21 ELEMENTARY SHORTHAND
4 crs.
Fundamentals of Gregg shorthand (Diamond Jubilee) with emphasis
on theory, reading and writing shorthand. Introduction to transcription.
Not open to students who have had one year of shorthand in high
school. [5 hours. Prereq. : 1 or equiv. Fall.]
22 INTERMEDIATE SHORTHAND
4 crs.
Review for those with previous shorthand instruction. Development of
speed and accuracy in taking and transcribing mate?ial dictated a t
speeds of 80-100 words a minute. 15 hours. Prereq.: 21 or equiv. Winter.1
UPPER DIVISION
COURSES
W
50 ADVANCED TYPEWRITING
5 crs.
Further development of typewriting technique in business letter arrangement, billing, tabulating, manuscript typing, and the typing of
legal documents. [Prereq.: 1 or equiv. Winter.]
53 ADVANCED SHORTHAND
5 crs.
Advanced study of Gregg shorthand. Rapid dictation and transcription
of material dictated a t speeds of 100-120 words a minute. [Prereq.:
22 or equiv. Spring.]
63 SECRETARIAL PROCEDURES
4 crs.
Dictation, business letter writing, telephoning, use of business and legal
forms, personality development, writing application letters, and making
applications for a job. An introduction to automation. [Prereq.: 22 or
equiv. Spring.]
65 BUSINESS SEMINAR
3 crs.
A study in special problems in the field of business education through
research and-inforial
discussion. Special emphasis on general business.
l-Fd.1
DEPARTMENT
OF
CHEMISTRY
MR. AGRE, chairman,MR. ALTON, MR. GYBERG,
MR. HOLUM, MR. INGEMANSON, MR. LYLE
I t is the purpose of this department to give students an understanding
and an appreciation of the nature of matter and the ways by which
this has been elucidated. The curriculum in chemistry provides an
opportunity to examine the chemical aspect of the structure, the power,
and the beauty of one of the great intellectual accomplishments of
man-modern science-and it provides dramatic examples of effective
ways to handle certain types of problems.
Courses in chemistry are offered as part of a liberal arts education, and
as a preparation for: (1)high school teaching, (2) the study of biology,
medicine, dentistry, pharmacy, medical technology, nursing and allied
professions, (3) graduate study in chemistry and molecular biology, and
(4) the chemical profession.
The chemistry department is approved by the American Chemical Society
for the preparation of chemistry majors.
Students planning to majo-. in chemistry in preparation for graduate
school, medical school, or high school teaching, are urged to consult
with the chemistry staff a t the earliest possible time.
Major: 40 credits, including Chem. 51, 52, 53, 61, and one additional
upper division course. Also required are Physics 21, 22, 23; Math. 41, 42.
Recommended for pre-medical students: 15, 16, 51, 52, 53, 61, and 62; for
pre-dental students: 15, 16 (or 5, 6), 51, 52; for graduate study: 15,
16, and all courses above 50. Additional mathematics and physics strongly
recommended for graduate study.
Majors participate in informal, weekly seminars during the junior and
senior years in Chem. 91.
Minor: 27 credits; must include Chem. 15, 16 (or 5, 6) and other courses
to complete the 27 credits. Chem. 23 and 53 are strongly recommended.
Course 3 does not count toward the major or minor.
See under Curriculums for a suggested course of study.
3 ELEMENTARY CHEMISTRY
4 crs.
Selected elements of general, organic, and biological chemistry are
organized around the theme: the molecular basis of life. Designed for
prospective nurses from Lutheran Deaconess, Fairview, Methodist,
and Swedish Hospitals. 13 lect., 1double lab. Prereq.: H.S. Chem. Fall.]
5 , 6 PRINCIPLES OF CHEMISTRY
6, 6 crs.
Primarily for non-majors. The concepts and laws underlying chemistry
illustrated by examples from inorganic and organic chemistry. Semimicro qualitative analysis included in the laboratory. [5 lect., 2 double
labs. 5, Fall. 6, Winter.]
6, 6 crs.
15, 16 GENERAL AND QUALITATIVE CHEMISTRY
An intensive course for pre-medical students and future chemists;
others only by permission of instructor. First term devoted to fundamental principles, and second to inorganic chemistry and qualitative
analysis. [5 lect., 2 double labs. Proreq.: H.S. Chem., elem. alg., plane
geom. 15, Fall. 16, Winter.]
6 crs.
2 3 ELEMENTARY ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
Designed for medical technology and other students 1.. ho desire less
than the more intensive two-term course. Aliphatic and aromatic compounds with frequent reference to bio-chemistry. [5 lect., 1 three-hour
lab. Prereq. :5 or 15. Spring.]
5 1 . 52 ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
6 , 6 crs.
Important classes of organic compounds with special emphasis on
types of mechanisms and multi-step syntheses. Descriptive material is
correlated by means of modern theories of chemical bonds, energyrelationships, and reaction mechanisms. Laboratory work is a study
of techniques while synthesizing or identifying typical compounds.
Normally taken in the sophomore year. [5 lect., 2 three-hour labs. Prereq. : 6 or 16. 51, Fall. 52, Winter.]
UPPER DIVISION
53 QUANTITATIVE ANALYTICAL CHEMISTRY
5 or 6 crs.
Gravimetric and volumetric analysis with some instrumental analysis.
Ionic equilibria and treatment of data. Normally taken in the sophomore
year. Medical technology students register for 6 credits, others for 5.
[4 lect., 2 three-hour labs. Prereq. : 6 or 16. Spring.]
61, 62 PHYSICAL CHEMISTRY
6, 6 crs.
Atomic structure, states of matter, gas laws, thermodynamics, thermochemistry, equilibrium, solutions, phase rule, electrochemistry, kinetics,
and colloids. [5 lect., 1 three-hour lab. Prereq.: 53, Physics 23, Math.
42. 61, Fall. 62, Winter.1
63 ADVANCED ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
5 crs.
Organized around the problems of identifying organic compounds in
the laboratory, the lecture topics include : structure-spectra correlations
for TTe. UV, NMR, and mass spectroscopy; classical methods; use
of the literature (inc. Beilstein); and further study in reaction mechanisms. IR and UV spectra routinely used. [4 lect., 2 four-hour labs.
Prereq.: 52, 61, and some reading knowledge of German. Spring.]
1 72 QUANTUM CHEMISTRY
4 crs.
Classical mechanics, uncertainty principle, Schrediiger's equation, approximate methods of solution, commutators, conservation laws, electron
spin, angular momentum, the hydrogen atom, many electron problems.
[4 lect. Prereq. :61 or #. Winter.]
8 1 ADVANCED ANALYTICAL CHEMISTRY
5 crs.
Principles of atomic and molecular spectroscopy and their application
to modern analytical methods. Includes instrumental methods, such as
spectrophotometric, electro-analytical, and chromatographic techniques.
[3 lect., 2 three-hour labs. Prereq. :53, 62 or #. Fall.]
83 ADVANCED INORGANIC CHEMISTRY
5 crs.
Correlation of inorganic chemistry using the electrostatic, valence bond,
and molecular orbital models. Coordination compounds are discussed
using the ligand field theory. Preparations of typical inorganic compounds using a variety of techniques including vacuum manipulations.
[4 lect., I four-hour lab. Prereq. : 62 or #. Spring.]
91 CHEMISTRY SEMINAR
0 crs.
During the junior and senior years all chemistry majors will participate
in weekly seminars to present and discuss research papers of general
interest. [Fall, Winter, Spring.]
97 CHEMISTRY RESEARCH
Cr. arr.
During the summer after the junior year or during the senior year,
each chemistry major preparing for graduate study in chemistry may
participate in independent research in cooperation with staff members.
By staff permission only. [Fall, Winter, Spring, or special summer program.]
DEPARTMENT
OF
CLASSICAL.
LANGUAGES
MR. COLACCI, chairman, SISTER M. GERTRUDE WARD
The purpose of the courses offered in the department is two-fold; first
to provide the students with a linguistic foundation in order that they
may have a direct approach to the classical tradition which is an essential part of our Western literary heritage; second, to introduce the
studects to some of the major works of the Greek and Latin world in
the original language. Courses 11 through 52 are designed to meet the
two-year requirement in New Testament Greek of most theological seminaries.
GREEK
Major: 42 credits in Greek. Also required: Latin 1, 2.
Special arrangements will be made for students who intend to major
in Greek. If the number of students is not large enough to permit regular offering by the College, provisions will be made so that they may
complete the major at the University of Minnesota. When this is the
case, in addition to courses 11, 12, 13, 51, 52, 59, they are required to
take a t the University, five courses to be chosen from those listed under
Greek, 61 to 163.
Minor: 27 credits.
H 1 1 , 12 BEGINNING GREEK
5, 5 crs.
Theoretical and practical study of Greek grammar, with special emphasis an morphology. Translation exercises from and into Greek. CPrereq.:
Latin 2 or 2 yrs., H.S. Latin or #. 11, Fall, 12, Winter.]
13 INTERMEDIATE GREEK
5 crs.
Continuation of grammar with special emphasis on syntax. Reading
and parsing of easy selections from classical and New Testament Greek
writings. [Prereq. :12. Spring.]
5 1 , 52 NEW TESTAMENT GREEK
4, 4 crs.
Selections from the synoptic Gospels and the book of Acts. Special
emphasis is given to parsing and syntax of the Greek text. [Prereq.:
13. 51, Fall; 52, Winter.]
H 55 GREEK EXEGESIS
4 crs.
Selections from the Pauline and Catholic Epistles. Special emphasis is
given to the syntactical and exegitical approach to the Greek text. COffered on demand. Spring.]
H 59 CLASSICAL GREEK
4 crs.
Selections from classical Greek prose and poetry. [Prereq. : 52. Offered on
demand.]
UPPER DIVISION
COURSES
LATIN
Minor: 28 credits. Also required: Eng. 35.
Courses 52, 53 offered only if there is sufficient enrollment. If they are
not offered, a minor may be completed a t the University of Minnesota.
Consult the department chairman a t Augsburg.
Students who wish to major in Latin may complete all courses in Latin
offered a t Augsburg, plus 61, 62, 63 and 9 additional credits in courses
numbered above 63 a t the University of Minnesota.
1 , 2 BEGINNING LATIN
5, 5 crs.
Theoretical and practical study of Latin grammar, with special emphasis
on morphology. Exercises in translation from and into Latin. [I, Fall, 2,
Winter.]
3 , 4 INTERMEDIATE LATIN
4, 4 crs.
Continuation of grammar. Reading of prose and poetry selections from
Latin authors; e.g. Caesar, Cicero, Livy, Vergil, Ovid, St. Augustine,
and the Medieval Latin writers. [Prereq.: 2 or equiv., determined by
placement test. 3, Fall; 4, Winter.]
UPPER DIVISION
COURSES
52 VERGlL
5 crs.
Selections from Vergil's "Aeneid" and pastoral poems. [Offered on demand.]
53 CICERO
5 crs.
Selections from Cicero's works. [Offered on demand.]
ECONOMICS
See under Department of Business Administration, Economics, and
Business Education.
DEPARTMENT
OF
EDUCATION
MR. JOHNSON, chairman, MRS. ANDEREGG, MR. FARDIG,
MR. GROENHOFF, MRS. LUDEMAN, MISS MATTSON,
MRS. PARKER, MR. M. QUANBECK
The education curriculum has been designed primarily for those preparing to do public school teaching, although any student who is preparing to work with youth is encouraged to study in the area. The work
in this department will qualify the graduate for teaching on the elementary or the junior and senior high school level. as well a s for further
study in the field of education. The program is accredited by the State
of Minnesota, the North Central Association of Colleges and Secondary
Schools, and the National Council for Accreditation of Teacher Education.
Admission to the education curriculum requires an application to be
approved by the Committee on Teacher Education. Application must
be made during the second semester of the sophomore year. Approval
is granted on the basis of a satisfactory health report, favorable personality characteristics and a satisfactory scholastic achievement. For
elementary teaching candidates, this means essentially a 2.5 grade-point
average in work completed in the minor and a 2.0 over-all; for secondary
teaching candidates a 2.5 in work completed in the major and a 2.0
over-all. Both are expected to maintain a 2.5 average in their major
and 2.0 over-all average. Candidates in both fields must make application
for student teaching as juniors and are required to meet the 2.5 major
and 2.0 general average at this point.
ELEMENTARY EDUCATION
Major: 51 credits in professional education courses. In addition, the
following general education courses are required: Psych. 5; Hist. 2 1 or
22; Math. 56; Geog. 14; and three terms of Group Activities (Ed. 52,
53, 54).
See under Curriculums for a suggested course of study.
0 crs.
52, 53, 54 GROUP ACTIVITIES 1 , 11, 111
Required without academic credit as a laboratory experience in connection with Education 55 and 56. Includes such experience as teaching,
supervising recreation, advising clubs in cooperation with city organizations and agencies. Three terms required. [Fall, Winter, Spring.]
55 HUMAN GROWTH AND DEVELOPMENT
4 crs.
The growth and development of the human organism from conception
through adolescence. Emphasis on process of learning, factors influencing learning. [Prereq.: Psych. 5. Fall.]
1 56 ELEMENTARY SCHOOL TEACHING
5 crs.
The qualifications of teachers; the teaching profession. Survey of American schools: philosophies, curricula, policies, and practices. Learning
theory and tests and measurements. Includes observation of teaching
situations. [Prereq. : Admission to Elementary Education. Fall.]
1 57 METHODS AND MATERIALS:
HEALTH, PHYSICAL EDUCATION, MUSIC
4 crs.
Principles, methods and techniques for teaching health and physical
education a t the elementary school level. Methods pertaining to rote
singing, notation, rhythm, part singing. Integration of music in total
elementary program. [Prereq. : 55, 56. Winter.]
58 ART IN ELEMENTARY SCHOOLS
4 crs.
See under Department of Art.
1 63 METHODS AND MATERIALS:
MATHEMATICS, SCIENCE
4 crs.
Principles, methods and techniques of teaching arithmetic and science
in the elementary school. Use of instructional materials. [Prereq. : 55, 56.
Spring. I
64 METHODS AND MATERIALS:
LANGUAGE ARTS, READING
6 crs.
Objectives and techniques in the language arts : listening, speaking,
writing, and reading. Application of principles of learning in acquisition
of skills, interests, attitudes. Examinations of modern methods and
materials. [Prereq. : 55, 56. Spring.]
65 METHODS AND MATERIALS: SOCIAL STUDIES
2 crs.
Objectives, principles, methods and techniques in the social studies.
Development of units. [Prereq.: 55, 56. Spring.]
15 crs.
77 PROFESSIONAL LABORATORY EXPERIENCE
Student spends ten weeks in the classroom, assisting the regular teacher, and doing actual teaching. Supervision is carried out by the cooperating teacher and the college staff. This is followed by one week of
seminar with discussion of problems encountered in the classroom. [Prereq. : # Fall, Winter.]
.
79 CHILDREN'S LITERATURE
3 crs.
Study of literature suitable to the elementary school child. Role of
literature in the classroom, in life outside of school. Extensive reading
and evaluation of children's books, compiling bibliography. [Prereq. : 55,
56 or #. Spring.]
87 SCHOOL AND SOCIETY
4 crs.
ment of American education. [Prereq. : Senior standing. Winter, Spring.]
Problems in education and the relation of the American school system
to modern society. A study of educational philosophy and the development of American education. [Prereq.: Senior standing. Winter, Spring.]
0
SECONDARY EDUCATION
For the Minnesota teacher's certificate students are required to complete 28 credits in professional education courses including 50, 52, 53, 54,
59, 83, 84, 87. All students must register for three terms of Group Activity (Education 52, 53, 54). Secondary education students must take
Phy. Ed. 10 and Psych. 5 in addition to other general education requirements.
50 EDUCATIONAL PSYCHOLOGY
4 crs.
Physical, mental, social and emotional development of adolescents with
special emphasis placed on educational implication. The nature and
conditions of learning. [Prereq.: Psych. 5 and junior standing. Fall,
Winter.]
0 cr.
52, 53, 54 GROUP ACTIVITY I, 11, 111
Required without academic credit as a laboratory experience in connection with Education 50 and 59. lncludes such experience as teaching, supervising recreation, advising clubs in cooperation with city organizations and agencies. Three terms required. [Fall, Winter, Spring.]
M 59 METHODS IN SECONDARY EDUCATION
5 crs.
Teaching procedures, materials and problems at the secondary level.
Three class sessions per week will be devoted to general methods and
two to four class sessions to the specific methods and materials of the
student's major field. [Prereq. : 50. Spring.]
68 TEACHING OF MUSIC IN ELEMENTARY AND
JUNIOR HIGH SCHOOLS
4 crs.
Materials, organization, and teaching procedures in the field of music
a t the elementary and junior high school levels. For music majors.
[Prereq.: 50. Spring.]
8 3 SEMINAR FOR STUDENT TEACHING
5 crs.
Preparation for the student teaching experience including observation
and planning. Special attention will be given to tests and measurements.
[Prereq. : Admission to student teaching. Fall, Winter.]
84 STUDENT TEACHING
10 crs.
Experience in observing and directing learning experiences a t the secondary school level under supervision of college and high school personnel.
Course fee $20.00. [Prereq.: Admission to the student teaching program.
Fall, Winter.]
W 87 SCHOOL AND SOCIETY
4 crs.
Problems in education and the relation of the American school system
to modern society. A study of educational philosophy and the development of American education. [Winter, Spring.]
88 GUIDANCE
4 crs.
The guidance function of the classroom teacher; tools and techniques
used in studying students; and methods appropriate for student guidance,
including counseling. [Fall.]
W 99 INDEPENDENT STUDY
2-5 crs.
Independent study offering students an opportunity to explore areas of
specialization in education. Each student does research and presents a
report of his findings on the requirements, present status, and future
possibilities of his own field of interest. Conducted largely on a seminar basis. Open to seniors with the approval of the department. [Fall,
Winter, Spring.]
LIBRARY SCIENCE
The following courses prepare the student to meet the state requirements for a minor in library science. Preparation for selection of books
and related materials, efficient and effective management of library
materials, intelligent use of library sources are included. While the
minor in library science is planned to prepare the graduate in the area
of school librarianship, it is also a valuable minor for any student planning a teaching career, since it introduces him to many avenues of
curriculum enrichment. The courses provide a foundation for the student
who wishes to do advanced work in the field of library science.
Minor: 23 credits.
45 FUNCTIONS OF THE SCHOOL LIBRARY
5 crs.
The role of the library in the school and community. Types of library
services and activities; methods of evaluation. Organization of library
materials, including cataloging and circulation. [Fall.]
W 46 SELECTION OF LIBRARY MATERIALS
4 crs.
Theory, principles and techniques of selection. An introduction to basic
selection tools; analysis of book reviews and annotations. C3 lects., 1
disc. Spring.]
UPPER DIVISION
58 THE ELEMENTARY SCHOOL LIBRARY:
MATERIALS SELECTION AND GUIDANCE
5 crs.
Characteristics and purposes of an elementary school library. Extensive study of book lists, book talks, story-telling and a wide exposure
to individual titles of books and related materials. Emphasis on preparation of papers and bibliographies. C3 lects. Fall.]
59 INTRODUCTION OF REFERENCE MATERIALS
4 crs.
Intensive study of outstanding and useful reference books most frequently used by students and librarians; bibliographies, indexes, and periodical guides. Development of skills in the performance of reference duties
-of a librarian. Laboratory work. C3 lects. Winter.]
75 THE HIGH SCHOOL LIBRARY:
5 crs.
MATERIALS SELECTION AND GUIDANCE
Survey and evaluation of library materials on the secondary level, with
attention to their use in relation to school curricula as well as for personal interests and needs of young adults. Emphasis on preparation of
papers and bibliographies. [3 lects. Prereq.: 45. Spring.]
GEOGRAPHY
14 HUMAN GEOGRAPHY
4 crs.
An intxoduction to the basic concepts and tools of geography followed
by a survey of the distribution patterns to be found in our physical and
human environment. [Winter, Spring.]
DEPARTMENT
OF
MR. GRAY, chairman, MR. BERGSTROM, MR. BLY,
MRS. BOLSTERLI, MRS. CHRISTENSEN, MR. DAHLEN,
MRS. KARVONEN, MISS LILLEHEI, MRS. LIVINGSTON,
MR. NICHOLL, MR. PALOSAARI, MISS PEDERSON, MR. SARGENT,
MRS. TRAUTWEIN
The aim of the Department of English is to develop the student's ability
in oral and written expression, to increase his proficiency in reading
and analyzing literature, to acquaint him with the English language
and with the beginnings of Western literature and its development,
especially in England and America, and to stimulate his appreciation and
understanding of the fundamental human problems and situations revealed in great literature.
The department prepares for the teaching of English in the elementary
and secondary school and for graduate study.
Major: 46 credits above 15, Including, 35, 45, 47, 61, 62, 84, plus one
writing course above 15, one seminar, one modern literature course,
and electives.
Major for secondary teaching: 54 credits above 15, including course
55 in addition to those listed for the major. Writing course 31 required.
Speech 12 or 52, or 55, and 60 or 66, as well as Library Science 75 are
also required.
Students preparing for graduate study should include 86, 88, and a t least
one tsrm of Independent Study. Proficiency in one or more foreign languages is recommended. Foreign languages most generally required
for graduate study in English are Latin, German, French.
Minor: 32 credits above 15, including 35, 45, 47 or 61 or 62, 84, plus one
writing course above 15, one seminar course, and electives.
Minor for secondary school teaching: 32 credits including course 31 for
the writing course, and 55 in addition to those listed for the minor.
Minor for elementary school teaching: 24 credits above 15, including
31, 35, 45, 55, and 47 or 61 or 62.
Concerning English Proficiency: Juniors who do not have a satisfactory grade on the sophomore English Test must improve their use
of English in preparation for a second test. The English Department
will, upon request, advise the student how to direct his studies in preparation for the second test.
Satisfactory completion of course 11 is prerequisite to 12; satisfactory
completion of course 12 or 15 is prerequisite to all other English courses.
W I I COMPOSITION AND LITERATURE
4 crs.
The study of language and composition with emphasis on expository
writing. Attention to correct usage, logical organization, reading and
analysis of expository and narrative selections, especially the short story.
[Fall, Winter, Spring.]
W 12 COMPOSITION AND LITERATURE
5 crs.
Continued stress on expository writing, including the reference paper,
the study and analysis of drama, poetry, novel. [Fall, Winter, Spring.]
W 15 COMPOSITION AND LITERATURE
5 crs.
Honors course for students with high proficiency in English. Covers
basically the material listed under 11 and 12 with more emphasis on
critical analysis. Students completing this course meet the freshman
English requirement by completing English 35 or 40 or 45. [Fall.]
W 2 1 INTRODUCTION TO JOURNALISM
4 crs.
A brief survey of the ethics and history of journalism, with emphasis on
the techniques and practices in news, feature, and editorial writing.
rWinter.1 ,
3 1 EXPOSITORY WRITING
4 crs.
A course in expository and argumentative writing, including reading
analysis of selected models. [Fall, Winter, Spring.]
W 32 CREATIVE WRITING
4 crs.
Study of the techniques of descriptive and narrative writing, both prose
and poetry. Class discussion and evaluation of the student's work. [Fall.]
W 35 THE CLASSICAL TRADITION
5 crs.
Study of the works of selected Greek and Roman writers in the various
genre, and the influence of the classical tradition on later Western literature. [Fall, Winter, Spring.]
W 40 LITERARY CLASSICS
4 crs.
Reading, analysis, discussion of selected European classics from the
Renaissance to the Modern Age, chiefly non-English writers. [Fall,
Winter, Spring.]
45 MAJOR AMERICAN WRITERS
5 crs.
Works of selected American writers from Colonial times to the present,
noting their contribution to the historical development and the literary
movements of American literature. [Fall, Winter, Spring.]
47 MEDIEVAL AND RENAISSANCE LITERATURE
5 crs.
The development of Western literature, chiefly British, from "Beowulf"
to Shakespeare through study of significant works and their relation to
the literary and historical context. [Prereq.: 35 or #. Fall, Spring.]
UPPER DIVISION
COURSES
.
55 INTRODUCTION TO MODERN ENGLISH
5 crs.
A study of modern English viewed from a historical perspective, with
reading in recent linguistic studies. Designed to give the student an
introduction to structural linguistics and a view of the development of
the English language. [Spring.]
6 1 BRITISH LITERATURE, 16 16-1 800
5 crs.
Reading, analysis, and discussion of works of selected writers from the
metaphysical poets through Blake, with attention to the historical, intellectual, and social influences and the major literary movements. [Prereq. :47 or
# .Fall.]
62 BRITISH LITERATURE OF THE NINETEENTH CENTURY 5 crs.
Study of the works of the major Romantic and Victorian poets, critics,
essayists and novelists and of the major literary movements of the
century. [Prereq. : 61 or # Winter.]
.
72 MODERN FICTION
4 crs.
Significant works of selected prose writers, chiefly British and American, of the twentieth century. [Winter.]
74 MODERN POETRY
4 crs.
Study of the work of selected twentieth century poets, chiefly British
and American, with attention to recent criticism. [Spring.]
78 ADVANCED WRITING: PROSE AND POETRY
4 crs.
A course for students with demonstrated proficiency in writing. Assignments based on students' needs and interests. Class discussion of students' work. [Prereq. :31 or 32 or #. Spring.]
80 THE BRITISH NOVEL
4 crs.
Survey of the development of the novel in England through study of
the work of selected major novelists from the eighteenth century to the
present. [Winter, 196%70.]
82 THE AMERICAN NOVEL
4 crs.
A study of major and representative wokks of selected American novelists. [Winter, 196849.1
84 SHAKESPEARE
5 crs.
Study of ten or twelve major plays-comedies, histories, tragedieswith attention to the development of Shakespeare's dramatic and poetic
art. Additional plays assigned for reading -and analysis. [ ~ r e r e i . :47.
Spring.]
86 MILTON
4 crs.
A study of major poems and selected prose with reference to the intellectual and historical background of Milton's works. [Prereq.: 61
or #. Spring, 196849.1
88 CHAUCER
4 crs.
Study of CXmucer's works and language, with emphasis on "The Canterbury Tales." [Prereq. :47 or #. Spring, 1968-69.1
9 0 , 9 1 , 9 2 ENGLISH SEMINAR
3, 3, 3, crs.
Course 90, methods and problems of bibliography and research; 91,
a major American or British writer; 92, studies in criticism. Open, with
limited enrollment, to any junior or senior with permission of the
instructor. [90, Fall. 91, Winter. 92, Spring.]
99 INDEPENDENT STUDY
2-5 crs.
Open to junior or senior English majors with a grade of B or above.
Provides directed independent study in the area of the student's choice.
[Fall, Winter, Spring.]
As an aid to students who are handicapped in their college work by
inefficient reading skills, Augsburg College offers a non-credit class in
Improvement of Reading. The fee for the class is $25 per term. Arrangements to take the course must be made at the time of registration
for the fall term.
FRENCH AND GERMAN
See under Department of Modern Languages.
GEOGRAPHY
See under Department of Education.
GREEK
See under Department of Classical Languages.
DEPARTMENT
OF HEALTH
AND
EDUCATION
MR. ANDERSON, chairman, MISS ANDERSON, MR. NELSON,
MISS OLSON, MR. PEARSON, MRS. PETERSON, MR. PFEFFER,
MR. SAUGESTAD
The aim of the Department of Health and Physical Education is to
promote health and physical fitness through a well-rounded physical
education program, to develop character and good sportsmanship,
to further the worthy use of leisure time, and to provide an effective
training program for prospective teachers of health and physical
education.
All students are required to take a physical examination as a part
of the registration procedure before participating in any phase of the
physical education program.
One year of physical activities, course 1, 2, 3, is required of all students.
Physical Education major: 40 credits including 11 or 13, 23, 31, 32, 43,
51, 52, 71, 72.
Broad teaching major in Health and Physical Education: 68 credits
including 10, 11 or 13, 23, 31, 32, 43, 50, 51, 52, 57, 59, 60, 71,
72, 73, Biol. 6, plus P.E. 82 for men, and Soc. 31 for women.
Physical Education teaching major: 53 credits includhg 10, 11 or 13,
23, 31, 32, 43, 51, 52, 59, 71, 72, and Biol. 6.
Physical Education teaching minor: 29 credits including 10, 23, 31, 32,
43, and 72.
Health teaching mfnor: 31 credits including 10, 50, 51, 60, 73, and Soc.
31, and Biol. 6.
Coaching endorsement: 25 credits including 10, 43, 51, 82, and Biol. 6.
Coaches entering their first head-coaching assignment in Minnesota
Public Schools are reauired to have a t least a coaching endorsement
in the field of physical education. Sports included under this requirement
are football, basketball, track, hockey, wrestling, and baseball.
1, 2, 3 PHYSICAL ACTIVITIES
1/3, 1/3, 1/3 crs.
Two hours per week. Meets the general education requirement. [I, Fall.
2, Winter. 3, Spring.]
10 HEALTH AND FIRST AID
5 crs.
Modern concepts and practices of health and healthful living applied
to the individual and the community. Includes also the American Red
Cross First Aid Course. [Winter, Spring.]
I I , 13 SWIMMING AND AQUATICS
I , I cr.
Theory and practice in teaching swimming, life-saving and water
safety. Open only to majors and minors. C2 hrs. per wk. 11, (Women),
Fall. 13 (Men), Spring.]
23 TEAM SPORTS
5 crs.
Theory and practice in teaching and officiating team sports. Separate
sections for men and women. [lo hrs. per wk. Spring.]
31 INDIVIDUAL AND DUAL SPORTS
5 crs.
Theory and practice in teaching individual and dual sports. Separate
sections for men and women. [lo hrs. per week. Fall.]
32 RECREATIONAL ACTIVITIES AND RHYTHMS
4 crs.
Theory and practice in teaching recreational activities, social recreation,
quiet games, low organized games, noon-hour activities, camp nights,
relays, modified games, simple rhythmic games, folk and square dancing. C8 hrs. per wk. Winter.]
43 HISTORY AND PRINCIPLES OF PHYSICAL
EDUCATION
5 crs.
History, principles, and philosophy of physical education. [Spring.]
50 INSTRUCTOR'S COURSE IN FIRST AID
I cr.
Methods and materials in teaching the American Red Cross First Aid
Course. [Prereq.: Currently valid Standard First Aid card. Winter.]
51 KINESIOLOGY AND PHYSIOLOGY OF EXERCISE 6 crs.
Mechanics of movement with special emphasis upon the action of the
muscular system. The major effects of exercises upon the systems
of the body. [5 lect. and 1hr. arr. Prereq. : Biol. 6, Chem. 5. Fall.]
52 ADAPTED PHYSICAL EDUCATION AND
EVALUATION
4 crs.
Physical education for the exceptional child with special reference to
the analysis of functional and organic abnormalities and the role of
physical education. Survey of basic statistical procedures and evaluation
of tests in physical ed